UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
FORM 20-F
 
 
(Mark One)
¨
REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) or (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR
 
x
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended 31 December 2019
OR
 
¨

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR
 
¨

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number: 1-6262

BP p.l.c.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 
England and Wales
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

1 St James’s Square, London SW1Y 4PD
United Kingdom
(Address of principal executive offices)

Dr Brian Gilvary
BP p.l.c.
1 St James’s Square, London SW1Y 4PD
United Kingdom
Tel +44 (0) 20 7496 5311
Fax +44 (0) 20 7496 4573
(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)





Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act
 
 
 
Title of each class
Trading Symbol(s)
Name of each exchange on which registered
American Depositary Shares
BP
New York Stock Exchange
Ordinary Shares of 25c each
 
New York Stock Exchange*
Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2020
BP/20D
New York Stock Exchange
Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2021
BP/21D
New York Stock Exchange
Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2022
BP/22D and
BP/22H
New York Stock Exchange
4.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2020
BP/20 and
BP/20C
New York Stock Exchange
4.742% Guaranteed Notes due 2021
BP/21A and
BP/21F
New York Stock Exchange
3.561% Guaranteed Notes due 2021
BP/21B
New York Stock Exchange
2.112% Guaranteed Notes due 2021
BP/21C and
BP/21E
New York Stock Exchange
2.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
BP/22B
New York Stock Exchange
2.520% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
BP/22E and BP/22F
New York Stock Exchange
3.245% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
BP/22A and BP/22G
New York Stock Exchange
3.062% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
BP/22C
New York Stock Exchange
2.750% Guaranteed Notes due 2023
BP/23 and
BP/23D
New York Stock Exchange
3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023
BP/23B and
BP/23C
New York Stock Exchange
3.994% Guaranteed Notes due 2023
BP/23A
New York Stock Exchange
3.535% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
BP/24A
New York Stock Exchange
3.814% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
BP/24
New York Stock Exchange
3.224% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
BP/24B and
BP/24D
New York Stock Exchange
3.790% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
BP/24C
New York Stock Exchange
3.506% Guaranteed Notes due 2025
BP/25
New York Stock Exchange
3.796% Guaranteed Notes due 2025
BP/25A
New York Stock Exchange
3.119% Guaranteed Notes due 2026
BP/26 and
BP/26A
New York Stock Exchange
3.410% Guaranteed Notes due 2026
BP/26C
New York Stock Exchange
3.017% Guaranteed Notes due 2027
BP/27 and
BP/27D
New York Stock Exchange
3.279% Guaranteed Notes due 2027
BP/27B
New York Stock Exchange
3.588% Guaranteed Notes due 2027
BP/27A and
BP/27C
New York Stock Exchange
3.723% Guaranteed Notes due 2028
BP/28
New York Stock Exchange
3.937% Guaranteed Notes due 2028
BP/28A
New York Stock Exchange
4.234% Guaranteed Notes due 2028
BP/28B
New York Stock Exchange
3.067% Guaranteed Notes due 2050
BP/50
New York Stock Exchange
3.000% Guaranteed Notes due 2050
BP/50A
New York Stock Exchange
 
*
Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission






Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.
None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.
None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.
 
 
Ordinary Shares of 25c each
21,535,839,814

Cumulative First Preference Shares of £1 each
7,232,838

Cumulative Second Preference Shares of £1 each
5,473,414

 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  x    No  ¨

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Note—Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or an emerging growth company. See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer  x     Accelerated filer  ¨    Non-accelerated filer  ¨ Emerging growth company ¨

If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ¨

† The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:
U.S. GAAP  ¨
    
International Financial Reporting Standards as issued
by the International Accounting Standards Board  x
  
Other  ¨

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.

Item 17  ¨                Item  18  ¨

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x



BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Our purpose is reimagining energy for people and our planet. We want to help the world reach net zero and improve people’s lives. We will aim to dramatically reduce carbon in our operations and production and grow new low carbon businesses, products and services. We will advocate for fundamental and rapid progress towards Paris and strive to be a leader in transparency. We know we don’t have all the answers and will listen to and work with others. We want to be an energy company with purpose; one that is trusted by society, valued by shareholders and motivating for everyone who works at BP. We believe we have the experience and expertise, the relationships and the reach, the skill and the will, to do this.


 
Strategic report Financial statements Chairman’s letter 2 Consolidated financial statements 131 Chief executive officer’s letter 4 of the BP group Our ambition for the energy transition 6 Notes on the financial statements 157 At a glance 8 Supplementary information on 232 oil and natural gas (unaudited) Global context 10 Our business model 14 Our strategy 16 Our investment process 19 Our strategy in action 24 Additional disclosures 297 Measuring our progress 32 Group performance 36 Shareholder information 327 Sustainability 39 Glossary 337 Upstream 50 Non-GAAP measures 344 reconciliations Downstream 56 Rosneft 61 Signatures 347 Other businesses and corporate 63 Cross-reference to Form 20-F 348 Alternative Energy 63 Information about this report 349 Section 172 statement 66 Exhibits 349 How we manage risk 68 Risk factors 70 Corporate governance Board of directors 74 Executive team 78 The leadership team 80 Introduction from the chair 82 Board activities in 2019 84 How the board has engaged with shareholders, 88 the workforce and other stakeholders Nomination and governance committee 90 Audit committee 91 Safety, environment and security 96 assurance committee Geopolitical committee 98 Chairman’s committee 99 Directors’ remuneration report 100 Remuneration committee 101 Navigating our reports Our fast read Our reporting centre Glossary provides a concise summary of the annual brings together all our key reports, including our Like any industry, ours has its own unique language. report, highlighting strategy, performance and sustainability report, as well as other reports on how For that reason, words and terms marked with  sustainability information. we see the energy market evolving in the future. are defined in the glossary on page 337. bp.com/annualreport. bp.com/reportingcentre. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 1


 
Chairman’s letter “We enter a new decade with a new company purpose: to reimagine energy for people and our planet.” Our investor proposition Growing sustainable free cash flow and distributions to shareholders over the long term. $8.3bn total dividends distributed to BP shareholders (2018 $8.1bn) 6.9% annual dividend yield ordinary share (2018 6.3%) 2 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Dear fellow shareholders, focused on evolving BP’s strategy and Our focus throughout 2020 As I write, the world is facing an portfolio to address the challenges of One of the focal points for the board in unprecedented set of challenges. The tomorrow. This focus has included 2020 will be BP’s capital markets day coronavirus pandemic (COVID-19) is ensuring the smooth transition in in September, when Bernard and his spreading rapidly, with tragic consequences leadership from Bob to Bernard, followed leadership team will lay out more detail for many people across many geographies. by regular engagement by the board with about the strategy, near-term targets and Global efforts to stop the virus are also Bernard and his new leadership team to ways to measure progress. It will be the having significant economic consequences. develop BP’s purpose and net zero moment the vision and ambition set out in And in an oil market where demand has ambition. This is a process which has February becomes much more concrete. fallen, supply has sharply increased. been supported by our dialogue with We will do this while ensuring that we investors, governments, employees maintain a strong focus on high quality and Though unprecedented, a global energy and other key stakeholders. efficient operations and on delivering the company like BP should be prepared for promises we have made to our investors such challenges. Our enduring commitments BP is now set for a future that is different My thanks to you all BP is indeed prepared. Our global to its past, but some things won’t change. In addition to thanking Bob, two other operating structure and long time- BP’s values-based culture will be maintained departing senior leaders deserve a special horizons are intended to mitigate the and further developed. BP’s purpose and mention – chief financial officer Brian effect of near-term shocks. That is how ambition reflect its culture, and together Gilvary, who has decided to step down from BP has approached shocks and volatility they position BP well to develop as an the board in June after eight years in the job, in its 110-year history, and that is how increasingly sustainable company. and Downstream chief executive Tufan we will approach this storm too. In Erginbilgic, who leaves BP at the end of particular, the past decade has given Our commitment to safe and reliable March. On behalf of the board, I extend my BP unique experience in successfully operations will remain paramount. BP’s thanks and my deep appreciation for the handling crises – and we enter this one safety performance has seen near profound contributions they each made even better prepared. continuous improvement since 2010, and during an important period for the company. we must continue to learn and improve. But in this world of change, BP itself is also We believe that the new organizational Of course, each of our employees has a changing. We enter a new decade with a structure BP set out last month will help very important role to play in BP’s progress, new company purpose: to reimagine to reinforce this commitment. and they should be recognized. On behalf energy for people and our planet. We have of the board I extend my sincere thanks to also set a new ambition: to become a net As well as our enduring commitment all our people for a job well done in 2019. zero company by 2050 or sooner, and to to safety, BP’s commitment to its help the world get to net zero. And to lead relationships and partnerships will not Today, BP’s engagement with its and deliver on both we have a new chief change, including with governments customers, suppliers, shareholders, executive officer, Bernard Looney, who around the world. BP intends to use its employees and others is wider and deeper took on the role on 5 February 2020. energy market experience, skills and than ever, but it has to further develop as technology to help countries, cities and we progress on our journey. I therefore want Evolving for an uncertain world corporations decarbonize, while at the to use this opportunity to thank you, BP This is a new direction for BP, and it is only same time building a thriving, lower shareholders, for your continued support possible because of the foundation laid by carbon energy business. and engagement during 2019, including Bob Dudley. Bob served as BP’s group through your votes at our AGM in May. Your chief executive with distinction for almost BP’s new ambition also gives us extra challenge and input have been important in a decade, and he and his team deserve reason to maintain the capital discipline our effort to set a new strategic direction. our considerable thanks for guiding BP to and focus that has served the company so I look forward to continuing our dialogue. a position of operational and financial well. We can only reimagine energy if we strength and deepened resilience. generate the cash needed to manage the balance sheet, invest in new low carbon At these times, BP’s 110-year history of businesses, and continue to pay the navigating uncertainty is also reassuring. dividend on which you, our owners, depend. Your company has anticipated and That is how we will meet our ambition. It is responded to change many times over. something that I, together with the BP Helge Lund Indeed, throughout 2019 your board has board, look forward to working on with Chairman Bernard and his executive team. 18 March 2020 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 3


 
Chief executive officer’s letter Dear fellow shareholders, Reimagining and reinventing energy Our investor proposition will remain As we publish this report, the world is In February, we announced a new unchanged as we lay out new near-term working through extraordinarily difficult purpose for BP, and a major reorganization plans later this year. This includes our times. Countries around the globe are to deliver our new ambition to be a net commitment to growing sustainable free battling the coronavirus pandemic zero company by 2050 or sooner and help cash flow and returns to shareholders (COVID-19). People’s lives are being the world get to net zero. over the long term. hugely disrupted, with tragic The current market shocks only reaffirm We will continue to maintain a strong consequences for many. The financial the need for this reimagining of energy and financial frame, including a focus on markets are reflecting the disruption and reinvention of BP. Our current upstream- deleveraging our balance sheet and our sector is particularly hard hit, not just downstream structure has served us well staying within a disciplined frame for our by a virus-related shock to demand but by for over a century, but I believe we now capital expenditure. a supply-side shock as well. need a different model for the rapidly And now, more than ever, we will focus At BP, we are taking calm and deliberate changing demands of the future. We need on managing costs, pursuing efficiencies actions for the well-being of our people an agile, highly integrated structure that is and driving waste out of the system. and the health of your company. We do more focused than ever on our core so with a robust balance sheet, strong capabilities in operations, customers, low A force for good and competitive returns liquidity and the flexibility in our portfolio carbon and innovation. The leadership team This new decade is a pivotal time for BP. and financial framework that provide us is working with the board to develop this We will continue to be an energy business, with options. structure, along with a new strategy and but a very different kind of energy business near-term targets, which we intend to in years to come. We may not get A resilient company share with you in September 2020. everything right along the way and will This resilience is a tribute to Bob Dudley’s need to listen and learn from others, not leadership over the past decade. I see huge opportunity for BP given our least you, our owners. Following the Deepwater Horizon distinctive combination of reach, accident, Bob’s steady hand has guided resources and relationships. The world will But with your continued support we BP through recovery and back to growth need to invest trillions of dollars in new expect to become leaner, faster-moving, as a safer, stronger and more disciplined energies over the next several decades. lower carbon – and more valuable. company – one that has delivered We have the skill and the will to help the Our destination is a thriving, sustainable consistently for 12 consecutive quarters world deliver a rapid energy transition. energy business in a net zero world. One on the plan we put forward in 2017. Performing while transforming that is a motivating and inspiring place to • We made an underlying profit of This may be our most wide-ranging work for our employees. That is wanted $10 billion in 2019. reorganization for more than a century, but as well as needed by society. And one • Operating cash flow was strong at I want to assure you of our commitment that is valued by you, our shareholders, as $26 billion for the year. to perform as we transform. Among many a force for good as well as a provider of • That gave us the confidence to increase significant changes, however, there will be competitive returns. our dividend, which currently stands at no change to the fundamental principles 10.5c per ordinary share. that have served us well over the last decade and which apply equally in low During 2019, two colleagues sadly lost price environments as well as high. their lives while working at BP. My heart goes out to their families and friends. We Above all, our commitment to safe and must learn from these tragedies and reliable operations remains unchanged. Bernard Looney continue to make BP safer. I believe that Safety will always be a BP core value and Chief executive officer we can build on progress that last year we believe that the new structure we are 18 March 2020 saw our lowest-ever figure for BP people introducing will further strengthen our getting hurt at work (our recordable injury safety performance. frequency measure). Profit attributable to BP shareholders $4.0bn Nearest GAAP equivalent to underlying profit. 4 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report “Our destination is a thriving, sustainable energy business in a net zero world. One that is a motivating and inspiring place to work for our employees.” Our purpose is reimagining energy for people and our planet. This will frame our thinking, our activities and our interactions. Introducing a new structure, new leadership team and new ways of working. Our commitment to safe and reliable operations remains unchanged. And our investor proposition remains unchanged. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 5


 
Our ambition is to be a net zero company by 2050 or sooner and to help the world get to net zero. Our ambition for the energy transition Pursuing a strategy that is Responding to increased shareholder interest consistent with the Paris goals In 2019 the board recommended that The CA100+ resolution, which requires BP The world needs a rapid transition to net shareholders support a special resolution to respond to a number of different elements, zero and to reimagine the global energy requisitioned by Climate Action 100+ passed with more than 99% of the vote. system. This presents an opportunity for (CA100+) on climate change disclosures. These responses are contained throughout BP to provide the cleaner energy the this annual report. world wants and needs. We see opportunities in helping the The CA100+ resolution, which includes safeguards such as for commercially confidential and world decarbonize through new competitively sensitive information, is on page 337. Key terms related to this resolution response business models and creating cleaner are indicated with  and defined in the glossary on page 337. These should be reviewed with cities. We plan to provide more the following information. information on our future strategy and Element of the CA100+ resolution Related content Where near-term plans at our capital markets Strategy that the board considers in good faith Our strategy 16 day in September 2020. to be consistent with the Paris goals. For more information about how we How BP evaluates each new material capex investment Our investment process 19 believe our current strategy is consistent for consistency with the Paris goals and other outcomes with the Paris goals, see page 17. relevant to BP’s strategy. Disclosure of BP’s principal metrics and relevant Measuring our progress 17 targets or goals over the short, medium and long term, consistent with the Paris goals. Anticipated levels of investment in: Financial framework 18 (i) Oil and gas resources and reserves (ii) Other energy sources and technologies. BP’s targets to promote operational GHG reductions. Sustainability 40 Estimated carbon intensity of BP’s energy products Sustainability 40 and progress over time. Any linkage between above targets and executive pay Directors’ remuneration report 100 remuneration. 2019 annual bonus outcome 105 2020 remuneration: Policy on a page 110 6 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report This is supported by 10 aims, which when taken collectively, set out a path that we believe is consistent with the Paris goals. Five aims to get BP to net zero Aim 1 is to be net zero Aim 2 is to be net zero on Aim 3 is to cut the carbon Aim 4 is to install methane Aim 5 is to increase the across our entire operations an absolute basis across intensity of the products measurement at all our proportion of investment on an absolute basis by the carbon in our upstream we sell by 50% by 2050 or existing major oil and gas we make into our non-oil 2050 or sooner. This aim oil and gas production by sooner. This is a lifecycle processing sites by 2023, and gas businesses. Over relates to Scope 1 and 2 GHG 2050 or sooner. This aim carbon intensity approach, publish the data, and then time, as investment goes up emissions. relates to Scope 3 emissions, per unit of energy. It covers drive a 50% reduction in in low and no carbon, we see and is on a BP equity share marketing sales of energy methane intensity of our it going down in oil and gas. For more on our basis excluding Rosneft. products and potentially, in operations. And we will work operational emissions, future, certain other products to influence our joint ventures see Sustainability, See Sustainability, e.g. associated with land to set their own methane page 40. page 40. carbon projects. intensity targets of 0.2%. See Sustainability, See Modernizing the page 40. whole group, page 31. Five aims to help the world get to net zero Aim 6 is to more actively Aim 7 is to incentivize our Aim 8 is to set new Aim 9 is to be recognized Aim 10 is to launch a new advocate for policies that global workforce to deliver expectations for our as an industry leader for team to create integrated support net zero, including on our aims and mobilize relationships with trade the transparency of our clean energy and mobility carbon pricing. We will them to become advocates associations around the reporting. On 12 February solutions. The team will stop corporate reputation for net zero. This will include globe. We will make the 2020, we declared our support help countries, cities and advertising campaigns and increasing the percentage case for our views on for the recommendations of corporations around the re-direct resources to promote of remuneration linked to climate change within the the Task Force on Climate- world decarbonize. well-designed climate policies. emissions reductions for associations we belong to and related Financial Disclosures In future, any corporate leadership and around we will be transparent where (TCFD). We intend to work advertising will be to push 37,000 employees. we differ. And where we can’t constructively with the TCFD for progressive climate policy; reach alignment, we will be and others – such as the See Directors’ communicate our net zero prepared to leave. Sustainability Accounting remuneration report, ambition; invite ideas; or build Standards Board – to develop page 100. See Sustainability, collaboration. We will continue good practices and standards page 49 and bp.com/ to run recruitment campaigns for transparency. tradeassociations. and advertise our products, See Sustainability, services and partnerships – page 44. although we aim for these to increasingly be low carbon. See bp.com/sustainability. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 7


 
2019 at a glance Our scale, our reach and range of activities, from exploration to refining and biofuels to solar, make us a truly global energy provider. This section gives an overview of BP’s structure, scale and performance in 2019. For details of our future structure, see pages 15 and 80. Upstream Responsible for oil and natural gas exploration, field development and production, gas and power marketing and trading activities. Replacement cost (RC) profit Underlying RC profit before interest and tax before interest and tax $4.9bn $11.2bn (2018 $14.3bn) (2018 $14.6bn) Rosneft We have a 19.75% shareholding in Rosneft, one of Russia’s largest oil and gas companies, which has both upstream and downstream operations. RC profit before Underlying RC profit interest and tax before interest and tax $2.3bn $2.4bn (2018 $2.2bn) (2018 $2.3bn) Other businesses and corporate Downstream Comprises our Alternative Energy business as Comprises the manufacturing and marketing of fuels, lubricants, and well as a number of corporate activities. petrochemicals, as well as our oil integrated supply and trading function. RC loss before Underlying RC loss RC profit before Underlying RC profit interest and tax before interest and tax interest and tax before interest and tax $(2.8)bn $(1.3)bn $6.5bn $6.4bn (2018 $(3.5)bn) (2018 $(1.6)bn) (2018 $6.9bn) (2018 $7.6bn) 8 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Scale Performance Advancing low carbon We are an integrated energy business. We Our 2019 performance has helped us We are committed to advancing a low carbon have operations in Europe, North and South deliver for our shareholders and other future. We will aim to dramatically reduce America, Australasia, Asia and Africa. stakeholders, including energy carbon in our operations and in our production, consumers worldwide. and grow new lower carbon businesses, products and services. 70,100 98 >20 employees tier 1 and 2 process safety events years in renewable businesses (2018 73,000) (2018 72) KPI 79 $4.0bn >$500m countries profit attributable to BP shareholders invested in low carbon activities in 2019 (2018 78) (2018 $9.4bn) 19,341 $10.0bn >7,50 0 million barrels of oil equivalent – underlying RC profit BP Chargemaster charging points in the UK group proved hydrocarbon reservesa (2018 $12.7bn) KPI (2018 19,945mmboe) 18,900 94.9% 13 retail sites downstream refining availability countries where Lightsource BP (2018 18,700) (2018 95.0%) KPI is active 3.8 million barrels of oil equivalent per day – group hydrocarbon productiona (2018 3.7mmboe/d) a On a combined basis of subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities. KPI See key performance indicators on page 32. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 9


 
Global context Many forces and trends are fundamentally changing the business environment, creating uncertainties and influencing the way we operate. We monitor these trends closely and explore the forces shaping the global energy transition. Megatrends BP Energy Outlook 2019 The exact pace and nature of the Our Outlook explores the forces shaping the Scenarios energy transition is unclear, but it global energy transition out to 2040 and the • Evolving transition: assumes that government is clear that the market for our key uncertainties surrounding it. The 2019 policies, technology and social preferences products is changing. Megatrends Outlook considers a range of scenarios. They continue to evolve in a manner and speed seen affecting our industry include: have some common features, such as ongoing over the recent past. • Rapid transition: envisages a more rapid economic growth and a shift towards a lower Growing global concern over transition to a lower carbon energy system, carbon fuel mix, but differ in terms of policy, climate change through a reduction in emissions stemming from technology and behavioural assumptions. greater energy efficiency, fuel switching and use Rapidly advancing digital of carbon capture, use and storage (CCUS). technology, affecting all For more information see bp.com/energyoutlook. aspects of economic activity The BP Energy Outlook 2020 will be published Increasing prosperity in the later in the year. emerging world driving Global carbon emissions economic growth (GtCO2) Changing societal expectations 50 of corporations 45 Shifting geopolitical trends as 40 trade, economies and 35 relationships change over time 30 25 Growing global concern over 20 climate change is a key driving 15 force among these trends. The 10 way the world responds to this, 5 and the resulting impact on the energy sector, is the most 0 1970 1980 1990 2000 2010 2020 2030 2040 significant uncertainty we face. Evolving transition Rapid transition Source: BP Energy Outlook 2019 10 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report The transition envisaged in the 2019 Outlook The world economy continues to grow, Demand for energy is set to But carbon emissions need to fall sharply driven by increasing prosperity grow significantly • There is a growing commitment around • The global population grows by 1.7 billion, • Global energy demand increases by about the world to move to a pathway consistent reaching close to 9.2 billion people in 2040. 20-35% by 2040 in the different scenarios. with meeting the climate goals of the • The global economy more than doubles over • The vast majority of demand growth comes Paris Agreementa. the next 25 years, with twice as much from developing economies to support their • To help achieve this, the world needs to economic activity in 2040 than we see today. industry and infrastructure and allow living transition to a lower carbon energy system. • The emergence of a large and growing standards to keep improving. middle class, particularly in emerging Asia, is an increasingly important force shaping growth and energy trends. The key dimensions of the energy transition To meet the Paris goals, we believe the world must take strong action on a range of fronts. The pace at which the transition can be achieved and the precise mix of elements Improving energy efficiency, to Switching to lower or zero carbon liquid is uncertain. decouple energy demand growth and gaseous fuels, particularly in areas There are many possible pathways to meeting from growing prosperity. such as heavy transport. the Paris goals and we use different scenarios Rapid growth in renewable energy and Deploying carbon-removal technologies, to explore this uncertainty. When we evaluate other low or zero carbon energy sources. such as CCUS, at scale. the consistency of our new material capex investments with the Paris goals, we Increasing the share of electricity in Promoting natural climate solutions, consider a range of different possible final energy use and decarbonizing including the management and restoration pathways and scenarios, see page 21. power generation. of habitats, and the role of carbon credits. a Paris Agreement: (1) Article 2.1(a) of the Paris Agreement states the goal of ‘Holding the increase in the global average temperature to well below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and pursuing efforts to limit the temperature increase to 1.5°C above pre-industrial levels, recognizing that this would significantly reduce the risks and impacts of climate change.’ (2) Article 4.1 of the Paris Agreement: In order to achieve the long-term temperature goal set out in Article 2, parties aim to reach global peaking of greenhouse gas emissions as soon as possible, recognizing that peaking will take longer for developing country parties, and to undertake rapid reductions thereafter in accordance with best available science, so as to achieve a balance between anthropogenic emissions by sources and removals by sinks of greenhouse gases in the second half of this century, on the basis of equity, and in the context of sustainable development and efforts to eradicate poverty. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 11


 
The changing energy mix Increased demand for energy is likely to be Primary energy consumption by fuel met over the coming decades through a Exajoules (EJ) diverse range of supplies including renewable 85% energy, oil and natural gas. 800 2040 of primary energy growth is from renewables and The energy mix is shifting as the transition to a 700 natural gas in our ‘evolving lower carbon energy system continues, with transition’ scenario renewable energy and natural gas gaining in 600 importance relative to oil and coal. 500 Scenarios • Evolving transition: renewables and natural 400 gas account for almost 85% of the growth in 300 primary energy by 2040, with their importance increasing relative to all other 200 sources of energy. • Rapid transition: renewable energy grows 100 rapidly, accounting for more than the entire increase in primary energy by 2040 – and a 0 2017 Evolving Rapid sharp contraction in the use of coal. The transition transition level of oil consumption falls, but gas Renew* Nuclear Gas continues to grow aided by increasing use Hydro Coal Oil of carbon capture, use and storage (CCUS). * Renewables includes wind, solar, geothermal, biomass and biofuels Source: BP Energy Outlook 2019 What this means for oil and gas The BP Energy Outlook 2019 considers a range Demand and supply of oil of scenarios for oil demand, with the timing of (Mb/d) the peak in demand varying from the next few 140 years to beyond 2040. Despite these differences, the scenarios 120 share two common features. First, they each suggest that oil will continue to play a 100 significant role in the global energy system in 2040, with the level of oil demand in 2040 80 ranging from around 80Mb/d to 100Mb/d. Second, significant levels of investment are 60 required for there to be sufficient supplies of oil to meet demand in 2040. 40 Similarly there is a wide range of uncertainty 20 in relation to the role of gas in the energy mix even in scenarios that achieve the Paris goals, 0 with different organizations using significantly 1970 1980 1990 2000 2010 2020 2030 2040 different assumptions. Those with a higher Evolving transition �Supply with no investments in new fields proportion of CCUS see a higher demand for Rapid transition gas, and in the outlook’s ‘rapid transition’ scenario, close to a third of natural gas in Source: BP Energy Outlook 2019 2040 is being used in conjunction with CCUS. 12 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Achieving the Paris goals – a multitude of pathways There are many different pathways to Global carbon emissions from energy use achieve the Paris goals, with substantial (GtCO2) variation in the implied energy mix. 40 The Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC) is the United Nations’ body 30 for assessing the science related to climate change. It is the leading source of data that 20 summarises the potential pathways to achieve the Paris goals. The IPCC compiles a database of the published results on 10 mitigation pathways from modelling teams around the world. 0 The chart shows a range of modelled pathways for carbon emissions from energy -10 and industrial use, collected by the IPCC, that meet the long-term temperature goals -20 in the Paris Agreement, together with the 1980 1990 2000 2010 2020 2030 2040 2050 2060 2070 2080 2090 2100 paths associated with two of BP’s own scenarios. The ‘rapid transition’ scenario Range of scenarios collected by the IPCC which Energy Outlook ‘evolving transition’ meet the long-term temperature goals of the IEA SDS clearly sits well within the range. Also Paris Agreement Energy Outlook ‘rapid transition’ highlighted is the ‘Sustainable Development Source: Integrated Assessment Modeling Consortium (IAMC) 1.5°C Scenario Explorer and Data hosted Scenario’ from the International Energy by International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis (IIASA), release 2.0. Scenario data has Agency (IEA SDS), which is often cited been rebased to common starting point that matches the BP Energy Outlook history for 2015. as a reference case for a scenario that is consistent with meeting the Paris goals. Global energy markets in 2019 The world economy grew at 2.4% in 2019, Oil Natural gas reflecting slower growth in both advanced and • Dated Brent crude oil prices averaged • Gas spot prices dropped in all three emerging economies, amid weakening trade $64 per barrel in 2019 – a 9% decrease key regional markets in 2019. and investment. This was below the average from 2018 levels but almost 30% above • Global consumptionc growth slowed of around 3% seen over the past 10 years. the 2015-17 average. down in 2019 compared with the Growth in advanced economies was 1.6% in • Global consumptionb increased by exceptional growth in 2018, driven by 2019 while in emerging markets was 3.5%a. 0.9 million barrels per day (mmb/d) to slower growth in both the US and China. 100.1mmb/d for the year (0.9%) – a • Total gas production growth slowed slowdown from growth rates seen in the down in 2019, with the exception of the 2020 volatility prior two years as trade tensions slowed US. Meanwhile, LNG trade increased There has been considerable market global macroeconomic growth. significantly during 2019. volatility in the first quarter, compounded • Global oil production remained flat at by the coronavirus (COVID-19). We 100.5mmb/d, with growth from non-OPEC expect the outlook for the year to remain countries offsetting supply restraint and For more information on prices and margins challenging, see pages 52 and 57. disruptions in OPEC countries. see pages 52 and 58. a World Bank Global Economic Prospects, January 2020. b IEA Oil Market Report, February 2020©. c JODI-Gas World Database, and IHS Markit: China Natural Gas Data Tables: February 2020 for China. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 13


 
Our business model We deliver a diverse range of energy products and services to people around the world. What we do New business models Investing in innovative companies across our value chain to help accelerate and commercialize new technologies, products and business models that we believe can benefit BP and global energy systems. Venturing and low carbon across the business Finding and Refining, manufacturing Delivering products generating energy and marketing and services Repowering some Using technology and of our facilities partnership to recycle and reuse our products Transport and trading • Finding additional resources and • Producing refined petroleum products and • Delivering fuels, fast electric-vehicle replenishing our development options scaling up co-processing of lower carbon charging and convenience retail services, with exploration and technology. fuels at our refineries. as well as premium and lower carbon • Developing and extracting oil and gas, and • Manufacturing and marketing lubricants lubricants. seeking to extend the life of existing fields. and petrochemicals products. • Supplying petrochemical products that • Generating renewable energy using • Developing technologies to help advance are used to make a range of products biofuels, biopower, wind and solar. the circular economy, such as BP Infinia, including clothes and building materials. which can recycle previously • Providing renewable power to industries unrecyclable plastics. and local electricity grids. More information Upstream on page 50. Downstream on page 56. Other businesses and corporate on page 63. 14 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Reinventing BP On 12 February 2020 we introduced our ambition and aims with a new structure, a new leadership team, and new ways of working. To deliver our ambition we are reinventing BP, retiring our existing model and replacing it with one that is more focused, more integrated and faces the energy transition head on. One that can deliver for the changing demands of consumers, investors and governments. Our new leadership structure is due to come into place on 1 July 2020 and is expected to be fully operational by 1 January 2021. The new leadership will focus on four core capabilities: operations, customers, low carbon and innovation. These four highly focused business groups will work with three integrators (sustainability and strategy; regions, cities and solutions; and trading and shipping) to facilitate collaboration and unlock value. And four teams will serve as enablers of business delivery. For more information see bp.com/reimagine. Business model foundations These are the things that every Partnerships and collaboration Governance and oversight energy business needs and are We aim to build enduring relationships with our Our board has a diversity of knowledge, expertise, critical foundations for what we key stakeholders, and partner with others to find and ways of thinking that help us transition our do and how we do it. innovations that can improve efficiency and deliver business, manage risks and continue to deliver low carbon solutions. value over the long term. • 20 years of collaboration with the world’s • ~42% of the company’s board are women. top universities. See page 74. Safe and reliable Talented people Technology and innovation We value the safety of our workforce and focus on We work to attract, motivate and retain the best New technologies help us produce energy safely and maintaining a safe operating culture every day. This talent the world offers and equip our people with the more efficiently. We selectively invest in areas with the culture of safety also improves the integrity and right skills for the future. Our performance and ability potential to add greatest value to our business, now and reliability of our assets. to thrive globally depend on it. in the future, including building lower carbon businesses. • 94.4% BP-operated upstream plant reliability. • 8th most desirable employer in the UK • >3,900 patents granted or pending across on LinkedIn. the BP group in 2019. See page 45. See page 47. What makes us different These are the things we believe set us Global energy trading Distinctive customer offers apart from our peers and demonstrate We combine expertise in physical supply and trading Our convenience partnerships provide customers our distinctive ways of working. and advanced analytics to deliver long-term value, with a differentiated offer that includes fresh, from wellhead to end customer. We trade a variety of high-quality food and drink, such as M&S Simply products such as crude oil, refined products, natural Food® in the UK and REWE to Go® in Germany. gas, LNG, carbon products and power. 4bn ~1,600 barrels of crude a year traded, equivalent differentiated convenience partnership sites to 20% global traded oil. across our network of around 18,900 retail sites. ‘Reduce, improve, Rosneft create’ framework partnership Our framework helps focus everyone in BP on our low Our share in Rosneft, one of Russia’s largest oil and gas carbon ambitions. It encompasses activities across producers, gives us a stake in one of the largest and the group to reduce emissions from our operations, lowest-cost hydrocarbon resource bases in the world, improve the products we offer to help customers with access to huge markets, both east and west. reduce their emissions, and create low or zero carbon businesses to deliver more energy with fewer emissions. 0.14% 19.75% methane intensity in 2019. BP’s stake in Rosneft. See page 40. See page 61. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 15


 
Our strategy We have established a track record of operational and financial delivery. This has helped create a strong Strategic foundation for us to advance our priorities low carbon agenda as we work to achieve our ambition to become a net zero company by 2050 or sooner and to help the world get to net zero. Growing Market-led Venturing and Modernizing Our strategy, which we set out in advantaged growth in the low carbon the whole group 2017, allows us to be competitive, oil and gas in Downstream across multiple flexible and resilient while also responding to a rapidly changing the Upstream fronts energy landscape, with growing Invest in oil and gas, Innovate with Pursue new Simplify our processes expectations for us to adapt to producing both with advanced products and opportunities to meet and enhance our changing demands from increasing efficiency strategic partnerships, evolving technology, productivity through stakeholders. (lower cost, higher building competitively consumer and digital solutions. margin and close to advantaged businesses policy trends. We remain committed to managing markets), with a focus that deliver profitable our portfolio for value, and investing on carbon. marketing growth with discipline in flexible and resilient options, which together See page 25. See page 27. See page 28. See page 31. support our pursuit of a strategy which we believe is consistent with the goals of the Paris Agreement. Supported Following BP’s new ambition and by our aims, set out in February 2020, we low carbon plan to announce more information on ambitions how we intend to reimagine energy and reinvent BP, while performing as we transform, at our capital markets day in September 2020. Embedded within Reducing Improving Creating our strategy is our commitment to advance emissions in our products low carbon a low carbon future. our operations businesses We plan to deliver this • Achieve zero net • Provide lower • Expand low carbon across our entire growth in operational emissions gas. and renewable business through what emissions out to 2025. • Develop more businesses. we call our ‘reduce, • Make 3.5Mte of efficient and lower • Invest $500 million in improve, create’ sustainable GHG carbon fuels, low carbon activities (RIC) framework. reductions by 2025. lubricants and each year. • Target industry leading petrochemicals. • Collaborate and invest methane intensity of • Grow lower carbon in the OGCI’s $1bn+ 0.2%. offers for customers. fund for research and technology. For more information on our RIC framework, see page 41. 16 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Pursuing a strategy that is and advocating for progressive climate policies 2. We believe that our strategy positions BP to consistent with the Paris goals to advance a low carbon future in support of the remain an attractive investment for current Paris goals. and prospective shareholders throughout the In February 2020 we set out our ambition to be energy transition, including in a world that is In 2019 examples included: a net zero company by 2050 or sooner and to meeting the Paris goals. Our strong and help the world get to net zero. This is supported • Launching a review of our climate-related trade disciplined financial framework supports the by 10 aims which, when taken collectively, set association memberships – read more on page 49. delivery of our strategy. This provides us with out a path that we believe is consistent with the Our aim going forward is to set new expectations a strong platform to deliver our purpose to Paris goals, see page 7. One specific aim relates for trade associations around the globe. reimagine energy, and work towards our new to increasing the proportion of investment in • Establishing a collaboration with DiDi to begin net zero ambition and aims. our non-oil and gas business. Over time, as building an electric-vehicle charging network in China. investment in low or no carbon activity increases, For more information on our investor • Beginning the roll out of ultra-fast chargers across we see investment in oil and gas going down. proposition and financial framework, see BP forecourts in the UK and piloting ultra-fast page 18. Since 2017, when BP reset its five-year strategy, charging at Aral forecourts in Germany, bringing we have pursued a way forward that is flexible charging time closer to the time taken to fill a tank. The role of the board and adaptable to a range of energy and market • Increasing our stake in Lightsource BP to create a The board is responsible for setting the strategy scenarios. These different scenarios are based on 50:50 joint venture. and has oversight of the overall conduct of the a range of assumptions about policy, technology • Expanding our biofuels business in Brazil by more group’s business. During 2019, the board and consumer behaviour, and supply and demand than 50% through a joint venture with Bunge to considered BP’s strategy at every board meeting. changes. We do not know what path the energy create BP Bunge Bioenergia. This took into account the wider operating transition will take, so BP’s strategy is intended to • Installing continuous methane measurement at our environment and discussed strategic themes be effective under a range of scenarios, and not a Khazzan central processing facility in Oman to help relating to BP’s purpose, including in relation to single, deterministic view of the future – in short, quickly identify new leaks and reduce time taken the segments and key functions. The impact of responsive to uncertainty. to respond. the lower carbon energy transition on the group’s • Supporting well-designed carbon pricing, such as business model was also reviewed and discussed We believe that our current strategy is consistent the Washington State cap-and-invest bill. We aim throughout 2019. As a result, the board considers with the Paris goals. This consistency has, at its to advocate more actively for policies that support that the strategy allows us to be flexible to adapt core, two key parts. And these remain relevant as net zero, including carbon pricing. to market changes and scenarios to remain we work towards our net zero ambition and aims. consistent with the Paris goals. For more information on our strategy in action, 1. We are striving to play our part in meeting the see pages 24-31. For more information on the role of the board world’s energy needs in reliable, affordable and in relation to climate governance, see page 42. lower carbon; and we intend to achieve this For the board’s activity in relation to strategy, through collaboration, technology, innovation see Corporate governance on page 84. Measuring our progress Our group-wide principal metrics and relevant targets/goals The CA100+ resolution requires us to disclose the company’s principal metrics and relevant RIC framework Reduce • Zero net growth in operational emissions out to 2025. targets or goals consistent with the Paris goals. Sustainability, page 40. • 3.5Mte sustainable emissions reductions by 2025. We consider this to cover the principal metrics • 0.2% methane intensity. used at group level to help monitor progress on delivery of our strategic consistency with Create the Paris goals – including our near-term • $500 million invested in low carbon activities annually. RIC framework. (>$500 million in 2019). • Collaborate and invest in OGCI’s $1bn+ fund for A number of these metrics and targets are research and technology. relevant to the recommendations of the Task Force on Climate-related Financial Investment process (RCM) • Profitability index. • Average operational carbon intensity. Disclosures (TCFD). Our investment process, page 22. Going forward, we are considering metrics to Greenhouse gas emissions • Scope 1 and 2 emissions. support our ambition to be a net zero company • Emissions from the carbon in our upstream oil and Sustainability, page 40. by 2050 or sooner, and to help the world get to gas production. net zero. We plan to provide more information • For further GHG metrics see bp.com/ESGdata. on our future strategy and near-term plans at our capital markets day in September 2020. Carbon intensity • Average emissions intensity of marketed energy products. • Ratio of Scope 1 and 2 emissions: gross production. For more information on the TCFD, see page 42. Sustainability, page 40. Remuneration • 2020 annual bonus scorecard target related to sustainable emissions reductions. Directors’ remuneration report, page 100. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 17


 
Our investor proposition Our investor proposition is to grow sustainable free cash flow and distributions to shareholders over the long term. Fit for Focused We believe our strategy enables this Safer through a focus on safe, reliable and the future on returns efficient execution, leveraging our distinctive portfolio, and disciplined safe, reliable and a distinctive portfolio fit value based, disciplined investment to support growing returns. efficient execution for a changing world investment and cost focus Growing sustainable free cash flow and distributions to shareholders over the long term Our financial framework We maintain a disciplined financial We continue to expect to deliver the 2021 The CA100+ resolution requires us to disclose framework, which underpins our strategy targets laid out three years ago. (a) our anticipated investment in oil and gas and investment choices, and supports resources and reserves – this is anticipated We plan to increasingly focus our investment growth in sustainable free cash flow, to be less in 2020 than it was in 2019, and on the highest-quality barrels and drive returns returns and distributions to shareholders. (b) our anticipated investment in other energy and cash flow, not volumes. As a result, the sources and technologies – which is This discipline helps us maintain a anticipated proportion of our investment that anticipated to be significantly greater focused portfolio, which we believe is goes to oil and gas is expected to change. than 2019 levels. resilient in the long run to many potential outcomes and seeks to grow long-term We also plan to provide more information returns to shareholders. on this as part of our capital markets day in September 2020. Our capital frame is reviewed on an ongoing basis. We believe that the continuing flexibility it provides gives us the flexibility to pursue 2019 actual 2020 guidance our net zero ambition and aims, allocating an Lower than increasing proportion of investment toward Upstream production excluding Rosneft lower carbon businesses over time. This will 2.6mmboe/d 2019 help drive both the long-term resilience of Lower end of the portfolio and the creation of new value. This is balanced against the pace of i $15-17bn Organic capital expenditure range development of these new lower carbon $15.2bn business developments and levels of cash Slightly below flow generation. Depreciation, depletion and amortization $17.8bn 2019 In addition, our capital expenditure programme has flexibility, which enables us to respond Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments $2.4bn <$1bn to a low-price environment by reducing or rephasing investment. Other businesses and corporate average underlying quarterly charge $320m ~$350m Below ii Underlying effective tax rate 36% 40% Nearest equivalent GAAP measures: i Capital expenditure: $19.4bn. ii Effective tax rate: 49%. 18 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Our investment process BP’s investments fall within a governance framework. This seeks to ensure investments align with Price assumptions Resource commitment meeting our strategy, fall within our prevailing financial Investments are evaluated against a range For capital investments above defined financial framework, and add shareholder value. The of alternative prices (central, upper and lower) thresholds for organic or inorganic spend, the governance framework also provides for for oil, natural gas, refining margins and carbon investment approval is conducted by the investments to be assessed consistently prices. These price ranges do not link to executive-level resource commitment meeting and against a range of other outcomes specific scenarios or outcomes, but instead (RCM), which is chaired by the chief executive relevant to our strategy, including a range try to capture the range of different officer. The RCM reviews the merits of each of environmental and sustainability factors. possibilities surrounding the future path of such investment case against a balanced set Investments follow an integrated stage gate the global energy system. The price ranges of criteria and considers any key issues raised process designed to enable us to choose refer to the long-run level of prices over the in the assurance process. and develop the most attractive investment next 20 years. The nature of the uncertainty The CA100+ resolution requires BP to disclose cases. A balanced set of investment criteria means that these price ranges inevitably how we evaluate the consistency of new are used, see page 20. This allows for the reflect considerable judgement. The ranges material capex investments with (i) the Paris comparison and prioritization of investments are reviewed and updated on an annual basis goals and (ii) a range of other outcomes across an increasingly diverse range of as our understanding and judgement about relevant to BP’s strategy. BP’s evaluation of business models. the energy transition evolves. consistency of such investments with the Paris The governance framework also specifies Range of prices goals was undertaken by the RCM in 2019. that investments are tested against a range Henry of carbon prices for projected operational Brenta Huba RMMb The role of the board emissions and subject to assurance by ($/bbl) ($/mmBtu) ($/bbl) The board assesses the impact of portfolio functions independent of the business before Upper case 90 5.0 17 changes, such as strategic acquisitions and a final investment decision (FID) is taken. Central case 70 4.0 14 the allocation of capital. They also consider For more information on BP’s governance Lower case 50 2.0 11 specific investment cases deemed sufficiently framework, see page 83. material to warrant their attention, which have Carbon prices been approved by the RCM. ($/tonnea) For more information on climate governance, Upper case 80 see page 42. Central case 40 Lower case 0 a 2015 $ real. b Nominal. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 19


 
Balanced investment criteria For the purposes of evaluating consistency with a range of other outcomes relevant to BP’s strategy, all group-wide investment cases are required to set out the investment Investment merits in a standard format against a set of economics balanced criteria. Investments are considered against a range Safety Cash flow and risks certainty of prices (upper, central and lower). All three price assumptions place some weight on scenarios in which the transition to a low Investment carbon energy system is sufficiently rapid criteria to meet the goals of the Paris Agreement, Capability as well as scenarios in which the transition Optionality and scale is not, or may not be, sufficiently rapid. They also place some weight on a range Environment of other factors, which can drive prices, and and are not related to the goals of the sustainability Paris Agreement. In addition, investment cases are asked to present scenarios covering a range of variables, related to the economics of the investment, such as cost, resource, policy Environment and sustainability Investment economics changes and schedule, to highlight the All investment cases are considered We consider investment economics against robustness of investment cases to a range against appropriate environmental impacts a range of measures including profitability of other factors. and sustainability measures, including but index, internal rate of return, net present not limited to carbon. Investment cases value, discounted payback, investment This standardized approach creates a level above defined thresholds for anticipated efficiency, using a set of scenarios for playing field for decision making and allows annual greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions commodity prices, margins and carbon prices. portfolio wide comparisons of investment from operations must estimate those Investments are generally considered against cases. Further, the decision to endorse an anticipated GHG emissions and include internal rate of return hurdles typically set in investment based on the information an associated carbon price of $40/te the mid to high teens. Close attention is paid provided represents BP’s evaluation that 2015 $ real (and sensitivities of $0 and to discounted payback as a measure of the investment is considered consistent $80) in the investment economics. commercial risk in the context of the energy with a range of other outcomes, relevant transition and profitability index as a measure to BP’s strategy. of capital efficiency. Capability and scale Cash flow certainty For all investment cases, we consider whether Economic metrics are also considered in they involve distinctive capability that BP has, the context of the cash flow certainty of the or intends to develop, and whether it adds to investment assumptions. For example, a high an existing ‘scale’ business within the portfolio return deepwater tieback will have less certain or could help us create one. and more volatile (oil price linked) cash flows than a lower return but more certain renewable power project with a long-term power purchase agreement (and a fixed power price). Safety and risks Optionality Investment cases are required to describe All investment cases are requested to risks unique to the project which have a quantify the strategic optionality that might significantly higher probability than usual or be accessed through follow-on activity. have a significantly greater impact (relative to For example, a greenfield offshore platform the size of the project) were they to occur. may provide additional optionality to develop nearby satellite fields in the future. 20 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Evaluating new material capex investments for consistency with the Paris goals When evaluating the consistency of our 2019 The 2019 evaluation was done in the context These price assumptions do not new material capex investments with the of a ‘sustained low-price environment’, which correspond to a single specific ‘Paris- Paris goals, a focus of the evaluation criteria assumes the lower price case for oil ($50/bbla), consistent’ scenario, but instead place was on their competitiveness and financial natural gas ($2/mmBtua) and refining margins weight on a range of possibilities for how robustness as the prices of different forms of ($11/bbl (nominal)) together with the higher the demand for different forms of energy a energy and products adjust in response to the carbon price ($80/teCO2 ). may change in Paris-consistent pathways changing market environment. and how this may affect future energy pricesb. Sustained low-price environment Oil price (Brent): In many ‘Paris-consistent’ scenarios, global oil demand peaks within the next five years or so and falls a between 15-35% by 2040. Such a fall in demand, combined with the abundance of oil resources, would be $50/bbl expected to lead to an increasingly competitive market for oil. But the extent to which these competitive forces feed through into a sustained reduction in global oil prices is expected to be tempered by the dependence of many oil-producing economies on oil revenues to support their wider economies. For example, the IMF estimate that the fiscal break-even prices of the major Middle East and North African oil exporters is close to $80c. We consider that the pace at which the major oil producing economies are able to diversify their economies and so reduce the fiscally sustainable price at which they can produce oil is likely to limit the extent to which oil prices can fall on a sustained basis over the next 20 yearsd. US natural gas price (Henry Hub): The price of US gas (Henry Hub) is used as the main price for evaluating gas-based investments, either a directly for US-based projects or indirectly (via netback pricing relationships) for gas-based projects in other $2/mmBtu parts of the world. The outlook for natural gas in ‘Paris-consistent’ scenarios is more varied across different scenarios: some point to global gas consumption increasing or remaining broadly flat over the next 20 years; others point to gas demand peaking within the next five years and declining by 20-30% by 2040. These differences stem in part from the extent to which natural gas is assumed to be used in conjunction with carbon capture, use and storage (CCUS) projects, either in the power and industrial sectors directly, or to produce decarbonized gas (in the form of ‘blue’ hydrogen). US natural gas prices will also depend on a number of supply-side factors, such as: the extent to which productivity gains within shale gas continue to improve, and how quickly US tight oil production – and hence the associated gas produced as part of that production – peaks. Refining marker margin (RMM): The outlook for refining margins is most relevant when considering investments in refineries or closely $11/ bbl related activities. (nominal) Many ‘Paris-consistent’ scenarios provide less detailed information on the outlook for refined products and refining activity. However, the significant falls in global oil demand envisaged in many of these scenarios are likely to also be reflected in the demand for refined products. Indeed, some scenarios highlight the expected growth in natural gas liquids (NGLs) and biofuels which suggest that refining activity might decline by even more than the overall demand for liquid fuels. To the extent that falling demand for refined products leads to over-capacity in the refining sector, this would be expected to lead to the least-efficient refineries closing over time, raising the average efficiency of the remaining refineries and so reducing the sustainable level of refining margins. However, the need for some refineries to continue to operate can be expected to limit the extent to which refining margins can fall on a sustained basis. Carbon prices: The outlook for carbon prices has both a direct and indirect effect on the evaluation of new material a investments. The direct effect relates to the operational emissions associated with different investment $80/teCO2 projects: the greater the operational emissions, the greater the exposure to increases in carbon prices. The indirect impact relates to the impact of carbon prices on the differential between retail and wholesale prices for oil and natural gas. An increase in carbon prices can be expected to increase the differential between retail and wholesale prices: potentially both dampening demand growth (due to higher retail prices) and reducing the prices received by oil and gas producers (due to lower wholesale prices). The direct effects associated with carbon prices are explicitly assessed within BP’s investment evaluation criteria, whereas the indirect effects are captured within the overall prospects for oil and gas demand and the associated prices. In many ‘Paris-consistent’ scenarios, carbon prices are used as a key policy instrument for accelerating the transition to a low carbon energy system, with carbon prices (on a global basis) increasing to between $100‑200/teCO2 by 2040. But in these scenarios, carbon prices are typically increased only gradually, in part since this mitigates the costs to the economy of prematurely scrapping and replacing productive assets. Hence, the average level of carbon prices in these scenarios over the next 20 years tends to be significantly lower than the level they are projected to reach in 2040 or so. For example, in BP’s rapid transition scenario, carbon prices in developed economies are assumed to reach $200/teCO2 by 2040, but the average level of carbon prices between 2017 and 2040 in that scenario is around $75/teCO2. a 2015 $ real. b To aid this analysis, we consider a range of scenarios which claim to be consistent with meeting the Paris goals including: IEA’s ‘Sustainable Development Scenario’, BEIS’ ‘Low Prices’ case, Aurora Energy Research’s ‘Two degrees’ scenario and MIT’s ‘Paris to 2°C’ scenario. c Regional Economic Outlook – Middle East and Central Asia, International Monetary Fund, October 2019. d The Oil and Gas Industry in Energy Transitions | IEA 2020. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 21


 
Evaluating new material capex investments for consistency with the Paris goals – continued Evaluation process Quantitative evaluations Our new material capital investments are intended to support the delivery of Investment economics Environment and sustainability BP’s strategy. In 2019, we evaluated The calculation of profitability index (PI) Where appropriate, the operational carbon their consistency with the Paris goals using the ‘low-price’ case for commodity intensity of the investment relative to that by considering them against a balanced prices and margins and the ‘high’ carbon of the portfolio average for the segment or set of investment criteria (see page 20). price of $80 per tonne (2015 $ real). As a the related business activity (upstream, For each of the investment criteria, a guide, we would normally target a minimum refining, petrochemicals). As a guide, we qualitative explanation of each business threshold of greater than 1.0x on this basis. would normally target a ratio of less than case was considered and presented to 100%, meaning that the investment is the resource commitment meeting (RCM). expected to reduce the average operational They then discussed and addressed key carbon intensity of that portfolio. issues raised, as per the description on The potential impact of new material capex page 19. investments on BP’s greenhouse gas Two quantitative evaluations were emission targets is a further consideration. considered for Paris consistency. As our approach matures with experience, we may adjust or supplement these. There may be instances when new material capex investments are evaluated as consistent with the Paris goals despite either or both of these guide levels not being met, due to other considerations being taken into account. Evaluation outcome The figure shows the respective rankings of investment performance against each of the tests As shown in the figure, each of the new material capex investments approved in Investment economics: Environment and sustainability: 2019 met the evaluation guides, with the Profitability index Carbon intensity (%) exception of one investment not meeting the guide level for carbon intensity. This investment was evaluated to be consistent Guide with the Paris goals, based on the strength of the investment economics with a short payback period, delivering short-cycle cash returns and reducing the timeframe during which the investment would be exposed to uncertainties associated with Paris Guide consistent pathways. In 2019, the overall averages for the new material capex investments met the guide levels for each of the two quantitative Capital weighted average ~1.5x Average operational carbon intensity is ~45% evaluation tests: • Profitability index on an average capital 1. The respective 2019 new material capex investments have been ranked against the two tests. As a result they are ordered weighted basis was approximately 1.5x, differently in each graph above. versus a guide level of greater than 1.0x. 2. For two of the 2019 new material capex investments the operational carbon intensity was not calculated due to the nature of • An average operational carbon intensity these investments: of approximately 45% relative to the • We do not calculate operational carbon intensity for replacement of end of life assets. • The projected operational carbon intensity of fuels marketing businesses is not considered necessary to quantify for current portfolio(s), versus a guide level of these purposes as the relevant operational emissions would not be expected to be significant. less than 100%. 22 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Decisions taken in 2019 Eight new material capex investment decisions were taken in 2019, six in the Upstream and two in the Downstream. Upstream Azeri Central East (ACE) Angola Block 18 – Platina A new offshore platform and facilities in the Azeri-Chirag-Deepwater Four subsea well tiebacks to an existing FPSO vessel, which also support Gunashli field in Azerbaijan. continued production from the main field under the licence extension granted by the Angolan government. India KGD6 – MJ Angola Block 15 The third phase of Block KG D6 gas development, seven subsea wells Further investment, which will extend the production-sharing agreement will tie‑back to a new FPSO vessel to process and separate liquids. for the block through 2032. Thunder Horse South Expansion Phase 2 Block 61 2020 development wells Two new subsea production units with eight wells tied back to existing Further development and drilling of 18 wells at Ghazeer and seven wells at infrastructure in the US Gulf of Mexico. Khazzan, both in Oman. Downstream Gelsenkirchen steam and water project Reliance partnership Construction of four boilers and a steam turbine to further the safe and Strategic agreement with Reliance Industries Limited to form a retail and reliable management of fuel gas excess. aviation joint venture in India. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 23


 
24 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Growing advantaged oil and gas in the Upstream What this strategic priority means We aim to invest in oil and gas, producing both with increasing efficiency. This means lower cost, higher margin and close to markets, with a focus on carbon. Almost half of BP’s upstream portfolio is natural gas, and several more gas projects are planned to come onstream in the next few years. As the world moves towards net zero  emissions, we think natural gas can play an important role in getting us there. When burned for power, natural gas has, on average on a lifecycle basis, about half the GHG emissions of coal, with fewer air pollutants, so expanding its use globally to displace coal Energy with purpose will help to reduce carbon emissions. In fact, switching from coal to gas has avoided more than 500 million tonnes of CO2 from the power Gas in Oman sector globally since 2010. BP successfully brought the Khazzan major project into production in 2017, Progress in 2019 and since then we’ve continued to build We’ve started up 24 of the 35 planned successful partnerships and reinforce major projects since 2016 and are on track our commitment to the country. to deliver 900,000 barrels of oil equivalent Exploration opportunity per day of new major project production by Together with Eni, we signed an the end of 2021. exploration and production-sharing agreement for Block 77 in central Oman • Sanctioned $6 billion Azeri Central East with the Ministry of Oil and Gas of the development with partners. Sultanate of Oman. • Agreed to sell our Alaska assets to Hilcorp. • The block covers a total area of • Sanctioned the third project in block more than 2,700 square kilometres. KG D6, offshore India with our • It is located 30 kilometres east of partner Reliance. Block 61, where the Khazzan gas field is already producing around 1 billion cubic feet of gas a day. • BP and Eni will each hold a 50% interest, subject to royal decree, with Eni acting as operator during 5 $100m exploration. major project fund for projects that will start ups. help reduce greenhouse Khazzan phase two gas emissions. Ghazeer, the second development phase of the gas field, is expected to come online in 2021. Advantaged gas We used expertise and technology from our US onshore business to help access tight gas locked in the Khazzan field and bring it commercially to market. Detecting methane We installed and tested continuous measurement of methane emissions at our Khazzan central processing facility. The technology uses instruments such as a gas cloud imaging camera to continuously monitor our facilities, quickly identify new leaks and reduce time taken to respond. We now aim to install methane measurement at all our existing major oil and gas processing sites by 2023. For more information see Upstream on page 50. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 25


 
26 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Market-led growth in the Downstream What this strategic priority means We aim to innovate with advanced products and strategic partnerships, building competitively advantaged businesses that deliver profitable marketing growth. We aim to invest in higher-returning fuels marketing and lubricants businesses with growth potential and reliable cash flows. And we are continuing to expand into Energy with purpose fast-growing emerging markets. We are also delivering and developing new products, offers and business models Electrifying China that support the transition to a lower BP has joined forces with DiDi, the carbon and digitally enabled future over world’s leading mobile transportation the longer term. platform, to build an electric vehicle (EV) charging network in China. Progress in 2019 Why it matters We have continued to make strategic China is the largest and fastest- developing EV market. progress in fuels marketing, with our convenience partnership model now in • 50% of the world’s battery EVs around 1,600 sites across the network. are in China. • DiDi offers a full range of app-based • Agreed to expand our partnership with services across Asia, Latin America Reliance Industries Ltd to include a retail and Australia, including ride-hailing, service station network and aviation fuels automobile solutions and other offers. business across India. • The platform has 550 million users, • Continued to expand in other material tens of millions of drivers and serves markets – most notably in Mexico where we around 1 million EVs. now have more than 520 BP-branded retail What’s involved sites. We also continued to grow our The joint venture plans to develop network in Indonesia and expanded our high-quality EV charging hubs for China network into Shandong and Hebei DiDi users and other drivers. provinces through our joint venture with • The partners intend to add loyalty, Dongming. convenience and fleet services • Announced the development of BP Infinia, in the future. an enhanced recycling technology, capable Why we’re doing it of processing currently unrecyclable PET As the world’s largest EV market, China plastic waste. offers extraordinary opportunities to develop innovative new businesses at scale and we see this as the perfect partnership for such a fast-evolving environment. The lessons we learn here will help further expand BP’s advanced >1,20 0 ~1,600 mobility business worldwide, helping retail sites in new convenience drive the energy transition and develop markets of China, partnership sites. solutions for a low carbon world. Mexico and Indonesia. And elsewhere BP Chargemaster is powering around 1.5 million electric miles a week, making this the most-used public charging infrastructure operator in the UK. We have also begun rolling out 150kW ultra-fast chargers on BP forecourts across the UK with plans to build a national network of high-power charging – one which will closely replicate the current fuelling experience. This is helping to accelerate the adoption of EVs, by making EV charging fast, convenient and For more information see Downstream on hassle-free. page 56. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 27


 
Venturing and low carbon across multiple fronts What this strategic priority means “Pairing Calysta’s exciting We aim to pursue new opportunities to technology and meet evolving technology, consumer and entrepreneurial drive with policy trends. BP’s global scale and gas We are building up our renewable energy market expertise offers the portfolio – with activities spanning renewable opportunity to improve food fuels and products, wind and solar energy security and sustainability.” and biopower. We work across multiple fronts through our investments in low carbon Dominic Emery activities with joint ventures, collaborations Group chief of staff and new business models. Through BP Ventures we have invested more than $650 million in around 40 companies since it was set up in 2007. Our investments support technologies and innovations that we believe could benefit BP and global energy systems. Progress in 2019 We increased our stake in Lightsource BP to create a 50:50 joint venture and expanded Energy with purpose our biofuels business in Brazil by more than 50%, through a joint venture with Bunge to create BP Bunge Bioenergia. We also made a Using gas to create number of other investments spanning a range sustainable fish food of strategic focus areas. BP Ventures has invested $30 million • Started BP Launchpad, our scale-up factory, o help create new markets for our designed to help quickly grow disruptive natural gas in the fish-farming industry. technologies and business models which could become future BP business units. What we’re doing We’re extending the idea of gas • Expanded our digital energy portfolio by as a source of energy beyond its investing in Grid Edge, which has developed conventional applications, through an artificial intelligence-based energy our investment in California start-up, management platform that helps customers Calysta, to create Feedkind® – protein predict, control and optimize their buildings’ food for fish, livestock and pets. energy profile. Why it matters • Invested $5 million in Belmont Technology Finding sustainable ways to feed to further strengthen BP’s artificial a growing global population within intelligence and digital capabilities. planetary boundaries is a pressing issue and Calysta can be part of the solution: • Feedkind® is produced with fewer resources, such as water and land, >50% 7 than current alternatives. increase in biofuels new investments • Existing protein sources, including business in Brazil, through BP Ventures fishmeal and soya bean protein, are through BP Bunge in 2019. either at full capacity or connected to Bioenergia. other issues such as deforestation. • The global aquaculture market is expected to grow by around 25% by 2025 and Feedkind® offers a way to support this increase sustainably. How it works Naturally occurring bacteria is fermented using methane from gas as its energy source. The protein created is harvested, dried and sold in pellet form. Why we’re doing it The investment supports BP’s strategy of creating new markets in which gas can deliver a more sustainable future. For more information see page 63. 28 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 29


 
“This programme reflects our commitment to be a leader in advancing the energy transition by maximizing the benefits of natural gas.” Gordon Birrell Chief operating officer– production, transformation and carbon 30 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Modernizing the whole group What this strategic priority means We aim to simplify our processes and enhance our productivity through digital solutions. We achieve this through three pillars: • Agility – improving and simplifying the way we operate. • Mindset change – accepting the reality and adopting the right attitude for a business that is increasingly competitive and margin-dependent. • Digital transformation – digitizing and automating our work. Progress in 2019 We’ve introduced a range of technologies and improved ways of working across BP to support our modernization priority. Our mentors and coaches deliver a programme of training for employees to share agile practices and support changing mindsets, which are key to generating ideas to improve how we work Energy with purpose across the whole business. • Launched ‘Connected BP’ in partnership with data technology pioneer Palantir. Managing methane The programme connects different BP is introducing a programme of new systems and business areas into one and complementary technologies to platform where users can connect, continuously detect, measure and transform and share data. help reduce methane emissions at • Developed a holistic process for leak our BP-operated upstream assets. detection and intervention using infrared Why it matters cameras, lasers and drone technology at Methane is the primary component our US onshore BPX Energy operations. of natural gas. If it escapes into the • Performed a concept trial of Spot, a robot atmosphere unburnt, it can be a from Boston Dynamics, at our US Whiting potent greenhouse gas. refinery. Spot can gather data, detect What we’re doing abnormalities and perform tasks, such We aim to install methane as detecting gas emissions and helping measurement, such as gas cloud remove people from hazardous spaces. imaging, at all BP’s major oil and gas processing sites by 2023 and then reduce methane intensity of our operations by 50%. What else? We’re also planning to deploy a new >1,000 ~$1.5bn generation of drones, hand-held devices transformation projects invested every year and multi-spectral flare combustion running in the Upstream. in maintaining BP’s cameras – drawing upon scientific infrastructure. breakthroughs made in diverse fields, spanning healthcare, space exploration and defence. Collaboration with stakeholders We have agreed to work in collaboration with the Environmental Defense Fund, a New York-based non-profit environmental advocacy group. The three-year commitment aims to advance technologies and practices to reduce methane emissions from the global oil and gas supply chain. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 31


 
Measuring our progress We assess our performance across a wide range of measures and indicators that are consistent with our strategy and investor proposition. Our key performance indicators (KPIs) provide Changes to KPIs Remuneration a balanced set of metrics that give emphasis • Added sustainable GHG emission To help align the focus of our board and to both financial and non-financial measures. reductions and methane intensity, in line executive management with the interests of These help the board and executive with our ‘reduce, improve, create’ our shareholders, certain measures are used management assess performance against our framework. for executive remuneration. strategic priorities and business plans. BP • Removed production as a volume measure Key management uses these measures to evaluate as it doesn’t reflect our value over volume New/amended operating performance and make financial, approach, and is not used to assess New or amended in 2019 strategic and operating decisions. executive remuneration. The metric is REM reported on At a glance, page 9. Used for the remuneration policy • Combined tier 1 and tier 2 process safety events, giving investors a wider view of For more information see Directors’ process safety events. remuneration report on page 100. • As reported in 2018, we have now revised our refining availability metric to BP‑operated refining availability, to more closely match our upstream plant reliability measure. Safety Tier 1 and 2 process safety eventsa We track tier 1 and tier 2 events and report the 2019 26 72 98 2019 performance aggregated outcome. Tier 1 events are losses of The total number of tier 1 and tier 2 process primary containment from a process of greatest 2018 16 56 72 safety events increased in 2019, mainly consequence – causing harm to a member of the reflecting performance in assets acquired over 2017 18 61 79 workforce, damage to equipment from a fire or the past 18 months. Underlying performance explosion, a community impact or exceeding 2016 16 84 100 across the group improved slightly from 2018. defined quantities. Tier 2 events are those of We are implementing BP procedures and lesser consequence. 2015 20 83 103 processes to help bring newly acquired assets Tier 1 Tier 2 in line with BP assets. Reported recordable injury frequencya Reported recordable injury frequency (RIF) 2019 0.166 2019 performance measures the number of reported work-related We have seen a decrease in RIF compared with employee and contractor incidents that result in a 2018 0.198 2018; and maintain our focus to drive toward zero fatality or injury per 200,000 hours worked. incidents. 2017 0.218 2016 0.211 2015 0.243 a This represents reported incidents occurring within BP’s operational HSSE reporting boundary. That boundary includes BP’s own operated facilities and certain other locations or situations. 32 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Sustainable operations Proved reserves replacement ratio (%) Proved reserves replacement ratio is the extent to 2019 67 2019 performance which the year’s production has been replaced by The lower ratio reflects a net decrease of reserves proved reserves added to our reserve base. 2018 100 due to lower gas and oil prices mainly within the US Lower 48, partly offset by new developments The ratio is expressed in oil-equivalent terms and 2017 143 and existing field optimization in Angola, includes changes resulting from discoveries, Argentina, Azerbaijan, India, Oman, Russia improved recovery and extensions and revisions 2016 109 and the US. to previous estimates, but excludes changes 2015 61 resulting from acquisitions and disposals. The ratio reflects both subsidiaries and equity‑accounted entities. This measure helps to demonstrate our success in accessing, exploring and extracting resources. Upstream unit production costs ($/boe) The upstream unit production cost indicator 2019 6.84 2019 performance shows how supply chain, headcount and scope Lower production costs compared with 2018 optimization impact cost efficiency. 2018 7.15 were mainly due to the impacts of IFRS 16. 2017 7.11 2016 8.46 2015 10.46 Upstream plant reliability (%) BP-operated upstream plant reliability is 2019 94.4 2019 performance calculated as 100% less the ratio of total Plant reliability was 1.3% lower than 2018 mainly unplanned plant deferrals divided by installed 2018 95.7 due to design and integrity issues addressed production capacity. through maintenance activities. 2017 94.7 2016 95.3 2015 95.0 90.0 Downstream refining availability (%) Refining availability represents Solomon 2019 94.9 2019 performance Associates’ operational availability for BP- Refining availability was similar to 2018, reflecting operated refineries. The measure shows the 2018 95.0 continued strong operational performance in our percentage of the year that a unit is available for portfolio. This performance is underpinned by our 2017 95.2 processing after deducting the time spent on global reliability programmes. turnaround activity and all mechanical, process 2016 95.2 and regulatory downtime. 2015 94.6 Refining availability is an important indicator of the operational performance of our downstream 90.0 businesses. Major project delivery We monitor the progress of our major projects to 2019 5 2019 performance gauge whether we are delivering our core pipeline We started up five major projects in Egypt, of projects under construction on time. 2018 6 Trinidad, the UK and US. Projects take many years to complete, requiring 2017 7 differing amounts of resource, so a smooth or increasing trend should not be anticipated. 2016 6 Major projects are defined as those with a BP net 2015 4 investment of at least $250 million, or considered to be of strategic importance to BP, or of a high degree of complexity. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 33


 
Sustainable operations Greenhouse gas emissions (MtCO2e) We provide data on greenhouse gas (GHG) 2019 46.0 2019 performance emissions material to our business on a Our Scope 1 (direct) equity share emissions carbon dioxide-equivalent basis. This particular 2018 46.5 decreased by 0.5MtCO2e to 46.0MtCO2e in 2019 KPI comprises Scope 1 (direct) emissions of (46.5MtCO2e in 2018). Emissions resulting from 2017 49.4 CO2 and methane, for 100% emissions from the BHP acquisitions were balanced out by subsidiaries and the percentage of emissions 2016 50.1 sustainable emissions reductions and the impact equivalent to our share of joint arrangements of divestments. and associates, other than BP’s share 2015 49.0 of Rosneft. Sustainable GHG emissions reduction (MtCO2e) This measure includes actions taken by our 2019 1.4 2019 performance businesses to improve energy efficiency and We delivered 1.4Mte of sustainable emissions reduce methane emissions and flaring – all leading 2018 1.3 reductions (SERs), and this meant we exceeded to ongoing, quantifiable GHG reductions. These our target of 3.5Mte of SERs for the period 2016 2017 0.5 refer to the GHG emissions that would have to 2025, six years ahead of schedule. occurred had we not made the change i.e. they 2016 0.7 could be absolute in nature or underlying. Since 2019, progress against this target is used as a 2015 0.2 factor in determining bonuses for around 37,000 employees, including executives. Methane intensity (%) We define methane intensity as the amount of 2019 0.14 2019 performance methane emissions from our upstream oil and gas Our methane intensity was 0.14%, a reduction operations as a percentage of the gas that goes to 2018 0.16 from 0.16% in 2018 and below our stated target market from those operations. This applies to of 0.2%. methane emissions within our operational control boundary, where we have the highest degree of control. Methane emissions from non-producing activities, such as exploration drilling, are excluded. We have an existing methane target of 0.2% and a new ambition that seeks to reduce that – once validated – by 50%. Diversity and inclusionb (%) 25 Each year we report the percentage of women and 2019 2019 performance individuals from countries other than the UK and 25 Both measures increased slightly. As a global the US among BP’s group leaders. business we are committed to increasing the 24 2018 diversity of our workforce and leadership. 24 21 2017 24 22 2016 23 19 2015 21 Women in group leadership People from beyond the UK and US in group leadership b Relates to BP employees. Employee engagement (%) We conduct an annual employee survey to 2019 65 2019 performance understand and monitor levels of employee The overall employee engagement score saw engagement and identify areas for improvement. 2018 66 a marginal decline since last year. We are working to identify areas for improvement. Scores prior 2017 66 to 2017 are based on questions on priorities 2016 73 set out in 2012, so the numbers are not directly comparable. 2015 71 34 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Financial performance Underlying replacement cost profit ($ billion) Underlying RC profit is a useful measure for 4.0 2019 performance 2019 investors because it is one of the profitability 10.0 2019 underlying RC profit was lower, largely measures BP management uses to assess reflecting the impact of the weaker price performance. It assists management in 9.4 environment. Profit for the year was significantly 2018 understanding the underlying trends in operational 12.7 lower, due to the above factor, divestment-related performance on a comparable year-on-year basis. impairment charges and reclassification of past 3.4 foreign exchange losses on the formation of the It reflects the replacement cost of inventories sold 2017 6.2 BP Bunge Bioenergia joint venture. in the period and is arrived at by excluding inventory holding gains and losses from profit or 0.1 2016 loss. Adjustments are also made for non‑operating 2.6 items and fair value accounting effects. (6.5) 2015 5.9 Profit (loss) for the year attributable to BP shareholders Underlying RC profit for the year (non-GAAP) Operating cash flow ($ billion) Operating cash flow is net cash flow provided 2019 25.8 2019 performance by operating activities, as reported in the group Operating cash flow was higher than 2018, cash flow statement. Operating activities are the 201� 22�9 reflecting lower Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments principal revenue-generating activities of the and the favourable impact of lease payments 201� 1��9 group and other activities that are not investing that are now classified as financing cash flows or financing activities. 201� 10�� under IFRS 16. 201� 19�1 Return on average capital employed (%) Return on average capital employed (non-GAAP) 2019 8.9 2019 performance gives an indication of a company’s capital The decrease reflects lower profit due to the efficiency, dividing the underlying RC profit after 201� 11�2 impact of lower oil and gas prices and weaker adding back net interest by average capital refining environment. 201� ��� employed, excluding cash and goodwill. See page 345 for more information including the nearest 201� 2�� equivalent GAAP data. 201� ��� Total shareholder return (%) Total shareholder return (TSR) represents the 5.8 2019 performance 2019 change in value of a BP shareholding over a 1.1 Improvement in TSR reflects increased dividends calendar year. It assumes that dividends are in 2019. reinvested to purchase additional shares at the ����� 201� closing price on the ex-dividend date. 0�� We are committed to maintaining a progressive 20�0 201� and sustainable dividend policy. 9�� 29�0 201� ���� �12��� 201� ����� A�S �a�i� �rdinar� ��are �a�i� BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 35


 
Group performance “Despite the challenging environment in 2019, we continued to deliver operating cash flow growth, which together with continued capital discipline has underpinned growth in free cash flow. Furthermore, we have made significant progress towards our $10 billion divestment target. Together this supported our decision to increase the dividend with the fourth-quarter results.” Dr Brian Gilvary Group chief financial officer $10.0bn Underlying replacement cost (RC) profit (2018 $12.7bn) $4.0bn $25.8bn Profit attributable to BP shareholders Operating cash flow (2018 $9.4bn) (2018 $22.9bn) Financial and operating performance $ million except per share amounts 2019 2018 2017 Segment RC profit (loss) before Profit before interest and taxation 11,706 19,378 9,474 interest and tax Finance costs and net finance expense relating to pensions and (3,552) (2,655) (2,294) ($ billion) other post-retirement benefits Taxation (3,964) (7,145) (3,712) 2019 Non-controlling interests (164) (195) (79) 2018 Profit for the yeara 4,026 9,383 3,389 2017 Inventory holding (gains) losses, before tax (667) 801 (853) (5) 0 5 10 15 20 25 Taxation charge (credit) on inventory holding gains and losses 156 (198) 225 ● Upstream ● Downstream ● Rosneft RC profit 3,515 9,986 2,761 ● Other businesses and corporate (includes Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items 8,263 3,380 3,730 costs related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill) ● Consolidation adjustment – UPll★ and fair value accounting effects before tax ❙ Group RC profit before interest and tax Taxation charge (credit) on non-operating items (1,788) (643) (325) and fair value accounting effects Underlying RC profit 9,990 12,723 6,166 Dividends paid per share – cents 41.0 40.5 40.0 – pence 31.977 30.568 30.979 a Profit (loss) attributable to BP shareholders. More information Upstream, see page 50. Downstream, see page 56. Rosneft, see page 61. Other businesses and corporate, see page 63. Oil and gas disclosures for the group, see page 308. For a discussion of BP’s financial and operating performance for the year ending 31 December 2017, see BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018, pages 19-39 and BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2017, pages 21-43. 36 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Results Cash flow and net debt information Profit for the year ended 31 December 2019 attributable to BP $ million shareholders was $4.0 billion, compared with $9.4 billion in 2018. 2019 2018 2017 Excluding inventory holding gains, replacement cost (RC) profit was Operating cash flow 25,770 22,873 18,931 $3.5 billion, compared with $10.0 billion in 2018. Net cash used in investing activities (16,974) (21,571) (14,077) After adjusting RC profit for a net charge for non-operating items Net cash used in financing activities (8,817) (4,079) (3,296) of $7.2 billion and net favourable fair value accounting effects of Cash and cash equivalents at end of year 22,472 22,468 25,586 $0.7 billion (both on a post-tax basis), underlying RC profit for the year Capital expenditure ended 31 December 2019 was $10.0 billion, a decrease of $2.7 billion Organic capital expenditure (15,238) (15,140) (16,501) compared with 2018. The decrease was predominantly due to lower  oil and gas prices in the Upstream segment and a significantly weaker Inorganic capital expenditure (4,183) (9,948) (1,339) environment in the Downstream segment. (19,421) (25,088) (17,840) Finance debt 67,724 65,132 62,574 Profit for the year ended 31 December 2018 attributable to BP  shareholders was $9.4 billion, including inventory holding losses, Net debt 45,442 43,477 37,819 RC profit was $10.0 billion. After adjusting RC profit for a net charge Finance debt ratio (%) 40.2% 39.3% 38.6% for non-operating items of $2.8 billion and net favourable fair value Gearing (%) 31.1% 30.0% 27.0% accounting effects of $68 million (both on a post-tax basis), underlying RC profit for the year ended 31 December 2018 was $12.7 billion. This Operating cash flow reflected higher oil prices, record plant reliability and the benefit of new major projects start-ups in Upstream; stronger refining margins and Operating cash flow for the year ended 31 December 2019 was strong fuels marketing growth in Downstream; and higher oil prices in $25.8 billion, $2.9 billion higher than 2018. Operating cash flow in Rosneft segment. 2019 reflects $2.7 billion of pre-tax cash outflows related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Compared with 2018, operating cash flows in 2019 Non-operating items also reflected the favourable effect of an estimated $2.0 billion of lease payments being classified as financing cash flows from 1 January 2019 The net charge for non-operating items was $7.2 billion after tax in following the implementation of IFRS 16. 2019, mainly related to impairment charges, principally resulting from the announcements to dispose of certain assets in the US and Movements in working capital adversely impacted cash flow in the reclassification of accumulated foreign exchange losses from reserves year by $2.9 billion, including an adverse impact on working capital from to the income statement on the formation of the BP Bunge Bioenergia the Gulf of Mexico oil spill of $2.6 billion. BP actively manages its joint venture. working capital balances to optimize and reduce volatility in cash flow. The net charge for non-operating items was $2.8 billion post-tax in Operating cash flow for the year ended 31 December 2018 was 2018, mainly related to additional charges for the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, $22.9 billion, reflecting $3.5 billion of pre-tax cash outflows related to environmental and other provisions, and further restructuring costs. the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. More information on non-operating items and fair value accounting Movements in working capital adversely impacted cash flow in the year effects can be found on pages 300 and 344. by $4.8 billion. There was an adverse impact on working capital from the Gulf of Mexico oil spill of $3.1 billion. Other working capital effects, Taxation principally an increase in other current and non-current assets partially offset by a decrease in inventory, had an adverse effect of $1.7 billion. The charge for corporate income taxes was $3,964 million in 2019 compared with $7,145 million in 2018. The decrease mainly reflects the lower level of profit in 2019. The effective tax rate (ETR) on the profit or loss for the year was 49% in 2019 and 43% in 2018. The ETR for both years was impacted by various one-off items. Adjusting for inventory holding impacts, non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, the underlying ETR was 36% in 2019 (2018 38%). The lower underlying ETR in 2019 compared with 2018 reflects the reassessment of the recognition of deferred tax assets. In the current environment, the underlying ETR in 2020 is expected to be lower than 40%. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 37


 
Net cash used in investing activities Group reserves and production (including Rosneft segment)a Net cash used in investing activities for the year ended 31 December 2019 decreased by $4.6 billion compared with 2018. $ million 2019 2018 2017 The decrease mainly reflected the phasing of the payments to BHP for the Petrohawk acquisition. Estimated net proved reserves (net of royalties) Total capital expenditure for 2019 was $19.4 billion (2018 $25.1 billion), Liquids (mmb) 11,478 11,456 10,672 of which organic capital expenditure was $15.2 billion (2018 $15.1 Natural gas (bcf) 45,601 49,239 45,060 billion). Sources of funding are fungible, but the majority of the group’s Total hydrocarbons (mmboe) 19,341 19,945 18,441 funding requirements for new investment comes from cash generated by existing operations. We expect 2020 organic capital expenditure to Of which: b remain towards the lower end of our $15-17 billion range. Equity-accounted entities 9,965 9,757 8,949 Production (net of royalties) Total divestment and other proceeds for 2019 amounted to $2.8 billion Liquids (mb/d) 2,211 2,191 2,260 including $0.6 billion received in relation to the sale of a 49% interest in BP’s retail property portfolio in Australia, shown within financing Natural gas (mmcf/d) 9,102 8,659 7,744 activities in the group cash flow statement. Total divestment and other Total hydrocarbons (mboe/d) 3,781 3,683 3,595 proceeds for 2018 amounted to $3.5 billion including a $0.6 billion loan Of which: repayment, relating to the refinancing of Trans Adriatic Pipeline AG. Subsidiaries 2,420 2,328 2,164 Equity-accounted entitiesc 1,360 1,355 1,431 BP expects to meet its target of $10 billion proceeds by end-2020 and expects to announce a further $5 billion of agreed disposals by a Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component mid-2021. parts. b Includes BP’s share of Rosneft. See Rosneft on page 61 and Supplementary information on oil and natural gas on page 232 for further information. Net cash used in financing activities c Includes BP’s share of Rosneft. See Rosneft on page 61 and Oil and gas disclosures for the group on page 308 for further information. Net cash used in financing activities for the year ended 31 December 2019 was $8.8 billion, compared with $4.1 billion in 2018. This was Total hydrocarbon proved reserves at 31 December 2019, on an oil mainly as a result of $2.3 billion in lease liability repayments which were equivalent basis including equity-accounted entities, decreased by 3% presented as operating cash flows and capital expenditure prior to the (decrease of 8% for subsidiaries and increase of 2% for equity- implementation of IFRS 16, an increase of $1.5 billion in debt financing, accounted entities) compared with 31 December 2018. Natural gas an increase of $1.2 billion in net repurchase of shares and an increase in represented about 41% (48% for subsidiaries and 34% for equity- dividend payments of $0.3 billion offset by $0.6 billion in cash received accounted entities) of these reserves. The change includes a net in relation to the sale of the 49% interest in BP’s retail property portfolio decrease from acquisitions and disposals of 133mmboe (decrease of in Australia as described above. 134mmboe within our subsidiaries and increase of 1mmboe within our equity-accounted entities). Acquisition activity in our subsidiaries Total dividends distributed to shareholders in 2019 were 41.0 cents per occurred in India, and divestment activity in our subsidiaries in the US share, 0.5 cents higher than 2018. This amounted to a total distribution and Egypt. There were no material acquisitions or divestments in our to shareholders of $8.3 billion (2018 $8.1 billion), of which shareholders equity-accounted entities. elected to receive $1.4 billion (2018 $1.4 billion) in shares under the scrip dividend programme. The total distributed in cash during the year Total hydrocarbon production for the group was 3% higher compared amounted to $6.9 billion (2018 $6.7 billion). with 2018. The increase comprised a 4% increase (1% increase for liquids and 7% increase for gas) for subsidiaries and was broadly flat Debt with 2018 for equity-accounted entities. Finance debt at the end of 2019 increased by $2.6 billion from the end of 2018. The finance debt ratio at the end of 2019 increased by 0.9%. Net debt at the end of 2019 increased by $2.0 billion from the 2018 year-end position. Gearing at the end of 2019 increased by 1.1%. Net debt and gearing are non-GAAP measures. See Financial statements – Note 26 for finance debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis, and Note 27 for further information on net debt, including the amendment of comparative information for finance debt, net debt and gearing following the implementation of IFRS 16. For information on financing the group’s activities, see Financial statements – Note 29 and Liquidity and capital resources on page 301. 38 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Sustainability Operating sustainably, safely and responsibly is core to our ability to create long-term value for our stakeholders, deliver our net zero ambition and aims, and realize our purpose to reimagine energy for people and our planet. Our sustainability focus areas Environment • Climate change and • Accrediting our low We refreshed and expanded our the energy transition. carbon activities. sustainability materiality assessment • Net zero aims. • Calling for more process in 2019. We asked a range of • Carbon intensity of our products. progressive climate policies external and internal stakeholders, • GHG emissions • Climate-related financial including shareholders and employees, from our operations. disclosures. to share their feedback on the issues that • Our ‘reduce, improve, • Working with others. matter most to them. We also asked them create’ framework. • Managing our impacts. to consider the relative impact of these issues on our business and how they think Safety and • Keeping people safe. • Cyber threats. BP can influence them positively. We security • Managing safety. • Security. validated and prioritized the findings with • Our operating • Working with contractors experts in BP to help prioritize our management system. • Our partners in joint sustainability reporting. We’ve covered • Preventing incidents. arrangements. the main issues they consider in this • Emergency preparedness. section, along with additional key non-financial information. Our people • Attraction and retention. • Employee engagement. Our reporting For more information on our sustainability • Diversity. • Share ownership. performance, see the BP Sustainability • Inclusion. Report 2019. For key environmental, social and Communities • Value to society. • Human rights. governance data, see our ESG datasheet at bp.com/ESGdata. For our mapping to some key sustainability Governance • Our values. • Lobbying and political frameworks and standards, including GRI and business • The BP code of conduct. donations. and IPIECA, see bp.com/reportingcentre. ethics • Anti-bribery and corruption. • Trade associations. • Tax and transparency. Non-financial reporting Page Other related information Page information statement Environmental matters 40-45 Business model 14-15 This sustainability section, and other pages Our employees 47, 88-89, 221 Strategy 16-18 referenced below, provide information as Social matters 48 Non-financial KPIs 32-34 required by section 414CB of the Companies Act 2006 in relation to: Human rights 48 Principal risks 69-71 Anti-bribery and corruption 49 Policies 39-49, 68-69 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 39


 
Environment Greenhouse gas emissions from our operations We report Scope 1 (direct) and Scope 2 (indirect) GHG emissions on Climate change and the energy transition a carbon dioxide equivalent (CO2e) basis. Direct emissions include CO2 The world needs more energy to fuel prosperity and improve standards and methane from the combustion of fuel and the operation of facilities, of living for a growing global population. This energy must be delivered and indirect emissions include those resulting from the purchase of in affordable and reliable ways, but it must also be lower carbon. BP’s electricity and steam we import into our operations. purpose is to reimagine energy for people and our planet. To deliver Our overall emissions, on an operational control basis, increased in this, we have set out a new ambition to become a net zero company 2019, mainly due to major acquisitions. But the SERs we achieved by 2050 or sooner, and to help the world reach net zero. came close to countering this increase. We achieved zero net growth in our operational emissions with no offsets required against our Net zero aims adjusted 2015 baseline. Aim 1: Net zero operations a Greenhouse gas emissions (MteCO2e) We aim to be net zero across our entire operations on an absolute basis by 2050 or sooner. This aim relates to Scope 1 (direct) and Scope 2 Operational controlb (indirect) greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions. 2019 2018 2017 Aim 2: Net zero oil and gas Scope 1 (direct) emissions 49.2 48.8 50.5 We aim to be net zero on an absolute basis across the carbon in our Scope 2 (indirect) emissions 5.2 5.4 6.1 upstream oil and gas production by 2050 or sooner. This is our Scope 3 Total 54.4 54.2 56.6 aim, and is on a BP equity share basis excluding Rosneft. This carbon a was equivalent to 360MteCO2e of emissions in 2019. BP equity sharec 2019 2018 2017 Scope 3 Scope 1 (direct) emissions 46.0 46.5 49.4 Scope 2 (Indirect) emissions 5.7 5.7 6.8 There are 15 categories of Scope 3 emissions. For our industry Total 51.7 52.2 56.2 the most important of these categories is the ‘use of sold products’ (category 11). For this category of Scope 3, we are a Our approach to reporting GHG emissions broadly follows the IPIECA/API/IOGP Petroleum reporting for the first time the estimated CO2 emissions from Industry Guidelines for Reporting GHG Emissions. We calculate CO2 emissions based on the carbon in our upstream oil and gas productiona. This metric the fuel consumption and fuel properties for major sources. We report CO2 and methane. We do not include nitrous oxide, hydrofluorocarbons, perfluorocarbons and sulphur replaces the ‘customer emissions’ metric, which we previously hexafluoride as they are not material to our operations and it is not practical to collect this reported in our Sustainability Report. For more information see data. bp.com/sustainabilityreport. b Operational control data comprises 100% of emissions from activities that are operated by BP, going beyond the IPIECA guidelines by including emissions from certain other activities such as contracted drilling activities. c BP equity share data comprises 100% of emissions from subsidiaries and the percentage a This figure assumes that 100% of the oil and gas produced is combusted with no carbon of emissions equivalent to our share of joint arrangements and associates, other than capture, use and storage, although a proportion of global oil and gas goes into non- BP’s share of Rosneft. combusted uses, such as petrochemicals and lubricants. Ratio of Scope 1 (direct) and Scope 2 (indirect) GHG emissions to gross Aim 3: Halving intensity d production (teCO2e/te) Our aim is to cut the carbon intensity of the products we sell by 50%, by 2050 or sooner. This is a lifecycle GHG emissions intensity approach, 2019 2018 2017 2016 per unit of energy. It covers marketing sales of energy products and, 0.22 0.22 0.24 0.24 potentially, in the future, certain other products, such as those d Gross production comprises upstream production, refining throughput and associated with land carbon projects. petrochemicals produced. This metric also responds to the CA100+ resolution, which requires us to report the estimated carbon intensity of our energy products. Estimated emissions intensity (gCO2e/MJ) 2019 Average emissions intensity of marketed energy products 79.7 Refined energy products 93.7 Gas products 71.6 Bio-products 28.8 Power products 43.8 40 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Our ‘reduce, improve, create’ framework In 2018 we set out our low carbon ambition and targets in In 2019 we announced plans to link our annual cash bonus to our our ‘reduce, improve, create’ (RIC) framework: sustainable emissions reduction (SER) target. This means around 37,000 employees, including executives, are now incentivized and • Reducing GHG emissions in our own operations. rewarded for their contribution to reducing carbon emissions in BP. • Improving products to help our customers and consumers lower their emissions. We’ve met our SER target six years ahead of schedule and this has • Creating low carbon businesses. motivated us to start work to set new targets. We plan to provide more detail in September 2020. Reducing Improving Creating emissions in our operations our products low carbon businesses 2019 progress 2019 progress 2019 progress • Achieved zero net growth in • Continued to scale up our • Began rolling out BP Chargemaster operational emissions. Our total co-processing business, growing ultra-fast charging across BP forecourts GHG emissions (operated) increased the volume of lower carbon bio- in the UK and piloted ultra-fast charging slightly in 2019, largely due to the feedstock processed at our refineries. at Aral forecourts in Germany. major acquisitions at the end of 2018. • Established more than 30 carbon • Increased our stake in Lightsource BP, This was countered by other neutral BP retail sites, offering a to create a 50:50 joint venture, see emissions reductions. Total emissions range of carbon neutral products page 73. were still below the adjusted 2015 and services. • Took a leading role in the OGCI’s Net baseline so no offsets were required. • Increased the supply of BP biojet, our Zero Teesside project in the UK. Using • 1.4Mte of SERs delivered in 2019 sustainable aviation fuel, to 11 locations integrated carbon capture, use and and 3.9Mte since 2016. And we linked worldwide – including in Sweden, storage, the project aims to store the this target to the annual cash bonus France and the US. carbon dioxide emissions of the of around 37,000 eligible employees carbon-intensive industries situated in 2019. within the Teesside industrial cluster. • Methane intensity of 0.14%, below our target of 0.2%. More information Our strategy on page 16. Directors’ remuneration report on page 100. bp.com/sustainability. Accrediting our lower carbon activities Calling for more progressive climate policies Our advancing low carbon (ALC) accreditation programme aims to We plan to allocate more resources to advocate for well-designed inspire every part of BP to identify lower carbon opportunities. Since its policies, including carbon pricing. We believe carbon pricing is the launch, the programme has motivated people across BP to do more to most efficient way to reduce GHG emissions and incentivize everyone, advance low carbon, with 76 activities being accredited in 2019. Each including energy producers and consumers, to play their part. In our activity supports one of our low carbon ambitions. Deloitte conducts view, pricing can be as effective as a tax or a cap-and-trade system. independent assurance on ALC activities. We estimate that 64MteCO2e While we support well-designed carbon pricing, we’re prepared to have been saved or offset through activities delivered by BP, and oppose poorly designed proposals. For example, we opposed the 5.4Mte through activities delivered by BP partners since the ballot initiative to introduce a carbon fee in Washington State, US in programme began in 2017a. November 2018. We believed that the policy was badly designed and See bp.com/advancinglowcarbon for details on the programme and would have harmed Washington’s economy without significantly Deloitte’s assurance statement. reducing carbon emissions. The ballot was not passed. a The total emissions saved or offset from the accredited activities are estimated using a We continued to work with legislative leaders in the state and in 2019 variety of methodologies and baselines. The figures aim only to illustrate the impact of the activities within the programme, and delivered by BP or a BP partner only refers to the supported a cap-and-invest bill, which we believe will be more effective. organization leading on delivering the activity. Savings or offsets may be claimed by or We intend to continue working with the Washington legislature during its attributed to other parties. The scope of accredited activities is wider than, and does not 2020 session to see if a new carbon bill can be advanced. seek to align with, our GHG reporting boundaries. Therefore, the figures are not directly comparable to BP’s reported emissions. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 41


 
Climate-related financial disclosures and the preparation and consideration of corporate reporting documents and AGM materials. The board has reviewed the consistency of our We support the recommendations of the Task Force on Climate-related current strategy with the Paris goals, see page 17. Financial Disclosures (TCFD), which was established by the Financial Stability Board with the aim of improving the reporting of climate- The executive related risks and opportunities. We intend to work constructively with The assessment and management of climate-related matters is the TCFD, and others, to develop good practices and standards for embedded across BP at various levels and delegated authority flows transparency. This will be a multi-year journey, but we have already down from the board, see page 83. started, and our latest reporting provides information supporting the Climate-related matters were discussed at each of the 11 executive TCFD’s recommended disclosures. team meetings in 2019 including the development of BP’s net zero Governance ambition and aims ahead of discussion with the board. Recommendation: Disclose the organization’s governance around The executive team is supported by BP’s senior-level leadership and climate-related issues and opportunities. their respective teams, with dedicated business and functional The board expertise focused on climate-related matters. This includes our carbon The board is responsible for the overall conduct of the group’s business, management, safety and operational risk, group policy and our which extends to setting our strategy and approach to the energy economics teams. transition. The board and its associated committees, where appropriate, Alignment between group, business and functional leaders is fostered have oversight of climate-related matters (which include issues and through cross-functional bodies, including the group, upstream and opportunities) and are updated on these matters as frequently as downstream carbon steering committees.
 necessary. In 2019 climate matters were included on the agenda for each of the six board meetings. This informed the board’s consideration of strategy. The process by which the board is updated on climate-related matters is managed by our company secretary’s office and depends on the topic being discussed. In 2019 these processes included formal analysis of our RIC targets, briefings with subject matter experts from the business Climate governance: investments in 2019 BP board Considers investment cases deemed sufficiently material to warrant the board’s attention. New business models Existing and new business models Renewal committee Resource commitment meeting Reviews strategic, commercial and investment decisions outside of core Reviews strategic, commercial and investment decisions related to activity and related to new lines of business (up to $250 million organic existing and new lines of business (above $250 million organic and and $25 million inorganic capital investment). Chaired by our chief $25 million inorganic capital investment). Chaired by our chief executive. transition officer. New energy frontiers Ventures investment steering committee committee Oversees strategy and Oversees strategic, commercial development of growth and investment decisions in opportunities in low carbon venturing business. Chaired by business models that can be our group head of technology. scaled up to create new businesses for BP. Chaired by our chief transition officer. BP Launchpad Launchpad is BP’s business-builder and scale-up factory. Its mission is to build five $1 billion business unicorns. Chaired by our group head of technology. Executive-level committee. Cross-functional committee. 42 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Strategy For the first time we have published the estimated lifecycle carbon Recommendation: Disclose the actual and potential impacts of intensity of our marketed energy products, see page 40. climate-related risks and opportunities on the organization’s We recognize that climate-related risks include both: business, strategy and financial planning where such information is material. • Physical risks – risks related to the physical impacts of climate change including event driven risks such as changes in the severity We recognize the significance of the energy transition and the risks and/or frequency of extreme weather events. and opportunities it presents. As part of their consideration of BP’s • Transition risks – risks related to the transition to a lower carbon strategy, the board and executive team consider risks and opportunities economy including policy and legal, technology, markets and associated with climate change and the energy transition informed by reputational risks. a range of external inputs, including the International Panel on Climate Change (IPCC), academic research and emerging regulatory The potential impacts of such climate-related risks are described in Risk requirements, and BP materials such as the different scenarios factors, see pages 70-71. We place importance on pursuing a flexible described in the BP Energy Outlook 2019. strategy which gives us optionality where there is uncertainty about the pathways to achieve the Paris goals. This positions us to deliver our We believe that the transition to a lower carbon economy presents strategic priorities, and net zero ambition and aims. significant business opportunities for BP. One of our strategic priorities is to pursue new opportunities to meet evolving technology, consumer When developing our strategy, we draw on expertise from across the and policy trends through venturing and low carbon, see page 28. organization. This includes our group economics team and their work Some of the opportunities we see are set out in our RIC framework – on the scenarios described in the BP Energy Outlook 2019. The Energy to improve our products, to help customers lower their emissions and to Outlook, together with other scenarios, informs our price assumptions create new, lower carbon businesses, see page 41. which are part of our investment governance processes. The evaluation of new material capex investment in 2019 for consistency with the Paris We have set out 10 aims to support our ambition to be a net zero goals is discussed on page 21. company by 2050 or sooner and to help the world reach net zero. We believe that collectively, these 10 aims set out a path that is consistent with the Paris goals. One of our specific aims relates to halving the carbon intensity of our marketed products by 2050 or sooner. See page 6 for more information on our net zero ambition and aims. Climate governance: management of climate-related matters in 2019 Chief executive and the executive team Senior leadership Carbon steering group Accountability Focuses on strategy, policy, performance oversight and collaboration relating to carbon management activities across the group. Chaired by our vice president of carbon management. Delegation Upstream carbon steering committee Downstream advancing the energy transition committee Focuses on the delivery of lower carbon plans in the Upstream. Develops and drives the implementation of advancing the Chaired by our chief operating officer of production, energy transition in the Downstream. Chaired by our head transformation and carbon, Upstream. of technology, Downstream and chief scientist. Underpinned by systems, processes and risk management. Executive-level committee. Cross-functional committee. Senior-leadership level. Business and segment committee. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 43


 
Our group strategic planning team is responsible for using data from Metrics and targets the BP Energy Outlook and implementing the insights in our strategic Recommendation: Disclose the metrics and targets used to assess frameworks, including our net zero ambition and mid-term RIC targets. and manage relevant climate-related risks and opportunities where We recognize that climate-related risks are an important consideration such information is material. in developing our strategy. Climate-related risks are incorporated into We present the principal group-wide metrics and targets used to assess BP’s governance process, see How we manage risk on page 69. and manage climate-related risks and opportunities on page 17. This Risk management includes the targets we set out in 2018 in our RIC framework. Recommendation: Disclose how the organization identifies, In addition, in 2019 BP announced that sustainable GHG emissions assesses and manages climate-related risks. reductions would be included as a factor in the reward of around Our processes for identifying and managing climate-related risks are 37,000 eligible employees across the group and around the world, integrated into BP’s risk management policy and the associated risk including executive directors. This target was 10% of the group’s annual management procedures. BP’s risk management system is designed cash bonus scorecard and we exceeded the target set of 1.0Mte to address all types of risks and as part of this system our operating (1.4Mte). In 2020 we plan to increase the percentage of remuneration businesses are responsible for identifying and managing their risks. which is linked to emissions reductions for our leadership and eligible Risks which may be identified include potential effects on operations employees. Our aim is to mobilize our workforce to become advocates at asset level, performance at business level and developments at for our net zero ambition. regional level from extreme weather or the transition to a lower For information on our 2020 remuneration policy, see page 110. carbon economy. As part of our annual planning process we review the group’s principal risks and uncertainties. Climate change and the transition to a lower carbon economy has been identified as a principal risk, see page 69. This covers various aspects of how risks associated with the energy transition could manifest. Similarly, physical climate-related risks such as extreme weather are covered in our principal risks related to safety and operations. TCFD index table TCFD recommended disclosure Where reported Governance a. Describe the board’s oversight of climate-related Page 42. Disclose the organization’s risks and opportunities. governance around climate- b. Describe the management’s role in assessing and Page 42. related issues and opportunities. managing climate related risks and opportunities. Strategy a. Describe the climate-related risks and opportunities Achieving the Paris goals, page 13 – for a discussion of the Disclose the actual and potential the organization has identified over the short, different pathways and time horizons considered impacts of climate-related risks medium, and long term. RIC framework, page 41 – for an outline of opportunities. and opportunities on the Risk factors, pages 70-71 – description of principal risks. organization’s business, strategy b. Describe the impact of climate-related risks and Risk factors, pages 70-71 – description of principal risks. and financial planning where opportunities on the organization’s businesses, such information is material. strategy, and financial planning. c. Describe the resilience of the organization’s strategy, Achieving the Paris goals, page 13. taking into consideration different climate-related Our strategy, page 16. scenarios, including a 2°C or lower scenario. Risk management a. Describe the organization’s processes for identifying Risk management, page 44. Disclose how the organization and assessing climate-related risks. Upstream, page 50. identifies, assesses and Downstream, page 56. manages climate-related risks. Other businesses and corporate, page 63. b. Describe the organization’s processes for managing Risk management, page 44. climate-related risks. c. Describe how processes for identifying, assessing, Risk management, page 44. and managing climate-related risks are integrated How we manage risk, pages 68-69. into the organization’s overall risk management. Risk factors, pages 70-71. Metrics and targets a. Disclose the metrics used by the organization to Relevant group-wide metrics and targets, page 17. Disclose the metrics and targets assess climate-related risks and opportunities in line used to assess and manage with its strategy and risk management process. relevant climate-related risks b. Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2, and, if appropriate, GHG emissions data, page 40. and opportunities where such Scope 3 GHG emissions, and the related risks. information is material. c. Describe the targets used by the organization to RIC framework, page 41. manage climate-related risks and opportunities and (Also note: Net zero ambition and aims, page 6). performance against targets. 44 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Working with others Safety and security We work with peers, non-governmental organizations and Safety remains our number one priority and one of our core values. academic institutions to support the energy transition. Our aim is to have no accidents, no harm to people and no damage to the environment. The Oil and Gas Climate Initiative (OGCI) brings together 13 oil and gas companies to increase the ambition, speed and scale of the initiatives We are working to continue to improve personal and process safety and undertaken by its individual companies to help reduce manmade GHG operational risk management across BP and to strengthen our safety emissions. OGCI announced a collective methane intensity target for management. Our approach builds on our experience, including learning member companies in 2018. from incidents, operations audits, annual risk reviews and sharing For more information on BP’s methane intensity, see page 34. lessons learned with our industry peers. BP is working with OGCI Climate Investments and certain other OGCI Process safety events Recordable injury frequency member companies to help progress the UK’s first commercial (number of incidents) (workforce incidents per 200,000 hours worked) full-chain carbon capture, use and storage project. Net Zero Teesside 100 0.4 83 84 plans to capture CO2 from new, efficient gas-fired power generation and 72 transport it by pipeline to be stored in a formation under the southern 75 0.3 61 North Sea. The infrastructure would also allow other industries in 56 Teesside to store CO2 captured from their processes. The project, 50 0.2 which is currently undergoing a feasibility study, could be in operation by the mid-2020s. 25 0.1 26 20 16 18 16 Managing our impacts 0 0 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 We work hard to avoid, mitigate and manage our environmental Tier 1 Tier 2 Workforce 0.243 0.211 0.218 0.198 0.166 and social impacts over the life of our operations. Employee 0.203 0.194 0.202 0.152 0.128 Contractor 0.279 0.222 0.229 0.233 0.193 The way our businesses around the world are expected to understand American Petroleum Institute US benchmark* and manage their environmental and social impacts is set out in our International Association of Oil & Gas operating management system (OMS). This includes requirements on Producers benchmark* engaging with stakeholders who may be affected by our activities. * API and IOGP 2019 data reports are not available until May 2020. In planning our projects, we identify potential impacts from our activities in areas such as land rights, water use and protected areas. We use the Keeping people safe results of this analysis to identify actions and mitigation measures and All our employees and contractors have the responsibility and the look to implement these in project design, construction and operations. authority to stop unsafe work. Our safety rules guide our workers on For example, in Mauritania and Senegal we are working with national staying safe while performing tasks with the potential to cause most and international scientists on the biodiversity action plan for the harm. The rules are aligned with our OMS and focus on areas such as Greater Tortue Ahmeyim development. working at heights, lifting operations and driving safety. Our OMS requires each of BP’s operating businesses and functions to We monitor and report on key workforce personal safety metrics in line create and maintain its own OMS handbook, describing how it will carry with industry standards. We include both employees and contractors in out its local operating activities. Through self-verification, local business our data. processes are reviewed and areas for improvement are prioritized, allowing focus on delivering safe, reliable and compliant operations. Tragically we suffered two fatalities in 2019. In July a fire-fighting assistant in our biofuels business in Brazil was fatally injured following a For information on our oil spill performance see page 46. fire truck accident while attending to an agricultural fire. In October a Water contractor at our Whiting refinery in the US was fatally injured when he We review water risks every year, taking into account availability, fell from a scaffold ladder. quantity, quality and regulatory requirements. We also use a range of tools, including the Global Environmental Management Initiative Local 2019 2018 2017 a Water Tool and the World Resources Institute Aqueduct Global Water Recordable injury frequency 0.166 0.198 0.218 Risk Atlas. Day away from work case frequencyb 0.047 0.048 0.055 Severe vehicle accident rate 0.05 0.04 0.03 In 2019 we saw a 4% rise in freshwater withdrawals and a 3% rise in freshwater consumption. This was largely due to increased production, a Incidents that result in a fatality or injury per 200,000 hours worked. with freshwater withdrawal and consumption intensities remaining flat, b Incidents that result in an injury where a person is unable to work for a day (shift) or more compared with 2018. per 200,000 hours worked. Air emissions Our recordable injury frequency, which includes BHP assets acquired in We put measures in place to manage our air emissions, in line with 2018, reduced by 16% in 2019. There is always more we can do and we regulations and industry guidelines designed to protect the health of remain focused on achieving better results today and in the future. local communities and the environment. In 2019 we took delivery of the last three vessels in our new fleet of six liquefied natural gas (LNG) carriers. These use around 25% less fuel and emit less nitrogen oxides than the older LNG carriers in the BP operated fleet. See bp.com/environment for more information. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 45


 
Managing safety Cyber threats BP-operated businesses are responsible for identifying and managing The severity, sophistication and scale of cyber attacks continues to operating risks and bringing together people with the right skills and evolve. The increasing digitalization and reliance on IT systems makes competencies to address them. Our safety and operational risk team managing cyber risk an even greater priority for many industries, works alongside BP-operated businesses to provide oversight and including our own. technical guidance, while our group audit team visits sites on a The risk comes from a variety of cyber-threat actors, including nation risk-prioritized basis to check how they are managing risks. states, criminals, terrorists, hacktivists and insiders. As with previous Our operating management system years, we’ve experienced threats to the security of our digital infrastructure, but none of these had a significant impact on our Our OMS is a group-wide framework designed to help us manage risks business in 2019. We have a range of measures to manage this risk, in our operating activities and drive performance improvements. It brings including the use of cyber-security policies and procedures, security together BP requirements on health, safety, security, the environment, protection tools, continuous threat monitoring and event detection social responsibility and operational reliability, as well as related issues, capabilities, and incident response plans. We also conduct exercises such as maintenance, contractor relations and organizational learning, to test our response to and recovery from cyber attacks. To encourage into a common management system. vigilance among our staff, our cyber-security training and awareness programme covers topics such as phishing and the correct classification Our OMS also helps us improve the quality of our activities by setting a and handling of our information. We collaborate closely with governments, common framework that our operations must work to. We review and law enforcement and industry peers to understand and respond to new amend these requirements from time to time to reflect our priorities. and emerging threats. Any variations in the application of our OMS, in order to meet local regulations or circumstances, are subject to a governance process. Security Recently acquired operations need to transition to our OMS. We monitor for hostile actions that could harm our people or disrupt Preventing incidents our operations. These actions might be connected to political or social unrest, terrorism, armed conflict or criminal activity. We take these We carefully plan our operations, with the aim of identifying potential potential threats seriously and assess them continuously. hazards and having rigorous operating and maintenance practices applied by capable people to manage risks at every stage. We design Our 24-hour response information centre in the UK uses state-of-the-art our new facilities in line with process safety, good design and technology to monitor evolving high-risk situations in real-time. It helps engineering principles. us to assess the safety of our people and provide them with practical advice if there is an emergency. We track our safety performance using industry metrics such as the American Petroleum Institute recommended practice 754 and the This year, we faced a number of protests. We worked with local police, International Association of Oil & Gas Producers recommended including marine authorities, to minimize any disruption from these to practice 456. our operations. 2019 2018 2017 Working with contractors Tier 1 and tier 2 process safety eventsa 98 72 79 Through documents that help bridge between our policies and those Oil spills – numberb 152 124 139 of our contractors, we define the way our safety management system Oil spills contained 90 63 81 co-exists with those of our contractors to manage risk on a site. For our Oil spills reaching land and water 58 57 58 contractors facing the most serious risks, we conduct quality, technical, Oil spilled – volume (thousand litres) 710 538 886 health, safety and security audits before awarding contracts. Once they Oil unrecovered (thousand litres) 300 131 265 start work, we continue to monitor their safety performance. a Tier 1 process safety events are losses of primary containment of greatest consequence Our OMS includes requirements and practices for working with – such as causing harm to a member of the workforce, costly damage to equipment or contractors. Our standard model contracts include health, safety and exceeding defined quantities. Tier 2 events are those of lesser consequence. security requirements. We expect and encourage our contractors and b Number of spills greater than or equal to one barrel (159 litres, 42 US gallons). their employees to act in a way that is consistent with our code of The total number of tier 1 and tier 2 process safety events increased conduct and take appropriate action if those expectations, or their in 2019, mainly reflecting performance in assets recently acquired. contractual obligations, are not met. Underlying performance across the group improved slightly from 2018. We are implementing BP procedures and processes to help bring newly Our partners in joint arrangements acquired assets in line with BP assets. In joint arrangements where we are the operator, our OMS, code of We investigate incidents including near misses. And we use leading conduct and other policies apply. We aim to report on aspects of our indicators, such as inspections and equipment tests, to monitor the business where we are the operator – as we directly manage the strength of controls to prevent incidents. We also use techniques that performance of these operations. We monitor performance and how risk is help teams to analyse and redesign tasks to reduce the chance of managed in our joint arrangements, whether we are the operator or not. mistakes occurring. Where we are not the operator, our OMS is available as a reference point for BP businesses when engaging with operators and co- Emergency preparedness venturers. We have a group framework to assess and manage BP’s The scale and spread of BP’s operations means we must be prepared exposure related to safety, operational and bribery and corruption risk to respond to a range of possible disruptions and emergency events. from our participation in these types of arrangements. Where We maintain disaster recovery, crisis and business continuity appropriate, we may seek to influence how risk is managed in management plans and work to build day-to-day response capabilities arrangements where we are not the operator. to support local management of incidents. 46 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Our people At the end of 2019 we had five female directors (2018 5) on our board. Our nomination committee remains mindful of diversity when considering BP’s success depends on having a talented and diverse workforce that potential candidates. For more information on the composition of our represents the communities we serve. board, see page 74. In the UK we report the gender pay gap for five BP entities. Our 2019 Number of employees at 31 Decembera 2019 2018 2017 report shows small improvements since 2018, including improvements Upstream 16,600 16,900 17,700 in our highest pay gap entities – BP p.l.c. and BP Exploration Operating Downstream 44,300 42,700 42,100 Company Limited. Six of the 10 gaps have narrowed. Our challenge is Other businesses and corporate 9,200 13,400 14,200 to maintain and, if possible, accelerate this trend. We are working to Total 70,100 73,000 74,000 address the differences but recognize that this is a long-term challenge. a Reported to the nearest 100. For more information see Financial statements – Note 35. See bp.com/ukgenderpaygap for data and more information on our gender pay gap in the UK. Our people are the most important element of our success. We need a motivated, engaged, and diverse workforce to deliver our purpose Inclusion and strategy. We aim to build a culture that generates the diversity of thought, approach and ideas needed to play a leading role in the To promote an inclusive culture we provide leadership training and energy transition, a culture in which people’s wellbeing is valued and support employee-run advocacy groups in areas such as gender, differences are respected. ethnicity, sexual orientation and disability. As well as bringing employees together, these groups support our recruitment programmes and The group people committee helps facilitate the group chief executive’s provide feedback on the potential impact of policy changes. Each oversight of policies relating to employees. In 2019 the committee group is sponsored by a senior executive. discussed people policies, including our remuneration policy, progress in our diversity and inclusion programme, modernizing and strengthening In 2019 we built closer ties between our central diversity and our attractiveness as an employer, our talent and learning programmes inclusion team and local business resource groups (BRGs). We also and long-term people priorities. held a number of events for employees from our BRGs, including an ‘economics of diversity’ webcast, a roadshow and a diversity and Attraction and retention inclusion week. We aim to recruit talented people from diverse backgrounds, and We aim to ensure equal opportunity in recruitment, career development, invest in training, development and competitive rewards for all our promotion, training and reward for all employees – regardless of ethnicity, people. We invest in employee development – with a focus on driving national origin, religion, gender, age, sexual orientation, marital status, safe, reliable and compliant operations, and on building technical, disability, or any other characteristic protected by applicable laws. functional and leadership capability. This includes a range of Where existing employees become disabled, our policy is to engage development opportunities for our people through a mix of on-the-job and use occupational assistance where needed, and to use reasonable learning, developmental relationships with mentors, managers and accommodations or adjustments to enable continued employment. peers, and training delivered face-to-face, virtually and through We have been recognized by a number of external awards in 2019, simulation or e-learning. including The Times newspaper’s Top 50 Employers for Women, Stonewall Global Leader and the FT’s Inclusive Companies recognition. Diversity We set out our current diversity and inclusion ambition in 2012. It is Employee engagement based on our core values of safety, respect, excellence, courage and Our managers hold regular team and one-to-one meetings with their one team. team members, complemented by formal processes through works We aim to attract, develop and retain the best talent and to create a councils in parts of Europe. We regularly communicate with employees diverse and inclusive working environment, where everyone is on factors that affect BP’s performance, and seek to maintain accepted, valued and treated equally without discrimination. constructive relationships with labour unions formally representing our employees. A total of 25% of our group leaders came from countries other than the UK and the US in 2019 (2018 24%). To understand what our employees think and feel about BP, we run an annual ‘Pulse’ survey and in 2019 we introduced ‘Pulse Live’, which Workforce by gender enables us to monitor changes in employee sentiment on a weekly As at 31 December 2019 Male Female Female % basis. The overall employee engagement score in our 2019 survey was Board directors 7 5 42 65% (2018 66%). Pride in working for BP was 75% (2018 76%). In the Executive team 11 2 15 2019 survey, participating employees told us we should focus more attention in several areas, including: sharing our strategy, reinforcing the Group leaders 285 93 25 need for an open speak-up culture, explaining how BP is taking action to Subsidiary directors 1,202 247 17 help create a low carbon future and providing updates on safety All employees 43,762 26,280 38 improvements and other priorities. The gender balance across BP as a whole is improving, with women Share ownership representing 38% of BP’s total population (2018 35%). We are working to improve these numbers further by, for example, developing We encourage employee share ownership and have a number of mentoring, sponsorship and coaching programmes to help more employee share plans in place. For example, we operate a ShareMatch women advance. But we still have work to do at the executive and plan in more than 50 countries, matching BP shares purchased by our senior levels. employees. We also operate a group-wide discretionary share plan, which allows employee participation at different levels globally and is linked to the company’s performance. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 47


 
Communities Value to society We aim to have a positive and enduring impact on the communities in which we operate. In supplying energy, we contribute to economies around the world by employing local staff, helping to develop national and local suppliers, and through the funds we pay to governments from taxes and other agreements. Additionally, our social investments support community efforts to increase incomes and improve standards of living. We committed $84 million in social investment in 2019 (2018 $114.2 million). We aim to recruit our workforce from the community or country in which we operate. We also run programmes to build the skills of businesses and develop the local supply chain in a number of locations. For example, in the West Nile Delta, we provided training on vocational skills and health and safety standards for local people. We reached more than 2,000 people by the end of 2019. Nationals employed 2019 2018 Angola 88% 87% Azerbaijan 92% 91% Egypt 81% 78% Indonesia 97% 96% Oman 80% 77% Trinidad & Tobago 96% 96% See bp.com/society for more information on how we generate value to society. Human rights We are committed to respecting the rights and dignity of all people when conducting our business. We respect internationally recognized human rights as set out in the International Bill of Human Rights and the International Labour Organization’s Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work. These include the rights of our workforce and those living in BP Target Neutral communities potentially affected by our activities. By buying carbon offsets, Target Neutral is supporting finance in projects that not only reduce We set out our commitments in our business and human rights policy carbon but make a critical difference to the health and our code of conduct. Our OMS contains guidance on respecting the of low-income families. rights of workers and community members. The ONIL cookstove project has equipped 25,000 We are incorporating the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human rural homes in Mexico with cookstoves that burn Rights, which set out how companies should prevent, address and more efficiently, using up to 58% less firewood remedy human rights impacts, into our business processes. Our focus than a traditional open fire, and are equipped with areas include ethical recruitment and working conditions, responsible chimneys to take harmful cooking fumes outside the household. security and community health and livelihoods. See bp.com/humanrights for more information about our approach to human rights. 48 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Governance and business ethics Lobbying and political donations Our aim is to more actively advocate for policies that support net zero, Our values including carbon pricing, see page 41. Our values of safety, respect, excellence, courage and one team We work with governments on a range of issues that are relevant to represent the qualities and actions we wish to see in BP. They inform our business, from regulatory compliance, to understanding our tax the way we do business and the decisions we make. We use these liabilities, to collaborating on community initiatives. The way in which values as part of our recruitment, promotion and individual performance we interact with those governments depends on the legal and management processes. regulatory framework in each country. See bp.com/values for more information. We prohibit the use of BP funds or resources to support any political The BP code of conduct candidate or party. We recognize the rights of our employees to participate in the political Our code of conduct is based on our values and sets clear expectations process and these rights are governed by the applicable laws in the for how we work at BP. It applies to all BP employees, including countries in which we operate. For example, in the US we provide members of the board. administrative support for the BP employee political action committee Employees, contractors or other third parties who have a question (PAC), which is a non-partisan committee that encourages voluntary about our code of conduct or see something that they feel is unethical employee participation in the political process. All BP employee PAC or unsafe can discuss this with their managers, supporting teams, contributions are reviewed for compliance with federal and state law works councils (where relevant) or through OpenTalk, a confidential and are publicly reported in accordance with US election laws. and anonymous helpline operated by an independent company. Trade associations We received more than 1,800 concerns or enquiries through these channels in 2019 (2018 1,712). The most commonly raised concerns We aim to set new expectations for our relationships with trade were related to the ‘Our people’ section of our code. The section associations around the world. BP is a member of many industry addresses issues such as harassment, equal opportunity, and diversity associations that offer opportunities to share good practices and and inclusion. collaborate on issues of importance to our sector. In 2019 we began an in-depth review assessing the alignment of the climate-related We take steps to identify and correct areas of non-conformance and policies and activities of 30 key trade associations to which we take disciplinary action where appropriate. In 2019 our businesses belong with BP’s position. As a result of this process we will be dismissed 74 employees for non-conformance with our code of conduct leaving three associations due to misalignment on climate policy. or unethical behaviour (2018 50). This excludes dismissals of staff For more information on the review process and outcomes see employed at our retail service stations. bp.com/tradeassociations. See bp.com/codeofconduct for more information. Tax and transparency Anti-bribery and corruption We are committed to complying with tax laws in a responsible manner We operate in parts of the world where bribery and corruption present and having open and constructive relationships with tax authorities. a high risk. We have a responsibility to our employees, our shareholders We paid $6.9 billion in income and production taxes to governments and to the countries and communities in which we do business to be in 2019 (2018 $7.5 billion). ethical and lawful in all our work. Our code of conduct explicitly prohibits engaging in bribery or corruption in any form. We disclose information on payments to governments for our upstream activities on a country-by-country and project basis under national Our group-wide anti-bribery and corruption policy and procedures reporting regulations such as those in effect in the UK. We also make include measures and guidance to assess risks, understand relevant payments to governments in connection with other parts of our laws and report concerns. They apply to all BP-operated businesses. business – such as the transporting, trading, manufacturing and We provide training to employees appropriate to the nature or location marketing of oil and gas. of their role. Around 11,000 employees completed anti-bribery and corruption training in 2019 (2018 10,957). We are a founding member of the Extractive Industries Transparency Initiative (EITI), which requires disclosure of payments made to and We assess any exposure to bribery and corruption risk when working received by governments in relation to oil, gas and mining activity. with suppliers and business partners. Where appropriate, we put in place a risk mitigation plan or we reject them if we conclude that risks Through EITI we work with governments, NGOs and international are too high. We also conduct anti-bribery compliance audits on agencies to improve transparency. For example, in 2019 we enacted selected suppliers when contracts are in place. For example, our our global commitment through membership of the international board, upstream business conducts audits for a number of suppliers in including supporting decision making on the new global EITI standard, higher-risk regions to assess their conformance with our anti-bribery which represents a further evolution in transparency. The focus is on and corruption contractual requirements. We take corrective action making disclosure and open data a routine part of government and with suppliers and business partners that fail to meet our expectations, corporate reporting, providing information to stakeholders in a way which may include terminating contracts. In 2019 we issued 25 audit that supports its widespread use in analysis and decision making. It reports (2018 27). now requires contract transparency for new contracts from 2021, as well as new requirements on environmental reporting and gender. See bp.com/tax for our approach to tax and our payments to governments report. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 49


 
Upstream The Upstream segment is responsible for our activities in oil and natural gas exploration, field development and production. Business model Exploration Wells and Global operations projects organization The exploration function is The global wells organization The global operations responsible for renewing our and the global projects organization is responsible for resource base through access, organization are responsible for safe, reliable and compliant exploration and appraisal, while the safe, reliable and compliant operations, including upstream the reservoir development execution of wells (drilling and production assets and midstream function is responsible for the completions) and major projects. transportation and processing stewardship of our resource activities. portfolio over the life of each field. Performance in 2019 Upstream profitability 2 ($ billion) 58,000km 94.4% 9 new exploration access BP-operated upstream plant successful completion 4.9 2019 (2018 63,000km2) reliability of turnarounds 11.2 (2018 95.7%) (2018 7) 14.3 2018 14.6 5.2 5 5 2.6 2017 5.9 final investment decisions major project start ups million barrels of oil equivalent (2018 9) (2018 6) per day – hydrocarbon production 0.6 2016 (2018 2.5mmboe/d) –0.5 –0.9 2015 1.2 RC profit (loss) before interest and tax Underlying RC profit (loss) before interest and tax★ 50 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Strategy In 2016 we identified a future growth target of 900,000 barrels of oil equivalent per day of production from new major projects by 2021 and Our strategy has three parts and is enabled by: we remain on track to deliver that, having started up 24 of the 35 major Quality execution projects needed to reach this target by the end of 2019. We want to be the best at what we do – everywhere we work. We see our scale and long history in many of the great basins in the This starts with executing our activity safely. In every basin, we will world as a differentiator for BP and believe in the strength of our benchmark against the competition and aim to be the best – whether incumbent positions. We believe we are balanced and flexible – in it be operating facilities reliably and cost effectively, with a focus on terms of geography, hydrocarbon type and geology – and rather than emissions, drilling wells, managing our reservoirs, exploring, building being restricted by a traditional way of working, we have and will projects, or deploying technology. Through the quality of our execution, continue to use creative business models to generate value. scale and infrastructure, we aim to be competitive in every basin, and as a business, get more from a unit of capital than our peers. This describes our strategy and organizational model in 2019. Growing advantaged oil and gas Following BP’s new ambition and aims set out in February 2020, We manage our portfolio through disciplined investment in the world’s we are transforming our business. We plan to provide more great oil and gas basins. information on our future strategy and near-term plans at our We intend to make longer-term investments in natural gas as a lower capital markets day in September 2020. carbon fuel which can complement renewables and provide stable cash flows while contributing to the energy transition to a lower carbon future. We see our gas portfolio being complemented by oil assets that we consider to be advantaged in the energy transition; this is oil we can produce at a lower cost and higher margin, with faster payback Financial performance times and ready access to markets, and maintaining a rigorous focus $ million on carbon. 2019 2018 2017 Sales and other operating revenuesa 54,501 56,399 45,440 We aim to maintain a strong financial frame, allocating capital to build resilience to withstand uncertainty and change in the external RC profit before interest and tax 4,917 14,328 5,221 environment. Ensuring sustainability of our business model and Net (favourable) adverse impact of products will be key to maintaining competitiveness. non-operating items and fair value accounting effects 6,241 222 644 Returns-led growth Underlying RC profit (loss) before We want to grow returns and value, and believe this will come from interest and tax 11,158 14,550 5,865 many sources – expanding and managing our margins, operational Organic capital expenditureb 11,904 12,027 13,763 efficiency, unit cost reduction, and capital efficiency with disciplined BP average realizationsc $ per barrel levels of capital reinvestment. Crude oild 61.56 67.81 51.71 Our major projects are selected and evaluated on a balanced set of Natural gas liquids 18.23 29.42 26.00 investment criteria, which allow for comparison and prioritization, and to Liquids 57.73 64.98 49.92 evaluate for consistency with Paris goals within an appropriate portfolio context. In the Upstream this evaluation includes confirming whether $ per thousand cubic feet we expect them to generate positive returns within a price and demand Natural gas 3.39 3.92 3.19 environment we consider to be consistent with those goals, with a bias US natural gas 1.93 2.43 2.36 towards shorter payback times and a comparison with the operational $ per barrel of oil equivalent emissions profile of our wider Upstream portfolio. Total hydrocarbons 38.00 43.47 35.38 Underpinning our business model and strategy is our transformation $ per barrel of oil equivalent agenda. In 2019 we had more than 1,000 projects across the Upstream Average oil marker pricese $ per barrel aimed at sustainably improving both performance and ways of working Brent 64.21 71.31 54.19 in the Upstream. Since the inception of our transformation programme in 2016, projects are estimated to have delivered an additional West Texas Intermediate 57.03 65.20 50.79 $1.5 billion of cash flow to the business. Average natural gas marker prices $ per million British thermal units Average Henry Hub gas pricef 2.63 3.09 3.11 In addition to our core upstream exploration, development and production activities, the segment is responsible for the midstream pence per therm transportation, storage and processing that support its operations. We Average UK National Balancing e also market and trade natural gas, including liquefied natural gas (LNG), Point gas price 34.70 60.38 44.95 power and natural gas liquids. In 2019 our activities took place in 34 a Includes sales to other segments. countries. b A reconciliation to GAAP information at the group level is provided on page 299. c Realizations are based on sales by consolidated subsidiaries only, which excludes BPX Energy, our onshore oil and gas business in the US Lower 48 equity-accounted entities. states, continues to operate as a separate, asset-focused, onshore d Includes condensate. business. Integration of the BHP assets acquired in 2018 has gone e All traded days average. well, with realized savings from synergies more than double our f Henry Hub First of Month Index. original target for 2019. We optimize and integrate the delivery of our activities across 12 regions, with support provided by global functions in specialist areas of expertise: technology, finance, procurement and supply chain, human resources, information technology and legal. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 51


 
Market prices Financial results Brent remains an integral marker to the production portfolio, from which Sales and other operating revenues for 2019 decreased compared a significant proportion of production is priced directly or indirectly. with 2018, primarily reflecting lower liquids and gas realizations partially offset by higher production and strong gas marketing and trading revenues. Brent ($/bbl) Replacement cost profit before interest and tax for the segment 120120 included a net non-operating charge of $6,947 million. This primarily relates to impairments arising from disposal transactions. 90 See Financial statements – Note 5 for further information. Fair value accounting effects had a favourable impact of $706 million relative to 60 management’s view of performance. 30 The 2018 result included a net non-operating charge of $183 million, primarily related to impairment charges associated with a number of 0 0 assets, following changes in reserves estimates, the decision to Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec dispose of certain assets and the decision to relinquish a number of 2019 2018 2017 Five-year range leases expiring in the near future, partially offset by reversals of prior year impairment charges. Fair value accounting effects had an adverse Dated Brent prices averaged $64.21 per barrel in 2019 – a 9% decrease impact of $39 million relative to management’s view of performance. from 2018 levels but almost 30% above the 2015-17 average. Prices After adjusting for non-operating items and fair value accounting fluctuated during the year reaching a peak of $71 in April on OPEC+ effects, the underlying replacement cost result before interest and tax supply restraints and the decline in Venezuelan and Iranian output. In was lower in 2019 compared with 2018. This primarily reflected lower the second half of the year, prices fluctuated between $59 in August liquids and gas realizations and higher depreciation, depletion and to $67 in December as OPEC+ restrained supply amid trade tensions. amortization partly offset by strong gas marketing and trading results Global consumption increased by 0.9 million barrels per day (mmb/d) to and higher production. 100.1mmb/d for the year (0.9%) – a slowdown from growth rates seen in the prior two years as trade tensions slowed global macroeconomic Organic capital expenditure was $11.9 billion (2018 $12.0 billion). growth. Global oil production remained flat at 100.5mmb/d, with growth In total, disposal transactions generated $2 billion in proceeds in 2019, from non-OPEC countries offsetting supply restraint and disruptions with a corresponding reduction in net proved reserves of 134mmboe in OPEC countries. The fall in output in Venezuela and Iran due to within our subsidiaries. The major disposal transaction during 2019 was sanctions significantly contributed to the 1.9mmb/d decline in the disposal of our interests in Gulf of Suez oil concessions in Egypt. OPEC output in 2019. At year end, a number of balances associated with assets awaiting the completion of announced disposals were held within the Assets Henry Hub ($/mmBtu) held for sale category in the balance sheet. These related to assets in Alaska and US Lower 48. Impairment charges totalling $6.0 billion were 9 9 recognized in connection with these planned disposals. See Financial statements – Notes 2 and 4 for further information. 6 More information on disposals is provided in Upstream analysis by region on page 303. 3 Outlook for 2020 At the current time the global spread of the coronavirus (COVID-19) 0 0 is causing considerable uncertainty in the market, lowering demand Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec forecasts. This, and the changing dynamic among OPEC+ members, has put downward pressure on prices. Aside from these factors, 2019 2018 2017 Five-year range we had expected price volatility in the near term. Taking these factors into account, we expect the outlook for the year as a whole Henry Hub prices decreased to $2.63/mmBtu in 2019 from to remain challenging. $3.09/mmBtu in 2018 as US associated gas production continued to grow strongly while US gas consumption growth slowed down. The UK National Balancing Point hub price was almost halved from 60.38 pence per therm in 2018, down to 34.70 in 2019, due to a significant increase in European LNG imports and record high storage levels. Asian spot prices declined from $9.76/mmBtu in 2018, down to $5.49/mmBtu on the back of global LNG oversupply, declining LNG demand in Japan and Korea and a slow-down of Chinese LNG imports. 52 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Exploration Proved reserves replacement ratio The group explores for oil and natural gas under a wide range of The proved reserves replacement ratio for the segment in 2019 was licensing, joint arrangement and other contractual agreements. 41% for subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (2018 69%), 25% We may do this alone or, more frequently, with partners. for subsidiaries alone (2018 66%) and 210% for equity-accounted entities alone (2018 106%). For more information on proved reserves Our exploration and new access teams work to find advantaged barrels replacement for the group see page 308. to build our hopper of options for potential future development. That hopper of options gives us the flexibility to grow the cash and value Upstream proved reserves in the Upstream business while increasing the average quality of (mmboe) the portfolio. Liquids In line with our strategy, we are spending less on exploration and we 4,902 Subsidiaries plan to spend a significant part of our exploration budget on lower-risk, 831 Equity-accounted entities shorter-cycle-time opportunities around our incumbent positions. Gas 4,473 Subsidiaries New access in 2019 854 Equity-accounted entities We gained access to new acreage covering around 58,000km2 in nine countries – Argentina, Australia, Brazil, the Gambia, India, Oman, Peru, the UK North Sea and the US Gulf of Mexico. Estimated net proved reservesa (net of royalties) Exploration success 2019 2018 2017 We participated in 10 potentially commercial discoveries in 2019 – King Liquids million barrels Embayment in the US Gulf of Mexico, Bele-1, Tuk-1, Hi-Hat-1, Boom-1 b and Ginger in Trinidad, Nour North Sinai in Egypt, GTA-1 and Yakaar-2 in Crude oil Senegal and Orca-1 in Mauritania. Subsidiaries 4,367 4,378 4,129 Equity-accounted entitiesc 810 794 674 Exploration and appraisal costs 5,177 5,172 4,803 Total exploration and appraisal costs were $1,587 million (2018 $1,478 Natural gas liquids million), of which $302 million (2018 $180 million) related to lease Subsidiaries 535 576 318 acquisition. Equity-accounted entitiesc 21 15 18 These costs included exploration and appraisal activities, which 556 590 336 were capitalized within intangible fixed assets, and geological and Total liquids geophysical exploration costs, which were charged to income Subsidiariesd 4,902 4,954 4,447 as incurred. Equity-accounted entitiesc 831 808 692 Approximately 6% of exploration and appraisal costs were directed 5,733 5,762 5,139 towards appraisal activity. We participated in 47 gross (21.15 net) Natural gas billion cubic feet exploration and appraisal wells in 11 countries. Of these, 11 were lower Subsidiariese 25,946 30,355 29,263 risk wells around incumbent positions. Equity-accounted entitiesc 4,951 4,559 2,274 Exploration expense 30,897 34,914 31,537 Total hydrocarbons million barrels of oil equivalent Total exploration expense of $964 million (2018 $1,445 million, Subsidiariese 9,375 10,188 9,492 2017 $2,080 million) comprised the write-off of expenses related to Equity-accounted entitiesc 1,685 1,594 1,085 unsuccessful drilling activities, lease expiration or uncertainties around development, as well as geological and geophysical exploration costs 11,060 11,782 10,577 (see Financial statements – Note 8). a Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts. Reserves booking b Includes condensate and bitumen. c BP’s share of reserves of equity-accounted entities in the Upstream segment. During 2019 Reserves bookings from new discoveries will depend on the results upstream operations in Argentina, Bolivia, Mexico, Russia and Norway as well as some of of ongoing technical and commercial evaluations, including appraisal our operations in Angola were conducted through equity-accounted entities. d Includes 11 million barrels (12 million barrels at 31 December 2018 and 14 million barrels drilling. The segment’s total hydrocarbon reserves on an oil-equivalent at 31 December 2017) in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad & basis, including the segment’s equity-accounted entities at Tobago LLC. 31 December 2019, decreased by 6% (a decrease of 8% for e Includes 1,330 billion cubic feet of natural gas (1,573 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2018 subsidiaries and an increase of 6% for equity-accounted entities) and 1,860 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2017) in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad & Tobago LLC. compared with proved reserves at 31 December 2018. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 53


 
Developments We achieved five major project start-ups in 2019 – in the US Gulf of Mexico, Egypt, Trinidad and the UK North Sea. The Raven project in Egypt is now expected to come onstream at the end of 2020. In addition to these, we continued to progress all 11 of the remaining projects that we expect will deliver our future production growth target announced in 2016. Highlights from a selection of these are: • India – Work on the KG D6 series of projects continued and the first of the three projects is expected to begin production in 2020. • Mauritania and Senegal – In Phase 1 of the Greater Tortue Ahmeyim project, the first deepwater cross-border LNG project is underway following sanction in early 2019 with a ramp up in engineering, procurement and fabrication activity. • UK North Sea – At Vorlich, two wells were drilled during the year and production is expected to start in 2020. Subsidiaries’ development expenditure incurred, excluding midstream activities, was $10.8 billion (2018 $9.9 billion, 2017 $10.7 billion). Angelin, Trinidad & Tobago Operator: BP Includes a new platform and four Partners: BP (70%) and Repsol (30%) wells, with gas flowing to the Project type: LNG Serrette platform hub via a new Major project start-ups in 2019 13‑mile pipeline. Giza and Fayoum, Egypt Constellation, US Gulf of Mexico Includes a deepwater, long-distance Discovered in 2016, the field has tieback to an existing onshore plant been developed as a subsea tieback and eight wells. to Anadarko’s Constitution spar. Operator: BP Operator: Anadarko Partners: BP (82.75%), DEA Deutsche Partners: Anadarko (33.33%), Erdoel AG (17.25%) BP (66.67%) Project type: Conventional gas Project type: Deepwater oil Culzean, UK North Sea Includes a standalone three-bridge- linked platform development with six production wells. Operator: Total Partners: Total (50%), BP (32%), JX Nippon (18%) Project type: High-pressure gas Alligin, UK North Sea Operator: BP Includes two wells, tied-back into Partners: BP (50%) and Shell (50%) the existing Schiehallion and Loyal Project type: Conventional Oil subsea infrastructure. 54 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Production Gas and power marketing Our offshore and onshore oil and natural gas production assets include and trading activities wells, gathering centres, in-field flow lines, processing facilities, storage facilities, offshore platforms, export systems (e.g. transit lines), Our integrated supply and trading function markets and trades our own pipelines and LNG plant facilities. These include production from and third-party natural gas (including LNG), biogas, power and NGLs. conventional and unconventional assets. This provides us with routes into liquid markets for the gas we produce and generates margins and fees from selling physical products and Our principal areas of production are Angola, Argentina, Australia, derivatives to third parties as well as asset optimization and trading. Azerbaijan, Egypt, Oman, Trinidad, the UAE, the UK and the US. With This means we have a single interface with gas trading markets and BP-operated plant reliability increasing from around 86% in 2011 to 94% a single set of trading compliance and risk management processes, in 2019, efficient delivery of turnarounds and strong infill drilling systems and controls. We are continuing to expand our LNG portfolio, performance, we have maintained base decline to 3-5% on average which includes global partnerships with utility companies, gas over the last five years. Our long-term expectation for managed base distributors and national oil and gas companies. decline remains at 3-5% per guidance we have previously given. This activity primarily takes place in North America, Europe and Asia, a Production (net of royalties) and supports group LNG activities, managing market price risk and 2019 2018 2017 creating incremental trading opportunities through the use of commodity derivative contracts. It also enhances margins and Liquids thousand barrels per day generates fee income from sources such as the management of b Crude oil price risk on behalf of third-party customers. Subsidiaries 1,046 1,051 1,064 Our trading financial risk governance framework is described in Equity-accounted entitiesc 127 121 199 Financial statements – Note 29 and the range of contracts used is 1,173 1,172 1,263 described in Glossary – commodity trading contracts on page 337. Natural gas liquids Subsidiaries 104 88 85 Equity-accounted entitiesc 10 8 8 114 96 93 Total liquids Subsidiaries 1,150 1,139 1,149 Equity-accounted entitiesc 138 129 207 1,288 1,268 1,356 Natural gas million cubic feet per day Subsidiaries 7,366 6,900 5,889 Equity-accounted entitiesc 457 474 547 7,823 7,374 6,436 Total hydrocarbons thousand barrels of oil equivalent per day Subsidiaries 2,420 2,328 2,164 Equity-accounted entitiesc 216 211 302 2,637 2,539 2,466 a Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts. b Includes condensate and bitumen. c Includes BP’s share of the production of equity-accounted entities in the Upstream segment. Our total hydrocarbon production for the segment in 2019 was 3.8% higher compared with 2018. The increase comprised a 3.9% increase (1.0% for liquids and 6.8% for gas) for subsidiaries and a 2.5% increase (6.4% increase for liquids and 3.6% decrease for gas) for equity- accounted entities compared with 2018. For more information on production, see Oil and gas disclosures for the group on page 308. Underlying production was broadly flat compared to 2018. The group and its equity-accounted entities have numerous long-term sales commitments in their various business activities, all of which are expected to be sourced from supplies available to the group that are not subject to priorities, curtailments or other restrictions. No single contract or group of related contracts is material to the group. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 55


 
Downstream The Downstream segment has global marketing and manufacturing operations. It is the product and service-led arm of BP and is made up of three businesses. Business model Fuels Lubricants Petrochemicals Includes refineries, logistic Manufactures and markets Manufactures and markets networks and fuels marketing lubricants and related products products that are produced businesses, which together with and services to the automotive, using industry-leading proprietary global oil supply and trading industrial, marine and energy BP technology, and are then used activities make up our integrated markets globally. We add value by others to make consumer fuels value chains (FVCs). We sell through brand, technology and products such as food packaging, refined petroleum products relationships, such as collaboration textiles and building materials. including gasoline, diesel and with original equipment Through our new BP Infinia aviation fuel, and have a significant manufacturing partners. technology, we are working to Downstream profitability presence in the convenience retail reduce plastic waste, helping ($ billion) sector. We also have a growing to enable a stronger circular presence in electric vehicle economy. 6.5 charging with a focused strategy to 2019 6.4 build the fastest, most convenient networks for our customers. 6.9 2018 7.6 Performance in 2019 7.2 2017 7.0 $2.7bn ~1,600 49% 5.2 2016 fuels marketing earnings convenience of lubricant sales 5.6 +2.5% vs 2018 partnership sites were premium grade 7.1 (2018 $2.6bn) (2018 ~1,400) (2018 46%) 2015 7.5 RC profit before interest and tax 94.9% 1.7 12.1 Underlying RC profit before interest and tax★ refining availability million barrels of oil million tonnes of (2018 95.0%) refined per day petrochemicals produced (2018 1.7mmb/d) (2018 11.9mmte) Strategy We aim to run safe and reliable Safe and reliable operations potential, making the businesses This describes our strategy and operations across all our This remains our core value and more resilient to margin volatility. organizational model in 2019. businesses, supported by leading first priority and we continue to Simplification and efficiency Following BP’s new ambition brands and technologies, to drive improvements in personal This remains central to what and aims set out in February deliver high-quality products and and process safety performance. we do to support performance 2020, we are transforming our services that meet our customers’ Profitable marketing growth improvement and make our business. We plan to provide needs. Our strategy is to deliver We invest in higher-returning businesses even more underlying earnings growth and more information on our future fuels marketing and lubricants competitive. build resilient, competitively strategy and near-term plans businesses with growth potential advantaged businesses, and we Transition to a lower carbon at our capital markets day in and reliable cash flows. are working at pace to create low September 2020. and digitally enabled future carbon businesses that can Advantaged manufacturing We are delivering and developing advance the energy transition. We aim to have a competitively new products, offers and business advantaged refining and models that support the transition The execution of our strategy in petrochemicals portfolio to a lower carbon and digitally 2019 has continued to deliver, underpinned by operational enabled future. with underlying replacement cost excellence and to grow earnings profit of $6.4 billion in the year. 56 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Financial performance $ million 2019 2018 2017 Sale of crude oil through spot 59,738 62,484 47,702 and term contracts Marketing, spot and term sales 180,236 195,020 159,475 of refined products Other sales and operating revenues 10,923 13,185 12,676 Sales and operating revenuesa 250,897 270,689 219,853 RC profit before interest and taxb Fuels 4,791 5,261 4,679 Lubricants 1,315 1,065 1,457 Petrochemicals 396 614 1,085 Energy with purpose 6,502 6,940 7,221 Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items and fair value Making more plastics recyclable accounting effects Fuels (32) 381 193 Thinking beyond business as usual, Companies joining the consortium: we’re using our know-how to explore • Packaging and recycling specialist Lubricants (57) 227 22 a breakthrough technology for ALPLA. Petrochemicals 6 13 (469) recycling opaque and difficult-to- • Food, drink and consumer goods (83) 621 (254) recycle PET plastic waste – familiar producers Britvic, Danone and to consumers as coloured bottles and Unilever. Underlying RC profit before b food trays. Our enhanced recycling • Waste management and recycling interest and tax technology, BP Infinia, enables specialist REMONDIS. Fuels 4,759 5,642 4,872 PET to be diverted from landfill or Lubricants 1,258 1,292 1,479 incineration and transformed into Petrochemicals 402 627 616 virgin-quality feedstocks. 6,419 7,561 6,967 We plan to build a $25 million Organic capital expenditurec 2,997 2,781 2,399 pilot plant in the US to prove the technology, which is expected to be operational in late 2020. And a Includes sales to other segments. we’ve now joined forces with b Income from petrochemicals produced at our Gelsenkirchen and Mülheim sites in Germany leading businesses across the is reported in the fuels business. Segment-level overhead expenses are included in the fuels business result. PET packaging value chain to help c A reconciliation to GAAP information at the group level is provided on page 299. accelerate commercialization of the technology. Financial results We believe BP Infinia has the potential to be a game-changer and important Sales and other operating revenues in 2019 were lower than in 2018, stepping stone in enabling a stronger mainly due to lower crude and product prices. circular economy and helping to reduce Replacement cost (RC) profit before interest and tax for 2019 included unmanaged plastic waste. a net non-operating charge of $77 million, which includes environmental provisions. The 2018 result included a net non-operating charge of $716 million, primarily reflecting restructuring costs. In addition, fair value accounting effects had a favourable impact of $160 million, compared with a favourable impact of $95 million in 2018. After adjusting for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, underlying RC profit before interest and tax in 2019 was $6,419 million. Outlook for 2020 The coronavirus (COVID-19) has already had significant impact on margins and activity at the start of the year. We expect this uncertainty to continue and anticipate lower industry refining margins during 2020. We also anticipate wider North American heavy crude oil discounts and a lower level of turnaround activity than in 2019. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 57


 
Our fuels business BP refining marker margin ($/bbl) Our fuels strategy focuses primarily on fuels value chains (FVCs). This includes an advantaged refining portfolio through operating reliability 32 and efficiency, location advantage and feedstock flexibility, as well as 24 commercial optimization opportunities. We believe that having a quality refining portfolio connected to strong marketing positions is core to our 16 integrated FVC businesses as this provides optimization opportunities in highly competitive markets. 8 Our fuels marketing business comprises retail, business-to-business 0 and aviation fuels. It is a material part of Downstream with a strong Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec track record of growth. We have an advantaged portfolio of assets 2019 2018 2017 Five-year range with good growth potential, attractive returns and reliable cash flows. We continue to grow our fuels marketing business through our differentiated marketing offers and strategic convenience partnerships. Refining We also partner with leading retailers, creating distinctive retail At 31 December 2019 we owned or had a share in 10 refineriesab offers that aim to deliver good returns and reliable profit growth producing refined petroleum products that we supply to retail and and cash generation. commercial customers. For a summary of our interests in refineries We have also grown our presence in electric vehicle charging in recent and average daily crude distillation capacities see page 307. years, with a focus on the key markets of China, UK and Germany, Underlying growth in our refining business is underpinned by our where we aim to build the fastest, most convenient networks for multi-year business improvement plans, which comprise globally electric vehicle customers. consistent programmes focused on operating reliability and efficiency, Underlying RC profit before interest and tax for our fuels business advantaged feedstocks and commercial optimization. Operating was lower compared with 2018, with strong refining operational reliability is a core foundation of our refining business and in 2019 performance, which led to a second consecutive year of record refining operations remained strong, with refining availability at BP-operated throughput and higher commercial optimization, despite high levels refineries of 94.9% (2018 95%) and refinery utilization rates across of turnaround activity. This was more than offset, however, by lower our refining portfolio at 91% (2018 91%). As a result, we achieved refining margins, including significantly narrower heavy crude oil record levels of refining throughput for a second consecutive year, discounts, which together represented one of the weakest refining despite high levels of turnaround activity. environments across our portfolio in the last 10 years. In fuels marketing Our refinery portfolio – along with our supply capability – enables us to we saw volumes and margins grow year on year, offset by adverse process advantaged crudes. For example, in the US, our three refineries foreign exchange effects. The full year result also reflects a higher all have location-advantaged access to Canadian crudes which are contribution from supply and trading. typically cheaper than other crudes. Our commercial optimization  programme aims to maximize value from our refineries by capturing Refining marker margin opportunities in every step of the value chain, from crude selection We track the refining margin environment using a global refining through to yield optimization and utilization improvements. marker margin (RMM). Refining margins are a measure of the difference During 2019 we also continued to scale up co-processing at our between the price a refinery pays for its inputs (crude oil) and the refineries, growing the volume of lower carbon bio-feedstock market price of its products. Although refineries produce a variety of processed. petroleum products, we track the margin environment using a simplified indicator that reflects the margins achieved on gasoline and diesel only. The refining result was lower in 2019 compared with 2018, with strong The RMM may not be representative of the margin achieved by BP in operational performance and higher commercial optimization, which any period because of BP’s particular refinery configurations and crude was more than offset by a significantly weaker refining environment, and product slates. In addition, the RMM does not include estimates of primarily driven by narrower heavy crude oil discounts. energy or other variable costs. thousand barrels per day $ per barrel 2019 2018 2017 Region Crude marker 2019 2018 2017 Refinery throughputsac US North West Alaska 17.6 16.2 18.8 US 737 703 713 North Slope Europe 787 781 773 US Mid West West Texas 16.0 16.0 16.9 Rest of the world 225 241 216 Intermediate Total 1,749 1,725 1,702 Northwest Brent 11.1 11.1 11.7 % Europe Refining availability 94.9 95.0 95.2 Mediterranean Azeri Light 9.1 9.8 10.4 Australia Brent 11.1 11.5 12.9 a This does not include BP’s interest in Pan American Energy Group. BP RMM 13.2 13.1 14.1 b On 31 December we completed the sale of our interest in the German Bayernoil refinery. c Refinery throughputs reflect crude oil and other feedstock volumes. The global RMM averaged $13.2/bbl in 2019, similar to the level in 2018 ($13.1/bbl), with weaker demand balanced by reduced supply due to an increased level of refinery maintenance over the year. In addition refining margins across our portfolio were significantly impacted by other crude and product differentials outside of the global RMM, primarily due to narrower heavy crude oil discounts. 58 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Fuels marketing and logistics US, while expanding into major growth markets that offer long-term competitive advantages, such as Asia, Africa and Latin America. Across our fuels marketing businesses, we operate an advantaged infrastructure and logistics network that includes pipelines, storage In 2019 we continued to develop new offers and solutions to advance terminals and tankers for road and rail. We seek to drive excellence the energy transition and to meet the changing needs of our customers. in operational and transactional processes and deliver compelling Through our collaboration with Neste, a leading producer of renewable customer offers in the various markets where we operate. Through products, we began supplying aviation fuel made from sustainable materials our retail business, we supply fuel and convenience retail services to to a number of airports in Sweden. We also expanded our partnership with consumers through company-owned and franchised retail sites, as China National Aviation Fuel Group, signing a joint venture agreement to well as other channels, including dealers and jobbers. We also supply operate a general aviation fuel and services business in southwest China. commercial customers in the transport and industrial sectors. The joint venture intends to support the growth and development of China’s general aviation sector. Retail is the most material part of our fuels marketing business and a significant source of earnings growth through our strong market Oil supply and trading positions, brands and distinctive customer offers. This is underpinned by the strength of our retail convenience partnerships, technology such Our integrated supply and trading function is responsible for delivering as our advanced fuels and use of digital technology, as well as our value across our crude and oil products supply chain. This enables our customer relationships. This differentiation enables our growth in downstream businesses to maintain a single interface with oil trading existing markets and supports our growth plans in new material markets and operate with a single set of trading compliance and risk markets such as Mexico, India, Indonesia and China. management processes, systems and controls. It principally achieves this objective in two ways: During 2019 we continued to expand our convenience partnership model, which is now in around 1,600 sites across our network, First, it seeks to identify the best markets and prices for our crude oil, including our differentiated REWE to Go® offer, now in around 550 sites source optimal raw materials for our refineries and provide competitive across Germany. supply for our marketing businesses. We will often sell our own crude and purchase alternative crudes from third parties for our refineries We also made significant progress towards our growth ambition in new where this will generate incremental margin. markets, most notably in Mexico where we now have more than 520 BP-branded retail sites, with volumes more than doubling in 2019, and Second, it aims to create and capture trading opportunities by entering in December we signed an agreement with Reliance Industries Limited into a full range of exchange-traded commodity derivatives and to form a fuels retail and aviation joint venture across India, providing over-the-counter spot and term contracts. In combination with its rights to access to one of the world’s largest and fastest growing fuels markets. access storage and transportation capacity, it also seeks to access advantageous price differences between locations, time periods, and We have a clear strategy and focused activity set for the transition to a markets. lower carbon and digitally enabled future. We are actively implementing and developing new offers and business models centred around digital The function has trading offices in Europe, North America and Asia. Our and advanced mobility trends. presence in the more actively traded regions of the global oil markets supports the overall understanding of the supply and demand forces In 2019 we signed an agreement with DiDi, the world’s leading mobile across these markets. transportation platform, to build an electric vehicle charging network in China, the world’s largest market for electric vehicles. In addition, in the Our trading financial risk governance framework is described in UK, BP Chargemaster began installing 150kW ultra-fast electric vehicle Financial statements – Note 29 and the range of contracts used is chargers at our BP retail sites, with plans to build a national network of described in Glossary – commodity trading contracts on page 337. high-power charging – one which will closely replicate the current thousand barrels per day fuelling experience. These advances support BP’s strategy to create the Sales volume 2019 2018 2017 fastest and most convenient electrification networks in these markets. Marketing salesa 2,727 2,736 2,799 BPme is our global customer engagement platform, which is also fast Trading/supply salesb 3,268 3,194 3,149 becoming the portal to a suite of offers and services that will transform Total refined product sales 5,995 5,930 5,948 our retail offer and deliver an enhanced and personalized customer Crude oilc 2,713 2,624 2,616 experience. The platform provides an easy, fast and convenient way for Total 8,708 8,554 8,564 customers to pay for fuel from their car, and for customers in the UK, Australia and the US, it also incorporates our new loyalty programme a Marketing sales include branded and unbranded sales of refined fuel products and lubricants BPme Rewards. to business-to-business and business-to-consumer customers, including service station dealers, jobbers, airlines, small and large resellers such as hypermarkets, and the military. Fuels marketing earnings in 2019 were similar to 2018, with volume b Trading/supply sales are fuel sales to large unbranded resellers and other oil companies. and margin growth offset by adverse foreign exchange effects. c Crude oil sales relate to transactions executed by our integrated supply and trading function, primarily for optimizing crude oil supplies to our refineries and in other trading. 2019 includes Aviation 118 thousand barrels per day relating to revenues reported by the Upstream segment. Our Air BP business is one of the world’s largest suppliers of aviation fuels Number of BP-branded retail sites and services, selling fuel to commercial airlines, the military and general Retail sitesd 2019 2018 2017 aviation customers. Air BP supplies around 6.6 billion gallons of aviation US 7,200 7,200 7,200 fuel a year at over 800 locations in more than 55 countries. Air BP’s Europe 8,200 8,200 8,100 services include the design, build and operation of fuelling facilities, technical consultancy and training, supporting customers to meet their Rest of world 3,500 3,300 3,000 lower carbon goals and digital fuelling solutions to increase efficiency and Total 18,900 18,700 18,300 reduce risk. Our Air BP business is differentiated through its strong market positions, brand strength, partnerships, technology and customer d Reported to the nearest 100. Includes sites not operated by BP but instead operated by dealers, relationships. Our strategy is to maintain a strong presence in our core jobbers, franchisees or brand licensees under a BP brand. These may move to or from the BP brand as their fuel supply or brand licence agreements expire and are renegotiated in the normal geographies of Australia, New Zealand, Europe, the Middle East and the course of business. Retail sites are primarily branded BP, ARCO, Amoco and Aral. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 59


 
Our lubricants business Our petrochemicals business We manufacture and market lubricants and related products and Our petrochemicals business manufactures and markets three main services to the automotive, industrial, marine and energy markets product lines: purified terephthalic acid (PTA), paraxylene (PX) and across the world. Our key brands are Castrol, BP and Aral. Castrol is a acetic acid. These have a large range of uses including polyester fibre, recognized brand worldwide that we believe provides us with significant food packaging and building materials. We also produce a number of competitive advantage. We are one of the largest purchasers of base other specialty petrochemicals products. In addition, we manufacture oil in the market but have chosen not to produce it or manufacture olefins and derivatives at Gelsenkirchen and solvents at Mülheim in additives at scale. Our participation choices in the value chain are Germany, the income from which is reported in our fuels business. focused on areas where we can leverage competitive differentiation and strength. Along with the assets we own and operate, we have also invested in a number of joint arrangements in Asia, where our partners are leading Our strategy is to focus on our premium lubricants and growth companies in their domestic market. markets while leveraging our strong brands, technology and customer relationships – all of which are sources of differentiation for our Our strategy is to grow our underlying earnings and ensure the business business. With 65% of profit generated from growth markets and is resilient to margin volatility, positioning ourselves to capture growth 49% of our sales from premium grade lubricants, we have a strong and investment opportunities in an attractive and growing market. base for further expansion and sustained profit growth. We do this through the execution of our business improvement In 2019 we strengthened our strategic relationship with Groupe programmes which include operational efficiency, deploying our Renault, extending the Renault Sport Racing Formula 1 sponsorship industry-leading proprietary technology, commercial optimization and through to the end of 2024 and taking over as global service fill engine competitive feedstock sourcing. We have also grown our third-party oil lubricants partner. We also announced a partnership with Bosch to technology licensing income to create additional value. run jointly branded workshops in China and the US. We aim to create material, industry leading business models in We have a robust pipeline of technology development through which sustainable chemicals and plastics circularity and in 2019 we announced we seek to respond to engine developments and evolving consumer the development of BP Infinia, an enhanced recycling technology, needs and preferences, including lower carbon options. We apply capable of processing currently unrecyclable PET plastic waste. We also our expertise to create differentiated, premium lubricants and high- formed a consortium with a number of leading companies operating performance fluids for customers in on-road, off-road, sea and industrial across the polyester packaging value chain which aims to accelerate the applications. commercialization of BP Infinia technology and to develop a new circular approach to dealing with PET plastic waste. In 2020 BP plans to build a With the onset of electrification, demand for EV-fluids is expected to pilot plant in the US to prove the technology, before progressing to grow. These include transmission fluids, battery coolants and greases. full-scale commercialization. We believe these are important steps in Castrol is investing in and partnering with original equipment enabling a stronger circular economy in the PET plastics industry, manufacturers (OEMs) to develop advantaged EV-fluid technologies, underpinned by our advantaged technology and strategic partnerships. and in 2019 we announced a new partnership with the Panasonic Jaguar Racing Formula E Team for season 2019/20. Using Castrol’s In addition, we signed an agreement with Virent and Johnson Matthey EV-fluids allows Jaguar and Castrol to collaborate and further develop to further advance the development of bio-paraxylene, a key raw advanced technology and EV-fluids for both race and road cars material for the production of renewable polyester. of the future. As part of our growth agenda we expanded capacity at our joint venture The lubricants business delivered an underlying RC profit before interest acetyls site in South Korea and signed an agreement with Zhejiang and tax that was similar to 2018, reflecting year-on-year unit margin Petroleum and Chemical Corporation (ZPCC) to explore the creation of a improvement, offset by adverse foreign exchange rate movements. new, world-scale joint venture to build and operate a 1 million tonne per annum acetic acid plant in Zhejiang Province, China. In December 2018 we signed a heads of agreement with SOCAR to evaluate the creation of a joint venture to build and operate a world- scale petrochemicals complex in Turkey. This advantaged facility would be the largest integrated aromatics and PTA complex in the western hemisphere. Significant progress has been made in defining the project with a final investment decision expected towards the end of 2020. In 2019 the petrochemicals business delivered an underlying RC profit before interest and tax that was lower compared with 2018, reflecting a significantly weaker margin environment across both aromatics and acetyls. Our petrochemicals production of 12.1 million tonnes in 2019 was higher than in 2018 (2018 11.9mmte). 60 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Rosneft Rosneft is the largest oil company in Russia, with a strong portfolio of current and future opportunities. Russia has one of the largest and lowest-cost hydrocarbon resource bases in the world and its resources play an important role in long-term energy supply to the global economy. Rosneft shareholding About Rosneft Rosneft is the largest oil company Rosneft is the leading Russian Rosneft’s largest shareholder in Russia and one of the largest refining company based on with 50% plus one share publicly traded oil companies in throughput. It owns and operates is Rosneftegaz JSC the world based on hydrocarbon 13 refineries in Russia, and holds (Rosneftegaz), which is production volume. Rosneft stakes in three refineries in wholly owned by the has a major resource base of Germany, one in India and Russian government. hydrocarbons onshore and one in Belarus. BP has a 19.75% shareholding offshore, with assets in all of Downstream operations include and two directors on the a Russia’s key hydrocarbon ROSNEFTEGAZ JSC 50.00% jet fuel, bunkering, bitumen and 11-person board. regions and abroad. BP 19.75% lubricants. Rosneft also owns and Bob Dudley and Guillermo QH Oil operates Rosneft-branded retail Investments LLC 18.93% Quintero are currently elected service stations, as well as to those roles. Others 11.32% BP-branded sites operating a 50% plus one share. under a licensing agreement. 2019 summary • BP received $785 million, net of withholding taxes, (2018 $620 million), representing its share of BP share of Rosneft dividend Rosneft’s dividends. This dividend represents 50% of IFRS net profit, and is paid twice a year in line ($ millions)b with the dividend policy adopted in 2017. • BP remains committed to our strategic investment in Rosneft, while complying with all relevant sanctions. 2019 451 334 785 2018 420 200 620 2017 124 190 314 8,281 18 19.75% 2016 332 million barrels of oil equivalent refineries – owned BP’s shareholding in Rosneft – BP share of Rosneft or hold a stake in 2015 271 proved reserves (2018 18) Interim (2018 8,163mmboe) Annual for previous year, less interim b Net of withholding taxes. 1.1 2.24 >3,000 million barrels of oil equivalent million barrels of oil retail service stations per day – BP share of Rosneft refined per day in Russia and abroad hydrocarbon production (2018 2.33mmb/d) (2018 >2,960) (2018 1.1mmboe/d) BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 61


 
Co-operation with Rosneft $ million Our strategy is to work in co-operation with Rosneft to increase total 2019 2018 2017 shareholder return. We also partner with Rosneft in building a material Profit before interest and taxa b 2,306 2,288 923 business in addition to our shareholding. Inventory holding (gains) losses 10 (67) (87) Joint ventures RC profit before interest and tax 2,316 2,221 836 BP partners with Rosneft to generate incremental value from joint Net charge (credit) for non-operating items 103 95 – ventures and associates that are separate from BP’s core 19.75% Underlying RC profit before interest and tax 2,419 2,316 836 shareholding. Average oil marker prices $ per barrel • BP holds a 49% interest in Kharampurneftegaz LLC (Kharampur), Urals (Northwest Europe – CIF) 62.96 69.89 52.84 together with Rosneft (51%), which develops resources within the Kharampurskoe and Festivalnoye licence areas in Yamalo-Nenets a BP’s share of Rosneft’s earnings after finance costs, taxation and non-controlling interests in northern Russia. BP’s interest is reported through the is included in the BP group income statement within profit before interest and taxation. Upstream segment. b Includes $(11) million (2018 $(5) million, 2017 $(2) million) of foreign exchange (gain)/losses arising on the dividend received. • BP holds a 20% interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha (Taas), together with Rosneft (50.1%) and a consortium comprising Oil India Market price Limited, Indian Oil Corporation Limited and Bharat PetroResources The price of Urals delivered in North West Europe (Rotterdam) averaged Limited (29.9%). In 2019 BP received dividends from Taas of $62.96/bbl in 2019. The discount to dated Brent was $1.25/bbl in line $157 million, net of withholding taxes (2018 $48 million). BP’s with 2018 ($1.42/bbl). interest in Taas is reported through the Upstream segment. Financial results • Rosneft (51%) and BP (49%) jointly own Yermak Neftegaz LLC Replacement cost (RC) profit before interest and tax for the segment (Yermak). The joint venture conducts onshore exploration in the included a non-operating charge of $103 million for 2019 and $95 million West Siberian and Yenisei-Khatanga basins. In April the right to for 2018. explore two additional oil and gas licence areas located in Sakha (Yakutia) was transferred to a wholly owned subsidiary of Yermak. After adjusting for non-operating items, the increase in the underlying BP’s interest in Yermak is reported through the Upstream segment. RC profit before interest and tax compared with 2018 primarily reflected • Rosneft and BP are in the process of creating a joint venture favourable foreign exchange and certain one-off items offset by lower investment fund (VIF). This supports BP and Rosneft’s agenda to oil prices. See also Financial statements – Notes 17 and 32 for other accelerate new innovations in the oil and gas industry. foreign exchange effects. Collaboration Balance sheet BP collaborates on the provision of technical, HSE and non-technical $ million services on a contractual basis to improve functional asset performance. As at 31 December 2019 2018 2017 BP and Rosneft have developed an innovative cable-less onshore Investments in associatesc 12,927 10,074 10,059 seismic acquisition system and are in discussions about further collaboration. Production and reserves Social projects 2019 2018 2017 BP together with Rosneft sponsor the Petroleum Engineering Masters Production (net of royalties) (BP share) degree programme led by the Kazan Federal University (Russia) and Liquids (mb/d) Imperial College London (UK), providing financial support, mentoring Crude oild 920 919 900 and lecturing for the students. Natural gas liquids 3 4 4 Also, with Rosneft, BP sponsors the Britten-Shostakovich Festival Total liquids 923 923 904 Orchestra which brings together the finest young talents from British Natural gas (mmcf/d) 1,279 1,285 1,308 and Russian music schools, with an average age of 22. Performances in 2019 took place in both the UK and Russia. Total hydrocarbons (mboe/d) 1,144 1,144 1,129 Estimated net proved reserves Rosneft segment performance (net of royalties) (BP share) Liquids (million barrels) BP’s investment in Rosneft is managed and reported as a separate Crude oild 5,604 5,539 5,402 segment under IFRS. The segment result includes equity-accounted earnings, representing BP’s 19.75% share of the profit or loss of Natural gas liquids 141 154 131 Rosneft, as adjusted for the accounting required under IFRS relating Total liquidse 5,745 5,693 5,533 to BP’s purchase of its interest in Rosneft and the amortization of Natural gas (billion cubic feet)f 14,705 14,325 13,522 the deferred gain relating to the disposal of BP’s interest in TNK-BP. Total hydrocarbons (mmboe) 8,281 8,163 7,864 See Financial statements – Note 17 for further information. c See Financial statements – Note 17 for further information. d Includes condensate. e Includes 357mmb (356mmb at 31 December 2018; 338mmb at 31 December 2017) for the 6.21% non-controlling interest (6.32% at 31 December 2018; 6.31% at 31 December 2017) in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 26 million barrels (24mmb at 31 December 2018; 6mmb at 31 December 2017) held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft. f Includes 1,430bcf (1,211bcf at 31 December 2018; 306bcf at 31 December 2017) for the 9.72% non-controlling interest (8.60% at 31 December 2018; 2.30% at 31 December 2017) in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 569bcf (480bcf at 31 December 2018; 2bcf at 31 December 2017) held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft. 62 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Other businesses and corporate Currently comprises our Alternative Energy business, shipping, treasury, BP Ventures and corporate activities, including centralized functions and any residual costs of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Alternative Energy Financial performance $ million 2019 2018 2017 Sales and other operating revenuesa 1,788 1,678 1,469 BP Ventures RC profit (loss) before interest and tax Gulf of Mexico oil spill (319) (714) (2,687) Other (2,452) (2,807) (1,758) RC profit (loss) before interest and tax (2,771) (3,521) (4,445) Shipping Net adverse impact of non-operating items Gulf of Mexico oil spill 319 714 2,687 Other 1,172 1,249 160 Net charge (credit) for non-operating items 1,491 1,963 2,847 Underlying RC profit (loss) before interest and tax (1,280) (1,558) (1,598) Treasury Organic capital expenditureb 337 332 339 a Includes sales to other segments. b A reconciliation to GAAP information at the group level is provided on page 299. Insurance The replacement cost (RC) loss before interest Alternative Energy and tax for the year ended 31 December 2019 was $2,771 million (2018 $3,521 million). The Renewables are the fastest-growing energy 2019 result included a net charge for non- source, potentially contributing half of the operating items of $1,491 million, primarily growth in global energy, with its share in relating to the reclassification of $877 million primary energy increasing from 4% in 2019 of accumulated foreign exchange losses from to around 15% by 2040a. reserves to the income statement, which In BP, we have an established and growing arose as a result of the contribution of our alternative energy business, with a significant Brazilian biofuels business to BP Bunge portfolio across renewable fuels, power Bioenergia, as well as Gulf of Mexico oil spill and products. And we are developing new related costs of $319 million (non-operating business models in areas such as low carbon items in 2018 $1,963 million). power and digital energy. After adjusting for these non-operating items, a BP Energy Outlook 2019: ‘evolving transition’ scenario. the underlying RC loss before interest and tax for the year ended 31 December 2019 was $1,280 million (2018 $1,558 million). This Our ‘reduce, improve, create’ framework result mainly reflected improved shipping We have set targets and aims to reduce performance. emissions in our operations, improve our products to help customers reduce Outlook their emissions and create low carbon businesses – see page 41. Other businesses and corporate annual charges, excluding non-operating items, are expected to be around $1.4 billion in 2020. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 63


 
Our Alternative Energy portfolio We formed BP Bunge Bioenergia, a joint venture that We increased our stake in Lightsource BP to combines BP and Bunge’s Brazilian bioenergy and become a 50:50 joint venture. Lightsource BP aims Biofuels sugarcane ethanol businesses. The venture operates Solar to develop 10GW of solar projects by 2023, see 11 biofuels sites and has a production capacity of energy page 73 for more information. 32 million metric tonnes of sugarcane a year (see Going big in biofuels). BP Bunge Bioenergia produces renewable energy Butamax® our 50:50 joint venture with DuPont from its biofuels manufacturing sites. The joint produces bio-isobutanol from corn. The energy-rich Biopower venture is capable of exporting 1,200GW hours of Renewable bioproduct has a variety of uses, such as in paints biopower to the national grid. products and lubricants. We operate nine sites in six US states and hold an We are developing a number of digital platforms to interest in another facility in Hawaii. Together they connect consumers with local, low carbon electricity Wind have a net generating capacity of 926MW. Low carbon to power their homes and transport, and are energy power and exploring opportunities to create value at the digital energy interplay between gas and renewable energy. Energy with purpose Investing in energy management To help grow our digital energy portfolio, we have invested in Grid Edge, an energy management company. Its technology helps customers predict, control and optimize a building’s energy profile. • Grid Edge can help customers lower carbon emissions by 10-15% on average. The cloud-based software can anticipate a building’s energy demand using data such as weather forecasts and expected occupancy. • This allows building managers to adapt energy use and take advantage of periods of high renewable power generation. • Customers can also use the building’s flexibility in energy demand and generation like a giant battery. “This investment is Going big in biofuels Brazil is the world’s second-largest “With a shared market for ethanol as a transportation in support of our BP has formed a 50:50 joint commitment to safety fuel, with around 75% of the country’s venture in Brazil with leading strategy to create vehicles able to run on it. and sustainability, agri-commodities company Bunge an ecosystem of Limited. The deal expands our • Demand for ethanol is growing bringing together our distinctive, digitally existing biofuels business by more rapidly in the country. In 2019 assets and expertise enabled, low carbon than 50%. demand increased 10% versus allows us to improve 2018 and is set to increase up to • BP Bunge Bioenergia is now businesses for 55% by 2030. performance, develop the second-largest operator by commercial and effective crushing capacity in the options for growth and industrial customers.” country’s bioethanol market. generate real value.” Nick Wayth Dev Sanyal Chief development officer, Chief executive, Alternative Energy Alternative Energy 64 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report BP Ventures The energy transition is driving the need for rapid change in technology and ways of working, and the imperative for innovation has never been more urgent. Venturing plays a key role in BP, helping meet the world’s need for more energy, while at the same time reducing carbon emissions. We aim to do this by leveraging our investments across a portfolio of relevant technology businesses that can help BP transition to a lower carbon economy. BP Ventures is set up to grow new energy businesses in the Upstream, Downstream, Alternative Energy and in five areas: advanced mobility, power and storage, carbon management, bio and low carbon products, and digital transformation. We have invested over $650 million dollars Energy with purpose BP invests in forest since 2007 in more than 40 companies with technologies and carbon offsets leader innovations that we believe will materially impact BP and global BP Ventures’ investment in Finite energy systems. Resources is helping to grow its We invested $30 million into Calysta in 2019. This alternative protein business, supporting sustainable producer uses natural gas to produce protein for fish, livestock and pet forest management practices. feeds, see page 28. We also invested a further $30 million into Fulcrum The funding will help Finite Carbon, Bioenergy®, a pioneer in making low carbon, low-cost, transportation “The conservation and a subsidiary of Finite Resources, fuels from one of the most abundant resources – household garbage. scale up its voluntary carbon offsets And we made two investments in energy management companies – restoration of forests programme for businesses. Grid Edge and R&B – totalling $5.4 million. is vital to combatting The programme aims to connect climate change. We look landowners to businesses that want BP Launchpad to purchase forest carbon offsets, with forward to supporting corporations paying a fee per tonne of BP’s scale-up factory, BP Launchpad, became fully operational in 2019. the team’s expansion carbon stored in the forest. The initiative aims to quickly create multiple businesses valued over into the voluntary $1 billion that can help tackle the dual energy challenge. Launchpad is This investment is part of our aim to support the technologies and focused on building world-scale businesses that specialize in digital and carbon market.” innovations we believe will benefit BP low carbon technologies and the circular economy, with potential for and global energy systems during the these businesses to become future BP business units. Nacho Gimenez Managing director, transition to a low carbon economy. Examples of growth businesses in the Launchpad portfolio: BP Ventures • Lytt: a subsurface analytics business, providing fibre optic development, deployment and operational services, including acoustic and temperature sensing. • STRYDE: a land seismic receiver technology business. STRYDE’s technology breaks the cost/time trade-off to generate high-quality Treasury seismic images of the subsurface. • Fotech: a technology company focused on developing and deploying Treasury manages the financing of the group centrally, with advanced fibre optic sensing hardware. Launchpad acquired Fotech in responsibility for managing the group’s debt profile, share buyback late 2019; BP Ventures has been a minority investor since 2013. programmes and dividend payments, while seeking to ensure that liquidity is sufficient to meet group requirements. It also manages key financial risks including interest rate, foreign exchange, pension funding and investment, and financial institution credit risk. From locations in Shipping the UK, US and Singapore, treasury provides the interface between BP and the international financial markets and supports the financing of BP’s shipping and chartering activities help to ensure the safe and efficient BP’s projects around the world. Treasury holds foreign exchange and transportation of our hydrocarbons using a combination of BP-operated, interest rate products in the financial markets to hedge group time-chartered and spot-chartered vessels. At 31 December 2019, BP had exposures. In addition, treasury generates incremental value through 35 BP-operated and 40 time-chartered vessels for our international oil and optimizing and managing cash flows and the short-term investment of LNG shipping operations. All vessels conducting BP shipping activities are operational cash balances. For more information, see Financial required to meet BP approved standards. statements – Note 29. Insurance The group generally restricts its purchase of insurance to situations where this is required for legal or contractual reasons. Some risks are insured with third parties and reinsured by group insurance companies. This approach is reviewed on a regular basis or if specific circumstances require such a review. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 65


 
Section 172 statement How the board complied with its Section 172 duty. 3. Monitoring decisions and actions of the CEO and the performance of BP: including implementation of, and performance The board welcomes the new reporting requirement as an opportunity against, the strategy and the plan; and the exercise of authority to explain how dialogue with stakeholders has informed and helped to delegated to the CEO. The board satisfies itself that emerging and shape its decisions. For example the board’s engagement with Climate principal risks to BP are identified and understood, systems of risk Action 100+ in the lead up to the 2019 AGM. management, compliance and controls are in place to mitigate such Following the announcement of Bernard Looney’s appointment as chief risks and expected conduct of BP’s business and its employees is executive officer (CEO) in October 2019, the board engaged with Bernard reflected in a set of values established by the CEO. and the leadership team to develop the company’s new purpose, net 4. Succession: ensuring systems and processes are in place for  zero ambition and aims. This was supported by extensive dialogue with succession, evaluation and compensation of the CEO, executive and investors, governments, employees and other stakeholders. non-executive directors and key members of senior management. Through working collaboratively with management and listening to Those delegated to by the directors to take decisions have access to feedback from the company’s many stakeholders, the board believes functional assurance support to identify matters which may have an that BP is well positioned to respond to increasing uncertainty. We are impact on a proposed decision. embarking on a period of change to deliver on our purpose to reimagine energy for people and our planet, while reinventing BP so that we can succeed over the long term. This means continuing to deliver our The Companies Act 2006 (CA2006) sets out a number of general investor proposition, while responding to society’s expectations. duties which directors owe to the company. New legislation has Delegation of authority been introduced to help shareholders better understand how directors have discharged their duty to promote the success of The board believes governance of BP is best achieved by delegation the company, while having regard to the matters set out in section of its authority for the executive management of BP to the CEO, subject 172(1)(a) to (f) of the CA2006 (s172 factors). In 2019 the directors to defined limits and monitoring by the board. The board routinely continued to exercise all their duties, while having regard to these monitors the delegation of authority, ensuring that it is regularly and other factors as they reviewed and considered proposals from updated, while retaining ultimate responsibility. senior management and governed the company on behalf of its The board has adopted a long-standing corporate governance shareholders through the BP board. framework, which includes principles outlining: • The board’s relationship with shareholders and executive management. Further information as to how the board has had regard to the s172 factors: • The conduct of board affairs and the tasks and requirements for board committees. Section 172 factor Key examples Page • The board’s focus on activities that enable it to promote shareholders’ Consequence of any New ambition and purpose 6 interests, including development of strategy, monitoring of executive decision in the long term Investment process 19 action and ongoing board and executive management succession. Strategy 16 Interests of employees Engagement, below and page 88 The framework is being reviewed to ensure it is best suited to support Sustainability ‘Our people’ 47 the evolving strategy and BP’s new purpose, ambition and aims. Parental leave 89 Alignment of ACB and option 34, 41, 44 The current framework covers the following principal areas: to carbon offset 1. Company purpose: pursuing BP’s purpose and accountability to Fostering business Engagement, below and page 88 shareholders for the company’s actions. This means focusing relationships with suppliers, primarily on strategic issues, while having regard to economic, customers and others political and social issues and other relevant external matters which Impact of operations New ambition and purpose 6 may influence or affect the development of BP’s business and on the community See our support for CA100+ 6 exemplify through the board principles (including the executive and the environment resolution and response limitations), its expectations for the conduct of the BP business Engagement, below and pages 40-45, 48 and its employees. Maintaining high standard Governance, pages 81-99, 101 of business conduct Sustainability 40-49 2. Strategy: responsibility for establishing and reviewing the long-term Acting fairly between Stakeholder engagement, 88 strategy and the annual plan (the plan) for BP, based on proposals members below and page made by the CEO for achieving BP’s purpose. Balanced long-term decision making 67 Investor proposition 18 How we engage and foster strong relationships with some of our key stakeholders Customers Employees Government Investors and Partners and Society and regulators shareholders suppliers • Original equipment • Pulse survey. • Country economic • Annual engagement • Industry events and • Social media. manufacturer • Town halls. impact reports. programme. memberships. • Community workshops collaborations. • Helios awards. • Multi-stakeholder • Quarterly and • Supplier workshops and and training. • Global customer groups. year‑end results. training. • Social investment brand tracking. • Government lobbying. • Annual general meeting. • University collaborations. programmes. • Customer events. See bp.com/ See Sustainability See bp.com/ See Corporate See bp.com/technology. See Sustainability sustainabilityreport. on page 47 and tradeassociations and governance on on page 39 Corporate governance bp.com/tax. page 88. and bp.com/ on page 88. sustainabilityreport. 66 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report How our board considers stakeholders in decision making Strategy Performance People Governance At every board meeting the directors In order to become a net zero company by BP’s workforce is key to its success. The board, led by the chairman, believes review, with the management team, the 2050 or sooner, BP must perform as we Our people help us maintain our strong that strong governance is essential to progress against strategic priorities and the transform. reputation for high standards of business the success of the company. At the end changing shape of the business portfolio. conduct are fundamental in delivering our of 2018, it participated in an external This collaborative approach by the board, The board regularly reviews and monitors purpose to reimagine energy. evaluation of its performance. The board together with the board’s approval of the BP’s safety, reliability and environmental discussed the findings of this review company strategy, helps it to promote the performance, with the aim of continually The past year was significant for BP, and the chairman introduced changes to long-term success of BP. The board making BP safer for our entire workforce with the announcement of Bernard the board’s ways of working. It agreed assesses different areas of the business and minimizing our environmental impact. Looney as new CEO. As part of the to implement changes to board meetings, so that BP is well positioned to deliver on It also focuses on maintaining financial succession planning for this role, the so that agendas will be structured around its ambition to become a net zero company discipline and delivering strong earnings, board considered a number of factors, four distinct pillars in 2020 – strategy, by 2050 or sooner, and to help the world cash flow and returns to shareholders. including the values and leadership performance, people and governance. behaviours that this role requires. Bernard get to net zero. Ultimately board decisions In 2019, BP increased its stake in are taken against the backdrop of what has been with BP since 1991 and has a In light of BP’s new corporate purpose, Lightsource BP, see page 73; formed strong sense of BP’s culture and values. ambition and aims and the changing it considers to be in the best interest of a new joint venture with BP Bunge the long-term financial success of the As chief executive of Upstream, he corporate governance landscape, the Bioenergia, see page 64; partnered with oversaw improvements in personal board is reviewing its governance company and BP’s stakeholders, the world-leading mobility platform, including shareholders, employees, safety and initiated developments in the framework in order to modernize its DiDi, to create a new electric vehicle workplace in areas such as mental health, principles and processes. The new the community and environment, charging network in China, see page 27; our suppliers and customers. diversity and inclusion. framework will continue to drive the and is exiting BP’s Alaska business as highest levels of business standards We made strong progress with our part of a two-year $10 billion divestment Together the board and new CEO and best practice, aligning these with divestment plans and built exciting new programme. reviewed the new organizational structure, BP’s business purpose, values, strategy opportunities in fast-growing markets in including the appointment of the and culture. In 2019 a recordable injury frequency rate leadership team and restructuring plans. 2019. BP’s flexible strategy allows it to of 0.166 was the lowest since reporting grow in ways that can make a significant The board will continue to assess and began, while the number of injuries The board is reviewing the manner in monitor culture and will look to obtain contribution to the energy transition, recorded fell by 17%. Safety will always which it engages with the workforce helping deliver the lower carbon energy useful insight through effective dialogue be one of our core values. This is to enable it to better understand the with our key stakeholders and taking the world wants and needs, while important to our workforce, local interests and concerns of BP’s people, fostering strong relationships with our feedback into account in the board’s communities and the environment, while see page 88. decision-making process. stakeholders. This further strengthens the securing strong operational availability company’s balance sheet, enabling us to and reliability is crucial to our partners, pursue new advantaged opportunities for suppliers and customers. BP’s portfolio within our disciplined financial framework. Relevant section 172 factors The board (including delegation of authority) Customers Employees Government Investors and Partners and Society and regulators shareholders suppliers Our broad customer We work to attract, develop We aim to help countries Our investment proposition We depend on the We consult with local base spans industries, and retain the world’s best around the world grow their is to grow sustainable capability and performance people and NGOs to gain businesses and end talent, equipped with the domestic energy supplies free cash flow and of our suppliers, contractors valuable perspectives on consumers of our products right skills for the future. and boost energy security. distributions to shareholders and other partners, such as the ways in which our and services. We work Our people have a crucial This in turn helps create over the long term. We rely small businesses, industry activities could impact closely with our customers role in delivering against our jobs and generates on the support of our peers and academia, to help the local community or to understand their evolving strategy and creating value. revenues for governments. investors, analysts and deliver the products and environment. We typically needs so we can improve We aim to maintain dialogue proxy voting agencies and services we need for our engage well before any and adapt to meet them. with governments and engage with global operations and our physical work begins on a engage in policy debates investment centres, sharing customers. project and continue the that are of concern to us updates on our strategic conversation throughout a and the communities in progress and our financial project’s lifespan. which we operate. and non-financial plans. >10m 70,100 $6.9bn $8.3bn $364m $84m retail customers served employees paid in income and total dividends invested in research committed to social every day worldwide production taxes to distributed to BP and development investment in 2019 governments in 2019 shareholders in 2019 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 67


 
How we manage risk BP manages, monitors and reports on the principal risks and Risk oversight and governance uncertainties that can impact our ability to deliver our strategy. Key risk oversight and governance committees include the following: These risks are described in the Risk factors on page 70. Our management systems, organizational structures, processes, Executive committees standards, code of conduct and behaviours together form a system of • Executive team meeting – for strategic and commercial risks. internal control that governs how we conduct the business of BP and • Group operations risk committee – for health, safety, security, manage associated risks. environment and operations integrity risks. • Group financial risk committee – for finance, treasury, trading BP’s risk management system and cyber risks. BP’s risk management system and policy is designed to be a consistent • Group disclosure committee – for financial reporting risks. and clear framework for managing and reporting risks from the group’s • Group people committee – for employee risks. operations to management and to the board. The system seeks to avoid • Group ethics and compliance committee – for legal and incidents and maximize business outcomes by allowing us to: regulatory compliance and ethics risks. • Resource commitment meeting – for investment decision risks. • Understand the risk environment, identify the specific risks and • Renewal committee – for strategic, commercial and investment assess the potential exposure for BP. decision risks related to new lines of business. • Determine how best to deal with these risks to manage overall potential exposure. Board and its committees • Manage the identified risks in appropriate ways. • BP board. • Monitor and seek assurance of the effectiveness of the management • Audit committee. of these risks and intervene for improvement where necessary. • Safety, environment and security assurance committee. • Report up the management chain and to the board on a periodic basis • Geopolitical committee. on how significant risks are being managed, monitored, assured and See BP governance framework on page 83, Board activity in 2019 the improvements that are being made. on page 84 and committee reports on pages 90-99 and 101. Our risk management activities Risk management processes Day-to-day risk Business and Oversight and We aim for a consistent basis of measuring risk to: management strategic risk governance • Establish a common understanding of risks on a like-for-like basis, management taking into account potential impact and likelihood. �dent���� Plan� mana�e �et pol��� • Report risks and their management to the appropriate levels of mana�e and per�orman�e and mon�tor the organization. report r���� and a��ure pr�n��pal r���� • Inform prioritization of specific risk management activities and resource allocation. Fa��l�t�e�� Bu��ne�� ��e�ut��e ��e a��et� and �e�ment� and and �orporate �oard Businesses and functions review significant risks and associated risk operat�on� �un�t�on� �un�t�on� management activities in alignment with key business processes to help enable key decisions to be risk informed. Day-to-day risk management – management and staff at our As part of BP’s annual planning process, the executive team and board facilities, assets and functions seek to identify and manage risk, review the group’s principal risks and uncertainties and determine risks promoting safe, compliant and reliable operations. BP requirements, for particular oversight by the board and its committees. These may be which take into account applicable laws and regulations, underpin the updated during the year in response to changes in internal and external practical plans developed to help reduce risk and deliver safe, compliant circumstances. and reliable operations as well as greater efficiency and sustainable financial results. Our risk profile Business and strategic risk management – our businesses and The nature of our business operations is long term, resulting in many of functions integrate risk management into key business processes such our risks being enduring in nature. Nonetheless, risks can develop and as strategy, planning, performance management, resource and capital evolve over time and their potential impact or likelihood may vary in allocation, and project appraisal. We do this by using a standard framework response to internal and external events. These may include emerging for collating risk data, assessing risk management activities, making further risks which are considered through existing processes, including BP’s improvements and in connection with planning new activities. risk management system, BP’s Energy Outlook, BP’s Technology Oversight and governance – throughout the year functional Outlook and group strategic reviews. leadership, the executive team, the board and relevant committees We identify longer-term strategic risks and high priority risks for particular provide oversight of how significant risks to BP are identified, assessed oversight by the board and its various committees in the coming year. and managed. They help to ensure that risks are governed by relevant Those identified for particular oversight in 2020 are listed in this section. policies and are managed appropriately. Such oversight may include These may be updated throughout the year in response to changes in reviews of the outcomes of business processes including strategy, internal and external circumstances. The oversight and management of planning and resource and capital allocation. other risks is undertaken in the normal course of business. BP’s group risk team analyses the group’s risk profile and maintains the There can be no certainty that our risk management activities will group risk management system. Our group audit team provides mitigate or prevent these, or other risks, from occurring. Further details independent assurance to the group chief executive and board as to of the principal risks and uncertainties we face are set out in Risk whether the group’s system of internal control is adequately designed factors on page 70. and operating effectively to respond appropriately to the risks that are significant to BP. 68 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Risks for particular oversight by the board and its We seek to manage this risk through development and maintenance of committees in 2020 relationships with governments and stakeholders and by becoming trusted partners in each country and region. In addition, we closely The risks for particular oversight by the board and its committees in monitor events and implement risk mitigation plans where appropriate. 2020 have been reviewed. In addition to the risks reviewed in 2019, climate-related risks have been added as a longer-term strategic risk. The impact of the UK’s exit from the EU Climate-related risks We have been assessing the potential impact on BP of Brexit and the UK’s future global relationships and have considered Risks associated with climate change and the transition to a lower carbon different outcomes but do not believe any of these outcomes economy impact many elements of our strategy and, as such, these risks are pose a significant risk to our business. The board’s geopolitical considered through key business processes including the strategy, annual committee continues to monitor these developments. plan, capital allocation and investment decisions. The outputs of these key business processes are reviewed in line with the cadence of these activities. Further details are described in Environment on page 40 and Climate Safety and operational risks change and the transition to a lower carbon economy on page 70. Process safety, personal safety and environmental risks Strategic and commercial risks The nature of the group’s operating activities exposes us to a wide range of significant health, safety and environmental risks such as Financial liquidity incidents associated with releases of hydrocarbons when drilling wells, External market conditions can impact our financial performance. operating facilities and transporting hydrocarbons. Supply and demand and the prices achieved for our products can be Our operating management system helps us manage these risks and affected by a wide range of factors including political developments, drive performance improvements. It sets out the rules and principles consumer preferences for low carbon energy, global economic which govern key risk management activities such as inspection, conditions and the influence of OPEC. maintenance, testing, business continuity and crisis response planning We seek to manage this risk through BP’s diversified portfolio, our and competency development. In addition, we conduct our drilling financial framework, liquidity stress testing, maintaining a significant activity through a global wells organization in order to promote a cash buffer, regular reviews of market conditions and our planning and consistent approach for designing, constructing and managing wells. investment processes. Security See Prices and markets and Liquidity, financial capacity and financial, Hostile acts such as terrorism or piracy could harm our people and including credit, exposure on page 70. disrupt our operations. We monitor for emerging threats and vulnerabilities to manage our physical and information security. The impact of coronavirus (COVID-19) Our central security team provides guidance and support to our The spread of coronavirus coupled with actions from OPEC+ has businesses through a network of regional security advisors who advise caused a significant drop in the oil price. Our financial frame is and conduct assurance activities with respect to the management of designed to be robust to periods of low price, with flexibility to security risks affecting our people and operations. We continue to reduce cost and capital expenditure if required. We continue to monitor threats globally and maintain disaster recovery, crisis and assess the potential impact of coronavirus on our staff and business continuity management plans. operations and have instigated appropriate mitigation plans. Compliance and control risks Cyber security Ethical misconduct and legal or regulatory non-compliance The targeted and indiscriminate threats to the security of our digital Ethical misconduct or breaches of applicable laws or regulations infrastructure and those of third parties continue to evolve rapidly and could damage our reputation, adversely affect operational results are increasingly prevalent across industries worldwide. and shareholder value, and potentially affect our licence to operate. We seek to manage this risk through a range of measures, which Our code of conduct and our values and behaviours, applicable to all include cyber security standards, security protection tools, ongoing employees, are central to managing this risk. Additionally, we have various detection and monitoring of threats and testing of cyber response and group requirements and training covering areas such as anti-bribery and recovery procedures. We collaborate closely with governments, law corruption, anti-money laundering, competition/ anti-trust law and international enforcement agencies and industry peers to understand and respond to trade regulations. We seek to keep abreast of new regulations and legislation new and emerging cyber threats. We build awareness with our staff, and plan our response to them. We offer an independent confidential helpline, share information on incidents with leadership for continuous learning OpenTalk, for employees, contractors and other third parties. and conduct regular exercises including with the executive team to test Trading non-compliance response and recovery procedures. In the normal course of business, we are subject to risks around our Geopolitical trading activities which could arise from shortcomings or failures in our The diverse locations of our operations around the world expose us to systems, risk management methodology, internal control processes or a wide range of political developments and consequent changes to the employee conduct. economic and operating environment. Geopolitical risk is inherent to We have specific operating standards and control processes to manage many regions in which we operate, and heightened political or social these risks, including guidelines specific to trading, and seek to monitor tensions or changes in key relationships could adversely affect compliance through our dedicated compliance teams. We also seek to the group. maintain a positive and collaborative relationship with regulators and the industry at large. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 69


 
Risk factors The risks discussed below, separately or in combination, could have Failure to accurately forecast or work within our financial framework could impact a material adverse effect on the implementation of our strategy, our our ability to operate and result in financial loss. Trade and other receivables, including business, financial performance, results of operations, cash flows, overdue receivables, may not be recovered, divestments may not be successfully liquidity, prospects, shareholder value and returns and reputation. completed and a substantial and unexpected cash call or funding request could disrupt our financial framework or overwhelm our ability to meet our obligations. Strategic and commercial risks An event such as a significant operational incident, legal proceedings or a geopolitical event in an area where we have significant activities, could reduce our Prices and markets – our financial performance is impacted by financial liquidity and our credit ratings. Credit ratings downgrades could potentially fluctuating prices of oil, gas and refined products, technological change, increase financing costs and limit access to financing or engagement in our trading exchange rate fluctuations, and the general macroeconomic outlook. activities on acceptable terms, which could put pressure on the group’s liquidity. Oil, gas and product prices are subject to international supply and demand and Credit rating downgrades could also trigger a requirement for the company to margins can be volatile. Political developments, increased supply from new oil review its funding arrangements with the BP pension trustees and may cause and gas or alternative low carbon energy sources, technological change, global other impacts on financial performance. In the event of extended constraints on economic conditions, public health situations and the influence of OPEC can our ability to obtain financing, we could be required to reduce capital expenditure impact supply and demand and prices for our products. Decreases in oil, gas or or increase asset disposals in order to provide additional liquidity. See Liquidity product prices could have an adverse effect on revenue, margins, profitability and and capital resources on page 301 and Financial statements – Note 29. cash flows. If significant or for a prolonged period, we may have to write down assets and re-assess the viability of certain projects, which may impact future Joint arrangements and contractors – varying levels of control over the cash flows, profit, capital expenditure and ability to maintain our long-term standards, operations and compliance of our partners, contractors and investment programme. Conversely, an increase in oil, gas and product prices sub-contractors could result in legal liability and reputational damage. may not improve margin performance as there could be increased fiscal take, We conduct many of our activities through joint arrangements, associates or cost inflation and more onerous terms for access to resources. The profitability of with contractors and sub-contractors where we may have limited influence and our refining and petrochemicals activities can be volatile, with periodic over- control over the performance of such operations. Our partners and contractors supply or supply tightness in regional markets and fluctuations in demand. are responsible for the adequacy of the resources and capabilities they bring to a Exchange rate fluctuations can create currency exposures and impact underlying project. If these are found to be lacking, there may be financial, operational or costs and revenues. Crude oil prices are generally set in US dollars, while products safety risks for BP. Should an incident occur in an operation that BP participates vary in currency. Many of our major project development costs are denominated in, our partners and contractors may be unable or unwilling to fully compensate in local currencies, which may be subject to fluctuations against the US dollar. us against costs we may incur on their behalf or on behalf of the arrangement. Where we do not have operational control of a venture, we may still be pursued Access, renewal and reserves progression – inability to access, by regulators or claimants in the event of an incident. renew and progress upstream resources in a timely manner could adversely affect our long-term replacement of reserves. Digital infrastructure and cyber security – breach or failure of our or third parties’ digital infrastructure or cyber security, including loss or Renewing our reserve base depends on our ability to continually replenish future misuse of sensitive information could damage our operations, increase opportunities to access and produce oil and natural gas. Competition for access costs and damage our reputation. to investment opportunities, heightened political and economic risks in certain countries where significant hydrocarbon basins are located, unsuccessful The oil and gas industry is subject to fast-evolving risks from cyber threat actors, exploration activity and increasing technical challenges and capital commitments including nation states, criminals, terrorists, hacktivists and insiders. A breach or may adversely affect our reserve replacement. This, and our ability to progress failure of our or third parties’ digital infrastructure – including control systems – due upstream resources and sustain long-term reserves replacement, could impact to breaches of our cyber defences, or those of third parties, negligence, intentional our future production and financial performance. misconduct or other reasons, could seriously disrupt our operations. This could result in the loss or misuse of data or sensitive information, injury to people, Major project delivery – failure to invest in the best opportunities or disruption to our business, harm to the environment or our assets, legal or deliver major projects successfully could adversely affect our financial regulatory breaches and legal liability. Furthermore, the rapid detection of attempts performance. to gain unauthorized access to our digital infrastructure, often through the use of We face challenges in developing major projects, particularly in geographically sophisticated and co-ordinated means, is a challenge and any delay or failure to and technically challenging areas. Poor investment choice, efficiency or delivery, detect could compound these potential harms. These could result in significant or operational challenges at any major project that underpins production or costs including fines, cost of remediation or reputational consequences. production growth could adversely affect our financial performance. Climate change and the transition to a lower carbon economy Geopolitical – exposure to a range of political developments and – policy, legal, regulatory, technology and market developments related consequent changes to the operating and regulatory environment could to the issue of climate change could increase costs, reduce demand for cause business disruption. our products, reduce revenue and limit certain growth opportunities. We operate and may seek new opportunities in countries and regions where Laws, regulations, policies, obligations, social attitudes and customer preferences political, economic and social transition may take place. Political instability, relating to climate change and the transition to a lower carbon economy could changes to the regulatory environment or taxation, international sanctions, have an adverse impact on our business (including increased costs from expropriation or nationalization of property, civil strife, strikes, insurrections, acts compliance, litigation, and regulatory or litigation outcomes), and could lead to of terrorism, acts of war and public health situations (including an outbreak of an constraints on production and supply and access to new reserves and a decline in epidemic or pandemic) may disrupt or curtail our operations or development demand for certain products. activities. These may in turn cause production to decline, limit our ability to Technological improvements or innovations that support the transition to a lower pursue new opportunities, affect the recoverability of our assets or cause us to carbon economy, and customer preferences or regulatory incentives that alter incur additional costs, particularly due to the long-term nature of many of our fuel or power choices, could impact demand for oil and gas. Depending on the projects and significant capital expenditure required. Events in or relating to nature and speed of any such changes and our response, this could adversely Russia, including trade restrictions and other sanctions, could adversely impact affect the demand for our products, investor sentiment, our access to capital our income and investment in or relating to Russia. Our ability to pursue business markets, our competitiveness and financial performance. Policy, legal regulatory, objectives and to recognize production and reserves relating to these investments technological and market developments related to climate change could also could also be adversely impacted. affect future price assumptions used in the assessment of recoverability of Liquidity, financial capacity and financial, including credit, asset carrying values including goodwill, the judgement as to whether there is continued intent to develop exploration and appraisal intangible assets, the timing exposure – failure to work within our financial framework could impact of decommissioning of assets and the useful economic lives of assets used for our ability to operate and result in financial loss. the calculation of depreciation and amortization. See Financial statements – Note 1 and Environment on page 40. 70 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Strategic report Competition – inability to remain efficient, maintain a high-quality Drilling and production – challenging operational environments and portfolio of assets, innovate and retain an appropriately skilled other uncertainties could impact drilling and production activities. workforce could negatively impact delivery of our strategy in a highly Our activities require high levels of investment and are sometimes conducted in competitive market. challenging environments such as those prone to natural disasters and extreme Our strategic progress and performance could be impeded if we are unable to control weather, which heightens the risks of technical integrity failure. The physical our development and operating costs and margins, or to sustain, develop and operate characteristics of an oil or natural gas field, and cost of drilling, completing or a high-quality portfolio of assets efficiently. We could be adversely affected if operating wells is often uncertain. We may be required to curtail, delay or cancel competitors offer superior terms for access rights or licences, or if our innovation in drilling operations or stop production because of a variety of factors, including areas such as exploration, production, refining, manufacturing, renewable energy, new unexpected drilling conditions, pressure or irregularities in geological formations, technologies or customer offer that lags the industry. Our performance could also be equipment failures or accidents, adverse weather conditions and compliance with negatively impacted if we fail to protect our intellectual property. Our industry faces governmental requirements. increasing challenge to recruit and retain diverse, skilled and experienced people in the fields of science, technology, engineering and mathematics. Successful recruitment, Compliance and control risks development and retention of specialist staff is essential to our plans. Ethical misconduct and non-compliance – ethical misconduct or Crisis management and business continuity – failure to address an breaches of applicable laws by our businesses or our employees could incident effectively could potentially disrupt our business. be damaging to our reputation, and could result in litigation, regulatory Our business activities could be disrupted if we do not respond, or are perceived action and penalties. not to respond, in an appropriate manner to any major crisis or if we are not able Incidents of ethical misconduct or non-compliance with applicable laws and to restore or replace critical operational capacity. regulations, including anti-bribery and corruption and anti-fraud laws, trade Insurance – our insurance strategy could expose the group to material restrictions or other sanctions, could damage our reputation, and result in uninsured losses. litigation, regulatory action and penalties. BP generally purchases insurance only in situations where this is legally and Regulation – changes in the regulatory and legislative environment contractually required. Some risks are insured with third parties and reinsured by could increase the cost of compliance, affect our provisions and limit group insurance companies. Uninsured losses could have a material adverse our access to new growth opportunities. effect on our financial position, particularly if they arise at a time when we are Governments that award exploration and production interests may impose facing material costs as a result of a significant operational event which could put specific drilling obligations, environmental, health and safety controls, pressure on our liquidity and cash flows. controls over the development and decommissioning of a field and possibly, Security – hostile acts against our staff and activities could cause harm nationalization, expropriation, cancellation or non-renewal of contract rights. to people and disrupt our operations. Royalties and taxes tend to be high compared with those imposed on similar commercial activities, and in certain jurisdictions there is a degree of uncertainty Acts of terrorism, piracy, sabotage and similar activities directed against our relating to tax law interpretation and changes. Governments may change their operations and facilities, pipelines, transportation or digital infrastructure could fiscal and regulatory frameworks in response to public pressure on finances, cause harm to people and severely disrupt operations. Our activities could also be resulting in increased amounts payable to them or their agencies. severely affected by conflict, civil strife or political unrest. Such factors could increase the cost of compliance, reduce our profitability in Product quality – supplying customers with off-specification products certain jurisdictions, limit our opportunities for new access, require us to divest could damage our reputation, lead to regulatory action and legal liability, or write down certain assets or curtail or cease certain operations, or affect the and impact our financial performance. adequacy of our provisions for pensions, tax, decommissioning, environmental and legal liabilities. Potential changes to pension or financial market regulation Failure to meet product quality specifications could cause harm to people and the could also impact funding requirements of the group. Following the Gulf of environment, damage our reputation, result in regulatory action and legal liability, Mexico oil spill, we may be subjected to a higher level of fines or penalties and impact financial performance. imposed in relation to any alleged breaches of laws or regulations, which could Safety and operational risks result in increased costs. Treasury and trading activities – ineffective oversight of treasury Process safety, personal safety, and environmental risks – and trading activities could lead to business disruption, financial loss, exposure to a wide range of health, safety, security and environmental regulatory intervention or damage to our reputation. risks could cause harm to people, the environment and our assets and We are subject to operational risk around our treasury and trading activities in result in regulatory action, legal liability, business interruption, increased financial and commodity markets, some of which are regulated. Failure to costs, damage to our reputation and potentially denial of our licence process, manage and monitor a large number of complex transactions across to operate. many markets and currencies while complying with all regulatory requirements Technical integrity failure, natural disasters, extreme weather or a change in its could hinder profitable trading opportunities. There is a risk that a single trader or frequency or severity, human error and other adverse events or conditions, including a group of traders could act outside of our delegations and controls, leading to breach of digital security, could lead to loss of containment of hydrocarbons or other regulatory intervention and resulting in financial loss, fines and potentially hazardous materials. This could also lead to constrained availability of resources damaging our reputation. See Financial statements – Note 29. used in our operating activities, as well as fires, explosions or other personal and Reporting – failure to accurately report our data could lead to process safety incidents, including when drilling wells, operating facilities and those associated with transportation by road, sea or pipeline. There can be no certainty regulatory action, legal liability and reputational damage. that our operating management system or other policies and procedures will External reporting of financial and non-financial data, including reserves adequately identify all process safety, personal safety and environmental risks or estimates, relies on the integrity of systems and people. Failure to report data that all our operating activities, including acquired businesses will be conducted in accurately and in compliance with applicable standards could result in regulatory conformance with these systems. See Safety and security on page 45. action, legal liability and damage to our reputation. Such events or conditions, including a marine incident, or inability to provide safe The Strategic report was approved by the board and signed on its behalf environments for our workforce and the public while at our facilities, premises or by Ben J. S. Mathews, company secretary on 18 March 2020. during transportation, could lead to injuries, loss of life or environmental damage. As a result we could face regulatory action and legal liability, including penalties and remediation obligations, increased costs and potentially denial of our licence to operate. Our activities are sometimes conducted in hazardous, remote or environmentally sensitive locations, where the consequences of such events or conditions could be greater than in other locations. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 71


 
Energy with purpose means helping the world reach net zero. 72 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Corporate governance Board of directors 74 Executive team 78 The leadership team 80 Introduction from the chairman 82 Board activities in 2019 84 How the board has engaged with shareholders, 88 the workforce and other stakeholders Nomination and governance committee 90 Audit committee 91 Safety, environment and security 96 assurance committee Geopolitical committee 98 Chairman’s committee 99 Directors’ remuneration report 100 Remuneration committee 101 Energy with purpose Expanding solar Lightsource BP is helping shape the future of global energy delivery by developing solar capacity around the world. • We increased our stake in Lightsource BP to create a 50:50 joint venture in 2019. Lightsource BP highlights in 2019 • Entered the Spanish solar market with the purchase of a 300MW portfolio of solar development projects across six sites. • Signed a long-term agreement to build a 240MW facility, supplying EVRAZ, a US steel company. • Established a presence in Brazil with the purchase of 1.9GW of solar projects in various stages of development. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 73


 
Board of directors as at 18 March 2020 Committee membership key Chairman Audit Safety, environment and security assurance Remuneration Geopolitical Chairman’s Nomination and governance Non-executive directors’ tenure Helge Lund Bernard Looney Chairman Chief executive officer Appointed to the board 26 July 2018 (appointed Appointed 5 February 2020 chairman 1 January 2019) Outside interests: Outside interests: Fellow of the Royal Academy of Engineering, Fellow Chairman of Novo Nordisk AS, Operating Advisor to of the Energy Institute, Mentor for FTSE 100 Clayton Dubilier & Rice, Member of the Board of Cross-Company Mentoring Executive Programme Trustees of the International Crisis Group, Member Age: 49 of the European Round Table of Industrialists Nationality: Irish Age: 57 1 – 3 years 5 Career summary: Nationality: Norwegian 4 – 6 years 2 Bernard Looney joined BP in 1991 as a drilling 7+ years 4 Career summary: engineer working in roles in the North Sea, Vietnam Helge served as chief executive of BG Group from and the Gulf of Mexico. Prior to becoming the chief 2015 to 2016, when the company merged with Shell. executive of BP Upstream in April 2016, Bernard held He joined BG Group from Equinor (formerly Statoil) a range of senior roles, including chief operating where he served as its president and chief executive officer of production, managing director BP North Board gender diversity officer for 10 years from 2004. Prior to Equinor, Sea and vice president in Norway and North Sea Helge was president and chief executive officer of infrastructure and BP Alaska. He has led access into the industrial conglomerate, Aker Kvaerner, and has new countries, including Mauritania and Senegal, also held executive positions in the Norwegian high-graded the portfolio with the acquisition of industrial holding company, Aker RGI and the former onshore US assets from BHP Billiton and the sale of Norwegian power and industry company, Hafslund the Alaska business, and created innovative new Nycomed. He worked as a consultant with McKinsey business models, such as Aker BP in Norway. & Company and served as a political adviser for the As chief executive of BP Upstream, Bernard parliamentary group of the Conservative party in oversaw improvements in both process and personal Norway. Prior to joining BP, he was a non-executive safety performances and production grew by 20%. director of the oil service group Schlumberger from There were also significant improvements in both 2016 to 2018, and Nokia from 2011 to 2014. He gender and global diversity. Bernard initiated a Female 5 served as a member on the United Nations group-wide dialogue on mental health in hope of Male 6 Secretary-General’s Advisory Group on Sustainable ‘ending the stigma’ associated with the issue. Energy from 2011 to 2014. Relevant skills and experience: Relevant skills and experience: Bernard has spent his career at BP and has Board nationality Helge has an impressive track record of leadership demonstrated dynamic leadership and vision as he in the oil and gas industry. His open-minded and has progressed through various roles within the forward-looking approach is vital as the industry Company. As part of the appointment process to focuses on the transition to a lower carbon world. becoming the new chief executive officer, Bernard He has deep industry knowledge and global business exceeded at range of aptitude and psychometric experience – not only in the oil and gas industry but testing. During his 10 years as a leader of Upstream, also in pharmaceuticals, healthcare and construction. Bernard saw the segment through one of the most difficult periods in the BP’s history, helping transform the company into a safer, stronger and more resilient business. He was instrumental in a number of workforce based initiatives to promote a diverse and UK 6 inclusive environment. US 3 Non UK/US 2 View the directors’ biographies in full at bp.com/board. 74 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Brian Gilvary Dame Alison Carnwath Pamela Daley Chief financial officer Independent non-executive director Independent non-executive director Appointed 1 January 2012 Appointed 21 May 2018 Appointed 26 July 2018 Brian will retire on 30 June 2020. Outside interests: Outside interests: Member of Supervisory Board of BASF SE, Director Director of BlackRock, Inc, Director of SecureWorks, Inc Outside interests: of Zurich Insurance Group, Independent director of Non-executive director of Air Liquide SA, Non- Age: 67 PACCAR Inc, Member of UK Panel on Takeovers and executive director of Barclays PLC, Non-executive Mergers, Trustee of The Economist Group Nationality: American director of Royal Navy Board, Senior independent director of The Francis Crick Institute, Chairman of Age: 67 Career summary: The Hundred Group of Financial Directors (The 100 Pam joined General Electric Company in 1989 as tax Nationality: British Group), Fellow of the Energy Institute; Great Britain counsel and held a number of senior executive roles Age Group Triathlete Career summary: in the company, overseeing a wide range of Dame Alison is a qualified chartered accountant with corporate transactions and serving as senior vice Age: 58 a wealth of financial industry experience obtained president and senior advisor to the chairman in 2013, Nationality: British during an expansive career in London and New York. before retiring from GE. Pam has served as a director In addition to her current appointments, she was of BlackRock since 2014 and of SecureWorks since Career summary: previously Chairman of Land Securities Group plc 2016. She was a director of BG Group plc from 2014 Brian joined BP in 1986 after obtaining a PhD in from September 2004 until July 2018 and served as to 2016 until its acquisition by Shell, a director of mathematics from the University of Manchester. a non-executive director of Barclays PLC from 2010 Patheon N.V. from 2016 to 2017 until its acquisition Following a broad range of roles across the group in to 2012 and Man Group plc from November 2012 to by Thermo Fisher, and was previously a partner at upstream, downstream and trading in Europe and the May 2013. In 2014, Dame Alison was appointed to Morgan, Lewis & Bockius, a major US law firm, US, he became downstream’s commercial director in the order of Dame Commander of the Most Excellent where she specialized in domestic and cross-border 2002. From 2005 until 2009 he was chief executive Order of the British Empire for her services to tax-oriented financings and commercial transactions. of BP’s commodity trading arm and, in 2010, he was business and diversity. appointed deputy group chief financial officer. Brian Relevant skills and experience: was a director of TNK-BP over two separate periods, Relevant skills and experience: Pam is a qualified lawyer with significant from 2003 to 2005 and from 2010 until the sale of Dame Alison has extensive financial experience both management insight obtained from previous senior the business and BP’s acquisition of Rosneft equity as an executive and non-executive director. Dame positions held at companies that operate in highly in 2013. He served on the HM Treasury Financial Alison has chaired significant boards and has deep regulated industries. Pam has a wealth of experience Management Review Board from 2014 to 2017. experience of the workings of investors and the in global business and strategy gained from over 20 finance industry in the City of London. She has years in an executive role at GE. She also has Relevant skills and experience: worked with global organizations and brings this experience in the UK oil and gas industry from her Brian’s broad experience of working across the broad range of skills to the BP board and to the time served on the BG Group plc board. Pam group has provided him with deep insight into BP’s audit committee. contributes important insight to the audit committee assets and businesses. He has been key during from her previous executive experience. In 2019, she BP’s strategy implementation to transform into a joined the remuneration committee, where her ‘value over volume’ business where trading is a key understanding of employee and investor creator of value. His deep understanding of finance perspectives brings value. and trading has been vital in adjusting capital structures and operational costs while ensuring the group continues to be capable of meeting new opportunities. Brian played a major role in overseeing financial aspects of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, and leading settlement negotiations to resolve outstanding federal and state claims. He also played a lead role in the negotiations around the exit of TNK-BP and investment into Rosneft and led the 2018 acquisition of the BHP onshore Lower 48 assets. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 75


 
Sir Ian Davis Professor Dame Ann Dowling Melody Meyer Senior independent director Independent non-executive director Independent non-executive director Appointed 2 April 2010 Appointed 3 February 2012 Appointed 17 May 2017 Outside interests: Outside interests: Outside interests: Chairman of Rolls-Royce Holdings plc, Non-executive Deputy vice-chancellor and emeritus professor President of Melody Meyer Energy LLC, Director director of Majid Al Futtaim Holding LLC, of Mechanical Engineering at the University of of the National Bureau of Asian Research, Trustee Non-executive director of Johnson & Johnson, Inc. Cambridge, Non-executive director of Smiths of Trinity University, Non-executive director of Group plc AbbVie Inc., Non-executive director of National Age: 68 Oilwell Varco, Inc. Age: 67 Nationality: British Age: 62 Nationality: British Career summary: Nationality: American Sir Ian began his career at The Bowater Corporation Career summary: Limited, a paper manufacturing company, before Professor Dame Ann is a deputy vice-chancellor and Career summary: joining McKinsey & Company in 1979. He was a emeritus professor of Mechanical Engineering at the Melody started her career in 1979 with Gulf Oil partner at McKinsey & Company for 31 years until his University of Cambridge where her research includes which later merged with Chevron Corporation, where retirement in 2010 and also served as chairman and fluid mechanics, acoustics and combustion. She has she remained until her retirement in 2016. During her managing director between 2003 and 2009. Sir Ian held visiting posts at MIT and at Caltech. Dame Ann career with Chevron, Melody held several key has remained as a senior partner emeritus of is a fellow of the Royal Society and the Royal leadership roles in global exploration and production, McKinsey & Company since his retirement. He also Academy of Engineering and a foreign associate of working on a number of international projects and served as a lead non-executive board member for the the US National Academy of Engineering, the operational assignments. Melody was the executive Cabinet Office from 2015 to 2016. Sir Ian was given Chinese Academy of Engineering and the French sponsor of the Chevron Women’s Network and the honour of knighthood in the 2019 Birthday Academy of Sciences. She was an advisor at continues as a mentor and advocate for the Honours for services to business. Rolls-Royce until 2015. Dame Ann was President of advancement of women in the industry. Melody has the Royal Academy of Engineering from September received several awards and accolades throughout Relevant skills and experience: 2014 to 2019. In December 2015 she was appointed her career including being recognized as a 2009 Sir Ian brings global financial and strategic experience to the Order of Merit. Trinity Distinguished Alumni, with the BioHouston to the board. He has worked with and advised global Women in Science Award and she was most recently organizations and companies in a wide variety of Relevant skills and experience: recognized by Hart Energy as an Influential Woman sectors including oil and gas and the public sector. Dame Ann is an internationally respected leader in in Energy in 2018. He is able to draw on knowledge of diverse issues engineering research and the practical application of and outcomes to assist the board and its new technology in industry. Her contribution, Relevant skills and experience: committees. research and academic leadership in these fields are Melody has spent her entire career in the oil and gas admired internationally. Her academic background industry. The breadth, variety and geographic scope Sir Ian’s previous experience as a non-executive provides balance to the board and brings a different of her experience is distinctive. Her career has been director for the Cabinet Office gives him an important perspective to the safety, environment and security marked by a focus on excellence, safety and perspective on government affairs which is an asset assurance committee, particularly as developments performance improvement. She has expertise in the to both the board and the geopolitical committee. in technology accelerate. Her work in this area is execution of major capital projects, creation of supplemented by her chairing the company’s businesses in new countries, strategic and business technology advisory council. planning, merger integration and safe and reliable operations. Melody brings a world-class operational perspective to the board, with a deep understanding of the factors influencing safe, efficient and commercially high-performing projects in a global organization. 76 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Brendan Nelson Paula Rosput Reynolds Sir John Sawers Independent non-executive director Independent non-executive director Independent non-executive director Appointed 8 November 2010 Appointed 14 May 2015 Appointed 14 May 2015 Outside interests: Outside interests: Outside interests: Non-executive director of NatWest Markets plc, Non-executive director of BAE Systems plc, Visiting professor at King’s College London, Governor Member of the Financial Reporting Review Panel Non-executive director of General Electric Company of the Ditchley Foundation, Trustee of the Bilderberg Association, UK, Executive Chairman of Newbridge Age: 70 Age: 63 Advisory Limited Nationality: British Nationality: American Age: 64 Career summary: Career summary: Nationality: British Brendan is a qualified chartered accountant and Paula commenced her energy career at Pacific Gas & former partner at KPMG having held a number of Electric Corp in 1979 and spent over 25 years in the Career summary: senior positions at KPMG International. He served energy industry. She has held a number of executive Sir John spent 36 years in public service in the UK, on the KPMG UK board from 2000 until his positions during her career, including CEO of Duke working on foreign policy, international security and retirement in 2010. Brendan previously served as a Energy Power Services, Chairman, President and intelligence. He was chief of the Secret Intelligence member of the Financial Services Practitioner Panel CEO of AGL Resources as well as Chairman and CEO Service, MI6, from 2009 to 2014 and prior to that for six years and was president of the Institute of of Safeco Corporation and Vice Chairman and Chief spent the bulk of his career in the Diplomatic Service, Chartered Accountants of Scotland in 2013/14. He Restructuring Officer of AIG. Paula was a non- representing the British government around the has extensive financial and banking experience executive director of TransCanada Corporation and world and leading negotiations at the UN, in the having been a non-executive director of The Royal CBRE Group, Inc until May 2019, having been European Union and in the G8. After he left public Bank of Scotland Group p.l.c. and National appointed in 2011 and 2016 respectively. Paula was service, Sir John was chairman and general partner Westminster Bank p.l.c. from 2010 until April 2019 awarded the National Association of Corporate of Macro Advisory Partners, a firm that advises and December 2018 respectively. Directors (US) Lifetime Achievement Award in 2014. clients on the intersection of policy, politics and markets, from February 2015 to May 2019. He then Relevant skills and experience: Relevant skills and experience: set up his own firm, Newbridge Advisory, to carry Brendan has completed a wide variety of audit, Paula has had a long career leading global companies out similar work. Sir John was appointed Knight regulatory and due-diligence engagements over the in the energy and financial sectors. Her financial Grand Cross of the Order of St Michael and St course of his career. He played a significant role in background and deep experience of trading makes George in the 2015 New Year Honours for services the development of the profession’s approach to the her ideally suited to serve on the audit committee. to national security. audit of banks in the UK, with particular emphasis on Her experience with international and US companies, establishing auditing standards. He continues to Relevant skills and experience: including several restructuring processes and contribute in his role as a member of the Financial Sir John’s deep experience of international political mergers, gives her insight into strategic and Reporting Review Panel. and commercial matters is an asset to the board in regulatory issues, which is an asset to the board. navigating the geopolitical issues faced by a modern This wide experience makes him ideally suited to Paula currently serves as the chair of the global company. Sir John brings a unique perspective chair the audit committee and to act as its financial remuneration committee of BAE Systems plc. Her and broad experience which makes him ideal to lead expert. He brings related input from his role as the experience there and her wider business experience the geopolitical committee. His knowledge and skills chair of the audit committee of a major bank. His and understanding of the views of investors are well gained in government, diplomacy and policy analysis specialism in the financial services industry allows suited to her being the chair of the BP remuneration and advice are invaluable to both the board and the him to contribute insight into the challenges faced by committee. safety, environment and security assurance global businesses by regulatory frameworks. committee. Ben J S Mathews Ben joined BP as a company secretary in May 2019. He is chairman of the The Association of General Counsel and Company Secretaries of the FTSE Company secretary 100 (GC100) and the co-chair of the Corporate Governance Council of the Appointed 7 May 2019 Conference Board. Ben is also a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Secretaries and Administrators. Former appointments include Group Company Secretary of HSBC Holdings plc and Rio Tinto plc. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 77


 
Executive team as at 18 March 2020 Gordon Birrell Susan Dio Tufan Erginbilgic Interim head of upstream Chairman and president of BP America Chief executive, Downstream Appointed 12 February 2020 Appointed 1 September 2018 Appointed 1 October 2014 Gordon will continue as part of the new Susan will step down from her role on 30 June 2020 Tufan will retire from the company on 31 March 2020. leadership team. and retire from the company in the second half Outside interests: of 2020. Outside interests: Member of the Turkish-British Chamber of No external appointments Outside interests: Commerce & Industry Board of Directors, Member Member of the American Petroleum Institute of the Strategic Advisory Board of the University Age: 57  Nationality: British Board and Executive Committee, Member of the of Surrey. Career summary: Greater Houston Partnership Executive Committee, Age: 60  Nationality: British and Turkish Before being appointed to his new role, Gordon Member of the Ford’s Theatre Board of Trustees was chief operating officer for production, Executive Committee. Career summary: transformation and carbon. In a long BP career, Tufan was appointed chief executive, Downstream Age: 59  Nationality: American Gordon has spent time in various technical, on 1 October 2014. safety and operational risk (S&OR) and leadership Career summary: Prior to this, Tufan was the chief operating officer of roles including four years as BP president Susan is chairman and president of BP America, the fuels business, accountable for BP’s fuels value Azerbaijan, Georgia and Turkey. providing leadership and oversight to BP’s US chains worldwide, the global fuels businesses and businesses. the refining, sales and commercial optimization Since joining the company in 1984, she has held key functions for fuels. Tufan joined Mobil in 1990 and operational and executive positions in the US, UK and BP in 1997 and has held a wide variety of roles in Australia. Before assuming her current role, Susan refining and marketing in Turkey, various European served as chief executive officer of BP Shipping. countries and the UK. David Eyton Bob Fryar Andy Hopwood Group head of technology Executive vice president, safety and Executive vice president, chief operating officer, Appointed 1 September 2018 operational risk upstream strategy Appointed 1 October 2010 Appointed 1 November 2010 David will continue as part of the new leadership team. Bob will retire from the company in the second half Andy will retire from the company in the second half Outside interests: of 2020. of 2020. Fellow of the UK Royal Academy of Engineering, Fellow of the Institute of Materials, Minerals & Outside interests: Outside interests: Mining, Fellow of the Institute of Directors, Trustee No external appointments No external appointments of the John Lyons Foundation, Member of Oil & Gas Age: 56  Nationality: American Age: 62  Nationality: British Climate Initiative Climate Investments Board. Career summary: Career summary: Age: 58  Nationality: British Bob is responsible for safety, operational risk Andy was appointed chief operating officer, upstream Career summary: management and the systematic management of strategy in April 2018. Andy joined BP in 1980, spending As group head of technology, David is accountable for operations across the BP group. He is accountable his first 10 years in operations in the North Sea, Wytch technology strategy and its implementation across BP. for a variety of group-level disciplines. In this capacity, Farm and Indonesia. In 1989 Andy joined the corporate This includes corporate venture capital investments he looks after the group-wide operating management planning team formulating BP’s upstream strategy and and conducting research and development in areas of system implementation and capability programmes. subsequent portfolio rationalization. corporate renewal. In this role, David sits on the Oil & Bob has over 30 years’ experience in the oil and gas Following the BP-Amoco merger, Andy spent time Gas Climate Initiative Climate Investments Board. industry, having joined Amoco Production Company leading BP’s businesses across the world. He was David was recognized for his services to engineering in 1985. appointed executive vice president, exploration and and energy in 2018 and awarded a CBE. production in 2010. 78 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Lamar McKay Eric Nitcher Dev Sanyal Chief transition officer Group general counsel Chief executive, alternative energy and Appointed 16 June 2008 Appointed 1 January 2017 executive vice president, regions Appointed 1 January 2012 Lamar’s current portfolio will be redistributed on Eric will continue as part of the new leadership team. 1 July and he will continue in his capacity as chief Dev will continue as part of the new leadership team. Outside interests: transition officer. No external appointments Outside interests: Outside interests: Independent non-executive director of Man Group plc; Age: 57  Nationality: American No external appointments Member of the International Advisory Board on Energy, Career summary: Government of India; Advisory Board of the Centre for Age: 61  Nationality: American Eric is responsible for legal matters across the BP European Reform; Board of Advisors of The Fletcher Career summary: group. He joined Amoco in 1990 and over the years School of Law and Diplomacy, Tufts University; Fellow Lamar took on a new role as chief transition officer in has held a wide variety of roles. of the Energy Institute. 2019. He is responsible for supporting the chairman Eric moved to London in 2000, to join the mergers Age: 54  Nationality: British and Indian and new group chief executive in achieving a full and and acquisitions legal team. He returned to Houston orderly transfer of leadership. In addition, he Career summary: in 2007 to serve as special counsel and chief of staff continues to hold responsibility for leading BP’s Dev is responsible for BP’s global alternative energy to BP America’s chairman and president. strategy work for the energy transition. business and for the group’s interests in the Europe Most recently he played a leading role in the and Asia regions. He was appointed to the BP Group Lamar started his career in 1980 with Amoco and settlement of the Deepwater Horizon US executive committee in 2011. has since held a number of senior roles including government claims and resolution of many of the most recently group deputy CEO. Dev joined BP in 1989 and has held a variety of remaining private claims. international roles in London, Athens, Istanbul, Vienna and Dubai. Dev was previously appointed group treasurer in 2007 and was also chairman of BP Investment Management. Until April 2016, Dev was executive vice president, strategy and regions. Dame Angela Strank Helmut Schuster BP chief scientist and head of technology, Executive vice president, group human downstream resources director Appointed 1 September 2018 Appointed 1 March 2011 Angela will retire from the company at the end of 2020. Helmut will step down from his current role on 1 July and continue working with BP as an advisor. Outside interests: Non-executive director of Severn Trent plc, Fellow of Outside interests: the Royal Society, Fellow of the Royal Academy of Non-executive director of Ivoclar Vivadent AG, Germany Engineering. Age: 59  Nationality: Austrian and British Age: 67  Nationality: British Career summary: Career summary: Helmut became group human resources (HR) Dame Angela is responsible for technology across a director in March 2011. Since joining BP in 1989, number of BP’s businesses. As BP’s chief scientist Helmut has held a number of leadership roles. He she is accountable for developing strategic insights has worked for BP in the US, UK and continental from advances in science and managing technology Europe and within most parts of refining, marketing, capability in BP. trading and gas and power. She joined BP in 1982 as a geologist in exploration and Before taking on his current role, his portfolio of has held various leadership roles across the business. responsibilities as vice president, HR, included She was recognized for her services to the oil industry leading the people agenda for roughly 60,000 people and women in science, technology, engineering and across the globe. mathematics in 2017 and awarded a DBE. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 79


 
The leadership team from 1 July 2020 Murray Auchincloss Giulia Chierchia Emma Delaney Kerry Dryburgh Executive vice president, Executive vice president, Executive vice president, Executive vice president, finance strategy and sustainability customers and products people and culture From 2015 until being announced to Giulia joins BP from McKinsey, where Emma has spent 25 years working in Kerry was previously head of HR for his new position, Murray was chief she was a senior partner. She led the BP, both in the Upstream and the the Upstream and has held a series of financial officer for BP Upstream. He global downstream oil and gas practice Downstream, most recently as regional senior HR positions. She was a key has held other senior roles in the and was a key member of the president, West Africa. Prior to this driver behind the Upstream people segment and spent three years as chemicals and electricity, power and role she held a variety of senior roles: transformation during 2015-2017. Kerry head of the group chief executive’s natural gas practices. She begins this CFO (chief financial officer) for Asia previously ran HR in BP’s shipping, office. He spent his early career in role with more than 10 years’ Pacific, head of business development integrated supply and trading (IST) North America and qualified as a experience in the energy sector, for Upstream gas value chains and and corporate functions teams. She Chartered Financial Analyst. including helping companies shape commercial director for Iraq. She brings experience from other sectors their strategies for the energy was the vice president for integrated in Europe and Asia, having worked at transition. social and economic programmes in both BT and Honeywell before joining Indonesia. In Downstream she held a BP. She currently sits as a non- number of roles in marketing and executive director for the United planning. Kingdom Strategic Command. Carol Howle William Lin Geoff Morell Biographies for the Executive vice president, Executive vice president, Executive vice president, other members of the trading and shipping regions, cities and solutions communications and advocacy leadership team Before taking on her current role, Carol William served as chief operating Geoff has run group communications Bernard Looney, chief executive ran BP shipping and was the chief officer, upstream regions before joining and external affairs (C&EA) since 2017, officer, page 74. operating officer for IST oil. She has the leadership team. Previous senior after six years leading BP America’s more than 20 years’ experience in the roles include vice president – gas communications and government Gordon Birrell, executive energy industry, many in IST. Previous development and operations for Egypt, relations teams. He was instrumental vice-president, production and roles, include chief operating officer regional president for Asia Pacific and in rebuilding BP’s reputation in the operations, page 78. for natural gas liquids, regional leader head of the group chief executive’s years following Deepwater Horizon. of global oil Europe and finance. Carol office. William managed the Prior to BP, Geoff spent four years at David Eyton, executive vice also served as the head of the group successful start-up of the Tangguh the Pentagon, serving as the chief president, innovation and chief executive’s office. LNG facility during his time in spokesperson for the military under engineering, page 78. Indonesia. He is a non-executive presidents Bush and Obama. He Eric Nitcher, executive vice director for Pan American previously worked in television, president, legal, page 79. Energy Group that operates in including as White House Argentina. correspondent for ABC News. Dev Sanyal, executive vice president, gas and low carbon energy, page 79. 80 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Introduction from the chairman “Our new purpose is the result of a period of careful development and wide debate with the management team and also reflects the valuable feedback we have received from a number of our stakeholders, both inside and outside of BP.” Helge Lund Chairman It has been a privilege to lead BP’s board for the past year, New ways of working especially given the important decisions we have taken The board itself is an important component of BP’s leadership. together. BP now begins the new decade with a new direction. The most effective boards – and the most effective board Our new purpose, to reimagine energy for people and our meetings – are inclusive, collaborative, open and transparent. planet, is supported by a new ambition - for BP to get to net During 2019, I was pleased with the support I received from zero by 2050 or sooner, and to help the world get to net zero my colleagues on the board as we fostered an atmosphere too. And we have appointed a new chief executive officer, with the management team in which those standards are Bernard Looney, who under the board’s oversight, will lead clearly exhibited. BP in achieving both its purpose and its ambition. These improvements have gone in-hand with improvements BP’s board has been deeply involved in each of these to the board’s efficiency and productivity. We have strengthened changes. It is the board’s responsibility to define and set how we manage the board’s meeting agenda, the materials the company’s purpose, its values and its strategy, and to developed for the board and the division of labour between the be assured that these are aligned with BP’s culture. Our committees and the board. I believe that these changes have strategy and evolving portfolio have been discussed with enabled us to effectively manage both the leadership succession the management team at every board meeting in 2019. Our and develop our new purpose and ambition. new purpose is the result of a period of careful development Evolving board composition and wide debate with the management team and also reflects The make-up of the board has also evolved, and I expect that the valuable feedback we have received from a number of to continue in future as we seek to ensure we have the right our stakeholders, both inside and outside of BP. balance of skills, experience and diversity. In November last BP’s new leadership year, Nils Andersen was appointed Chairman of Unilever, and During the year, the board, through its nomination and therefore stepped down from BP’s board on 18 March after a governance committee, took equal care in its executive period of transition. On behalf of the board, I thank Nils for his succession planning, including in our appointment of a service to BP. In Nils’ place, Melody Meyer agreed to chair the successor to Bob Dudley. When we began that planning in safety, environment and security assurance committee (SESAC), earnest in autumn 2018, we knew that Bob’s many recognizing her strong operational and safety experience. achievements in the role set a high bar for his eventual Separately, the board has assumed direct oversight of ethics successor. That was reflected in the time we took to define and compliance matters, previously the responsibility of SESAC. the qualities we were looking for in the new leadership of BP One of the chairman’s responsibilities is to ensure cohesion at a time of considerable change. A year on, we were delighted of the board over time, especially during times of transition. to welcome Bernard Looney to the role. He is both capable, To provide continuity, Sir Ian Davis and Brendan Nelson have performance oriented and deeply aware of the importance that kindly agreed to stand for re-election at the 2020 AGM for up to we attach to working in close dialogue with BPs stakeholders. a further year. Because they have now each exceeded nine years BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 81


 
in the role, in putting them forward for re-election this year the board Our stakeholders carefully considered whether, they still demonstrate the necessary This year also marks the first year in which the board is required to qualities of independence. I am pleased to confirm that the board is report on how it has fulfilled its duties under section 172 of the satisfied that they do, and I am grateful for the support and wisdom that Companies Act, which requires directors to promote the success of the Sir Ian and Brendan bring to the board. Our nomination and governance company for the benefit of its members, and in doing so to have regard committee has, as you would expect, begun a process to identify to our stakeholders, including employees, suppliers and customers, the successors to these important roles. impact of our operations on communities and the environment, and the likely consequences of any decision in the long term. While continuity is important, BP’s new direction gives reason to examine whether the board’s composition is optimally aligned to Regard for a wider group of stakeholders is not new. Indeed, it has been BP’s new direction. We’ll always need a core cadre of members with incorporated into the board’s working for some time. But new reporting global executive experience from similar industries, but different requirements are an opportunity to explain the processes we have specialist skills may also be valuable. These include skills relevant to followed, and how dialogue with stakeholders has shaped decisions. BP’s ambition, individuals with strong digital and transformational skills Details can be found on page 66, and information about how the board and those with broader energy and sustainability experience. has engaged with BP’s workforce is on page 88. In light of the changes ahead of us, but also as a consequence of natural Closing thanks succession, I anticipate that we will add new competences and Finally, I want to express my gratitude to Bob Dudley, Bernard Looney, experiences to the board during 2020. the executive team, our employees and my board colleagues for their hard work, their commitment, and their contribution to BP’s new direction. Evolving remuneration structure The year 2019 also marked a transition for executive remuneration. In I look forward to working with our teams to compete effectively in a order to develop a new remuneration policy, which will be proposed at changing energy market. the 2020 AGM, the remuneration committee sought candid feedback from some of our largest shareholders. Consequently, while we will retain our current structure, which is simple and well understood, we will strengthen the elements relating to our energy transition ambition. More details of our new policy are set out in the Directors’ remuneration report on page 100. Helge Lund Chairman 82 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Governance framework Shareholders BP board Audit committee Safety, Geopolitical Remuneration Nomination and Chairman’s HPGR* monitored environment and committee committee governance committee • Financial liquidity. security assurance HPGR monitored Responsibilities committee Responsibilities • Cyber security. committee • Geopolitical. • Recommend Responsibilities • Evaluate • Compliance remuneration • Review performance and HPGR monitored Responsibilities with business principles and composition effectiveness • Monitor marine, • Monitor social, regulations. policy. of board. of chief executive well and pipeline economic and • Trading • Maintain dialogue • Review outside officer. incidents. political events compliance with shareholders commitments • Review the • Oversee effective around the world. and control. and workforce of the NEDs. structure and controls around • Identify major and on remuneration • Maintain strong effectiveness Responsibilities releases at correlated issues. pipeline. of the business • Reviewing facilities and/or geopolitical risks. • Monitor alignment • Review organization. financial explosion. • Consider broader of remuneration developments in • Review system disclosures. • Review and advise political policy and incentives corporate of executive • Monitoring on major security developments. for all employees. development Accountability compliance. incident. governance, • Report on and succession. • Reviewing audit • Cyber security. See page 98. law and ESG. implementation effectiveness, See page 99. Responsibilities of remuneration See page 90. including internal • Review safety and policy. Delegation controls and risk operational risk. management. • Monitor security See page 101. • Advice on external developments. auditor. • Review See page 91. environmental matters. See page 96. Chief executive officer Executive committee Group Group Group Group people Group Resource Technical operations risk financial risk disclosure committee ethics and commitment advisory committee committee committee compliance meeting council committee Framework changes in 2020 As part of the governance framework review, the board committees and their responsibilities will be reviewed. * HPGR – highest priority group risks. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 83


 
Board activities in 2019 Role of the board Strategy Performance and monitoring The board is responsible for the overall During 2019 the board considered the BP strategy at The board reviews financial, operational and safety conduct of the group’s business. Directors every board meeting and held a two-day strategy performance throughout the year, as well as the have duties under the both UK company law discussion in September. The board also received a latest view on expected full-year delivery against and BP’s Articles of Association. The primary number of technical briefings to expand the directors’ external scorecard measures. During the year there tasks of the board in 2019 included: knowledge in particular areas, such as Scope 3 were a number of business and regional reviews, emissions, the BP Energy Outlook and including North Sea, Russia, the lubricants business • Active consideration and establishment of environmental, social and corporate governance and BPX Energy. long-term strategy and approval of the (ESG) matters, to best equip the board to consider Updates are also given on various components of and debate strategic themes relating to BP’s annual plan. value delivery for BP’s business. Regular reports segments, key functions and the impact of the lower • Monitoring of BP’s performance against presented to the board include: the strategy and plan including ethics and carbon transition on the group’s business model. This included looking at long-term energy trends and compliance. • Chief executive’s report. projections for world energy markets. • Group performance report. • Ensuring that the principal and emerging • Group financial outlook. The board monitored the company’s performance risks and uncertainties to BP are identified • Effectiveness of investment review. against the annual plan for 2019 and approved the and that systems of risk management and • Quarterly and full-year results. annual plan for 2020 after taking into account control are in place. • Shareholder distributions. management’s revised assumptions and outlook for • Board and executive management the year. They received regular reports on the In 2019 the board re-assumed primary responsibility succession. progress and implementation of the strategy from for ethics and compliance (E&C), having previously the group chief executive (GCE) and chief financial managed oversight jointly through the SESAC and officer (CFO) by means of a strategic performance the audit committee. The group head of E&C scorecard, which is discussed at each board attended the board meeting four times in 2019, meeting. providing an update on E&C matters, and how the importance of such was embedded within the BP The board undertook portfolio reviews of various culture throughout the business. The board was also parts of the BP group, including upstream, provided ethics and compliance training. The NEDs downstream and renewables. It assessed the held private sessions with the head of E&C. potential impact changes to the portfolio might have on the financial framework and discussed allocation The board reviews the quarterly and full-year results, of capital. The board looked at circular and including shareholder and capital distributions. The “The board is responsible sustainable solutions and business development 2019 annual report was assessed in terms of the opportunities in a low carbon future, through the lens directors’ obligations and reflects the briefings on for establishing the of what was in the best interest of long-term success updated corporate governance requirements and company’s purpose, its of the company. best practice. In a year that saw BP face significant transition, both The board monitors employee opinion via an annual values and strategy, and internally with the announcement of Bob Dudley’s ‘Pulse’ survey which includes measurement of how retirement and more widely as the company looks the BP values are incorporated into culture around satisfying itself that these to play an important role in the world’s energy our global operations. transition, the board discussed BP’s purpose and and its culture are aligned.” ambitions and their alignment with strategy and the Feedback from other stakeholders is also considered BP culture. by the board as part of its monitoring of performance, as outlined in the BP Section 172 statement and on Helge Lund pages 88-89. Chairman 84 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Risk Succession Looking forward, the board is implementing changes to its ways of working and redefining The board, either directly or through its committees, The board, in conjunction with the nomination and its primary responsibilities. As outlined on regularly reviews the processes whereby principal and governance and chairman’s committees, reviews page 66, from 2020, board agendas will be emerging risks are identified, evaluated and managed. succession plans for executive and non-executive structured along the following four distinct directors and senior executives on a regular basis. Each of the highest priority group risks were pillars – strategy, performance, people and The board ensures that potential candidates are reviewed in 2019. The board has a focus on emerging governance. Within those areas the key areas identified and evaluated against objective criteria and risks and how these are being managed and of focus will be: on merit, with due regards to the benefits of diversity mitigated. The board undertook its annual review of of thought, gender, social and ethnic backgrounds Strategy: the board will consider and help cyber security risk in particular in December 2019. and cognitive and personal strengths, through a establish the strategy of BP alongside the Each year the board assesses the effectiveness of formal and rigorous procedure. BP operated board new CEO and leadership team to achieve the group’s system of internal control and risk and senior executive succession planning across the purpose, ambition and aims set out on management as part of the review and sign off of the three horizons. 12 February 2020, see page 6. In doing so, BP Annual Report and Form 20-F, to satisfy itself that the board will ensure that every member of 1. Contingency planning is constantly at the forefront the report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and the board has a deep understanding of the as mitigation against key person risk in cases of understandable, and provides the information board’s role in determining BP’s capital sudden and unforeseen departures. necessary for shareholders to assess the company’s allocation process and enabling effective position, performance, business model and strategy. 2. Medium-term planning relates to the orderly decision making. replacement of board and committee members and Further information on BP’s system of risk Performance: the board will continue to senior executives as they retire or change roles. management is outlined in How we manage risk on perform an important monitoring role, making page 68. 3. Finally, long-term planning seeks to equip BP with sure the CEO and the leadership team are held the skills required now and in the future as we to account against the 2020 Annual Plan to implement the long-term strategy. satisfy itself that BP is performing while transforming. The board employs executive search firms when it concludes that this is an effective way of finding People: the board will focus on reviewing suitable candidates. Bernard Looney’s appointment the composition, skills, experience and as chief executive officer (CEO) resulted from a diversity of the board and executive review of both internal and external candidates. The management, as well as the process for nomination and governance committee engaged with executive succession planning talent external headhunters to source external candidates management and development. It will ensure for this purpose of the CEO succession and in that workforce policies and practices are support of the overall process. consistent with the company’s values and the manner in which BP invests and rewards its • Pamela Daley was appointed to the remuneration workforce is designed and implemented in a committee on 30 January 2019. way that supports the company’s long-term • Nils Andersen was appointed to the nomination sustainable success. and governance and remuneration committees upon becoming the chair of the safety, Governance: as outlined on page 83,the environment and security assurance committee on board is developing a new corporate 8 April 2019. Subsequently Nils stepped down as governance framework. This framework will chair of the safety, environment and security reinforce the effectiveness of the internal assurance committee on 13 November 2019 control framework and be more closely aligned following the announcement of his appointment as with BP’s new purpose and ambition. chairman of Unilever. He was succeeded by Melody Meyer as chair of the SESAC on the same day. He resigned from the board and all other committees on 18 March 2020. • Alan Boeckmann and Admiral Frank Bowman stood down as directors and from all committees following the AGM on 21 May 2019. • Bob Dudley retired as group chief executive and a director on 4 February 2020. Bernard Looney succeeded him as chief executive officer on 5 February 2020. • Brian Gilvary announced his retirement in January 2020. He will be succeeded by Murray Auchincloss on 1 July 2020. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 85


 
Board and committee attendance Nomination and Audit Remuneration Geopolitical governance Chairman’s Non-executive director Board committee SESAC committee committee committee committee Helge Lund 9 (9)  6 (6)  7 (7)  Nils Andersen* 8 (9) 6 (6) 4 (6) 3 (4) 6 (7) Alan Boeckmann 3 (3) 2 (2) 3 (3) 2 (2) 2 (2) Admiral Frank Bowman 3 (3) 2 (2) 2 (2) 2 (2) Dame Alison Carnwath 9 (9) 8 (8) 7 (7) Pamela Daley 9 (9) 7 (8) 8 (8) 6 (7) Sir Ian Davis 9 (9) 8 (9) 4 (4) 6 (6) 7 (7) Professor Dame Ann Dowling 9 (9) 6 (6) 6 (7) Melody Meyer 9 (9) 6 (6)  4 (4) 7 (7) Brendan Nelson 9 (9) 8 (8)  9 (9) 6 (6) 7 (7) Paula Rosput Reynolds 9 (9) 8 (8) 9 (9) 6 (6) 7 (7) Sir John Sawers 9 (9) 6 (6) 4 (4)  6 (6) 7 (7) Executive directors Bob Dudley* 9 (9) Brian Gilvary 9 (9) Chairman of board/committee * Bob Dudley stepped down from the board 4 February; Nils Andersen stepped down from the board 18 March 2020 Background Non-executive director Background and experience Operational Global business People leadership excellence and risk leadership and and organizational Technology, digital Society, politics Finance, risk, Energy markets management governance transformation and innovation and geopolitics trading, etc Dame Alison Carnwath Pamela Daley Sir Ian Davis Professor Dame Ann Dowling Helge Lund Melody Meyer Brendan Nelson Paula Rosput Reynolds Sir John Sawers Diversity At the end of 2019 the board comprised five female directors (2018 5, 2017 3) representing 42% of a 12-person board (46% of an 11 person board at the time BP believes diversity and inclusion is vital to our values, the group strategy and of publication). Our senior management, as defined by the Corporate Governance the success of the company. We understand that better decisions and outcomes Code 2018, and their direct reports comprise 38% female and 18% black, Asian are achieved when we have different people, with differences of opinions from and minority ethnic (BAME) individuals. For details of BP workforce diversity and different backgrounds. inclusion, see Our people on page 47. The board looked at diversity across the We recognize the importance of diversity, whether that be gender, social or group as part of its annual review of HR, capability and talent management. ethnic backgrounds, personal identities, age, religion, physical abilities and more. BP continues to take action to address the broader issue of diversity within These all promote diversity of thought and reduce the risk of groupthink. This the group. approach is followed by the board, senior executives and their direct reports and throughout the BP group. Independence We are committed to attracting the best talent to BP and feel an inclusive and Non-executive directors (NEDs) are expected to be independent in character and respectful work environment, where people are valued as individuals, is key. judgement and free from any business or other relationship that could materially When reviewing the composition of the board, the nomination and governance interfere with exercising that judgement. It is the board’s view that all BP NEDs committee reviews not only the skills and experience of existing board members, are independent. but also their background and diversity. Equally, when seeking to identify candidates to join the board, the committee gives consideration to merits of The board is satisfied that there is no compromise to the independence of, and diversity, including gender, in helping to bring greater balance to the board’s nothing to give rise to conflicts of interest for, those directors who serve together discussion and debates on strategy and associated matters. as directors on other company’s boards or who hold other external appointments. Directors are required to provide the board with sufficient information to evaluate Diversity is considered as an integral part of succession planning. Executive gender their independence and the board keeps the other interests of the NEDs under and ethnicity were taken into consideration as part of the board’s wider executive review and regularly reviews the conflicts of interest register. succession review in 2019, while diversity of thought, deriving from a robust combination of gender, social or ethnic backgrounds, was a prominent factor in the Sir Ian Davis and Brendan Nelson are proposed for re-election notwithstanding selection process, ensuring that BP has a diverse executive pipeline. that they have both served beyond nine years as non-executive directors. 86 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Following careful consideration, the board believes that both Sir Ian and Brendan Learning, development and inductions continue to provide constructive challenge and robust scrutiny of matters that The board held a number of developmental briefing sessions during the year, in which come before the board and the committees on which they serve. Neither director field experts with a range of academic and practical knowledge were invited to provide has served simultaneously with an executive director for over nine years and the bespoke training sessions, updating them on latest intelligence in their particular area. overall average tenure of the board is similar to that of the average FTSE 100 This develops and optimizes the skill set within the board on evolving technical topics directors’ tenure. In 2018 the board undertook significant refreshment of its and aids conversation around strategic planning. composition with a number of new non-executives and a new chairman. Since assuming the chairmanship of the board at the beginning of the year, Helge Lund The board continued to build its knowledge of the BP business through briefings has led the process to identify and, in October 2019, to announce the and site visits as part of its learning programme, see examples on page 89. appointment of a new group CEO. This was supplemented by a process to identify and, in January 2020, announce the appointment of a new group CFO. No new directors were appointed during 2019. In October 2019, BP announced that Sir Ian and Brendan will play crucial roles in the transition period as these new Bob Dudley would be retiring in 2020, succeeded by Bernard Looney. Bernard’s appointments come into effect, so that BP’s culture and values are not adversely functional and operational knowledge of BP meant that an in-depth induction impacted and that the integrity of its financial reporting is maintained. After programme was not necessary. Nonetheless, Bernard attended a number of town careful consideration, the board is satisfied that Sir Ian and Brendan continue halls with Helge Lund in 2019 to engage with BP people. to demonstrate the qualities of independence in carrying out their duties. Board evaluation Appointment and time commitment Each year, BP completes a review of the board, its committees and of the The chairman and NEDs each have letters of appointment. There is no term limit individual directors. It is generally recommended that such reviews are externally on a director’s service, as BP proposes all directors for annual re-election by led once every three years. Having undertaken an externally facilitated review in shareholders in line with best governance practice. 2018, the 2019 evaluation was facilitated by the incoming company secretary. The process involved interviews with each member of the board based around a The chairman’s letter of appointment sets out the time commitment expected of number of themes, including strategy formulation and portfolio development, the him. The NEDs’ letters of appointment do not set out a fixed time commitment. role of the new chairman and boardroom dynamics, the evolution of BP’s purpose The time required of directors fluctuates depending on the demands of BP and wider stakeholder engagement and the processes in place for managing business and other events. They are expected to allocate appropriate time to BP succession across the organization. Positive feedback was received on the new to perform their duties effectively and make themselves available for all regular chairman’s style and the benefits his inclusive leadership approach had brought to and ad hoc meetings. The board believes that, notwithstanding the NEDs’ other the board during the year. The outputs of this review highlighted three areas of appointments, they have sufficient time to fulfil their BP duties. future focus and attention: Executive directors are normally permitted to take up one board appointment at • Reviewing the composition, skills, experience and diversity of the board and an external listed company, subject to the agreement of the chairman and after the process for executive succession planning talent management and consultation with the company secretary. In February 2020, Brian Gilvary was development. appointed as a non-executive director of Barclays PLC. An announcement in • Ensuring every member of the board has a deep understanding of the board’s respect of Brian’s plans to retire as CFO of BP was made in January 2020. He will role in determining BP’s capital allocation process and enabling effective stay in the role until June 2020 to work with his successor, Murray Auchincloss, decision making. in order to ensure an orderly transition. Given these circumstances and after • Re-shaping the BP corporate governance framework and how this it should consideration by the chairman and company secretary, it was concluded that reinforce the effectiveness of the internal control framework and be more Brian’s role at Barclays PLC was unlikely to be detrimental to his duties as closely aligned with BP’s new purpose and ambition. outgoing CFO. Fees received for an external appointment may be retained by the executive director and are reported in the Directors’ remuneration report (see A new corporate governance framework is in development, supported by the page 100). Neither the chairman nor the senior independent director are outputs from this year’s board review process, with the aim of ensuring that this employed as an executive of the group. new framework is in place by the time that the new organizational structure and reporting arrangements take effect. The board also considers all NED external appointments and considers the impact those requiring significant commitment might have on the director’s ability to UK Corporate Governance Code compliance dedicate sufficient capacity in times of increased demand. In November 2019, the board acknowledged the appointment of Nils Andersen as Chairman of BP complied throughout 2019 with the principles and provisions of the 2018 UK Unilever NV/PLC and accepted his resignation from the BP board. Nils remained Corporate Governance Code except in the following aspects: as a non-executive director until March 2020 to support Melody Meyer who took Provision 33 over as chair of the SESAC in November 2019. The remuneration of the chairman is not set by the remuneration committee. Instead, the chairman’s remuneration is reviewed by the remuneration committee which makes a recommendation to the board as a whole for final approval, within the limits set by shareholders. This wider process enables all board members to discuss and approve the chairman’s remuneration, rather than solely the members of the remuneration committee. Provision 38 The pension arrangements for Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary reflect the historical retirement benefits available to employees that joined BP at similar times. We recognize that the contribution rates under these arrangements are higher than the majority of the current workforce and as such the pension contributions for the new executive directors, Bernard Looney and Murray Auchincloss, have been aligned with those available to the majority of the workforce. A copy of the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code is available at frc.org.uk. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 87


 
How the board has engaged with shareholders, the workforce and other stakeholders Shareholders In 2019 the AGM was held in Aberdeen for the first time, which enabled the board to engage with shareholders who might not have had the Institutional investors opportunity to attend a meeting before. There were two shareholder The company engages with its institutional shareholders through its requisitioned resolutions put to the meeting in 2019. active investor relations programme. The board receives feedback on shareholder views in many ways, particularly through the chairman and All resolutions supported by the board, including the shareholder senior management who meet regularly with shareholders throughout resolution from the Climate Action 100+ group, passed at the meeting, the year, as well as through the results of an independent investor study see page 6. The shareholder resolution from Follow This, which was not and report. supported by the board, did not pass. In September 2019 the chair of the remuneration committee hosted an Each year the board receives a report after the AGM giving a breakdown event for large investors on considerations for the new remuneration of the votes and investor feedback on its voting decisions to inform it on policy which is to be tabled at the 2020 AGM in May (see Remuneration any issues arising. committee report on page 101). The chairman also held one-to-one meetings with major institutional investors during the year, collecting Workforce their views and sharing these with the other board members and the At BP we believe a diverse and engaged workforce is critical to us remuneration committee. successfully delivering our group strategy. BP strives to create an open During the course of the year, senior management met regularly with culture where dialogue between the board, senior management and institutional investors through road shows, group and one-to-one the workforce, which includes a wide range of employees, contractors, meetings, events for socially responsible investors (SRIs), meetings agency and remote workers across all of its geographical locations, is with various investors to discuss environment, social and governance encouraged and expected. ‘Respect’ and ‘courage’ are two of our matters, and oil and gas sector conferences. corporate values that underpin this and are embedded in our performance management system. Employees are informed of In May 2019, the chairman and board committee chairs held their information on matters of concern to them as employees through BP’s annual investor event. This meeting enabled BP’s largest shareholders intranet and local sites, social media channels, town halls, site visits to hear about the work of the board and its committees and for and webinars including topics such as quarterly results, strategy, the investors to share their views directly with non-executive directors. low carbon transition and diversity. We have a number of employee-led See bp.com/investors for investor and strategy presentations, including the forums and business resource groups and aim to build constructive group’s financial results and information on the work of the board and its relationships with labour unions formally representing some employees. committees. Employees are consulted on a regular basis through regular team and Shareholder engagement cycle 2019 one-to-one meetings and through our annual ‘Pulse’ survey. These initiatives are applied where practicable. • Fourth quarter and full year 2018 results and strategy update Q1 Our annual employee ‘Pulse’ survey results for overall engagement, • Investor roadshows with executive management – fourth long-term cultural metrics and listening and involvement have shown quarter and full year 2018 results a steady and sustained improvement over this period, see page 47. • BP Energy Outlook presentation • BP Annual Report 2018 launch With such a diverse and globally distributed workforce, we believe • BP Sustainability Report 2018 launch ongoing dialogue through multiple channels is the best way for the Q2 • Chairman and board committee chairs meeting with investors board and management to engage with our people and listen to what • UKSA (retail shareholders’) meeting with the chairman they have to say. The board is firmly of the opinion that face-to-face • First quarter 2019 results presentation interaction with our people is the best way to get direct feedback and • Annual general meeting an understanding of the important issues of the workforce, as well as • BP Statistical Review of World Energy launch deepen the board’s operational understanding. Only by visiting and Q3 • Second quarter 2019 results presentation meeting with employees from all aspects of the business can the board • Investor roadshows with executive management following fully assess the culture and tone of BP. The board held a number of site 2Q results visits in 2019 to a number of different locations, including Busan, Kuala Q4 • Third quarter 2019 results presentation Lumpur, Singapore, Aberdeen and Denver. A number of non-executive • Investor roadshows with executive management following directors also took opportunities to engage directly with local workforce 3Q results at various BP offices around the globe. As part of Helge Lund’s first year as chairman, he conducted town hall meetings with the workforce in Washington DC, Baku, Rotterdam, Beijing, Houston and London. Retail investors BP held an event for retail investors in conjunction with the UK The board and its committees are committed to meeting with a Shareholders’ Association (UKSA) in 2019. The chairman and a wide range of employees across the entire workforce and at times representative from investor relations gave presentations on BP’s exclude senior management from meetings to get the unfettered annual results, strategy and the work of the board. Shareholders’ opinions of their teams. An example of this was the SESAC’s visit questions were focused on BP’s activities and performance. to a new LNG vessel off the coast of South Korea immediately prior to its maiden voyage. This was the first shipping visit of its kind, AGM during which members of the SESAC held private informal meetings Voting levels were relatively consistent at 67.1% (of issued share capital, with the ship’s crew, away from senior officers. The crew highlighted including votes cast as withheld) in 2019, compared to 67.3% in 2018. a couple of potential improvements, the SESAC members agreed The lower voting level of 50.8% in 2017 was due to the negative impact and, as a consequence, certain improvements were undertaken by of stock lending. shipping leadership. 88 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance As an example of how engagement has directly contributed to shaping scheme to more employees across the group. The board will dedicate policy, in 2019 we launched a new global commitment to minimum time to specifically review the outputs from the various channels of parental leave for new parents. This policy was established through workforce engagement at board sessions. engagement with our employee-led business resource groups and The board believes the existing approaches and mechanisms described employee forums, including the working parents’ forum. above enable comprehensive two-way engagement opportunities BP invests in its workforce through a number of employee share with BP’s workforce, and as such, is satisfied that these are effective ownership schemes and plans. For example, we operate ‘ShareMatch’ alternatives to the proposed workforce engagement methods set out in more than 50 countries. The plan matches BP shares purchased by in Provision 5 of the Code. Given the current period of transition within our employees. We also operate a group-wide discretionary share plan, BP, the board will continue to review its engagement mechanisms to which rewards employees with participation in BP’s equity at different seek new ways to strengthen existing workforce forums to ensure a levels globally and is linked to BP performance. continuing robust relationship and collaboration. As we look to achieve our purpose, ambition and aims – engagement Other stakeholders with our global talent pool is as critical as ever. BP wants to recruit, retain and reward people from wide-ranging and diverse backgrounds For details of how the board complied with Section 172 of the who can support us in the global transition to a low carbon energy Companies Act 2006 and how it further engaged with other system. We will continue to expand our existing networks of stakeholders, see page 66. communication to foster a listening culture that enables the board and management to gain meaningful insight directly from our colleagues around the world, and respond accordingly. For instance, following feedback from BP’s working parents’ forum, agile working and parental leave policies have been improved, and in response to growing demand 300 from our workforce, BP introduced a way for some employees to offset employees attended their personal carbon emissions and is working towards expanding this the town hall presented by Helge Lund and Bob Dudley. Site visits Denver The board visited BP’s Denver office in September 2019 where they hosted Aberdeen several employee events. A town hall Following the AGM in Aberdeen, the Members of the board had further took place, led by Helge Lund, with the board held a number of engagement engagement with the workforce at the rest of the board present to talk with activities. Helge Lund and Bob Dyce office, observing new agile ways the workforce and answer questions Dudley led a town hall which was of working and gaining technological over a community lunch with over 150 attended by over 300 employees at insight into new initiatives. Members employees in attendance. The board was BP’s Dyce office and streamed live to of the board also visited the Clair also introduced to emerging talent in the the offshore teams in the North Sea. Ridge platform, where they learnt region and met with senior leadership. The board hosted a business more about operations offshore. As part of the suite of events the board reception, inviting members of the They discussed the safety agenda also met with external stakeholders local community, local political and onsite, visited the drilling floor and at a business reception in the city. government officials, employees and spoke with employees directly to local businesses. better understand the culture when 150 working offshore. employees attended a community lunch with the board. South Korea The SESAC visited BP’s shipping function and spent a day at sea in Kuala Lumpur and Singapore South Korea on board a new LNG Members of the audit committee vessel. They experienced the vessel visited the global business services in a period of ‘shakedown’ ahead of in Kuala Lumpur. Touring BP’s going into service. The committee offices gave valuable insight into observed safety processes in action the workforce which has been and were able to discuss physical responsible for centralizing and and cyber security planning. standardizing key business processes Members of the SESAC met with across the organization and sea farers without management transforming processes end-to-end. present to discuss life working on The directors then visited the IST board the vessels. team in Singapore where they met “The committee members with senior leadership and the wider workforce at BP’s offices. noted strong morale.” BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 89


 
Nomination and governance committee Role of the committee The committee seeks to ensure an orderly succession of candidates for directors, the company secretary and senior executives and oversees corporate governance matters for the group. Key responsibilities • Identify, evaluate and recommend candidates for appointment or reappointment as directors. • Review the outside directorships/commitments of the Non-Executive Directors (NEDs). • Review the mix of knowledge, skills, experience and diversity of the board for the orderly succession of directors. • Identify, evaluate and recommend candidates for appointment as company secretary. • Review developments in law, regulation and best practice relating to corporate governance and make “The committee dedicated a significant recommendations to the board on appropriate action, including on Environmental, Social and amount of time to its role in 2019 and this Governance matters. will continue as BP implements its new Membership purpose, ambition and aims.” Helge Lund Member since July 2018 and chairman since September 2018 Helge Lund Alan Boeckmann Member Committee chair (resigned April 2019) Sir Ian Davis Member Nils Andersen Member (resigned March 2020) Chairman’s introduction Brendan Nelson Member Paula Reynolds Member The committee dedicated a significant amount of time to its role in 2019, a Sir John Sawers Member year which was vitally important for BP and the future direction of the company. This will continue as BP implements its new purpose, ambition Meetings and attendance and aims. The committee met six times in 2019. All members attended each meeting with the exception of Nils During the year the committee led the search for a new CEO to succeed Andersen who missed two meetings owing to prior Bob Dudley. This involved agreeing the leadership credentials and desired commitments. experiences for the executive role. External headhunters were engaged to support the process and to identify candidates with the required skills, Activities during the year experience and diversity credentials. After a thorough and transparent 2019 saw the workload and required time commitment of committee members increase significantly as the process, Bernard Looney was identified as the best suited candidate and committee continued to monitor the composition and his appointment was announced in October 2019. skills of the board, with foresight across the three The committee’s focus on executive succession planning continued, and succession planning horizons, as part of the process BP announced Murray Auchincloss as Brian Gilvary’s successor as CFO in of developing a reinvented BP. January 2020. During the year, it supported the board in the selection of the new CEO, which was announced Finally, a review was undertaken by the committee of the new leadership in October 2019, and the new CFO, which was team which was announced in February 2020. announced in January 2020. Regular updates were As part of the selection and appointment process for each of these roles, provided to the chairman’s committee to ensure that all NEDs were kept informed of the pending changes candidates completed extensive leadership assessment testing and were to BP’s executive leadership. The committee also asked to give insight to their aims for BP’s future. reviewed the wider executive team’s succession During the year the committee also undertook a review of the executive planning, considered the implications of the new UK succession pipeline, considering the process, emerging talent and Corporate Governance Code 2018 and made recommendations to the board following the leadership role key-person-risks. As part of this review, the committee results of the external board evaluation in 2018. took into account the importance of diverse talent pipelines and the current We will continue to focus on ensuring that the and future skill sets required to help the company achieve its strategy board’s composition is strong and diverse and to The committee discussed the implications of the UK Corporate Governance promote best practice governance in the boardroom and throughout the company. Code 2018 and how to maintain the highest standards of governance. Lastly, the committee considered the findings of the 2018 board evaluation and made proposals to the board on new ways of working. Together with the results from the 2019 board review, these changes are being incorporated into a new corporate governance framework. Helge Lund Committee chair 90 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Audit committee Role of the committee The committee monitors the effectiveness of the group’s financial reporting, systems of internal control and risk management and the integrity of the group’s external and internal audit processes. Key responsibilities • Monitoring and obtaining assurance that the process to identify, manage and mitigate principal and emerging financial risks are appropriately addressed by the chief executive officer and that the system of internal control is designed and implemented effectively in support of the limits imposed by the board (‘executive limitations’), as set out in the BP board governance principles. • Reviewing financial statements and other financial disclosures and monitoring compliance with relevant legal and listing requirements. “The committee robustly challenges • Reviewing the effectiveness of the group audit function, BP’s internal financial controls and reports...enabling it to determine systems of internal control and risk management. whether BP’s financial reporting is • Overseeing the appointment, remuneration, fair, balanced and understandable.” independence and performance of the external auditor and the integrity of the audit process as a whole, including the engagement of the external Brendan Nelson auditor to supply non-audit services to BP. Committee chair • Reviewing the systems in place to enable those who work for BP to raise concerns about possible improprieties in financial reporting or other issues and for those matters to be investigated. Chairman’s introduction Membership During 2019, in keeping with the new UK Corporate Governance Code Brendan Nelson Member since November 2010 2018, the committee continued its focus on monitoring the integrity of and chair since April 2011 the group’s financial reporting and risk management systems. Each Dame Alison Member quarter the committee robustly challenges the reports from management Carnwath and the external auditor highlighting significant accounting issues and Pamela Daley Member judgements, enabling it to determine whether BP’s financial reporting is Paula Reynolds Member ‘fair, balanced and understandable’. Throughout the year, the committee Brendan Nelson is chair of the audit committee. He reviewed the group’s principal and emerging risks, including scenarios was formerly vice chairman of KPMG and president of which could impact the company’s long-term viability which also helped the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Scotland. to inform the committee’s debates on what would constitute significant Currently he is chairman of the group audit committee failings and weaknesses in our system of internal control. of NatWest Markets plc and a member of the Financial Reporting Review Panel. The board is satisfied that he In 2019 the committee focused on the effectiveness of a number of is the audit committee member with recent and group functions including integrated supply and trading, treasury, tax, relevant financial experience as outlined in the UK information technology and security. We also received presentations Corporate Governance Code and competence in regarding, and reviewed performance of, both the Upstream and accounting and auditing as required by the FCA’s Downstream segments and regularly considered climate change risk Corporate Governance Rules in DTR7. It considers that affecting the whole business. These reviews helped inform the the committee as a whole has an appropriate and committee of the work and future plans of those functions and experienced blend of commercial, financial and audit expertise to assess the issues it is required to address, businesses and enabled the committee to understand the key risks and as well as competence in the oil and gas sector. The challenges (and associated mitigations and lessons learned) faced by board also determined that the audit committee meets each of them. In addition, the committee carried out reviews into the the independence criteria provisions of Rule 10A-3 of group risks of financial liquidity, cyber security and compliance with the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and that business regulations. Brendan may be regarded as an audit committee financial expert as defined in Item 16A of Form 20-F. There were no changes to the committee membership during the year and the skills and experience of our committee members remain strong, Meetings and attendance enabling the committee to continue to perform effectively. There were eight committee meetings in 2019. All members attended each meeting with the exception of Brendan Nelson Pamela Daley who was absent from the September Committee chair meeting owing to prior commitments. Regular attendees at the meetings include the chief financial officer, group controller, chief accounting officer, group head of audit, group general counsel and external auditor. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 91


 
Activities during the year The committee reviewed the group’s programme of controls and contingencies for managing this risk, including enhanced approaches to monitor the risk in light of business evolution (such as an increase in How the committee reviewed financial disclosure venturing), as well as other internal and external trends. The committee also The committee reviewed the quarterly, half-year and annual financial reviewed key areas of BP’s legal function that advise on compliance matters. statements with management, focusing on the: Cyber security risk: including inappropriate access to or misuse of • Integrity of the group’s financial reporting process. information and systems and disruption of business activity. • Clarity of disclosure. The committee reviewed ongoing developments in the cyber security • Compliance with relevant legal and financial reporting standards. landscape, including events in the oil and gas industry and within BP • Application of accounting policies and judgements. itself. The review focused on a strengthened approach in order to As part of its review, the committee received quarterly updates from manage the ever increasing threat of cyber risk and maintain cyber management and the external auditor in relation to accounting judgements security, as the focus on a digital transformation across BP continues. and estimates including those relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, Financial liquidity: including the risk associated with external market recoverability of asset carrying values and other matters. The committee conditions, supply and demand and prices achieved for BP’s products keeps under review the frequency of results reporting during the year. which could impact financial performance. The committee reviewed the assessment and reporting of longer-term The committee reviewed the key assumptions, and underlying viability, systems of risk management and internal control, including the judgements, used to manage the group’s liquidity, and capital reporting and categorization of risk across the group and the examination investments (including appraisal, effectiveness and efficiency). of what might constitute a significant failing or weakness in the system of internal control. It also examined the group’s modelling for stress testing different financial and operational events, and considered whether the How other reviews were undertaken period covered by the company’s viability statement was appropriate. Other reviews undertaken in 2019 by the committee included the The committee considered the BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 and following, and in each case where the committee received segment and assessed whether the report was fair, balanced and understandable and function reviews, each reported on strategy, performance, capability and provided the information necessary for shareholders to assess the group’s risk management as well as on their first, second and third lines of position and performance, business model and strategy. In making this defence policies as appropriate: assessment, the committee examined disclosures during the year, • Non-operated joint venture: including management of exposure to discussed the requirement with senior management, confirmed that financial, reputational and regulatory risks. representations to the external auditors had been evidenced and reviewed • Upstream: including strategy, business model, financial performance reports relating to internal control over financial reporting. The committee and risk management. made a recommendation to the board, which in turn reviewed the report as • Downstream: including strategy, performance, capability and risk a whole, confirmed the assessment and approved the report’s publication. management. Other disclosures reviewed included: • Tax: including strategy, performance, key drivers of the group’s effective tax rate, the global indirect tax environment, the tax • Oil and gas reserves. modernization programme and the evolving approach to management • Pensions and post-retirement benefits assumptions. of key risks. • Risk factors. • Other businesses and corporate: including overview of the • Legal liabilities. businesses and functional activities, financial performance and • Tax strategy. financial control framework. • Going concern. • Treasury: including performance, capability, and risk management. • IFRS 16 (lease accounting). • Integrated supply and trading: including strategy, performance, capability and risk management. How risks were reviewed • Capability and succession in BP’s finance function, including the group’s finance summary of change programme. • Effectiveness of investment: annual review of performance of The principal risks allocated to the audit committee for monitoring in projects with sanctioned capital over a certain threshold. 2019 included those associated with: • Assessment of financial metrics for executive remuneration: Trading activities: including risks arising from shortcomings or failures consideration of financial performance for the group’s 2019 annual in systems, risk management methodology, internal control processes cash bonus scorecard and performance share plan, including or employees. adjustments to plan conditions and non-operating items. • Internal controls: assessments of management’s plans to remediate In reviewing this risk, the committee focused on external market the external auditor’s findings. developments and how BP’s trading function had responded to a rapidly • Information technology and security: including an update on the changing environment, including modernizing its control environment transformation of the function to enable the digitization and policies to strengthen its compliance and control culture. The committee modernization of the firm at pace. further considered updates in the integrated supply and trading function’s risk management programme, including compliance with regulatory developments, activities in response to cyber threats, and How internal control and risk management efficiencies derived from more collaborative ways of working across was assessed group functions and businesses and the use of digital technologies. Group audit Compliance with business and regulations: including ethical The committee received quarterly reports on the findings of group audit in misconduct or breaches of applicable laws or regulations that could 2019, including their assessment of issues raised in previous years, damage BP’s reputation, adversely affect operational results and/or especially those relating to IT access controls. The committee met shareholder value and potentially affect BP’s licence to operate. 92 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance privately with the group head of audit and key members of his leadership How the committee assessed audit effectiveness team. The committee monitored and reviewed the effectiveness of Management undertook a survey which comprised questions across internal audit and considered whether it had the appropriate level of five main criteria to measure the auditor’s performance: independence and its importance in assessing the company culture. • Robustness of the audit process. Training • Independence and objectivity. The committee considered market updates and developments throughout • Quality of delivery. the year including the CMA statutory audit market study, the Brydon • Quality of people and service. Review and the Kingman Review. It received technical updates from the • Value added advice. chief accounting officer on developments in financial reporting and The results of the survey indicated that the external auditor’s performance accounting policy, in particular an update on IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ and the was broadly comparable with the previous year. Areas with high scores and stakeholder engagement disclosures required under The Companies favourable comments included quality of accounting and auditing judgement (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 2018 for the 2019 accounting year, and robust stance on issues. Areas for improvement were identified but and amendments to IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ for interest rate none impacted on the effectiveness of the audit, mostly in recognition of it benchmark reform from the start of 2020. having been Deloitte’s first year in role. The results of the survey were GBS and integrated supply and trading visit discussed with Deloitte for consideration in their 2019 audit approach. In March the committee visited BP’s global business services (GBS) The committee held private meetings with the external auditor during centre in Kuala Lumpur. During the visit they met with the head of country the year and the committee chair met separately with the external and his leadership team who presented GBS strategy to 2025 enabling auditor and group head of audit at least quarterly. modernization of BP through accelerated standardization, digital solutions and process transformation – underpinned by a global functional operating The effectiveness of the external auditor is evaluated by the audit model. They also met with the Procurement and HR services teams committee. The committee assessed the auditor’s approach to providing including an interactive session with local business resource colleagues. audit services. On the basis of such assessment, the committee concluded that the audit team was providing the required quality in In March the committee also visited BP’s integrated supply and trading relation to the provision of the services. The audit team had shown the (IST) function in Singapore, meeting with senior leaders to discuss the necessary commitment and ability to provide the services together with role of this function in BP, review of the risks and controls processes a demonstrable depth of knowledge, robustness, independence and and a floor walk through key functions and the trading desks. See page objectivity as well as an appreciation of complex issues. The team had 89 for more information on these visits by the committee. posed constructive challenge to management where appropriate. In October, the committee held its meeting at BP’s IST function in London The committee specifically considered the findings of the FRC’s Audit and conducted its annual tour, which covered global oil strategy, integrated Quality Review team’s review of Deloitte’s 2018 audit. The committee gas and power, associated key risks and risk and compliance management noted the single observation raised and Deloitte’s proposed response and how the function was responding to a fast evolving market by using thereto. Overall the committee noted the review did not raise any digital tools to drive efficiencies. The following trading desks were visited concerns in respect of audit quality. by the committee: treasury trading, global environmental products and integrated gas and power. How the auditor reappointment and independence was assessed The committee considers the reappointment of the external auditor each External audit year before making a recommendation to the board. The committee How the committee assessed audit risk assesses the independence of the external auditor on an ongoing basis and The external auditor set out its audit strategy for 2019, identifying significant the external auditor is required to rotate the lead audit partner every five audit risks to be addressed during the course of the audit. These included: years and other senior audit staff every five to seven years. No partners or • Focus on the consistency of management’s judgements and senior staff associated with the BP audit may transfer to the group. estimates within BP’s strategy in the context of climate change. How the committee had oversight of non-audit services • Responding to the risk of material misstatements in the group, by The audit committee is responsible for BP’s policy on non-audit services way of substantive testing and the use of detailed data analytics. and the approval of non-audit services. Audit objectivity and independence • The risk of impairment of upstream oil and gas property, plant and is safeguarded through the prohibition of non-audit tax services and the equipment, and exploration and appraisal assets. limitation of audit-related work which falls within defined categories. BP’s • Accounting for structured commodity transactions in the integrated policy on non-audit services states that the auditor may not perform supply and trading function. non-audit services that are prohibited by the SEC, Public Company • Valuation of level 3 financial instruments held by the integrated supply Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB), International Auditing and Assurance and trading function. Standards Board (IAASB) and the UK Financial Reporting Council (FRC). • Management override of controls. The audit committee approves the terms of all audit services as well as The committee received updates during the year on the audit process, permitted audit-related and non-audit services in advance. The external including how the auditor had challenged the group’s assumptions on auditor is considered for permitted non-audit services only when its these issues. expertise and experience of BP is important. How the committee assessed audit fees Approvals for individual engagements of pre-approved permitted services The audit committee reviews the fee structure, resourcing and terms of below certain thresholds are delegated to the group controller or the chief engagement for the external auditor annually; in addition it reviews the financial officer. Any proposed service not included in the permitted non-audit services that the auditor provides to the group on a quarterly basis. services categories must be approved in advance either by the audit Fees paid to the external auditor for the year were $49 million (2018 $42 committee chairman or the audit committee before engagement million), of which 2% was for non-audit assurance work (see Financial commences. The audit committee, chief financial officer and group statements – Note 36). The audit committee is satisfied that this level of controller monitor overall compliance with BP’s policy on audit-related and fee is appropriate in respect of the audit services provided and that an non-audit services, including whether the necessary pre-approvals have effective audit can be conducted for this fee. Non-audit or non-audit been obtained. The categories of permitted and pre-approved services are related assurance fees were $1 million (2018 $2 million). Non-audit or outlined in Principal accountant’s fees and services on page 322. non-audit related services consisted of other assurance services. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 93


 
How accounting judgements and estimates were considered and addressed Key judgements and estimates Audit committee activity Conclusions/outcomes in financial reporting Exploration and appraisal intangible assets BP uses technical and commercial judgements when • Reviewed exploration write-offs as part of the • Exploration write-offs totalling $0.6 billion were accounting for oil and gas exploration, appraisal and group’s quarterly due diligence process. recognized during the year. development expenditure and in determining the • Received the output of management’s annual • Exploration intangibles totalled $14.1 billion at group’s estimated oil and gas reserves. intangible asset certification process used to 31 December 2019. ensure accounting criteria to continue to carry the • BP believes it is appropriate to continue to Judgement is required to determine whether it is exploration intangible balance are met. capitalize the costs relating to intangible assets, on appropriate to continue to carry intangible assets • Received briefings on the status of upstream the ‘watch-list’. related to exploration costs on the balance sheet. intangible assets, including the status of items on the intangible assets ‘watch-list’. Recoverability of asset carrying values Determination as to whether and how much an • Held an in-depth review of BP’s policy and • The group’s long-term price assumption for Brent asset, cash generating unit (CGU) or group of CGUs guidelines for compliance with oil and gas oil, was reduced by $5 from 2018 assumptions containing goodwill is impaired involves management reserves disclosure regulation, including the and was unchanged for Henry Hub gas. judgement and estimates on uncertain matters such group’s reserves governance framework • The period over which the group’s price as future commodity prices, discount rates, and controls. assumptions transition from recent market prices production profiles, reserves and the impact of • Reviewed the group’s oil and gas price to the long-term assumption was unchanged at inflation on operating expenses. assumptions. five years for Brent oil and increased from 5 to 12 • Reviewed the group’s discount rates for years for Henry Hub gas from 2018. Reserves estimates based on management’s impairment testing purposes. • A sensitivity analysis estimating the effect of assumptions for future commodity prices have a • Upstream impairment charges, reversals and reductions in the price assumptions has been direct impact on the assessment of the recoverability ‘watch-list’ items were reviewed as part of the disclosed in Note 1. of asset carrying values reported in the financial quarterly due diligence process. • The methodology for determining the group’s statements. discount rates used for impairment testing was enhanced, resulting in country-specific rates being applied. • Impairments of $6.6 billion were recorded in the year, net of impairment reversals, primarily relating to decisions to dispose of certain assets. Investment in Rosneft Judgement is required in assessing the level of • Reviewed the judgement on whether the group • BP has retained significant influence over Rosneft control or influence over another entity in which the continues to have significant influence over throughout 2019 as defined by IFRS. group holds an interest. Rosneft, including following Bob Dudley stepping down from his role as BP group chief executive. BP uses the equity method of accounting for its • Considered IFRS guidance on evidence of investment in Rosneft and BP’s share of Rosneft’s oil participation in policy-making processes. and natural gas reserves is included in the group’s • Received reports from management which estimated net proved reserves of equity-accounted assessed the extent of significant influence, entities. including BP’s participation in decision-making. The equity-accounting treatment of BP’s 19.75% interest in Rosneft continues to be dependent on the judgement that BP has significant influence over Rosneft. 94 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Key judgements and estimates Audit committee activity Conclusions/outcomes in financial reporting Derivative financial instruments For its level 3 derivative financial instruments, BP • Received a briefing on the group’s trading risks • BP considers that longer-term contracts to buy or estimates their fair values using internal models due and reviewed the system of risk management and sell LNG do not meet the definition of a derivative to the absence of quoted market pricing or other controls in place. under IFRS. BP has assets and liabilities of $5.5 observable, market-corroborated data. Judgement • The committee annually reviews the control and $4.4 billion respectively, recognized on the may be required to determine whether contracts to process and risks relating to the trading business. balance sheet for level 3 derivative financial buy or sell commodities meet the definition of a instruments at 31 December 2019, mainly relating derivative, in particular longer-term LNG contracts. to the activities of the integrated supply and trading function (IST). • BP’s use of internal models to value certain of these contracts has been disclosed in Note 30. Provisions BP’s most significant provisions relate to • Received briefings on decommissioning, • Decommissioning provisions of $15.1 billion decommissioning, environmental remediation environmental, asbestos and litigation provisions, were recognized on the balance sheet at and litigation. including those related to the Gulf of Mexico oil 31 December 2019. spill. These included the requirements, • The discount rate used by BP to determine the The group holds provisions for the future governance and controls for the development balance sheet obligation at the end of 2019 was decommissioning of oil and natural gas production and approval of cost estimates and provisions a nominal rate of 2.5% – based on long-dated facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic in the financial statements. US government bonds – a reduction of 0.5% lives. Most of these decommissioning events are • Reviewed the group’s discount rates for from 2018. many years in the future and the exact requirements calculating provisions. • The impact of applying the revised rate has that will have to be met when a removal event occurs been disclosed. are uncertain. Assumptions are made by BP in relation to settlement dates, technology, legal requirements and discount rates. The timing and amounts of future cash flows are subject to significant uncertainty and estimation is required in determining the amounts of provisions to be recognized. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits Accounting for pensions and other post-retirement • Reviewed the group’s assumptions used to • The method for determining the group’s benefits involves making estimates when measuring determine the projected benefit obligation at assumptions remained largely unchanged from the group’s pension plan surpluses and deficits. the year end, including the discount rate, rate 2018. The values of these assumptions and a These estimates require assumptions to be made of inflation, salary growth and mortality levels. sensitivity analysis of the impact of possible about uncertain events, including discount rates, changes on the benefit expense and obligation inflation and life expectancy. are provided in Note 24. • At 31 December 2019, surpluses of $7.1 billion and deficits of $8.6 billion were recognized on the balance sheet in relation to pensions and other post-retirement benefits. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 95


 
Safety, environment and security assurance committee (SESAC) Committee overview Role of the committee The role of the SESAC is to look at the processes adopted by BP’s executive management to identify and mitigate significant non-financial risk. This includes monitoring the management of personal and process safety risk, security and environment risks and receiving assurance that processes to identify and mitigate such non-financial risks are appropriate in their design and effective in their implementation. Key responsibilities The committee receives specific reports from the business segments and functions, which include, but are not limited to, the safety and operational risk function, shipping, group audit and group security. The SESAC can access any other independent advice and counsel it requires on an unrestricted basis. “The committee has continued to The SESAC and audit committee worked together, focus on working with executive through their chairs and secretaries, to ensure that management to drive safe and agendas did not overlap or omit coverage of any key risks during the year. reliable operations.” Meetings and attendance Melody Meyer There were six committee meetings in 2019. All Committee chair directors attended every meeting for which they were eligible. In addition to the committee members, all SESAC meetings were attended by the group chief executive, the executive vice president for safety Chairman’s introduction and operational risk (S&OR) and the head of group At the end of 2019 I took the role of chair for the committee. Alan audit or his delegate. The external auditor has access to the chair and secretary to the committee as Boeckmann retired from the board in April 2019 and Nils Andersen required. The group general counsel also attended replaced him as the committee chair. In November last year, Nils some of the meetings. At the conclusion of each announced his intention to step down from the board in March 2020 meeting the committee scheduled private sessions and I replaced Nils as SESAC chair with immediate effect. for the committee members only, without the presence of executive management, to discuss any During 2019 the committee has continued to focus on working with issues arising and the quality of the meeting. The executive management to drive safe and reliable operations. As part of group chief executive receives invitations to join the the committee’s review of the executives’ management of the highest private meetings on an ad hoc basis and at least once priority non-financial group risks assigned to SESAC we provide a year the head of group audit is invited to a private constructive challenge and oversight. The risks under our remit remained meeting with the committee. the same as for 2018: marine, wells, pipelines, explosion or release at Membership facilities, major security incidents and cyber security in the process control network. The committee receives reports on each of these risks Melody Meyer Member since May 2017 and and monitors their management and mitigation. chair since November 2019 Nils Andersen Member In 2019 the committee reviewed the BP Sustainability Report 2018. It (resigned March 2020) also reviewed work practices in BP in relation to and following publication Alan Boeckmann Member of the company’s Modern Slavery Act (MSA) statement in 2019. The (retired April 2019) committee will continue to review progress in developing and embedding Admiral Frank Member practices to mitigate the risk of modern slavery and related human rights. Bowman (retired May 2019) Professor Dame Member In March, members of the committee visited the shipping function as one Ann Dowling of the new LNG vessels went into service from the building yard in Sir John Sawers Member Busan, South Korea. This afforded the committee time with the crew on board the vessel, employees in the office and with contractors in the shipyard. See page 89 for more details. The level of access into the operations on such visits gives the directors first-hand, direct insight. This framework provides an opportunity for meaningful and open dialogue with the local site teams, allowing the committee to better fulfil its obligations. Melody Meyer Committee chair 96 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Activities during the year The board also undertook a site visit. This was not a SESAC site visit but, nevertheless, safety and non-financial risk matters were covered System of internal control and risk management during the visit to Clair Ridge in May 2019. Corporate reporting The review of operational risk and performance forms a large part of the committee’s agenda. Group audit provided quarterly reports on its The committee oversaw the BP Sustainability Report 2018. The assurance work and its annual review of the system of internal control committee reviewed the content and worked with the external auditor and risk management. with respect to its assurance of the report. The committee also received regular reports from the group chief executive and vice president for S&OR on operational risk, including regular reports prepared on the group’s health, safety, security and environmental performance and operational integrity. These included meeting-by-meeting measures of personal and process safety, environmental and regulatory compliance, security and cyber risk analysis, as well as quarterly reports from group audit. In addition, the group auditor regularly met in private with the chairman and other members of the committee over the course of the year. During the year the committee received separate reports on the company’s management of risks relating to: • Marine. • Wells. • Pipelines. • Explosion or release at our facilities. • Major security incidents. • Cyber security (process control networks). The committee reviewed these risks and their management and mitigation in depth with relevant executive management. The committee reviewed the 2019 forward programme for the group audit function. Site visits In March members of the committee made a physical visit to the shipping function for the first time. While the committee has regular access to senior leaders in the function, attempting to visit the vessels needed careful planning. With the launch of six new LNG vessels between October 2018 and April 2019, the committee took the opportunity to visit, and arrived as the fifth LNG vessel was in its period of ‘shakedown’ – a period post-launch and pre-service, when checks are made onboard the ship. The visit, hosted by the chief operating officer of shipping, was made to The British Mentor while it was at sea, just off the coast of South Korea. Committee members went on board and were met by the ship’s crew, undertook a thorough tour, and later met with various seafarers, without the captain present, to get a sense of the culture on board. The committee also spent time at the office and held an informal town hall and lunch to hear from employees. The following day the committee was also able to visit the shipyard which had built the LNG vessels, and meet with management. The committee members were able to take a tour of a LNG vessel in the building phase and see the technology used in the construction of the vessel at various stages of completion. The committee spent time with the shipyard owners, important stakeholders in the programme of delivery. In respect of the visit, committee members and other directors received briefings on operations, the status of conformance with BP’s operating management system, key business and operational risks and risk management and mitigation. Committee members reported back in detail about the visit to the committee and subsequently to the board. See page 89 for further details. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 97


 
Geopolitical committee Role of the committee The committee monitors the company’s identification and management of geopolitical risk. Key responsibilities • Monitor the company’s identification and management of major and correlated geopolitical risk and consider reputational as well as financial consequences. • Review BP’s activities in the context of political and economic developments on a regional basis and advise the board on these elements in its consideration of BP’s strategy and the annual plan. • Major geopolitical risks are those brought about by social, economic or political events that occur in countries where BP has material investments. • Correlated geopolitical risks are those brought about by social, economic or political events that occur in “The committee continued to address countries where BP may or may not have a presence but that can lead to global political key geopolitical matters and their instability. potential impact on BP.” Membership Sir John Sawers Sir John Sawers Member since September 2015 Committee chair and chair since April 2016 Nils Andersen Member (resigned March 2020) Admiral Frank Member Bowman (resigned May 2019) Sir Ian Davis Member Melody Meyer Member Meetings and attendance Chairman’s introduction The chairman and group chief executive regularly attend committee meetings. The chief executive of The work of the geopolitical committee in 2019 continued to address key Alternative Energy and executive vice president, geopolitical matters and their potential impact on BP and how these regions and the head of government and political evolved during the year. As chair of this committee I also attended all of affairs attend meetings as required. The committee the international advisory board (IAB) meetings in 2019. Now that the IAB met four times during the year. All directors attended has been disbanded, this committee will look to take some of the IAB’s each meeting that they were eligible to attend, with the exception of Nils Andersen who missed one remit and we will report next year on how that evolves. In May 2019, meeting due to a prior commitment. Admiral Frank Bowman stood down from the committee. Nils Andersen left the committee upon his resignation from the board in March 2020. I would like to thank Frank and Nils, both of whose contributions were much valued. Other board members joined our meetings from time to time. Sir John Sawers Committee chair Activities during the year The committee discussed BP’s involvement in the key countries where it has existing investments or is considering investment. These included the EU, Mexico, Brazil, Algeria, Libya, Egypt, Iraq, Oman and The Gambia. The committee also discussed the potential impact of Brexit on BP, and the negotiations between the UK and the EU on their future relationship. It reviewed the geopolitical background to BP’s global investments, the global politics of climate change, the geopolitics of gas, Russian energy exports, OPEC, the USA-China trade war, and developments in the Persian Gulf. 98 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Chairman’s committee Role of the committee To provide a forum for matters to be discussed by the non-executive directors. Key responsibilities • Evaluate the performance and the effectiveness of the chief executive officer. • Review the structure and effectiveness of the business organization. • Review the systems for senior executive development and determine succession plans for the chief executive officer, executive directors and other senior members of executive management. • Determine any other matter that is appropriate to be considered by non-executive directors. • Opine on any matter referred to it by the chairman of any committees comprised solely of non- executive directors. “The committee spent significant time Membership discussing the development and The committee is made up solely of non-executive progression of BP’s purpose, directors, each of whom is appointed to the committee upon their appointment to the board. expanding upon what the purpose Meetings and attendance actually means for the company and The committee met seven times in 2019. Nils how it impacts BP’s stakeholders.” Andersen, Pamela Daley and Professor Dame Ann Dowling each missed one meeting during the year, all Helge Lund other directors attended every meeting for which they Committee chair were eligible. Chairman’s introduction The chairman’s committee worked closely with the nomination and governance committee on the selection process of the new group CEO and CFO, receiving regular updates and providing feedback on the succession planning. The committee also spent significant time discussing the development and progression of BP’s purpose, expanding upon what the purpose actually means for the company and how it impacts BP’s stakeholders. We discussed the updated UK Corporate Governance Code 2018 and the implications for the business. In May 2019, Alan Boeckmann and Frank Bowman stood down from the board and the chairman’s committee. I would like to pay tribute to their exceptional service and thank them for their dedication to the committee and BP as a whole. Helge Lund Committee chair Activities during the year • Evaluated the performance of the group chief executive. • Reviewed the composition of and the succession plans for the executive team. • Discussed the company’s purpose and what it meant for the business. • Considered updates to the UK Corporate Governance Code 2018. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 99


 
Directors’ remuneration report Contents 2019 performance and pay outcomes 104 2019 annual bonus outcome 105 2017-19 performance share plan outcome 106 Executive directors’ pay for 2019 108 2020 remuneration: Policy on a page 110 Alignment with strategy 111 Wider workforce in 2019 112 Stewardship and executive director interests 114 Non-executive director outcomes and interests 116 Other disclosures 118 Directors’ remuneration report – the 2020 policy 119 “Through a vibrant exchange of views, we believe the committee will be wiser.” Paula Rosput Reynolds Committee chair Dear shareholder, Results, progress and incentive outcomes This is my second letter to you as chair of the remuneration 2019 has been another year of challenges and accomplishments in committee. It comes at the end of a period during which we have our operating and financial performance, and concludes a three-year engaged with many of you on our new remuneration policy. I have cycle which has seen significant strategic progress. From a shareholder been fortunate to get to know a number of you individually, and as perspective, robust operating cash flow gave headroom for a committee we have deeply appreciated the spirit of collaboration distributions of $8.3 billion through dividends, together with $1.5 billion evident throughout our dialogue on remuneration matters. of share buybacks. Although recent share price performance has been disappointing for BP and global share markets generally, the year It also comes at a time when, as a global community, we are nonetheless concludes a three-year cycle that has delivered a 29% navigating uncharted territory because of the global onset of total return. coronavirus (COVID-19). None of us yet know quite how broad its impact will be, nor how deeply it will be felt. What we do know is that From our analysis of annual performance outcomes, the committee our industry is seeing a significant demand and supply-side shock, determined that the 2019 bonus should be 67.5% of maximum, with consequent share price volatility. The board and I will remain rather than the purely formulaic 71.5% derived from the performance close as the situation develops, and we will respond with consideration scorecard. This was to reflect our judgment that strong cash receipts of the facts. Clearly, the remuneration targets we have set for the year at year-end would potentially impact receipts in 2020, hence the will need to be adjusted to the circumstances as they unfold. I can reduction in the formulaic result. also confirm that the remuneration committee will monitor business The committee also determined that the performance share conditions and exercise judgement in applying discretion relating to outcome should be 71.2% of maximum. We took the financial 2020 remuneration. We will proceed with great care in determining measures as reported but used our discretion in determining the the timing and magnitude of equity awards. At year-end, when we quality of the strategic progress. We determined that, over the assess performance, we will be thoughtful in the interpretation of three-year performance cycle that ended in 2019, significant results, balanced with the shareholder experience. I do believe that strategic progress was made towards a lower carbon future. But our the 2020 policy as drafted provides us with maximum flexibility in message, too, with scoring of strategic progress, is that there is the applying discretion – which the times call upon us to exercise. need for greater pace and accomplishment in the years ahead. Turning to our 2019 report, we cover three areas. First the To this point, as we look forward, the committee is faced with measuring remuneration outcomes over 2019 and the 2017-19 performance strategic progress through a different lens. As our recently appointed shares cycle are presented, along with a discussion about the BP leadership realigns strategy to reduce the carbon footprint of our relationship between company performance, earned rewards and business with greater urgency, the committee must strike the balance the shareholder experience. Second, the largely regulatory driven between rewarding progress in energy transition matters and rewarding reporting of stewardship and related matters is shown. Third, the delivery of our commitment to strong financial performance and safe 2020 directors’ remuneration policy, which will be the subject of a operations. As we progress the energy transition, we will be faced with binding vote at our annual general meeting in May. establishing new goals for which benchmark measures may not be With the number of statutory requirements increasing, this report readily and immediately available. You will read herein, even the question continues to grow. For those of you needing a quick overview, of the peer group to be used to measure relative total shareholder returns I recommend our summary pages on 104 and 110 which reflect (rTSR) is greatly complicated by the question of whose performance outcomes for 2019 and the 2020 policy respectively. should be tracked in the energy transition. 100 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Remuneration committee Role of the committee • Approve the principles of any equity plan that Meetings and attendance The role of the committee is to determine and requires shareholder approval. The chairman and the group chief executive attend recommend to the board the remuneration policy for • Ensure termination terms and payments to meetings of the committee except for matters the chairman and executive directors. In determining executive directors and the executive team are fair. relating to their own remuneration. The group chief the policy, the committee takes into account various • Receive and consider regular updates on executive is consulted on the remuneration of the factors, including structuring the policy to promote workforce views and engagement initiatives chief financial officer, the executive team and more the long-term success of the company and linking related to remuneration, insight from data sources broadly on remuneration across the wider employee reward to business performance. The committee on pay ratio, gender pay gap and other workforce population. Both the group chief executive and chief recognizes the remuneration principles applicable remuneration outcomes as appropriate. financial officer are consulted on matters relating to to all employees below board level. • Maintain appropriate dialogue with shareholders the group’s performance. on remuneration matters. Key responsibilities The group human resources director attends • Recommend to the board the remuneration Membership meetings and other executives may attend where principles and policy for the chairman and the necessary. The committee consults other board Paula Rosput Member since September 2017 executive directors while considering policies committees on the group’s performance and on Reynolds and chair since May 2018 for employees below the board and the issues relating to the exercise of judgement or executive team. Nils Andersen Member (resigned March 2020) discretion as necessary. • Determine the terms of engagement, Pamela Daley Member The committee met nine times during the year. remuneration, benefits and termination of Sir Ian Davis Member All directors attended each meeting that they were employment for the chairman and the executive Melody Meyer Member eligible to attend, except Nils Andersen who was directors, executive team and the company Brendan Nelson Member not able to attend two meetings. Pamela Daley and secretary in accordance with the policy. Sir Ian Davis each missed one committee meeting. • Prepare the annual remuneration report to shareholders to show how the policy has been implemented. We understand that these are matters of great importance to our For our new chief executive officer, Bernard Looney, pay will be governed shareholders. Therefore we will work closely with the incoming by the 2020 remuneration policy. The committee disclosed in October leadership team to assure that goal-setting, in particular for progress 2019 that it had set Bernard’s salary at £1.3 million (approximately 9% against the carbon agenda, remains ambitious while also delivering pay below Bob Dudley’s salary) as of 5 February 2020, with a reduced cash outcomes that align with your own experience. We intend to confer allowance retirement benefit of 15% of salary, which puts his allowance in with shareholders later in 2020 to establish goals once the details of our line with the majority of our wider workforce. Bernard retains a deferred energy transition efforts have been provided. pension benefit from service prior to April 2011, and certain deferred share awards from service prior to 2020. Single figure results for executive directors Earlier this year we made similar announcements regarding the 2019 single figures of total remuneration for Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary retirement of Brian Gilvary and the appointment of his successor, are $13.23 million and £6.56 million respectively, as reported on page 108. Murray Auchincloss, with effect from 1 July 2020. Further detail is These outcomes represent a 13% decrease for Bob, and a 20% decrease provided on page 103 for the new executives. for Brian, reflecting reductions in the performance shares outcome, and in particular lower share price growth over the three-year cycle. As noted Our 2020 policy renewal above, the committee applied the well-established formulas where During 2019 we have been grateful for the time and attention our major relevant and, in conjunction with strategic progress, carefully reviewed shareholders gave us as we consulted on requirements for the new the contributions of the executives. The impact of weaker share price 2020 policy. In particular, 30 of our largest shareholders joined us in performance on realized value is consistent with the experience of September for a novel session focused on expressing unconstrained shareholders and thus we deem these outcomes reasonable. views on remuneration arrangements. Together with subsequent For an overview of our executive remuneration structure, please refer to discussions and correspondence, the key issues emerging for the “at a glance” table on page 103. consideration have been: Succession arrangements • Clear end-to-end alignment from strategy, through measurable performance indicators and reward outcomes, to shareholder 2019 also marked a point of succession, as our group chief executive experience. Bob Dudley announced his intention to retire from BP, to be succeeded • Balance our contribution to the energy transition with delivering by Bernard Looney. shareholder returns. The committee was encouraged to use appropriate discretion, given the complexity of the environment in the Bob has now stepped down from the BP board, and ceases employment energy transition. from 31 March. As we announced in October 2019, he has waived his • Assure that strategic moves align to long-term sustainability, relative entitlement to notice pay for the unserved part of his notice period, and to a wider peer group. to any bonus for any part of 2020. By any measure, Bob has been an • Use meaningful and transparent measures to reflect our progress in exemplar of corporate service; he leaves BP as a ‘good leaver’ under the energy transition and reductions to our carbon impact. the terms of our executive director incentive plan, and therefore his interests under various deferred share awards are preserved and will vest in line with scheduled vesting dates and decisions, subject only to the committee retaining its discretion in the administration of the underpin on safety. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 101


 
Directors’ remuneration report With all of this in mind, we have established a policy proposal which As UK remuneration committees now have the regulatory obligation to we believe reflects our strategic imperatives and allows for competitive review remuneration of the wider workforce, our committee has sought remuneration outcomes aligned to the shareholder experience. The to understand how pay practices vary across the globe and to examine proposal makes modest but appropriate adjustments to our 2017 issues of fundamental fairness. We examined pay outcomes by gender framework which, to our mind, is well understood and has delivered and other criteria. We have also considered how the committee can appropriate results for both shareholders and executive directors. We effectively add value to our stewardship of the wider workforce and studied many far-reaching alternatives in concluding our final proposal our 2020 plans will include some additional engagement in this area. but typically found other approaches carried too much complexity, an The committee reviewed the breadth of historical pension amplified concern given the transition our industry faces. arrangements across the spectrum of our employees in 2019. As an The key changes we are making include a reduced emphasis on relative outcome, BP made changes that have brought pensions for executive total shareholder return, but measuring our returns against a more directors and the wider workforce into alignment. diverse group of companies; a sharpened focus on energy transition Our committee appreciated the time and thoughtful input shareholders measures throughout the structure; tighter limits on pension benefits; and their representatives have given to the refreshment of the and a reduction in the number of measures that will be considered for remuneration policy. Through a vibrant exchange of views, we believe the annual bonus plan. the committee will be wiser as it considers executive pay against the Other matters backdrop of a challenging environment. We respectfully ask for your endorsement of the committee’s 2019 remuneration decisions and your Our committee activity in 2019 was extensive. It included a review of approval of the proposed 2020 policy framework. the principles of remuneration to support our updated policy (page 119) and engagement with shareholders and shareholder representatives. We also spent considerable time on remuneration matters related to the succession of the group chief executive and the various leadership changes that followed, in line with our increasing accountability for setting senior executive pay. Paula Rosput Reynolds Chair of the remuneration committee 18 March 2020 In this Directors’ remuneration report RC profit (loss), underlying RC profit, return on average capital employed and operating cash flow (excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments) are non-GAAP measures. These measures and upstream plant reliability, refining availability, major projects and underlying production and reserves replacement ratio are defined in the Glossary on page 335. 102 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Remuneration at a glance Purpose and Outcomes for 2019 Implementation in 2020 (2020 policy Key features link to strategy (2017 policy) proposal unless stated otherwise) Salary and • Salary is reviewed annually • Fixed remuneration • Bob Dudley’s salary • Bob Dudley’s salary to remain at benefits and, if appropriate, increased reflecting the scale and unchanged at $1,854,000. $1,854,000 until he ceases employment following the AGM. complexity of our • Brian Gilvary’s salary on 31 March. • Benchmarked to market at business, enabling us to increased by 2% to • Bernard Looney’s salary is set at inception with increases attract and keep the £790,500. £1,300,000. reflective of those of our highest calibre global • Benefits remain • Brian Gilvary’s salary to remain at wider workforce. talent. unchanged. £790,500 until he ceases employment. • Murray Auchincloss’s salary to be set at £695,000. • Bernard’s benefits remain unchanged. Murray will be eligible for standard UK benefits from his appointment on 1 July. Retirement • Bob is a member of both US • To recognize competitive • Bob’s defined benefit • Arrangements for Bob will continue benefits pension (defined benefit) and practice in home country. pension did not increase in unchanged until he ceases employment on retirement savings (defined 2019. His actual and 31 March. contribution) plans. notional company • Bernard’s cash allowance reduces to 15% • Brian is a member of a UK contributions, together of salary from the date of his appointment. final salary defined benefit with investment returns Accrued service for his deferred pension is pension plan and receives a within his retirement already capped, and the pension cash allowance in lieu of savings plans, amounted calculation will be based on his pre- further service accrual. to $543,661. appointment salary. • Brian’s accrued defined • Brian’s cash allowance is subject to a benefit pension increase previously agreed schedule of reductions was below inflation. He and will terminate when he ceases received a cash allowance employment on 30 June. at 35% of salary to 31 • Murray’s cash allowance will be set at 15% May, and at 30% of salary of salary from his appointment on 1 July. from 1 June 2019, which is He retains a deferred pension arrangement included in the single from his US service, which will be based figure table. on his pre-appointment salary. Annual • 112.5% of salary at target, • To incentivize delivery • Against our scorecard of • Bob has waived any entitlement to an bonus and 225% at maximum. of our annual and safety (20%), environment annual bonus for 2020. • 50% of the bonus is paid in strategic goals. (10%), reliable operations • Brian will qualify for a pro-rated bonus for cash and 50% is mandatorily • The 50% deferral (20%) and financial his service in 2020. deferred and held in BP reinforces the long-term performance (50%), our • Proposed scorecard with four measures shares for three years. nature of our business performance score is across safety (20%), environment (20%), • To continue under 2020 and the importance of 135% of target (67.5% of operational (10%) and financial (50%) policy. sustainability. maximum). performance. Performance • Annual grant of performance • To link the largest part of • Against our balanced • Awards granted in 2018, under our 2017 shares shares, representing the remuneration opportunity scorecard of financial policy, at 500% (Bob Dudley) and 450% maximum outcome. 500% with the long-term measures (80%), and (Brian Gilvary) of salary will vest in of salary for group chief performance of the strategic progress (20%), proportion to success against the executive and 450% of salary business. The outcome our 2017-19 performance measures of our 2018-20 scorecard, on a for chief financial officer. varies with performance score is 71.2% of pro-rata basis for time in service. • Shares only vest to the against measures linked maximum. • For our 2020-23 cycle, grant levels will extent performance directly to financial remain unchanged for our incoming chief conditions are met. returns and strategic executive and chief financial officer at • To continue under 2020 priorities. 500% and 450% of salary respectively, policy. with weightings of 40% for relative total shareholder return (rTSR), 30% for return on average capital employed (ROACE) and 30% for energy transition measures. Shareholding • Executive directors are • To ensure sustained • Both Bob Dudley and Brian • From 2020, executive directors are requirement required to maintain a alignment between the Gilvary materially exceed required to maintain their full minimum shareholding equivalent to at interests of executive the share ownership shareholding requirement for two years least five times their salary. directors and our requirements. post employment. • Additionally, they have been shareholders. • The minimum shareholding requirement expected to maintain remains five times salary for the group shareholdings of at least two chief executive and is four and a half times and a half times salary for two salary for other executive directors. years post employment. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 103


 
Directors’ remuneration report 2019 performance and pay outcomes Business A strong year of operational performance, set against challenging external conditions. Improvement across safety metrics, and significant growth in our retail business. Strong underlying profits for 2019, with a 29% return to performance shareholders over the three-year cycle. Key strategic highlights • $10 billion underlying replacement cost profit 2nd (29%) $28.2bn $8.3bn • Dividend increased to 10.5 cents per share Among peers for Operating Dividends paid, • Expansion of our convenience partnership sites total shareholder cash flow including scrip to around 1,600 globally return 2017-19 (excluding Gulf of • Created BP Bunge Bioenergia, a world-class Mexico oil spill bioenergy company payments) Performance Strong results for the year, beating targets on five out of six measurement categories in our scorecards. outcomes 2019 Annual bonus 2017-19 Performance shares 71.5% -4.0% 67.5% 71.2% 0% 71.2% Formulaic Committee Final outcome Formulaic Committee Final outcome outcome judgement, (% of maximum) outcome judgement, (% of maximum) (% of maximum) discretionary (% of maximum) no adjustment reduction Performance dimensions (% weighting) Performance dimensions (% weighting) Safety (20%) KPI 15.5/20 Financial (80%) KPI 57/80 Environment (10%) KPI 7/10 Strategic progress (20%) KPI 14/20 Reliability (20%) KPI 8.5/20 Financial (50%) KPI 40/50a Annual bonus outcome (67.5% of maximum) Performance shares outcome (71.2% of maximum) Bob Dudley $2,815,763 Bob Dudley $7,936,660 Brian Gilvary £1,200,572 Brian Gilvary £2,752,815 KPI This legend denotes remuneration measures that directly relate to BP’s key performance indicators. See page 32. Bob Dudley 18.7% fixed Brian Gilvary 16.7% fixed Total Group chief executive 81.3% variable Chief financial officer 83.3% variable remuneration Salary and benefits, (14.6)% Salary and benefits, (12.9)% 2019 Retirement benefits, (4.1)% Retirement benefits, (3.8)% Annual bonus, (21.3)% Annual bonus, (18.3)% Performance shares, (60.0)% $13.23m Performance shares, (42.0)% £6.56m 2018: $15.25m Discontinued plans, (23.0)% 2018: £8.22m Share Shareholding is a key means by which the interests of executive directors are aligned with those of shareholders. As at 3 March 2020 both directors had holdings in BP which significantly exceeded our shareholding policy ownership requirement of five times salary. Bob Dudley, Group chief executive 15.18 times salary, 5,290,446 sharesb. Brian Gilvary, Chief financial officer 16.20 times salary, 3,086,437 shares. Policy requirements (5x) Actual a Due to rounding, these figures do not precisely equal the overall outcome, 71.5% b Held as American depository shares (ADSs) 104 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance 2019 annual bonus outcome For 2019 the committee established a bonus scorecard of eight As noteworthy as this result is, we still regard any accident as one too measures across four areas of focus: safety and operational risk, the many, and it is a matter of great regret that two of our colleagues suffered environment, reliable operations and financial performance. These fatal injuries in 2019. To underscore our determination to eliminate these measures align with our strategy and investor proposition and, in tragic incidents, we reflect any fatality in the performance assessment of particular, reflect the annual plan. Seven of the eight measures align the relevant business, thereby causing a material reduction in bonus for with our 2018 scorecard. The eighth measure, sustainable emissions every individual in that business. In reaching our final conclusion, we rely reduction, was new and marked an acceleration of our intent to gear on the judgement of the safety, environment and security assurance elements of financial reward to our progress in navigating the low committee (SESAC) on the evaluation of safety outcomes. carbon transition. Similarly, we sought the input of the audit committee to ensure our In order to build on the strong results of 2018, the committee again set conclusions are robust and properly reflect underlying financial notably stretching targets for each measure. For instance, our 2019 performance relative to markets. This included a review of the threshold outcome for recordable injury frequency was set at the level of adjustments we make in our financial targets to reflect any pricing our 2018 outcome, meaning we had to exceed that 2018 result to achieve impacts, and thereby avoid windfall outcomes in our financial measures. even a minimum contribution to the 2019 bonus. Overall, our focus on For 2019, this led to a proportional reduction in our profit and cash flow safety delivered a year with both the fewest process safety incidents on targets, reflecting the weaker oil price environment. Over the eight years record (excluding the impact of recent Mexico retail and BHP onshore to 2019, we have increased targets four times, and reduced them four aquisitions), and the lowest recordable injury frequency on record. times, consistently stripping out the impact of the price environment. 2019 annual bonus scorecard These measures were set under the terms of our 2017 policy KPI See key performance indicators on page 32. Safety Environment Reliable Financial Formulaic 0.31 + 0.14 + operations + performance = score 1.43a 0.17 0.80 out of 2.0 Measures Weighting Threshold (0) Target (1) Maximum (2) Outcome Safety Process safety tier 1 KPI 10% 80 events 72 events 56 events 70 events and tier 2 eventsb 0 0.1 0.2 0.11 (20% weight) Recordable injury KPI 10% 0.198/200k hrs 0.188/200k hrs 0.168/200k hrs 0.159/200k hrs frequency 0 0.1 0.2 0.20 Outcome 0.31 Environment Sustainable emissions KPI 10% 0.49 mte 1.0 mte 2.0 mte 1.4 mte reductions 0 0.1 0.2 0.14 (10% weight) Reliable BP-operated refining KPI 10% 94.5% 95.0% 95.5% 94.9% availabilityc 0 0.1 0.2 0.08 operations (20% weight) BP-operated upstream KPI 10% 92.6% 94.6% 96.6% 94.4% plant reliability 0 0.1 0.2 0.09 Outcome 0.17 Financial Operating cash flow KPI 20% $24.0 bn $26.5 bn $29.0 bn $28.2 bn (excluding Gulf of Mexico 0 0.2 0.4 0.33 performance oil spill payments) (50% weight) Underlying replacement KPI 20% $8.1 bn $8.9 bn $9.7 bn $10.0 bn cost profit 0 0.2 0.4 0.40 Upstream unit KPI 10% $7.12/bbl $6.72/bbl $6.32/bbl $6.84/bbl production costs 0 0.1 0.2 0.07 Outcome 0.80 Formulaic score 1.4 3 a out of 2.0 Formulaic Input audit Remuneration Final 67.5% scorecard committee committee scorecard of outcome and SESAC judgement outcome maximum 1.43 out of 2 No adjustment Minus 0.08 1.35 out of 2 a Due to rounding, the total does not equal the sum of the parts. b Measure excludes data from Mexico retail and BHP onshore operations for two years from the date of their acquisition by BP. c Solomon Associates’ operational availability. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 105


 
Directors’ remuneration report While we continue to believe these adjustments are appropriate, Market-led growth in the downstream. BP has materially entered they potentially create some tension between the relative basis of our the retail markets in Mexico and Indonesia and expanded our overall financial measurement, and shareholders’ experience of cash flow and retail network with 850 sites opened since 2016. Marketing of premium profit. With this context, we decided to reduce the formulaic bonus fuels has seen compound growth of 7% per annum in these higher scorecard outcome to reflect our judgement that strong cash receipts value sales. at year end would potentially impact receipts in 2020. Venturing and low carbon across multiple fronts. BP has made Our bonus outcome for 2019 is therefore 135% of target and 67.5% of signature investments in BP Chargemaster, our DiDi fast-charging joint maximum. This compares with 81% of target and 40.5% of maximum venture in China and Lightsource BP, all of which underpin growth in in 2018. With the rigour of our process and discussions, and the support electric vehicle charging and solar. We merged our biofuels business we have received from the SESAC and audit committee, we believe the with another operator to create BP Bunge Bioenergia thereby creating 2019 annual bonuses fairly reflect and reward 2019 performance for the synergies and scale for growth in biofuels. We have created a ‘scale-up’ executive directors and senior leadership of BP. factory known as BP Launchpad, to enhance our access to investment in new ventures, and have increased the portfolio over the last three As shown below, half of the bonus is paid in cash after year end, and years. The committee will be monitoring and measuring the progress half is deferred into shares that will vest in three years, according to of these ventures over time. 2017 policy terms. The full value of the 2019 bonus, including the deferred shares, is included in the 2019 single figure table. This differs Gas, power and renewables trading and marketing growth. We from reporting in respect of the 2014 policy, under which deferred noted robust early progress with BP’s new integrated gas and power shares related to the 2016 bonus are included in the 2019 single figure, organization, mainly through a growing presence as a merchant in the i.e. the year in which they vest. global LNG trade, although financial results remain volatile. We also Adjusted Paid Deferred into noted the development of infrastructure to undertake renewables outcome in cash BP shares trading, which has included building diverse counter-party relationships, Bob Dudley $2,815,763a $1,407,881 $1,407,881 such as with renewable energy source producers and owners of forests Brian Gilvary £1,200,572 £600,286 £600,286 for the purposes of creating a market for natural climate solutions (NCS). Along with the combination of financial and strategic measures that a Due to rounding the total does not match the sum of the parts. shareholders approved in the 2017 policy, the provision for ‘underpin’ The annual bonus outcome is unrelated to the BP share price, and decision by the committee was instituted. Namely, before deciding on therefore no part of the bonus is attributable to share price appreciation. the final result, the committee takes a broader view of performance to ensure that reward outcomes align with absolute shareholder returns, 2017-19 performance share plan outcome safety and environmental factors, and progress in low carbon and climate change matters. Our conclusion is that returns from the 2017-19 Vesting levels for the 2017-19 performance share awards are performance shares cycle are proportional and appropriate. Therefore, determined under the terms of the 2017 policy, in line with the we have made no further adjustment to the scorecard outcome. Vesting performance measures and outcomes shown on the scorecard on therefore has been set at 71.2% of maximum, delivering the outcomes page 107, and the committee’s broader deliberations in line with the detailed below. ‘underpin’ established in that policy. The scorecard for this period included relative total shareholder return (50%), return on average Shares vesting including Value of capital employed (30%) and four strategic progress measures (20%) Shares awarded dividends vested shares that are assessed both quantitatively and qualitatively. Bob Dudleya 1,571,628 1,319,478 $7,936,660 Assessed against the two financial scorecard measures, the group’s Brian Gilvary 722,093 606,347 £2,752,815 performance for the three years from 2017 to 2019 is strong. We placed second on relative total shareholder return (with a 29% total return) a Bob Dudley’s award is granted in respect of American depositary shares (ADSs). The which measures us against our super-major peers, Chevron, numbers in this table reflect calculated equivalents in ordinary shares. One ADS equates to ExxonMobil, Shell and Total. Return on average capital employed six ordinary shares. (ROACE) was 8.9%, comfortably ahead of the 8.1% target. The value of vested shares reflects the share price changes all We introduced the four strategic progress measures in our 2017 policy. shareholders experienced over the three-year period. For this 2017-19 Hence this is the first cycle for which we have made an assessment on award cycle, the original grant was calculated based on ordinary share strategic progress. We find that a rating of 13.8% out of 20% maximum and ADS prices of £4.73 and $35.39 respectively, while the equivalent opportunity is appropriate. Below are the four strategic pillars and a short prices on 18 February 2020, the vesting date, were £4.54 and $36.09. description of some of the factors that influenced our scoring decision: Consequently, share price appreciation in this cycle accounts for $130,549 (1.6%) of the value of Bob’s vested shares, and none of the Shift to gas and advantaged oil in the upstream. Gas production value of Brian’s vested shares. has grown 35% (comparing 2019 with 2016), and 75% of all pre-2022 start-ups planned during the 2017-19 cycle are in gas. Pre-2022 start-ups in oil are lower-cost or adjacent to existing basins, creating additional value and lowering carbon intensity relative to BP’s legacy portfolio. 106 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance 2017-19 performance shares scorecard These measures were set under the terms of our 2017 policy KPI See key performance indicators on page 32. Financial Strategic progress Formulaic 57.4% + 13.8% = vesting 71.2% Weighting Threshold Maximum Measures at maximum performance performance Outcome Financial Relative total KPI 50% Third First Second shareholder return 40.0% Return on average KPI 30% 7.25% 11.0% 8.9% capital employed 17.4% Outcome 57.4% Strategic Shift to gas and advantaged 5% oil in the upstream 3.75% progress Market-led growth 5% in the downstream Qualitative and quantitative assessment 3.0% Venturing and low carbon 5% by the committee. No numeric scale for across multiple fronts vesting outcome – see page 106. 4.25% Gas, power and 5% renewables trading 2.75% and marketing growth Outcome 13.8% Total formulaic 71.2% score Formulaic Underpin: Committee review of absolute shareholder returns, long-term safety 71.2% vesting and environmental performance, low carbon and climate change considerations. final vesting 71.2% after committee No adjustment judgement BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 107


 
Directors’ remuneration report Executive directors’ pay for 2019 Single figure table – executive directors (audited) Remuneration is reported in the currency Bob Dudley Brian Gilvary in which the individual is paid (thousand) (thousand) 2019 2018 2019 2018 Salary and Salary $1,854 $1,854 £785 £769 benefits Benefits $84 $79 £59 £67 Retirement Pension and retirement saving – value increasea $544 $0 £0 £0 benefits Cash in lieu of future accrual – – £252 £269 Annual Cash bonus $1,408 $845 £600 £353 bonus Shares – deferred for three years $1,408 $845 £600 £353 Performance Performance shares $7,937b $11,630 c £2,753b £4,295c shares Discontinued Deferred share awards from prior-year bonuses –d –d £1,510e £2,113 e plans Total remunerationf $13,234 $15,253 £6,558 £8,219 Value attributed to share price appreciationg $131 $2,033 – £1,753 a For Bob Dudley this represents the aggregate value of the company match and investment gains on the accumulating unfunded BP Excess Compensation (Savings) Plan (ECSP) account under Bob’s US retirement savings arrangements. Full details are set out on page 109. For Brian Gilvary this represents the annual increase in accrued pension, net of inflation, multiplied by 20. In 2019 Brian’s salary increased by less than inflation, hence there is no net increase in accrued pension, and zero is reported as per regulations. Full details are set out on page 109. b Represents the vesting of shares on 18 February 2020 following the end of the 2017-19 performance period, based on the assessment of performance achieved under the rules of the plan and includes accrued dividends on shares vested. The value of shares at vesting was $36.09 for ADSs and £4.54 for ordinary shares. c In accordance with UK regulations, in the 2018 single figure table, the performance outcome values were based on fourth quarter average prices of $41.48 for ADSs and £5.33 for ordinary shares. In May 2019, after the external data became available, the committee reviewed the relative reserves replacement ratio position, and this resulted in no adjustment to the final vesting of 80%. On 3 May 2019, 269,974 ADSs for Bob Dudley and 776,611 ordinary shares for Brian Gilvary vested at prices of $43.08 and £5.53. The 2018 values for the total vesting have increased by $587,301 for Bob Dudley and £211,889 for Brian Gilvary because of the higher share prices and additional accrued dividends. d In line with previous practice Bob Dudley has voluntarily agreed to defer performance assessment and vesting of the awards related to his 2016 annual bonus until at least one year after retirement, therefore the performance period will exceed the minimum term of three years. As stated in the 2017 and 2018 directors’ remuneration reports, Bob voluntarily deferred performance assessment and vesting of the 2014 and 2015 deferred and matching awards until at least one year after retirement. See the Deferred shares table on page 115 for further details on these awards. e The amounts reported for 2019 relate to the matching element of the 2014 annual bonus deferral, which Brian had voluntarily deferred for an additional two years, and the deferred element of the 2016 annual bonus. These awards vested on 18 February 2020 at the market price of £4.54 for ordinary shares and include accrued dividends on shares vested. The amounts reported for 2018 relate to the 2015 annual bonus, comprising the underlying award that vested on 19 February 2019 at a market price of £5.38 (as disclosed in our 2018 report), and the additional vesting of accrued dividends on 3 May 2019 at the market price of £5.53. See the Deferred shares table on page 115 for further details on these awards. f Due to rounding, the totals do not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts. g The values shown for performance shares and deferred share awards include the share price appreciation, if any, experienced over the applicable three-year vesting periods. This additional line shows the value of those awards that is directly attributable to share price appreciation, being the number of shares vesting multiplied by the increase in share price from grant date to vesting date. The 2018 values have been restated from the 2018 reported values to exclude share price growth relating to accrued dividends. 108 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Overview of single figure outcomes (audited) Retirement benefits Bob Dudley is provided with pension benefits and retirement savings The single figures of total remuneration for Bob Dudley and Brian through a combination of tax-qualified and non-qualified benefit plans. Gilvary are $13.234 million and £6.558 million respectively. This is a His normal retirement age is 60. 13% decrease for Bob, and a 20% decrease for Brian. The BP Supplemental Executive Retirement Benefit Plan (SERB) is a Salary and benefits non-qualified defined benefit pension plan which provides a proportion Bob Dudley’s salary remained at $1,854,000 throughout 2019. Brian of earnings for each year of service. In 2019 his accrued defined benefit Gilvary’s salary was increased by 2% to £790,500 with effect from pension did not increase and in accordance with the requirements of UK 21 May 2019. Both executive directors received car-related benefits, regulations, the amount included in the single figure table on page 108 assistance with tax return preparation, security assistance, insurance is zero. and medical benefits. The BP Employee Savings Plan (ESP) is a US tax-qualified defined 2019 annual bonus and 2017-19 performance shares contribution plan to which both Bob and BP contribute. The BP Excess Please refer to pages 105-107 for details of the performance measures, Compensation (Savings) Plan (ECSP) is a non-qualified, unfunded, targets, results and the related reward outcomes for annual bonus and retirement savings plan to which BP notionally contributes 7% of base performance shares. salary above the annual IRS limit. In 2019 Bob made contributions to the Discontinued plans: deferral of 2014 and 2016 bonus ESP totalling $28,000 and BP made matching contributions to the ESP, In accordance with 2014 policy, Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary and notional contributions to the ECSP, totalling $129,780. In addition to compulsorily deferred one third of their 2016 annual bonus and these contributions, Bob realised investment gains of $413,881 in his each received an equivalent value matching award of BP shares. unfunded ECSP account (aggregating the unfunded arrangements Both the deferred and matching awards were subject to a three-year relating to his overall service with BP and TNK-BP), hence the amount performance period which ended on 31 December 2019. included in the single figure table is $543,661. Bob has requested that the committee delay the performance Brian Gilvary is provided with pension benefits through a combination of assessment and hence the vesting of his 2016 deferred and matching tax-qualified and non-qualified plans for service to 31 March 2011, but awards. This is a continuing practice from previous years and reflects linked to his final salary, and a cash allowance for service thereafter. In his ongoing commitment to the long-term success of BP, even post common with more than 3,800 UK employees employed prior to 2010 employment. These awards will vest, subject to an assessment against (or before 2014 in the North Sea) Brian is a member of the BP Pension the original safety and environmental sustainability conditions, after Scheme (BPPS), a UK final salary defined benefit pension plan. Pension his retirement. benefits accrued in excess of the individual lifetime tax allowance set by legislation are provided to Brian via a non-qualified, unfunded pension Brian had previously voluntarily requested that the committee delay arrangement designed to mirror the design of the approved BPPS. His the performance assessment and vesting of his 2014 matching award normal retirement age is 60, although due to his long service, benefits for two years. In 2018 he requested that the committee delay the accrued before 1 December 2006 may be paid unreduced from age 55 performance assessment and vesting of his 2016 matching award with BP’s consent. until at least one year post employment. In 2019 Brian’s salary increase was below inflation. In accordance with For Brian’s 2014 matching award and 2016 deferred awards, the the requirements of UK regulations, the amount included in the single committee considered operational and financial performance and figure table on page 108 is zero. reviewed safety and environmental sustainability performance over the 2015-19 and 2017-19 periods, seeking input from the SESAC on safety Brian receives a cash allowance of 30% of salary (this will reduce to 25% and sustainability measures. The committee concluded that safety on 1 June 2020 for his last month of service). This amount has been performance continues to show improvement, with safety embedded in separately identified in the single figure table. the culture of the organization and supporting strong operational and financial performance. The committee concluded that these two History of group chief executive remuneration awards should vest in full. Total Performance Total shares Group chief remuneration Annual bonus % shares % of a vesting, Year executive thousand of maximum maximum Shares Vesting including Total value 2010b Tony Hayward £3,890 0 0 Name granted agreed dividends at vesting Bob Dudley $8,057 0 0 Bob Dudleya 2011 Bob Dudley $8,439 66.7 16.7 2016 Deferred award 147,642 –a – – 2012 Bob Dudley $9,609 64.9 0 2016 Matching award 147,642 –a – – 2013 Bob Dudley $15,086 88.0 45.5 Brian Gilvaryb 2014 Bob Dudley $16,390 73.3 63.8 2014 Matching award 176,576 100% 246,359 £1,118,470 2015 Bob Dudley $19,376 100.0 74.3 2016 Deferred award 73,070 100% 86,176 £391,239 2016 Bob Dudley $11,904 61.0 40.0 2016 Matching award 73,070 –a –a –a 2017 Bob Dudley $15,108 71.5 70.0 a Vesting of these awards deferred until at least one year post employment, subject 2018 Bob Dudley $15,253 40.5 80.0 to conditions. 2019 Bob Dudley $13,234 67.5 71.2 b Based on a vesting share price of £4.54. a Total remuneration figures include pension. The total figure is also affected by share vesting outcomes and these amounts represent the actual outcome for the periods up to 2011, the adjusted outcome for the years 2012 to 2018 where preliminary assessments of performance for EDIP had initially been made, and the actual outcome for 2019. b 2010 figures show full year remuneration for both Tony Hayward and Bob Dudley, although Bob Dudley did not become group chief executive until October 2010. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 109


 
Directors’ remuneration report 2020 remuneration: Policy on a page Approach: We will retain the structure that has served well since 2017, reserving increased flexibility to adapt as BP pursues its ambition to become a net zero company by 2050 or sooner, and help the world get to net zero. Salary and Salary will be reviewed annually. Increases are measured against Benefits are unchanged and include car-related provisions (or cash benefits external pay relativity, and will not exceed the increase for our in lieu), security assistance, insurance and medical cover. wider workforce. Retirement New appointees from within the BP group retain previously accrued This is a material reduction from our 2017 policy. benefits benefits. For their service as a director, retirement benefits will be no more than the median provision offered to the wider workforce in the UK. Annual bonus Bonus is measured against an annual scorecard. Measures will The committee will set appropriately stretching targets for each include financial (50%), operational (10%), safety (20%) and measure. environmental (20%) goals. Target bonus is 112.5%, and maximum bonus is 225% of salary. The committee holds discretion to choose the specific measures to Half of the bonus for each year is paid in cash, and half is delivered be adopted within each of these categories and the relative as a deferred share award vesting in three years. weightings to assign to them to reflect the annual plan as agreed with the board. Numeric scales are set for each measure, to score outcomes relative to targets. Performance Performance shares are granted with a three-year performance At the outset of each award the committee will review the shares period. Awards to be granted under this policy will vest in 2023, measures that are to govern the award, along with weightings and 2024 and 2025, and shares held until 2026, 2027 and 2028. targets, to ensure they remain focused on delivering the strategy and are in the interests of shareholders. Measures will include rTSR (40%), assessed against a broader peer group, ROACE (30%) and an assessment related to the low carbon Annual grants will be at 500% of salary for the chief executive transition (30%). officer, and 450% of salary for any other executive director. These awards will vest in three years and in proportion to the For 2020, the rTSR peer group will include additional energy outcomes measured through the performance scorecard, with a companies in our sector, but ones who also have low carbon holding period that requires the shares to be retained for a further businesses or material commitments, such as Equinor, ENI and three years. Repsol. Beyond 2020, the committee will consider additional companies whose programmes provide meaningful challenge to The committee will assess safety outcomes over the perfomance BP regarding its own lower carbon ambitions. cycle as an underpin in determining the final vesting percentage. Shareholding Chief executive officer to build a shareholding of at least five times Executive directors are required to maintain that level for at least requirement salary, and other executive directors four and a half times salary, two years post employment. within five years of appointment. Malus and Malus provisions may apply where there is: a material safety or Clawback provisions may apply where there is: an incorrect clawback environmental failure; an incorrect award outcome due to outcome due to miscalculation or incorrect information; a miscalculation or incorrect information; a restatement due to restatement due to financial reporting failure or misstatement of financial reporting failure or misstatement of audited results; audited results; or material misconduct. material misconduct; or other exceptional circumstances that the committee considers similar in nature. Committee Under this policy, the committee will hold flexibility to choose the The committee reserves discretion in determining the outcomes flexibility measures and weightings to be adopted for each annual bonus and for annual bonus and performance shares, allowing it to take broad performance shares scorecard, and to adjust the peer group for the views on alignment with shareholder experience, environmental, rTSR measure, at the start of each performance cycle. societal and other inputs. This will allow appropriate re-alignment, over the policy term, to the anticipated evolution of the low carbon competitor market. The table above shows an at-a-glance summary of our proposed 2020 executive director remuneration policy. For the full remuneration policy, which will be proposed for shareholder approval at our 2020 AGM, please see pages 119 to 127. 110 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Alignment with strategy Bernard Looney recently announced a bold new purpose and ambition The strategic shift that BP signalled in February, and which will be for BP, reaching out to 2050. This reframes a crucial part of our investor further detailed during our capital markets presentation in September, proposition with an explicit commitment to the energy transition that sharply increases the need for the remuneration policy to reflect low investors and wider society rightly expect. It also recommits us to carbon ambitions and the energy transition. For this reason, the delivering competitive financial returns, through our ‘performing while environmental measure in annual bonus will increase from 10% to 20% transforming’ programme. weighting, and the strategic measures for performance share vesting are now explicitly tied to low carbon/energy transition, and carry a 30% While the specifics of our strategic milestones are yet to be defined, weighting. As BP’s leadership continues to develop specific strategic our direction is clear. For alignment of remuneration policy to corporate goals in this space, we are reserving committee discretion to define and strategy, we will broadly retain our policy structure, while reserving communicate the precise measures and weighting that will apply for the specific flexibility to allow an evolution of performance measures and performance share awards, and to adjust from cycle to cycle. their weightings over the three-year policy term. Our 2017 policy structure, driven by an annual bonus and three-year performance shares, has allowed us to harness the energy and commitment of our executive directors and senior leadership through a set of clearly articulated and ambitious goals. By retaining flexibility to adjust performance measures and weightings, we have been able to maintain alignment between shareholders and executives even as BP’s strategy has developed over time. We therefore believe that this combination of structure and flexibility, that has served us well through the last policy cycle, is equally well suited to the transition years ahead. The annual bonus is determined in line with performance relative to annual targets for safety, environmental, operational and financial measures. Performance shares vest in line with performance relative to three-year targets for rTSR, ROACE and a set of low carbon/energy transition measures. This suite of measures allows for an end-to-end alignment between our strategic direction, our executive focus and our remuneration outcomes, always with the underpin of committee discretion to adjust outcomes as appropriate to match shareholders’ own experience. Safety is and will remain a core value, hence continues to drive a material part of the bonus outcome, as well as forming part of the committee’s ‘underpin’ consideration in the finalvesting of performance shares. Likewise, BP has made clear strategic commitment to maintain focus on financial returns to shareholders, which therefore remain well-represented in the performance measures for annual bonus (50% weighting) and performance shares (40% weighting on rTSR and 30% weighting on ROACE). Reflecting the views of our shareholders, we have reduced the rTSR weighting (from 50%) and also started to widen the comparator group. For the first performance share cycle under the new 2020 policy, the comparator group is expanded from the four super majors to include ENI, Equinor and Repsol, all of whom have some lower carbon elements in their strategies. We have studied opportunities to expand the peer group further. But we conclude that other low carbon operators and indices have yet to reach sufficient maturity for inclusion at this time. Nevertheless it is possible that this will change during the policy cycle and hence we retain the discretion to introduce other companies or an index of low carbon companies in the coming equity cycles within the life of this policy. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 111


 
Directors’ remuneration report Wider workforce in 2019 • An analysis of the use of equity-based reward, to understand the extent to which equity forms a core element of reward in different Workforce experience locations and business areas. • The structure of workforce pensions in the US and UK, to deepen our Delivery of our strategy, both near and long term, depends upon BP’s understanding of the variety of entitlements that exist across success in attracting and engaging a highly talented workforce, and on different levels of the organization, given obligations to honour equipping our people with the skills for the future. While the board legacy arrangements from prior policies. considers ways to deepen engagement with the workforce, and to understand the workplace in its broadest sense, the remuneration This wider workforce context is helpful to our thinking about future committee continues to receive and review information on pay reward policies. Aside from our specific oversight of remuneration in outcomes and processes for our wider workforce. the IST business, the committee does not intend to supplant the appropriate role of management in setting rewards for the wider During 2019, we have taken a measured path towards deepening our workforce. But the committee believes our engagement and our own understanding of this complex field by studying these five areas: experiences in other companies and other industries can be additive to • The overall demographics of the workforce, to understand where we the thought process of management. employ our people, at what levels within the organization, and in what In addition to the board’s workforce engagement initiatives, as a business areas. committee we have started a programme of engagement directly • The distinct reward frameworks used by our major business areas, to related to remuneration. This includes focus group sessions related to understand different approaches to fixed pay, incentives and benefits. our remuneration practices and the connectivity we see between This review included a detailed consideration, by way of case study executive and wider workforce remuneration. examples, of the progression of total reward across the job hierarchy in seven representative business areas. • A deeper look at annual bonus, to build a greater appreciation of the business and geographic profile of our total bonus spend, and how target levels of bonus vary across the employee hierarchy in our top eight countries. Summary of remuneration structure for employees below the board Element Policy features for the wider workforce Comparison with executive director remuneration Salary Our salary is the basis for a competitive total reward package for all The salaries of our executive directors and executive team form the basis employees, and we conduct an annual salary review for all non-unionized of their total remuneration, and we review these salaries annually. employees. The primary purpose of the review is to stay aligned with relevant market As we determine salaries in this review, we take account of market rates comparators, although we ensure any increases are kept within the of pay at relevant comparators, the skills, knowledge and experience of budgets set for our wider workforce salary review. each individual, relativity to peers within BP, individual performance, and the overall budget we set for each country. In setting the budget each year, we assess how employee pay is currently positioned relative to market rates, forecasts of any further market increases, and business context related to such things as growth plans, workforce turnover and affordability. Pensions and We offer market-aligned benefits packages reflecting normal practice in Other than the addition of security-related benefits, our executive benefits each country in which we operate. Where appropriate, and subject to director benefit packages are broadly aligned with other employees who scale, we offer significant elements of personal benefit choice to our joined BP in the same country at the same time. employees. Given the variety of markets in which we operate, and with For new executive directors, pension benefits have been sharply the aspect of choice available to many employees, there is no identifiable reduced. Bernard Looney’s cash-in-lieu of pension allowance is set at pension rate for our wider workforce. For context, however, a majority of 15% of salary. His defined benefit calculation is based on his pre- our UK employees are entitled to a 15% (of salary) benefits budget. appointment salary and his accrued service is capped. Annual bonus Approximately half of our global workforce participate in an annual cash Annual bonus for executive directors is directly related to the same group bonus plan that multiplies a target bonus amount by a performance performance measures and outcomes as the wider workforce, but factor in the range 0 to 2. The performance factor is an average of without the individual performance element. performance outcomes measured at a group and individual level. This structure places equal emphasis on the importance of an employee’s personal contribution and the results achieved by BP. We operate different bonus plans for those distinct parts of our business where remuneration models in the market are markedly different, such as our trading and marketing businesses. Performance We operate a performance share plan with three-year vesting for Performance shares for our executive directors are assessed using the shares employees from our professional entry level and above. Operation varies same group performance scorecard used for the group leader based on seniority in three broad tiers: group leaders (approximately 400); performance shares. senior leaders (approximately 4,000); and all other professional employees (approximately 35,000 potential participants, of whom 20% will participate). Vesting is subject to group performance outcomes for the group leader population only. 112 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Group chief executive-to-employee pay ratio Equal pay and UK gender pay gap reporting Since 2016 we have disclosed the ratio between our group chief As well as looking at pay structures, the committee has spent time executive’s total remuneration and the median remuneration of a understanding how effectively current pay policies and processes comparator group of our UK and US professional and managerial maintain fairness and avoid bias in pay outcomes. We noted BP’s 2019 workforce (representing 38% of our global professional workforce). UK gender pay gap reporting, published in March 2020, for the five legal This calculation highlights pay differentials across the concentrated entities covered by the regulations, and the explanations provided in the portion of our workforce and thus we have retained this voluntary narrative that accompanied BP’s reporting. measure for the purpose of comparison over time. Overall the committee feels assured that the anti-discrimination For 2019, however, we also report the pay ratio based on the new controls written into pay policies, and the quality of processes behind requirements set out in the 2018 regulations. Given the markedly individual pay decision making, are effective in delivering an equal pay different comparator groups, the voluntary and required pay ratios environment (like pay for like work) for the wider workforce. While the are not directly comparable. The different ratios arise because of two UK gender pay gap reporting showed pay gaps in favour of men for four key differences: the required method includes BP hourly paid retail out of the five entities, we understand that these gaps result largely workforce in its fuels and convenience stations who are employed in from the relative under-representation of women in senior roles, and roles which attract relatively lower market rates of pay; and the required that the group’s primary focus should therefore be on improving method excludes the majority of our professional workforce, namely representation of women, rather than adjusting pay practices. We are those outside the UK, such as our Houston, Texas campus. encouraged by the various initiatives taken by management to address these representation concerns and will continue to monitor progress. 25th 50th 50th 75th The illustration below, from our 2019 UK gender pay gap reporting (the percentile percentile percentile percentile most recent available), highlights the representation issue and how it pay ratio pay ratio total pay pay ratio Year Method relates to the gender pay gap for each entity. For instance, our larger 2018 BP voluntary – 106:1 $136,865 – median gender pay gaps relate to BP Exploration and BP p.l.c. where $147,612/ we have the largest differential between representation of women in a a 2019 BP voluntary – 89:1 £115,683 – the top and bottom pay quartiles. By contrast, we reported a negative 2019 Option Ab 543:1c 188:1df £55,071 82:1e median pay gap in BP Chemicals (-12.4%), where male to female representation is more balanced. a Remuneration converted from $ to £ at an exchange rate of 1.276. b Option A has been selected as it is the most accurate approach. Pay and benefits have been calculated using values for the year ended 31 December 2019 and no broadly applicable components of pay or benefits have been omitted. Full-time equivalent remuneration has been calculated by mathematical engrossment. BP Exploration Operating c The relevant 25th percentile values are £19,108 total pay and benefits, and £18,845 salary. BP Chemicals Limited Company Limited d The relevant 50th percentile values are £55,071 total pay and benefits, and £38,800 salary. median pay gap -12.4% median pay gap 24.9% e The relevant 75th percentile values are £126,085 total pay and benefits, and £74,200 salary. Upper f The company believes that the 50th percentile pay ratio reflects total pay and benefits values 74% 26% Upper 90% 10% fully in line with reward policies for the group chief executive and the median UK employee respectively, and consequently that the ratio is consistent with policy. 73% 27% 84% 16% Percentage change comparisons: 88% 12% 80% 20% Lower GCE remuneration versus UK workforce 75% 25% Lower 58% 42% BP Chemicals is our petrochemicals business BP Exploration covers Upstream activities in the UK, principally our operation in Hull. Comparing 2019 to 2018 Salary Benefits Bonus in the UK, principally North Sea operations. % change in GCE remuneration 0% 6.3% 66.7% Men Women % change in comparator group remuneration 3.8% 1.0% 16.8% BP Oil UK Limited BP Express Shopping Limited median pay gap 9.5% median pay gap 4.0% The comparator group used here is our UK workforce, in line with the required basis for chief executive to employee pay ratio reporting and Upper 69% 31% Upper 61% 39% therefore provides a measure of consistency in reporting. 61% 39% 60% 40% Relative importance of spend on pay 69% 31% 49% 51% ($ million) Lower 42% 58% Lower 38% 62% Distributions to Remuneration paid to Capital investment shareholders all employees BP Oil represents our Downstream BP Express Shopping is our largest UK 15,238 15,140 fuels and lubricants businesses. employing business, concerned with retail operations supporting our UK-wide network of forecourts. 10,497b 9,844a 9,872 BP p.l.c. a 8,435 median pay gap 18.9% Upper 71% 29% 66% 34% 56% 44% 2019 2018 2019 2018 2019 2018 Lower 37% 63% a Distributions to shareholders comprise dividend payments of $8,333 million. ($8,080 million in 2018) and share buybacks at a cost of $1,511 million ($355 million in 2018). BP p.l.c. predominantly covers employees in Bar charts represent the balance between See page 299 for details. corporate business and functions, including male ( ) and female ( ) employees in each b This amount was misstated as $10,494 in our 2018 report. our integrated Supply and Trading and Air total pay quartile of the relevant business. BP businesses. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 113


 
Directors’ remuneration report Stewardship and executive director interests Value of current Multiple of Director Appointment date shareholding salary achieved We believe that our executive directors should have a material interest Bob Dudley October 2010 $28,145,173 15.18 x salary in the company, both during their tenure and after they leave BP. Our Brian Gilvary January 2012 £12,808,714 16.20 x salary recent shareholding policy therefore required executive directors to build a personal shareholding of five times their salary within five years Bob and Brian have interests in both performance shares and deferred of their appointment. They were expected to maintain personal bonus shares under the executive directors’ incentive plan (EDIP). The shareholdings of at least two and a half times salary for two years post share interests are shown in aggregate and by plan in the tables below. employment. Updates to this policy are proposed as an integral part of These figures show the maximum possible vesting levels. The actual our 2020 remuneration policy, as detailed on page 121. number of shares/ADSs that vest will depend on the extent to which Directors’ shareholdings (audited) performance conditions are satisfied. The tables below detail the personal shareholdings of each current Unvested Unvested Unvested and recent executive director. Both Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary ordinary shares ordinary shares Changes from ordinary shares significantly exceed the policy requirement at 3 March 2020, with or equivalents at or equivalents as 31 Dec 2019 to or equivalents at Bernard Looney building towards the policy requirement that applies Director 1 Jan 2019 31 Dec 2019 3 Mar 2020 3 Mar 2020 five years from his appointment on 5 February 2020. These figures Bob Dudleya 6,825,606b 6,639,882 -1,343,142 5,296,740 include all beneficial and non-beneficial ownership of shares of BP Brian Gilvary 3,291,614 2,905,764 -845,629 2,060,135 (or calculated equivalents) that have been disclosed to the company. a Held as ADSs. b This shareholding has been re-based to reflect the 500% of salary grant level of the 2017 Ordinary shares Ordinary shares Changes from Ordinary shares policy, in place of the original 550% per the 2014 policy. or equivalents at or equivalents at 31 Dec 2019 to or equivalents at Director 1 Jan 2019 31 Dec 2019 3 Mar 2020 3 Mar 2020 Bob Dudleya 3,718,284 4,592,208 698,238 5,290,446 Brian Gilvary 2,043,899 2,593,708 492,729 3,086,437 a Held as ADSs. Performance shares (audited) Share element interests Interests vested in 2019 and 2020 a Potential maximum performance shares Number of Performance Date of award of ordinary shares Face value of period performance shares At 1 Jan 2019 Awarded 2019 At 31 Dec 2019 vested Vesting date award, £ Bob Dudleyb 2016-18 4 Mar 2016 1,645,074c – – 1,619,844d 3 May 2019d – 2017-19 19 May 2017 1,571,628 – 1,571,628 1,319,478e 18 Feb 2020e – 2018-20 22 May 2018 1,395,600 – 1,395,600 – – 8,206,128 f 2019-21 19 Feb 2019 – 1,340,766 1,340,766 – – 7,199,913 g Brian Gilvary 2016-18 4 Mar 2016 786,559 – – 776,611d 3 May 2019d – 2017-19 19 May 2017 722,093 – 722,093 606,347e 18 Feb 2020e – 2018-20 22 May 2018 696,705 – 696,705 – – 4,096,625f 2019-21 19 Feb 2019 – 654,315 654,315 – – 3,513,672g a For awards under the 2016-18 plan, performance conditions are measured one third on TSR relative to Chevron, ExxonMobil, Shell and Total (‘comparator companies’); one third on operating cash flow; and one third on a balanced scorecard of strategic imperatives. There is no identified overall minimum vesting threshold level but to comply with UK regulations a value of 44.4%, which is conditional on the TSR, operating cash flow, each of the strategic imperatives and strategic progress reaching the minimum threshold, has been calculated. For awards under the 2017-19 plan, performance conditions are measured 50% on TSR relative to the comparator companies over three years, 30% on ROACE based on performance in 2019, and 20% on strategic progress assessed over the performance period. For awards under the 2018-2020 plan, performance conditions are measured on the same basis as the 2017-2019 plan, except ROACE which will be based on performance in the last two years of the performance period (i.e. 2019 and 2020). For awards under the 2019-2021 plan, performance conditions are measured 50% on TSR relative to the comparator companies over three years, 30% on strategic progress assessed over the performance period and 20% ROACE averaged over the full performance period. In the event that no threshhold performance targets are met, no shares would vest unless the committee found reason to exercise discretion. Each performance period ends on 31 December of the third year. b Bob Dudley received awards in the form of ADSs. The above numbers reflect calculated equivalents in ordinary shares. One ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares. c Bob Dudley has requested that the EDIP performance shares vesting in respect of the performance period 2016-2018 is based on the 500% maximum annual award level which applies under the 2017 directors’ remuneration policy, rather than the 550% maximum annual award level which applied under the 2014 directors’ remuneration policy. d Represents vestings of shares made at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan and includes reinvested dividends on the shares vested. This 2016-2018 award vested on 3 May 2019. The market price of each share at the vesting date was £5.48 and for ADSs was $43.08. Details can be found in the single figure table on page 108. e Represents vestings of shares made at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan and includes reinvested dividends on the shares vested. This 2017-2019 award vested on 18 February 2020. The market price of each share at the vesting date was £4.54 and for ADSs was $36.09. Details can be found in the single figure table on page 108. f The face value has been calculated using the market price at closing of ordinary shares on 22 May 2018 of £5.88. g The face value has been calculated using the market price at closing of ordinary shares on 19 February 2019 of £5.37. 114 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Deferred shares (audited)a Deferred share element interests Potential maximum deferred shares Interests vested in 2019 and 2020 Number of Face Date of award ordinary value of Bonus Performance of deferred At 1 Jan Awarded At 31 Dec shares Vesting the award, year Type period shares 2019 2019 2019 vested date £ Bob Dudleybc 2014 Comp 2015-17 11 Feb 2015 147,054 – 147,054 – – 655,861d Vol 2015-17 11 Feb 2015 147,054 – 147,054 – – 655,861d Mat 2015-17 11 Feb 2015 294,108 – 294,108 – – 1,311,722d 2015 Comp 2016-18 04 Mar 2016 275,892 – 275,892 – – 1,015,283e Vol 2016-18 04 Mar 2016 275,892 – 275,892 – – 1,015,283e Mat 2016-18 04 Mar 2016 551,784 – 551,784 – – 2,030,565e 2016 Comp 2017-19 19 May 2017 147,642 – 147,642 – – 696,870f Mat 2017-19 19 May 2017 147,642 – 147,642 – – 696,870f 2017 Comp 2018-20 22 May 2018 226,236 – 226,236 – – 1,330,268g 2018 Comp 2019-21 19 Feb 2019 118,584 118,584 – – 636,796h Brian Gilvary 2014 Mat 2015-17 11 Feb 2015 176,576 – 176,576 246,359i 18 Feb 20 – 2015 Comp 2016-18 04 Mar 2016 159,021 – 159,021 196,262j 19 Feb 19 – Vol 2016-18 04 Mar 2016 159,021 – 159,021 196,262j 19 Feb 19 – Mat 2016-18k 04 Mar 2016 318,042 – 318,042 – – 1,170,395 e 2016 Comp 2017-19 19 May 2017 73,070 – 73,070 86,176 i 18 Feb 20 – Mat 2017-19l 19 May 2017 73,070 – 73,070 – – 344,890f 2017 Comp 2018-20 22 May 2018 127,457 – 127,457 – – 749,447g 2018 Comp 2019-21 19 Feb 2019 64,436 64,436 – – 346,021h a Since 2010, vesting of the deferred shares has been subject to a safety and environmental sustainability hurdle. If the committee assesses that there has been a material deterioration in safety and environmental performance, or there have been major incidents, either of which reveal underlying weaknesses in safety and environmental management, then it may conclude that shares should vest only in part, or not at all. In reaching its conclusion, the committee will obtain advice from the SESAC. There is no identified minimum vesting threshold level. b Bob Dudley received awards in the form of ADSs. The above numbers reflect calculated equivalents in ordinary shares. One ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares. c Bob Dudley has voluntarily agreed to defer vesting of these awards until the later of one year post employment or the end of the relevant performance period, therefore the performance period will exceed the minimum term of three years. d The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 11 February 2015 of £4.46. e The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 4 March 2016 of £3.68. f The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 19 May 2017 of £4.72. g The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 22 May 2018 of £5.88. h The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 19 February 2019 of £5.37 i Represents vestings of shares made at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan and includes reinvested dividends on the shares vested. The market price of each share used to determine the total value at vesting on the vesting date of 18 February 2020 was £4.54. j Represents vestings of shares made at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan and includes reinvested dividends on the shares vested. The market price of each share used to determine the total value at vesting on the vesting date of 19 February 2019 was £5.38. These totals include the accrual of dividends which vested on 3 May 2019. k Brian Gilvary has voluntarily agreed to defer vesting of these matching awards for a total of five years with a further one-year retention period. l Brian Gilvary has voluntarily agreed to defer vesting of this matching award to at least one year post employment. In common with many of our UK employees, Brian Gilvary holds options under the BP group Save As You Earn (SAYE) schemes as shown below. These options are not subject to performance conditions. Share interests in share option plans (audited) Market price Date from At 1 Jan At 31 Dec Option at date of which first Expiry Option type 2019 Granted Exercised 2019a price exercise exercisable date Brian Gilvary BP 2011b 400,000 – – 400,000 £3.72 – 07 Sep 14 07 Sep 2021 SAYE 3,103 – 3,103 – £2.90 £5.07 01 Sep 19 28 Feb 2020 SAYE – 2,064 – 2,064 £4.36 01 Sep 22 28 Feb 2023 a The closing market prices of an ordinary share on 31 December 2019 was £4.72. During 2019 the highest market price was £5.83 and the lowest market price was £4.62. b BP 2011 means the BP 2011 plan. These options were granted to Brian Gilvary prior to his appointment as a director and are not subject to performance conditions. Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary have no interests in BP preference shares, debentures or option plans (other than as listed above), and no interests in shares or loan stock of any subsidiary company. No directors or other senior managers own more than 1% of the ordinary shares in issue. At 3 March 2020, our directors and senior managers collectively held interests of 19,004,688 ordinary shares or their calculated equivalents, 7,699,795 restricted share units (with or without conditions) or their calculated equivalents, 8,542,463 performance shares or their calculated equivalents and 4,299,972 options over ordinary shares or their calculated equivalents, under BP group share option schemes. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 115


 
Directors’ remuneration report Post employment share ownership interests As we reported last year, Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary will retain significant interests in BP post employment. They have given their personal commitment as executive directors to maintain actual holdings equivalent to two and a half times salary for two years post employment. The commitment is guaranteed by the fact that their anticipated interests in share awards under group plans which remain subject to vesting and/or holding periods at the time they leave BP exceed the two and a half times salary threshold. Although we are instituting a formal post employment share ownership requirement as part of our 2020 policy, given the foregoing, we see no need to modify the commitments of these outgoing executives. Non-executive director outcomes and interests The board’s remuneration policy for the chairman and non-executive directors (NEDs) was approved at the 2017 AGM and implemented during 2017. There has been no variance of the fees or allowances for the chairman and the NEDs since approval in 2017. Chairman The fee structure for the chairman, which has been in place since May 2013, is £785,000 per year. The chairman is not eligible for committee chairmanship and membership fees or intercontinental travel allowance. As chairman throughout 2019, Helge Lund had the use of a fully maintained office for company business, a car and driver, and security advice in London. The table below shows the fees paid for the year ended 31 December 2019. 2019 remuneration (audited) Fees Benefitsa Totalb £ thousand 2019 2018 2019 2018 2019 2018 Helge Lundc 785 46 95d 122d 880 169 Carl-Henric Svanberge – 785 – 24 – 809 a Benefits include travel and other expenses relating to attendance at board and other meetings. Amounts disclosed have been grossed up using a tax rate of 45%, where relevant, as an estimation of tax due. b Due to rounding, the totals may not agree exactly with the sum of the component parts. c Appointed as a director on 26 July 2018 and as chairman on 1 January 2019. d Benefits include relocation expenses. e Resigned on 31 December 2018. The figures below include all the beneficial and non-beneficial interests of the chairman in shares of BP (or calculated equivalents) that have been disclosed according to the disclosure guidance and transparency rules in the Financial Conduct Authority handbook (‘the DTRs’) as at the applicable dates. The chairman’s holdings as at 31 December 2019, as a percentage of the shareholding policy, were 361%. Ordinary Ordinary shares Ordinary shares Changes from shares or or equivalents at or equivalents as 31 Dec 2019 to equivalents at 1 Jan 2019 31 Dec 2019 3 Mar 2020 3 Mar 2020 Helge Lund 600,000 600,000 – 600,000 Non-executive directors’ fee structure The table below shows the fee structure for non-executive directors, per our 2017 policy. Fees £ thousand Senior independent directora 120 Board member 90 Audit, geopolitical, remuneration and SESA committees chairmanship feesb 30 Committee membership feec 20 Intercontinental travel allowance 5 a The senior independent director is eligible for committee chairmanship fees and intercontinental travel allowance plus any committee membership fees. b Committee chairmen do not receive an additional membership fee for the committee they chair. c For members of the audit, geopolitical, SESA and remuneration committees. 116 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance 2019 remuneration (audited) Fees Benefitsa Totalb £ thousand 2019 2018 2019 2018 2019 2018 Nils Andersen 161 132 11 11 172 144 Alan Boeckmannc 68 155 6 10 74 165 Admiral Frank Bowmanc 74 160 6 14 80 174 Dame Alison Carnwathd 115 74 33 47 148 121 Pamela Daleye 164 55 37 42 201 97 Sir Ian Davis 165 170 5 2 170 172 Professor Dame Ann Dowlingf 140 158 3 2 143 159 Melody Meyer 152 160 16 26 168 186 Brendan Nelson 150 150 11 12 161 162 Paula Rosput Reynolds 170 166 36 33 206 200 Sir John Sawers 145 150 1 1 146 151 a Benefits include travel and other expenses relating to the attendance at board and other meetings. Amounts disclosed have been grossed up using a tax rate of 45%, where relevant, as an estimation of tax due. b Due to rounding, the totals may not agree exactly with the sum of the component parts. c Resigned on 21 May 2019. d Appointed 21 May 2018. e Appointed 26 July 2018. f Fee includes £25,000 for chairing and being a member of the BP technology advisory council. Non-executive director fees are reviewed on a regular basis and were last changed in 2012. This year, following a review of the increasing time commitment associated with the role and taking into account non-executive director fees against those of comparable UK listed companies, the fee structure below will be adopted from 1 June 2020. Fees £ thousand Senior independent directora 155 Board member 115 Audit, geopolitical, remuneration and SESA committees chairmanship feesb 35 Committee membership feec 20 a The senior independent director is eligible for committee chairmanship fees plus any committee membership fees, excluding the nomination and governance committee. b Committee chairmen do not receive an additional membership fee for the committee they chair. c A membership fee is not payable for the chairman’s committee. The board has decided to remove the intercontinental travel allowance to simplify the structure of non-executive director fees, although under the proposed policy it retains the flexibility to reintroduce such an allowance. In addition, following a review of the time commitment required, a fee of membership of the nomination and governance committee will be introduced in line with other committee membership fees to compensate for the increased time commitment. The senior independent director will not be eligible for this fee and no fee is payable for chairing the nomination and governance committee. Non-executive directors’ interests The figures below indicate and include all the beneficial and non-beneficial interests of each non-executive director of the company in shares of BP (or calculated equivalents) that have been disclosed to the company under the DTRs as at the applicable dates. Ordinary shares Ordinary shares Changes from Ordinary shares or equivalents at or equivalents at 31 Dec 2019 to or equivalents at Value of current % of policy 1 Jan 2019 31 Dec 2019 3 Mar 2020 3 Mar 2020 shareholdinga achieved Nils Andersen 125,000 125,000 – 125,000 £518,750 576% Alan Boeckmannb 44,812cd Admiral Frank Bowmanb 24,864c Dame Alison Carnwath 17,700 17,700 – 17,700 £73,455 82% Pamela Daley 17,592c 17,592c – 17,592c $93,589 82% Sir Ian Davis 50,296 52,671 – 52,671 £218,585 243% Professor Dame Ann Dowling 22,320 22,320 – 22,320 £92,628 103% Melody Meyer 20,646c 20,646c – 20,646c $109,837 96% Brendan Nelson 11,040 11,040 – 11,040 £45,816 51% Paula Rosput Reynolds 73,200c 73,200c – 73,200c $389,424 339% Sir John Sawers 15,030 15,506 6,494 22,000 £91,300 101% a Based on share and ADS prices at 3 March 2020 of £4.15 and $31.92. b Resigned on 21 May 2019. c Held as ADSs. d Amended from 44,772 as originally disclosed in the 2018 report. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 117


 
Directors’ remuneration report Other disclosures Freshfields Bruckhaus Deringer LLP (‘Freshfields’) provided legal advice on specific compliance matters to the committee. Payments for loss of office and payments to past directors (audited) PwC and Freshfields provide other advice in their respective areas to the group. During the year, PwC provided BP with services including: We made no payments for loss of office during or in respect of 2019 subsidiary company secretarial support; global mobility; internal audit to current or former directors. Sir Ian Prosser (who retired as a non- subject matter expertise; cyber security risk reviews; tax modernization; executive director of BP in April 2010) was appointed as a director and low carbon strategy consulting; digital, data analytics and IT non-executive chairman of BP Pension Trustees Limited on 1 October implementation services. 2010. During 2019, he received £100,000 for this role. Other than this, we made no payment to any past director of BP during 2019 (we have Shareholder engagement no de minimis threshold for such disclosures). Throughout 2019 we continued to discuss remuneration policy and Historical TSR performance approach with many of our largest shareholders, as well as investor representative bodies. We plan to continue this dialogue in 2020, as we 250 consider updates to our remuneration policies for 2020 and beyond. 200 The table below shows the votes on the report for the last three years. AGM directors’ remuneration report vote results 150 % vote % vote Votes Year ‘for’ ‘against’ withheld 100 2019 95.93% 4.07% 337,586,814 50 2018 96.42% 3.58% 42,741,541 2017 97.05% 2.95% 63,453,383 0 2010 2013 2016 2019 The remuneration policy was approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM BP FTSE 100 on 17 May 2017. The votes on the policy are shown below. 2017 AGM directors’ remuneration policy vote results This graph shows the growth in value of hypothetical £100 investments in BP p.l.c. ordinary shares, and in the FTSE 100 Index (of which % vote % vote Votes BP is a constituent), over 10 years from 31 December 2009 to Year ‘for’ ‘against’ withheld 31 December 2019. 2017 97.28% 2.72% 36,563,886 Independence and advice External appointments The board considers all committee members to be independent The board supports executive directors taking up appointments with no personal financial interest, other than as shareholders, in the outside the company to broaden their knowledge and experience. committee’s decisions. Further detail on the activities of the committee, Each executive director is permitted to retain any fee from their external advice received, and shareholder engagement is set out in the appointments. Such external appointments are subject to agreement by remuneration committee report on page 101. the chairman and reported to the board. Any external appointment must not conflict with a director’s duties and commitments to BP. Details of During 2019 Hannah Ashdown and, from his appointment as company appointments as non-executive directors of publicly listed companies secretary on 7 May 2019, Ben Mathews, both of whom were employed during 2019 are shown below. by the company and reported to the chairman of the board, acted as secretary to the remuneration committee. Appointee Additional position held at The committee also received advice on various matters relating to the Director company appointee company Total fees remuneration of executive directors and senior management from Bob Dudley Rosnefta Director 0 Helmut Schuster, executive vice president, group human resources, Brian Gilvary Air Liquide SA Non-executive director Euros 77,500 and Ashok Pillai, vice president, group reward. a Bob Dudley holds this appointment as a result of the company’s shareholding in Rosneft. PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (‘PwC’) continued to provide independent advice to the committee in 2019, following its appointment as independent adviser to the committee in September 2017, following a competitive tender process. None of PwC’s consultants advising the BP remuneration committee have any connection with the company’s directors. Advice included, for example, support with the remuneration policy review and remuneration benchmarking. PwC is a member of the Remuneration Consulting Group and, as such, operates under the code of conduct in relation to executive remuneration consulting in the UK. The committee is satisfied that the advice received is objective and independent. Total fees or other charges (based on an hourly rate) for the provision of remuneration advice to the committee in 2019 (save in respect of legal advice) were £144,175 to PwC. 118 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Directors’ remuneration report – the 2020 policy In this part of our report we set out our directors’ remuneration policy for 2020 and subsequent years (the ‘2020 policy’). We will present this 2020 policy to shareholders at the 2020 annual general meeting and, subject to shareholder approval, it will take effect for the 2020 financial year. Remuneration principles In preparation for the review of our directors’ remuneration policy, the committee gave deep consideration to the changing reward frameworks for the wider workforce, alongside our more specific debates on executive remuneration. All of this is in the context of a changing business model as we evolve to meet and contribute to the low carbon energy transition. From this, we have drawn a unifying set of remuneration principles that apply equally to executives, and to employees at all levels of our workforce hierarchy. Alignment Our remuneration programmes will align with BP’s strategic priorities, long-term success and shareholders’ experience. In delivering our remuneration programmes across the globe we will reflect the policies and practices of the respective markets in which we operate. Competitiveness Total remuneration will be competitive for the role taking into account scale, sector, complexity of responsibility and geography. When setting senior executive pay, we will consider both external pay relativity and wider workforce remuneration and conditions. Pay for performance We promote a culture where all employees are accountable for delivering performance . Depending on the level of the individual in the organization, we use variable pay to incentivize delivery against performance. Pay will be delivered with an emphasis on long-term equity in line with seniority. Performance measures and targets will seek to balance collective BP success with clear line of sight for participants. Remuneration outcomes aim to reflect sustained long-term underlying performance of BP. Factors beyond the control of management will be adjusted in determining final outcomes. Judgement We will use discretion and judgement to review formulaic performance outcomes to arrive at fair and balanced remuneration outcomes for both BP and employees. Sustainability Remuneration programmes will support the development of a long-term sustainable business informed by environmental, societal and other inputs. Performance targets and measures will typically be chosen with due regard to incentives for prudent risk taking. Individual contribution and values and behaviours will be reflected in remuneration outcomes. Consideration of shareholder views We have reflected on the valuable shareholder engagement exercise that led to the significant changes from our 2014 to 2017 policy. In our view, those changes have stood up well over the last three years, have delivered remuneration outcomes that align to shareholders’ own experience, and have encouraged strategic decisions appropriate for the long term. Notably, the current 2017 policy also corresponds well to our recently concluded remuneration principles, shown above. Throughout 2019 we consulted widely with shareholder representatives individually and collectively. In particular through a constructive listening session with our largest shareholders in September 2019, we identified four broad themes for our future policy direction: • Clear end-to-end alignment from strategy, through measurable performance indicators and reward outcomes, to shareholder experience • Balance our contribution to the energy transition with delivering shareholder returns. The committee was encouraged to use appropriate discretion, given the complexity of the environment in the energy transition • Assure that strategic moves align to long-term sustainability, relative to a wide peer group • Use meaningful and transparent measures to reflect our progress in the energy transition and reductions to our carbon impact. We have concluded that the strongly performance-oriented reward model that has served us well in recovery from the aftermath of the 2010 Deepwater Horizon oil spill, and particularly the structure of our 2017 policy, broadly remains the right frame as we look ahead to the equally great challenge of reducing our carbon footprint. The 2020 policy set out below therefore retains and builds upon the 2017 policy structure, and thus commands the advantage of being well-understood and accepted by our executives and wider workforce alike. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 119


 
Directors’ remuneration report – 2020 policy Policy table – executive directors Salary and benefits Purpose To provide fixed remuneration to reflect the scale and complexity of both the business and the role, and to be competitive with the external market. Operation and Salary Benefits opportunity Salary levels will relate to the nature of the role, performance Executive directors are entitled to receive those benefits available of the business and the individual, market positioning and pay to all BP employees generally, such as participation in all-employee conditions in the wider BP group. There is no maximum salary share plans, sickness pay, relocation assistance and parental leave. under the policy. Benefits are not pensionable. When setting salaries, the committee considers practice in other Executive directors may receive other benefits that are judged to oil and gas majors as well as European and US companies of a be cost effective and appropriate in terms of the individual’s role, similar size, geographic spread and business dynamic to BP. The time and/or security. These include car-related benefits or cash committee will consider salary increases for the most senior in lieu, security, assistance with tax return preparation, insurance management and the wider workforce. In particular, percentage and medical benefits. The company may meet any tax charges increases for executive directors will not exceed increases for the arising on business-related benefits provided to directors, for broader employee population, other than in specific circumstances example security. identified by the committee (e.g. in response to a substantial The taxable value of benefits provided may fluctuate during the change in responsibilities). period of this policy, depending on the cost of provision and a Salaries are normally set in the home currency of the executive director’s personal circumstances. director and are reviewed annually. They may be reviewed at other In general, the committee expects to maintain benefits at the times where appropriate, for example following a major role change. current level. Performance Not applicable framework Retirement benefits Purpose To recognize competitive practice in home country. Operation and Executive directors normally participate in the company retirement Current executives (including designates) in BP have been opportunity plans that operate in their home country. employees of the group for a number of years and remain as participants in long-standing arrangements in which other similarly For future appointments, the committee will carefully review any situated employees continue to participate. retirement benefits to be granted to a new director, taking account of retirement policies across the wider group and any arrangements UK participants will become deferred pensioners of the company’s currently in place. Specifically, the committee will be sensitive to defined benefit plan. They will receive a cash supplement in lieu of investor concerns over pensions for directors, and limit pension further service accrual under the plan. contribution rates to no more than the median allowance offered to the wider workforce in the UK (as a percentage of salary). Performance Retirement benefits are not directly linked to performance. framework Annual bonus Purpose To provide variable remuneration dependent on performance against annual financial, operational, safety and environmental measures. 50% of the bonus is paid in cash and 50% is mandatorily deferred and held in BP shares for three years to reinforce the long-term nature of the business and the importance of sustainability. Operation and The bonus is based on performance against annual measures and The final bonus outcome, following the formulaic assessment of opportunity targets set at the start of the year, evaluated over the financial year performance relative to targets, is specifically reserved as a matter and assessed following the year end. for the committee’s judgement. Accordingly, the committee may exercise its discretion to adjust the formulaic outcome either The target annual bonus is half of the maximum available, and relates upwards or downwards. to delivery of performance in line with targets in the annual plan. Half the bonus is paid in cash, and half is deferred into BP shares Executive directors may earn a maximum annual bonus of 225% for three years. Dividends (or equivalents, including the value of any of salary. This maximum level would relate to performance at or reinvestment) may accrue in respect of any deferred shares. above the highest end of the performance scale for every measure. The committee intends to set demanding requirements for Awards are subject to malus and clawback provisions as described maximum payment. on page 123. 120 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Performance The committee determines a scorecard of specific measures, The scorecard will typically include a balance of financial, framework weightings and targets each year to reflect the priorities operational, environmental and safety measures. Details of the in the annual plan. The scorecard is designed to deliver the measures and weighting will be reported in advance each year in group’s strategy. the annual report on remuneration, while targets will be disclosed retrospectively. The committee holds discretion to choose the specific measures and weightings to be adopted within each of these categories to better reflect the annual plan as agreed with the board. Performance shares Purpose To link the largest part of remuneration opportunity with the long-term performance of the business. The outcome varies with performance against measures of relative total shareholder return (rTSR), return on average capital employed (ROACE) and an assessment related to the low carbon transition. Operation and The maximum annual award level for the chief executive officer will The shares that vest are subject to a holding period. The combined opportunity be 500% of salary and 450% of salary for the chief financial officer. length of the performance and holding periods will normally be six years. Annual awards of shares will vest based on performance relative to measures and targets that reflect the delivery of BP’s strategy over Dividends (or equivalents, including the value of reinvestment) may a performance period of typically three years. accrue in respect of share awards to the extent that they vest. For each measure, the threshold level at which vesting is Awards are subject to malus and clawback provisions as described first triggered is not expected to yield vesting above 25% of on page 123. the maximum. The final performance shares outcome, following the formulaic assessment of performance relative to targets, is specifically reserved as a matter for the committee’s judgement. Accordingly, the committee may exercise its discretion to adjust the formulaic outcome either upwards or downwards. Performance Performance shares vest relative to performance achieved against For the relative assessment of total shareholder returns, the framework a combination of financial and strategic measures. committee will in time consider broadening the comparator set as our own transition towards low carbon evolves. For 2020 awards, the measures (weightings) will be: We expect to outline specific measures for the low carbon / energy • Relative total shareholder return (40%) assessed relative to transition element later this year. This will follow, and align with, the Chevron, Eni, Equinor Exxon, Repsol, Shell and Total strategy update planned for our capital markets day later this year. • Return on average capital employed (30%). This will be assessed on a three-year average basis, with no adjustment for market The committee would consult appropriately with major conditions shareholders regarding any material changes to the measures. • Low carbon/energy transition (30%). The committee will assess safety outcomes over the perfomance At the outset of each cycle the committee will review the cycle as an underpin in determining the final vesting percentage. measures that are to govern the award, along with weightings and targets, to ensure they remain focused on delivering the strategy and are in the interests of shareholders. Shareholding requirements Purpose To provide alignment between the interests of executive directors and our other shareholders. Operation and The chief executive officer is required to build and maintain a Other executive directors are required to build and maintain opportunity minimum shareholding of five times base salary within five years a minimum shareholding of four and a half times base salary of appointment, and to maintain that minimum shareholding for at within five years of appointment, and to maintain that minimum least two years post-retirement. shareholding for at least two years post-retirement. Performance Not applicable. framework BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 121


 
Directors’ remuneration report – 2020 policy Notes to the policy table 1. New components and key changes from the 2017 policy While the structure of the 2017 policy has been retained, the committee highlights the following key changes from 2017: • A new requirement to limit the value of retirement benefits for service as an executive director. In practice, we do not expect to offer pension contribution rates worth more than 15% of salary. • The minimum shareholding requirement is clearly stated and continues to apply, in full, for two years post employment. This minimum shareholding requirement is now formally adopted as part of the remuneration policy. 2. How is variable pay linked to performance? 50% paid in cash; 50% in BP Annual bonus Bonus aligned with annual objectives shares deferred for 3 years Performance 6 years; 3 year performance period Share award for meeting three-year targets bonus + 3 year holding period Built up over 5 years Share ownership Long-term shareholding and maintained The three elements described above provide a balance between focus on short-term, medium-term and long-term performance, while encouraging behaviours which are in the long-term interests of shareholders. The operation of variable pay is supported by a focus on stewardship. There is a requirement that the chief executive officer will build up a holding of five times salary, and other executive directors a holding of four and a half times salary, over a period of five years following appointment and maintain that level during employment and for a further two years post employment. 3. How are performance measures linked to strategy? Variable pay is linked to performance measures designed to deliver the BP strategy. At the start of each year, the remuneration committee reviews the measures, targets and weightings to ensure they remain consistent with the priorities in the annual plan and the group strategy. For the annual bonus and performance shares, the approach to performance measurement is intended to provide a balance of measures to assess performance reflecting the global scale of the business, the unique characteristics of the oil and gas sector, and the role our enterprise will play in advancing the transition to lower carbon energy. The key changes from our 2017 policy, and a summary of measures for 2020 awards, are shown below: • Weighting of the environment target in our annual bonus scorecard is doubled to 20%. • Fewer measures in our annual bonus scorecard (from two to one on safety, from two to one on reliable operations, from three to two on financial performance). Our 2020 financial performance on cash flow changes from operating cash flow to free cash flow. • Weighting of the rTSR measure in our performance shares scorecard reduced to 40%. The comparator group has been expanded to include Repsol, ENI and Equinor. The low carbon / energy transition category replaces strategic progress and weighting increases to 30%. New remuneration policy measures for the period commencing in 2020 Annual bonus Safety Environment Operational performance Financial performance 20% 20% 10% 50% Performance shares Relative total shareholder return Return on average capital employment Low carbon / energy transition 40% 30% 30% Underpin: Take into account safety outcomes prior to determining final vesting percentage. Discretion to reflect shareholder experience, environmental, societal and other inputs. Robust malus and clawback. 122 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance 4. How will we use flexibility, judgement and discretion? The committee reviews BP’s performance against specific measures and targets, and in doing so may make both quantitative and qualitative assessments of performance in reaching its decisions. This involves the application of judgement and discretion, in which the committee also seeks relevant input from the board’s audit and safety, environment and security assurance committees. Accordingly, the committee may decide to adjust the formulaic outcome derived from the relevant scorecards, either upwards or downwards, to reflect broader considerations. The committee continues to consider that the powers of flexibility, judgement and discretion are critical to the successful execution of the policy. In framing the policy, the committee has taken care to ensure that these important powers continue to be available: • Sufficient flexibility to take account of future changes in the industry environment and in remuneration practice generally. This allows the committee to respond to changes in circumstances, for example in applying particular performance measures and/or weightings within the plans, or in broadening the comparator group for the relative returns measure, in order to evolve with the company’s strategy, without the need for specific shareholder approval. • Power to exercise judgement in making a qualitative assessment in certain circumstances. A number of measures are used for annual or long-term incentive awards, many of which are numerical in nature and require a quantitative assessment of performance. Others may require a qualitative assessment, such as the low carbon / energy transition measures in the performance shares plan. • Scope for the committee to exercise discretion, mainly where it is desirable to vary a formulaic outcome that would otherwise arise from the policy’s implementation. The committee considers that the ability to exercise discretion, upwards or downwards, is important to ensure that a particular outcome is fair in light of the director’s own performance, the company’s overall performance and positioning under particular performance measures and outcomes for shareholders. The committee intends to provide appropriate disclosure on the use of discretion so that shareholders can understand the basis for its decisions. 5. How will we safeguard against payments for failure? Performance A significant portion of remuneration varies with performance – based pay where performance targets are not achieved, lower or no payments will be made under the plans. Discretion The committee may vary formulaic outcomes where these do not suitably reflect performance over the relevant performance period. Malus and clawback The malus provisions enable the committee to reduce the size of The clawback provisions enable the committee to require award, cancel an unvested award, or impose further conditions on participants to return some or all of an award after payment or an award made under this policy. vesting. They may be applied under the following circumstances: The malus provisions may apply if, prior to the vesting or payment • incorrect outcomes due to miscalculation or based on incorrect of an award, there is a negative event such as: information • restatement due to financial reporting failure or misstatement of • material failure impacting safety or environmental sustainability audited results • incorrect award outcomes due to miscalculation or based on • material misconduct by the participant. incorrect information • restatement due to financial reporting failure or misstatement of audited results • material misconduct by the participant • such other exceptional circumstances that the committee consider to be similar in nature. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 123


 
Directors’ remuneration report – 2020 policy 6. Differences from remuneration policy in the wider group This executive director remuneration policy is structurally similar to remuneration for the majority of the wider workforce, but naturally differs in quantum reflecting market norms for the differing size and complexity of roles. Although performance assessment is a common feature for executive and wider workforce remuneration, the relative importance of different performance measures changes in line with seniority. For instance, executive directors are subject to longer-term measures and no individual performance element, whereas the majority of the wider workforce receive variable pay that is based on annual performance measures, including their own individual performance. Illustrations of application of remuneration policy The total remuneration opportunity for executive directors is strongly performance based and weighted to the long term. The charts below provide scenarios for the total remuneration of executive directors at different levels of performance and are calculated as prescribed in UK regulations. Bernard Looney Brian Gilvary Min 100% £1.5m Min 100% £1.1m Mid 25% 23% 52% £6.3m Mid 29% 24% 48% £3.8m Max 14% 27% 59% £11.0m Max 17% 28% 55% £6.4m Fixed pay Annual bonus Performance shares Fixed pay Annual bonus Performance shares Murray Auchincloss Min 100% £0.85m Mid 27% 24% 49% £3.2m Max 15% 28% 56%a £5.5m Fixed pay Annual bonus Performance shares a Due to rounding, the sum of the parts does not equal 100%. The remuneration outcomes reported above reflect the face value of performance shares and therefore exclude the impact of potential share price growth, as well as dividends. If share prices were to appreciate by 50% from face value, then the maximum remuneration receivable by Bernard Looney, Brian Gilvary and Murray Auchincloss would increase to £14.2m, £8.2m and £7.1m respectively. Fixed components For these illustrations salary, benefits and pension are the same in all three scenarios (annual values shown). Salary CEO (Looney) £1,300,000 Bernard Looney’s salary from appointment on 5 February 2020. CFO (Gilvary) £790,500 Brian’s salary, effective until his retirement from BP on 30 June 2020. CFO (Auchincloss) £695,000 Murray’s salary, effective from his appointment on 1 July 2020. Benefits and CEO (Looney) £245,000 Based on pension benefits at 15% of salary, with an estimated £50,000 total for other benefits. pension benefits CFO (Gilvary) £296,150 Based on Brian’s 30% cash in lieu of pension, plus the total of other benefits shown in the 2019 single figure table. CFO (Auchincloss) £154,250 Based on pension benefits at 15% of salary, with an estimated £50,000 total for other benefits. Variable components Variable pay under the policy comprises annual bonus and performance shares. Scenario Minimum Mid Maximum Annual bonus Threshold not met 50% of maximum 100% of maximum (including cash and Nil 112.5% of salary 225% of salary deferred elements) Performance Threshold not met 50% vesting 100% vesting shares CEO – Nil CEO – 250% of salary CEO – 500% of salary CFO – Nil CFO – 225% of salary CFO – 450% of salary 124 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance 7. Clarity, simplicity, and other considerations related to the Service contract Corporate Governance Code Bob Dudley’s service contract is with BP Corporation North America The committee consider the scorecard-based approach to setting Inc., Bernard Looney’s and Brian Gilvary’s service contracts are with targets and measuring outcomes provides great clarity in our ability to BP p.l.c., and Murray Auchincloss’ service contract will be with BP p.l.c. engage transparently with shareholders and the wider workforce on remuneration arrangements, and that this is complemented by retaining Each executive director is entitled to retirement benefits as outlined on the simple structure of our 2017 policy; market aligned fixed pay with page 120. annual cash and three-year performance share incentives. Risks are Each executive director is also entitled to the following contractual managed through a combination of careful setting of performance benefits: measures and targets, the many options to apply committee discretion in assessing outcomes, and the robust malus and clawback measures • If appropriate for security reasons, a company car and driver is reserved in this policy. The committee also considers that remuneration provided for business and private use, with the company bearing outcomes are predictable, as shown clearly in the scenario charts at note all normal employment, servicing, insurance and running costs. 6 above, and proportional by virtue of the challenging performance levels Alternatively, where not required for security reasons, a cash required to achieve target pay outcomes. By retaining material weighting allowance may be paid instead. in measures related to both safety and the environment, this policy • Medical and dental benefits, sick pay during periods of absence and aligns closely with central themes of BP’s culture, purpose and ambition. assistance with the preparation of tax returns. • Indemnification in accordance with applicable law. Recruitment policy • Participation in bonus or incentive arrangements at the committee’s sole discretion. The committee expects any new executive director to be engaged on terms that are consistent with the policy. However it recognizes that it Each executive director may terminate their employment by giving cannot anticipate circumstances in which any new executive director may 12 months’ written notice. In this event, for business reasons, the be recruited. The committee may determine that it is in the interests of employer may not necessarily hold the executive director to their full the company and shareholders to secure the services of a particular notice period. individual which may require it to take account of the terms of that The employer may lawfully terminate the executive director’s individual’s existing employment and/or their personal circumstances. employment in the following ways: Accordingly, the committee will ensure that: • By giving the director 12 months’ written notice. • The salary level of any new director is appropriate to their role and • Without compensation, in circumstances where the employer is the competitive environment at the time of appointment. Where entitled to terminate for cause, as defined for the purposes of their appropriate it may appoint an individual on a lower salary (relative to service contract. any previous incumbent), then gradually increase salary levels as the The company may lawfully terminate employment by making a lump individual gains experience in the role. sum payment in lieu of notice equal to 12 months’ salary or by monthly • Variable remuneration will be awarded within the parameters of instalments rather than as a lump sum. the policy for current executive directors. • The committee may tailor the vesting criteria for initial incentive The lawful termination mechanisms described above are without awards depending on the specific circumstances. prejudice to the employer’s ability in appropriate circumstances to • Where an existing employee is promoted to the board, the company terminate in breach of the notice period referred to above, and thereby may honour all existing contractual commitments including any to be liable for damages to the executive director. outstanding share awards or pension entitlements. In the event of termination by the company, each executive director • The committee would expect any new director to participate may have an entitlement to compensation in respect of their statutory in the company pension and benefit schemes that are open to rights under employment protection legislation in the UK and potentially other employees (where appropriate referencing the candidate’s elsewhere. Where appropriate the company may also meet a director’s home country). reasonable legal expenses in connection with either their appointment • Where an individual is relocating in order to take up the role, the or termination of their appointment. company may provide certain one-off benefits such as reasonable relocation expenses, accommodation for a period following Copies of the executive directors’ service contracts, along with the appointment, assistance with visa applications or other immigration non-executive director appointment letters, are available for inspection issues and ongoing arrangements such as tax filing assistance, at the registered office of BP p.l.c. annual flights home and a housing/utilities allowance. • Where an individual would be forfeiting remuneration or employment terms in order to join the company, the committee may award appropriate compensation. The committee would require reasonable evidence of the nature and value of any forfeited arrangements and would, to the extent practicable, ensure any compensation was of comparable commercial value and capped as appropriate, considering the terms of the previous arrangement being forfeited (for example the form and structure of award, timeframe, performance criteria and likelihood of vesting). Where appropriate, the committee prefers to deliver buy-outs in the form of restricted shares in the company. In making any decision on the remuneration of a new director, the committee would balance shareholder expectations, current best practice and the circumstances of any new director. It would strive not to pay more than is necessary to recruit the right candidate and would give full details in the next remuneration report. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 125


 
Directors’ remuneration report – 2020 policy Termination payments In determining overall termination arrangements, the committee will distinguish between types of leaver and the circumstances of their leaving. The committee would also consider all relevant circumstances, including whether a contractual provision in the director’s arrangements complied with best practice at the time of termination and the date the provision was agreed, as well as the performance of the director in certain respects. Where appropriate, the committee may consider providing certain benefits relating to termination including the provision of outplacement support or reasonable costs associated with relocation back to an individual’s home country. Should it become necessary to terminate an executive director’s employment, and therefore to determine a termination payment, the committee’s policy is as follows: Termination The director’s primary entitlement would be a termination payment If the departing director is eligible for an early retirement pension, payments in respect of their service agreement, as set out above. However the committee would consider, if relevant under the terms of the the committee will consider mitigation to reduce the termination appropriate plan, the extent of any actuarial reduction that should be payment where appropriate to do so, taking into account the applied. UK directors who leave in circumstances approved by the circumstances for leaving and the terms of the agreement. committee may have a favourable actuarial reduction applied to their Mitigation would not be applicable where a contractual payment pensions (which to date has been 3%). Departing directors who in lieu of notice is made. leave in other circumstances may be subject to a greater reduction. Annual bonus The committee would consider whether the director should be Normally, any such bonus would be restricted to the director’s entitled to an annual bonus in respect of the financial year in which actual period of service in that financial year. the termination occurs. Share awards Share awards will be treated in accordance with the relevant plan In deciding whether to exercise discretion to preserve EDIP rules. For awards granted under the executive directors’ incentive awards, the committee would also consider the proximity of the plan (EDIP), the treatment can only be made in accordance with the award to its maturity date. framework approved by shareholders. To the extent that any such share award vests, the release of those The committee would consider whether conditional share awards shares to the former director will be made approximately one year held by the director should lapse on leaving or should, at the after their date of termination (even if they would have been subject committee’s discretion, be preserved. If awards are preserved, to a longer holding period had the executive remained in the award would normally continue until the vesting date. Awards employment with BP). may be pro-rated based on service over the performance period. Legacy arrangements and other detailed provisions Previously the deferred element of the annual bonus in respect of years up to and including 2016 attracted a corresponding award of matching shares. Although the committee no longer grants matching awards in respect of future bonus awards, executives retain interests in legacy awards previously granted under this arrangement under the terms set out in the 2014 policy. For completeness, the table below summarizes the key terms of the previous matching share element. Purpose To reinforce the long-term nature of the business and the importance of sustainability. Operation Previously one third of the annual bonus was subject to compulsory Where shares vest, additional shares representing the value of deferral and a further third was subject to voluntary deferral. reinvested dividends are added. These deferred shares were matched on a one-for-one basis. All deferred shares are subject to clawback provisions if they are found to have been granted on the basis of a material misstatement of financial or other data. Performance Both deferred and matching shares must pass an additional hurdle If there has been a material deterioration in safety and framework related to safety and environmental sustainability performance in environmental metrics, or major incidents revealing underlying order to vest. weaknesses in safety and environmental management then the committee, with advice from the board’s safety, environment and security assurance committee, may conclude that shares vest in part, or not at all. In addition to the award described above, the committee may continue to satisfy existing remuneration commitments and/or payments for loss of office, including the exercise of any discretion in connection with such payments provided that such terms were agreed: • before 10 April 2014 when the first approved remuneration policy came into effect • before the 2020 policy came into effect, provided that the terms of the payment were consistent with the shareholder-approved directors’ remuneration policy in force at the time they were agreed • at a time when the relevant individual was not a director of the company and, in the opinion of the committee, the payment was not in consideration for the individual becoming a director. Share awards are subject to the terms of the relevant plan rules under which the award has been granted. The committee may adjust or amend awards, but only in accordance with the provisions of the plan rules. This includes making adjustments to awards to reflect one-off corporate events, such as a change in the company’s capital structure or treatment of awards in the event of a change of control. In accordance with the plan rules, awards may be settled in cash rather than shares, where the committee considers this appropriate. The committee may make minor amendments to the policy to aid its operation or implementation without seeking shareholder approval, for example for regulatory, exchange control, tax or administrative purposes or to take account of a change in legislation provided that any such change is not to the material advantage of the directors. 126 BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019


 
Corporate governance Remuneration in the wider group The committee considers employment conditions in the BP group when establishing and implementing policy for executive directors to ensure the alignment of and context for principles and approach. In particular, the committee reviews the policy and makes decisions for the most senior leaders (the BP leadership team that reports to the CEO). Decisions regarding remuneration for employees outside the most senior leaders are the responsibility of the chief executive officer. The committee does not consult directly with employees when formulating the policy. However, feedback from employee focus groups and employee surveys, that are regularly reported to the board, provide views on a wide range of employee matters including pay. The wider employee group participates in performance-based incentives. Throughout the group, salary and benefit levels are set in accordance with the prevailing relevant market conditions and practice in the countries in which employees are based. Differences between executive director pay policy and that of other employees reflect the senior position of the individuals, prevailing market conditions and corporate governance practices in respect of executive director remuneration. The key difference in policy for executive directors is that a greater proportion of total remuneration is delivered as performance-based incentives. Policy table – non-executive directors The following table sets out the framework that will be used to determine the fees for non-executive directors during the term of this policy. Non-executive chairman Fees Approach Remuneration is in the form of cash fees, payable monthly. The level and structure of the chairman’s remuneration will primarily be compared against UK best practice. Operation and The quantum and structure of the non-executive chairman’s remuneration is reviewed annually by the remuneration committee, which opportunity makes a recommendation to the board. Benefits and expenses Approach The chairman is provided with support and reasonable travelling expenses. Operation and The chairman is provided with an office and full-time secretarial and administrative support in London and a contribution to an office opportunity and secretarial support in his home country as appropriate. A car and the use of a driver is provided in London, together with security assistance. All reasonable travelling and other expenses (including any relevant tax) incurred in carrying out his duties is reimbursed. Non-executive directors Fees Approach Remuneration is in the form of cash fees, payable monthly. Remuneration practice is consistent with recognized best practice standards for non-executive directors’ remuneration and, as a UK-listed company, the level and structure of non-executive directors’ remuneration will primarily be compared against UK best practice. Additional fees may be payable to reflect additional board responsibilities, for example, committee chairmanship and membership and for the role of senior independent director. Operation and The level and structure of non-executive directors’ remuneration is reviewed by the chairman, the CEO and the company secretary who opportunity make a recommendation to the board. Non-executive directors do not vote on their own remuneration. Remuneration for non-executive directors is reviewed annually. Intercontinental allowance Approach Non-executive directors may receive an allowance to reflect the global nature of the company’s business. This allowance would be payable for the purpose of attending board or committee meetings or site visits. Operation and This allowance would be paid in cash following each event of intercontinental travel. opportunity Benefits and expenses Approach Non-executive directors are provided with administrative support and reasonable travelling expenses. Professional fees are reimbursed in the form of cash, payable following the provision of advice and assistance. Operation and Non-executive directors are reimbursed for all reasonable travelling and subsistence expenses (including any relevant tax) incurred in opportunity carrying out their duties. Professional fees incurred by non-executive directors based outside the UK in connection with advice and assistance on UK tax compliance matters are reimbursed. Shareholding guidelines Approach Non-executive directors are encouraged to establish a holding in BP shares of the equivalent value of one year’s base fee. Letters of appointment for chairman and non-executive directors Approach The chairman and non-executive directors each have letters of appointment. There is no term limit on a director’s service, as BP proposes all directors for annual re-election by shareholders in line with best governance practice. There are no obligations arising from the non-executive directors’ letters of appointment for remuneration or payments for loss of office, except for the chairman whose appointment may be terminated in the following ways: • by either party giving three months’ written notice, or • by the company for cause (as set out in the letter of appointment) and without compensation. The company may lawfully terminate the appointment by making a lump sum payment in lieu of notice equal to three months’ fees. Copies of the executive directors’ service contracts and non-executive directors’ letters of appointment are available for inspection at the registered office of the company. The maximum fees for non-executive directors are set in accordance with the Articles of Association. This directors’ remuneration report was approved by the board and signed on its behalf by Ben J.S. Mathews, company secretary on 18 March 2020. BP Annual Report and Form-20F 2019 127


 
Pages 128-129 have been removed as they do not form part of BP’s Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC. 128 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 
Corporate governance Pages 128-129 have been removed as they do not form part of BP’s Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 129


 
Energy with purpose means transforming while performing. Energy with purpose BPX Energy: Delivering synergies We have been transforming BPX Energy, our US onshore oil and gas business, with the purchase of world-class unconventional assets from BHP. • The acquisition gave us access to some of the best basins in the onshore US, with 487,000 acres of leasehold across a new position in the liquids-rich Permian-Delaware basin, and two positions in the Eagle Ford and Haynesville basins. • It positions BP as a top producer in the region. Good progress Since we began operating the assets, we have delivered synergies of $240 million in 2019, above our planned target of $90 million. 130 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019


 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial
statements
 
132
 
 
Independent auditor’s
 
 
 
Group statement of
 
 
 
reports
146
 
 
changes in equity
154
 
 
152
 
 
155
 
 
Group statement of
 
 
 
156
 
 
 
comprehensive income
153
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
157
 
 
 
1.
Significant accounting
 
 
21.
Valuation and qualifying
 
 
 
 
 
policies
157
 
 
accounts
192
 
 
 
2.
Non-current assets
 
 
22.
Trade and other
 
 
 
 
 
held for sale
173
 
 
payables
193
 
 
 
3.
Business combinations
 
 
23.
Provisions
193
 
 
 
 
and other significant
 
 
24.
Pensions and other post-
 
 
 
 
 
transactions
174
 
 
retirement benefits
194
 
 
 
4.
Disposals and
 
 
25.
Cash and cash equivalents
200
 
 
 
 
impairment
175
 
26.
Finance debt
200
 
 
 
5.
Segmental analysis
177
 
27.
Capital disclosures and
 
 
 
 
6.
Revenue from contracts
 
 
 
net debt
201
 
 
 
 
with customers
180
 
28.
Leases
202
 
 
 
7.
Income statement
 
 
29.
Financial instruments and
 
 
 
 
 
analysis
180
 
 
financial risk factors
202
 
 
 
8.
Exploration expenditure
181
 
30.
Derivative financial
 
 
 
 
9.
Taxation
181
 
 
instruments
207
 
 
 
10.
Dividends
184
 
31.
Called-up share capital
215
 
 
 
11.
Earnings per share
184
 
32.
Capital and reserves
216
 
 
 
12.
Property, plant and
 
 
33.
Contingent liabilities
219
 
 
 
 
equipment
186
 
34.
Remuneration of senior
 
 
 
 
13.
Capital commitments
187
 
 
management and non-
 
 
 
 
14.
Goodwill
187
 
 
executive directors
220
 
 
 
15.
Intangible assets
188
 
35.
Employee costs and
 
 
 
 
16.
Investments in joint
 
 
 
numbers
221
 
 
 
 
ventures
189
 
36.
Auditor’s remuneration
221
 
 
 
17.
Investments in
 
 
37.
Subsidiaries, joint
 
 
 
 
 
associates
189
 
 
arrangements and
 
 
 
 
18.
Other investments
191
 
 
associates
 
222
 
 
 
19.
Inventories
191
 
38.
Condensed consolidating
 
 
 
 
 
20.
Trade and other
 
 
 
information on certain US
 
 
 
 
 
 
receivables
192
 
 
subsidiaries
 
223
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
232
Supplementary information on oil and natural gas (unaudited)
 
 
 
Oil and natural gas
 
 
 
Standardized measure of
 
 
 
 
exploration and production
 
 
 
discounted future net cash
 
 
 
 
activities
233
 
 
flows and changes therein
 
 
 
 
Movements in estimated net
 
 
 
relating to proved oil and
 
 
 
 
proved reserves
239
 
 
gas reserves
254
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Operational and statistical
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
information
 
257
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
131


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
























Pages 132-145 have been removed as they do not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.


























This page does not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.

132
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


























Pages 132-145 have been removed as they do not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.


























This page does not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
133


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the shareholders and board of directors of BP p.l.c.
Opinion on the financial statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated group balance sheets of BP p.l.c. (the company) and subsidiaries (together the group) as at 31 December 2019 and 2018, and the related consolidated group income statements, group statements of comprehensive income, group statements of changes in equity, and group cash flow statements, for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2019, and the related notes as well as the legal proceedings described on pages 319-320 (collectively referred to as the 'group financial statements'). In our opinion, the group financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the group as at 31 December 2019 and 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2019, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the European Union and IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the group's internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2019, based on criteria established in the UK Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting relating to internal control over financial reporting and our report dated 18 March 2020 expressed an unqualified opinion on the group's internal control over financial reporting.
Basis for opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of the group's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the group's financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the group in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Critical Audit Matters
The critical audit matters communicated below are matters arising from the current-period audit of the group financial statements that were communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (1) relate to accounts or disclosures that are material to the group financial statements and (2) involved especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matters below, providing separate opinions on the critical audit matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they relate.
Throughout the course of our audit we identify risks of material misstatement ('risks'). We consider both the likelihood of a risk and the potential magnitude of a misstatement in making the assessment. Certain risks are classified as 'significant' or 'higher' depending on their severity. The category of the risk determines the level of evidence we seek in providing assurance that the associated financial statement item is not materially misstated.
Impairment of upstream oil and gas property, plant and equipment (PP&E) assets - Notes 1 and 12 to the financial statements
Critical Audit Matter Description
The group balance sheet includes property, plant and equipment (PP&E) of $133 billion, of which $90 billion is oil and gas properties within the upstream segment.
Management announced an approximately $10 billion disposal programme for 2019 and 2020. As a consequence of this, certain assets identified for disposal have been assessed for impairment in the context of their fair value based on the expected disposal proceeds from third parties, as opposed to their value in use.
The transition to a lower carbon global economy may potentially lead to a lower oil and gas price scenario in the future due to declining demand. Management took into account considerations of uncertainty over the pace of the transition to lower-carbon supply and demand and the social, political and environmental actions that will be taken to meet the goals of the Paris climate change agreement when determining their future oil and gas price assumptions and revised the future price assumptions downwards when compared with the prior year assumptions as set out in Note 1 on page 162. As a consequence, they identified a risk of impairment across all upstream CGUs.
Accordingly, as required by International Accounting Standard (IAS) 36 'Impairment of Assets', management performed a review of all the upstream cash generating units (CGUs) for indicators of impairment and impairment reversal as at 31 December 2019. Further information has been provided in Note 1.
In large part due to the disposal programme, for the year ended 31 December 2019 BP recorded $5,871 million of upstream impairment charges and $129 million of impairment reversals. Through our risk assessment procedures, we have determined that there are three key estimates in management’s determination of the level of impairment charge/reversal to record. These are:
a.
Oil and gas prices - BP’s oil and gas price assumptions have a significant impact on CGU impairment assessments and valuations performed across the portfolio, and are inherently uncertain. Furthermore, as noted above the estimation of future oil and gas prices is subject to increased uncertainty, given climate change and the global energy transition. There is a risk that management’s oil and gas price assumptions are not reasonable, leading to a material misstatement. The assumptions are highly judgemental.
b.
Discount rates - Given the long timeframes involved, certain recoverable amounts of assets are sensitive to the discount rate applied. There is a risk that discount rates do not reflect the return required by the market and the risks inherent in the cash flows being discounted, leading to a material misstatement. Determination of the appropriate discount rate can be judgemental.
c.
Reserves estimates - A key input to impairment assessments and valuations is the production forecast, in turn closely related to the group’s reserves estimates and field development assumptions. CGU-specific estimates are not generally material. However, material

146
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


misstatements could arise either from systematic flaws in reserves estimation policies, or due to flawed estimates in a particularly material individual impairment test.
We identified and focused on certain individual CGUs with a total carrying value of $12.3 billion which we determined would be most at risk of a material impairment as a result of a reasonably possible change in the key assumptions, particularly the oil and gas price assumptions. Accordingly, we identified these as a significant audit risk. We also focused on assets with a further $33.4 billion of combined CGU carrying value which were less sensitive. We identified these as a higher audit risk as they would be potentially at risk in aggregate to a material impairment by a change in such assumptions. Further information regarding these sensitivities is given in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.
How the Critical Audit Matter was addressed in the Audit
We tested management’s internal controls over the setting of oil and gas prices, discount rates and reserve estimates, as well as the controls over the performance of the impairment valuation tests. In addition, we conducted the following substantive procedures.
Oil and gas prices
We independently developed a reasonable range of forecasts based on external data obtained, against which we compared the company’s future oil and gas price assumptions in order to challenge whether they are reasonable.
In developing this range we obtained a variety of reputable third party forecasts, peer information and market data.
In challenging management's price assumptions, we considered the extent to which they and each of the forecast pricing scenarios obtained from third parties reflect the impact of lower oil and gas demand due to climate change. We specifically reviewed third party forecasts stated as being, or interpreted by us as being, consistent with achieving the 2015 COP 21 Paris agreement goal to limit temperature rises to well below 2°C (Paris 2°C Goal).
We reviewed and challenged management’s disclosures including in relation to the sensitivity of oil and gas price assumptions to reduced demand scenarios whether due to climate change or other reasons.
Discount rates
We independently evaluated BP’s discount rates used in impairment tests with input from Deloitte valuation specialists.
We assessed whether country risks and tax adjustments were appropriately reflected in BP’s discount rates.
Reserves estimates
We reviewed BP’s reserves estimation methods and policies, assisted by Deloitte reserves experts.
We assessed, with the assistance of Deloitte reserves experts, how these policies had been applied to a sample of internal reserves estimates.
We reviewed reports provided by external experts and assessed their scope of work and findings.
We assessed the competence, capability and objectivity of BP’s internal and external reserve experts, through obtaining their relevant professional qualifications and experience.
We compared hydrocarbon production forecasts used in impairment tests to estimates and reports and our understanding of the life of fields.
We performed a retrospective review to check for indications of estimation bias over time.
Other procedures
We challenged management’s CGU determination, and considered whether there was any contradictory evidence present.
We validated that BP’s asset impairment methodology was appropriate and tested the integrity of impairment models.
Where relevant, we also assessed management’s historical forecasting accuracy and whether the estimates had been determined and applied on a consistent basis across the group.
Since 31 December 2019, the oil price has fallen sharply in large part due to the impact of the international spread of COVID-19 (Coronavirus) and geopolitical factors. As part of our post balance sheet audit procedures we considered whether these events provide evidence of conditions that existed at the balance sheet date.
Impairment of exploration and appraisal assets (included within 'intangible assets' within the group balance sheet) - Notes 1 and 15 to the financial statements
Critical Audit Matter Description
The group capitalizes exploration and appraisal (E&A) expenditure on a project-by-project basis in line with IFRS 6 'Exploration for and Evaluation of Mineral Resources'. At the end of 2019, $14 billion of E&A expenditure was carried in the group balance sheet. E&A activity is inherently risky and a significant proportion of projects fail, requiring the write-off of the related capitalized costs when the relevant criteria in IFRS 6 and BP’s accounting policy are met.
There is a significant judgement relating to the risk that certain capitalized E&A costs are not written off promptly at the appropriate time, in line with information from, and decisions about, E&A activities and the impairment requirements of IFRS 6.
Furthermore, similar to upstream PP&E assets discussed above, E&A assets are also potentially exposed to climate change and the global energy transition. A greater number of projects may be expected not to proceed as a consequence of lower forecast future demand, lower appetite by management and the board to allocate capital to certain projects, or increased objections from stakeholders to the development of certain projects.
During the current year, and subsequent to the year end, management have obtained license extensions in the Gulf of Mexico and other regions where licenses had previously expired such that we have concluded this does not represent a significant audit risk. Nevertheless, given the inherent uncertainty associated with the development and deployment of these assets, we still consider this area to be a higher risk.
How the Critical Audit Matter was addressed in the Audit
We obtained an understanding of the group’s E&A impairment assessment processes and tested management’s internal controls,

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
147


including the controls addressing potential climate change considerations.
We performed a licence-by-licence risk assessment of the group’s E&A balance through to year end, to identify significant carrying amounts with a current period risk of impairment (e.g. new information from exploration activities, or imminent licence expiry).
We performed a retrospective review of impairment charges recorded in the period, and assessed whether impairment charges were timely.
We reviewed and challenged management’s significant IFRS 6 impairment judgements, having regard to the impairment criteria of IFRS 6 and BP’s accounting policy. We verified key facts relevant to significant carrying amounts (by obtaining for example evidence of future E&A plans and budgets, and evidence of active dialogue with partners and regulators including negotiations to renew licences or modify key terms).
We tested the completeness and accuracy of information used in management’s E&A impairment assessment, by reviewing and testing key controls over management’s register of E&A licences and agreeing key aspects of this to underlying support (e.g. licence documentation); holding meetings and discussions with operational and finance management; considering adverse changes in management’s reserves and resource estimates associated with E&A assets; reviewing correspondence with regulators and joint arrangement partners; and considering the implications of capital allocation decisions. When considering capital allocation decision making, we considered whether the development of any projects would be inconsistent with the elements of BP’s current strategy which are designed to ensure it is resilient to the energy transition and climate change considerations or which would otherwise have a prohibitively high environmental or social impact for the directors to sanction the necessary investment.
Accounting for structured commodity transactions (SCTs) within the integrated supply and trading function (IST), and the valuation of other level 3 financial instruments, where fraud risks may arise in revenue recognition (potentially impacting all financial statement accounts, in particular finance debt) - Notes 1, 20, 22, 29 and 30 to the financial statements
Critical Audit Matter Description
In the normal course of business, IST enters into a variety of transactions for delivering value across the group’s supply chain. The nature of these transactions requires significant audit effort be directed towards challenging management’s valuation estimates or the adopted accounting treatment.
Accounting for structured commodity transactions:
IST may also enter into a variety of transactions which we refer to as SCTs. We generally consider a SCT to be an arrangement having one of the following features:
Two or more counterparties with non-standard contractual terms;
Multiple commodity-based transactions; and/or
Contractual arrangements entered into in contemplation of each other.
SCTs are often long-dated, can have a significant multi-year financial impact, and may require the use of complex valuation models or unobservable inputs when determining their fair value, in which case they will be classified as level 3 financial instruments under IFRS 13, ‘Fair Value Measurement’.
Accounting for SCTs is often complex and involves significant judgement, as these transactions often feature multiple elements that will have a material impact on the presentation and disclosure of these transactions in the financial statements and on key performance measures, including in particular classification of liabilities as finance debt. We have identified the accounting for SCTs as a significant audit risk.
Level 3 financial instruments:
Unlike other financial instruments whose values or inputs are readily observable and therefore more easily independently corroborated, there are certain transactions for which the valuation is inherently more subjective due to the use of either complex valuation models and/or unobservable inputs. These instruments are classified as level 3 financial assets or liabilities under IFRS 13. This degree of subjectivity also gives rise to potential fraud through management incorporating bias in determining fair values. Accordingly, we have identified these as a significant audit risk.
As at 31 December 2019, the group’s total financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value were $12.5 billion and $8.8 billion, of which level 3 derivative financial assets were $5.3 billion and level 3 derivative financial liabilities were $4.4 billion.
How the Critical Audit Matter was addressed in the Audit
Accounting for SCTs
For structured commodity transactions, we performed audit procedures to:
Test controls related to the accounting for complex transactions.
Develop an understanding of the commercial rationale of the transactions through review of transaction support documents and executed agreements, and discussions with management.
Perform a detailed accounting analysis for a sample of structured commodity transactions involving significant day one profits, deferred working capital arrangements, offtake arrangements and/or commitments.
To assess the appropriateness of the accounting treatment of SCTs, we embedded technical accounting specialists within the audit team.
During the year we identified two new SCTs which were subjected to our audit procedures listed above. We also reconsidered the SCTs which were identified during 2018 and which have been subject to ongoing assessment in 2019.
Other level 3 financial instruments:
To address the complexities associated with auditing the value of level 3 financial instruments, the engagement team included valuation specialists having significant quantitative and modelling expertise to assist in performing our audit procedures. Our valuation audit procedures included the following control and substantive procedures:
We tested the group’s valuation controls including the:

148
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Model certification control, which is designed to review a model’s theoretical soundness and the appropriateness of its valuation methodology; and
Independent price verification control, which is designed to review the appropriateness of valuation inputs that are not observable and are significant to the financial instrument’s valuation.
We performed substantive valuation testing procedures at interim and year-end balance sheet date, including:
Engaging a Deloitte valuations specialist to develop fair value estimates, using independently sourced inputs where these were available, and challenge models to evaluate against management’s fair value estimates by evaluating whether the differences between our independent estimates and management’s estimates were within a reasonable range. In situations where we utilised management’s inputs, these were compared to external data sources to ensure they were reasonable;
Evaluating management’s valuation methodologies against standard valuation practice and analysing whether a consistent framework is applied across the business period over period; and
Comparing management’s input assumptions against the expected assumptions of other market participants and observable market data.



/s/ Deloitte LLP

London
United Kingdom
18 March 2020

The first accounting period we audited was the 12 months ended 31 December 2018. In 2017, we commenced our audit planning procedures.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
149


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the shareholders and board of directors of BP p.l.c.

Opinion on internal control over financial reporting
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of BP p.l.c. and subsidiaries (the Company) as at 31 December 2019, based on the criteria established in the UK Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting relating to internal control over financial reporting (UK FRC Guidance). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2019, based on the criteria established in the UK FRC Guidance.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 31 December 2019, of the Company and our report dated 18 March 2020, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.
Basis for opinion
The Company's management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Definition and limitations of internal control over financial reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


/s/ Deloitte LLP
London, United Kingdom
18 March 2020



150
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the shareholders and board of directors of BP p.l.c.

Opinion on the financial statements
We have audited the accompanying group balance sheet of BP p.l.c. (the Company) as of 31 December 2017, and the related group income statement, group statement of comprehensive income, group statement of changes in equity and group cash flow statement for the period ended 31 December 2017, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the "group financial statements"). In our opinion, the group financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of BP p.l.c. at 31 December 2017 and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the period ended 31 December 2017, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the European Union and IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
Basis for opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of BP p.l.c.'s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to BP p.l.c. in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audit included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audit also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.


/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
We served as the Company's auditor from 1909 to 2018.
London, United Kingdom
29 March 2018

Note that the report set out above is included for the purposes of BP p.l.c.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for 2019 only and does not form part of BP p.l.c.’s Annual Report and Accounts for 2017.































 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
151


Group income statement
For the year ended 31 December
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Note

2019

2018

2017

Sales and other operating revenues
 
5

278,397

298,756

240,208

Earnings from joint ventures – after interest and tax
 
16

576

897

1,177

Earnings from associates – after interest and tax
 
17

2,681

2,856

1,330

Interest and other income
 
7

769

773

657

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4

193

456

1,210

Total revenues and other income
 
 
282,616

303,738

244,582

Purchases
 
19

209,672

229,878

179,716

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
 
21,815

23,005

24,229

Production and similar taxes
 
5

1,547

1,536

1,775

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
5

17,780

15,457

15,584

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4

8,075

860

1,216

Exploration expense
 
8

964

1,445

2,080

Distribution and administration expenses
 
 
11,057

12,179

10,508

Profit before interest and taxation
 
 
11,706

19,378

9,474

Finance costs
 
7

3,489

2,528

2,074

Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
24

63

127

220

Profit before taxation
 
 
8,154

16,723

7,180

Taxation
 
9

3,964

7,145

3,712

Profit for the year
 
 
4,190

9,578

3,468

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
   BP shareholders
 
 
4,026

9,383

3,389

   Non-controlling interests
 
 
164

195

79

 
 
 
4,190

9,578

3,468

Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
 
Profit for the year attributable to BP shareholders
 
 
 
 
 
Per ordinary share (cents)
 
 
 
 
 
   Basic
 
11

19.84

46.98

17.20

   Diluted
 
11

19.73

46.67

17.10

Per ADS (dollars)
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
11

1.19

2.82

1.03

Diluted
 
11

1.18

2.80

1.03




152
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Group statement of comprehensive incomea 
For the year ended 31 December
 
 
 
 
 $ million

 
 
Note

2019

2018

2017

Profit for the year
 
 
4,190

9,578

3,468

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 
 
1,538

(3,771
)
1,986

Exchange (gains) losses on translation of foreign operations reclassified to gain or loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
 
880


(120
)
Available-for-sale investments
 
 


14

Cash flow hedges marked to market
 
30

(100
)
(126
)
197

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement
 
30

106

120

116

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the balance sheet
 
30



112

Costs of hedging marked to market
 
30

(4
)
(244
)

Costs of hedging reclassified to the income statement
 
30

57

58


Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
16, 17

82

417

564

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 
9

(70
)
4

(196
)
 
 
 
2,489

(3,542
)
2,673

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
24

328

2,317

3,646

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 
30

(3
)
(37
)

Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 
9

(157
)
(718
)
(1,303
)
 
 
 
168

1,562

2,343

Other comprehensive income
 
 
2,657

(1,980
)
5,016

Total comprehensive income
 
 
6,847

7,598

8,484

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
 
6,674

7,444

8,353

Non-controlling interests
 
 
173

154

131

 
 
 
6,847

7,598

8,484

a
See Note 32 for further information.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
153


Group statement of changes in equitya 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Share capital and capital reserves

Treasury shares

Foreign currency translation reserve

Fair value reserves

Profit and loss account

BP shareholders' equity

Non-controlling interests

Total equity

At 31 December 2018
 
46,352

(15,767
)
(8,902
)
(987
)
78,748

99,444

2,104

101,548

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 16, net of tax
 




(329
)
(329
)
(1
)
(330
)
At 1 January 2019
 
46,352

(15,767
)
(8,902
)
(987
)
78,419

99,115

2,103

101,218

Profit for the year
 




4,026

4,026

164

4,190

Other comprehensive income
 


2,407

52

189

2,648

9

2,657

Total comprehensive income
 


2,407

52

4,215

6,674

173

6,847

Dividendsb
 




(6,929
)
(6,929
)
(213
)
(7,142
)
Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet, net of tax
 



23


23


23

Repurchase of ordinary share capital
 




(1,511
)
(1,511
)

(1,511
)
Share-based payments, net of tax
 
173

1,355



(809
)
719


719

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 




5

5


5

Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 




316

316

233

549

At 31 December 2019
 
46,525

(14,412
)
(6,495
)
(912
)
73,706

98,412

2,296

100,708

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2017
 
46,122

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9, net of tax
 



(54
)
(126
)
(180
)

(180
)
At 1 January 2018
 
46,122

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
(797
)
75,100

98,311

1,913

100,224

Profit for the year
 




9,383

9,383

195

9,578

Other comprehensive income
 


(3,746
)
(216
)
2,023

(1,939
)
(41
)
(1,980
)
Total comprehensive income
 


(3,746
)
(216
)
11,406

7,444

154

7,598

Dividendsb
 




(6,699
)
(6,699
)
(170
)
(6,869
)
Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet, net of tax
 



26


26


26

Repurchase of ordinary share capital
 




(355
)
(355
)

(355
)
Share-based payments, net of tax
 
230

1,191



(718
)
703


703

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 




14

14


14

Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 






207

207

At 31 December 2018
 
46,352

(15,767
)
(8,902
)
(987
)
78,748

99,444

2,104

101,548

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2017
 
46,122

(18,443
)
(6,878
)
(1,153
)
75,638

95,286

1,557

96,843

Profit for the year
 




3,389

3,389

79

3,468

Other comprehensive income
 


1,722

410

2,832

4,964

52

5,016

Total comprehensive income
 


1,722

410

6,221

8,353

131

8,484

Dividendsb
 




(6,153
)
(6,153
)
(141
)
(6,294
)
Repurchases of ordinary share capital
 




(343
)
(343
)

(343
)
Share-based payments, net of tax
 

1,485



(798
)
687


687

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 




215

215


215

Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 




446

446

366

812

At 31 December 2017
 
46,122

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404

a See Note 32 for further information.
b See Note 10 for further information.


154
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Group balance sheet
At 31 December
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Note

2019

2018a

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
12

132,642

135,261

Goodwill
 
14

11,868

12,204

Intangible assets
 
15

15,539

17,284

Investments in joint ventures
 
16

9,991

8,647

Investments in associates
 
17

20,334

17,673

Other investments
 
18

1,276

1,341

Fixed assets
 
 
191,650

192,410

Loans
 
 
630

637

Trade and other receivables
 
20

2,147

1,834

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

6,314

5,145

Prepayments
 
 
781

1,179

Deferred tax assets
 
9

4,560

3,706

Defined benefit pension plan surpluses
 
24

7,053

5,955

 
 
 
213,135

210,866

Current assets
 
 
 
 
Loans
 
 
339

326

Inventories
 
19

20,880

17,988

Trade and other receivables
 
20

24,442

24,478

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

4,153

3,846

Prepayments
 
 
857

963

Current tax receivable
 
 
1,282

1,019

Other investments
 
18

169

222

Cash and cash equivalents
 
25

22,472

22,468

 
 
 
74,594

71,310

Assets classified as held for sale
 
2

7,465


 
 
 
82,059

71,310

Total assets
 
 
295,194

282,176

Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
22

46,829

46,265

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

3,261

3,308

Accruals
 
 
5,066

4,626

Lease liabilities
 
28

2,067

44

Finance debta
 
26

10,487

9,329

Current tax payable
 
 
2,039

2,101

Provisions
 
23

2,453

2,564

 
 
 
72,202

68,237

Liabilities directly associated with assets classified as held for sale
 
2

1,393


 
 
 
73,595

68,237

Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 
22

12,626

13,830

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

5,537

5,625

Accruals
 
 
996

575

Lease liabilities
 
28

7,655

623

Finance debta
 
26

57,237

55,803

Deferred tax liabilities
 
9

9,750

9,812

Provisions
 
23

18,498

17,732

Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 
24

8,592

8,391

 
 
 
120,891

112,391

Total liabilities
 
 
194,486

180,628

Net assets
 
 
100,708

101,548

Equity
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders’ equity
 
32

98,412

99,444

Non-controlling interests
 
32

2,296

2,104

Total equity
 
32

100,708

101,548

a Finance debt on the comparative balance sheet has been re-presented to align with the current period. See Note 1 for further information.

Helge Lund Chairman
B Looney Chief executive officer
18 March 2020

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
155


Group cash flow statement
For the year ended 31 December
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Note

2019

2018

2017

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
Profit before taxation
 
 
8,154

16,723

7,180

Adjustments to reconcile profit before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 
8

631

1,085

1,603

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
5

17,780

15,457

15,584

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4

7,882

404

6

Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 
 
(3,257
)
(3,753
)
(2,507
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 
 
1,962

1,535

1,253

Interest receivable
 
 
(441
)
(468
)
(304
)
Interest received
 
 
416

348

375

Finance costs
 
7

3,489

2,528

2,074

Interest paid
 
 
(2,870
)
(1,928
)
(1,572
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
24

63

127

220

Share-based payments
 
 
730

690

661

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 
24

(238
)
(386
)
(394
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
 
(176
)
986

2,106

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
 
(3,406
)
672

(848
)
(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
 
(2,335
)
(2,858
)
(4,848
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
 
2,823

(2,577
)
2,344

Income taxes paid
 
 
(5,437
)
(5,712
)
(4,002
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
25,770

22,873

18,931

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
 
(15,418
)
(16,707
)
(16,562
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 
3

(3,562
)
(6,986
)
(327
)
Investment in joint ventures
 
 
(137
)
(382
)
(50
)
Investment in associates
 
 
(304
)
(1,013
)
(901
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
 
(19,421
)
(25,088
)
(17,840
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
4

500

940

2,936

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 
4

1,701

1,911

478

Proceeds from loan repayments
 
 
246

666

349

Net cash used in investing activities
 
 
(16,974
)
(21,571
)
(14,077
)
Financing activitiesa
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase of shares
 
 
(1,511
)
(355
)
(343
)
Lease liability payments
 
 
(2,372
)
(35
)
(45
)
Proceeds from long-term financing
 
 
8,597

9,038

8,712

Repayments of long-term financing
 
 
(7,118
)
(7,175
)
(6,231
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 
 
180

1,317

(158
)
Net increase (decrease) in non-controlling interests
 
 
566


1,063

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
10

(6,946
)
(6,699
)
(6,153
)
Non-controlling interests
 
 
(213
)
(170
)
(141
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
 
(8,817
)
(4,079
)
(3,296
)
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 
 
25

(330
)
544

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 
 
4

(3,107
)
2,102

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 
 
22,468

25,575

23,484

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 
 
22,472

22,468

25,586

a The presentation of financing cash flows for the comparative periods have been amended to align with the current period. See Note 1 for further information.


156
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Notes on financial statements
1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions
Authorization of financial statements and statement of compliance with International Financial Reporting Standards
The consolidated financial statements of BP p.l.c and its subsidiaries (collectively referred to as BP or the group) for the year ended 31 December 2019 were approved and signed by the chief executive officer and chairman on 18 March 2020 having been duly authorized to do so by the board of directors. BP p.l.c. is a public limited company incorporated and domiciled in England and Wales. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), IFRS as adopted by the European Union (EU) and in accordance with the provisions of the UK Companies Act 2006 as applicable to companies reporting under IFRS. IFRS as adopted by the EU differs in certain respects from IFRS as issued by the IASB. The differences have no impact on the group’s consolidated financial statements for the years presented. The significant accounting policies and accounting judgements, estimates and assumptions of the group are set out below.
Basis of preparation
The consolidated financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis and in accordance with IFRS and IFRS Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) interpretations issued and effective for the year ended 31 December 2019. The accounting policies that follow have been consistently applied to all years presented, except where otherwise indicated.
The consolidated financial statements are presented in US dollars and all values are rounded to the nearest million dollars ($ million), except where otherwise indicated.
Significant accounting policies: use of judgements, estimates and assumptions
Inherent in the application of many of the accounting policies used in preparing the consolidated financial statements is the need for BP management to make judgements, estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses. Actual outcomes could differ from the estimates and assumptions used. The accounting judgements and estimates that have a significant impact on the results of the group are set out in boxed text below, and should be read in conjunction with the information provided in the Notes on financial statements. The areas requiring the most significant judgement and estimation in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are: accounting for the investment in Rosneft; exploration and appraisal intangible assets; the recoverability of asset carrying values, including the estimation of reserves; derivative financial instruments; provisions and contingencies; and pensions and other post-retirement benefits. Where an estimate has a significant risk of resulting in a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year this is specifically noted within the boxed text. The group does not consider income taxes to represent a significant estimate or judgement for 2019, see Income taxes for more information.
Basis of consolidation
The group financial statements consolidate the financial statements of BP p.l.c. and its subsidiaries drawn up to 31 December each year. Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date of their acquisition, being the date on which the group obtains control, and continue to be consolidated until the date that control ceases. The financial statements of subsidiaries are prepared for the same reporting year as the parent company, using consistent accounting policies. Intra-group balances and transactions, including unrealized profits arising from intra-group transactions, have been eliminated. Unrealized losses are eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Non-controlling interests represent the equity in subsidiaries that is not attributable, directly or indirectly, to BP shareholders.
Interests in other entities
Business combinations and goodwill
Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. The identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recognized at their fair values at the acquisition date.
Goodwill is initially measured as the excess of the aggregate of the consideration transferred, the amount recognized for any non-controlling interest and the acquisition-date fair values of any previously held interest in the acquiree over the fair value of the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date. The amount recognized for any non-controlling interest is measured at the present ownership's proportionate share in the recognized amounts of the acquiree’s identifiable net assets. At the acquisition date, any goodwill acquired is allocated to each of the cash-generating units, or groups of cash-generating units, expected to benefit from the combination’s synergies. Following initial recognition, goodwill is measured at cost less any accumulated impairment losses. Goodwill arising on business combinations prior to 1 January 2003 is stated at the previous carrying amount under UK generally accepted accounting practice, less subsequent impairments. See Note 14 for further information.
Goodwill may arise upon investments in joint ventures and associates, being the surplus of the cost of investment over the group’s share of the net fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities. Any such goodwill is recorded within the corresponding investment in joint ventures and associates.
Goodwill may also arise upon acquisition of interests in joint operations that meet the definition of a business. The amount of goodwill separately recognized is the excess of the consideration transferred over the group's share of the net fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities.
Interests in joint arrangements
The results, assets and liabilities of joint ventures are incorporated in these consolidated financial statements using the equity method of accounting as described below.
Certain of the group’s activities, particularly in the Upstream segment, are conducted through joint operations. BP recognizes, on a line-by-line basis in the consolidated financial statements, its share of the assets, liabilities and expenses of these joint operations incurred jointly with the other partners, along with the group’s income from the sale of its share of the output and any liabilities and expenses that the group has incurred in relation to the joint operation.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
157


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Interests in associates
The results, assets and liabilities of associates are incorporated in these consolidated financial statements using the equity method of accounting as described below.
Significant judgement: investment in Rosneft
Judgement is required in assessing the level of control or influence over another entity in which the group holds an interest. For BP, the judgement that the group has significant influence over Rosneft Oil Company (Rosneft), a Russian oil and gas company is significant. As a consequence of this judgement, BP uses the equity method of accounting for its investment and BP's share of Rosneft's oil and natural gas reserves is included in the group's estimated net proved reserves of equity-accounted entities. If significant influence was not present, the investment would be accounted for as an investment in an equity instrument measured at fair value as described under 'Financial assets' below and no share of Rosneft's oil and natural gas reserves would be reported.
Significant influence is defined in IFRS as the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the investee but is not control or joint control of those policies. Significant influence is presumed when an entity owns 20% or more of the voting power of the investee. Significant influence is presumed not to be present when an entity owns less than 20% of the voting power of the investee.
BP owns 19.75% of the voting shares of Rosneft. The Russian federal government, through its investment company JSC Rosneftegaz, owned 50% plus one share of the voting shares of Rosneft at 31 December 2019. IFRS identifies several indicators that may provide evidence of significant influence, including representation on the board of directors of the investee and participation in policy-making processes. BP’s group chief executive, as at 31 December 2019, Bob Dudley, has been a member of the board of directors of Rosneft since 2013 and remains one of BP's nominated directors following his resignation as BP's group chief executive. He is also chairman of the Rosneft board’s Strategic Planning Committee. A second BP-nominated director, Guillermo Quintero, has been a member of the Rosneft board and its HR and Remuneration Committee since 2015. BP also holds the voting rights at general meetings of shareholders conferred by its 19.75% stake in Rosneft. BP's management consider, therefore, that the group has significant influence over Rosneft, as defined by IFRS.
The equity method of accounting
Under the equity method, an investment is carried on the balance sheet at cost plus post-acquisition changes in the group’s share of net assets of the entity, less distributions received and less any impairment in value of the investment. Loans advanced to equity-accounted entities that have the characteristics of equity financing are also included in the investment on the group balance sheet. The group income statement reflects the group’s share of the results after tax of the equity-accounted entity, adjusted to account for depreciation, amortization and any impairment of the equity-accounted entity’s assets based on their fair values at the date of acquisition. The group statement of comprehensive income includes the group’s share of the equity-accounted entity’s other comprehensive income. The group’s share of amounts recognized directly in equity by an equity-accounted entity is recognized in the group’s statement of changes in equity.
Financial statements of equity-accounted entities are prepared for the same reporting year as the group. Where material differences arise in the accounting policies used by the equity-accounted entity and those used by BP, adjustments are made to those financial statements to bring the accounting policies used into line with those of the group.
Unrealized gains on transactions between the group and its equity-accounted entities are eliminated to the extent of the group’s interest in the equity-accounted entity.
The group assesses investments in equity-accounted entities for impairment whenever there is objective evidence that the investment is impaired. If any such objective evidence of impairment exists, the carrying amount of the investment is compared with its recoverable amount, being the higher of its fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. If the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount, the investment is written down to its recoverable amount.
Segmental reporting
The group’s operating segments are established on the basis of those components of the group that are evaluated regularly by the group chief executive, BP’s chief operating decision maker, in deciding how to allocate resources and in assessing performance.
The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as the group’s accounting policies described in this note, except that IFRS requires that the measure of profit or loss disclosed for each operating segment is the measure that is provided regularly to the chief operating decision maker. For BP, this measure of profit or loss is replacement cost profit before interest and tax which reflects the replacement cost of inventories sold in the period and is arrived at by excluding inventory holding gains and losses from profit. Replacement cost profit for the group is not a recognized measure under IFRS. For further information see Note 5.
Foreign currency translation
In individual subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates, transactions in foreign currencies are initially recorded in the functional currency of those entities at the spot exchange rate on the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated into the functional currency at the spot exchange rate on the balance sheet date. Any resulting exchange differences are included in the income statement, unless hedge accounting is applied. Non-monetary assets and liabilities, other than those measured at fair value, are not retranslated subsequent to initial recognition.
In the consolidated financial statements, the assets and liabilities of non-US dollar functional currency subsidiaries, joint ventures, associates, and related goodwill, are translated into US dollars at the spot exchange rate on the balance sheet date. The results and cash flows of non-US dollar functional currency subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates are translated into US dollars using average rates of exchange. In the consolidated financial statements, exchange adjustments arising when the opening net assets and the profits for the year retained by non-US dollar functional currency subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates are translated into US dollars are recognized in a separate component of equity and reported in other comprehensive income. Exchange gains and losses arising on long-term intra-group foreign currency borrowings used to finance the group’s non-US dollar investments are also reported in other comprehensive income if the borrowings form part of the net investment in the subsidiary, joint venture or associate. On disposal or for certain partial disposals of a non-US dollar functional currency subsidiary, joint venture or associate, the related accumulated exchange gains and losses recognized in equity are reclassified from equity to the income statement.

158
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Non-current assets held for sale
Non-current assets and disposal groups classified as held for sale are measured at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell.
Significant non-current assets and disposal groups are classified as held for sale if their carrying amounts will be recovered through a sale transaction rather than through continuing use. This condition is regarded as met only when the sale is highly probable and the asset or disposal group is available for immediate sale in its present condition subject only to terms that are usual and customary for sales of such assets. Management must be committed to the sale, which should be expected to qualify for recognition as a completed sale within one year from the date of classification as held for sale, and actions required to complete the plan of sale should indicate that it is unlikely that significant changes to the plan will be made or that the plan will be withdrawn.
Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets are not depreciated or amortized once classified as held for sale.
Intangible assets
Intangible assets, other than goodwill, include expenditure on the exploration for and evaluation of oil and natural gas resources, computer software, patents, licences and trademarks and are stated at the amount initially recognized, less accumulated amortization and accumulated impairment losses.
Intangible assets are carried initially at cost unless acquired as part of a business combination. Any such asset is measured at fair value at the date of the business combination and is recognized separately from goodwill if the asset is separable or arises from contractual or other legal rights.
Intangible assets with a finite life, other than capitalized exploration and appraisal costs as described below, are amortized on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives. For patents, licences and trademarks, expected useful life is the shorter of the duration of the legal agreement and economic useful life, and can range from three to fifteen years. Computer software costs generally have a useful life of three to five years.
The expected useful lives of assets and the amortization method are reviewed on an annual basis and, if necessary, changes in useful lives or the amortization method are accounted for prospectively.
Oil and natural gas exploration, appraisal and development expenditure
Oil and natural gas exploration, appraisal and development expenditure is accounted for using the principles of the successful efforts method of accounting as described below.
Licence and property acquisition costs
Exploration licence and leasehold property acquisition costs are capitalized within intangible assets and are reviewed at each reporting date to confirm that there is no indication that the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount. This review includes confirming that exploration drilling is still under way or planned or that it has been determined, or work is under way to determine, that the discovery is economically viable based on a range of technical and commercial considerations, and sufficient progress is being made on establishing development plans and timing. If no future activity is planned, the remaining balance of the licence and property acquisition costs is written off. Lower value licences are pooled and amortized on a straight-line basis over the estimated period of exploration. Upon internal approval for development and recognition of proved reserves of oil and natural gas, the relevant expenditure is transferred to property, plant and equipment.
Exploration and appraisal expenditure
Geological and geophysical exploration costs are recognized as an expense as incurred. Costs directly associated with an exploration well are initially capitalized as an intangible asset until the drilling of the well is complete and the results have been evaluated. These costs include employee remuneration, materials and fuel used, rig costs and payments made to contractors. If potentially commercial quantities of hydrocarbons are not found, the exploration well costs are written off. If hydrocarbons are found and, subject to further appraisal activity, are likely to be capable of commercial development, the costs continue to be carried as an asset. If it is determined that development will not occur then the costs are expensed.
Costs directly associated with appraisal activity undertaken to determine the size, characteristics and commercial potential of a reservoir following the initial discovery of hydrocarbons, including the costs of appraisal wells where hydrocarbons were not found, are initially capitalized as an intangible asset. Upon internal approval for development and recognition of proved reserves, the relevant expenditure is transferred to property, plant and equipment.
The determination of whether potentially economic oil and natural gas reserves have been discovered by an exploration well is usually made within one year of well completion, but can take longer, depending on the complexity of the geological structure. Exploration wells that discover potentially economic quantities of oil and natural gas and are in areas where major capital expenditure (e.g. an offshore platform or a pipeline) would be required before production could begin, and where the economic viability of that major capital expenditure depends on the successful completion of further exploration or appraisal work in the area, remain capitalized on the balance sheet as long as such work is under way or firmly planned.
Development expenditure
Expenditure on the construction, installation and completion of infrastructure facilities such as platforms, pipelines and the drilling of development wells, including service and unsuccessful development or delineation wells, is capitalized within property, plant and equipment and is depreciated from the commencement of production as described below in the accounting policy for property, plant and equipment.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
159


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Significant judgement: exploration and appraisal intangible assets
Judgement is required to determine whether it is appropriate to continue to carry costs associated with exploration wells and exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells on the balance sheet. This includes costs relating to exploration licences or leasehold property acquisitions. It is not unusual to have such costs remaining suspended on the balance sheet for several years while additional appraisal drilling and seismic work on the potential oil and natural gas field is performed or while the optimum development plans and timing are established.The costs are carried based on the current regulatory and political environment or any known changes to that environment. All such carried costs are subject to regular technical, commercial and management review on at least an annual basis to confirm the continued intent to develop, or otherwise extract value from, the discovery. Where this is no longer the case, the costs are immediately expensed.
In scenarios where the expected time horizon for establishing the development plan is lengthy or uncertain, greater judgement is required. BP is in the exploration and appraisal phase in certain Canadian oil sands assets that require further advancement of low-carbon extraction technology in order to achieve optimum development. Sufficient technological progress is expected to be achieved and therefore BP continues to carry the capitalized costs on its balance sheet.
The judgement disclosed in prior years in relation to expiring leases in the Gulf of Mexico is no longer considered to be significant following recent agreement of lease extensions with the US Bureau of Safety and Environmental Enforcement.
 The carrying amount of capitalized costs is included in Note 8.
Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment owned by the group is stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses. The initial cost of an asset comprises its purchase price or construction cost, any costs directly attributable to bringing the asset into the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management, the initial estimate of any decommissioning obligation, if any, and, for assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use, directly attributable general or specific finance costs. The purchase price or construction cost is the aggregate amount paid and the fair value of any other consideration given to acquire the asset.
Expenditure on major maintenance refits or repairs comprises the cost of replacement assets or parts of assets, inspection costs and overhaul costs. Where an asset or part of an asset that was separately depreciated is replaced and it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the group, the expenditure is capitalized and the carrying amount of the replaced asset is derecognized. Inspection costs associated with major maintenance programmes are capitalized and amortized over the period to the next inspection. Overhaul costs for major maintenance programmes, and all other maintenance costs are expensed as incurred.
Oil and natural gas properties, including certain related pipelines, are depreciated using a unit-of-production method. The cost of producing wells is amortized over proved developed reserves. Licence acquisition, common facilities and future decommissioning costs are amortized over total proved reserves. The unit-of-production rate for the depreciation of common facilities takes into account expenditures incurred to date, together with estimated future capital expenditure expected to be incurred relating to as yet undeveloped reserves expected to be processed through these common facilities. Information on the carrying amounts of the group’s oil and natural gas properties, together with the amounts recognized in the income statement as depreciation, depletion and amortization is contained in Note 12 and Note 5 respectively.
Estimates of oil and natural gas reserves determined by applying US Securities and Exchange Commission regulations including the determination of prices using 12-month historical data are used to calculate depreciation, depletion and amortization charges for the group’s oil and gas properties. Therefore, the charges are not dependent on management forecasts of future oil and gas prices. The impact of changes in estimated proved reserves is dealt with prospectively by amortizing the remaining carrying value of the asset over the expected future production. Management does not believe that a reasonably possible change in the economic environment would result in a material change to the depreciation and amortization charge for other classes of assets.
The estimation of oil and natural gas reserves and BP’s process to manage reserves bookings is described in Supplementary information on oil and natural gas on page 232, which is unaudited. Details on BP’s proved reserves and production compliance and governance processes are provided on page 286. The 2019 movements in proved reserves are reflected in the tables showing movements in oil and natural gas reserves by region in Supplementary information on oil and natural gas (unaudited) on page 232.
Other property, plant and equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over its expected useful life. The typical useful lives of the group’s other property, plant and equipment are as follows:
Land improvements
15 to 25 years
Buildings
20 to 50 years
Refineries
20 to 30 years
Petrochemicals plants
20 to 30 years
Pipelines
10 to 50 years
Service stations
15 years
Office equipment
3 to 7 years
Fixtures and fittings
5 to 15 years
The expected useful lives and depreciation method of property, plant and equipment are reviewed on an annual basis and, if necessary, changes in useful lives or the depreciation method are accounted for prospectively.
An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognized upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the continued use of the asset. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the item) is included in the income statement in the period in which the item is derecognized.


160
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, and goodwill
The group assesses assets or groups of assets, called cash-generating units (CGUs), for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset or CGU may not be recoverable; for example, changes in the group’s business plans, changes in the group’s assumptions about commodity prices, low plant utilization, evidence of physical damage or, for oil and gas assets, significant downward revisions of estimated reserves or increases in estimated future development expenditure or decommissioning costs. If any such indication of impairment exists, the group makes an estimate of the asset’s or CGU’s recoverable amount. Individual assets are grouped into CGUs for impairment assessment purposes at the lowest level at which there are identifiable cash flows that are largely independent of the cash flows of other groups of assets. A CGU’s recoverable amount is the higher of its fair value less costs of disposal and its value in use. If it is probable that the value of the CGU will be primarily recovered through a disposal transaction, the expected disposal proceeds are considered in determining the recoverable amount. Where the carrying amount of a CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, the CGU is considered impaired and is written down to its recoverable amount.
The business segment plans, which are approved on an annual basis by senior management, are the primary source of information for the determination of value in use. They contain forecasts for oil and natural gas production, refinery throughputs, sales volumes for various types of refined products (e.g. gasoline and lubricants), revenues, costs and capital expenditure. As an initial step in the preparation of these plans, various assumptions regarding market conditions, such as oil prices, natural gas prices, refining margins, refined product margins and cost inflation rates are set by senior management. These assumptions take account of existing prices, global supply-demand equilibrium for oil and natural gas, other macroeconomic factors and historical trends and variability. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are adjusted for the risks specific to the asset group that are not reflected in the discount rate and are discounted to their present value typically using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money.
Fair value less costs of disposal is the price that would be received to sell the asset in an orderly transaction between market participants and does not reflect the effects of factors that may be specific to the group and not applicable to entities in general. In limited circumstances where recent market transactions are not available for reference, discounted cash flow techniques are applied. Where discounted cash flow analyses are used to calculate fair value less costs of disposal, estimates are made about the assumptions market participants would use when pricing the asset, CGU or group of CGUs containing goodwill and the test is performed on a post-tax basis.
An assessment is made at each reporting date as to whether there is any indication that previously recognized impairment losses may no longer exist or may have decreased. If such an indication exists, the recoverable amount is estimated. A previously recognized impairment loss is reversed only if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount since the last impairment loss was recognized. If that is the case, the carrying amount of the asset is increased to the lower of its recoverable amount and the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation, had no impairment loss been recognized for the asset in prior years. Impairment reversals are recognized in profit or loss. After a reversal, the depreciation charge is adjusted in future periods to allocate the asset’s revised carrying amount, less any residual value, on a systematic basis over its remaining useful life.
Goodwill is reviewed for impairment annually or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate the recoverable amount of the group of CGUs to which the goodwill relates should be assessed. In assessing whether goodwill has been impaired, the carrying amount of the group of CGUs to which goodwill has been allocated is compared with its recoverable amount. Where the recoverable amount of the group of CGUs is less than the carrying amount (including goodwill), an impairment loss is recognized. An impairment loss recognized for goodwill is not reversed in a subsequent period.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
161


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Significant judgements and estimates: recoverability of asset carrying values
Determination as to whether, and by how much, an asset, CGU, or group of CGUs containing goodwill is impaired involves management estimates on highly uncertain matters such as the effects of inflation and deflation on operating expenses, discount rates, production profiles, reserves and resources, and future commodity prices, including the outlook for global or regional market supply-and-demand conditions for crude oil, natural gas and refined products. Judgement is required when determining the appropriate grouping of assets into a CGU or the appropriate grouping of CGUs for impairment testing purposes. For example, individual oil and gas properties may form separate CGUs whilst certain oil and gas properties with shared infrastructure may be grouped together to form a single CGU. Alternative groupings of assets or CGUs may result in a different outcome from impairment testing. See Note 14 for details on how these groupings have been determined in relation to the impairment testing of goodwill.
As disclosed above, the recoverable amount of an asset is the higher of its value in use and its fair value less costs of disposal. Fair value less costs of disposal may be determined based on expected sales proceeds or similar recent market transaction data.
Details of impairment charges and reversals recognized in the income statement are provided in Note 4 and details on the carrying amounts of assets are shown in Note 12, Note 14 and Note 15.
The estimates for assumptions made in impairment tests in 2019 relating to discount rates and oil and gas properties are discussed below. Changes in the economic environment or other facts and circumstances may necessitate revisions to these assumptions and could result in a material change to the carrying values of the group's assets within the next financial year.
Discount rates
For discounted cash flow calculations, future cash flows are adjusted for risks specific to the CGU. Value-in-use calculations are typically discounted using a pre-tax discount rate based upon the cost of funding the group derived from an established model, adjusted to a pre-tax basis and incorporating a market participant capital structure. Fair value less costs of disposal calculations use the post-tax discount rate.
The discount rates applied in impairment tests are reassessed each year. In 2019 the post-tax discount rate was 6% (2018 6%) and the pre-tax discount rate typically ranged from 7% to 13% (2018 9%) depending on the applicable tax rate in the geographic location of the CGU. Where the CGU is located in a country that is judged to be higher risk an additional premium of 1% to 4% was added to the discount rates (2018 2%). The judgement of classifying a country as higher risk and the applicable premium takes into account various economic and geopolitical factors.
Oil and natural gas properties
For oil and natural gas properties, expected future cash flows are estimated using management’s best estimate of future oil and natural gas prices and production and reserves volumes. The estimated future level of production in all impairment tests is based on assumptions about future commodity prices, production and development costs, field decline rates, current fiscal regimes and other factors.
The recoverable amount of oil and gas properties is primarily sensitive to changes in the oil and gas price assumptions. Further sensitivity analysis may be performed if a specific oil and gas property is identified to have low headroom above its carrying amount. In 2019, the group identified oil and gas properties with carrying amounts totalling $25,092 million (2018 $22,000 million) where the headroom, as at the dates of the last impairment test performed on those assets, was less than or equal to 20% of the carrying value, including $1,256 million (2018 $1,345 million) in relation to equity-accounted entities. A change in the discount rate, reserves, resources or the oil and gas price assumptions in the next financial year may result in the recoverable amount of one or more of these assets falling below the current carrying amount.
The recoverability of intangible exploration and appraisal expenditure is covered under Oil and natural gas exploration, appraisal and development expenditure above.
Oil and natural gas prices
The long-term price assumptions used for investment appraisal are recommended by the group chief economist after considering a range of external price, and supply and demand forecasts under various energy transition scenarios. They are reviewed and approved by management. As a result of the current uncertainty over the pace of transition to lower-carbon supply and demand and the social, political and environmental actions that will be taken to meet the goals of the Paris climate change agreement, the forecasts and scenarios considered include those where those goals are met as well as those where they are not met. The assumptions below represent management’s best estimate of future prices; they do not reflect a specific scenario and sit within the range of the external forecasts considered.
The long-term price assumptions used to determine recoverable amount based on value-in-use impairments tests are derived from the central case investment appraisal assumptions (see page 19) of $70 per barrel for Brent and $4 per mmBtu for Henry Hub gas, both in 2015 prices (2018 $75 per barrel and $4 per mmBtu respectively, in 2015 prices). These long-term prices are applied from 2025 and 2032 respectively (2018 both from 2024) and continue to be inflated for the remaining life of the asset.
The price assumptions used over the periods to 2025 and 2032 have been set such that there is a linear progression from our best estimate of 2020 prices, which were set by reference to 2019 average prices, to the long-term assumptions.
The majority of BP’s reserves and resources that support the carrying value of the group’s oil and gas properties are expected to be produced over the next 10 years. Average prices (in real 2015 terms) used to estimate cash flows over this period are $67 per barrel for Brent and $3.1 per mmBtu for Henry Hub gas.
Oil prices fell 10% in 2019 from 2018 due to trade tensions, a macroeconomic downturn, and a slight slowdown in oil demand. OPEC+ production restraint, unplanned outages, and sanctions on Venezuela and Iran kept prices from falling further. BP's long-term assumption for oil prices is higher than the 2019 price average, based on the judgement that current price levels would not encourage sufficient investment to meet global oil demand sustainably in the longer term, especially given the financial requirements of key low-cost oil producing economies.
US gas prices dropped by around 15% in 2019 compared to 2018. After an initial spike in January, they remained relatively low for much of the year due to a combination of strong associated gas production growth, and storage levels coming back to normal. US gas demand growth was much lower than the exceptional increase in 2018, while LNG exports continued to expand. BP's long-term price assumption for US gas is higher than recent market prices due to forecast rising domestic demand, rapidly increasing pipeline and LNG exports, and lowest cost resources being absorbed leading to production of more expensive gas, as well as requiring increased investment in infrastructure.

162
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Management tested the impact of a reduction in prices of 15% against the best estimate for Brent oil and Henry Hub gas in all future years. These price reductions in isolation could indicatively lead to a reduction in the carrying amount of BP’s oil and gas properties in the range of $2-3 billion, which is approximately 1-2% of the net book value of property, plant and equipment as at 31 December 2019.
Management also tested the impact of a scenario where Brent oil and Henry Hub gas prices start 15% lower than the best estimate and gradually reduce to 25% lower than the best estimate by 2040. Although this is not considered to be a reasonably possible change in the long-term assumptions within the next financial year, it reflects the inherent uncertainty in forecasting long-term prices. These price reductions in isolation could indicatively lead to a reduction in the carrying amount of BP’s oil and gas properties in the range of $4-5 billion which is approximately 3-4% of the net book value of property, plant and equipment as at 31 December 2019. Additionally, such a price reduction does not indicate a reduction in the carrying amount of the Upstream goodwill balance.
These sensitivity analyses do not, however, represent management’s best estimate of any impairments that might be recognized as they do not fully incorporate consequential changes that may arise, such as reductions in costs and changes to business plans, phasing of development, levels of reserves and resources, and production volumes. As the extent of a price reduction increases, the more likely it is that costs would decrease across the industry. The above sensitivity analyses therefore do not reflect a linear relationship between price and value that can be extrapolated. Past experience of performing impairment tests suggests that any impairment arising from such price reductions is likely to be lower once all these factors are taken into consideration. The interdependency of these inputs and risk factors plus the diverse characteristics of our oil and gas properties limits the practicability of estimating the probability or extent to which the overall recoverable amount is impacted by changes to the price assumptions.
The decline in oil and natural gas prices in the first quarter of 2020 is not expected to materially impact the recoverable amount of the group’s oil and natural gas properties.
Oil and natural gas reserves
In addition to oil and natural gas prices, significant technical and commercial assessments are required to determine the group’s estimated oil and natural gas reserves. Reserves estimates are regularly reviewed and updated. Factors such as the availability of geological and engineering data, reservoir performance data, acquisition and divestment activity and drilling of new wells all impact on the determination of the group’s estimates of its oil and natural gas reserves. BP bases its proved reserves estimates on the requirement of reasonable certainty with rigorous technical and commercial assessments based on conventional industry practice and regulatory requirements.
Reserves assumptions for value-in-use tests reflect the reserves and resources that management currently intend to develop. The recoverable amount of oil and gas properties is determined using a combination of inputs including reserves, resources and production volumes. Risk factors may be applied to reserves and resources which do not meet the criteria to be treated as proved. 
Goodwill
Irrespective of whether there is any indication of impairment, BP is required to test annually for impairment of goodwill acquired in business combinations. The group carries goodwill of approximately $11.9 billion on its balance sheet (2018 $12.2 billion), principally relating to the Atlantic Richfield, Burmah Castrol, Devon Energy and Reliance transactions. Sensitivities and additional information relating to impairment testing of goodwill in the Upstream segment are provided in Note 14.
Inventories
Inventories, other than inventories held for short-term trading purposes, are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value. Cost is determined by the first-in first-out method and comprises direct purchase costs, cost of production, transportation and manufacturing expenses. Net realizable value is determined by reference to prices existing at the balance sheet date, adjusted where the sale of inventories after the reporting period gives evidence about their net realizable value at the end of the period.
Inventories held for short-term trading purposes are stated at fair value less costs to sell and any changes in fair value are recognized in the income statement.
Supplies are valued at the lower of cost on a weighted average basis and net realizable value.
Leases
Agreements that convey the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration are accounted for as leases. The right to control is conveyed if BP has both the right to obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from, and the right to direct the use of, the identified asset throughout the period of use. An asset is identified if it is explicitly or implicitly specified by the agreement and any substitution rights held by the lessor over the asset are not considered substantive.
Agreements that convey the right to control the use of an intangible asset including rights to explore for or use hydrocarbons are not accounted for as leases. See significant accounting policy: intangible assets.
A lease liability is recognized on the balance sheet on the lease commencement date at the present value of future lease payments over the lease term. The discount rate applied is the rate implicit in the lease if readily determinable, otherwise an incremental borrowing rate is used. The incremental borrowing rate is determined based on factors such as the group’s cost of borrowing, lessee legal entity credit risk, currency and lease term. The lease term is the non-cancellable period of a lease together with any periods covered by an extension option that BP is reasonably certain to exercise, or periods covered by a termination option that BP is reasonably certain not to exercise. The future lease payments included in the present value calculation are any fixed payments, payments that vary depending on an index or rate, payments due for the reasonably certain exercise of options and expected residual value guarantee payments.
Payments that vary based on factors other than an index or a rate such as usage, sales volumes or revenues are not included in the present value calculation and are recognized in the income statement. The lease liability is recognized on an amortized cost basis with interest expense recognized in the income statement over the lease term, except for where capitalized as exploration, appraisal or development expenditure.
The right-of-use asset is recognized on the balance sheet as property, plant and equipment at a value equivalent to the initial measurement of the lease liability adjusted for lease prepayments, lease incentives, initial direct costs and any restoration obligations. The right-of-use asset is depreciated typically on a straight-line basis over the lease term. The depreciation charge is recognized in the income statement except for where capitalized as exploration, appraisal or development expenditure. Right-of-use assets are assessed for impairment in line with the accounting policy for impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, and goodwill.
Agreements may include both lease and non-lease components. Payments for lease and non-lease components are allocated on a relative stand-alone selling price basis except for leases of retail service stations where the group has elected not to separate non-lease payments from the calculation of the lease liability and right-of-use asset.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
163


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
If the lease term at commencement of the agreement is less than 12 months, a lease liability and right-of-use asset are not recognized, and a lease expense is recognized in the income statement on a straight-line basis.
If a significant event or change in circumstances, within the control of BP, arises that affects the reasonably certain lease term or there are changes to the lease payments, the present value of the lease liability is remeasured using the revised term and payments, with the right-of-use asset adjusted by an equivalent amount.
Modifications to a lease agreement beyond the original terms and conditions are accounted for as a re-measurement of the lease liability with a corresponding adjustment to the right-of-use asset. Any gain or loss on modification is recognized in the income statement. Modifications that increase the scope of the lease at a price commensurate with the stand-alone selling price are accounted for as a separate new lease.
The group recognizes the full lease liability, rather than its working interest share, for leases entered into on behalf of a joint operation if the group has the primary responsibility for making the lease payments. In such cases, BP’s working interest share of the right-of-use asset is recognized if it is jointly controlled by the group and the other joint operators, and a receivable is recognized for the share of the asset transferred to the other joint operators. If BP is a non-operator, a payable to the operator is recognized if they have the primary responsibility for making the lease payments and BP has joint control over the right-of-use asset, otherwise no balances are recognized.
As noted in ‘Impact of new International Financial Reporting Standards - IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, BP elected to apply the ‘modified retrospective’ transition approach on adoption of IFRS 16. Under this approach, comparative periods’ financial information is not restated. The accounting policy applicable for leases in the comparative periods only is disclosed in the following paragraphs.
Agreements under which payments are made to owners in return for the right to use a specific asset are accounted for as leases. Leases that transfer substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are recognized as finance leases. All other leases are accounted for as operating leases.
Finance leases are capitalized at the commencement of the lease term at the fair value of the leased item or, if lower, at the present value of the minimum lease payments. Finance charges are allocated to each period so as to achieve a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability and are charged directly against income. Capitalized leased assets are depreciated over the shorter of the estimated useful life of the asset or the lease term. Operating lease payments are recognized as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term except where capitalized as exploration or appraisal expenditure. See significant accounting policy: Exploration and appraisal expenditure.
Financial assets
Financial assets are recognized initially at fair value, normally being the transaction price. In the case of financial assets not at fair value through profit or loss, directly attributable transaction costs are also included. The subsequent measurement of financial assets depends on their classification, as set out below. The group derecognizes financial assets when the contractual rights to the cash flows expire or the rights to receive cash flows have been transferred to a third party along with either substantially all of the risks and rewards or control of the asset. This includes the derecognition of receivables for which discounting arrangements are entered into.
The group classifies its financial asset debt instruments as measured at amortized cost, fair value through other comprehensive income or fair value through profit or loss. The classification depends on the business model for managing the financial assets and the contractual cash flow characteristics of the financial asset.
Financial assets measured at amortized cost
Financial assets are classified as measured at amortized cost when they are held in a business model the objective of which is to collect contractual cash flows and the contractual cash flows represent solely payments of principal and interest. Such assets are carried at amortized cost using the effective interest method if the time value of money is significant. Gains and losses are recognized in profit or loss when the assets are derecognized or impaired and when interest is recognized using the effective interest method. This category of financial assets includes trade and other receivables.
Financial assets measured at fair value through other comprehensive income
Financial assets are classified as measured at fair value through other comprehensive income when they are held in a business model the objective of which is both to collect contractual cash flows and sell the financial assets, and the contractual cash flows represent solely payments of principal and interest. The group does not have any financial assets classified in this category.
Financial assets measured at fair value through profit or loss
Financial assets are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss when the asset does not meet the criteria to be measured at amortized cost or fair value through other comprehensive income. Such assets are carried on the balance sheet at fair value with gains or losses recognized in the income statement. Derivatives, other than those designated as effective hedging instruments, are included in this category.
Investments in equity instruments
Investments in equity instruments are subsequently measured at fair value through profit or loss unless an election is made on an instrument-by-instrument basis to recognise fair value gains and losses in other comprehensive income. The group does not have any investments for which this election has been made.
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge are carried on the balance sheet at fair value. The treatment of gains and losses arising from revaluation is described below in the accounting policy for derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Cash equivalents
Cash equivalents are short-term highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash, are subject to insignificant risk of changes in value and generally have a maturity of three months or less from the date of acquisition. Cash equivalents are classified as financial assets measured at amortized cost or, in the case of certain money market funds, fair value through profit or loss.

164
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Impairment of financial assets measured at amortized cost
The group assesses on a forward-looking basis the expected credit losses associated with financial assets classified as measured at amortized cost at each balance sheet date. Expected credit losses are measured based on the maximum contractual period over which the group is exposed to credit risk. As lifetime expected credit losses are recognized for trade receivables and the tenor of substantially all of other in-scope financial assets is less than 12 months there is no significant difference between the measurement of 12-month and lifetime expected credit losses for the group. The measurement of expected credit losses is a function of the probability of default, loss given default and exposure at default. The expected credit loss is estimated as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of the future cash flows the group expects to receive discounted at the financial asset’s original effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is adjusted, with the amount of the impairment gain or loss recognized in the income statement.
A financial asset or group of financial assets classified as measured at amortized cost is considered to be credit-impaired if there is reasonable and supportable evidence that one or more events that have a detrimental impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset (or group of financial assets) have occurred. Financial assets are written off where the group has no reasonable expectation of recovering amounts due.
Financial liabilities
The measurement of financial liabilities depends on their classification, as follows:
Financial liabilities measured at fair value through profit or loss
Financial liabilities that meet the definition of held for trading are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss. Such liabilities are carried on the balance sheet at fair value with gains or losses recognized in the income statement. Derivatives, other than those designated as effective hedging instruments, are included in this category.
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge are carried on the balance sheet at fair value. The treatment of gains and losses arising from revaluation is described below in the accounting policy for derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Financial liabilities measured at amortized cost
All other financial liabilities are initially recognized at fair value, net of directly attributable transaction costs. For interest-bearing loans and borrowings this is typically equivalent to the fair value of the proceeds received, net of issue costs associated with the borrowing.
After initial recognition, other financial liabilities are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method. Amortized cost is calculated by taking into account any issue costs and any discount or premium on settlement. Gains and losses arising on the repurchase, settlement or cancellation of liabilities are recognized in interest and other income and finance costs respectively.
This category of financial liabilities includes trade and other payables and finance debt.
The group’s trade payables include some supplier arrangements that utilize letter of credit facilities (see Note 29 - Liquidity risk for further information). The group assesses the payables subject to these arrangements to determine whether they should continue to be classified as trade payables and give rise to operating cash flows or finance debt and financing cash flows. The criteria used in making this assessment include the payment terms for the amount due relative to terms commonly seen in the markets in which BP operates. Liabilities subject to these arrangements with payment terms of up to approximately 60 days are generally considered to be trade payables and give rise to operating cash flows.  
Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities
The group uses derivative financial instruments to manage certain exposures to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates, interest rates and commodity prices, as well as for trading purposes. These derivative financial instruments are recognized initially at fair value on the date on which a derivative contract is entered into and subsequently remeasured at fair value. Derivatives are carried as assets when the fair value is positive and as liabilities when the fair value is negative.
Contracts to buy or sell a non-financial item (for example, oil, oil products, gas or power) that can be settled net in cash, with the exception of contracts that were entered into and continue to be held for the purpose of the receipt or delivery of a non-financial item in accordance with the group’s expected purchase, sale or usage requirements, are accounted for as financial instruments. Gains or losses arising from changes in the fair value of derivatives that are not designated as effective hedging instruments are recognized in the income statement.
If, at inception of a contract, the valuation cannot be supported by observable market data, any gain or loss determined by the valuation methodology is not recognized in the income statement but is deferred on the balance sheet and is commonly known as ‘day-one gain or loss’. This deferred gain or loss is recognized in the income statement over the life of the contract until substantially all the remaining contract term can be valued using observable market data at which point any remaining deferred gain or loss is recognized in the income statement. Changes in valuation subsequent to the initial valuation at inception of a contract are recognized immediately in the income statement.
For the purpose of hedge accounting, hedges are classified as:
Fair value hedges when hedging exposure to changes in the fair value of a recognized asset or liability.
Cash flow hedges when hedging exposure to variability in cash flows that is attributable to either a particular risk associated with a recognized asset or liability or a highly probable forecast transaction.
Hedge relationships are formally designated and documented at inception, together with the risk management objective and strategy for undertaking the hedge. The documentation includes identification of the hedging instrument, the hedged item or transaction, the nature of the risk being hedged, the existence at inception of an economic relationship and subsequent measurement of the hedging instrument's effectiveness in offsetting the exposure to changes in the hedged item’s fair value or cash flows attributable to the hedged risk, the hedge ratio and sources of hedge ineffectiveness. Hedges meeting the criteria for hedge accounting are accounted for as follows:

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
165


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Fair value hedges
The change in fair value of a hedging derivative is recognized in profit or loss. The change in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged is recorded as part of the carrying value of the hedged item and is also recognized in profit or loss, where it offsets. The group applies fair value hedge accounting when hedging interest rate risk and certain currency risks on fixed rate finance debt.
Fair value hedge accounting is discontinued only when the hedging relationship or a part thereof ceases to meet the qualifying criteria. This includes when the risk management objective changes or when the hedging instrument is sold, terminated or exercised. The accumulated adjustment to the carrying amount of a hedged item at such time is then amortized prospectively to profit or loss as finance interest expense over the hedged item's remaining period to maturity.
Cash flow hedges
The effective portion of the gain or loss on a cash flow hedging instrument is reported in other comprehensive income, while the ineffective portion is recognized in profit or loss. Amounts reported in other comprehensive income are reclassified to the income statement when the hedged transaction affects profit or loss.
Where the hedged item is a highly probably forecast transaction that results in the recognition of a non-financial asset or liability, such as a forecast foreign currency transaction for the purchase of property, plant and equipment, the amounts recognized within other comprehensive income are transferred to the initial carrying amount of the non-financial asset or liability. Where the hedged item is an equity investment, the amounts recognized in other comprehensive income remain in the separate component of equity until the hedged cash flows affect profit or loss. Where the hedged item is recognized directly in profit or loss, the amounts recognized in other comprehensive income are reclassified to production and manufacturing expenses or sales and other operating revenues as appropriate.
Cash flow hedge accounting is discontinued only when the hedging relationship or a part thereof ceases to meet the qualifying criteria. This includes when the designated hedged forecast transaction or part thereof is no longer considered to be highly probable to occur, or when the hedging instrument is sold, terminated or exercised without replacement or rollover. When cash flow hedge accounting is discontinued amounts previously recognized within other comprehensive income remain in equity until the forecast transaction occurs and are reclassified to profit or loss or transferred to the initial carrying amount of a non-financial asset or liability as above. If the forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, amounts previously recognized within other comprehensive income will be immediately reclassified to profit or loss.
Costs of hedging
The foreign currency basis spread of cross-currency interest rate swaps are excluded from hedge designations and accounted for as costs of hedging. Changes in fair value of the foreign currency basis spread are recognized in other comprehensive income to the extent that they relate to the hedged item. For time-period related hedged items, the amount recognized in other comprehensive income is amortized to profit or loss on a straight line basis over the term of the hedging relationship.
Fair value measurement
Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. The group categorizes assets and liabilities measured at fair value into one of three levels depending on the ability to observe inputs employed in their measurement. Level 1 inputs are quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 2 inputs are inputs that are observable, either directly or indirectly, other than quoted prices included within level 1 for the asset or liability. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability reflecting significant modifications to observable related market data or BP’s assumptions about pricing by market participants.
Significant estimate and judgement: derivative financial instruments
In some cases the fair values of derivatives are estimated using internal models due to the absence of quoted prices or other observable, market-corroborated data. This primarily applies to the group’s longer-term derivative contracts. The majority of these contracts are valued using models with inputs that include price curves for each of the different products that are built up from available active market pricing data (including volatility and correlation) and modelled using the maximum available external information. Additionally, where limited data exists for certain products, prices are determined using historical and long-term pricing relationships. The use of alternative assumptions or valuation methodologies may result in significantly different values for these derivatives. A reasonably possible change in the price assumptions used in the models relating to index price would not have a material impact on net assets and the Group income statement primarily as a result of offsetting movements between derivative assets and liabilities. For more information, including the carrying amounts of level 3 derivatives, see Note 30.
In some cases, judgement is required to determine whether contracts to buy or sell commodities meet the definition of a derivative. In particular longer -term contracts to buy and sell LNG are not considered to meet the definition as they are not considered capable of being net settled due to a lack of liquidity in the LNG market and so are accounted for on an accruals basis, rather than as a derivative.
Offsetting of financial assets and liabilities
Financial assets and liabilities are presented gross in the balance sheet unless both of the following criteria are met: the group currently has a legally enforceable right to set off the recognized amounts; and the group intends to either settle on a net basis or realize the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. A right of set off is the group’s legal right to settle an amount payable to a creditor by applying against it an amount receivable from the same counterparty. The relevant legal jurisdiction and laws applicable to the relationships between the parties are considered when assessing whether a current legally enforceable right to set off exists.
Provisions and contingencies
Provisions are recognized when the group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. Where appropriate, the future cash flow estimates are adjusted to reflect risks specific to the liability.
If the effect of the time value of money is material, provisions are determined by discounting the expected future cash flows at a pre-tax risk-free rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money. Where discounting is used, the increase in the provision due to the passage of time is recognized within finance costs. Provisions are discounted using a nominal discount rate of 2.5% (2018 3.0%).
Provisions are split between amounts expected to be settled within 12 months of the balance sheet date (current) and amounts expected to be settled later (non-current).

166
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Contingent liabilities are possible obligations whose existence will only be confirmed by future events not wholly within the control of the group, or present obligations where it is not probable that an outflow of resources will be required or the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. Contingent liabilities are not recognized in the consolidated financial statements but are disclosed unless the possibility of an outflow of economic resources is considered remote.
Decommissioning
Liabilities for decommissioning costs are recognized when the group has an obligation to plug and abandon a well, dismantle and remove a facility or an item of plant and to restore the site on which it is located, and when a reliable estimate of that liability can be made. Where an obligation exists for a new facility or item of plant, such as oil and natural gas production or transportation facilities, this liability will be recognized on construction or installation. Similarly, where an obligation exists for a well, this liability is recognized when it is drilled. An obligation for decommissioning may also crystallize during the period of operation of a well, facility or item of plant through a change in legislation or through a decision to terminate operations; an obligation may also arise in cases where an asset has been sold but the subsequent owner is no longer able to fulfil its decommissioning obligations, for example due to bankruptcy. The amount recognized is the present value of the estimated future expenditure determined in accordance with local conditions and requirements. The provision for the costs of decommissioning wells, production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives is estimated using existing technology, at future prices, depending on the expected timing of the activity, and discounted using the nominal discount rate.
An amount equivalent to the decommissioning provision is recognized as part of the corresponding intangible asset (in the case of an exploration or appraisal well) or property, plant and equipment. The decommissioning portion of the property, plant and equipment is subsequently depreciated at the same rate as the rest of the asset. Other than the unwinding of discount on or utilisation of the provision, any change in the present value of the estimated expenditure is reflected as an adjustment to the provision and the corresponding asset where that asset is generating or is expected to generate future economic benefits.
Environmental expenditures and liabilities
Environmental expenditures that are required in order for the group to obtain future economic benefits from its assets are capitalized as part of those assets. Expenditures that relate to an existing condition caused by past operations that do not contribute to future earnings are expensed.
Liabilities for environmental costs are recognized when a clean-up is probable and the associated costs can be reliably estimated. Generally, the timing of recognition of these provisions coincides with the commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites.
The amount recognized is the best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the obligation. Provisions for environmental liabilities have been estimated using existing technology, at future prices and discounted using a nominal discount rate.
Significant judgements and estimates: provisions
The group holds provisions for the future decommissioning of oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives. The largest decommissioning obligations facing BP relate to the plugging and abandonment of wells and the removal and disposal of oil and natural gas platforms and pipelines around the world. Most of these decommissioning events are many years in the future and the precise requirements that will have to be met when the removal event occurs are uncertain. Decommissioning technologies and costs are constantly changing, as are political, environmental, safety and public expectations. The timing and amounts of future cash flows are subject to significant uncertainty and estimation is required in determining the amounts of provisions to be recognized. Any changes in the expected future costs are reflected in both the provision and the asset.
If oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines are sold to third parties, judgement is required to assess whether the new owner will be unable to meet their decommissioning obligations, whether BP would then be responsible for decommissioning, and if so the extent of that responsibility. The group has assessed that no material decommissioning provisions should be recognized as at 31 December 2019 (2018 no material provisions) for assets sold to third parties where the sale transferred the decommissioning obligation to the new owner.
Decommissioning provisions associated with downstream refineries and petrochemicals facilities are generally not recognized, as the potential obligations cannot be measured, given their indeterminate settlement dates. The group performs periodic reviews of its downstream refineries and petrochemicals long-lived assets for any changes in facts and circumstances that might require the recognition of a decommissioning provision.
The provision for environmental liabilities is estimated based on current legal and constructive requirements, technology, price levels and expected plans for remediation. Actual costs and cash outflows can differ from current estimates because of changes in laws and regulations, public expectations, prices, discovery and analysis of site conditions and changes in clean-up technology.
The timing and amount of future expenditures relating to decommissioning and environmental liabilities are reviewed annually, together with the interest rate used in discounting the cash flows. The interest rate used to determine the balance sheet obligations at the end of 2019 was a nominal rate of 2.5% (2018 a nominal rate of 3.0%), which was based on long-dated US government bonds. The weighted average period over which decommissioning and environmental costs are generally expected to be incurred is estimated to be approximately 18 years (2018 18 years) and 6 years (2018 6 years) respectively.
Further information about the group’s provisions is provided in Note 23. Changes in assumptions in relation to the group's provisions could result in a material change in their carrying amounts within the next financial year. A 0.5% change in the nominal discount rate could have an impact of approximately $1.4 billion (2018 $1.3 billion) on the value of the group’s provisions.
A two-year change in the timing of expected future decommissioning expenditures does not have a material impact on the value of the group’s decommissioning provision. Management do not consider a change of greater than two years to be reasonably possible either in the next financial year or as a result of changes in the longer-term economic environment.
As described in Note 33, the group is subject to claims and actions for which no provisions have been recognized. The facts and circumstances relating to particular cases are evaluated regularly in determining whether a provision relating to a specific litigation should be recognized or revised. Accordingly, significant management judgement relating to provisions and contingent liabilities is required, since the outcome of litigation is difficult to predict.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
167


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Employee benefits
Wages, salaries, bonuses, social security contributions, paid annual leave and sick leave are accrued in the period in which the associated services are rendered by employees of the group. Deferred bonus arrangements that have a vesting date more than 12 months after the balance sheet date are valued on an actuarial basis using the projected unit credit method and amortized on a straight-line basis over the service period until the award vests. The accounting policies for share-based payments and for pensions and other post-retirement benefits are described below.
Share-based payments
Equity-settled transactions
The cost of equity-settled transactions with employees is measured by reference to the fair value of the equity instruments on the date on which they are granted and is recognized as an expense over the vesting period, which ends on the date on which the employees become fully entitled to the award. A corresponding credit is recognized within equity. Fair value is determined by using an appropriate, widely used, valuation model. In valuing equity-settled transactions, no account is taken of any vesting conditions, other than conditions linked to the price of the shares of the company (market conditions). Non-vesting conditions, such as the condition that employees contribute to a savings-related plan, are taken into account in the grant-date fair value, and failure to meet a non-vesting condition, where this is within the control of the employee is treated as a cancellation and any remaining unrecognized cost is expensed.
For other equity-settled share-based payment transactions, the goods or services received and the corresponding increase in equity are measured at the fair value of the goods or services received unless their fair value cannot be reliably estimated. If the fair value of the goods and services received cannot be reliably estimated, the transaction is measured by reference to the fair value of the equity instruments granted.
Cash-settled transactions
The cost of cash-settled transactions is recognized as an expense over the vesting period, measured by reference to the fair value of the corresponding liability which is recognized on the balance sheet. The liability is remeasured at fair value at each balance sheet date until settlement, with changes in fair value recognized in the income statement.
Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
The cost of providing benefits under the group’s defined benefit plans is determined separately for each plan using the projected unit credit method, which attributes entitlement to benefits to the current period to determine current service cost and to the current and prior periods to determine the present value of the defined benefit obligation. Past service costs, resulting from either a plan amendment or a curtailment (a reduction in future obligations as a result of a material reduction in the plan membership), are recognized immediately when the company becomes committed to a change.
Net interest expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits, which is recognized in the income statement, represents the net change in present value of plan obligations and the value of plan assets resulting from the passage of time, and is determined by applying the discount rate to the present value of the benefit obligation at the start of the year, and to the fair value of plan assets at the start of the year, taking into account expected changes in the obligation or plan assets during the year.
Remeasurements of the defined benefit liability and asset, comprising actuarial gains and losses, and the return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest described above) are recognized within other comprehensive income in the period in which they occur and are not subsequently reclassified to profit and loss.
The defined benefit pension plan surplus or deficit recognized on the balance sheet for each plan comprises the difference between the present value of the defined benefit obligation (using a discount rate based on high quality corporate bonds) and the fair value of plan assets out of which the obligations are to be settled directly. Fair value is based on market price information and, in the case of quoted securities, is the published bid price. Defined benefit pension plan surpluses are only recognized to the extent they are recoverable, either by way of a refund from the plan or reductions in future contributions to the plan.
Contributions to defined contribution plans are recognized in the income statement in the period in which they become payable.
Significant estimate: pensions and other post-retirement benefits
Accounting for defined benefit pensions and other post-retirement benefits involves making significant estimates when measuring the group's pension plan surpluses and deficits. These estimates require assumptions to be made about many uncertainties.
Pensions and other post-retirement benefit assumptions are reviewed by management at the end of each year. These assumptions are used to determine the projected benefit obligation at the year end and hence the surpluses and deficits recorded on the group's balance sheet, and pension and other post-retirement benefit expense for the following year.
The assumptions that are the most significant to the amounts reported are the discount rate, inflation rate, salary growth and mortality levels. Assumptions about these variables are based on the environment in each country. The assumptions used vary from year to year, with resultant effects on future net income and net assets. Changes to some of these assumptions, in particular the discount rate and inflation rate, could result in material changes to the carrying amounts of the group's pension and other post-retirement benefit obligations within the next financial year, in particular for the UK, US and Eurozone plans. Any differences between these assumptions and the actual outcome will also affect future net income and net assets.
The values ascribed to these assumptions and a sensitivity analysis of the impact of changes in the assumptions on the benefit expense and obligation used are provided in Note 24.
Income taxes
Income tax expense represents the sum of current tax and deferred tax.
Income tax is recognized in the income statement, except to the extent that it relates to items recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, in which case the related tax is recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity.
Current tax is based on the taxable profit for the period. Taxable profit differs from net profit as reported in the income statement because it is determined in accordance with the rules established by the applicable taxation authorities. It therefore excludes items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other periods as well as items that are never taxable or deductible. The group’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates and laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date.

168
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Deferred tax is provided, using the liability method, on temporary differences at the balance sheet date between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts for financial reporting purposes. Deferred tax liabilities are recognized for all taxable temporary differences except:
Where the deferred tax liability arises on the initial recognition of goodwill.
Where the deferred tax liability arises on the initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction that is not a business combination and, at the time of the transaction, affects neither accounting profit nor taxable profit or loss.
In respect of taxable temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries and associates and interests in joint arrangements, where the group is able to control the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences, carry-forward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses, to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences and the carry-forward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses can be utilized, except where the deferred tax asset relating to the deductible temporary difference arises from the initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction that is not a business combination and, at the time of the transaction, affects neither accounting profit nor taxable profit or loss. In respect of deductible temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries and associates and interests in joint arrangements, deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that the temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future and taxable profit will be available against which the temporary differences can be utilized.
The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable or increased to the extent that it is probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to allow all or part of the deferred tax asset to be utilized.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the asset is realized or the liability is settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are not discounted.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset only when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when the deferred tax assets and liabilities relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority on either the same taxable entity or different taxable entities where there is an intention to settle the current tax assets and liabilities on a net basis or to realize the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously.
Where tax treatments are uncertain, if it is considered probable that a taxation authority will accept the group's proposed tax treatment, income taxes are recognized consistent with the group's income tax filings. If it is not considered probable, the uncertainty is reflected within the carrying amount of the applicable tax asset or liability using either the most likely amount or an expected value, depending on which method better predicts the resolution of the uncertainty.
The computation of the group’s income tax expense and liability involves the interpretation of applicable tax laws and regulations in many jurisdictions throughout the world. The resolution of tax positions taken by the group, through negotiations with relevant tax authorities or through litigation, can take several years to complete and in some cases it is difficult to predict the ultimate outcome. Therefore, judgement is required to determine whether provisions for income taxes are required and, if so, estimation is required of the amounts that could be payable.
In addition, the group has carry-forward tax losses and tax credits in certain taxing jurisdictions that are available to offset against future taxable profit. However, deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses or tax credits can be utilized. Management judgement is exercised in assessing whether this is the case and estimates are required to be made of the amount of future taxable profits that will be available.
Management do not assess there to be a significant risk of a material change to the group’s tax provisioning or recognition of deferred tax assets within the next financial year, however the tax position remains inherently uncertain and therefore subject to change. To the extent that actual outcomes differ from management’s estimates, income tax charges or credits, and changes in current and deferred tax assets or liabilities, may arise in future periods. For more information see Note 9 and Note 33.
Judgement is also required when determining whether a particular tax is an income tax or another type of tax (for example a production tax). Accounting for deferred tax is applied to income taxes as described above, but is not applied to other types of taxes; rather such taxes are recognized in the income statement in accordance with the applicable accounting policy such as Provisions and contingencies. No new significant judgements were made in 2019 in this regard.
Customs duties and sales taxes
Customs duties and sales taxes that are passed on or charged to customers are excluded from revenues and expenses. Assets and liabilities are recognized net of the amount of customs duties or sales tax except:
Customs duties or sales taxes incurred on the purchase of goods and services which are not recoverable from the taxation authority are recognized as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset.
Receivables and payables are stated with the amount of customs duty or sales tax included.
The net amount of sales tax recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority is included within receivables or payables in the balance sheet.
Own equity instruments – treasury shares
The group’s holdings in its own equity instruments are shown as deductions from shareholders’ equity. Treasury shares represent BP shares repurchased and available for specific and limited purposes. For accounting purposes, shares held in Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) to meet the future requirements of the employee share-based payment plans are treated in the same manner as treasury shares and are, therefore, included in the consolidated financial statements as treasury shares. The cost of treasury shares subsequently sold or reissued is calculated on a weighted-average basis. Consideration, if any, received for the sale of such shares is also recognized in equity. No gain or loss is recognized in the income statement on the purchase, sale, issue or cancellation of equity shares. Shares repurchased under the share buy-back programme which are immediately cancelled are not shown as treasury shares, but are shown as a deduction from the profit and loss account reserve in the group statement of changes in equity.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
169


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Revenue and other income
Revenue from contracts with customers is recognized when or as the group satisfies a performance obligation by transferring control of a promised good or service to a customer. The transfer of control of oil, natural gas, natural gas liquids, LNG, petroleum and chemical products, and other items usually coincides with title passing to the customer and the customer taking physical possession. The group principally satisfies its performance obligations at a point in time; the amounts of revenue recognized relating to performance obligations satisfied over time are not significant.
When, or as, a performance obligation is satisfied, the group recognizes as revenue the amount of the transaction price that is allocated to that performance obligation. The transaction price is the amount of consideration to which the group expects to be entitled. The transaction price is allocated to the performance obligations in the contract based on standalone selling prices of the goods or services promised.
Contracts for the sale of commodities are typically priced by reference to quoted prices. Revenue from term commodity contracts is recognized based on the contractual pricing provisions for each delivery. Certain of these contracts have pricing terms based on prices at a point in time after delivery has been made. Revenue from such contracts is initially recognized based on relevant prices at the time of delivery and subsequently adjusted as appropriate. All revenue from these contracts, both that recognized at the time of delivery and that from post-delivery price adjustments, is disclosed as revenue from contracts with customers.
Certain contracts entered into by the group that result in physical delivery of products such as crude oil, natural gas and refined products are required by IFRS 9 to be accounted for as derivative financial instruments. The group's counterparties in these transactions may, however, meet the IFRS 15 definition of a customer. Revenue recognized relating to such contracts when physical delivery occurs is, therefore, measured at the contractual transaction price and presented together with revenue from contracts with customers. Changes in the fair value of derivative assets and liabilities prior to physical delivery are excluded from revenue from contracts with customers and are classified as other operating revenues. See also Impact of new International Financial Reporting Standards - Not yet adopted - IFRIC agenda decision on IFRS 9 'Financial instruments' below.
Where forward sale and purchase contracts for oil, natural gas or power have been determined to be for short-term trading purposes, the associated sales and purchases are reported net within sales and other operating revenues whether or not physical delivery has occurred.
Physical exchanges with counterparties in the same line of business in order to facilitate sales to customers are reported net, as are sales and purchases made with a common counterparty, as part of an arrangement similar to a physical exchange.
Where the group acts as agent on behalf of a third party to procure or market energy commodities, any associated fee income is recognized but no purchase or sale is recorded.
Interest income is recognized as the interest accrues (using the effective interest rate, that is, the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash receipts through the expected life of the financial instrument to the net carrying amount of the financial asset).
Dividend income from investments is recognized when the shareholders’ right to receive the payment is established.
Contract asset and contract liability balances are included within amounts presented for trade receivables and other payables respectively.
Finance costs
Finance costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of qualifying assets, which are assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use, are added to the cost of those assets until such time as the assets are substantially ready for their intended use. All other finance costs are recognized in the income statement in the period in which they are incurred.
Impact of new International Financial Reporting Standards
BP adopted IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, which replaced IAS 17 ‘Leases’ and IFRIC 4 ‘Determining whether an arrangement contains a lease’, with effect from 1 January 2019. There are no other new or amended standards or interpretations adopted during the year that have a significant impact on the consolidated financial statements.
IFRS 16 ‘Leases’
IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ provides a new model for lessee accounting in which the majority of leases will be accounted for by the recognition on the balance sheet of a right-of-use asset and a lease liability. The subsequent amortization of the right-of-use asset and the interest expense related to the lease liability is recognized in profit or loss over the lease term.
BP elected to apply the modified retrospective transition approach in which the cumulative effect of initial application is recognized in opening retained earnings at the date of initial application with no restatement of comparative periods’ financial information. Comparative information in the group balance sheet and group cash flow statement has, however, been re-presented to align with current year presentation, showing lease liabilities and lease liability payments as separate line items. These were previously included within finance debt and repayments of long-term financing line items respectively. Amounts presented in these line items for the comparative periods relate to leases accounted for as finance leases under IAS 17. We do not consider any of the judgements or estimates made on transition to IFRS 16 to be significant.
IFRS 16 introduces a revised definition of a lease. As permitted by the standard, BP elected not to reassess the existing population of leases under the new definition and only applies the new definition for the assessment of contracts entered into after the transition date. On transition the standard permitted, on a lease-by-lease basis, the right-of-use asset to be measured either at an amount equal to the lease liability (as adjusted for prepaid or accrued lease payments), or on a historical basis as if the standard had always applied. BP elected to use the historical asset measurement for its more material leases and used the asset equals liability approach for the remainder of the population. In measuring the right-of-use asset BP applied the transition practical expedient to exclude initial direct costs. BP also elected to adjust the carrying amounts of the right-of-use assets as at 1 January 2019 for onerous lease provisions that had been recognized on the group balance sheet as at 31 December 2018, rather than performing impairment tests on transition.
The effect on the group’s balance sheet is set out further below. The presentation and timing of recognition of charges in the income statement has changed following the adoption of IFRS 16. The operating lease expense previously reported under IAS 17, typically on a straight-line basis, has been replaced by depreciation of the right-of-use asset and interest on the lease liability. In the cash flow statement payments are now presented as financing cash flows, representing repayments of principal, and as operating cash flows, representing payments of interest. Variable lease payments that do not depend on an index or rate are not included in the lease liability and will continue to be presented as operating cash flows. In prior years, operating lease payments were principally presented within cash flows from operating activities.

170
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
The following table provides a reconciliation of the operating lease commitments as at 31 December 2018 to the total lease liability recognized on the group balance sheet in accordance with IFRS 16 as at 1 January 2019, with explanations below.
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Operating lease commitments at 31 December 2018
 
11,979

 
 
 
Leases not yet commenced
 
(1,372
)
Leases below materiality threshold
 
(86
)
Short-term leases
 
(91
)
Effect of discounting
 
(1,512
)
Impact on leases in joint operations
 
836

Variable lease payments
 
(58
)
Redetermination of lease term
 
(252
)
Other
 
(22
)
Total additional lease liabilities recognized on adoption of IFRS 16
 
9,422

Finance lease obligations at 31 December 2018
 
667

Adjustment for finance leases in joint operations
 
(189
)
Total lease liabilities at 1 January 2019
 
9,900

Leases not yet commenced: The operating lease commitments disclosed as at 31 December 2018 include amounts relating to leases entered into by the group that had not yet commenced as at 31 December 2018. In accordance with IFRS 16 assets and liabilities will not be recognized on the group balance sheet in relation to these leases until the dates of commencement of the leases. Commitments for leases not yet commenced as at 31 December 2019 are disclosed in note 28.
Short-term leases and leases below materiality threshold: As part of the transition to IFRS 16, BP elected not to recognize assets and liabilities relating to short-term leases i.e. leases with a term of less than 12 months and also applied a materiality threshold for the recognition of assets and liabilities related to leases. The disclosed operating lease commitments as at 31 December 2018 include amounts related to such leases.
Effect of discounting: The amount of the lease liability recognized in accordance with IFRS 16 is on a discounted basis whereas the operating lease commitments information as at 31 December 2018 is presented on an undiscounted basis. The discount rates used on transition were incremental borrowing rates as appropriate for each lease based on factors such as the lessee legal entity, lease term and currency. The weighted average discount rate used on transition was around 3.5%, with a weighted average remaining lease term of around nine years. For new leases commencing after 1 January 2019 the discount rate used will be the interest rate implicit in the lease, if this is readily determinable, or the incremental borrowing rate if the implicit rate cannot be readily determined.
Impact on leases in joint operations: The operating lease commitments for leases within joint operations as at 31 December 2018 were included on the basis of BP’s net working interest, irrespective of whether BP is the operator and whether the lease has been co-signed by the joint operators or not. However, for transition to IFRS 16, the facts and circumstances of each lease in a joint operation were assessed to determine the group’s rights and obligations and to recognize assets and liabilities on the group balance sheet accordingly. This relates mainly to leases of drilling rigs within joint operations in the Upstream segment. Where all parties to a joint operation jointly have the right to control the use of the identified asset and all parties have a legal obligation to make lease payments to the lessor, the group’s share of the right-of-use asset and its share of the lease liability will be recognized on the group balance sheet. This may arise in cases where the lease is signed by all parties to the joint operation. However, in cases where BP is the only party with the legal obligation to make lease payments to the lessor, the full lease liability will be recognized on the group balance sheet. This may be the case if for example BP, as operator of the joint operation, is the sole signatory to the lease. If, however, the underlying asset is jointly controlled by all parties to the joint operation BP will recognize its net share of the right-of-use asset on the group balance sheet along with a receivable representing the amounts to be recovered from the other parties. If BP is not legally obliged to make lease payments to the lessor but jointly controls the asset, the net share of the right-of-use asset will be recognized on the group balance sheet along with a payable representing amounts to be paid to the other parties.
Variable lease payments: Where there are lease payments that vary depending on an index or rate, the measurement of the operating lease commitments as at 31 December 2018 was based on the variable factor as at inception of the lease and was not updated to reflect subsequent changes in the variable factor. Such subsequent changes in the lease payments were treated as contingent rentals and charged to profit or loss as and when paid. Under IFRS 16 the lease liability is adjusted whenever the lease payments are changed in response to changes in the variable factor, and for transition the liability was measured on the basis of the prevailing variable factor on 1 January 2019.
Redetermination of lease term: Under the transition provisions of IFRS 16, the remaining terms of certain leases were redetermined with the benefit of hindsight, on the basis that BP was reasonably certain to exercise its option to terminate those leases before the full term.
Under IAS 17 finance leases were recognized on the group balance sheet and continue to be recognized in accordance with IFRS 16. The amounts recognized on the group balance sheet as at 1 January 2019 in relation to the right-of-use assets and liabilities for previous finance leases within joint operations are on a net or gross basis as appropriate as described above.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
171


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
In addition to the lease liability, other line items on the group balance sheet adjusted on transition to IFRS 16 include property, plant and equipment for the right-of-use assets, lease related prepayments, receivables from joint operation partners, accruals, payables to operators of joint operations, onerous lease provisions and deferred tax balances, as set out below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
31 December 2018

1 January 2019

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 16

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
135,261

143,950

8,689

Trade and other receivables
 
1,834

2,159

325

Prepayments
 
1,179

849

(330
)
Deferred tax assets
 
3,706

3,736

30

Current assets
 
 
 
 
Trade and other receivables
 
24,478

24,673

195

Prepayments
 
963

872

(91
)
Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
46,265

46,209

(56
)
Accruals
 
4,626

4,578

(48
)
Lease liabilities
 
44

2,196

2,152

Finance debt
 
9,329

9,329


Provisions
 
2,564

2,547

(17
)
Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 
13,830

14,013

183

Accruals
 
575

548

(27
)
Lease liabilities
 
623

7,704

7,081

Finance debt
 
55,803

55,803


Deferred tax liabilities
 
9,812

9,767

(45
)
Provisions
 
17,732

17,657

(75
)
 
 
 
 
 
Net assetsa
 
101,548

101,218

(330
)
 
 
 
 
 
Equity
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders' equity
 
99,444

99,115

(329
)
Non-controlling interests
 
2,104

2,103

(1
)
 
 
101,548

101,218

(330
)
a Net assets also includes the line items not affected by the transition to IFRS 16 that are not presented separately in the table

The total adjustments to the group's lease liabilities at 1 January 2019 are reconciled as follows:
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Total additional lease liabilities recognized on adoption of IFRS 16
 
9,422

Less: adjustment for finance leases in joint operations
 
(189
)
Total adjustment to lease liabilities
 
9,233

Of which – current
 
2,152

– non-current
 
7,081

Not yet adopted
The following pronouncements from the IASB have not been adopted by the group in these financial statements as they will only become effective for future financial reporting periods. In addition, the group is voluntarily changing certain accounting policies from 1 January 2020 following an IFRIC agenda decision on IFRS 9 'Financial instruments'. There are no other standards, amendments or interpretations in issue but not yet adopted that the directors anticipate will have a material effect on the reported income or net assets of the group.
IFRS 17 ' Insurance Contracts'
IFRS 17 'Insurance Contracts' provides a new general model for accounting for contracts where the issuer accepts significant insurance risk from another party and agrees to compensate that party if a future uncertain event adversely affects them. IFRS 17 replaces IFRS 4 'Insurance Contracts' and will be effective for BP for the financial reporting period commencing 1 January 2022 subject to endorsement by the UK and the EU. BP has commenced an assessment of the impact of IFRS 17 but it is not expected to have a significant effect on future financial reporting.
Interest Rate Benchmark Reform: Amendments to IFRS 9 'Financial instruments'
Amendments to IFRS 9 were issued in September 2019 to provide temporary relief from applying specific hedge accounting requirements to hedging relationships directly affected by interest rate benchmark reforms. The reliefs have the effect that the uncertainty over the interest rate benchmark reforms should not generally result in discontinuation of hedge accounting. The amendments have been endorsed by the EU. BP will adopt the IFRS 9 amendments in the financial reporting period commencing 1 January 2020.
The reliefs provided by the amendments would allow BP to assume that:
the interest rate benchmark component at initial designation of fair value hedges is separately identifiable; and
the interest rate benchmark is not altered for the purposes of assessing the economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument for fair value hedges.
The amendments are applicable to all of the group's fair value hedges disclosed in note 30.

172
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
IFRIC agenda decision on IFRS 9
In March 2019, the IFRIC issued an agenda decision on the application of IFRS 9 to the physical settlement of contracts to buy or sell a non-financial item such as commodities that are not accounted for as 'own-use' contracts. The IFRIC concluded that such contracts are settled by the delivery or receipt of a non-financial item in exchange for both cash and the settlement of the derivative asset or liability. BP regularly enters into forward sale and purchase contracts. As described in the group's accounting policy for revenue, revenue recognized at the time such contracts are physically settled is measured at the contractual transaction price and is presented together with revenue from contracts with customers in these financial statements. From 1 January 2020, however, the group has changed its accounting policy for these contracts in accordance with the conclusions included in the agenda decision. Purchases and revenues from such contracts will be measured at the contractual transaction price plus the carrying amount of the related derivative at the date of settlement. Furthermore, revenues on such sales contracts will no longer be presented together with the group's revenue from contracts with customers but will be included in other revenues. This change will have a significant effect on the group's disclosures in relation to revenue from contracts with customers. For 2019, it is currently estimated that the amount of revenue measured at the contractual transaction price presented together with revenue from contracts with customers in these financial statements that would be presented as other revenues following application of this change in accounting policy is approximately $130 billion. Comparative information for revenue from contracts with customers (see Note 6) will be restated in BP's 2020 financial statements.
Gains and losses on these realized physically settled derivative contracts will also be included in other revenues. The group expects there to be no material effect on reported profit as presented in the group income statement or on net assets as a result of these changes.

2. Non-current assets held for sale
The carrying amount of assets classified as held for sale at 31 December 2019 is $7,465 million, with associated liabilities of $1,393 million. These principally relate to two material disposal transactions which have been classified as held for sale in the group balance sheet.
On 27 August 2019, BP announced that it had agreed to sell all its Alaska operations and interests to Hilcorp Energy for up to $5.6 billion, subject to customary closing adjustments, of which $1.6 billion is contingent on future cash flows. The sale will include BP’s entire upstream and midstream business in the state, including BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc., which owns all of BP’s upstream oil and gas interests in Alaska, and BP Pipelines (Alaska) Inc.’s 49% interest in the Trans Alaska Pipeline System (TAPS). BP will retain decommissioning liability relating to TAPS, which will be partially offset by a 30% cost reimbursement from Hilcorp. The deal, which is subject to governmental authorizations, is expected to complete during 2020. Assets of $6,518 million and associated liabilities of $969 million relating to this transaction are classified as held for sale at 31 December 2019.
In November 2019, BP agreed to sell its interests in the San Juan basin in Colorado and New Mexico to IKAV. The deal is expected to complete during the first half of 2020. Assets and associated liabilities relating to this transaction are classified as held for sale at 31 December 2019.
The total assets and liabilities held for sale, which are all in the Upstream segment, are set out in the table below.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

Property, plant and equipment
 
6,359

Intangible assets
 
610

Investments in associates
 
43

Inventories
 
318

Trade and other receivables
 
135

Assets classified as held for sale
 
7,465

Trade and other payables
 
(33
)
Lease liabilities
 
(280
)
Provisions
 
(1,012
)
Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 
(68
)
Liabilities directly associated with assets classified as held for sale
 
(1,393
)


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
173


3. Business combinations and other significant transactions
Business combinations
As agreed as part of the original transaction, $3,480 million was paid in 2019 in respect of the 2018 acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation from BHP Billiton that is described below. Payments on this transaction are now complete. A number of other individually insignificant business combinations were also undertaken by BP in 2019.
BP undertook a number of business combinations in 2018. For the full year, total consideration paid in cash amounted to $7,100 million, offset by cash acquired of $114 million.
On 31 October 2018, BP acquired from BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc. 100% of the issued share capital of Petrohawk Energy Corporation, a wholly-owned subsidiary of BHP that holds a portfolio of unconventional onshore US oil and gas assets.
The acquisition brings BP extensive oil and gas production and resources in the liquids-rich regions of the Permian and Eagle Ford basins in Texas and in the Haynesville gas basin in Texas and Louisiana.
The total consideration for the transaction, after customary closing adjustments and the effect of discounting deferred payments, was $10,302 million, which was all paid in cash.
The transaction was accounted for as a business combination using the acquisition method. The fair values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired, as at the date of acquisition, are shown in the table below. No goodwill was recognized on the acquisition and no significant adjustments were made to the provisional fair values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired when those values were finalized.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

Assets
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
10,845

Intangible assets
 
21

Inventories
 
27

Trade and other receivables
 
493

Cash
 
104

Liabilities
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
(659
)
Provisions
 
(323
)
Non-controlling interest
 
(206
)
Total consideration
 
10,302

An analysis of the cash flows relating to the acquisition included within the cash flow statement for 2018 is provided below.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

Transaction costs of the acquisition (included in cash flows from operating activities)
 
62

Interest on deferred payments (included in cash flows from operating activities)
 
21

Cash consideration paid, net of cash acquired (included in cash flows from investing activities)
 
6,684

Total net cash outflow for the acquisition
 
6,767

From the date of acquisition to 31 December 2018, the acquired activities generated revenues of $472 million and profit before tax of $49 million. If the business combination had taken place on 1 January 2018, it is estimated that the acquired activities would have generated revenues of $2,798 million and profit before tax of $431 million.
In addition to the BHP transaction described above, BP undertook a number of other individually insignificant business combinations in 2018.
Other significant transactions
On 18 December 2018, BP purchased an additional 16.5% interest in the Clair field in the North Sea, as part of the agreements with ConocoPhillips in which ConocoPhillips simultaneously purchased BP's entire 39.2% interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area on the North Slope of Alaska. The purchase gives BP a 45.1% interest in Clair in total. Gross payments made and received of $1,739 million and $1,490 million are included in Capital expenditure and Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash acquired, respectively, in the group cash flow statement for 2018. Goodwill of $804 million, resulting from the recognition of a deferred tax liability as part of the transaction accounting, was recognized on the purchase of the interest in the Clair field.


174
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


4. Disposals and impairment
The following amounts were recognized in the income statement in respect of disposals and impairments.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
143

437

526

Downstream
 
50

15

674

Other businesses and corporate
 

4

10

 
 
193

456

1,210

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
415

707

127

Downstream
 
57

59

88

Other businesses and corporate
 
887

11


 
 
1,359

777

215

Impairment losses
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
6,752

400

1,138

Downstream
 
65

12

69

Other businesses and corporate
 
30

254

32

 
 
6,847

666

1,239

Impairment reversals
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
(131
)
(580
)
(176
)
Downstream
 

(2
)
(62
)
Other businesses and corporate
 

(1
)

 
 
(131
)
(583
)
(238
)
Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
8,075

860

1,216

Disposals
Disposal proceeds and principal gains and losses on disposals by segment are described below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
500

940

2,936

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 
1,701

1,911

478

 
 
2,201

2,851

3,414

By business
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
2,048

2,145

1,183

Downstream
 
152

120

2,078

Other businesses and corporate
 
1

586

153

 
 
2,201

2,851

3,414

At 31 December 2019, deferred consideration relating to disposals amounted to $159 million receivable within one year (2018 $35 million and 2017 $259 million) and $125 million receivable after one year (2018 $304 million and 2017 $268 million). In addition, contingent consideration receivable relating to disposals amounted to $598 million at 31 December 2019 (2018 $893 million and 2017 $237 million). These amounts of contingent consideration are reported within Other investments on the group balance sheet - see Note 18 for further information.
Upstream
In 2019, losses included $191 million fair value movements in relation to contingent consideration arising from the prior period disposal of the Bruce, Keith and Devenick assets and $171 million in relation to severance costs associated with the divestment of our Alaskan business.
In 2018, gains principally resulted from the disposal of interests in the Bruce, Keith and Rhum fields in the UK North Sea, from the disposal of certain properties in the US, and from adjustments to disposals in prior periods. Losses included $335 million resulting from the disposal of our interest in the Magnus field and associated assets in the UK North Sea, $221 million from the disposal of our interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area in the US (see Note 3 for further information), and adjustments to disposals in prior periods.
In 2017, gains principally resulted from the disposal of a portion of our interest in the Perdido offshore hub in the US, and further gains associated with disposals in the UK.
Downstream
In 2017, gains principally resulted from the disposal of our interest in the SECCO joint venture and the disposal of certain midstream assets in Europe.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
175


4. Disposals and impairment – continued
Other businesses and corporate
In 2019 losses on disposal of businesses and fixed assets were principally in respect of the reclassification of accumulated foreign exchange losses from reserves to the income statement upon the contribution of our Brazilian biofuels business to a new 50:50 joint venture BP Bunge Bioenergia.
In 2018 proceeds from disposals were principally in respect of life insurance policies in the US and wind farms within our US wind business.
Summarized financial information relating to the sale of businesses is shown in the table below.
The principal transaction categorized as a business disposal in 2019 was the sale of our interests in the Gulf of Suez oil concessions in Egypt.
The principal transaction categorized as a business disposal in 2018 was the disposal of our interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area in the US - see Note 3 for further information.
The principal transaction categorized as a business disposal in 2017 was the disposal of our interest in the Forties Pipeline System in the North Sea.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Non-current assets
 
1,653

3,274

735

Current assets
 
507

173

57

Non-current liabilities
 
(257
)
(250
)
(173
)
Current liabilities
 
(108
)
(97
)
(86
)
Total carrying amount of net assets disposed
 
1,795

3,100

533

Recycling of foreign exchange on disposal
 
880



Costs on disposal
 
190

3

3

 
 
2,865

3,103

536

Gains (losses) on sale of businesses
 
(1,190
)
(221
)
44

Total consideration
 
1,675

2,882

580

Non-cash consideration
 
(938
)
(282
)
(216
)
Consideration received (receivable)a
 
964

(689
)
114

Proceeds from the sale of businesses, net of cash disposedb
 
1,701

1,911

478

a $633 million relates to deposits received in advance of the disposal of our Alaska business and certain assets in our BPX business
b Proceeds are stated net of cash and cash equivalents disposed of $30 million (2018 $15 million and 2017 $25 million).
Impairments
Impairment losses and impairment reversals in each segment are described below. For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to impairments see Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangibles and goodwill within Note 1. See also Note 12, and Note 15 for further information on impairments by asset category.
Upstream
Impairment losses and reversals in all years relate primarily to producing and midstream assets.
The 2019 impairment losses of $6,752 million related to various assets, with the most significant charges arising in the US. Impairment losses arose primarily as a result of the decision to dispose of certain assets, including $4,703 million in relation to completed and expected disposals in BPX Energy and $1,264 million relating to the expected disposal of our Alaskan business; of these amounts $355 million primarily relates to impairment of associated goodwill.
The 2018 impairment losses of $400 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant charges arising in Australia and the US. Impairment losses arose primarily as a result of changes to project activity, asset obsolescence and the decision to dispose of certain assets. The 2018 impairment reversals of $580 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant reversals arising in the North Sea and Angola following a change to decommissioning cost estimates.
The 2017 impairment losses of $1,138 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant charges arising in BPX Energy (previously known as the US Lower 48 business) and the North Sea. Impairment losses within Upstream arose primarily as a result of changes in reserves estimates and the decision to dispose of certain assets, including the Forties Pipeline System business.
The 2017 impairment reversals of $176 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant reversals arising in the North Sea.
Downstream
Impairment losses totalling $65 million, $12 million, and $69 million were recognized in 2019, 2018 and 2017 respectively.
Other businesses and corporate
Impairment losses totalling $30 million, $254 million, and $32 million were recognized in 2019, 2018 and 2017 respectively. The amount for 2018 is in respect of assets within our US wind business in advance of their disposal in December 2018.


176
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


5. Segmental analysis
The group’s organizational structure reflects the various activities in which BP is engaged. At 31 December 2019, BP had three reportable segments: Upstream, Downstream and Rosneft.
Upstream’s activities include oil and natural gas exploration, field development and production; midstream transportation, storage and processing; and the marketing and trading of natural gas, including liquefied natural gas (LNG), together with power and natural gas liquids (NGLs).
Downstream’s activities include the refining, manufacturing, marketing, transportation, and supply and trading of crude oil, petroleum, petrochemicals products and related services to wholesale and retail customers.
BP’s interest in Rosneft is accounted for using the equity method and is reported as a separate operating segment, reflecting the way in which the investment is managed.
Other businesses and corporate comprises the biofuels and wind businesses, the group’s shipping and treasury functions, and corporate activities worldwide.
The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as the group’s accounting policies described in Note 1. However, IFRS requires that the measure of profit or loss disclosed for each operating segment is the measure that is provided regularly to the chief operating decision maker for the purposes of performance assessment and resource allocation. For BP, this measure of profit or loss is replacement cost profit or loss before interest and tax which reflects the replacement cost of supplies by excluding from profit or loss inventory holding gains and lossesa. Replacement cost profit or loss for the group is not a recognized measure under IFRS.
Sales between segments are made at prices that approximate market prices, taking into account the volumes involved. Segment revenues and segment results include transactions between business segments. These transactions and any unrealized profits and losses are eliminated on consolidation, unless unrealized losses provide evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Sales to external customers by region are based on the location of the group subsidiary which made the sale. The UK region includes the UK-based international activities of Downstream.
All surpluses and deficits recognized on the group balance sheet in respect of pension and other post-retirement benefit plans are allocated to Other businesses and corporate. However, the periodic expense relating to these plans is allocated to the operating segments based upon the business in which the employees work.
Certain financial information is provided separately for the US as this is an individually material country for BP, and for the UK as this is BP’s country of domicile.
In February 2020, BP announced plans for a future reorganization of the group’s operating segments.  The group’s current segmental reporting structure is expected to remain in place throughout 2020 with any changes coming into effect from 1 January 2021.


 

































a 
Inventory holding gains and losses represent the difference between the cost of sales calculated using the replacement cost of inventory and the cost of sales calculated on the first-in first-out (FIFO) method after adjusting for any changes in provisions where the net realizable value of the inventory is lower than its cost. Under the FIFO method, which we use for IFRS reporting, the cost of inventory charged to the income statement is based on its historical cost of purchase or manufacture, rather than its replacement cost. In volatile energy markets, this can have a significant distorting effect on reported income. The amounts disclosed represent the difference between the charge to the income statement for inventory on a FIFO basis (after adjusting for any related movements in net realizable value provisions) and the charge that would have arisen based on the replacement cost of inventory. For this purpose, the replacement cost of inventory is calculated using data from each operation’s production and manufacturing system, either on a monthly basis, or separately for each transaction where the system allows this approach. The amounts disclosed are not separately reflected in the financial statements as a gain or loss. No adjustment is made in respect of the cost of inventories held as part of a trading position and certain other temporary inventory positions.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
177


5. Segmental analysis – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

By business
 
Upstream

Downstream

Rosneft

Other
 businesses
and
corporate

Consolidation adjustment and eliminations

Total
group

Segment revenues
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
54,501

250,897


1,788

(28,789
)
278,397

Less: sales and other operating revenues between segments
 
(27,034
)
(973
)

(782
)
28,789


Third party sales and other operating revenues
 
27,467

249,924


1,006


278,397

Earnings from joint ventures and associates – after interest and tax
 
603

374

2,295

(15
)

3,257

Segment results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
4,917

6,502

2,316

(2,771
)
75

11,039

Inventory holding gains (losses)a
 
(8
)
685

(10
)


667

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
4,909

7,187

2,306

(2,771
)
75

11,706

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finance costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
(3,489
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
 
 
(63
)
Profit before taxation
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,154

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,672

1,335


55


6,062

Non-US
 
9,560

1,586


572


11,718

Charges for provisions, net of write-back of unused provisions, including change in discount rate
 
118

507


560


1,185

Segment assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investments in joint ventures and associates
 
12,196

3,609

12,927

1,593


30,325

Additions to non-current assetsb
 
16,254

4,014


2,345


22,613

a 
See explanation of inventory holding gains and losses on page 177.
b 
Includes additions to property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; and investments in associates.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

By business
 
Upstream

Downstream

Rosneft

Other businesses and corporate

Consolidation adjustment and eliminations

Total
group

Segment revenues
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
56,399

270,689


1,678

(30,010
)
298,756

Less: sales and other operating revenues between segments
 
(28,565
)
(574
)

(871
)
30,010


Third party sales and other operating revenues
 
27,834

270,115


807


298,756

Earnings from joint ventures and associates – after interest and tax
 
951

589

2,283

(70
)

3,753

Segment results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
14,328

6,940

2,221

(3,521
)
211

20,179

Inventory holding gains (losses)a
 
(6
)
(862
)
67



(801
)
Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
14,322

6,078

2,288

(3,521
)
211

19,378

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finance costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,528
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
 
 
(127
)
Profit before taxation
 
 
 
 
 
 
16,723

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,211

900


59


5,170

Non-US
 
8,907

1,177


203


10,287

Charges for provisions, net of write-back of unused provisions, including change in discount rate
 
355

834


1,557


2,746

Segment assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investments in joint ventures and associates
 
12,785

2,772

10,074

689


26,320

Additions to non-current assetsb c
 
24,266

3,609


477


28,352

a 
See explanation of inventory holding gains and losses on page 177.
b 
Includes additions to property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; and investments in associates.
c Amounts have been restated to include acquisitions

178
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


5. Segmental analysis – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

By business
 
Upstream

Downstream

Rosneft

Other businesses and corporate

Consolidation adjustment and eliminations

Total
group

Segment revenues
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
45,440

219,853


1,469

(26,554
)
240,208

Less: sales and other operating revenues between segments
 
(24,179
)
(1,800
)

(575
)
26,554


Third party sales and other operating revenues
 
21,261

218,053


894


240,208

Earnings from joint ventures and associates – after interest and tax
 
930

674

922

(19
)

2,507

Segment results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
5,221

7,221

836

(4,445
)
(212
)
8,621

Inventory holding gains (losses)a
 
8

758

87



853

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
5,229

7,979

923

(4,445
)
(212
)
9,474

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finance costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,074
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
 
 
(220
)
Profit before taxation
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,180

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,631

875


65


5,571

Non-US
 
8,637

1,141


235


10,013

Charges for provisions, net of write-back of unused provisions, including change in discount rate
 
220

304


2,902


3,426

a 
See explanation of inventory holding gains and losses on page 177.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2019

By geographical area
 
US

Non-US

Total

Revenues
 
 
 
 
Third party sales and other operating revenuesa
 
89,334

189,063

278,397

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
Production and similar taxes
 
315

1,232

1,547

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Non-current assetsb c
 
57,757

133,398

191,155

a 
Non-US region includes UK $63,194 million
b 
Non-US region includes UK $22,881 million
c 
Includes property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; investments in associates; and non-current prepayments.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

By geographical area
 
US

Non-US

Total

Revenues
 
 
 
 
Third party sales and other operating revenuesa
 
98,066

200,690

298,756

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
Production and similar taxes
 
369

1,167

1,536

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Non-current assetsb c
 
68,188

124,060

192,248

a 
Non-US region includes UK $65,630 million.
b 
Non-US region includes UK $19,426 million.
c 
Includes property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; investments in associates; and non-current prepayments.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
179


5. Segmental analysis – continued
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2017

By geographical area
 
US

Non-US

Total

Revenues
 
 
 
 
Third party sales and other operating revenuesa
 
83,269

156,939

240,208

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
Production and similar taxes
 
52

1,723

1,775

a 
Non-US region includes UK $48,837 million.

6. Revenue from contracts with customers
The amounts shown in the table below are included in Sales and other operating revenues in the group income statement. An analysis of total sales and other operating revenues by segment and region is provided in Note 5.
Revenue from contracts with customers, by product
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Crude oil
 
62,130

65,276

49,670

Oil products
 
180,528

195,466

159,821

Natural gas, LNG and NGLs
 
20,167

21,745

16,196

Non-oil products and other revenues from contracts with customers
 
13,254

13,768

12,538

Revenues from contracts with customers
 
276,079

296,255

238,225

The group’s sales to customers of crude oil and oil products were substantially all made by the Downstream segment. The group’s sales to customers of natural gas, LNG and NGLs were made by the Upstream segment. A significant majority of the group’s sales of non-oil products and other revenues from contracts with customers were made by the Downstream segment.
See Note 1 - impact of new International Financial Reporting Standards - Not yet adopted - IFRIC agenda decision on IFRS 9 'Financial instruments' for further information on changes to the presentation of revenue from contracts with customers that will apply from 1 January 2020.

7. Income statement analysis
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Interest and other income
 
 
 
 
Interest income from
 
 
 
 
Financial assets measured at amortized cost
 
371

421

288

Financial assets measured at fair value through profit or loss
 
49

39


Other income
 
349

313

369

 
 
769

773

657

Currency exchange losses charged to the income statementa
 
37

368

83

Expenditure on research and development
 
364

429

391

Costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill (pre-interest and tax)b
 
319

714

2,687

Finance costs
 
 
 
 
Interest payable on lease liabilitiesc
 
379

51

56

Interest payable on other liabilities measured at amortized cost
 
2,410

2,147

1,662

Capitalized at 3.50% (2018 3.56% and 2017 2.25%)d
 
(374
)
(419
)
(297
)
Unwinding of discount on provisionse
 
505

210

150

Unwinding of discount on other payables measured at amortized cost
 
569

539

503

 
 
3,489

2,528

2,074

a 
Excludes exchange gains and losses arising on financial instruments measured at fair value through profit or loss.
b 
Included within production and manufacturing expenses.
c 
Interest payable on lease liabilities in comparative periods relate to leases previously classified as finance leases under IAS 17.
d 
Tax relief on capitalized interest is approximately $51 million (2018 $55 million and 2017 $64 million).
e From 1 July 2018, the group changed its method of discounting and unwinding provisions from using real rates to using nominal rates.


180
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


8. Exploration for and evaluation of oil and natural gas resources
The following financial information represents the amounts included within the group totals relating to activity associated with the exploration for and evaluation of oil and natural gas resources. All such activity is recorded within the Upstream segment.
For information on significant judgements made in relation to oil and natural gas accounting see Intangible assets in Note 1.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Exploration and evaluation costs
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written offa
 
631

1,085

1,603

Other exploration costs
 
333

360

477

Exploration expense for the year
 
964

1,445

2,080

Impairment losses
 
2

137


Intangible assets – exploration and appraisal expenditureb
 
14,091

15,989

17,026

Liabilities
 
73

60

82

Net assets
 
14,018

15,929

16,944

Cash used in operating activities
 
333

360

477

Cash used in investing activities
 
1,215

1,119

1,901

a 2018 includes $447 million in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico principally relating to licence expiries. 2017 included write-offs in Angola of $574 million in relation to licence relinquishment and Egypt of $208 million following a determination that no commercial hydrocarbons had been found. 2017 also included a $145-million write-off in relation to the value ascribed to certain licences in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico as part of the accounting for the acquisition of upstream assets from Devon Energy in 2011. For further information see Upstream – Exploration on page 53.
b 2019 includes approximately $2.5 billion relating to Canadian oil sands. See Note 1 for further information.

The carrying amount, by location, of exploration and appraisal expenditure capitalized as intangible assets at 31 December 2019 is shown in the table below.
Carrying amount
 
Location
$1 - 2 billion
 
Angola; Egypt; Middle East
$2 - 3 billion
 
US - Gulf of Mexico; Canada; Brazil

9. Taxation
Tax on profit
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Current tax
 
 
 
 
Charge for the year
 
5,316

6,217

4,208

Adjustment in respect of prior yearsa
 
(68
)
(221
)
58

 
 
5,248

5,996

4,266

Deferred taxb
 
 
 
 
Origination and reversal of temporary differences in the current year
 
(1,190
)
907

(503
)
Adjustment in respect of prior years
 
(94
)
242

(51
)
 
 
(1,284
)
1,149

(554
)
Tax charge on profit
 
3,964

7,145

3,712

a 
The adjustments in respect of prior years reflect the reassessment of the current tax balances for prior years in light of changes in facts and circumstances during the year.
b 
Origination and reversal of temporary differences in the current year include the impact of tax rate changes on deferred tax balances. 2018 includes a credit of $121 million (2017 $859 million charge) in respect of the reduction in the US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018. The adjustments in respect of prior years reflect the reassessment of deferred tax balances for prior periods in light of all other changes in facts and circumstances during the year.
In 2019, the total tax charge recognized within other comprehensive income was $227 million (2018 $714 million charge and 2017 $1,499 million charge), primarily comprising the deferred tax impact of the remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset. See Note 32 for further information.
The total tax charge recognized directly in equity was $37 million (2018 $17 million charge and 2017 $263 million charge).
Reconciliation of the effective tax rate
The following table provides a reconciliation of the group weighted average statutory corporate income tax rate to the effective tax rate of the group on profit before taxation.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
181


9. Taxation – continued
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Profit before taxation
 
8,154

16,723

7,180

Tax charge on profit
 
3,964

7,145

3,712

Effective tax rate
 
49%
43%
52%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax rate computed at the weighted average statutory ratea
 
52

43

44

Increase (decrease) resulting from
 
 
 
 
Tax reported in equity-accounted entities
 
(7
)
(5
)
(7
)
Deferred tax not recognizedb
 
(2
)
1

6

Tax incentives for investment
 
(3
)
(2
)
(6
)
Foreign exchange
 
1

3

(4
)
Items not deductible for tax purposes
 
4

1

5

Impact of US tax reformc
 

(1
)
12

Otherb
 
4

3

2

Effective tax rate
 
49

43

52

a 
Calculated based on the statutory corporate income tax rate applicable in the countries in which the group operates, weighted by the profits and losses before tax in the respective countries.
b 
A minor amendment has been made to 2017 and 2018 to align with current period presentation.
c 
Relates to the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018.
Deferred tax
 
 
 
$ million

Analysis of movements during the year in the net deferred tax liability
 
2019

2018

At 31 December
 
6,106

3,513

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9a
 

(36
)
Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 16b
 
(75
)

At 1 January
 
6,031

3,477

Exchange adjustments
 
72

(68
)
Charge (credit) for the year in the income statement
 
(1,284
)
1,149

Charge for the year in other comprehensive income
 
233

734

Charge for the year in equity
 
37

17

Acquisitions, disposals and other additionsc
 
101

797

At 31 December
 
5,190

6,106

a 2018 reflects the deferred tax impact of adjustments recorded by the group on adoption of IFRS 9. See BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 - Financial statements - Note 1 for further information.
b 2019 reflects the deferred tax impact of adjustments recorded by the group on adoption of IFRS 16. See Note 1 for further information.
c 2018 relates primarily to the purchase of an additional 16.5% interest in the Clair field. See Note 3 - Other significant transactions for further information.




182
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


9. Taxation – continued
The following table provides an analysis of deferred tax in the income statement and the balance sheet by category of temporary difference:
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Income statementab
 
 
Balance sheetab

 
 
2019

2018

2017

2019

2018

Deferred tax liability
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation
 
(1,436
)
(1,297
)
(3,971
)
22,627

22,565

Pension plan surpluses
 
(31
)
65

(12
)
2,290

1,956

Derivative financial instruments
 
29

(36
)
(27
)
29


Other taxable temporary differences
 
159

(57
)
(64
)
1,496

1,224

 
 
(1,279
)
(1,325
)
(4,074
)
26,442

25,745

Deferred tax asset
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lease liabilities
 
264

8

(16
)
(1,380
)
(90
)
Pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 
62

(6
)
340

(1,367
)
(1,319
)
Decommissioning, environmental and other provisions
 
(472
)
1,505

3,503

(7,579
)
(7,126
)
Derivative financial instruments
 
63

(31
)
(47
)
(24
)
(95
)
Tax credits
 
(336
)
123

1,476

(3,964
)
(3,626
)
Loss carry forward
 
12

559

(964
)
(5,834
)
(5,900
)
Other deductible temporary differences
 
402

316

(772
)
(1,104
)
(1,483
)
 
 
(5
)
2,474

3,520

(21,252
)
(19,639
)
Net deferred tax charge (credit) and net deferred tax liabilityc
 
(1,284
)
1,149

(554
)
5,190

6,106

Of which – deferred tax liabilities
 
 
 
 
9,750

9,812

 – deferred tax assets
 
 
 
 
4,560

3,706

a The 2017 and 2018 income statement and 2018 balance sheet are impacted by the reduction in US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018.
b The 2019 balance sheet is impacted by the adoption of IFRS 16 and minor amendments have been made to the balance sheet and income statement comparatives to align with current period presentation.
c 
Included within the net deferred tax liability is a deferred tax asset balance of $5,526 million (2018 $5,562 million) related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill.
Of the $4,560 million of deferred tax assets recognised on the group balance sheet at 31 December 2019 (2018 $3,706 million), $2,421 million (2018 $2,758 million) relates to entities that have suffered a loss in either the current or preceding period. This amount is supported by forecasts that indicate sufficient future taxable profits will be available to utilize such assets. For 2019, $2,421 million relates to the US (2018 $1,563 million relates to the US and $1,108 million relates to India).
A summary of temporary differences, unused tax credits and unused tax losses for which deferred tax has not been recognized is shown in the table below.
 
 
 
$ billion

At 31 December
 
2019

2018

Unused US state tax lossesa
 
2.3

6.6

Unused tax losses – other jurisdictionsb
 
3.5

4.3

Unused tax credits
 
25.4

22.5

of which – arising in the UKc
 
21.5

18.7

              – arising in the USd
 
3.9

3.8

Deductible temporary differencese
 
40.4

37.3

Taxable temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
1.5

1.5

a 
For 2019 these losses expire in the period 2020-2039 with applicable tax rates ranging from 3% to 12%.
b 
The majority of the unused tax losses have no fixed expiry date.
c 
The UK unused tax credits arise predominantly in overseas branches of UK entities based in jurisdictions with higher statutory corporate income tax rates than the UK. No deferred tax asset has been recognized on these tax credits as they are unlikely to have value in the future; UK taxes on these overseas branches are largely mitigated by double tax relief in respect of overseas tax. These tax credits have no fixed expiry date.
d 
For 2019 the US unused tax credits expire in the period 2020-2029.
e 
The majority comprises fixed asset temporary differences in the UK. Substantially all of the temporary differences have no expiry date.
 
 
 
 
$ million

Impact of previously unrecognized deferred tax or write-down of deferred tax assets on tax charge
 
2019

2018

2017

Current tax benefit relating to the utilization of previously unrecognized deferred tax assets
 
272

83

22

Deferred tax benefit arising from the reversal of a previous write-down of deferred tax assets
 
96



Deferred tax benefit relating to the recognition of previously unrecognized deferred tax assets
 
364

112

436

Deferred tax expense arising from the write-down of a previously recognized deferred tax asset
 
73

169

78



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
183


10. Dividends
The quarterly dividend which is expected to be paid on 27 March 2020 in respect of the fourth quarter 2019 is 10.50 cents per ordinary share ($0.630 per American Depositary Share (ADS)). The corresponding amount in sterling was announced on 16 March 2020.
 
 
Pence per share
 
Cents per share
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

2019

2018

2017

2019

2018

2017

Dividends announced and paid in cash
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

1

1

Ordinary shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
March
 
7.7380

7.1691

8.1587

10.25

10.00

10.00

1,435

1,828

1,303

June
 
8.0660

7.4435

7.7563

10.25

10.00

10.00

1,779

1,727

1,546

September
 
8.3480

7.9296

7.6213

10.25

10.25

10.00

1,656

1,409

1,676

December
 
7.8250

8.0251

7.4435

10.25

10.25

10.00

2,075

1,734

1,627

 
 
31.9770

30.5673

30.9798

41.00

40.50

40.00

6,946

6,699

6,153

Dividend announced, paid in March 2020
 
 
 
 
10.50

 
 
2,120

 
 
The details of the scrip dividends issued are shown in the table below. The board decided not to offer a scrip dividend alternative in respect of the third quarter 2019 dividend paid in December 2019 and fourth quarter 2019 dividend expected to be paid on 27 March 2020.
 
 
2019

2018

2017

Number of shares issued (thousand)
 
208,927

195,305

289,789

Value of shares issued ($ million)
 
1,387

1,381

1,714

The financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2019 do not reflect the dividend announced on 4 February 2020 and paid in March 2020; this will be treated as an appropriation of profit in the year ending 31 December 2020.

11. Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
Cents per share

Per ordinary share
 
2019

2018

2017

Basic earnings per share
 
19.84

46.98

17.20

Diluted earnings per share
 
19.73

46.67

17.10

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dollars per share
 
Per American Depositary Share (ADS)
 
2019

2018

2017

Basic earnings per share
 
1.19

2.82

1.03

Diluted earnings per share
 
1.18

2.80

1.03

Basic earnings per ordinary share amounts are calculated by dividing the profit for the year attributable to BP ordinary shareholders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year.
The weighted average number of shares outstanding includes certain shares that will be issuable in the future under employee share-based payment plans and excludes treasury shares, which includes shares held by the Employee Share Ownership Plan trusts (ESOPs).
For the diluted earnings per share calculation, the weighted average number of shares outstanding during the year is adjusted for the average number of shares that are potentially issuable in connection with employee share-based payment plans. If the inclusion of potentially issuable shares would decrease loss per share, the potentially issuable shares are excluded from the weighted average number of shares outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per share.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Profit attributable to BP shareholders
 
4,026

9,383

3,389

Less: dividend requirements on preference shares
 
1

1

1

Profit for the year attributable to BP ordinary shareholders
 
4,025

9,382

3,388

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shares thousand

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares
 
20,284,859

19,970,215

19,692,613

Potential dilutive effect of ordinary shares issuable under employee share-based payment plans
 
114,811

132,278

123,829

Weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per share
 
20,399,670

20,102,493

19,816,442

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shares thousand

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares – ADS equivalent
 
3,380,809

3,328,369

3,282,102

Potential dilutive effect of ordinary shares (ADS equivalent) issuable under employee share-based payment plans
 
19,136

22,046

20,638

Weighted average number of ordinary shares (ADS equivalent) outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per share
 
3,399,945

3,350,415

3,302,740


184
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


11. Earnings per share – continued
The number of ordinary shares outstanding at 31 December 2019, excluding treasury shares, and including certain shares that will be issuable in the future under employee share-based payment plans was 20,241,170,965. Between 31 December 2019 and 27 February 2020, the latest practicable date before the completion of these financial statements, there was a net decrease of 46,527,851 in the number of ordinary shares outstanding primarily as a result of share issues in relation to employee share-based payment plans. A further 120 million of shares have also been repurchased in January 2020 as part of the share buyback programme at a total cost of $776 million.
Employee share-based payment plans
The group operates share and share option plans for directors and certain employees to obtain ordinary shares and ADSs in the company. Information on these plans for directors is shown in the Directors remuneration report on pages 100-127.
The following table shows the number of shares potentially issuable under equity-settled employee share option plans, including the number of options outstanding, the number of options exercisable at the end of each year, and the corresponding weighted average exercise prices. The dilutive effect of these plans at 31 December is also shown.
Share options
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
 
Number of optionsab
thousand

Weighted average
 exercise price $

Number of optionsab
thousand

Weighted average
 exercise price $

Outstanding
 
17,112

4.91

19,437

4.28

Exercisable
 
1,067

3.97

481

4.69

Dilutive effect
 
3,990

n/a

6,123

n/a

a 
Numbers of options shown are ordinary share equivalents (one ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares).
b 
At 31 December 2019 the quoted market price of one BP ordinary share was £4.72 (2018 £4.96).
In addition, the group operates a number of equity-settled employee share plans under which share units are granted to the group’s senior leaders and certain other employees. These plans typically have a three-year performance or restricted period during which the units accrue net notional dividends which are treated as having been reinvested. Leaving employment will normally preclude the conversion of units into shares, but special arrangements apply for participants that leave for qualifying reasons. The number of shares that are expected to vest each year under employee share plans are shown in the table below. The dilutive effect of the employee share plans at 31 December is also shown.
Share plans
 
2019

2018

 
 
Number of sharesa

Number of sharesa

Vesting
 
thousand

thousand

Within one year
 
91,105

108,934

1 to 2 years
 
89,939

106,337

2 to 3 years
 
80,844

71,407

3 to 4 years
 
725

588

Over 4 years
 
576

799

 
 
263,189

288,065

Dilutive effect
 
92,343

127,165

a 
Numbers of shares shown are ordinary share equivalents (one ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares).
There has been a net decrease of 37,497,364 in the number of potential ordinary shares relating to employee share-based payment plans between 31 December 2019 and 27 February 2020.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
185


12. Property, plant and equipment
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Land and land improvements

Buildings

Oil and gas propertiesa

Plant, machinery and equipment

Fittings, fixtures and office equipment

Transportationb

Oil depots, storage tanks and service stations

Total

Cost - owned property, plant and equipment (PP&E)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2019
 
3,562

1,502

232,684

45,721

2,747

10,183

8,866

305,265

Exchange adjustments
 
(22
)
5


(158
)
15

(3
)
(69
)
(232
)
Additions
 
88

93

13,237

2,433

172

274

644

16,941

Acquisitions
 
51






8

59

Transfers from intangible assets
 


1,885





1,885

Reclassified as assets held for sale
 
(26
)

(22,602
)

(76
)
(6,708
)

(29,412
)
Deletions
 
(44
)
(178
)
(10,852
)
(1,272
)
(326
)
(272
)
(755
)
(13,699
)
At 31 December 2019
 
3,609

1,422

214,352

46,724

2,532

3,474

8,694

280,807

Depreciation - owned PP&E
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2019
 
626

697

133,687

20,512

2,041

7,819

5,146

170,528

Exchange adjustments
 
(4
)
5


(63
)
12

(3
)
(45
)
(98
)
Charge for the year
 
44

59

13,012

1,705

168

173

420

15,581

Impairment losses
 
1

1

5,871

64

1

404

4

6,346

Impairment reversals
 


(129
)


(2
)

(131
)
Reclassified as assets held for sale
 


(17,764
)

(69
)
(5,478
)

(23,311
)
Deletions
 
(86
)
(65
)
(9,911
)
(691
)
(147
)
(169
)
(660
)
(11,729
)
At 31 December 2019
 
581

697

124,766

21,527

2,006

2,744

4,865

157,186

Owned PP&E - net book amount at 31 December 2019
 
3,028

725

89,586

25,197

526

730

3,829

123,621

Right-of-use assets - net book amount at 31 December 2019c
 

1,196

128

1,241

16

3,385

3,055

9,021

Total PP&E - net book amount at 31 December 2019
 
3,028

1,921

89,714

26,438

542

4,115

6,884

132,642

Cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2018
 
3,474

1,573

226,054

46,662

2,853

10,774

8,748

300,138

Exchange adjustments
 
(168
)
(58
)

(892
)
(73
)
(43
)
(501
)
(1,735
)
Additions
 
233

40

9,712

2,323

204

(112
)
736

13,136

Acquisitions
 
163

4

10,882

9

1

2

36

11,097

Remeasurementsb
 


17





17

Transfers from intangible assets
 


901





901

Deletions
 
(140
)
(45
)
(14,699
)
(1,810
)
(238
)
(128
)
(146
)
(17,206
)
At 31 December 2018
 
3,562

1,514

232,867

46,292

2,747

10,493

8,873

306,348

Depreciation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2018
 
683

818

133,326

20,996

2,136

7,523

5,185

170,667

Exchange adjustments
 
(25
)
(24
)

(460
)
(52
)
(27
)
(279
)
(867
)
Charge for the year
 
92

52

12,342

1,820

189

252

384

15,131

Impairment losses
 
2


86

253


178

2

521

Impairment reversals
 


(564
)
(1
)

(17
)

(582
)
Deletions
 
(126
)
(139
)
(11,333
)
(1,733
)
(232
)
(75
)
(145
)
(13,783
)
At 31 December 2018
 
626

707

133,857

20,875

2,041

7,834

5,147

171,087

Net book amount at 31 December 2018
 
2,936

807

99,010

25,417

706

2,659

3,726

135,261

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets held under finance leases at net book amount included aboved
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 

2

12

207


295

6

522

Assets under construction included above
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
23,897

At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22,522

Depreciation charge for the year on right-of-use assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 

220

31

671

9

784

526

2,241

a For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to the estimation of oil and natural reserves see Property, plant and equipment within Note 1.
b 
Includes adjustments to decommissioning provisions; see Note 1 for further information.
c $653 million of drilling rig right-of-use assets and $2,929 million of shipping vessel right-of-use assets are included in Plant, machinery and equipment and Transportation respectively.
d Leases previously classified as finance leases are included within right-of-use assets following the implementation of IFRS 16 ‘Leases’; see Note 1 for further information. The reconciliation of owned property, plant and equipment for 2019 does not include right-of-use assets and, therefore, the cost and depreciation at 1 January 2019 is not equal to the cost and depreciation of total property, plant and equipment at 31 December 2018. The relevant amounts excluded are cost of $1,083 million and depreciation of $559 million relating to leases previously classified as finance leases.


186
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


13. Capital commitments
Authorized future capital expenditure for property, plant and equipment (excluding right-of-use assets) by group companies for which contracts had been signed at 31 December 2019 amounted to $11,382 million (2018 $8,319 million, 2017 $11,340 million). BP has contracted capital commitments amounting to $787 million (2018 $1,227 million, 2017 $1,451 million) in relation to associates. BP’s share of contracted capital commitments of joint ventures amounted to $1,024 million (2018 $619 million, 2017 $483 million).

14. Goodwill and impairment review of goodwill
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

Cost
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
12,815

12,163

Exchange adjustments
 
79

(210
)
Acquisitions and other additionsa
 
26

1,046

Deletions
 
(55
)
(184
)
At 31 December
 
12,865

12,815

Impairment losses
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
611

612

Exchange adjustments
 


Impairment losses for the year
 
386


Deletions
 

(1
)
At 31 December
 
997

611

Net book amount at 31 December
 
11,868

12,204

Net book amount at 1 January
 
12,204

11,551

a 2018 principally relates to the purchase of an additional 16.5% share in the Clair field in the North Sea. See Note 3 - Other significant transactions for further information.
Impairment review of goodwill
 
 
 


Goodwill at 31 December
 
2019

2018

Upstream
 
7,958

8,346

Downstream
 
3,904

3,802

Other businesses and corporate
 
6

56

 
 
11,868

12,204

Goodwill acquired through business combinations has been allocated to groups of cash-generating units that are expected to benefit from the synergies of the acquisition. For Upstream, goodwill is allocated to all oil and gas assets in aggregate at the segment level. For Downstream, goodwill has been allocated to Lubricants and Other.
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to impairments see Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets and goodwill in Note 1.
Upstream
 
 
 


 
 
2019

2018

Goodwill
 
7,958

8,346

Excess of recoverable amount over carrying amount
 
93,250

53,391

The table above shows the carrying amount of goodwill for the segment and the excess of the recoverable amount, based on a pre-tax value-in-use calculation, over the carrying amount (headroom) at the date of the test. The increase in headroom principally arises from acquisitions (including the acquisition from BHP), new activity and discount rate changes, net of highly probable and completed divestments and price assumption changes.
Goodwill impairments of $386 million, related to goodwill allocated to expected divestments, were recognized during 2019 (2018 nil).
The value in use is based on the cash flows expected to be generated by the projected oil or natural gas production profiles up to the expected dates of cessation of production of each producing field, based on current estimates of reserves and resources, appropriately risked. Midstream and supply and trading activities and equity-accounted entities are generally not included in the impairment review of goodwill, because they are not part of the grouping of cash-generating units to which the goodwill relates and which is used to monitor the goodwill for internal management purposes. Where such activities form part of a wider Upstream cash-generating unit, they are reflected in the test. As the production profile and related cash flows can be estimated from BP’s past experience, management believes that the cash flows generated over the estimated life of field is the appropriate basis upon which to assess goodwill and individual assets for impairment. The estimated date of cessation of production depends on the interaction of a number of variables, such as the recoverable quantities of hydrocarbons, the production profile of the hydrocarbons, the cost of the development of the infrastructure necessary to recover the hydrocarbons, production costs, the contractual duration of the production concession and the selling price of the hydrocarbons produced. As each producing field has specific reservoir characteristics and economic circumstances, the cash flows of the fields are computed using appropriate individual economic models and key assumptions agreed by BP management. Capital expenditure, operating costs and expected hydrocarbon production profiles are derived from the business segment plan adjusted for assumptions reflecting the price environment at the time that the test was performed. Estimated production volumes and cash flows up to the date of cessation of production on a field-by-field basis are consistent with this. The production profiles used are consistent with the reserve and resource volumes approved as part of BP’s centrally controlled process for the estimation of proved and probable reserves and total resources.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
187


14. Goodwill and impairment review of goodwill – continued
The most recent review for impairment was carried out in the fourth quarter. The key assumptions used in the value-in-use calculation are oil and natural gas prices, production volumes and the discount rate. Oil and gas price assumptions and discount rate assumptions used were as disclosed in Note 1. The value-in-use calculation has been prepared solely for the purposes of determining whether the goodwill balance was impaired. Estimated future cash flows were prepared on the basis of certain assumptions prevailing at the time of the test. The actual outcomes may differ from the assumptions made. For example, reserves and resources estimates and production forecasts are subject to revision as further technical information becomes available and economic conditions change. Due to economic developments, regulatory change and emissions reduction activity arising from climate concern and other factors, future commodity prices and other assumptions may differ from the forecasts used in the calculations.
Sensitivities to different variables have been estimated using certain simplifying assumptions. For example, lower oil and gas price sensitivities do not fully reflect the specific impacts for each contractual arrangement and will not capture all favourable impacts that may arise from cost deflation. A detailed calculation at any given price or production profile may, therefore, produce a different result.
It is estimated that no reasonable sustained fall in the oil or gas price assumption over the next 20 years would individually cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment.
Estimated production volumes are based on detailed data for each field and take into account development plans agreed by management as part of the long-term planning process. The average production for the purposes of goodwill impairment testing over the next 15 years is 829 mmboe per year (2018 829 mmboe per year). It is estimated that no reasonably possible change in production volumes would cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment.
It is estimated that no reasonably possible change in the pre-tax discount rate would cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment. The weighted average discount rate used in the test is 12%.
Downstream
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
2018

 
 
Lubricants

Other

Total

Lubricants

Other

Total

Goodwill
 
2,779

1,125

3,904

2,692

1,110

3,802

Cash flows for each cash-generating unit are derived from the business segment plans, which cover a period of up to five years. To determine the value in use for each of the cash-generating units, cash flows for a period of 10 years are discounted and aggregated with a terminal value.
Lubricants
As permitted by IAS 36, the detailed calculations of Lubricants’ recoverable amount performed in the most recent detailed calculation in 2018 was used as the basis for the tests in 2019 as the criteria of IAS 36 were considered satisfied: the headroom was substantial in 2018; there have been no significant changes in the assets and liabilities; and the likelihood that the recoverable amount would be less than the carrying amount is remote.
The key assumptions to which the calculation of value in use for the Lubricants unit is most sensitive are operating unit margins, sales volumes, and discount rate. Operating margin and sales volumes assumptions used in the detailed impairment review of goodwill calculation are consistent with the assumptions used in the Lubricants unit’s business plan and values assigned to these key assumptions reflect past experience. No reasonably possible change in any of these key assumptions would cause the unit’s carrying amount to exceed its recoverable amount. Cash flows beyond the plan period are extrapolated using a nominal 2.8% growth rate.

15. Intangible assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
2018

 
 
Exploration and appraisal expenditurea

Other intangibles

Total

Exploration and appraisal expenditurea

Other intangibles

Total

Cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
17,053

4,504

21,557

17,886

4,488

22,374

Exchange adjustments
 

2

2


(128
)
(128
)
Acquisitions
 

35

35


25

25

Additions
 
1,268

457

1,725

1,095

318

1,413

Transfers to property, plant and equipment
 
(1,885
)

(1,885
)
(901
)

(901
)
Reclassified as assets held for sale
 
(671
)

(671
)



Deletions
 
(459
)
(98
)
(557
)
(1,027
)
(199
)
(1,226
)
At 31 December
 
15,306

4,900

20,206

17,053

4,504

21,557

Amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
1,064

3,209

4,273

860

3,159

4,019

Exchange adjustments
 

4

4


(77
)
(77
)
Charge for the year
 
631

331

962

1,085

326

1,411

Impairment losses
 
2

2

4

137


137

Reclassified as assets held for sale
 
(61
)

(61
)



Deletions
 
(421
)
(94
)
(515
)
(1,018
)
(199
)
(1,217
)
At 31 December
 
1,215

3,452

4,667

1,064

3,209

4,273

Net book amount at 31 December
 
14,091

1,448

15,539

15,989

1,295

17,284

Net book amount at 1 January
 
15,989

1,295

17,284

17,026

1,329

18,355

a For further information see Intangible assets within Note 1 and Note 8.


188
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


16. Investments in joint ventures
The following table provides aggregated summarized financial information relating to the group’s share of joint ventures. In December 2019, BP and Bunge both contributed their Brazilian biofuels and biopower businesses into a new joint venture, BP Bunge Bioenergia. BP owns 50% of the new entity.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Sales and other operating revenues
 
14,139

13,258

11,380

Profit before interest and taxation
 
975

1,396

1,394

Finance costs
 
111

85

100

Profit before taxation
 
864

1,311

1,294

Taxation
 
288

414

117

Profit for the year
 
576

897

1,177

Other comprehensive income
 
(6
)
6

8

Total comprehensive income
 
570

903

1,185

Non-current assets
 
13,408

10,399

 
Current assets
 
3,738

2,935

 
Total assets
 
17,146

13,334

 
Current liabilities
 
2,514

1,715

 
Non-current liabilities
 
4,676

3,017

 
Total liabilities
 
7,190

4,732

 
Net assets
 
9,956

8,602

 
Group investment in joint ventures
 
 
 
 
Group share of net assets (as above)
 
9,956

8,602

 
Loans made by group companies to joint ventures
 
35

45

 
 
 
9,991

8,647

 
Transactions between the group and its joint ventures are summarized below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Sales to joint ventures
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

Product
 
Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

LNG, crude oil and oil products, natural gas
 
4,884

431

4,603

251

3,578

352

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Purchases from joint ventures
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

Product
 
Purchases

Amount payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

LNG, crude oil and oil products, natural gas, refinery operating costs, plant processing fees
 
1,812

225

1,336

300

1,257

176

The terms of the outstanding balances receivable from joint ventures are typically 30 to 45 days. The balances are unsecured and will be settled in cash. There are no significant provisions for doubtful debts relating to these balances and no significant expense recognized in the income statement in respect of bad or doubtful debts. Dividends receivable are not included in the table above.

17. Investments in associates
The following table provides aggregated summarized financial information for the group’s associates as it relates to the amounts recognized in the group income statement and on the group balance sheet.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Income statement
 
 
Balance sheet

 
 
 
Earnings from associates
 - after interest and tax
 
 
Investments in associates

 
 
2019

2018

2017

2019

2018

Rosneft
 
2,295

2,283

922

12,927

10,074

Other associates
 
386

573

408

7,407

7,599

 
 
2,681

2,856

1,330

20,334

17,673

The associate that is material to the group at both 31 December 2019 and 2018 is Rosneft.
BP owns 19.75% of the voting shares of Rosneft which are listed on the MICEX stock exchange in Moscow and its global depository receipts are listed on the London Stock Exchange. The Russian federal government, through its investment company JSC Rosneftegaz, owned 50.0% plus one share of the voting shares of Rosneft at 31 December 2019.
BP classifies its investment in Rosneft as an associate because, in management’s judgement, BP has significant influence over Rosneft; see Interests in other entities within Note 1 for further information. The group’s investment in Rosneft is a foreign operation whose functional currency is the Russian rouble. The increase in the group's equity-accounted investment balance for Rosneft at 31 December 2019 compared with 31 December 2018 principally relates to earnings from Rosneft and foreign exchange effects, which have been recognized in other comprehensive income, offset by dividends.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
189


17. Investments in associates – continued
The value of BP’s 19.75% shareholding in Rosneft based on the quoted market share price of $7.21 per share (2018 $6.18 per share) was $15,090 million at 31 December 2019 (2018 $12,934 million).
The following table provides summarized financial information relating to Rosneft. This information is presented on a 100% basis and reflects adjustments made by BP to Rosneft’s own results in applying the equity method of accounting. BP adjusts Rosneft’s results for the accounting required under IFRS relating to BP’s purchase of its interest in Rosneft and the amortization of the deferred gain relating to the disposal of BP’s interest in TNK-BP. These adjustments have increased the reported profit for 2019, as shown in the table below, compared with the amounts reported in Rosneft's IFRS financial statements. In particular, in 2018 these adjustments resulted in BP reporting a lower amount relating to impairment charges of downstream goodwill than the equivalent amounts reported by Rosneft.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
Gross amount

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Sales and other operating revenues
 
134,046

131,322

103,028

Profit before interest and taxation
 
17,473

18,886

9,949

Finance costs
 
1,281

2,785

2,228

Profit before taxation
 
16,192

16,101

7,721

Taxation
 
3,058

2,957

1,742

Non-controlling interests
 
1,514

1,585

1,311

Profit for the year
 
11,620

11,559

4,668

Other comprehensive income
 
572

2,086

2,810

Total comprehensive income
 
12,192

13,645

7,478

Non-current assets
 
161,327

137,038

 
Current assets
 
38,657

43,438

 
Total assets
 
199,984

180,476

 
Current liabilities
 
44,459

41,311

 
Non-current liabilities
 
79,327

78,754

 
Total liabilities
 
123,786

120,065

 
Net assets
 
76,198

60,411

 
Less: non-controlling interests
 
10,744

9,403

 
 
 
65,454

51,008

 
The group received dividends, net of withholding tax, of $785 million from Rosneft in 2019 (2018 $620 million and 2017 $314 million).
Summarized financial information for the group’s share of associates is shown below.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP share

 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
2018

 
 
2017

 
 
Rosnefta

Other

Total

Rosnefta

Other

Total

Rosnefta

Other

Total

Sales and other operating revenues
 
26,474

7,934

34,408

25,936

9,134

35,070

20,348

7,600

27,948

Profit before interest and taxation
 
3,451

788

4,239

3,730

1,150

4,880

1,965

626

2,591

Finance costs
 
253

87

340

550

78

628

440

54

494

Profit before taxation
 
3,198

701

3,899

3,180

1,072

4,252

1,525

572

2,097

Taxation
 
604

315

919

584

499

1,083

344

164

508

Non-controlling interests
 
299


299

313


313

259


259

Profit for the year
 
2,295

386

2,681

2,283

573

2,856

922

408

1,330

Other comprehensive income
 
113

(25
)
88

412

(1
)
411

555

1

556

Total comprehensive income
 
2,408

361

2,769

2,695

572

3,267

1,477

409

1,886

Non-current assets
 
31,862

11,504

43,366

27,065

10,787

37,852

 
 
 
Current assets
 
7,635

1,924

9,559

8,579

2,398

10,977

 
 
 
Total assets
 
39,497

13,428

52,925

35,644

13,185

48,829

 
 
 
Current liabilities
 
8,781

1,908

10,689

8,159

2,232

10,391

 
 
 
Non-current liabilities
 
15,667

4,577

20,244

15,554

3,817

19,371

 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
24,448

6,485

30,933

23,713

6,049

29,762

 
 
 
Net assets
 
15,049

6,943

21,992

11,931

7,136

19,067

 
 
 
Less: non-controlling interests
 
2,122


2,122

1,857


1,857

 
 
 
 
 
12,927

6,943

19,870

10,074

7,136

17,210

 
 
 
Group investment in associates
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Group share of net assets (as above)
 
12,927

6,943

19,870

10,074

7,136

17,210

 
 
 
Loans made by group companies to associates
 

464

464


463

463

 
 
 
 
 
12,927

7,407

20,334

10,074

7,599

17,673

 
 
 
a 
From 1 October 2014, Rosneft adopted hedge accounting in relation to a portion of highly probable future export revenue denominated in US dollars over a five-year period. Foreign exchange gains and losses arising on the retranslation of borrowings denominated in currencies other than the Russian rouble and designated as hedging instruments are recognized initially in other comprehensive income, and are reclassified to the income statement as the hedged revenue is recognized.

190
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


17. Investments in associates – continued
Transactions between the group and its associates are summarized below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Sales to associates
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

Product
 
Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

LNG, crude oil and oil products, natural gas
 
1,544

243

2,064

393

1,612

216

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Purchases from associates
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

Product
 
Purchases

Amount payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

Crude oil and oil products, natural gas, transportation tariff
 
9,503

1,641

14,112

2,069

11,613

1,681

In addition to the transactions shown in the table above, in 2018 BP acquired a 49% stake in LLC Kharampurneftegaz, a Rosneft subsidiary, which develops resources within the Kharampurskoe and Festivalnoye licence areas in Yamalo-Nenets in northern Russia. BP’s interest in LLC Kharampurneftegaz is accounted for as an associate.
The terms of the outstanding balances receivable from associates are typically 30 to 45 days. The balances are unsecured and will be settled in cash. There are no significant provisions for doubtful debts relating to these balances and no significant expense recognized in the income statement in respect of bad or doubtful debts. Dividends receivable are not included in the table above.
The majority of purchases from associates relate to crude oil and oil products transactions with Rosneft. Sales to associates are related to various entities.
BP has commitments amounting to $11,198 million (2018 $11,303 million), primarily in relation to contracts with its associates for the purchase of transportation capacity. For information on capital commitments in relation to associates see Note 13.

18. Other investments
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
 
Current

Non-current

Current

Non-current

Equity investmentsa
 

571

1

482

Other
 
169

705

221

859

 
 
169

1,276

222

1,341

a 
The majority of equity investments are unlisted.
Other investments includes $598 million relating to contingent consideration amounts arising on disposals (2018 $893 million) which are financial assets classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss. The fair value is determined using an estimate of discounted future cash flows that are expected to be received and is considered a level 3 valuation under the fair value hierarchy. Future cash flows are estimated based on inputs including oil and natural gas prices, production volumes and operating costs related to the disposed operations. The discount rate used is based on a risk-free rate adjusted for asset-specific risks.

19. Inventories
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

Crude oil
 
5,610

4,878

Natural gas
 
222

322

Refined petroleum and petrochemical products
 
12,907

10,419

 
 
18,739

15,619

Trading inventories
 
182

282

 
 
18,921

15,901

Supplies
 
1,959

2,087

 
 
20,880

17,988

Cost of inventories expensed in the income statement
 
209,672

229,878

The inventory valuation at 31 December 2019 is stated net of a provision of $650 million (2018 $1,009 million) to write down inventories to their net realizable value, of which $290 million (2018 $604 million) relates to hydrocarbon inventories. The net credit to the income statement in the year in respect of inventory net realizable value provisions was $348 million (2018 $552 million charge), of which $309 million credit (2018 $553 million charge) related to hydrocarbon inventories.
Trading inventories are valued using quoted benchmark prices adjusted as appropriate for location and quality differentials. They are predominantly categorized within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
191


20. Trade and other receivables
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
 
Current

Non-current

Current

Non-current

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
Trade receivables
 
19,424

22

19,414

7

Amounts receivable from joint ventures and associates
 
672

2

642

2

Other receivables
 
3,325

826

3,275

740

 
 
23,421

850

23,331

749

Non-financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
Gulf of Mexico oil spill trust fund reimbursement asset
 
201


214


Sales taxes and production taxes
 
640

538

790

482

Other receivables
 
180

759

143

603

 
 
1,021

1,297

1,147

1,085

 
 
24,442

2,147

24,478

1,834

In both 2019 and 2018 the group entered into non-recourse arrangements to discount certain receivables in support of supply and trading activities and the management of credit risk.
Trade and other receivables are predominantly non-interest bearing. See Note 29 for further information.

21. Valuation and qualifying accounts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Trade and other receivables

Fixed asset
investments

Trade and other receivables

Fixed asset
investments

Trade and other receivables

Fixed asset
investments

At 1 January – IAS 39
 
416

235

335

314

392

335

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9
 


115

(85
)


At 1 January – IFRS 9
 
416

235

450

229

392

335

Charged to costs and expenses
 
206

28

30

10

68

47

Charged to other accountsa
 
(2
)

(12
)
(1
)
13

3

Deductions
 
(111
)
(14
)
(52
)
(3
)
(138
)
(71
)
At 31 December
 
509

249

416

235

335

314

a Principally exchange adjustments.
Valuation and qualifying accounts relating to trade and other receivables comprise expected credit loss allowances in 2019 and 2018 and impairment provisions recognized on an incurred loss basis in 2017. The adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9 relates to the additional loss allowance required by IFRS 9's expected credit loss model. The expected credit loss allowance comprises $414 million (2018 $327 million) relating to receivables that were credit-impaired at the end of the year and $95 million (2018 $89 million) relating to receivables that were not credit-impaired at the end of the year. There were no significant changes to the gross carrying amounts of trade and other receivables during the year that affected the estimation of the loss allowance at 31 December 2019.
Valuation and qualifying accounts relating to fixed asset investments comprise impairment provisions for investments in equity-accounted entities in 2019 and 2018. This includes expected credit loss allowances of $2 million (2018 $44 million) relating to loans that form part of the net investment in equity-accounted entities. The adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9 primarily relates to amounts provided against investments in equity instruments that were held at cost less impairment losses under IAS 39 but that are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss under IFRS 9.
In addition to the amounts presented above, expected loss allowances on cash and cash equivalents classified as measured at amortized cost totalled $11 million (2018 $11 million). For further information on the group's credit risk management policies and how the group recognizes and measures expected losses see Note 29.
Valuation and qualifying accounts are deducted in the balance sheet from the assets to which they apply.


192
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


22. Trade and other payables
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
 
Current

Non-current

Current

Non-current

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Trade payables
 
30,538


26,252


Amounts payable to joint ventures and associates
 
1,866


2,369


Payables for capital expenditure and acquisitionsa
 
3,868

1,196

7,325

1,345

Payables related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill
 
1,617

10,863

2,279

11,922

Other payables
 
5,810

133

4,980

318

 
 
43,699

12,192

43,205

13,585

Non-financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Sales taxes, customs duties, production taxes and social security
 
2,381

33

2,272

35

Other payables
 
749

401

788

210

 
 
3,130

434

3,060

245

 
 
46,829

12,626

46,265

13,830

a 
2018 includes $3,514 million deferred consideration relating to the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation from BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc. See Note 3 for further information.

Materially all of BP's trade payables have payment terms in the range of 30 to 60 days and give rise to operating cash flows.
Trade and other payables, other than those relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, are predominantly interest free. See Note 29 (c) for further information.
Payables related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill include amounts payable under the 2016 consent decree and settlement agreement with the United States and five Gulf coast states, including amounts payable for natural resource damages, state claims and Clean Water Act penalties. On a discounted basis the amounts included in other payables for these elements of the agreements are $5,166 million payable over 13 years, $2,742 million payable over 14 years and $3,782 million payable over 13 years respectively at 31 December 2019. Reported within net cash provided by operating activities in the group cash flow statement is a net cash outflow of $2,694 million (2018 outflow of $3,531 million, 2017 outflow of $5,336 million) related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, which includes payments made in relation to these agreements. For 2018 and 2017 payments under the 2012 agreement with the US government to resolve all federal criminal claims arising from the incident are also included. For full details of these agreements, see BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2015.
Payables related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill at 31 December 2019 also include amounts payable for settled economic loss and property damage claims which are payable over a period of up to eight years.

23. Provisions
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Decommissioning

Environmental

Litigation and claims

Other

Total

At 1 January 2019a
 
13,613

1,567

1,718

3,306

20,204

Exchange adjustments
 
74

(1
)

(19
)
54

Acquisitions
 
13


47

22

82

Increase (decrease) in existing provisions
 
1,045

272

290

960

2,567

Write-back of unused provisions
 
(22
)
(43
)
(15
)
(361
)
(441
)
Unwinding of discount
 
415

45

28

17

505

Change in discount rate
 
1,360

40

31

11

1,442

Utilization
 
(9
)
(252
)
(674
)
(665
)
(1,600
)
Reclassified to other payables
 
(187
)

(139
)
(328
)
(654
)
Reclassified as liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale
 
(1,004
)
(8
)


(1,012
)
Deletions
 
(188
)

(5
)
(3
)
(196
)
At 31 December 2019
 
15,110

1,620

1,281

2,940

20,951

Of which – current
 
317

280

558

1,298

2,453

– non-current
 
14,793

1,340

723

1,642

18,498

Of which – Gulf of Mexico oil spill
 


189


189

a Includes adjustment of $92 million for the implementation of IFRS 16. See Note 1 for further information.    

The decommissioning provision comprises the future cost of decommissioning oil and natural gas wells, facilities and related pipelines. The environmental provision includes provisions for costs related to the control, abatement, clean-up or elimination of environmental pollution relating to soil, groundwater, surface water and sediment contamination. The litigation and claims category includes provisions for matters related to, for example, commercial disputes, product liability, and allegations of exposures of third parties to toxic substances. Included within the other category at 31 December 2019 are provisions for deferred employee compensation of $311 million (2018 $338 million).
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to provisions, see Provisions and contingencies within Note 1.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
193


23. Provisions – continued
Gulf of Mexico oil spill
The group has recognized certain assets, payables and provisions and incurs certain residual costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill that occurred in 2010. In addition to the Litigation and claims narrative provided in this note, for further information see Notes 7, 9, 20, 22, 29, 33 and Legal proceedings on pages 319-320.
Litigation and claims - PSC settlements
The Economic and Property Damages Settlement Agreement (EPD Settlement Agreement) with the Plaintiff's Steering Committee (PSC) provides for a court-supervised settlement programme ,the DHCSSP, which commenced operation on 4 June 2012. A separate claims administrator was appointed to pay medical claims and to implement other aspects of the Medical Benefits Class Action Settlement. For further information on the PSC settlements, see Legal proceedings on page 319.
The litigation and claims provision reflects the latest estimate for the remaining costs associated with the PSC settlements. These costs relate predominantly to business economic loss (BEL) claims and associated administration costs. Only a very small number of claims remained to be determined by the end of 2019 however certain BEL claims determined by the DHCSSP have been and continue to be appealed by BP and/or the claimants. Claims under appeal will ultimately only be resolved once the full judicial appeals process has been concluded, including appeals to the Federal District Court and Fifth Circuit, as may be the case, or when settlements are reached with individual claimants. Depending upon the ultimate resolution of these claims, the amounts payable may differ from those currently provided. Payments to resolve outstanding claims under the PSC settlements are expected to be made over the next couple of years. The timing of payments, however, is uncertain, and, in particular, will be impacted by how long it takes to resolve claims that have been appealed and may be appealed in the future.

24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
Most group companies have pension plans, the forms and benefits of which vary with conditions and practices in the countries concerned. Pension benefits may be provided through defined contribution plans (money purchase schemes) or defined benefit plans (final salary and other types of schemes with committed pension benefit payments). For defined contribution plans, retirement benefits are determined by the value of funds arising from contributions paid in respect of each employee. For defined benefit plans, retirement benefits are based on such factors as an employee’s pensionable salary and length of service. Defined benefit plans may be funded or unfunded. The assets of funded plans are generally held in separately administered trusts.
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to accounting for these plans see Pensions and other post-retirement benefits in Note 1.
The primary pension arrangement in the UK is a funded final salary pension plan under which retired employees draw the majority of their benefit as an annuity. This pension plan is governed by a corporate trustee whose board is composed of four member-nominated directors, four company-nominated directors, an independent director and an independent chairman nominated by the company. The trustee board is required by law to act in the best interests of the plan participants and is responsible for setting certain policies, such as investment policies of the plan. The UK plan is closed to new joiners but remains open to ongoing accrual for current members. New joiners in the UK are eligible for membership of a defined contribution plan.
In the US, all pension benefits now accrue under a cash balance formula. Benefits previously accrued under final salary formulas are legally protected. Retiring US employees typically take their pension benefit in the form of a lump sum payment upon retirement. The plan is funded and its assets are overseen by a fiduciary Investment Committee. During 2019 the committee was composed of six BP employees appointed by the president of BP Corporation North America Inc. (the appointing officer). A seventh BP employee was added to the committee on 1 January 2020. The Investment Committee is required by law to act in the best interests of the plan participants and is responsible for setting certain policies, such as the investment policies of the plan. US employees are also eligible to participate in a defined contribution (401k) plan in which employee contributions are matched with company contributions. In the US, group companies also provide post-retirement healthcare to retired employees and their dependants (and, in certain cases, life insurance coverage); the entitlement to these benefits is usually based on the employee remaining in service until a specified age and completion of a minimum period of service.
In the Eurozone, there are defined benefit pension plans in Germany, France, the Netherlands and other countries. In Germany and France, the majority of the pensions are unfunded, in line with market practice. In Germany, the group’s largest Eurozone plan, employees receive a pension and also have a choice to supplement their core pension through salary sacrifice. For employees who joined since 2002, the core pension benefit is a career average plan with retirement benefits based on such factors as an employee’s pensionable salary and length of service. The returns on the notional contributions made by both the company and employees are based on the interest rate which is set out in German tax law. Retired German employees take their pension benefit typically in the form of an annuity. The German plans are governed by legal agreements between BP and the works council or between BP and the trade union.
The level of contributions to funded defined benefit plans is the amount needed to provide adequate funds to meet pension obligations as they fall due. During 2019 the aggregate level of contributions was $349 million (2018 $610 million and 2017 $637 million). The aggregate level of contributions in 2020 is expected to be approximately $550 million, and includes contributions in all countries that we expect to be required to make contributions by law or under contractual agreements, as well as an allowance for discretionary funding.
For the primary UK plan there is a funding agreement between the group and the trustee. On an annual basis the latest funding position is reviewed and a schedule of contributions is agreed covering the next five years. Contractually committed funding amounted to $1,276 million at 31 December 2019, all of which relates to future service. This amount is included in the group’s committed cash flows relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefit plans as set out in the table of contractual obligations on page 302.
The surplus relating to the primary UK pension plan is recognized on the balance sheet on the basis that the company is entitled to a refund of any remaining assets once all members have left the plan.
Pension contributions in the US are determined by legislation and are supplemented by discretionary contributions. No contributions were made into the primary US pension plan in 2019 and no statutory funding requirement is expected in the next 12 months.
The surplus relating to the primary US fund is recognized on the balance sheet on the basis that economic benefit can be gained from the surplus through a reduction in future contributions.
There was no minimum funding requirement for the US plan, and no significant minimum funding requirements in other countries at 31 December 2019.

194
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
The obligation and cost of providing pensions and other post-retirement benefits is assessed annually using the projected unit credit method. The date of the most recent actuarial review was 31 December 2019. The UK plans are subject to a formal actuarial valuation every three years; valuations are required more frequently in many other countries. The most recent formal actuarial valuation of the UK pension plans was as at 31 December 2017. A valuation of the US plan and largest Eurozone plans are carried out annually.
The material financial assumptions used to estimate the benefit obligations of the various plans are set out below. The assumptions are reviewed by management at the end of each year, and are used to evaluate the accrued benefit obligation at 31 December and pension expense for the following year.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
%
Financial assumptions used to determine benefit obligation
 
 
 
UK
 
 
US
 
 
Eurozone
 
2019
2018
2017
2019
2018
2017
2019
2018
2017
Discount rate for plan liabilities
 
2.1
2.9
2.5
3.1
4.1
3.5
1.3
2.0
1.9
Rate of increase in salaries
 
3.4
3.8
4.1
3.9
3.9
4.1
3.1
3.1
3.0
Rate of increase for pensions in payment
 
2.7
3.0
2.9
1.5
1.5
1.4
Rate of increase in deferred pensions
 
2.7
3.0
2.9
0.5
0.5
0.6
Inflation for plan liabilities
 
2.7
3.1
3.1
1.5
1.5
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
%
Financial assumptions used to determine benefit expense
 
 
 
UK
 
 
US
 
 
Eurozone
 
2019
2018
2017
2019
2018
2017
2019
2018
2017
Discount rate for plan service cost
 
3.0
2.6
2.7
4.2
3.6
4.1
2.5
2.4
2.1
Discount rate for plan other finance expense
 
2.9
2.5
2.7
4.1
3.5
3.9
2.0
1.9
1.7
Inflation for plan service cost
 
3.1
3.1
3.2
1.5
1.7
1.8
1.7
1.6
1.6
The discount rate assumptions are based on third-party AA corporate bond indices and for our largest plans in the UK, US and the Eurozone we use yields that reflect the maturity profile of the expected benefit payments. The inflation rate assumptions for our UK and US plans are based on the difference between the yields on index-linked and fixed-interest long-term government bonds. In other countries, including the Eurozone, we use this approach, or advice from the local actuary depending on the information available. The inflation assumptions are used to determine the rate of increase for pensions in payment and the rate of increase in deferred pensions where there is such an increase.
The assumptions for the rate of increase in salaries are based on the inflation assumption plus an allowance for expected long-term real salary growth. These include an allowance for promotion-related salary growth, of up to 0.8% depending on country.
In addition to the financial assumptions, we regularly review the demographic and mortality assumptions. The mortality assumptions reflect best practice in the countries in which we provide pensions, and have been chosen with regard to applicable published tables adjusted where appropriate to reflect the experience of the group and an extrapolation of past longevity improvements into the future. BP’s most substantial pension liabilities are in the UK, the US and the Eurozone where our mortality assumptions are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Years

Mortality assumptions
 
 
 
UK

 
 
US

 
 
Eurozone

 
 
2019

2018

2017

2019

2018

2017

2019

2018

2017

Life expectancy at age 60 for a male currently aged 60
 
27.3

27.4

27.4

24.9

25.1

25.1

25.7

25.6

25.1

Life expectancy at age 60 for a male currently aged 40
 
28.9

28.9

29.0

26.7

26.9

26.8

28.3

28.1

27.6

Life expectancy at age 60 for a female currently aged 60
 
28.7

28.8

28.8

28.0

28.5

28.4

29.1

29.0

29.0

Life expectancy at age 60 for a female currently aged 40
 
30.5

30.6

30.5

29.7

30.1

30.0

31.2

31.2

31.4

Pension plan assets are generally held in trusts, the primary objective of which is to accumulate assets sufficient to meet the obligations of the plans. The assets of the trusts are invested in a manner consistent with fiduciary obligations and principles that reflect current practices in portfolio management.
A significant proportion of the assets are held in equities, which are expected to generate a higher level of return over the long term, with an acceptable level of risk. In order to provide reasonable assurance that no single security or type of security has an unwarranted impact on the total portfolio, the investment portfolios are highly diversified.
The trustee’s long-term investment objective for the primary UK plan as it matures is to invest in assets whose value changes in the same way as the plan liabilities, in order to reduce the level of funding risk. To move towards this objective, the UK plan uses a liability driven investment (LDI) approach for part of the portfolio, investing primarily in government bonds to achieve this matching effect for the most significant plan liability assumptions of interest rate and inflation rate. This is partly funded by short-term sale and repurchase agreements, whereby the plan borrows money using existing bonds as security and which will be bought back at a specified price at an agreed future date. The funds raised are used to invest in further bonds to increase the proportion of assets which match the plan liabilities. The borrowings are shown separately in the analysis of pension plan assets in the table below.
For the primary UK pension plan there is an agreement with the trustee to increase the proportion of assets with liability matching characteristics over time primarily by reducing the proportion of plan assets held as equities and increasing the proportion held as bonds. There is a similar agreement in place for the primary US plan. During 2019, the UK and the US plans switched 2% and nil of plan assets respectively from equities to bonds (2018 12.5% and 10% respectively).

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
195


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
The current asset allocation policy for the major plans at 31 December 2019 was as follows:
 
 
UK
US
Asset category
 
%
%
Total equity (including private equity)
 
28
40
Bonds/cash (including LDI)
 
65
60
Property/real estate
 
7
The amounts invested under the LDI programme by the primary UK pension plan as at 31 December 2019 were $4,804 million (2018 $4,197 million) of government-issued nominal bonds and $19,462 million (2018 $17,491 million) of index-linked bonds.
Some of the group’s pension plans in the Eurozone and other countries use derivative financial instruments as part of their asset mix to manage the level of risk. The fair value of these instruments are included in other assets in the table below. The UK and US plans do not use derivative financial instruments.
The group’s main pension plans do not invest directly in either securities or property/real estate of the company or of any subsidiary.
The fair values of the various categories of assets held by the defined benefit plans at 31 December are presented in the table below, including the effects of derivative financial instruments. Movements in the fair value of plan assets during the year are shown in detail in the table on page 197.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
UKa

USb

Eurozone

Other

Total

Fair value of pension plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
Listed equities – developed markets
 
6,285

1,290

495

371

8,441

   – emerging markets
 
1,096

124

61

64

1,345

Private equityc
 
2,675

1,474


3

4,152

Government issued nominal bondsd
 
4,884

2,100

959

572

8,515

Government issued index-linked bondsd
 
19,462


100


19,562

Corporate bondsd
 
6,132

2,304

569

256

9,261

Propertye
 
2,507


96

27

2,630

Cash
 
426

289

33

93

841

Other
 
98

74

30

26

228

Debt (repurchase agreements) used to fund liability driven investments
 
(7,436
)



(7,436
)
 
 
36,129

7,655

2,343

1,412

47,539

At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
Listed equities – developed markets
 
5,191

1,238

413

306

7,148

   – emerging markets
 
950

63

65

56

1,134

Private equityc
 
2,792

1,495


4

4,291

Government issued nominal bondsd
 
4,263

2,072

895

533

7,763

Government issued index-linked bondsd
 
17,491


102


17,593

Corporate bondsd
 
4,606

2,184

506

243

7,539

Propertye
 
2,311

6

57

25

2,399

Cash
 
376

73

42

83

574

Other
 
116

64

32

40

252

Debt (repurchase agreements) used to fund liability driven investments
 
(6,011
)



(6,011
)
 
 
32,085

7,195

2,112

1,290

42,682

At 31 December 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
Listed equities – developed markets
 
9,548

2,158

537

376

12,619

   – emerging markets
 
2,220

220

83

53

2,576

Private equityc
 
2,679

1,461



4,140

Government issued nominal bondsd
 
2,663

1,777

941

545

5,926

Government issued index-linked bondsd
 
16,177


2


16,179

Corporate bondsd
 
4,682

2,024

546

272

7,524

Propertye
 
2,211

6

71

30

2,318

Cash
 
390

80

21

98

589

Other
 
104

53

23

45

225

Debt (repurchase agreements) used to fund liability driven investments
 
(5,583
)



(5,583
)
 
 
35,091

7,779

2,224

1,419

46,513

a 
Bonds held by the UK pension plans are denominated in sterling. Property held by the UK pension plans is in the United Kingdom.
b 
Bonds held by the US pension plans are denominated in US dollars.
c Private equity is valued at fair value based on the most recent transaction price or third-party net asset, revenue or earnings based valuations that generally result in the use of significant unobservable inputs.
d Bonds held by pension plans are valued using quoted prices in active markets.
e Properties are valued based on an analysis of recent market transactions supported by market knowledge derived from third-party professional valuers that generally result in the use of significant unobservable inputs.

196
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

Analysis of the amount charged to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current service costa
 
227

263

81

38

609

Past service costb
 
2


5

(1
)
6

Settlementb
 

(13
)
8


(5
)
Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
229

250

94

37

610

Payments to defined contribution plans
 
42

188

7

38

275

Total operating charge
 
271

438

101

75

885

Interest income on plan assetsa
 
(909
)
(285
)
(43
)
(46
)
(1,283
)
Interest on plan liabilities
 
757

387

133

69

1,346

Other finance (income) expense
 
(152
)
102

90

23

63

Analysis of the amount recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual asset return less interest income on plan assets
 
2,945

1,079

220

97

4,341

Change in financial assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
(2,294
)
(1,036
)
(748
)
(92
)
(4,170
)
Change in demographic assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
136

91

3

(4
)
226

Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities
 
(57
)
(22
)
6

4

(69
)
Remeasurements recognized in other comprehensive income
 
730

112

(519
)
5

328

Movements in benefit obligation during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at 1 January
 
26,830

9,696

6,906

1,686

45,118

Exchange adjustments
 
942


(142
)
26

826

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
229

250

94

37

610

Interest cost
 
757

387

133

69

1,346

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
20


2

6

28

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,207
)
(830
)
(76
)
(75
)
(2,188
)
Benefit payments (unfunded plans)d
 
(6
)
(205
)
(273
)
(15
)
(499
)
Reclassified as assets held for sale
 

(146
)


(146
)
Disposals
 


(30
)

(30
)
Remeasurements
 
2,215

967

739

92

4,013

Benefit obligation at 31 Decembera e
 
29,780

10,119

7,353

1,826

49,078

Movements in fair value of plan assets during the year
 





Fair value of plan assets at 1 January
 
32,085

7,195

2,112

1,290

42,682

Exchange adjustments
 
1,141


(43
)
24

1,122

Interest income on plan assetsa f
 
909

285

43

46

1,283

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
20


2

6

28

Contributions by employers (funded plans)
 
236

4

85

24

349

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,207
)
(830
)
(76
)
(75
)
(2,188
)
Reclassified as assets held for sale
 

(78
)


(78
)
Remeasurementsf
 
2,945

1,079

220

97

4,341

Fair value of plan assets at 31 Decemberg
 
36,129

7,655

2,343

1,412

47,539

Surplus (deficit) at 31 December
 
6,349

(2,464
)
(5,010
)
(414
)
(1,539
)
Represented by
 





Asset recognized
 
6,588

387

27

51

7,053

Liability recognized
 
(239
)
(2,851
)
(5,037
)
(465
)
(8,592
)
 
 
6,349

(2,464
)
(5,010
)
(414
)
(1,539
)
The surplus (deficit) may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 





Funded
 
6,588

387

(136
)
(87
)
6,752

Unfunded
 
(239
)
(2,851
)
(4,874
)
(327
)
(8,291
)
 
 
6,349

(2,464
)
(5,010
)
(414
)
(1,539
)
The defined benefit obligation may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 





Funded
 
(29,541
)
(7,268
)
(2,479
)
(1,499
)
(40,787
)
Unfunded
 
(239
)
(2,851
)
(4,874
)
(327
)
(8,291
)
 
 
(29,780
)
(10,119
)
(7,353
)
(1,826
)
(49,078
)
a 
The costs of managing plan investments are offset against the investment return, the costs of administering pension plan benefits are generally included in current service cost and the costs of administering other post-retirement benefit plans are included in the benefit obligation.
b 
Past service costs and settlements in the Eurozone have arisen from restructuring programmes and represent charges for special termination benefits reflecting the increased liability arising as a result of early retirements. Settlements in the US are the result of a buy-out transaction for the pensions of a group of low value annuitants.
c 
Most of the contributions made by plan participants into UK pension plans were made under salary sacrifice.
d 
The benefit payments amount shown above comprises $2,304 million benefits and $346 million settlements, plus $37 million of plan expenses incurred in the administration of the benefit.
e 
The benefit obligation for the US is made up of $7,789 million for pension liabilities and $2,330 million for other post-retirement benefit liabilities (which are unfunded and are primarily retiree medical liabilities). The benefit obligation for the Eurozone includes $4,567 million for pension liabilities in Germany which is largely unfunded.
f 
The actual return on plan assets is made up of the sum of the interest income on plan assets and the remeasurement of plan assets as disclosed above.
g 
The fair value of plan assets includes borrowings related to the LDI programme as described on page 196.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
197


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

Analysis of the amount charged to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current service costa
 
295

299

84

43

721

Past service costb
 
15


9

4

28

Settlementb
 


17


17

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
310

299

110

47

766

Payments to defined contribution plans
 
38

178

5

40

261

Total operating charge
 
348

477

115

87

1,027

Interest income on plan assetsa
 
(868
)
(262
)
(44
)
(45
)
(1,219
)
Interest on plan liabilities
 
774

369

136

67

1,346

Other finance (income) expense
 
(94
)
107

92

22

127

Analysis of the amount recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual asset return less interest income on plan assets
 
(722
)
(256
)
(69
)
(36
)
(1,083
)
Change in financial assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
1,770

945

14

65

2,794

Change in demographic assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
123

(9
)
(42
)
7

79

Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities
 
520

41

(43
)
9

527

Remeasurements recognized in other comprehensive income
 
1,691

721

(140
)
45

2,317

Movements in benefit obligation during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at 1 January
 
31,513

10,820

7,275

1,873

51,481

Exchange adjustments
 
(1,589
)

(303
)
(113
)
(2,005
)
Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
310

299

110

47

766

Interest cost
 
774

369

136

67

1,346

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
21


2

7

30

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,780
)
(597
)
(84
)
(83
)
(2,544
)
Benefit payments (unfunded plans)d
 
(6
)
(218
)
(301
)
(17
)
(542
)
Disposals
 



(14
)
(14
)
Remeasurements
 
(2,413
)
(977
)
71

(81
)
(3,400
)
Benefit obligation at 31 Decembera e
 
26,830

9,696

6,906

1,686

45,118

Movements in fair value of plan assets during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at 1 January
 
35,091

7,779

2,224

1,419

46,513

Exchange adjustments
 
(1,883
)

(93
)
(73
)
(2,049
)
Interest income on plan assetsa f
 
868

262

44

45

1,219

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
21


2

7

30

Contributions by employers (funded plans)
 
490

7

88

25

610

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,780
)
(597
)
(84
)
(83
)
(2,544
)
Disposals
 



(14
)
(14
)
Remeasurementsf
 
(722
)
(256
)
(69
)
(36
)
(1,083
)
Fair value of plan assets at 31 Decemberg
 
32,085

7,195

2,112

1,290

42,682

Surplus (deficit) at 31 December
 
5,255

(2,501
)
(4,794
)
(396
)
(2,436
)
Represented by
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset recognized
 
5,473

418

29

35

5,955

Liability recognized
 
(218
)
(2,919
)
(4,823
)
(431
)
(8,391
)
 
 
5,255

(2,501
)
(4,794
)
(396
)
(2,436
)
The surplus (deficit) may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 
 
 
 
 
 
Funded
 
5,473

396

(152
)
(97
)
5,620

Unfunded
 
(218
)
(2,897
)
(4,642
)
(299
)
(8,056
)
 
 
5,255

(2,501
)
(4,794
)
(396
)
(2,436
)
The defined benefit obligation may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 
 
 
 
 
 
Funded
 
(26,612
)
(6,799
)
(2,264
)
(1,387
)
(37,062
)
Unfunded
 
(218
)
(2,897
)
(4,642
)
(299
)
(8,056
)
 
 
(26,830
)
(9,696
)
(6,906
)
(1,686
)
(45,118
)
a 
The costs of managing plan investments are offset against the investment return, the costs of administering pension plan benefits are generally included in current service cost and the costs of administering other post-retirement benefit plans are included in the benefit obligation.
b 
Past service costs and settlements have arisen from restructuring programmes and represent charges for special termination benefits representing the increased liability arising as a result of early retirements mostly in the UK and Eurozone.
c 
Most of the contributions made by plan participants into UK pension plans were made under salary sacrifice.
d 
The benefit payments amount shown above comprises $3,046 million benefits and $2 million settlements, plus $38 million of plan expenses incurred in the administration of the benefit.
e 
The benefit obligation for the US is made up of $7,290 million for pension liabilities and $2,406 million for other post-retirement benefit liabilities (which are unfunded and are primarily retiree medical liabilities). The benefit obligation for the Eurozone includes $4,328 million for pension liabilities in Germany which is largely unfunded.
f 
The actual return on plan assets is made up of the sum of the interest income on plan assets and the remeasurement of plan assets as disclosed above.
g 
The fair value of plan assets includes borrowings related to the LDI programme as described on page 196.

198
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

Analysis of the amount charged to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current service costa
 
357

292

85

46

780

Past service costb
 
12


5

(1
)
16

Settlement
 


13


13

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
369

292

103

45

809

Payments to defined contribution plans
 
31

191

7

38

267

Total operating charge
 
400

483

110

83

1,076

Interest income on plan assetsa
 
(845
)
(266
)
(37
)
(48
)
(1,196
)
Interest on plan liabilities
 
831

393

121

71

1,416

Other finance (income) expense
 
(14
)
127

84

23

220

Analysis of the amount recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual asset return less interest income on plan assets
 
2,396

826

30

43

3,295

Change in financial assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
(236
)
(514
)
336

(47
)
(461
)
Change in demographic assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
734

72


(23
)
783

Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities
 
91

(40
)
(36
)
14

29

Remeasurements recognized in other comprehensive income
 
2,985

344

330

(13
)
3,646

a The costs of managing plan investments are offset against the investment return, the costs of administering pension plan benefits are generally included in current service cost and the costs of administering other post-retirement benefit plans are included in the benefit obligation.
b Past service costs have arisen from restructuring programmes and represent a combination of credits as a result of the curtailment in the pension arrangements of a number of employees mostly in the US and charges for special termination benefits representing the increased liability arising as a result of early retirements mostly in the UK and Eurozone.

Sensitivity analysis
The discount rate, inflation, salary growth and the mortality assumptions all have a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one-percentage point change, in isolation, in certain assumptions as at 31 December 2019 for the group’s pensions and other post-retirement benefit expense would have had the effects shown in the tables below. The effects shown for the expense in 2020 comprise the total of current service cost and net finance income or expense.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
One percentage point
 
 
 
UK
US
Eurozone
 
 
Increase

Decrease

Increase

Decrease

Increase

Decrease

Discount ratea
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Effect on expense in 2020
 
(274
)
227

(66
)
58

(1
)
(11
)
Effect on obligation at 31 December 2019
 
(4,729
)
6,364

(1,191
)
1,478

(1,060
)
1,347

Inflation rateb
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Effect on expense in 2020
 
171

(134
)
11

(9
)
35

(27
)
Effect on obligation at 31 December 2019
 
4,711

(3,890
)
67

(54
)
978

(824
)
Salary growth
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Effect on expense in 2020
 
42

(36
)
13

(11
)
7

(7
)
Effect on obligation at 31 December 2019
 
604

(525
)
80

(67
)
93

(89
)
a 
The amounts presented reflect that the discount rate is used to determine the asset interest income as well as the interest cost on the obligation.
b 
The amounts presented reflect the total impact of an inflation rate change on the assumptions for rate of increase in salaries, pensions in payment and deferred pensions.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
One year increase
 
 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Longevity
 
 
 
 
Effect on expense in 2020
 
31

6

9

Effect on obligation at 31 December 2019
 
1,140

147

306

Estimated future benefit payments and the weighted average duration of defined benefit obligations
The expected benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, but exclude plan expenses, up until 2029 and the weighted average duration of the defined benefit obligations at 31 December 2019 are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Estimated future benefit payments
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

2020
 
1,065

743

333

104

2,245

2021
 
1,078

789

323

98

2,288

2022
 
1,098

711

319

101

2,229

2023
 
1,138

718

314

98

2,268

2024
 
1,151

699

300

99

2,249

2025-2029
 
5,895

3,277

1,438

489

11,099

 
 
 
 
 
 
Years

Weighted average duration
 
18.3

13.2

16.4

13.0

 

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
199


25. Cash and cash equivalents
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

Cash
 
6,462

6,148

Term bank deposits
 
10,296

13,105

Cash equivalents (excluding term bank deposits)
 
5,714

3,215

 
 
22,472

22,468

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash in hand; current balances with banks and similar institutions; term deposits of three months or less with banks and similar institutions; money market funds and commercial paper. The carrying amounts of cash and term bank deposits approximate their fair values. Substantially all of the other cash equivalents are categorized within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy.
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December 2019 includes $1,676 million (2018 $1,350 million) that is restricted. The restricted cash balances include amounts required to cover initial margin on trading exchanges and certain cash balances which are subject to exchange controls.
The group holds $4,678 million (2018 $4,693 million) of cash and cash equivalents outside the UK and it is not expected that any significant tax will arise on repatriation.

26. Finance debt
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
2018

 
 
Current

Non-current

Total

Current

Non-current

Total

Borrowings
 
10,487

57,237

67,724

9,329

55,803

65,132

As a result of the adoption of IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, leases that were previously classified as finance leases under IAS 17 are now presented as ‘Lease liabilities’ on the group balance sheet and therefore do not form part of finance debt. Comparative information for finance debt has been amended to be on a consistent basis with amounts presented for 2019. See Note 1 and Note 27 for further information.
The main elements of current borrowings are the current portion of long-term borrowings that is due to be repaid in the next 12 months of $8,166 million (2018 $7,175 million) and issued commercial paper of $2,279 million (2018 $2,040 million). Finance debt does not include accrued interest, which is reported within other payables.
The following table shows the weighted-average interest rates achieved through a combination of borrowings and derivative financial instruments entered into to manage interest rate and currency exposures.
 
 
 
Fixed rate debt
 
Floating rate debt
 
Total

 
 
Weighted
average
interest
rate
%
Weighted
average
time for
which rate
is fixed
Years
Amount
$ million

Weighted
average
interest
rate
%
Amount
$ million

Amount
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

US dollar
 
4
5
25,634

3
41,871

67,505

Other currencies
 
6
10
183

7
36

219

 
 
 
 
25,817

 
41,907

67,724

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

US dollar
 
4
4
17,264

4
47,461

64,725

Other currencies
 
5
5
323

8
84

407

 
 
 
 
17,587

 
47,545

65,132

Comparative information in the table above has been amended to exclude previously classified finance lease liabilities of $667 million from US dollar and other currencies, primarily from fixed-rate debt. The calculation of the comparative weighted-average interest rate and time for which rate is fixed is unchanged for US dollar fixed-rate debt and was previously 7% and 18 years respectively for other currencies fixed-rate debt.
Fair values
The estimated fair value of finance debt is shown in the table below together with the carrying amount as reflected in the balance sheet.
Long-term borrowings in the table below include the portion of debt that matures in the 12 months from 31 December 2019, whereas in the group balance sheet the amount is reported within current finance debt.
The carrying amount of the group’s short-term borrowings, comprising mainly of commercial paper, approximates their fair value. The fair values of the significant majority of the group’s long-term borrowings are determined using quoted prices in active markets, and so fall within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Where quoted prices are not available, quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets are used and such measurements are therefore categorized in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
 
Fair value

Carrying
amount

Fair value

Carrying
amount

Short-term borrowings
 
2,321

2,321

2,153

2,153

Long-term borrowings
 
67,055

65,403

63,213

62,979

Total finance debt
 
69,376

67,724

65,366

65,132



200
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


27. Capital disclosures and net debt
The group defines capital as total equity. We maintain our financial framework to support the pursuit of value growth for shareholders, while ensuring a secure financial base.
The group monitors capital on basis of gearing (previously termed 'net debt ratio'), that is, the ratio of net debt to net debt plus equity. Net debt is calculated as finance debt, as shown in the balance sheet, plus the fair value of associated derivative financial instruments that are used to hedge foreign exchange and interest rate risks relating to finance debt for which hedge accounting is applied, less cash and cash equivalents. Net debt and gearing are non-GAAP measures. BP believes these measures provide useful information to investors. Net debt enables investors to see the economic effect of finance debt, related hedges and cash and cash equivalents in total. Gearing enables investors to see how significant net debt is relative to equity from shareholders. The derivatives are reported on the balance sheet within the headings ‘Derivative financial instruments’. All components of equity are included in the denominator of the calculation.
We aim to manage the gearing within a 20-30% band and maintain a significant liquidity buffer. At 31 December 2019, gearing was 31.1% (2018 30.0%).
As a result of the adoption of IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ from 1 January 2019, leases that were previously classified as finance leases under IAS 17 are now presented as ‘Lease liabilities’ on the group balance sheet and therefore do not form part of finance debt. Comparative information for finance debt (previously also termed ‘gross debt’), net debt and gearing have been amended to be on a consistent basis with amounts presented for 2019. The relevant amount for finance lease liabilities that has been excluded from comparative information for 2018 is $667 million. The previously disclosed amounts for finance debt and net debt for 2018 were $65,799 million and $44,144 million respectively. The previously disclosed gearing for 2018 was 30.3%.
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December
 
2019

2018

Finance debt
 
67,724

65,132

Less: fair value asset (liability) of hedges related to finance debta
 
(190
)
(813
)
 
 
67,914

65,945

Less: cash and cash equivalents
 
22,472

22,468

Net debt
 
45,442

43,477

Equity
 
100,708

101,548

Gearing
 
31.1
%
30.0
%
a 
Derivative financial instruments entered into for the purpose of managing interest rate and foreign currency exchange risk associated with net debt with a fair value liability position of $601 million (2018 liability of $827 million) are not included in the calculation of net debt shown above as hedge accounting was not applied for these instruments. The movement in the year is attributable to a net cash out flow of $286 million (2018 net cash flow $nil) and fair value loss of $60 million (2018 fair value losses of $193 million).

Net debt including leases is shown in the table below.
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December
 
2019

2018

Net debt
 
45,442

43,477

Lease liabilities
 
9,722

667

Net partner (receivable) payable for leases entered into on behalf of joint operations
 
(158
)

Net debt including leases
 
55,006

44,144

An analysis of changes in liabilities arising from financing activities is provided below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Finance
debt

Hedge-
accounted
derivatives

Lease liabilities

Net partner payable for leases entered into on behalf of joint operations

Total liabilities arising from financing activities

At 1 January 2019
 
65,132

813

667


66,612

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 16a
 


9,233

217

9,450

Exchange adjustments
 
(62
)

(4
)
8

(58
)
Net financing cash flow
 
1,671

2

(2,372
)
(14
)
(713
)
Fair value (gains) losses
 
924

(1,104
)


(180
)
New and remeasured leases/joint operation payables
 


2,614

82

2,696

Other movements
 
59

479

(416
)
(3
)
119

At 31 December 2019
 
67,724

190

9,722

290

77,926

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2018
 
62,574

175

656


63,405

Exchange adjustments
 
(237
)

(22
)

(259
)
Net financing cash flow
 
3,540

(360
)
(35
)

3,145

Fair value (gains) losses
 
(856
)
998



142

New leases
 


74


74

Other movements
 
111


(6
)

105

At 31 December 2018
 
65,132

813

667


66,612

a See Note 1 for information on adoption of IFRS 16 'Leases'.



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
201


28. Leases
The group leases a number of assets as part of its activities. This primarily includes drilling rigs in the Upstream segment and retail service stations, oil depots and storage tanks in the Downstream segment as well as office accommodation and vessel charters across the group. The weighted-average remaining lease term for the total lease portfolio is around 9 years. Some leases will have payments that vary with market interest or inflation rates. Certain leases contain residual value guarantees, which may be triggered in certain circumstances such as if market values have significantly declined at the conclusion of the lease.
The table below shows the timing of the undiscounted cash outflows for the lease liabilities included on the balance sheet.
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018a

Undiscounted lease liability cash flows due:
 
 
 
Within 1 year
 
2,514

98

1 to 2 years
 
1,839

97

2 to 3 years
 
1,364

95

3 to 4 years
 
1,105

94

4 to 5 years
 
876

86

5 to 10 years
 
2,427

309

Over 10 years
 
1,174

571

 
 
11,299

1,350

Impact of discounting
 
(1,577
)
(683
)
Lease liabilities at 31 December
 
9,722

667

Of which – current
 
2,067

44

– non-current
 
7,655

623

a Comparative information represents finance leases accounted for under IAS 17
The group may enter into lease arrangements a number of years before taking control of the underlying asset due to construction lead times or to secure future operational requirements. The total undiscounted amount for future commitments for leases not yet commenced as at 31 December 2019 is $5,688 million. The majority of this future commitment relates to the floating LNG vessel to service the Greater Tortue Ahmeyim project from 2022.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

Total cash outflow for amounts included in lease liabilitiesa
 
2,709

Expense for variable payments not included in the lease liability
 
67

Short-term lease expense
 
331

Additions to right-of-use assets in the period
 
2,542

a The cash outflows for amounts not included in lease liabilities approximate the income statement expense disclosed above
An analysis of right-of-use assets and depreciation is provided in Note 12. An analysis of lease interest expense is provided in Note 7.

29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors
The accounting classification of each category of financial instruments and their carrying amounts are set out below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December 2019
 
Note

 
Measured at amortized cost

Mandatorily measured at fair value through profit or loss

Derivative hedging instruments

Total carrying
amount

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
 
18

 

1,445


1,445

Loans
 
 
 
906

63


969

Trade and other receivables
 
20

 
24,271



24,271

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 

9,984

483

10,467

Cash and cash equivalents
 
25

 
18,183

4,289


22,472

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
22

 
(55,891
)


(55,891
)
Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 

(8,122
)
(676
)
(8,798
)
Accruals
 
 
 
(6,062
)


(6,062
)
Lease liabilities
 
28

 
(9,722
)


(9,722
)
Finance debta
 
26

 
(67,724
)


(67,724
)
 
 
 
 
(96,039
)
7,659

(193
)
(88,573
)

202
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December 2018
 
Note

 
Measured at amortized cost

Mandatorily measured at fair value through profit or loss

Derivative hedging instruments

Total carrying
amount

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
 
18

 

1,563


1,563

Loans
 
 
 
839

124


963

Trade and other receivables
 
20

 
24,080



24,080

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 

8,564

427

8,991

Cash and cash equivalents
 
25

 
20,366

2,102


22,468

Financial liabilities
 
 
 




Trade and other payables
 
22

 
(56,790
)


(56,790
)
Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 

(7,685
)
(1,248
)
(8,933
)
Accruals
 
 
 
(5,201
)


(5,201
)
Lease liabilities
 
28

 
(667
)


(667
)
Finance debta
 
26

 
(65,132
)


(65,132
)
 
 
 
 
(82,505
)
4,668

(821
)
(78,658
)
a As a result of the adoption of IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, leases that were previously classified as finance leases under IAS 17 are now presented as ‘Lease liabilities’ on the group balance sheet and therefore do not form part of finance debt. Comparative information for finance debt and lease liabilities have been amended to be on a consistent basis with amounts presented for 2019. The previously disclosed amounts for finance debt for 2018 was $65,799 million.
The fair value of finance debt is shown in Note 26. For all other financial instruments within the scope of IFRS 9, the carrying amount is either the fair value, or approximates the fair value.
Information on gains and losses on derivative financial assets and financial liabilities classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss is provided in the derivative gains and losses section of Note 30. Fair value gains and losses related to other assets and liabilities classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss totalled a net loss of $129 million. Dividend income of $20 million (2018 $8 million) from investments in equity instruments classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss is presented within other income - see Note 7.
Interest income and expenses arising on financial instruments are disclosed in Note 7.
Financial risk factors
The group is exposed to a number of different financial risks arising from natural business exposures as well as its use of financial instruments including market risks relating to commodity prices; foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates; credit risk; and liquidity risk.
The group financial risk committee (GFRC) advises the group chief financial officer (CFO) who oversees the management of these risks. The GFRC is chaired by the CFO and consists of a group of senior managers including the group treasurer and the heads of the group finance, tax and the integrated supply and trading functions. The purpose of the committee is to advise on financial risks and the appropriate financial risk governance framework for the group. The committee provides assurance to the CFO and the group chief executive (GCE), and via the GCE to the board, that the group’s financial risk-taking activity is governed by appropriate policies and procedures and that financial risks are identified, measured and managed in accordance with group policies and group risk appetite.
The group’s trading activities in the oil, natural gas, LNG and power markets are managed within the integrated supply and trading function. Treasury holds foreign exchange and interest-rate products in the financial markets to hedge group exposures related to debt issuance; the compliance, control, and risk management processes for these activities are managed within the treasury function. All other foreign exchange and interest rate activities within financial markets are performed within the integrated supply and trading function and are also underpinned by the compliance, control and risk management infrastructure common to the activities of BP’s integrated supply and trading function. All derivative activity is carried out by specialist teams that have the appropriate skills, experience and supervision. These teams are subject to close financial and management control.
The integrated supply and trading function maintains formal governance processes that provide oversight of market risk, credit risk and operational risk associated with trading activity. A policy and risk committee approves value-at-risk delegations, reviews incidents and validates risk-related policies, methodologies and procedures. A commitments committee approves the trading of new products, instruments and strategies and material commitments.
In addition, the integrated supply and trading function undertakes derivative activity for risk management purposes under a control framework as described more fully below.
(a) Market risk
Market risk is the risk or uncertainty arising from possible market price movements and their impact on the future performance of a business. The primary commodity price risks that the group is exposed to include oil, natural gas and power prices that could adversely affect the value of the group’s financial assets, liabilities or expected future cash flows. The group enters into derivatives in a well-established entrepreneurial trading operation. In addition, the group has developed a control framework aimed at managing the volatility inherent in certain of its natural business exposures. In accordance with the control framework the group enters into various transactions using derivatives for risk management purposes.
The major components of market risk are commodity price risk, foreign currency exchange risk and interest rate risk, each of which is discussed below.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
203


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
(i) Commodity price risk
The group’s integrated, supply and trading function is responsible for delivering value across the overall crude, oil products, gas and power supply chains. As such, it routinely enters into spot and term physical commodity contracts in addition to optimising physical storage, pipeline and transportation capacity. These activities expose the group to commodity price risk which is managed by entering into oil and natural gas swaps, options and futures.
The group measures market risk exposure arising from its trading positions in liquid periods using value-at-risk techniques based on Variance/Covariance or Monte Carlo simulation models. These techniques make a statistical assessment of the market risk arising from possible future changes in market prices over a one-day holding period within a 95% confidence level. The value-at-risk measure is supplemented by stress testing and scenario analysis through simulating the financial impact of certain physical, economic and geo-political scenarios. Trading activity occurring in liquid periods is subject to value-at-risk and other limits for each trading activity and the aggregate of all trading activity. The board has delegated a limit of $100 million (2018 $100 million) value at risk in support of this trading activity. Alternative measures are used to monitor exposures which are outside liquid periods and for which value-at-risk techniques are not appropriate.
(ii) Foreign currency exchange risk
Since BP has global operations, fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates can have a significant effect on the group’s reported results and future expenditure commitments. The effects of most exchange rate fluctuations are absorbed in business operating results through changing cost competitiveness, lags in market adjustment to movements in rates and translation differences accounted for on specific transactions. For this reason, the total effect of exchange rate fluctuations is not identifiable separately in the group’s reported results. The main underlying economic currency of the group’s cash flows is the US dollar. This is because BP’s major product, oil, is priced internationally in US dollars. BP’s foreign currency exchange management policy is to limit economic and material transactional exposures arising from currency movements against the US dollar. The group co-ordinates the handling of foreign currency exchange risks centrally, by netting off naturally-occurring opposite exposures wherever possible and then managing any material residual foreign currency exchange risks.
Most of the group’s borrowings are in US dollars or are hedged with respect to the US dollar. At 31 December 2019, the total foreign currency borrowings not swapped into US dollars amounted to $219 million (2018 $407 million excludes leases).
The group manages the net residual foreign currency exposures by constantly reviewing the foreign currency economic value at risk and aims to manage such risk to keep the 12-month foreign currency value at risk below $400 million. At no point over the past three years did the value at risk exceed the maximum risk limit. A continuous assessment is made in respect to the group’s foreign currency exposures to capture hedging requirements.
During the year, hedge accounting was applied to foreign currency exposure to highly probable forecast capital expenditure commitments. The group fixes the US dollar cost of non-US dollar supplies by using currency forwards for the highly probable forecast capital expenditure; the exposures are in sterling, euro, Australian dollar and Korean won. At 31 December 2019 the most significant open contracts in place were for $106 million sterling (2018 $434 million sterling).
Where the group enters into foreign currency exchange contracts for entrepreneurial trading purposes the activity is controlled using trading value-at-risk techniques as explained in (i) commodity price risk above.    
(iii) Interest rate risk
BP is also exposed to interest rate risk from the possibility that changes in interest rates will affect future cash flows or the fair values of its financial instruments, principally finance debt. While the group issues debt in a variety of currencies based on market opportunities, it uses derivatives to swap the debt to a floating rate exposure, mainly to US dollar floating, but in certain defined circumstances maintains a US dollar fixed rate exposure for a proportion of debt. The proportion of floating rate debt net of interest rate swaps at 31 December 2019 was 62% of total finance debt outstanding (2018 73% excludes leases). The weighted average interest rate on finance debt at 31 December 2019 was 3% (2018 4%) and the weighted average maturity of fixed rate debt was five years (2018 four years excludes leases).
The group’s earnings are sensitive to changes in interest rates on the floating rate element of the group’s finance debt. If the interest rates applicable to floating rate instruments were to have changed by one percentage point on 1 January 2020, it is estimated that the group’s finance costs for 2020 would change by approximately $419 million (2018 $475 million).
(b) Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk that a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument will fail to perform or fail to pay amounts due causing financial loss to the group and arises from cash and cash equivalents, derivative financial instruments and deposits with financial institutions and principally from credit exposures to customers relating to outstanding receivables. Credit exposure also exists in relation to guarantees issued by group companies under which the outstanding exposure incremental to that recognized on the balance sheet at 31 December 2019 was $692 million (2018 $696 million) in respect of liabilities of joint ventures and associates and $523 million (2018 $432 million) in respect of liabilities of other third parties.
The group has a credit policy, approved by the CFO that is designed to ensure that consistent processes are in place throughout the group to measure and control credit risk. Credit risk is considered as part of the risk-reward balance of doing business. On entering into any business contract the extent to which the arrangement exposes the group to credit risk is considered. Key requirements of the policy include segregation of credit approval authorities from any sales, marketing or trading teams authorized to incur credit risk; the establishment of credit systems and processes to ensure that all counterparty exposure is rated and that all counterparty exposure and limits can be monitored and reported; and the timely identification and reporting of any non-approved credit exposures and credit losses. While each segment is responsible for its own credit risk management and reporting consistent with group policy, the treasury function holds group-wide credit risk authority and oversight responsibility for exposure to banks and financial institutions.

204
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
For the purposes of financial reporting the group calculates expected loss allowances based on the maximum contractual period over which the group is exposed to credit risk. Lifetime expected credit losses are recognized for trade receivables and the credit risk associated with the significant majority of financial assets measured at amortized cost is considered to be low. Since the tenor of substantially all of the group's in-scope financial assets is less than 12 months there is no significant difference between the measurement of 12-month and lifetime expected credit losses. Expected loss allowances for financial guarantee contracts are typically lower than their fair value less, where appropriate, amortization. Financial assets are considered to be credit-impaired when there is reasonable and supportable evidence that one or more events that have a detrimental impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset have occurred. This includes observable data concerning significant financial difficulty of the counterparty; a breach of contract; concession being granted to the counterparty for economic or contractual reasons relating to the counterparty’s financial difficulty, that would not otherwise be considered; it becoming probable that the counterparty will enter bankruptcy or other financial re-organization or an active market for the financial asset disappearing because of financial difficulties. The group also applies a rebuttable presumption that an asset is credit-impaired when contractual payments are more than 30 days past due. Where the group has no reasonable expectation of recovering a financial asset in its entirety or a portion thereof, for example where all legal avenues for collection of amounts due have been exhausted, the financial asset (or relevant portion) is written off.
The measurement of expected credit losses is a function of the probability of default, loss given default (i.e. the magnitude of the loss after recovery if there is a default) and the exposure at default (i.e. the asset's carrying amount). The group allocates a credit risk rating to exposures based on data that is determined to be predictive of the risk of loss, including but not limited to external ratings. Probabilities of default derived from historical, current and future-looking market data are assigned by credit risk rating with a loss given default based on historical experience and relevant market and academic research applied by exposure type. Experienced credit judgement is applied to ensure probabilities of default are reflective of the credit risk associated with the group's exposures. Credit enhancements that would reduce the group's credit losses in the event of default are reflected in the calculation when they are considered integral to the related asset.
The maximum credit exposure associated with financial assets is equal to the carrying amount. The group does not aim to remove credit risk entirely but expects to experience a certain level of credit losses. As at 31 December 2019, the group had in place credit enhancements designed to mitigate approximately $7.0 billion (2018 $7.3 billion) of credit risk, of which substantially all relates to assets in the scope of IFRS 9's impairment requirements. Credit enhancements include standby and documentary letters of credit, bank guarantees, insurance and liens which are typically taken out with financial institutions who have investment grade credit ratings, or are liens over assets held by the counterparty of the related receivables. Reports are regularly prepared and presented to the GFRC that cover the group’s overall credit exposure and expected loss trends, exposure by segment, and overall quality of the portfolio.
Management information used to monitor credit risk, which reflects the impact of credit enhancements, indicates that the risk profile of financial assets which are subject to review for impairment under IFRS 9 is as set out below.
 
 
 
%

As at 31 December
 
2019

2018

AAA to AA-
 
16
%
22
%
A+ to A-
 
51
%
41
%
BBB+ to BBB-
 
13
%
16
%
BB+ to BB-
 
7
%
8
%
B+ to B-
 
11
%
11
%
CCC+ and below
 
2
%
2
%
Movements in the impairment provision for trade and other receivables are shown in Note 21.
Financial instruments subject to offsetting, enforceable master netting arrangements and similar agreements
The following table shows the amounts recognized for financial assets and liabilities which are subject to offsetting arrangements on a gross basis, and the amounts offset in the balance sheet.
Amounts which cannot be offset under IFRS, but which could be settled net under the terms of master netting agreements if certain conditions arise, and collateral received or pledged, are also presented in the table to show the total net exposure of the group.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Gross amounts of recognized financial assets (liabilities)

Amounts
set off

Net amounts
presented on
the balance
sheet

Related amounts not set off
in the balance sheet
 
Net amount

At 31 December 2019
 
Master
netting
arrangements

Cash
collateral
(received)
pledged

Derivative assets
 
13,191

(2,724
)
10,467

(1,971
)
(206
)
8,290

Derivative liabilities
 
(11,445
)
2,724

(8,721
)
1,971


(6,750
)
Trade and other receivables
 
10,661

(5,211
)
5,450

(961
)
(190
)
4,299

Trade and other payables
 
(10,266
)
5,211

(5,055
)
961


(4,094
)
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative assets
 
11,502

(2,511
)
8,991

(2,079
)
(299
)
6,613

Derivative liabilities
 
(11,337
)
2,511

(8,826
)
2,079


(6,747
)
Trade and other receivables
 
11,296

(5,390
)
5,906

(1,020
)
(169
)
4,717

Trade and other payables
 
(10,797
)
5,390

(5,407
)
1,020


(4,387
)

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
205


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
(c) Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that suitable sources of funding for the group’s business activities may not be available. The group’s liquidity is managed centrally with operating units forecasting their cash and currency requirements to the central treasury function. Unless restricted by local regulations, generally subsidiaries pool their cash surpluses to the treasury function, which will then arrange to fund other subsidiaries’ requirements, or invest any net surplus in the market or arrange for necessary external borrowings, while managing the group’s overall net currency positions.
The group benefits from open credit provided by suppliers who generally sell on five to 60-day payment terms in accordance with industry norms. BP utilizes various arrangements in order to manage its working capital and reduce volatility in cash flow. This includes discounting of receivables and, in the supply and trading business, managing inventory, collateral and supplier payment terms within a maximum of 60 days.
It is normal practice in the oil and gas supply and trading business for customers and suppliers to utilise letter of credit (LC) facilities to mitigate credit and non-performance risk. Consequently, LCs facilitate active trading in a global market where credit and performance risk can be significant. In common with the industry, BP routinely provides LCs to some of its suppliers.
The group has committed LC facilities totalling $12,175 million (2018 $12,175 million), allowing LCs to be issued for a maximum 24-month duration. There were also uncommitted secured LC facilities in place at 31 December 2019 for $4,440 million (2018 $4,190 million), which are secured against inventories or receivables when utilized. The facilities are held with over 20 international banks. The uncommitted secured LC facilities can only be terminated by either party giving a stipulated termination notice to the other.
In certain circumstances, the supplier has the option to request accelerated payment from the LC provider in order to further reduce their exposure. BP’s payments are made to the provider of the LC rather than the supplier according to the original contractual payment terms. At 31 December 2019, $4,755 million (2018 $3,705 million) of the group’s trade payables subject to these arrangements were payable to LC providers, with no material exposure to any individual provider.
Standard & Poor’s Ratings long-term credit rating for BP is A- (positive outlook) and Moody’s Investors Service rating is A1 (stable outlook).
During 2019, $8 billion (2018 $9 billion) of long-term taxable bonds were issued with terms ranging from one to thirty years. Commercial paper is issued at competitive rates to meet short-term borrowing requirements as and when needed.
As a further liquidity measure, the group continues to maintain suitable levels of cash and cash equivalents, amounting to $22.5 billion at 31 December 2019 (2018 $22.5 billion), primarily invested with highly rated banks or money market funds and readily accessible at immediate and short notice. At 31 December 2019, the group had substantial amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities available, consisting of $7,625 million (2018 $7,625 million) of standby facilities, all of which is available to draw and repay up to the first half of 2022. These facilities are with 25 international banks, and borrowings under them would be at pre-agreed rates. On 13th March the group entered into a committed $10,000 million credit facility which is available for two years at pre-agreed margins.
The table below shows the timing of cash outflows relating to finance debt, trade and other payables and accruals.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
 
2018

 
 
Trade and
other
payablesa

Accruals

Finance
debt

Interest on finance debt

Trade and
other
payablesa

Accruals

Finance
debtb

Interest on finance debtb

Within one year
 
43,699

5,066

10,065

2,037

43,230

4,626

9,257

2,350

1 to 2 years
 
1,937

261

6,726

1,641

2,232

146

6,743

1,904

2 to 3 years
 
1,465

146

7,949

1,409

1,662

95

6,758

1,653

3 to 4 years
 
1,409

181

7,022

1,172

1,484

64

8,005

1,379

4 to 5 years
 
1,332

108

7,554

942

1,406

89

7,009

1,101

5 to 10 years
 
5,863

231

23,540

1,970

6,058

113

25,187

2,250

Over 10 years
 
3,957

69

2,497

249

5,001

68

983

9

 
 
59,662

6,062

65,353

9,420

61,073

5,201

63,942

10,646

a 2019 includes $16,129 million (2018 $18,360 million) in relation to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, of which $14,501 million (2018 $16,058 million) matures in greater than one year.
b As a result of the adoption of IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, leases that were previously classified as finance leases under IAS 17 are now presented as ‘Lease liabilities’ on the group balance sheet and therefore do not form part of finance debt. Comparative information for finance debt and interest on finance debt has been amended to be on a consistent basis with amounts presented for 2019. $667 million and $683 million relating to finance lease liabilities have been excluded from the comparative information for finance debt and interest on finance debt respectively for 2018. The previously disclosed amounts for finance debt and interest on finance debt for 2018 was $64,608 million and $11,329 million respectively. The timing of cash outflows relating to lease liabilities reported on the balance sheet are now shown in Note 28.

The group manages liquidity risk associated with derivative contracts, other than derivative hedging instruments, based on the expected maturities of both derivative assets and liabilities as indicated in Note 30. Management does not currently anticipate any cash flows that could be of a significantly different amount or could occur earlier than the expected maturity analysis provided.

206
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
The table below shows the timing of cash outflows for derivative financial instruments entered into for the purpose of managing interest rate and foreign currency exchange risk associated with finance debt, whether or not hedge accounting is applied, based upon contractual payment dates. The amounts reflect the gross settlement amount where the pay leg of a derivative will be settled separately from the receive leg, as in the case of cross-currency swaps hedging non-US dollar finance debt. The swaps are with high investment-grade counterparties and therefore the settlement-day risk exposure is considered to be negligible. Not shown in the table are the gross settlement amounts (inflows) for the receive leg of derivatives that are settled separately from the pay leg, which amount to $24,787 million at 31 December 2019 (2018 $22,453 million) to be received on the same day as the related cash outflows. For further information on our derivative financial instruments, see Note 30.
 
 
 
$ million

Cash outflows for derivative financial instruments at 31 December
 
2019

2018

Within one year
 
1,678

1,700

1 to 2 years
 
2,384

1,678

2 to 3 years
 
2,838

2,384

3 to 4 years
 
2,906

2,838

4 to 5 years
 
3,321

2,906

5 to 10 years
 
10,633

11,475

Over 10 years
 
2,224

724

 
 
25,984

23,705


30. Derivative financial instruments
In the normal course of business the group enters into derivative financial instruments (derivatives) to manage its normal business exposures in relation to commodity prices, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates, including management of the balance between floating rate and fixed rate debt, consistent with risk management policies and objectives. An outline of the group’s financial risks and the objectives and policies pursued in relation to those risks is set out in Note 29. Additionally, the group has a well-established entrepreneurial trading operation that is undertaken in conjunction with these activities using a similar range of contracts.
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to the valuation of derivatives see Derivative financial instruments within Note 1.
The fair values of derivative financial instruments at 31 December are set out below.
Exchange traded derivatives are valued using closing prices provided by the exchange as at the balance sheet date. These derivatives are categorized within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Exchange traded derivatives are typically considered settled through the (normally daily) payment or receipt of variation margin.
Over-the-counter (OTC) financial swaps and physical commodity sale and purchase contracts are generally valued using readily available information in the public markets and quotations provided by brokers and price index developers. These quotes are corroborated with market data and are categorized within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
In certain less liquid markets, or for longer-term contracts, forward prices are not as readily available. In these circumstances, OTC financial swaps and physical commodity sale and purchase contracts are valued using internally developed methodologies that consider historical relationships between various commodities, and that result in management’s best estimate of fair value. These contracts are categorized within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
207


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Financial OTC and physical commodity options are valued using industry standard models that consider various assumptions, including quoted forward prices for commodities, time value, volatility factors, and contractual prices for the underlying instruments, as well as other relevant economic factors. The degree to which these inputs are observable in the forward markets determines whether the option is categorized within level 2 or level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
 
Fair value
asset

Fair value
liability

Fair value
asset

Fair value
liability

Derivatives held for trading
 
 
 
 
 
Currency derivatives
 
81

(744
)
69

(898
)
Oil price derivatives
 
1,918

(1,478
)
2,361

(1,849
)
Natural gas price derivatives
 
6,569

(4,871
)
4,787

(3,888
)
Power price derivatives
 
1,306

(952
)
1,240

(943
)
Other derivatives
 
110


107


 
 
9,984

(8,045
)
8,564

(7,578
)
Embedded derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
Other embedded derivatives
 

(77
)

(107
)
 
 

(77
)

(107
)
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Currency forwards
 
1

(4
)
5

(14
)
Gas price futures
 


2


 
 
1

(4
)
7

(14
)
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Currency swaps
 
344

(637
)
158

(789
)
Interest rate swaps
 
138

(35
)
262

(445
)
 
 
482

(672
)
420

(1,234
)
 
 
10,467

(8,798
)
8,991

(8,933
)
Of which – current
 
4,153

(3,261
)
3,846

(3,308
)
– non-current
 
6,314

(5,537
)
5,145

(5,625
)
Derivatives held for trading
The group maintains active trading positions in a variety of derivatives. The contracts may be entered into for risk management purposes, to satisfy supply requirements or for entrepreneurial trading. Certain contracts are classified as held for trading, regardless of their original business objective, and are recognized at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in the income statement. Trading activities are undertaken by using a range of contract types in combination to create incremental gains by arbitraging prices between markets, locations and time periods. The net of these exposures is monitored using market value-at-risk techniques as described in Note 29.
The following tables show further information on the fair value of derivatives and other financial instruments held for trading purposes.
Derivative assets held for trading have the following fair values and maturities.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
48

23

9

1



81

Oil price derivatives
 
1,619

114

76

53

45

11

1,918

Natural gas price derivatives
 
1,889

824

615

489

433

2,319

6,569

Power price derivatives
 
556

269

146

94

67

174

1,306

Other derivatives
 
33



77



110

 
 
4,145

1,230

846

714

545

2,504

9,984

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
48

12

9




69

Oil price derivatives
 
1,916

363

53

25

4


2,361

Natural gas price derivatives
 
1,333

708

542

452

352

1,400

4,787

Power price derivatives
 
540

276

158

79

55

132

1,240

Other derivatives
 




107


107

 
 
3,837

1,359

762

556

518

1,532

8,564


208
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Derivative liabilities held for trading have the following fair values and maturities.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
(166
)
(283
)
(201
)
(1
)
(23
)
(70
)
(744
)
Oil price derivatives
 
(1,405
)
(56
)
(14
)
(2
)
(1
)

(1,478
)
Natural gas price derivatives
 
(1,070
)
(522
)
(446
)
(399
)
(363
)
(2,071
)
(4,871
)
Power price derivatives
 
(395
)
(165
)
(104
)
(76
)
(51
)
(161
)
(952
)
 
 
(3,036
)
(1,026
)
(765
)
(478
)
(438
)
(2,302
)
(8,045
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
(299
)
(71
)
(256
)
(171
)
(3
)
(98
)
(898
)
Oil price derivatives
 
(1,560
)
(232
)
(43
)
(12
)
(2
)

(1,849
)
Natural gas price derivatives
 
(1,030
)
(557
)
(391
)
(338
)
(285
)
(1,287
)
(3,888
)
Power price derivatives
 
(401
)
(213
)
(95
)
(54
)
(47
)
(133
)
(943
)
 
 
(3,290
)
(1,073
)
(785
)
(575
)
(337
)
(1,518
)
(7,578
)
The following table shows the fair value of derivative assets and derivative liabilities held for trading, analysed by maturity period and by methodology of fair value estimation. This information is presented on a gross basis, that is, before netting by counterparty.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Fair value of derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 1
 
63

6

2


2

1

74

Level 2
 
5,344

1,014

439

210

120

42

7,169

Level 3
 
779

501

485

540

452

2,708

5,465

 
 
6,186

1,521

926

750

574

2,751

12,708

Less: netting by counterparty
 
(2,041
)
(291
)
(80
)
(36
)
(29
)
(247
)
(2,724
)
 
 
4,145

1,230

846

714

545

2,504

9,984

Fair value of derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 1
 
(49
)
(8
)
(4
)
(1
)
(2
)
(1
)
(65
)
Level 2
 
(4,522
)
(932
)
(458
)
(146
)
(113
)
(101
)
(6,272
)
Level 3
 
(506
)
(377
)
(383
)
(367
)
(352
)
(2,447
)
(4,432
)
 
 
(5,077
)
(1,317
)
(845
)
(514
)
(467
)
(2,549
)
(10,769
)
Less: netting by counterparty
 
2,041

291

80

36

29

247

2,724

 
 
(3,036
)
(1,026
)
(765
)
(478
)
(438
)
(2,302
)
(8,045
)
Net fair value
 
1,109

204

81

236

107

202

1,939

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Fair value of derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 1
 
111

14

3




128

Level 2
 
5,000

1,362

504

262

120

72

7,320

Level 3
 
491

385

353

331

427

1,640

3,627

 
 
5,602

1,761

860

593

547

1,712

11,075

Less: netting by counterparty
 
(1,765
)
(402
)
(98
)
(37
)
(29
)
(180
)
(2,511
)
 
 
3,837

1,359

762

556

518

1,532

8,564

Fair value of derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 1
 
(156
)
(11
)
(2
)
(2
)


(171
)
Level 2
 
(4,562
)
(1,161
)
(576
)
(308
)
(67
)
(163
)
(6,837
)
Level 3
 
(337
)
(303
)
(305
)
(302
)
(299
)
(1,535
)
(3,081
)
 
 
(5,055
)
(1,475
)
(883
)
(612
)
(366
)
(1,698
)
(10,089
)
Less: netting by counterparty
 
1,765

402

98

37

29

180

2,511

 
 
(3,290
)
(1,073
)
(785
)
(575
)
(337
)
(1,518
)
(7,578
)
Net fair value
 
547

286

(23
)
(19
)
181

14

986



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
209


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Level 3 derivatives
The following table shows the changes during the year in the net fair value of derivatives held for trading purposes within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Oil
price

Natural gas
price

Power
price

Other

Total

Fair value contracts at 1 January 2019
 
23

(13
)
(148
)
107

(31
)
Gains (losses) recognized in the income statement
 
128

82

244

2

456

Gains (losses) recognized in other comprehensive income
 


(18
)

(18
)
Settlements
 
(79
)
(21
)
(179
)

(279
)
Transfers out of level 3
 
(1
)
(20
)
(24
)
1

(44
)
Net fair value of contracts at 31 December 2019
 
71

28

(125
)
110

84

Deferred day-one gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
949

Derivative asset (liability)
 
 
 
 
 
1,033

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Oil
price

Natural gas
price

Power
price

Other

Total

Fair value contracts at 1 January 2018
 
67

65

(226
)
115

21

Gains (losses) recognized in the income statement
 
58

(26
)
209

(8
)
233

Settlements
 
(107
)
(32
)
(97
)

(236
)
Transfers out of level 3
 
5

(20
)
(34
)

(49
)
Net fair value of contracts at 31 December 2018
 
23

(13
)
(148
)
107

(31
)
Deferred day-one gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
577

Derivative asset (liability)
 
 
 
 
 
546

The amount recognized in the income statement for the year relating to level 3 held-for-trading derivatives still held at 31 December 2019 was a $250-million gain (2018 $123-million gain related to derivatives still held at 31 December 2018).
Derivative gains and losses
The group enters into derivative contracts including futures, options, swaps and certain forward sales and forward purchases contracts, relating to both currency and commodity trading activities. Gains or losses arise on contracts entered into for risk management purposes, optimization activity and entrepreneurial trading. They also arise on certain contracts that are for normal procurement or sales activity for the group but that are required to be fair valued under accounting standards. These gains and losses are included within sales and other operating revenues in the income statement. Also included within this line item are gains and losses on inventory held for trading purposes. The total amount relating to all these items was a net gain of $2,153 million (2018 $2,504 million net gain and 2017 $1,983 million net gain). This number does not include gains and losses on realized physical derivative contracts that have been reflected gross in the income statement within sales and purchases or the change in value of transportation and storage contracts which are not recognized under IFRS, but does include the associated financially settled contracts. The net amounts for actual gains and losses relating to these derivative contracts and all related items therefore differ significantly from the amounts disclosed above.
The group also enters into derivative contracts relating to foreign currency risk management activities. Gains and losses on these contracts are included within production and manufacturing expenses in the income statement. The change in the unrealized value of these contracts was a net gain of $160 million (2018 $351 million net loss and 2017 $1,420 million net gain), however the gains and losses in each year are largely offset by opposing net foreign exchange differences on retranslation of the associated non-US dollar debt. The net amounts for actual gains and losses relating to these derivative contracts and all related items therefore differ significantly from the amounts disclosed above.
Cash flow hedges
(i) Foreign currency risk of highly probable forecast capital expenditure
At 31 December 2019, the group held currency forwards designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships of highly probable forecast non-US dollar capital expenditure. Note 29 outlines the group’s approach to foreign currency exchange risk management. When the highly probable forecast capital expenditure designated as a hedged item occurs, a non-financial asset is recognized and is presented within the fixed asset section of the balance sheet.
The group claims hedge accounting only for the spot value of the currency exposure in line with the strategy to fix the volatility in the spot exchange rate element. The fair value on the instrument attributable to forward points and foreign currency basis spreads is taken immediately to the income statement.
The group applies hedge accounting where there is an economic relationship between the hedged item and hedging instrument. The existence of an economic relationship is determined at inception and prospectively by comparing the critical terms of the hedging instrument and those of the hedged item. The group enters into hedging derivatives that match the currency and notional of the hedged items on a 1:1 hedge ratio basis. The hedge ratio is determined by comparing the notional amount of the derivative with the notional designated on the forecast transaction. The group determines the extent to which it hedges highly probable forecast capital expenditures on a project by project basis.
The group has identified the following sources of ineffectiveness, which are not expected to be material:
counterparty's credit risk, the group mitigates counterparty credit risk by entering into derivative transactions with high credit quality counterparties; and
differences in settlement timing between the derivative and hedged items. The latter impacts the discount factor used in the calculation of the hedge ineffectiveness. The group mitigates differences in timing between the derivatives and hedged items by applying a rolling strategy and by hedging currency pairs from stable economies (i.e. sterling/US dollar, Euro/US dollar, Korean won/US dollar). The group's cash flow hedge designations are highly effective as the sources of ineffectiveness identified are expected to result in minimal hedge ineffectiveness.
The group has not designated any net positions as hedged items in cash flow hedges of foreign currency risk.

210
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
(ii) Commodity price risk of highly probable forecast sales
During the period the group held Henry Hub NYMEX futures designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships of certain highly probable forecast future sales. At 31 December 2019, these hedging instruments and highly probably forecast sales had been realised and the corresponding amounts recognised in the cash flow hedge reserve were released to the income statement during the period.
The group is exposed to the variability in the gas price, but only applied hedge accounting to the risk of Henry Hub price movements for a percentage of future gas sales from its BPX Energy business (previously known as US Lower 48 business).
The group applied hedge accounting in relation to these highly probable future sales where there was an economic relationship between the hedged item and hedging instrument. The existence of an economic relationship was determined at inception and prospectively by comparing the critical terms of the hedging instrument and those of the hedged item. The group entered into hedging derivatives that matched the notional amounts of the hedged items on a 1:1 hedge ratio basis. The hedge ratio was determined by comparing the notional amount of the derivative with the notional amount designated on the forecast transaction.
The hedge was highly effective due to the price index of the hedging instruments matching the price index of the hedged item. The group did not designate any net positions as hedged items in cash flow hedges of commodity price risk.
The tables below summarize the change in the fair value of hedging instruments and the hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness in the period.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Change in fair value of hedging instrument used to calculate ineffectiveness

Change in fair value of hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness

Hedge ineffectiveness recognized in profit or (loss)

At 31 December 2019
 
 
 
 
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange risk
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure
 
(1
)
1


Commodity price risk
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast sales
 
(100
)
100


 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange risk
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure
 
(5
)
5


Commodity price risk
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast sales
 
(126
)
126



The tables below summarize the carrying amount and nominal amount of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Carrying amount of hedging instrument
 
Nominal amounts of hedging instruments
 
 
 
Assets

Liabilities

At 31 December 2019
 
$ million

$ million

$ million

mmBtu

Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange risk
 
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure
 
1

(4
)
150



 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange risk
 
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure
 
5

(14
)
386

 
Commodity price risk
 
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast sales
 
2


 
145

All hedging instruments are presented within derivative financial instruments on the group balance sheet.
Of the nominal amount of hedging instruments at 31 December relating to highly probably forecast capital expenditure $150 million (2018 $304 million) matures within 12 months and $nil (2018 $82 million) within one to two years. All of the hedging instruments relating to highly probable forecast sales at 31 December 2018 matured in 2019.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
211


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
The table below summarizes the weighted average exchange rates and the weighted average sales price in relation to the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships at 31 December.
 
 
Weighted average price/rate
 
 
2019

 
2018

At 31 December
 
Forecast capital expenditure

Forecast capital expenditure

Forecast sales

Sterling/US dollar
 
1.35

1.34



Euro/US dollar
 
1.11

1.14



Australian dollar/US dollar
 

0.72



Norwegian krone/US dollar
 

8.67



Korean won/US dollar
 
1,115.66

1,107.90



Henry Hub $/mmBtu
 
 
 
2.86

Fair value hedges
At 31 December 2019, the group held interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swap contracts as fair value hedges of the interest rate risk and foreign currency risk arising from group fixed rate debt issuances. The interest rate swaps are used to convert US dollar denominated fixed rate borrowings into floating rate debt. The cross-currency interest rate swaps are used to convert sterling, euro, Swiss franc, Canadian dollar and Norwegian krone denominated fixed rate borrowings into US dollar floating rate debt. The group manages all risks derived from debt issuance, such as credit risk, however, the group applies hedge accounting only to certain components of interest rate and foreign currency risk in order to minimize hedge ineffectiveness. Note 29 outlines the group’s approach to interest rate and foreign currency exchange risk management.
The interest rate and foreign currency exposures are identified and hedged on an instrument-by-instrument basis. For interest rate exposures, the group designates as a fair value hedge the benchmark interest rate component only. This is an observable and reliably measurable component of interest rate risk. For foreign currency exposures, the group excludes from the designation the foreign currency basis spread component implicit in the cross-currency interest rate swaps. This is separately calculated at hedge designation, is recognized in other comprehensive income over the life of the hedge and amortized to the income statement on a straight-line basis, in accordance with the group’s policy on costs of hedging.
The group applies hedge accounting where there is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument. The existence of an economic relationship is determined initially by comparing the critical terms of the hedging instrument and those of the hedged item and it is prospectively assessed using linear regression analysis. The group issues fixed rate debt and enters into interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swaps with critical terms that match those of the debt and on a 1:1 hedge ratio basis. The hedge ratio is determined by comparing the notional amount of the derivative with the notional amount of the debt. The hedge relationship is designated for the full term and notional value of the debt. Both the hedging instrument and the hedged item are expected to be held to maturity.
The group has identified the following sources of ineffectiveness, which are not expected to be material:
derivative counterparty’s credit risk which is not offset by the hedged item. This risk is mitigated by entering into derivative transactions only with high credit quality counterparties; and
sensitivity to interest rate between the hedged item and the derivatives. This is driven by differences in payment frequencies between the instrument and the bond.
The tables below summarize the change in the fair value of hedging instruments and the hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness in the period. The signage convention for changes in fair value presented in this table is consistent with that presented in Note 27.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Change in fair value of hedging instrument used to calculate ineffectiveness

Change in fair value of hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness

Hedge ineffectiveness recognized in profit or (loss)

At 31 December 2019
 
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
(764
)
737

27

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
(336
)
286

50

 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
(70
)
69

(1
)
Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
812

(809
)
3





212
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
The tables below summarize the carrying amount of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in fair value hedge relationships at 31 December.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Carrying amount of hedging instrument
 
Nominal amounts of hedging instruments

At 31 December 2019
 
Assets

Liabilities

Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
138

(35
)
13,442

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
344

(637
)
21,296

 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
262

(445
)
24,513

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
158

(789
)
16,580


All hedging instruments are presented within derivative financial instruments on the group balance sheet. Ineffectiveness arising on fair value hedges is included within the production and manufacturing expenses section of the income statement.
The tables below summarize the profile by tenor of the nominal amount of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in fair value hedge relationships at 31 December. The weighted average floating interest rate of these interest rate swaps and cross-currency interest rate swaps was 2.36% (2018 3.04%) and 3.27% (2018 4.07%) respectively.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December 2019
 
Less than 1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

5-10 years

Over 10 years

Total

Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
3,000

2,576

4,039

1,200

206

2,421


13,442

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
882

672

1,400

2,777

3,109

10,216

2,240

21,296

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
2,694

2,324

2,597

4,923

1,700

10,275


24,513

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 

1,245

1,167

707

2,921

10,254

286

16,580


The tables below summarize the carrying amount, and the accumulated fair value adjustments included within the carrying amount, of the hedged items designated in fair value hedge relationships at 31 December.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Carrying amount of hedged item
 
Accumulated fair value adjustment included in the carrying amount of hedged items
 
At 31 December 2019
 
Assets

Liabilities

Assets

Liabilities

Discontinued hedges

Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 

(13,441
)

(100
)
(714
)
Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 

(21,240
)

(525
)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 

(24,747
)
175


(360
)
Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 

(16,883
)

(62
)


The hedged item for all fair value hedges is presented within finance debt on the group balance sheet.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
213


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Movement in reserves related to hedge accounting
The table below provides a reconciliation of the cash flow hedge and costs of hedging reserves on a pre-tax basis by risk category. The signage convention of this table is consistent with that presented in Note 32.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Cash flow hedge reserve
 
Costs of hedging reserve

 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure

Highly probable forecast sales

Purchase of equitya

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt

Total

At 1 January 2019
 
(21
)
(6
)
(651
)
(223
)
(901
)
Recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash flow hedges marked to market
 
(3
)
(100
)


(103
)
Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement - hedged item affected profit or loss
 

106



106

Costs of hedging marked to market
 



(4
)
(4
)
Costs of hedging reclassified to the income statement
 



57

57

 
 
(3
)
6


53

56

Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet
 
23




23

At 31 December 2019
 
(1
)

(651
)
(170
)
(822
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Cash flow hedge reserve
 
Costs of hedging reserve

 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure

Highly probable forecast sales

Purchase of equitya

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt

Total

At 31 December 2017
 
(10
)

(651
)

(661
)
Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9
 



(37
)
(37
)
At 1 January 2018
 
(10
)

(651
)
(37
)
(698
)
Recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash flow hedges marked to market
 
(37
)
(126
)


(163
)
Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement - hedged item affected profit or loss
 

120



120

Costs of hedging marked to market
 



(244
)
(244
)
Costs of hedging reclassified to the income statement
 



58

58

 
 
(37
)
(6
)

(186
)
(229
)
Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet
 
26




26

At 31 December 2018
 
(21
)
(6
)
(651
)
(223
)
(901
)
a See Note 32 for further information on the cash flow hedge reserve relating to the purchase of equity
Substantially all of the cash flow hedge reserve balances and all of the amounts reclassified into profit or loss during the year relate to continuing hedge relationships. Amounts deferred in the cash flow hedge reserve that have been reclassified to profit or loss are presented in sales and other operating revenues in the income statement.
Costs of hedging relates to the foreign currency basis spreads of hedging instruments used to hedge the group's interest rate and foreign currency risk on debt which is a time-period related item.


214
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


31. Called-up share capital
The allotted, called up and fully paid share capital at 31 December was as follows:
 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

Issued
 
Shares
thousand

$ million

Shares
thousand

$ million

Shares
thousand

$ million

8% cumulative first preference shares of £1 eacha
 
7,233

12

7,233

12

7,233

12

9% cumulative second preference shares of £1 eacha
 
5,473

9

5,473

9

5,473

9

 
 
 
21

 
21

 
21

Ordinary shares of 25 cents each
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
21,525,464

5,381

21,288,193

5,322

21,049,696

5,263

Issue of new shares for the scrip dividend programme
 
208,927

52

195,305

49

289,789

72

Issue of new shares for employee share-based payment plans
 
37,400

9

92,168

23



Issue of new shares – other
 






Repurchase of ordinary share capital
 
(235,951
)
(59
)
(50,202
)
(13
)
(51,292
)
(13
)
At 31 December
 
21,535,840

5,383

21,525,464

5,381

21,288,193

5,322

 
 
 
5,404

 
5,402

 
5,343

a The nominal amount of 8% cumulative first preference shares and 9% cumulative second preference shares that can be in issue at any time shall not exceed £10,000,000 for each class of preference shares.

Voting on substantive resolutions tabled at a general meeting is on a poll. On a poll, shareholders present in person or by proxy have two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of the first and second preference shares held and one vote for every ordinary share held. On a show-of-hands vote on other resolutions (procedural matters) at a general meeting, shareholders present in person or by proxy have one vote each.
In the event of the winding up of the company, preference shareholders would be entitled to a sum equal to the capital paid up on the preference shares, plus an amount in respect of accrued and unpaid dividends and a premium equal to the higher of (i) 10% of the capital paid up on the preference shares and (ii) the excess of the average market price of such shares on the London Stock Exchange during the previous six months over par value.
During 2019 the company repurchased 236 million ordinary shares for a total consideration of $1,511 million, including transaction costs of $8 million, as part of the share repurchase programme announced on 31 October 2017. All shares purchased were for cancellation. The repurchased shares represented 1.1% of ordinary share capital. A further 120 million of shares have been repurchased in January 2020 at a total cost of $776 million. The number of shares in issue is reduced when shares are repurchased.
Treasury sharesa 
 
 
 
2019

 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Shares
thousand

Nominal value
$ million

Shares
thousand

Nominal value
$ million

Shares
thousand

Nominal value
$ million

At 1 January
 
1,426,265

356

1,482,072

370

1,614,657

403

Purchases for settlement of employee share plans
 
1,118


757


4,423

1

Issue of new shares for employee share-based payment plans
 
37,400

9

92,168

23



Shares re-issued for employee share-based payment plans
 
(167,927
)
(42
)
(148,732
)
(37
)
(137,008
)
(34
)
At 31 December
 
1,296,856

323

1,426,265

356

1,482,072

370

Of which – shares held in treasury by BP
 
1,163,077

290

1,264,732

316

1,472,343

368

– shares held in ESOP trusts
 
133,707

33

161,518

40

9,705

2

– shares held by BP’s US share plan administratorb
 
72


15


24


a 
See Note 32 for definition of treasury shares.
b 
Held in the form of ADSs to meet the requirements of employee share-based payment plans in the US.

For each year presented, the balance at 1 January represents the maximum number of shares held in treasury by BP during the year, representing 5.9% (2018 6.9% and 2017 7.5%) of the called-up ordinary share capital of the company.
During 2019, the movement in shares held in treasury by BP represented less than 0.5% (2018 less than 1.0% and 2017 less than 0.5%) of the ordinary share capital of the company.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
215


32. Capital and reserves
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Share
capital

Share
premium
account

Capital
redemption
reserve

Merger
reserve

Total share capital
and capital
reserves

At 31 December 2018
 
5,402

12,305

1,439

27,206

46,352

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 16, net of tax
 





At 1 January 2019
 
5,402

12,305

1,439

27,206

46,352

Profit (loss) for the year
 





Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 





Cash flow hedges and costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 





Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of taxa
 





Other
 





Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 





Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 





Total comprehensive income
 





Dividends
 
52

(52
)



Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet, net of tax
 





Repurchases of ordinary share capital
 
(59
)

59



Share-based payments, net of taxb
 
9

164



173

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 





Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of taxc
 





At 31 December 2019
 
5,404

12,417

1,498

27,206

46,525

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2017
 
5,343

12,147

1,426

27,206

46,122

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9, net of tax
 





At 1 January 2018
 
5,343

12,147

1,426

27,206

46,122

Profit (loss) for the year
 





Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 





Cash flow hedges and costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 





Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of taxa
 





Other
 





Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 





Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 





Total comprehensive income
 





Dividends
 
49

(49
)



Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet, net of tax
 





Repurchases of ordinary share capital
 
(13
)

13



Share-based payments, net of taxb
 
23

207



230

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 





Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 





At 31 December 2018
 
5,402

12,305

1,439

27,206

46,352

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2017
 
5,284

12,219

1,413

27,206

46,122

Profit (loss) for the year
 





Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 





Available-for-sale investments (including reclassifications)
 





Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 





Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of taxa
 





Other
 





Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 





Total comprehensive income
 





Dividends
 
72

(72
)



Repurchases of ordinary share capital
 
(13
)

13



Share-based payments, net of taxb
 





Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 





Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of taxd
 





At 31 December 2017
 
5,343

12,147

1,426

27,206

46,122

a Principally foreign exchange effects relating to the Russian rouble.
b Movements in treasury shares relate to employee share-based payment plans.


216
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


32. Capital and reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Treasury
shares

Foreign
currency
translation
reserve

Available-
for-sale
investments

Cash flow
hedges

Costs of hedging

Total
fair value
reserves

Profit and
loss
account

BP
shareholders’
equity

Non-
controlling
interests

Total equity

(15,767
)
(8,902
)

(777
)
(210
)
(987
)
78,748

99,444

2,104

101,548







(329
)
(329
)
(1
)
(330
)
(15,767
)
(8,902
)

(777
)
(210
)
(987
)
78,419

99,115

2,103

101,218







4,026

4,026

164

4,190

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

2,407






2,407

9

2,416




5

50

55


55


55







82

82


82







(64
)
(64
)

(64
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 






171

171


171




(3
)

(3
)

(3
)

(3
)

2,407


2

50

52

4,215

6,674

173

6,847







(6,929
)
(6,929
)
(213
)
(7,142
)



23


23


23


23







(1,511
)
(1,511
)

(1,511
)
1,355






(809
)
719


719







5

5


5







316

316

233

549

(14,412
)
(6,495
)

(752
)
(160
)
(912
)
73,706

98,412

2,296

100,708

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(16,958
)
(5,156
)
17

(760
)

(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404



(17
)

(37
)
(54
)
(126
)
(180
)

(180
)
(16,958
)
(5,156
)

(760
)
(37
)
(797
)
75,100

98,311

1,913

100,224







9,383

9,383

195

9,578

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

(3,746
)





(3,746
)
(41
)
(3,787
)



(6
)
(173
)
(179
)

(179
)

(179
)






417

417


417







7

7


7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 






1,599

1,599


1,599




(37
)

(37
)

(37
)

(37
)

(3,746
)

(43
)
(173
)
(216
)
11,406

7,444

154

7,598







(6,699
)
(6,699
)
(170
)
(6,869
)



26


26


26


26







(355
)
(355
)

(355
)
1,191






(718
)
703


703







14

14


14









207

207

(15,767
)
(8,902
)

(777
)
(210
)
(987
)
78,748

99,444

2,104

101,548

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(18,443
)
(6,878
)
3

(1,156
)

(1,153
)
75,638

95,286

1,557

96,843







3,389

3,389

79

3,468

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

1,722





(3
)
1,719

52

1,771



14



14


14


14




396


396


396


396







564

564


564







(72
)
(72
)

(72
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 






2,343

2,343


2,343


1,722

14

396


410

6,221

8,353

131

8,484







(6,153
)
(6,153
)
(141
)
(6,294
)






(343
)
(343
)

(343
)
1,485






(798
)
687


687







215

215


215







446

446

366

812

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
17

(760
)

(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404

c Principally relates to the sale of a 49% interest in BP's retail property portfolio in Australia.
d Principally relates to the initial public offering of common units in BP Midstream Partners LP for which net proceeds of $811 million were received.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
217


32. Capital and reserves – continued
Share capital
The balance on the share capital account represents the aggregate nominal value of all ordinary and preference shares in issue, including treasury shares.
Share premium account
The balance on the share premium account represents the amounts received in excess of the nominal value of the ordinary and preference shares.
Capital redemption reserve
The balance on the capital redemption reserve represents the aggregate nominal value of all the ordinary shares repurchased and cancelled.
Merger reserve
The balance on the merger reserve represents the fair value of the consideration given in excess of the nominal value of the ordinary shares issued in an acquisition made by the issue of shares.
Treasury shares
Treasury shares represent BP shares repurchased and available for specific and limited purposes. For accounting purposes shares held in Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) and BP’s US share plan administrator to meet the future requirements of the employee share-based payment plans are treated in the same manner as treasury shares and are, therefore, included in the financial statements as treasury shares. The ESOPs are funded by the group and have waived their rights to dividends in respect of such shares held for future awards. Until such time as the shares held by the ESOPs vest unconditionally to employees, the amount paid for those shares is shown as a reduction in shareholders’ equity. Assets and liabilities of the ESOPs are recognized as assets and liabilities of the group.
Foreign currency translation reserve
The foreign currency translation reserve records exchange differences arising from the translation of the financial statements of foreign operations. Upon disposal of foreign operations, the related accumulated exchange differences are reclassified to the income statement.
Available-for-sale investments
This reserve recorded the changes in fair value of investments classified as available-for-sale under IAS 39 except for impairment losses, foreign exchange gains or losses, or changes arising from revised estimates of future cash flows. On adoption of IFRS 9 the balance in this reserve was transferred to the profit and loss account reserve. Under the new standard the group recognizes fair value gains and losses on these investments in profit or loss.
Cash flow hedges
This reserve records the portion of the gain or loss on a hedging instrument in a cash flow hedge that is determined to be an effective hedge. It includes $651 million relating to the acquisition of an 18.5% interest in Rosneft in 2013 which will only be reclassified to the income statement if the investment in Rosneft is either sold or impaired. For further information on the accounting for cash flow hedges see Note 1 - Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Costs of hedging
This reserve records the change in fair value of the foreign currency basis spread of financial instruments to which cost of hedge accounting has been applied. The accumulated amount relates to time-period related hedged items and is amortized to profit or loss over the term of the hedging relationship.
Prior to the group’s adoption of IFRS 9 changes in the fair value of such foreign currency basis spreads were recognized in profit or loss. On adoption of the new standard a transfer from the profit and loss account reserve to the costs of hedging reserve was made in order to reflect the opening reserves position for relevant hedging instruments existing on transition. For further information on the accounting for costs of hedging see Note 1 - Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Profit and loss account
The balance held on this reserve is the accumulated retained profits of the group.

218
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


32. Capital and reserves – continued
The pre-tax amounts of each component of other comprehensive income, and the related amounts of tax, are shown in the table below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Pre-tax

Tax

Net of tax

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 
2,418

(2
)
2,416

Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 
6

(1
)
5

Costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 
53

(3
)
50

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
82


82

Other
 

(64
)
(64
)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
328

(157
)
171

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 
(3
)

(3
)
Other comprehensive income
 
2,884

(227
)
2,657

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Pre-tax

Tax

Net of tax

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 
(3,771
)
(16
)
(3,787
)
Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 
(6
)

(6
)
Costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 
(186
)
13

(173
)
Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
417


417

Other
 

7

7

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
2,317

(718
)
1,599

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 
(37
)

(37
)
Other comprehensive income
 
(1,266
)
(714
)
(1,980
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Pre-tax

Tax

Net of tax

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 
1,866

(95
)
1,771

Available-for-sale investments (including reclassifications)
 
14


14

Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 
425

(29
)
396

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
564


564

Other
 

(72
)
(72
)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
3,646

(1,303
)
2,343

Other comprehensive income
 
6,515

(1,499
)
5,016


33. Contingent liabilities
There were contingent liabilities at 31 December 2019 in respect of guarantees and indemnities entered into as part of the ordinary course of the group’s business. No material losses are likely to arise from such contingent liabilities. Further information on financial guarantees is included in Note 29.
In the normal course of the group’s business, BP group entities are subject to legal and regulatory proceedings arising out of current and past operations, including matters related to commercial disputes, product liability, antitrust, commodities trading, premises-liability claims, consumer protection, general health, safety, climate change and environmental claims and allegations of exposures of third parties to toxic substances, such as lead pigment in paint, asbestos and other chemicals. The amounts claimed could be significant and could be material to the group’s results of operations, financial position or liquidity. While it is difficult to predict the ultimate outcome in some cases, BP expects that the impact of current legal and regulatory proceedings on the group‘s results of operations, liquidity or financial position will not be material.
The group files tax returns in many jurisdictions throughout the world. Various tax authorities are currently examining the group’s tax returns. Tax returns contain matters that could be subject to differing interpretations of applicable tax laws and regulations including the tax deductibility of certain intercompany charges. The resolution of tax positions through negotiations with relevant tax authorities, or through litigation, can take several years to complete and the amounts could be significant and could, in aggregate, be material to the group’s results of operations, financial position or liquidity. While it is difficult to predict the ultimate outcome in some cases, BP does not expect there to be any material impact upon the group‘s results of operations, financial position or liquidity.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
219


33. Contingent liabilities – continued
The group is subject to numerous national and local health, safety and environmental laws and regulations concerning its products, operations and other activities. These laws and regulations may require the group to take future action to remediate the effects on the environment of prior disposal or release of chemicals or petroleum substances by the group or other parties. Such contingencies may exist for various sites including refineries, chemical plants, oil fields, commodities extraction sites, service stations, terminals and waste disposal sites. In addition, the group may have obligations relating to prior asset sales or closed facilities. The ultimate requirement for remediation and its costs are inherently difficult to estimate. However, the estimated cost of environmental obligations has been provided in these accounts in accordance with the group‘s accounting policies. While the amounts of future possible costs that are not provided for could be significant and material to the group‘s results of operations in the period in which they are recognized, it is not possible to estimate the amounts involved. BP does not expect these costs to have a material impact on the group’s results of operations, financial position or liquidity.
If oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines are sold to third parties and the subsequent owner is unable to meet their decommissioning obligations it is possible that, in certain circumstances, BP could be partially or wholly responsible for decommissioning. While the amounts associated with decommissioning provisions reverting to the group could be significant and could be material, BP is not currently aware of any such cases that have a greater than remote chance of reverting to the group. Furthermore, as described in Provisions and contingencies within Note 1, decommissioning provisions associated with downstream and petrochemical facilities are not generally recognized as the potential obligations cannot be measured given their indeterminate settlement dates.
See also Legal proceedings on pages 319-320.
Contingent liabilities related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill
For information on legal proceedings relating to the Deepwater Horizon oil spill, see Legal proceedings on pages 319-320. Any further outstanding Deepwater Horizon related claims are not expected to have a material impact on the group's financial performance.

34. Remuneration of senior management and non-executive directors
Remuneration of directors
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Total for all directors
 
 
 
 
Emoluments
 
9

8

9

Amounts received under incentive schemesa
 
20

16

9

Total
 
29

24

18

a Excludes amounts relating to past directors.
Emoluments
These amounts comprise fees paid to the non-executive chairman and the non-executive directors and, for executive directors, salary and benefits earned during the relevant financial year, plus cash bonuses awarded for the year.
Pension contributions
During 2019 one executive director participated in a UK final salary pension plan in respect of service prior to 1 April 2011. During 2019, one executive director participated in retirement savings plans established for US employees and in a US defined benefit pension plan in respect of service prior to 1 September 2016.
Further information
Full details of individual directors’ remuneration are given in the Directors’ remuneration report on page 100. See also Related-party transactions on page 321.
Remuneration of directors and senior management
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Total for all senior management and non-executive directors
 
 
 
 
Short-term employee benefits
 
30

25

29

Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
2

2

2

Share-based payments
 
32

32

29

Total
 
64

59

60

Senior management comprises members of the executive team, see pages 78-79 for further information.
Short-term employee benefits
These amounts comprise fees and benefits paid to the non-executive chairman and non-executive directors, as well as salary, benefits and cash bonuses for senior management. Deferred annual bonus awards, to be settled in shares, are included in share-based payments. Short term employee benefits includes compensation for loss of office of $nil in 2019 (2018 $nil and 2017 $nil).
Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
The amounts represent the estimated cost to the group of providing pensions and other post-retirement benefits to senior management in respect of the current year of service measured in accordance with IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’.
Share-based payments
This is the cost to the group of senior management’s participation in share-based payment plans, as measured by the fair value of options and shares granted, accounted for in accordance with IFRS 2 ‘Share-based Payments’.


220
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


35. Employee costs and numbers
 
 
 
 
$ million

Employee costs
 
2019

2018

2017

Wages and salariesa
 
7,497

7,931

7,572

Social security costs
 
733

743

711

Share-based paymentsb
 
694

669

624

Pension and other post-retirement benefit costs
 
948

1,154

1,296

 
 
9,872

10,497

10,203


 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
2018

 
 
2017

Average number of employeesc
 
US

Non-US

Total

US

Non-US

Total

US

Non-US

Total

Upstream
 
5,800

11,000

16,800

5,900

11,500

17,400

6,200

12,200

18,400

Downstreamd
 
5,700

37,300

43,000

6,000

36,300

42,300

6,100

35,900

42,000

Other businesses and corporate
 
2,100

10,600

12,700

1,900

12,100

14,000

1,900

12,400

14,300

 
 
13,600

58,900

72,500

13,800

59,900

73,700

14,200

60,500

74,700

a Includes termination costs of $182 million (2018 $493 million and 2017 $189 million).
b The group provides certain employees with shares and share options as part of their remuneration packages. The majority of these share-based payment arrangements are equity-settled.
c Reported to the nearest 100.
d Includes 18,100 (2018 17,100 and 2017 16,500) service station staff.
e Includes 2,500 (2018 4,000 and 2017 4,700) agricultural, operational and seasonal workers in Brazil.

36. Auditor’s remuneration
 
 
 
 
$ million

Fees
 
2019

2018

2017

The audit of the company annual accountsa
 
32

25

26

The audit of accounts of subsidiaries of the company
 
11

10

11

Total audit
 
43

35

37

Audit-related assurance servicesb
 
4

4

7

Total audit and audit-related assurance services
 
47

39

44

Non-audit and other assurance services
 
1

2

3

Total non-audit or non-audit-related assurance services
 
1

2

3

Services relating to BP pension plans
 
1

1


 
 
49

42

47

a Fees in respect of the audit of the accounts of BP p.l.c. including the group’s consolidated financial statements.
b Includes interim reviews and audit of internal control over financial reporting and non-statutory audit services.

With effect from 2018, following a competitive tender process, Deloitte LLP (Deloitte) was appointed as auditor of the Company, replacing Ernst & Young LLP (EY). In the table above, auditor’s remuneration for services provided during the years ended 31 December 2019 and 31 December 2018 thus relates to Deloitte and for the year ended 31 December 2017 EY.
2019 includes $3.6 million of additional fees for 2018. In addition to the amounts shown in the table above, in 2018 $0.75 million of additional fees were paid to EY in respect of their audit for 2017. Auditor's remuneration is included in the income statement within distribution and administration expenses.
Tax services (in relation to income tax, indirect tax compliance, employee tax services and tax advisory services) were $nil in all periods presented.
The audit committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for the engagement of Deloitte to render audit and certain assurance and other services. The audit fees payable to Deloitte were considered as part of the audit tender process in 2016 and challenged by the audit committee through comparison with the audit pricing proposals of the other bidding firms, before being approved. Deloitte performed further assurance services that were not prohibited by regulatory or other professional requirements and were pre-approved by the Committee. Deloitte is engaged for these services when its expertise and experience of BP are important. Most of this work is of an audit-related or assurance nature.
Under SEC regulations, the remuneration of the auditor of $49 million (2018 $42 million and 2017 $47 million) is required to be presented as follows: audit $43 million (2018 $35 million and 2017 $37 million); other audit-related $4 million (2018 $4 million and 2017 $7 million); tax $nil (2018 $nil and 2017 $nil); and all other fees $3 million (2018 $3 million and 2017 $3 million).


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
221


37. Subsidiaries, joint arrangements and associates
The more important subsidiaries and associates of the group at 31 December 2019 and the group percentage of ordinary share capital (to nearest whole number) are set out below. There are no individually significant incorporated joint arrangements. The group's share of the assets and liabilities of the more important unincorporated joint arrangements are held by subsidiaries listed in the table below. Those subsidiaries held directly by the parent company are marked with an asterisk (*), the percentage owned being that of the group unless otherwise indicated. A complete list of undertakings of the group is included in Note 14 in the parent company financial statements of BP p.l.c. which are filed with the Registrar of Companies in the UK, along with the group’s annual report.
Subsidiaries
 
%
Country of
incorporation
 
Principal activities
International
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Corporate Holdings
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
 BP Exploration Operating Company
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
*BP Global Investments
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
*BP International
 
100
England & Wales
 
Integrated oil operations
 BP Oil International
 
100
England & Wales
 
Integrated oil operations
*Burmah Castrol
 
100
Scotland
 
Lubricants
Angola
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Angola)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Azerbaijan
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Caspian Sea)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
 BP Exploration (Azerbaijan)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Canada
 
 
 
 
 
*BP Holdings Canada
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
Egypt
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Delta)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Germany
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Europa SE
 
100
Germany
 
Refining and marketing
India
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Alpha)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Trinidad & Tobago
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Trinidad and Tobago
 
70
US
 
Exploration and production
UK
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Capital Markets
 
100
England & Wales
 
Finance
US
 
 
 
 
 
*BP Holdings North America
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
 Atlantic Richfield Company
 
100
US
 
Exploration and production, refining and marketing
 BP America
 
100
US
 
 BP America Production Company
 
100
US
 
 BP Company North America
 
100
US
 
 BP Corporation North America
 
100
US
 
 BP Exploration (Alaska)
 
100
US
 
 BP Products North America
 
100
US
 
 Standard Oil Company
 
100
US
 
 BP Capital Markets America
 
100
US
 
Finance
 
 
 
 
 
 
Associates
 
%
Country of
incorporation
 
Principal activities
Russia
 
 
 
 
 
 Rosneft Oil Company
 
19.75
Russia
 
Integrated oil operations


222
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries
BP p.l.c. fully and unconditionally guarantees the payment obligations of its 100%-owned subsidiary BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. under the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust. As described in Note 2, in 2020 BP expects, subject to governmental authorizations, to complete the sale of all of its Alaska operations, including its interest in BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc., to Hilcorp Energy. Following completion of the sale, BP will continue to fully and unconditionally guarantee the payment obligations of BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. to the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust. The following financial information for BP p.l.c., BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. and all other subsidiaries on a condensed consolidating basis is intended to provide investors with meaningful and comparable financial information about BP p.l.c. and its subsidiary issuers of registered securities and is provided pursuant to Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X in lieu of the separate financial statements of each subsidiary issuer of public debt securities. Non-current assets for BP p.l.c. includes investments in subsidiaries recorded under the equity method for the purposes of the condensed consolidating financial information. Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries is the group’s share of profit related to such investments. The eliminations and reclassifications column includes the necessary amounts to eliminate the intercompany balances and transactions between BP p.l.c., BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. and other subsidiaries. The financial information presented in the following tables for BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. incorporates subsidiaries of BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. using the equity method of accounting and excludes the BP group’s midstream operations in Alaska that are reported through different legal entities and that are included within the ‘other subsidiaries’ column in these tables. BP p.l.c. also fully and unconditionally guarantees securities issued by BP Capital Markets p.l.c. and BP Capital Markets America Inc. These companies are 100%-owned finance subsidiaries of BP p.l.c.
Income statement
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Sales and other operating revenues
 
4,413


278,111

(4,127
)
278,397

Earnings from joint ventures - after interest and tax
 


576


576

Earnings from associates - after interest and tax
 


2,681


2,681

Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

5,916


(5,916
)

Interest and other income
 
42

385

2,284

(1,942
)
769

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4


189


193

Total revenues and other income
 
4,459

6,301

283,841

(11,985
)
282,616

Purchases
 
2,361


211,438

(4,127
)
209,672

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
907


20,908


21,815

Production and similar taxes
 
163


1,384


1,547

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
169


17,611


17,780

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
747


7,328


8,075

Exploration expense
 


964


964

Distribution and administration expenses
 
75

803

10,333

(154
)
11,057

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
37

5,498

13,875

(7,704
)
11,706

Finance costs
 
17

1,569

3,691

(1,788
)
3,489

Net finance (income) expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(153
)
216


63

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
20

4,082

9,968

(5,916
)
8,154

Taxation
 
(40
)
56

3,948


3,964

Profit (loss) for the year
 
60

4,026

6,020

(5,916
)
4,190

Attributable to
 





BP shareholders
 
60

4,026

5,856

(5,916
)
4,026

Non-controlling interests
 


164


164

 
 
60

4,026

6,020

(5,916
)
4,190



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
223


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Income statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Sales and other operating revenues
 
4,315


298,620

(4,179
)
298,756

Earnings from joint ventures - after interest and tax
 


897


897

Earnings from associates - after interest and tax
 


2,856


2,856

Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

10,942


(10,942
)

Interest and other income
 
42

373

2,081

(1,723
)
773

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


456


456

Total revenues and other income
 
4,357

11,315

304,910

(16,844
)
303,738

Purchases
 
1,507


232,550

(4,179
)
229,878

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
1,015


21,990


23,005

Production and similar taxes
 
282


1,254


1,536

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
377


15,080


15,457

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
66


794


860

Exploration expense
 


1,445


1,445

Distribution and administration expenses
 
22

642

11,673

(158
)
12,179

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
1,088

10,673

20,124

(12,507
)
19,378

Finance costs
 
8

1,326

2,759

(1,565
)
2,528

Net finance (income) expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(95
)
222


127

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
1,080

9,442

17,143

(10,942
)
16,723

Taxation
 
164

59

6,922


7,145

Profit (loss) for the year
 
916

9,383

10,221

(10,942
)
9,578

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
916

9,383

10,026

(10,942
)
9,383

Non-controlling interests
 


195


195

 
 
916

9,383

10,221

(10,942
)
9,578

Income statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Sales and other operating revenues
 
3,264


240,177

(3,233
)
240,208

Earnings from joint ventures - after interest and tax
 


1,177


1,177

Earnings from associates - after interest and tax
 


1,330


1,330

Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

4,436


(4,436
)

Interest and other income
 
11

369

1,470

(1,193
)
657

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
71

9

1,139

(9
)
1,210

Total revenues and other income
 
3,346

4,814

245,293

(8,871
)
244,582

Purchases
 
1,010


181,939

(3,233
)
179,716

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
1,156


23,073


24,229

Production and similar taxesa
 
(18
)

1,793


1,775

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
735


14,849


15,584

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


1,216


1,216

Exploration expense
 


2,080


2,080

Distribution and administration expenses
 
19

616

10,022

(149
)
10,508

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
444

4,198

10,321

(5,489
)
9,474

Finance costs
 
6

826

2,286

(1,044
)
2,074

Net finance (income) expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(15
)
235


220

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
438

3,387

7,800

(4,445
)
7,180

Taxation
 
(392
)
(11
)
4,115


3,712

Profit (loss) for the year
 
830

3,398

3,685

(4,445
)
3,468

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
830

3,398

3,606

(4,445
)
3,389

Non-controlling interests
 


79


79

 
 
830

3,398

3,685

(4,445
)
3,468

a Includes revised non-cash provision adjustments; actual cash payments for Production and similar taxes remain in line with prior year.

224
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Statement of comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Profit (loss) for the year
 
60

4,026

6,020

(5,916
)
4,190

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 

200

1,338


1,538

Exchange (gains) or losses on translation of foreign operations transferred to gain or loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


880


880

Cash flow hedges marked to market
 


(100
)

(100
)
Cash flow hedges - recycled to the income statement
 


106


106

Costs of hedging market to market
 


(4
)

(4
)
Costs of hedging reclassified to the income statement
 


57


57

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 


82


82

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 


(70
)

(70
)
 
 

200

2,289


2,489

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 

732

(404
)

328

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 


(3
)

(3
)
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 

(331
)
174


(157
)
 
 

401

(233
)

168

Other comprehensive income
 

601

2,056


2,657

Equity-accounted other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
 

2,047


(2,047
)

Total comprehensive income
 
60

6,674

8,076

(7,963
)
6,847

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
  BP shareholders
 
60

6,674

7,903

(7,963
)
6,674

  Non-controlling interests
 


173


173

 
 
60

6,674

8,076

(7,963
)
6,847

Statement of comprehensive income continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Profit (loss) for the year
 
916

9,383

10,221

(10,942
)
9,578

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 

(296
)
(3,475
)

(3,771
)
Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 


(6
)

(6
)
Costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 


(186
)

(186
)
Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 


417


417

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 


4


4

 
 

(296
)
(3,246
)

(3,542
)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 










Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 

1,689

628


2,317

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 


(37
)

(37
)
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 

(511
)
(207
)

(718
)
 
 

1,178

384


1,562

Other comprehensive income
 

882

(2,862
)

(1,980
)
Equity-accounted other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
 

(2,821
)

2,821


Total comprehensive income
 
916

7,444

7,359

(8,121
)
7,598

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
916

7,444

7,205

(8,121
)
7,444

Non-controlling interests
 


154


154

 
 
916

7,444

7,359

(8,121
)
7,598


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
225


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Statement of comprehensive income continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Profit (loss) for the year
 
830

3,398

3,685

(4,445
)
3,468

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 

166

1,820


1,986

Exchange (gains) losses on translation of foreign operations transferred to gain or loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


(120
)

(120
)
Available-for-sale investments marked to market
 


14


14

Cash flow hedges marked to market
 


197


197

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement
 


116


116

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the balance sheet
 


112


112

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 


564


564

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 


(196
)

(196
)
 
 

166

2,507


2,673

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 

2,984

662


3,646

Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 

(1,169
)
(134
)

(1,303
)
 
 

1,815

528


2,343

Other comprehensive income
 

1,981

3,035


5,016

Equity-accounted other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
 

2,983


(2,983
)

Total comprehensive income
 
830

8,362

6,720

(7,428
)
8,484

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
830

8,362

6,589

(7,428
)
8,353

Non-controlling interests
 


131


131

 
 
830

8,362

6,720

(7,428
)
8,484


226
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Balance sheet
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 


132,642


132,642

Goodwill
 


11,868


11,868

Intangible assets
 


15,539


15,539

Investments in joint ventures
 


9,991


9,991

Investments in associates
 

2

20,332


20,334

Other investments
 


1,276


1,276

Subsidiaries - equity-accounted basis
 

167,895


(167,895
)

Fixed assets
 

167,897

191,648

(167,895
)
191,650

Loans
 


32,524

(31,894
)
630

Trade and other receivables
 

2,771

2,147

(2,771
)
2,147

Derivative financial instruments
 


6,314


6,314

Prepayments
 


781


781

Deferred tax assets
 


4,560


4,560

Defined benefit pension plan surpluses
 

6,588

465


7,053

 
 

177,256

238,439

(202,560
)
213,135

Current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 


339


339

Inventories
 
44


20,836


20,880

Trade and other receivables
 
690

135

42,157

(18,540
)
24,442

Derivative financial instruments
 


4,153


4,153

Prepayments
 


857


857

Current tax receivable
 
45


1,237


1,282

Other investments
 


169


169

Cash and cash equivalents
 


22,472


22,472

 
 
779

135

92,220

(18,540
)
74,594

Assets classified as held for sale
 
5,023


2,442


7,465

 
 
5,802

135

94,662

(18,540
)
82,059

Total assets
 
5,802

177,391

333,101

(221,100
)
295,194

Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
436

17,986

46,947

(18,540
)
46,829

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,261


3,261

Accruals
 
347

21

4,698


5,066

Lease liabilities
 


2,067


2,067

Finance debt
 


10,487


10,487

Current tax payable
 


2,039


2,039

Provisions
 


2,453


2,453

 
 
783

18,007

71,952

(18,540
)
72,202

Liabilities directly associated with assets classified as held for sale
 
706


687


1,393

 
 
1,489

18,007

72,639

(18,540
)
73,595

Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 

31,927

15,364

(34,665
)
12,626

Derivative financial instruments
 


5,537


5,537

Accruals
 


996


996

Lease liabilities
 


7,655


7,655

Finance debt
 


57,237


57,237

Deferred tax liabilities
 
456

2,293

7,001


9,750

Provisions
 
114


18,384


18,498

Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 

202

8,390


8,592

 
 
570

34,422

120,564

(34,665
)
120,891

Total liabilities
 
2,059

52,429

193,203

(53,205
)
194,486

Net assets
 
3,743

124,962

139,898

(167,895
)
100,708

Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders’ equity
 
3,743

124,962

137,602

(167,895
)
98,412

Non-controlling interests
 


2,296


2,296

 
 
3,743

124,962

139,898

(167,895
)
100,708


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
227


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Balance sheet continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
4,445


130,816


135,261

Goodwill
 


12,204


12,204

Intangible assets
 
598


16,686


17,284

Investments in joint ventures
 


8,647


8,647

Investments in associates
 

2

17,671


17,673

Other investments
 


1,341


1,341

Subsidiaries - equity-accounted basis
 

166,311


(166,311
)

Fixed assets
 
5,043

166,313

187,365

(166,311
)
192,410

Loans
 


32,402

(31,765
)
637

Trade and other receivables
 

2,600

1,834

(2,600
)
1,834

Derivative financial instruments
 


5,145


5,145

Prepayments
 


1,179


1,179

Deferred tax assets
 


3,706


3,706

Defined benefit pension plan surpluses
 

5,473

482


5,955

 
 
5,043

174,386

232,113

(200,676
)
210,866

Current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 


326


326

Inventories
 
302


17,686


17,988

Trade and other receivables
 
2,536

151

38,931

(17,140
)
24,478

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,846


3,846

Prepayments
 
7


956


963

Current tax receivable
 


1,019


1,019

Other investments
 


222


222

Cash and cash equivalents
 

13

22,455


22,468

 
 
2,845

164

85,441

(17,140
)
71,310

Total assets
 
7,888

174,550

317,554

(217,816
)
282,176

Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
413

14,634

48,358

(17,140
)
46,265

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,308


3,308

Accruals
 
89

31

4,506


4,626

Lease liabilities
 


44


44

Finance debt
 


9,329


9,329

Current tax payable
 
310


1,791


2,101

Provisions
 
1


2,563


2,564

 
 
813

14,665

69,899

(17,140
)
68,237

Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 

31,800

16,395

(34,365
)
13,830

Derivative financial instruments
 


5,625


5,625

Accruals
 


575


575

Lease liabilities
 


623


623

Finance debt
 


55,803


55,803

Deferred tax liabilities
 
586

1,907

7,319


9,812

Provisions
 
670


17,062


17,732

Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 

184

8,207


8,391

 
 
1,256

33,891

111,609

(34,365
)
112,391

Total liabilities
 
2,069

48,556

181,508

(51,505
)
180,628

Net assets
 
5,819

125,994

136,046

(166,311
)
101,548

Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders’ equity
 
5,819

125,994

133,942

(166,311
)
99,444

Non-controlling interests
 


2,104


2,104

 
 
5,819

125,994

136,046

(166,311
)
101,548



228
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Cash flow statement
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
20

4,082

9,968

(5,916
)
8,154

Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 


631


631

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
169


17,611


17,780

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
743


7,139


7,882

Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 


(3,257
)

(3,257
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 


1,962


1,962

Equity accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

(5,916
)

5,916


Dividends received from subsidiaries
 

6,360


(6,360
)

Interest receivable
 
(1
)

(2,228
)
1,788

(441
)
Interest received
 
1

12

2,191

(1,788
)
416

Finance costs
 
17


5,260

(1,788
)
3,489

Interest paid
 
(6
)

(4,652
)
1,788

(2,870
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(153
)
216


63

Share-based payments
 

739

(9
)

730

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 

(10
)
(228
)

(238
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
21


(197
)

(176
)
(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
(31
)

(3,375
)

(3,406
)
(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
(132
)
(155
)
(2,048
)

(2,335
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
1,954

3,469

(2,600
)

2,823

Income taxes paid
 
(444
)
(1
)
(4,992
)

(5,437
)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
 
2,311

8,427

21,392

(6,360
)
25,770

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
(173
)

(15,245
)

(15,418
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 


(3,562
)

(3,562
)
Investment in joint ventures
 


(137
)

(137
)
Investment in associates
 


(304
)

(304
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
(173
)

(19,248
)

(19,421
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
19


481


500

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 


1,701


1,701

Proceeds from loan repayments
 
21


225


246

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
(133
)

(16,841
)

(16,974
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase of shares
 

(1,511
)


(1,511
)
Lease liability payments
 
(46
)

(2,326
)

(2,372
)
Proceeds from long-term financing
 


8,597


8,597

Repayments of long-term financing
 


(7,118
)

(7,118
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 


180


180

Net increase (decrease) in non-controlling interests
 


566


566

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
(2,132
)
(6,929
)
(4,245
)
6,360

(6,946
)
Non-controlling interests
 


(213
)

(213
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
(2,178
)
(8,440
)
(4,559
)
6,360

(8,817
)
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 


25


25

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 

(13
)
17


4

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 

13

22,455


22,468

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 


22,472


22,472


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
229


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Cash flow statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
1,080

9,442

17,143

(10,942
)
16,723

Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 


1,085


1,085

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
377


15,080


15,457

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
66


338


404

Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 


(3,753
)

(3,753
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 


1,535


1,535

Equity accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

(10,942
)

10,942


Dividends received from subsidiaries
 

3,490


(3,490
)

Interest receivable
 
(42
)
(215
)
(1,776
)
1,565

(468
)
Interest received
 
42

215

1,656

(1,565
)
348

Finance costs
 
8

1,326

2,759

(1,565
)
2,528

Interest paid
 
(8
)
(1,326
)
(2,159
)
1,565

(1,928
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(95
)
222


127

Share-based payments
 

671

19


690

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 

(183
)
(203
)

(386
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
33


953


986

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
(62
)

734


672

(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
(72
)
165

(951
)
(2,000
)
(2,858
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
(491
)
4,509

(6,595
)

(2,577
)
Income taxes paid
 
(133
)

(5,579
)

(5,712
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
798

7,057

20,508

(5,490
)
22,873

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
(273
)

(16,434
)

(16,707
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 


(6,986
)

(6,986
)
Investment in joint ventures
 


(382
)

(382
)
Investment in associates
 


(1,013
)

(1,013
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
(273
)

(24,815
)

(25,088
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 


940


940

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 
1,475


436


1,911

Proceeds from loan repayments
 


666


666

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
1,202


(22,773
)

(21,571
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase of shares
 

(355
)


(355
)
Lease liability payments
 


(35
)

(35
)
Proceeds from long-term financing
 


9,038


9,038

Repayments of long-term financing
 


(7,175
)

(7,175
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 


1,317


1,317

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
(2,000
)
(6,699
)
(3,490
)
5,490

(6,699
)
Non-controlling interests
 


(170
)

(170
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
(2,000
)
(7,054
)
(515
)
5,490

(4,079
)
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 


(330
)

(330
)
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 

3

(3,110
)

(3,107
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 

10

25,565


25,575

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 

13

22,455


22,468


230
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Cash flow statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
438

3,387

7,800

(4,445
)
7,180

Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 


1,603


1,603

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
735


14,849


15,584

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(71
)
(9
)
77

9

6

Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 


(2,507
)

(2,507
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 


1,253


1,253

Equity accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

(4,436
)

4,436


Dividends received from (paid to) subsidiaries
 

3,183


(3,183
)

Interest receivable
 
(11
)
(220
)
(1,117
)
1,044

(304
)
Interest received
 
11

220

1,188

(1,044
)
375

Finance costs
 
6

826

2,286

(1,044
)
2,074

Interest paid
 
(6
)
(826
)
(1,784
)
1,044

(1,572
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(15
)
235


220

Share-based payments
 

595

66


661

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 

(145
)
(249
)

(394
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
(128
)

2,234


2,106

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
(25
)

(823
)

(848
)
(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
108

522

(5,478
)

(4,848
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
(830
)
3,374

(200
)

2,344

Income taxes paid
 


(4,002
)

(4,002
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
227

6,456

15,431

(3,183
)
18,931

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
(321
)

(16,241
)

(16,562
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 


(327
)

(327
)
Investment in joint ventures
 


(50
)

(50
)
Investment in associates
 


(901
)

(901
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
(321
)

(17,519
)

(17,840
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
94


2,842


2,936

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 


478


478

Proceeds from loan repayments
 


349


349

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
(227
)

(13,850
)

(14,077
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net issue (repurchase) of shares
 

(343
)


(343
)
Lease liability payments
 


(45
)

(45
)
Proceeds from long-term financing
 


8,712


8,712

Repayments of long-term financing
 


(6,231
)

(6,231
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 


(158
)

(158
)
Net increase (decrease) in non-controlling interests
 


1,063


1,063

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 

(6,153
)
(3,183
)
3,183

(6,153
)
Non-controlling interests
 


(141
)

(141
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 

(6,496
)
17

3,183

(3,296
)
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 


544


544

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 

(40
)
2,142


2,102

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 

50

23,434


23,484

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 

10

25,576


25,586




 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
231


Supplementary information on oil and natural gas (unaudited)
The regional analysis presented below is on a continent basis, with separate disclosure for countries that contain 15% or more of the total proved reserves (for subsidiaries plus equity-accounted entities), in accordance with SEC and FASB requirements.
Oil and gas reserves – certain definitions
Unless the context indicates otherwise, the following terms have the meanings shown below:
Proved oil and gas reserves
Proved oil and gas reserves are those quantities of oil and gas, which, by analysis of geoscience and engineering data, can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible – from a given date forward, from known reservoirs, and under existing economic conditions, operating methods, and government regulations – prior to the time at which contracts providing the right to operate expire, unless evidence indicates that renewal is reasonably certain, regardless of whether deterministic or probabilistic methods are used for the estimation. The project to extract the hydrocarbons must have commenced or the operator must be reasonably certain that it will commence the project within a reasonable time.
(i)
The area of the reservoir considered as proved includes:
(A) The area identified by drilling and limited by fluid contacts, if any; and
(B) Adjacent undrilled portions of the reservoir that can, with reasonable certainty, be judged to be continuous with it and to contain economically producible oil or gas on the basis of available geoscience and engineering data.
(ii)
In the absence of data on fluid contacts, proved quantities in a reservoir are limited by the lowest known hydrocarbons (LKH) as seen in a well penetration unless geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establishes a lower contact with reasonable certainty.
(iii)
Where direct observation from well penetrations has defined a highest known oil (HKO) elevation and the potential exists for an associated gas cap, proved oil reserves may be assigned in the structurally higher portions of the reservoir only if geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establish the higher contact with reasonable certainty.
(iv)
Reserves which can be produced economically through application of improved recovery techniques (including, but not limited to, fluid injection) are included in the proved classification when:
(A) Successful testing by a pilot project in an area of the reservoir with properties no more favourable than in the reservoir as a whole, the operation of an installed programme in the reservoir or an analogous reservoir, or other evidence using reliable technology establishes the reasonable certainty of the engineering analysis on which the project or programme was based; and
(B) The project has been approved for development by all necessary parties and entities, including governmental entities.
(v)
Existing economic conditions include prices and costs at which economic producibility from a reservoir is to be determined. The price shall be the average price during the 12-month period prior to the ending date of the period covered by the report, determined as an unweighted arithmetic average of the first-day-of-the-month price for each month within such period, unless prices are defined by contractual arrangements, excluding escalations based upon future conditions.
Undeveloped oil and gas reserves
Undeveloped oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that are expected to be recovered from new wells on undrilled acreage, or from existing wells where a relatively major expenditure is required for recompletion.
(i)
Reserves on undrilled acreage shall be limited to those directly offsetting development spacing areas that are reasonably certain of production when drilled, unless evidence using reliable technology exists that establishes reasonable certainty of economic producibility at greater distances.
(ii)
Undrilled locations can be classified as having undeveloped reserves only if a development plan has been adopted indicating that they are scheduled to be drilled within five years, unless the specific circumstances, justify a longer time.
(iii)
Under no circumstances shall estimates for undeveloped reserves be attributable to any acreage for which an application of fluid injection or other improved recovery technique is contemplated, unless such techniques have been proved effective by actual projects in the same reservoir or an analogous reservoir, or by other evidence using reliable technology establishing reasonable certainty.
Developed oil and gas reserves
Developed oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that can be expected to be recovered:
(i)
Through existing wells with existing equipment and operating methods or in which the cost of the required equipment is relatively minor compared to the cost of a new well; and
(ii)
Through installed extraction equipment and infrastructure operational at the time of the reserves estimate if the extraction is by means not involving a well.
For details on BP’s proved reserves and production compliance and governance processes, see pages 308-313.


232
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe
US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 
31,655


67,319

3,421

15,194

48,150


42,629

6,300

214,668

Unproved properties
 
425


3,106

2,547

3,262

3,495


1,865

606

15,306

 
 
32,080


70,425

5,968

18,456

51,645


44,494

6,906

229,974

Accumulated depreciation
 
18,481


35,379

409

9,922

35,572


22,481

3,924

126,168

Net capitalized costs
 
13,599


35,046

5,559

8,534

16,073


22,013

2,982

103,806

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of properties
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 
2


5





188


195

Unproved
 
13


50

1

220

18




302

 
 
15


55

1

220

18


188


497

Exploration and appraisal costsc
 
128


271

15

220

417

2

171

61

1,285

Development
 
717


4,047

33

737

2,530


2,614

137

10,815

Total costs
 
860


4,373

49

1,177

2,965

2

2,973

198

12,597

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decembera
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 
229


1,780

274

1,620

2,736

2

1,588

1,142

9,371

Sales between businesses
 
2,345


10,785

1

142

2,815


7,596

554

24,238

 
 
2,574


12,565

275

1,762

5,551

2

9,184

1,696

33,609

Exploration expenditure
 
157


233

13

124

222

2

187

26

964

Production costs
 
607


2,742

118

437

1,045


961

131

6,041

Production taxes
 
(75
)

315


293



951

63

1,547

Other costs (income)e
 
(308
)

2,527

67

92

33

42

(124
)
153

2,482

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
1,383


4,456

118

1,056

3,806

2

2,384

297

13,502

Net impairments and (gains) losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
483

(10
)
5,726

(1
)
160

151


1


6,510

 
 
2,247

(10
)
15,999

315

2,162

5,257

46

4,360

670

31,046

Profit (loss) before taxationf
 
327

10

(3,434
)
(40
)
(400
)
294

(44
)
4,824

1,026

2,563

Allocable taxes
 
(141
)

(776
)
(76
)
(234
)
593

(8
)
3,078

392

2,828

Results of operations
 
468

10

(2,658
)
36

(166
)
(299
)
(36
)
1,746

634

(265
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
 
 
 
Exploration and production activities – subsidiaries (as above)
 
327

10

(3,434
)
(40
)
(400
)
294

(44
)
4,824

1,026

2,563

Midstream and other activities – subsidiariesg
 
749

(26
)
(363
)
442

194

(19
)
11

766

9

1,763

Equity-accounted entitiesh
 
(6
)
70

23


65

82

2,460

213


2,907

Total replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
1,070

54

(3,774
)
402

(141
)
357

2,427

5,803

1,035

7,233

a These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of subsidiaries, which includes our share of oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of joint operations. They do not include any costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations are excluded. In addition, our midstream activities of marketing and trading of natural gas, power and NGLs in the US, Canada, UK, Asia and Europe are excluded. The most significant midstream pipeline interests include the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System, the South Caucasus Pipeline and the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan pipeline. Major LNG activities are located in Trinidad, Indonesia, Australia and Angola.
b Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
c Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
d Presented net of transportation costs, purchases and sales taxes.
e Includes property taxes and other government take. The UK region includes a $361-million gain which is offset by corresponding charges primarily in the US region, relating to the group self-insurance programme.
f Excludes the unwinding of the discount on provisions and payables amounting to $439 million which is included in finance costs in the group income statement.
g Midstream and other activities excludes inventory holding gains and losses.
h The profits of equity-accounted entities are included after interest and tax.




 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
233


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decemberb c
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 

4,078



10,376


29,883



44,337

Unproved properties
 

768



93


1,120



1,981

 
 

4,846



10,469


31,003



46,318

Accumulated depreciation
 

1,046



5,078


9,248



15,372

Net capitalized costs
 

3,800



5,391


21,755



30,946

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decemberb d e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 










Unproved
 






58



58

 
 






58



58

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 

120



19


198



337

Development
 

640



675


3,076



4,391

Total costs
 

760



694


3,332



4,786

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decemberb
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 

1,002



1,621





2,623

Sales between businesses
 






15,979



15,979

 
 

1,002



1,621


15,979



18,602

Exploration expenditure
 

92



43


73



208

Production costs
 

216



465


1,535



2,216

Production taxes
 




343


7,861



8,204

Other costs (income)
 

59



16


358



433

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 

323



414


1,773



2,510

Net impairments and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 




(42
)

49



7

 
 

690



1,239


11,649



13,578

Profit (loss) before taxation
 

312



382


4,330



5,024

Allocable taxes
 

229



245


848



1,322

Results of operations
 

83



137


3,482



3,702

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax from equity-accounted entities
Exploration and production activities – equity-accounted entities after tax (as above)
 

83



137


3,482



3,702

Midstream and other activities after taxg
 
(6
)
(13
)
23


(72
)
82

(1,022
)
213


(795
)
Total replacement cost profit (loss) after interest and tax
 
(6
)
70

23


65

82

2,460

213


2,907

a Amounts reported for Russia in this table include BP’s share of Rosneft’s worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia. The amounts reported include the corresponding amounts for their equity-accounted entities.
b These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of equity-accounted entities. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations as well as downstream activities of Rosneft and Pan American Energy Group are excluded.
c Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e The amounts shown reflect BP’s share of equity-accounted entities’ costs incurred, and not the costs incurred by BP in acquiring an interest in equity-accounted entities.
f Presented net of sales tax.
g Includes interest and adjustment for non-controlling interests. Excludes inventory holding gains and losses.

234
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 
29,730


89,069

3,385

14,269

51,980


38,315

6,119

232,867

Unproved properties
 
451


3,602

2,667

2,742

3,870


3,153

568

17,053

 
 
30,181


92,671

6,052

17,011

55,850


41,468

6,687

249,920

Accumulated depreciation
 
16,809


47,051

420

8,517

38,324


20,173

3,626

134,920

Net capitalized costs
 
13,372


45,620

5,632

8,494

17,526


21,295

3,061

115,000

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of properties
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 
1,933


10,650



(1
)

36


12,618

Unproved
 


35


100

50


(5
)

180

 
 
1,933


10,685


100

49


31


12,798

Exploration and appraisal costsc
 
238


216

139

245

283

5

148

24

1,298

Development
 
817


3,429

46

591

2,340


2,458

236

9,917

Total costs
 
2,988


14,330

185

936

2,672

5

2,637

260

24,013

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decembera
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 
619


1,306

105

2,074

3,228


1,430

1,410

10,172

Sales between businesses
 
2,255


11,656

1

195

3,928


7,793

665

26,493

 
 
2,874


12,962

106

2,269

7,156


9,223

2,075

36,665

Exploration expenditure
 
105


509

146

252

405

5

20

3

1,445

Production costs
 
646


2,729

120

430

1,066


951

138

6,080

Production taxes
 
(269
)

369


357



1,010

69

1,536

Other costs (income)e
 
(331
)
(2
)
2,379

43

165

133

42

94

223

2,746

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
1,199


3,921

101

1,023

3,635


2,165

298

12,342

Net impairments and (gains) losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(226
)

203

10


(141
)

21

136

3

 
 
1,124

(2
)
10,110

420

2,227

5,098

47

4,261

867

24,152

Profit (loss) before taxationf
 
1,750

2

2,852

(314
)
42

2,058

(47
)
4,962

1,208

12,513

Allocable taxesg
 
446


454

(95
)
314

1,184

13

3,509

508

6,333

Results of operations
 
1,304

2

2,398

(219
)
(272
)
874

(60
)
1,453

700

6,180

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
 
 
 
Exploration and production activities – subsidiaries (as above)
 
1,750

2

2,852

(314
)
42

2,058

(47
)
4,962

1,208

12,513

Midstream and other activities – subsidiariesh
 
(20
)
265

188

(111
)
135

(58
)
5

463

6

873

Equity-accounted entitiesi j
 
(2
)
130

28


209

207

2,346

245


3,163

Total replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
1,728

397

3,068

(425
)
386

2,207

2,304

5,670

1,214

16,549

a These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of subsidiaries, which includes our share of oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of joint operations. They do not include any costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations are excluded. In addition, our midstream activities of marketing and trading of natural gas, power and NGLs in the US, Canada, UK, Asia and Europe are excluded. The most significant midstream pipeline interests include the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System, the South Caucasus Pipeline and the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan pipeline. Major LNG activities are located in Trinidad, Indonesia, Australia and Angola.
b Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
c Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
d Presented net of transportation costs, purchases and sales taxes.
e Includes property taxes, other government take and the fair value gain on embedded derivatives of $17 million. The UK region includes a $384-million gain which is offset by corresponding charges primarily in the US region, relating to the group self-insurance programme.
f Excludes the unwinding of the discount on provisions and payables amounting to $208 million which is included in finance costs in the group income statement.
g US region includes the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the US Federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21% enacted in December 2017.
h Midstream and other activities excludes inventory holding gains and losses.
i The profits of equity-accounted entities are included after interest and taxes.
j From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
235


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decemberb c
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 

3,439



9,643


24,052

3,646


40,780

Unproved properties
 

657



86


828

26


1,597

 
 

4,096



9,729


24,880

3,672


42,377

Accumulated depreciation
 

670



4,665


6,749

3,672


15,756

Net capitalized costs
 

3,426



5,064


18,131



26,621

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decemberb d e
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 






425



425

Unproved
 

137





148



285

 
 

137





573



710

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 

67



25


207



299

Development
 

251



575


3,255

212


4,293

Total costs
 

455



600


4,035

212


5,302

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decemberb
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 

1,114



1,792



353


3,259

Sales between businesses
 






15,901



15,901

 
 

1,114



1,792


15,901

353


19,160

Exploration expenditure
 

89



7


112



208

Production costs
 

207



438


1,487

39


2,171

Production taxes
 




361


7,634

94


8,089

Other costs (income)
 

21



55


638



714

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 

290



416


1,627

212


2,545

Net impairments and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 

6





47

1


54

 
 

613



1,277


11,545

346


13,781

Profit (loss) before taxation
 

501



515


4,356

7


5,379

Allocable taxes
 

350



321


849



1,520

Results of operationsg
 

151



194


3,507

7


3,859

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax from equity-accounted entities
Exploration and production activities – equity-accounted entities after tax (as above)
 

151



194


3,507

7


3,859

Midstream and other activities after taxh
 
(2
)
(21
)
28


15

207

(1,161
)
238


(696
)
Total replacement cost profit (loss) after interest and tax
 
(2
)
130

28


209

207

2,346

245


3,163

a Amounts reported for Russia in this table include BP’s share of Rosneft’s worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia. The amounts reported include the corresponding amounts for their equity-accounted entities.
b These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of equity-accounted entities. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations as well as downstream activities of Rosneft and Pan American Energy Group are excluded.
c Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e The amounts shown reflect BP’s share of equity-accounted entities’ costs incurred, and not the costs incurred by BP in acquiring an interest in equity-accounted entities.
f Presented net of sales taxes.
g From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation.
h Includes interest and adjustment for non-controlling interests. Excludes inventory holding gains and losses.



236
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 
34,208


83,449

3,518

13,581

49,795


35,519

5,984

226,054

Unproved properties
 
481


3,957

2,561

2,905

4,013


3,407

562

17,886

 
 
34,689


87,406

6,079

16,486

53,808


38,926

6,546

243,940

Accumulated depreciation
 
21,793


48,462

367

7,495

34,870


18,007

3,192

134,186

Net capitalized costs
 
12,896


38,944

5,712

8,991

18,938


20,919

3,354

109,754

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of properties
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 


22



564


1,187


1,773

Unproved
 
13


13


330

374


228


958

 
 
13


35


330

938


1,415


2,731

Exploration and appraisal costsc
 
336


102

52

264

682

11

190

18

1,655

Development
 
995


2,776

58

911

2,972


2,760

223

10,695

Total costs
 
1,344


2,913

110

1,505

4,592

11

4,365

241

15,081

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decembera
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 
204


724

171

1,134

2,211


1,276

967

6,687

Sales between businesses
 
1,745


9,117

2

327

4,022


6,394

487

22,094

 
 
1,949


9,841

173

1,461

6,233


7,670

1,454

28,781

Exploration expenditure
 
331


282

39

83

1,346

11

(29
)
17

2,080

Production costs
 
629


2,256

116

573

979


904

157

5,614

Production taxes
 
(37
)

52


86



1,618

56

1,775

Other costs (income)e
 
(272
)
2

1,655

34

71

280

39

311

349

2,469

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
1,190


4,258

96

742

3,586


2,147

366

12,385

Net impairments and (gains) losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
133

(12
)
87

(1
)
(31
)


(10
)
13

179

 
 
1,974

(10
)
8,590

284

1,524

6,191

50

4,941

958

24,502

Profit (loss) before taxationf
 
(25
)
10

1,251

(111
)
(63
)
42

(50
)
2,729

496

4,279

Allocable taxesg
 
(104
)

(1,811
)
(28
)
155

788

(19
)
1,505

146

632

Results of operations
 
79

10

3,062

(83
)
(218
)
(746
)
(31
)
1,224

350

3,647

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
Exploration and production activities – subsidiaries (as above)
 
(25
)
10

1,251

(111
)
(63
)
42

(50
)
2,729

496

4,279

Midstream and other activities – subsidiariesh
 
(185
)
97

(176
)
(111
)
140

(80
)
3

315

11

14

Equity-accounted entitiesi j
 

71

25


381

205

837

245


1,764

Total replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
(210
)
178

1,100

(222
)
458

167

790

3,289

507

6,057

a These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of subsidiaries, which includes our share of oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of joint operations. They do not include any costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations are excluded. In addition, our midstream activities of marketing and trading of natural gas, power and NGLs in the US, Canada, UK, Asia and Europe are excluded. The most significant midstream pipeline interests include the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System, the South Caucasus Pipeline, the Forties Pipeline System and the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan pipeline. The Forties Pipeline System was divested on 31 October 2017. Major LNG activities are located in Trinidad, Indonesia, Australia and Angola.
b Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
c Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
d Presented net of transportation costs, purchases and sales taxes.
e Includes property taxes, other government take and the fair value gain on embedded derivatives of $32 million. The UK region includes a $343-million gain which is offset by corresponding charges primarily in the US region, relating to the group self-insurance programme.
f Excludes the unwinding of the discount on provisions and payables amounting to $120 million which is included in finance costs in the group income statement.
g US region includes the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the US Federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21% enacted in December 2017.
h Midstream and other activities excludes inventory holding gains and losses.
i The profits of equity-accounted entities are included after interest and tax.
j From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation. Of BP's initial 60% interest in PAE, 10% was classified as held for sale on 9 September 2017. For September, only 9 days of income was reported for the full 60%. After this equity accounting continued for the 50% not classified as held for sale. BP accounted for 50% of the enlarged entity from 16 December 2017.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
237


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decemberb c
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 

3,187



9,096


24,686

3,434


40,403

Unproved properties
 

481



68


907

26


1,482

 
 

3,668



9,164


25,593

3,460


41,885

Accumulated depreciation
 

400



4,249


6,207

3,460


14,316

Net capitalized costs
 

3,268



4,915


19,386



27,569

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decemberb d e
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 

323





653



976

Unproved
 

152



20


416



588

 
 

475



20


1,069



1,564

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 

49



43


194



286

Development
 

199



576


3,361

446


4,582

Total costs
 

723



639


4,624

446


6,432

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decemberb
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 

773



1,750



988


3,511

Sales between businesses
 






11,537



11,537

 
 

773



1,750


11,537

988


15,048

Exploration expenditure
 

68





59



127

Production costs
 

157



592


1,424

117


2,290

Production taxes
 




336


5,712

426


6,474

Other costs (income)
 

67



11


409

(5
)

482

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 

328



458


1,539

446


2,771

Net impairments and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 

6



27


54



87

 
 

626



1,424


9,197

984


12,231

Profit (loss) before taxation
 

147



326


2,340

4


2,817

Allocable taxes
 

54



(18
)

457



493

Results of operationsg
 

93



344


1,883

4


2,324

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax from equity-accounted entities
Exploration and production activities – equity-accounted entities after tax (as above)
 

93



344


1,883

4


2,324

Midstream and other activities after taxh
 

(22
)
25


37

205

(1,046
)
241


(560
)
Total replacement cost profit (loss) after interest and tax
 

71

25


381

205

837

245


1,764

a Amounts reported for Russia in this table include BP’s share of Rosneft’s worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia. The amounts reported include the corresponding amounts for their equity-accounted entities.
b These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of equity-accounted entities. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations as well as downstream activities of Rosneft and Pan American Energy Group are excluded.
c Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e The amounts shown reflect BP’s share of equity-accounted entities’ costs incurred, and not the costs incurred by BP in acquiring an interest in equity-accounted entities.
f Presented net of sales taxes.
g From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation. Of BP's initial 60% interest in PAE, 10% was classified as held for sale on 9 September 2017. For September, only 9 days of income was reported for the full 60%. After this equity accounting continued for the 50% not classified as held for sale. BP accounted for 50% of the enlarged entity from 16 December 2017.
h Includes interest and adjustment for non-controlling interests. Excludes inventory holding gains and losses.



238
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Crude oila b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc d

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
223


962

43

8

223


1,126

30

2,615

Undeveloped
 
243


802

190

5

36


482

5

1,763

 
 
466


1,764

234

14

259


1,608

34

4,378

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
(23
)

72

(8
)
1

39


104

2

187

Improved recovery
 


189

1






191

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 







1


1

Discoveries and extensions
 


34





11


45

Production
 
(36
)

(143
)
(9
)
(3
)
(57
)

(125
)
(6
)
(378
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 


(12
)


(45
)



(57
)
 
 
(59
)

141

(16
)
(2
)
(63
)

(9
)
(4
)
(12
)
At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
206


1,063

40

7

156


1,074

26

2,572

Undeveloped
 
200


842

179

5

40


525

4

1,794

 
 
406


1,905

218

12

196


1,599

30

4,367

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

57



293

1

3,190



3,541

Undeveloped
 

100


19

259


2,414



2,792

 
 

157


19

552

1

5,604



6,333

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2


1

(13
)
1

158



147

Improved recovery
 

4








4

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






7



7

Discoveries and extensions
 




33


277



310

Production
 

(13
)


(24
)

(345
)


(382
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(6
)


(6
)
 
 

(7
)

1

(4
)
1

91



81

At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

115



291

2

3,159



3,567

Undeveloped
 

35


20

257


2,535



2,847

 
 

150


20

548

2

5,695



6,415

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
223

57

962

43

302

224

3,190

1,126

30

6,156

Undeveloped
 
243

100

802

209

264

36

2,414

482

5

4,555

 
 
466

157

1,764

253

566

260

5,604

1,608

34

10,711

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
206

115

1,063

40

298

158

3,159

1,074

26

6,140

Undeveloped
 
200

35

842

198

262

40

2,535

525

4

4,642

 
 
406

150

1,905

238

560

198

5,695

1,599

30

10,781

a Crude oil includes condensate and bitumen. Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 4.5 million barrels upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Includes 362 million barrels of crude oil associated with Assets Held for Sale in the USA.
e Includes 4 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 346 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 6.17% non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 26 mmbbl held through BP's interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
h Total proved crude oil reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,604 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Egypt, Vietnam, Iraq and Canada, 35 million barrels in Venezuela and 5,568 million barrels in Russia.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
239


Movements in estimated net proved reserves - continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Natural gas liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8


266


2

14



5

295

Undeveloped
 
6


246


25

4




280

 
 
14


511


27

18



5

576

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 


(46
)

(1
)




(47
)
Improved recovery
 
1


62







63

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 


1







1

Productiond
 
(1
)

(33
)

(3
)
(3
)


(1
)
(41
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 


(17
)






(17
)
 
 
(1
)

(32
)

(4
)
(3
)


(1
)
(41
)
At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8


229


2

12



4

255

Undeveloped
 
5


250


21

4




280

 
 
13


479


23

16



4

535

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




7

103



114

Undeveloped
 

3





51



54

 
 

7




7

154



169

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 




3

5

(11
)


(3
)
Improved recovery
 

1








1

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 










Production
 

(1
)



(2
)
(2
)


(4
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 




2

4

(13
)


(7
)
At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

5



2

11

89



107

Undeveloped
 

3





52



55

 
 

7



2

11

141



162

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8

4

266


2

22

103


5

409

Undeveloped
 
6

3

246


25

4

51



335

 
 
14

7

511


27

26

154


5

744

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8

5

229


4

23

89


4

363

Undeveloped
 
5

3

250


21

4

52



334

 
 
13

7

479


25

27

141


4

697

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Includes 94 million barrels of NGL associated with Assets Held for Sale in the USA.
d Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
e Includes 7 million barrels of NGL in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 11 million barrels of NGLs in respect of the 7.90% non-controlling interest in Rosneft.
h Total proved NGL reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 141 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Egypt, Venezuela, Vietnam and Canada, and 141 million barrels in Russia.



240
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves - continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Total liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc d

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
231


1,228

43

10

237


1,126

35

2,910

Undeveloped
 
249


1,048

190

30

40


482

5

2,044

 
 
480


2,276

234

41

277


1,608

39

4,954

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
(24
)

26

(8
)

40


104

2

140

Improved recovery
 
1


252

1






254

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 







1


1

Discoveries and extensions
 


35





11


46

Productione
 
(38
)

(176
)
(9
)
(6
)
(60
)

(125
)
(7
)
(420
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 


(28
)


(45
)



(74
)
 
 
(60
)

109

(16
)
(6
)
(65
)

(9
)
(5
)
(52
)
At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
214


1,292

40

9

168


1,074

30

2,828

Undeveloped
 
205


1,092

179

26

43


525

4

2,074

 
 
420


2,384

218

35

212


1,599

34

4,902

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



293

8

3,293



3,655

Undeveloped
 

104


19

259


2,465



2,846

 
 

164


19

552

8

5,758



6,502

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2


1

(11
)
7

146



145

Improved recovery
 

5








5

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






7



7

Discoveries and extensions
 




33


277



310

Production
 

(14
)


(24
)
(2
)
(346
)


(386
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(6
)


(6
)
 
 

(7
)

1

(1
)
5

78



75

At 31 Decemberh i
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

120



293

13

3,248



3,675

Undeveloped
 

37


20

257


2,588



2,902

 
 

157


20

550

13

5,836



6,576

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
231

60

1,228

44

303

245

3,293

1,126

35

6,565

Undeveloped
 
249

104

1,048

209

289

40

2,465

482

5

4,890

 
 
480

164

2,276

253

593

285

5,758

1,608

39

11,456

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
214

120

1,292

40

302

181

3,248

1,074

30

6,502

Undeveloped
 
205

37

1,092

198

283

43

2,588

525

4

4,976

 
 
420

157

2,384

238

585

224

5,836

1,599

34

11,478

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 4.5 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Includes 456 million barrels associated with Assets Held for Sale in the USA.
e Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
f Also includes 11 million barrels in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
g Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
h Includes 357 million barrels in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 26 mmboe held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
i Total proved liquid reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,745 million barrels, comprising 35 million barrels in Venezuela, less than 1 million barrels in Iraq, Canada, Egypt and Vietnam and 5,709 million barrels in Russia.

                  

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
241


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
billion cubic feet
 
Natural gasa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
439


6,270


2,168

1,313


3,599

2,630

16,420

Undeveloped
 
343


5,056


3,073

1,067


3,218

1,179

13,936

 
 
782


11,326


5,241

2,380


6,817

3,809

30,355

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
(34
)

(1,877
)
1

(263
)
(4
)

285

(129
)
(2,022
)
Improved recovery
 
9


307







315

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 







50


50

Discoveries and extensions
 


11


178



299


488

Productiond
 
(57
)

(923
)
(1
)
(729
)
(450
)

(383
)
(291
)
(2,834
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 


(386
)


(21
)



(406
)
 
 
(82
)

(2,869
)

(814
)
(475
)

251

(420
)
(4,410
)
At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
493


6,330


2,192

1,163


3,667

2,256

16,101

Undeveloped
 
207


2,127


2,235

742


3,401

1,132

9,844

 
 
700


8,458


4,427

1,905


7,068

3,389

25,946

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

107



1,207

391

7,798

12


9,515

Undeveloped
 

55


4

446

143

8,719

4


9,369

 
 

161


4

1,653

534

16,517

15


18,884

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

9


3

(120
)
38

789



718

Improved recovery
 

15








15

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 




180


534



714

Productiond
 

(22
)


(135
)
(65
)
(448
)
(5
)

(676
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

2


3

(75
)
(27
)
874

(5
)

772

At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

108



1,130

507

9,324

10


11,079

Undeveloped
 

56


6

447


8,067



8,576

 
 

164


6

1,577

507

17,391

10


19,656

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
439

107

6,270


3,375

1,704

7,798

3,610

2,630

25,934

Undeveloped
 
343

55

5,056

4

3,519

1,210

8,719

3,221

1,179

23,305

 
 
782

161

11,326

4

6,894

2,914

16,517

6,832

3,809

49,239

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
493

108

6,330


3,323

1,670

9,324

3,677

2,256

27,181

Undeveloped
 
207

56

2,127

6

2,682

742

8,067

3,401

1,132

18,421

 
 
700

164

8,458

6

6,004

2,412

17,391

7,078

3,389

45,601

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Includes 3,054 billion cubic feet of natural gas associated with Assets Held for Sale in the USA.
d Includes 188 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations, 146 billion cubic feet in subsidiaries, 42 billion cubic feet in equity-accounted entities.
e Includes 1,330 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 1,433 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 9.72% non-controlling interest in Rosneft including 569 billion cubic feet held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
h Total proved gas reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 14,705 billion cubic feet, comprising 28 billion cubic feet in Venezuela, 10 billion cubic feet in Vietnam, 171 billion cubic feet in Egypt and 14,495 billion cubic feet in Russia.

               

242
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
million barrels of oil equivalentc
 
Total hydrocarbonsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USd e

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
307


2,309

43

384

464


1,746

488

5,741

Undeveloped
 
308


1,919

190

560

224


1,037

208

4,447

 
 
615


4,228

234

944

687


2,783

696

10,188

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
(29
)

(297
)
(8
)
(45
)
39


153

(21
)
(208
)
Improved recovery
 
3


305

1






309

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 







10


10

Discoveries and extensions
 


36


31



63


130

Productionf g
 
(48
)

(335
)
(9
)
(131
)
(137
)

(191
)
(57
)
(908
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 


(95
)


(49
)



(144
)
 
 
(74
)

(386
)
(16
)
(146
)
(147
)

35

(78
)
(813
)
At 31 Decemberh
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
300


2,384

40

387

369


1,707

419

5,604

Undeveloped
 
241


1,459

179

411

171


1,111

199

3,771

 
 
540


3,842

218

798

540


2,818

618

9,375

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)i
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

79



501

76

4,638

2


5,296

Undeveloped
 

113


20

336

25

3,968

1


4,462

 
 

192


20

837

101

8,605

3


9,757

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

4


1

(31
)
13

282



269

Improved recovery
 

7








7

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






7



7

Discoveries and extensions
 




64


369



434

Productionf
 

(17
)


(47
)
(13
)
(424
)
(1
)

(503
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(6
)


(6
)
 
 

(6
)

1

(14
)

229

(1
)

208

At 31 Decemberj k
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

139



488

100

4,856

2


5,585

Undeveloped
 

47


21

334


3,978



4,381

 
 

186


21

822

100

8,834

2


9,965

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
307

79

2,309

44

885

539

4,638

1,749

488

11,037

Undeveloped
 
308

113

1,919

210

896

249

3,968

1,037

208

8,908

 
 
615

192

4,228

253

1,781

788

8,605

2,786

696

19,945

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
300

139

2,384

40

875

469

4,856

1,708

419

11,189

Undeveloped
 
241

47

1,459

199

746

171

3,978

1,112

199

8,152

 
 
540

186

3,842

239

1,621

640

8,834

2,820

618

19,341

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 5.8 billion cubic feet of natural gas = 1 million barrels of oil equivalent.
d Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 4.5 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e Includes 982 million barrels of oil equivalent associated with Assets Held for Sale in the USA.
f Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
g Includes 32 million barrels of oil equivalent of natural gas consumed in operations, 25 million barrels of oil equivalent in subsidiaries, 7 million barrels of oil equivalent in equity-accounted entities.
h Includes 240 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
i Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
j Includes 603 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 124 mmboe held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
k Total proved reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 8,281 million barrels of oil equivalent, comprising less than 1 million barrels of oil equivalent in Iraq and Canada, 40 million barrels of oil equivalent in Venezuela, 2 million barrels of oil equivalent in Vietnam, 30 million barrels of oil equivalent in Egypt and 8,208 million barrels of oil equivalent in Russia.

    

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
243


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Crude oila b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245


932

54

10

281


1,040

31

2,592

Undeveloped
 
164


492

195

6

28


642

11

1,537

 
 
409


1,423

248

16

309


1,682

42

4,129

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
22


116

(6
)
1

11


40

(2
)
183

Improved recovery
 


51



1




52

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
93


412







504

Discoveries and extensions
 
15


17



13




46

Production
 
(37
)

(137
)
(9
)
(3
)
(75
)

(114
)
(6
)
(381
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(37
)

(118
)






(155
)
 
 
57


341

(15
)
(2
)
(50
)

(74
)
(8
)
249

At 31 Decemberd e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
223


962

43

8

223


1,126

30

2,615

Undeveloped
 
243


802

190

5

36


482

5

1,763

 
 
466


1,764

234

14

259


1,608

34

4,378

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

56



285

1

3,124

6


3,473

Undeveloped
 

89



263


2,251



2,603

 
 

145



548

1

5,374

6


6,076

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

11



7


150



168

Improved recovery
 

13








13

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






89



89

Discoveries and extensions
 



19

21


326



366

Production
 

(13
)


(25
)

(335
)
(6
)

(379
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

12


19

4

(1
)
229

(6
)

257

At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

57



293

1

3,190



3,541

Undeveloped
 

100


19

259


2,414



2,792

 
 

157


19

552

1

5,604



6,333

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245

56

932

54

295

282

3,124

1,047

31

6,064

Undeveloped
 
164

89

492

195

269

28

2,251

642

11

4,140

 
 
409

145

1,423

249

564

310

5,374

1,688

42

10,205

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
223

57

962

43

302

224

3,190

1,126

30

6,156

Undeveloped
 
243

100

802

209

264

36

2,414

482

5

4,555

 
 
466

157

1,764

253

566

260

5,604

1,608

34

10,711

a Crude oil includes condensate and bitumen. Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Includes 4 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 344 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 6.28% non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 24 mmbbl held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
g Total proved crude oil reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,539 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and Canada, 58 million barrels in Venezuela and 5,481 million barrels in Russia.


244
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Natural gas liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11


177


2

21



5

216

Undeveloped
 
3


69


28




1

102

 
 
14


246


30

21



6

318

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
1


20



(3
)



17

Improved recovery
 


16



2




18

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 


253







253

Discoveries and extensions
 
3


1



3




7

Productionc
 
(2
)

(25
)

(3
)
(3
)


(1
)
(34
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(3
)








(3
)
 
 


265


(3
)
(2
)


(1
)
258

At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8


266


2

14



5

295

Undeveloped
 
6


246


25

4




280

 
 
14


511


27

18



5

576

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




10

82



97

Undeveloped
 

4





49



53

 
 

8




10

131



149

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 





(1
)
25



23

Improved recovery
 










Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 










Production
 

(1
)



(1
)
(2
)


(4
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

(1
)



(3
)
23



19

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




7

103



114

Undeveloped
 

3





51



54

 
 

7




7

154



169

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11

4

177


2

31

82


5

313

Undeveloped
 
3

4

69


28


49


1

154

 
 
14

8

246


30

31

131


6

467

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8

4

266


2

22

103


5

409

Undeveloped
 
6

3

246


25

4

51



335

 
 
14

7

511


27

26

154


5

744

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
d Includes 8 million barrels of NGL in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 12 million barrels of NGLs in respect of the 7.82% non-controlling interest in Rosneft.
g Total proved NGL reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 154 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Venezuela, Vietnam and Canada, and 154 million barrels in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
245


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
million barrels
 
Total liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256


1,108

54

12

301


1,040

36

2,808

Undeveloped
 
167


561

195

34

28


642

12

1,639

 
 
424


1,669

248

46

329


1,682

48

4,447

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
23


136

(6
)
1

8


40

(2
)
200

Improved recovery
 


67



3




70

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
93


665







758

Discoveries and extensions
 
18


18



16




52

Productiond
 
(39
)

(162
)
(9
)
(6
)
(79
)

(114
)
(7
)
(415
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(40
)

(118
)






(158
)
 
 
56


606

(15
)
(5
)
(52
)

(74
)
(9
)
507

At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
231


1,228

43

10

237


1,126

35

2,910

Undeveloped
 
249


1,048

190

30

40


482

5

2,044

 
 
480


2,276

234

41

277


1,608

39

4,954

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



285

11

3,206

6


3,569

Undeveloped
 

93



263


2,300



2,656

 
 

153



548

12

5,505

6


6,225

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

11



7

(2
)
175



191

Improved recovery
 

13








13

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






89



89

Discoveries and extensions
 



19

21


326



366

Production
 

(13
)


(25
)
(2
)
(337
)
(6
)

(383
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

11


19

4

(3
)
253

(6
)

277

At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



293

8

3,293



3,655

Undeveloped
 

104


19

259


2,465



2,846

 
 

164


19

552

8

5,758



6,502

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256

60

1,108

54

297

313

3,206

1,047

36

6,377

Undeveloped
 
167

93

561

195

297

28

2,300

642

12

4,295

 
 
424

153

1,669

249

594

341

5,505

1,688

48

10,672

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
231

60

1,228

44

303

245

3,293

1,126

35

6,565

Undeveloped
 
249

104

1,048

209

289

40

2,465

482

5

4,890

 
 
480

164

2,276

253

593

285

5,758

1,608

39

11,456

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
e Also includes 12 million barrels in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 356 million barrels in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 24 mmboe held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
h Total proved liquid reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,693 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Canada, 58 million barrels in Venezuela, less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and 5,635 million barrels in Russia.

246
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
billion cubic feet
 
Natural gasa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia

Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523


5,238

(1
)
2,862

1,159


2,755

2,730

15,266

Undeveloped
 
320


3,086


3,330

1,510


4,245

1,505

13,997

 
 
843


8,323

(1
)
6,193

2,670


7,000

4,235

29,263

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
84


10

3

(195
)
(444
)

140

(123
)
(524
)
Improved recovery
 


1,315







1,315

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
40


2,655







2,695

Discoveries and extensions
 
60


11


31

578




680

Productionc
 
(66
)

(751
)
(3
)
(788
)
(423
)

(324
)
(303
)
(2,658
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(178
)

(237
)






(416
)
 
 
(61
)

3,003

1

(951
)
(290
)

(184
)
(426
)
1,092

At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
439


6,270


2,168

1,313


3,599

2,630

16,420

Undeveloped
 
343


5,056


3,073

1,067


3,218

1,179

13,936

 
 
782


11,326


5,241

2,380


6,817

3,809

30,355

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

112



1,274

476

6,077

17


7,955

Undeveloped
 

69



450

146

7,173

3


7,841

 
 

180



1,724

622

13,250

20


15,796

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2



(50
)
(39
)
805

2


719

Improved recovery
 




1





1

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






2,413



2,413

Discoveries and extensions
 



4

122


512



638

Productionc
 

(22
)


(145
)
(48
)
(464
)
(6
)

(685
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

(19
)

3

(71
)
(87
)
3,267

(5
)

3,087

At 31 Decemberf g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

107



1,207

391

7,798

12


9,515

Undeveloped
 

55


4

446

143

8,719

4


9,369

 
 

161


4

1,653

534

16,517

15


18,884

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523

112

5,238


4,136

1,635

6,077

2,771

2,730

23,221

Undeveloped
 
320

69

3,086


3,781

1,656

7,173

4,249

1,505

21,838

 
 
843

180

8,323


7,917

3,291

13,250

7,020

4,235

45,060

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
439

107

6,270


3,375

1,704

7,798

3,610

2,630

25,934

Undeveloped
 
343

55

5,056

4

3,519

1,210

8,719

3,221

1,179

23,305

 
 
782

161

11,326

4

6,894

2,914

16,517

6,832

3,809

49,239

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Includes 181 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations, 139 billion cubic feet in subsidiaries, 42 billion cubic feet in equity-accounted entities.
d Includes 1,573 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 1,211 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 8.60% non-controlling interest in Rosneft including 480 billion cubic feet held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
g Total proved gas reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 14,325 billion cubic feet, comprising 0 billion cubic feet in Canada, 26 billion cubic feet in Venezuela, 15 billion cubic feet in Vietnam, 200 billion cubic feet in Egypt and 14,084 billion cubic feet in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
247


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels of oil equivalent c
 
Total hydrocarbonsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USd

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347


2,011

54

505

501


1,515

507

5,440

Undeveloped
 
222


1,093

195

608

288


1,374

272

4,052

 
 
569


3,104

248

1,114

790


2,889

779

9,492

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
38


138

(5
)
(33
)
(69
)

64

(23
)
110

Improved recovery
 


294



3




297

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
100


1,123







1,222

Discoveries and extensions
 
29


20


5

116




169

Productione f
 
(50
)

(292
)
(9
)
(142
)
(152
)

(170
)
(59
)
(874
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(70
)

(159
)






(229
)
 
 
46


1,124

(15
)
(169
)
(102
)

(106
)
(82
)
696

At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
307


2,309

43

384

464


1,746

488

5,741

Undeveloped
 
308


1,919

190

560

224


1,037

208

4,447

 
 
615


4,228

234

944

687


2,783

696

10,188

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

80



505

93

4,254

9


4,941

Undeveloped
 

105



341

25

3,536

1


4,008

 
 

184



846

119

7,790

10


8,949

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

11



(1
)
(8
)
313



315

Improved recovery
 

13








14

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






505



505

Discoveries and extensions
 



20

42


414



476

Productione
 

(17
)


(50
)
(10
)
(417
)
(7
)

(501
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

8


19

(9
)
(18
)
816

(7
)

809

At 31 Decemberi j
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

79



501

76

4,638

2


5,296

Undeveloped
 

113


20

336

25

3,968

1


4,462

 
 

192


20

837

101

8,605

3


9,757

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347

80

2,011

54

1,010

595

4,254

1,524

507

10,381

Undeveloped
 
222

105

1,093

195

949

314

3,536

1,374

272

8,060

 
 
569

184

3,104

249

1,959

908

7,790

2,899

779

18,441

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
307

79

2,309

44

885

539

4,638

1,749

488

11,037

Undeveloped
 
308

113

1,919

210

896

249

3,968

1,037

208

8,908

 
 
615

192

4,228

253

1,781

788

8,605

2,786

696

19,945

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 5.8 billion cubic feet of natural gas = 1 million barrels of oil equivalent.
d Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
f Includes 31 million barrels of oil equivalent of natural gas consumed in operations, 24 million barrels of oil equivalent in subsidiaries, 7 million barrels of oil equivalent in equity-accounted entities.
g Includes 283 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
h Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
i Includes 565 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 107 mmboe held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
j Total proved reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 8,163 million barrels of oil equivalent, comprising less than 1 million barrels of oil equivalent in Canada, 62 million barrels of oil equivalent in Venezuela, 3 million barrels of oil equivalent in Vietnam, 35 million barrels of oil equivalent in Egypt and 8,063 million barrels of oil equivalent in Russia.

248
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Crude oila b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
155


826

42

9

317


1,107

32

2,487

Undeveloped
 
274


497

209

11

42


245

14

1,291

 
 
429


1,322

251

20

358


1,352

46

3,778

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
15


208

5

1

35


407

2

673

Improved recovery
 


12



2




14

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
3


1



1




5

Discoveries and extensions
 


12





42


53

Production
 
(29
)

(131
)
(7
)
(5
)
(88
)

(119
)
(6
)
(384
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(9
)








(9
)
 
 
(20
)

101

(2
)
(4
)
(50
)

330

(4
)
351

At 31 Decemberd e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245


932

54

10

281


1,040

31

2,592

Undeveloped
 
164


492

195

6

28


642

11

1,537

 
 
409


1,423

248

16

309


1,682

42

4,129

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

45



321

1

3,162

43


3,573

Undeveloped
 

69



325


2,134

1


2,529

 
 

114



646

1

5,296

44


6,101

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2



1


102

(1
)

104

Improved recovery
 

11



4





16

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

34





37



71

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



22


264



288

Production
 

(11
)


(28
)

(325
)
(36
)

(401
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(5
)


(98
)




(103
)
 
 

31



(98
)

78

(37
)

(25
)
At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

56



285

1

3,124

6


3,473

Undeveloped
 

89



263


2,251



2,603

 
 

145



548

1

5,374

6


6,076

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
155

45

826

42

330

318

3,162

1,150

32

6,060

Undeveloped
 
274

69

497

209

336

42

2,134

246

14

3,819

 
 
429

114

1,322

251

666

360

5,296

1,395

46

9,879

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245

56

932

54

295

282

3,124

1,047

31

6,064

Undeveloped
 
164

89

492

195

269

28

2,251

642

11

4,140

 
 
409

145

1,423

249

564

310

5,374

1,688

42

10,205

a 
Crude oil includes condensate and bitumen. Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Includes 5 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 337 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 6.31% non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmbbl held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
g Total proved crude oil reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,402 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and Canada, 59 million barrels in Venezuela and 5,342 million barrels in Russia.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
249


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Natural gas liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
13


226


5

13



9

266

Undeveloped
 
3


73


28

1



2

107

 
 
16


299


33

14



11

373

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
2


(44
)


11



(4
)
(36
)
Improved recovery
 


15







15

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 


1







1

Productionc
 
(3
)

(24
)

(3
)
(4
)


(1
)
(35
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(1
)








(1
)
 
 
(2
)

(52
)

(3
)
7



(5
)
(55
)
At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11


177


2

21



5

216

Undeveloped
 
3


69


28




1

102

 
 
14


246


30

21



6

318

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

3




11

50



65

Undeveloped
 

2





15



17

 
 

5




11

65



81

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 





1

68



69

Improved recovery
 

1








1

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

2








2

Discoveries and extensions
 










Production
 

(1
)



(1
)
(2
)


(4
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

3




(1
)
66



68

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




10

82



97

Undeveloped
 

4





49



53

 
 

8




10

131



149

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
13

3

226


5

24

50


9

331

Undeveloped
 
3

2

73


28

1

15


2

123

 
 
16

5

299


33

25

65


11

454

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11

4

177


2

31

82


5

313

Undeveloped
 
3

4

69


28


49


1

154

 
 
14

8

246


30

31

131


6

467

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 2 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
d 
Includes 9 million barrels of NGL in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f 
Total proved NGL reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 131 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Venezuela, Vietnam and Canada, and 131 million barrels in Russia.

250
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Total liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
168


1,051

42

14

330


1,107

42

2,753

Undeveloped
 
277


569

209

39

43


245

16

1,398

 
 
445


1,621

251

53

372


1,352

57

4,151

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
17


164

5

1

45


407

(2
)
637

Improved recovery
 


27



2




29

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
3


1



1




5

Discoveries and extensions
 


12





42


54

Productiond
 
(32
)

(155
)
(7
)
(8
)
(92
)

(119
)
(7
)
(419
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(10
)








(10
)
 
 
(22
)

49

(2
)
(7
)
(43
)

330

(9
)
296

At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256


1,108

54

12

301


1,040

36

2,808

Undeveloped
 
167


561

195

34

28


642

12

1,639

 
 
424


1,669

248

46

329


1,682

48

4,447

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

48



321

12

3,213

43


3,637

Undeveloped
 

71



325


2,148

1


2,545

 
 

119



646

12

5,361

44


6,183

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2



1

1

170

(1
)

174

Improved recovery
 

13



4





17

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

36





37



72

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



22


264



288

Production
 

(12
)


(28
)
(2
)
(327
)
(36
)

(405
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(6
)


(98
)




(104
)
 
 

34



(98
)
(1
)
144

(37
)

43

At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



285

11

3,206

6


3,569

Undeveloped
 

93



263


2,300



2,656

 
 

153



548

12

5,505

6


6,225

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
168

48

1,051

42

335

342

3,213

1,150

42

6,390

Undeveloped
 
277

71

569

209

364

43

2,148

246

16

3,943

 
 
445

119

1,621

251

699

385

5,361

1,395

57

10,333

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256

60

1,108

54

297

313

3,206

1,047

36

6,377

Undeveloped
 
167

93

561

195

297

28

2,300

642

12

4,295

 
 
424

153

1,669

249

594

341

5,505

1,688

48

10,672

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d 
Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 2 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
e 
Also includes 14 million barrels in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g 
Includes 338 million barrels in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmboe held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
h 
Total proved liquid reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,533 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Canada, 59 million barrels in Venezuela, less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and 5,473 million barrels in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
251


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
billion cubic feet
 
Natural gasa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
499


5,447


1,784

767


1,890

3,012

13,398

Undeveloped
 
350


2,567


4,970

2,191


3,769

1,643

15,490

 
 
848


8,014


6,755

2,958


5,659

4,654

28,888

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
50


(38
)
3

(677
)
(450
)

258

(129
)
(983
)
Improved recovery
 


1,002



1


6


1,009

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
25





527




552

Discoveries and extensions
 


10


829

14


1,229


2,082

Productionc
 
(77
)

(664
)
(3
)
(714
)
(380
)

(152
)
(291
)
(2,281
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(4
)








(4
)
 
 
(5
)

309


(562
)
(288
)

1,342

(420
)
376

At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523


5,238

(1
)
2,862

1,159


2,755

2,730

15,266

Undeveloped
 
320


3,086


3,330

1,510


4,245

1,505

13,997

 
 
843


8,323

(1
)
6,193

2,670


7,000

4,235

29,263

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

89



1,546

412

5,544

26


7,617

Undeveloped
 

21



534


6,304

4


6,863

 
 

110


1

2,080

412

11,847

30


14,480

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

19



47

5

1,556

(2
)

1,625

Improved recovery
 

37



55





92

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

39




237

10



286

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



67


324



392

Productionc
 

(19
)


(178
)
(32
)
(488
)
(8
)

(726
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(6
)


(347
)




(353
)
 
 

70



(356
)
210

1,403

(10
)

1,316

At 31 Decemberf g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

112



1,274

476

6,077

17


7,955

Undeveloped
 

69



450

146

7,173

3


7,841

 
 

180



1,724

622

13,250

20


15,796

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
499

89

5,447


3,330

1,179

5,544

1,916

3,012

21,015

Undeveloped
 
350

21

2,567


5,505

2,191

6,304

3,772

1,643

22,353

 
 
848

110

8,014


8,835

3,370

11,847

5,688

4,654

43,368

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523

112

5,238


4,136

1,635

6,077

2,771

2,730

23,221

Undeveloped
 
320

69

3,086


3,781

1,656

7,173

4,249

1,505

21,838

 
 
843

180

8,323


7,917

3,291

13,250

7,020

4,235

45,060

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Includes 180 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations, 131 billion cubic feet in subsidiaries, 49 billion cubic feet in equity-accounted entities.
d 
Includes 1,860 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f 
Includes 306 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 2.30% non-controlling interest in Rosneft including 2 billion cubic feet held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
g 
Total proved gas reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 13,522 billion cubic feet, comprising 0 billion cubic feet in Canada, 28 billion cubic feet in Venezuela, 19 billion cubic feet in Vietnam, 237 billion cubic feet in Egypt and 13,237 billion cubic feet in Russia.

252
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels of oil equivalentc
 
Total hydrocarbonsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USd

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
254


1,990

42

321

462


1,433

561

5,063

Undeveloped
 
338


1,012

209

896

420


895

299

4,068

 
 
592


3,002

251

1,217

882


2,327

860

9,131

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
25


157

5

(116
)
(32
)

451

(24
)
467

Improved recovery
 


200



2


1


203

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
8


1



92




100

Discoveries and extensions
 


14


143

3


254


413

Productione f
 
(45
)

(270
)
(8
)
(131
)
(157
)

(145
)
(57
)
(812
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(11
)








(11
)
 
 
(23
)

102

(2
)
(104
)
(93
)

562

(81
)
361

At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347


2,011

54

505

501


1,515

507

5,440

Undeveloped
 
222


1,093

195

608

288


1,374

272

4,052

 
 
569


3,104

248

1,114

790


2,889

779

9,492

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

63



588

83

4,168

47


4,951

Undeveloped
 

75



417


3,235

1


3,729

 
 

138



1,005

83

7,404

49


8,679

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

5



9

2

439

(1
)

454

Improved recovery
 

19



14





33

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

42




41

38



122

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



34


320



355

Productione
 

(15
)


(58
)
(7
)
(411
)
(38
)

(530
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(7
)


(158
)




(165
)
 
 

46



(159
)
35

386

(39
)

269

At 31 Decemberi j
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

80



505

93

4,254

9


4,941

Undeveloped
 

105



341

25

3,536

1


4,008

 
 

184



846

119

7,790

10


8,949

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
254

63

1,990

42

909

545

4,168

1,480

561

10,014

Undeveloped
 
338

75

1,012

209

1,313

420

3,235

896

299

7,797

 
 
592

138

3,002

251

2,222

966

7,404

2,376

860

17,810

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347

80

2,011

54

1,010

595

4,254

1,524

507

10,381

Undeveloped
 
222

105

1,093

195

949

314

3,536

1,374

272

8,060

 
 
569

184

3,104

249

1,959

908

7,790

2,899

779

18,441

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
5.8 billion cubic feet of natural gas = 1 million barrels of oil equivalent.
d 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e 
Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 2 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
f 
Includes 31 million barrels of oil equivalent of natural gas consumed in operations, 23 million barrels of oil equivalent in subsidiaries, 8 million barrels of oil equivalent in equity-accounted entities.
g 
Includes 335 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
h 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
i 
Includes 391 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 7 mmboe held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
j 
Total proved reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 7,864 million barrels of oil equivalent, comprising less than 1 million barrels of oil equivalent in Canada, 64 million barrels of oil equivalent in Venezuela, 3 million barrels of oil equivalent in Vietnam, 41 million barrels of oil equivalent in Egypt and 7,755 million barrels of oil equivalent in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
253


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves
The following tables set out the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows, and changes therein, relating to crude oil and natural gas production from the group’s estimated proved reserves. This information is prepared in compliance with FASB Oil and Gas Disclosures requirements.
Future net cash flows have been prepared on the basis of certain assumptions which may or may not be realized. These include the timing of future production, the estimation of crude oil and natural gas reserves and the application of average crude oil and natural gas prices and exchange rates from the previous 12 months. Furthermore, both proved reserves estimates and production forecasts are subject to revision as further technical information becomes available and economic conditions change. BP cautions against relying on the information presented because of the highly arbitrary nature of the assumptions on which it is based and its lack of comparability with the historical cost information presented in the financial statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 
28,600


135,900

7,400

11,500

21,200


135,800

24,000

364,400

Future production costb
 
13,700


59,200

3,400

5,700

6,700


53,200

6,100

148,000

Future development costb
 
1,700


16,400

1,200

2,000

1,300


16,700

2,700

42,000

Future taxationc
 
5,200


8,700

200

1,300

3,300


46,000

5,300

70,000

Future net cash flows
 
8,000


51,600

2,600

2,500

9,900


19,900

9,900

104,400

10% annual discountd
 
2,700


23,100

1,400

600

2,300


7,200

4,400

41,700

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowse f
 
5,300


28,500

1,200

1,900

7,600


12,700

5,500

62,700

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 

10,300



36,800


322,000



369,100

Future production costb
 

3,500



14,900


222,600



241,000

Future development costb
 

700



3,900


21,800



26,400

Future taxationc
 

4,700



4,100


13,300



22,100

Future net cash flows
 

1,400



13,900


64,300



79,600

10% annual discountd
 

400



8,200


37,100



45,700

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsh i
 

1,000



5,700


27,200



33,900

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsj
 
5,300

1,000

28,500

1,200

7,600

7,600

27,200

12,700

5,500

96,600

The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows:
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Subsidiaries

Equity-accounted
entities (BP share)

Total subsidiaries and
equity-accounted
entities

Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs
 
(27,400
)
(8,400
)
(35,800
)
Development costs for the current year as estimated in previous year
 
9,200

4,100

13,300

Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs
 
3,800

2,600

6,400

Net changes in prices and production cost
 
(28,100
)
(8,200
)
(36,300
)
Revisions of previous reserves estimates
 
300

1,100

1,400

Net change in taxation
 
16,600

2,400

19,000

Future development costs
 
(1,500
)
(4,300
)
(5,800
)
Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place
 
(1,400
)

(1,400
)
Addition of 10% annual discount
 
8,300

4,100

12,400

Total change in the standardized measure during the yeark
 
(20,200
)
(6,600
)
(26,800
)
a 
The marker prices used were Brent $62.74/bbl, Henry Hub $2.58/mmBtu.
b 
Production costs, which include production taxes, and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on the continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included.
c 
Taxation is computed with reference to appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates.
d 
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.
e 
In certain situations, revenues and costs are included in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows valuation and excluded from the determination of proved reserves and vice versa. This can result in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows being negative.
f 
Non-controlling interests in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $600 million.
g 
The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities includes standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
h 
Non-controlling interests in Rosneft amounted to $2,100 million in Russia.
i 
No equity-accounted future cash flows in Africa because proved reserves are received as a result of contractual arrangements, with no associated costs.
j 
Includes future net cash flows for assets held for sale at 31 December 2019.
k Total change in the standardized measure during the year includes the effect of exchange rate movements. Exchange rate effects arising from the translation of our share of Rosneft changes to US dollars are included within ‘Net changes in prices and production cost’.

254
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves – continued 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 
39,700


160,000

4,100

17,500

30,400


147,500

30,000

429,200

Future production costb
 
15,000


57,600

3,400

7,200

8,500


55,800

7,600

155,100

Future development costb
 
2,100


17,800

1,100

2,800

2,600


16,400

2,500

45,300

Future taxationc
 
8,900


16,600


3,200

5,300


51,100

6,900

92,000

Future net cash flows
 
13,700


68,000

(400
)
4,300

14,000


24,200

13,000

136,800

10% annual discountd
 
5,000


29,900

(200
)
700

3,300


9,400

5,800

53,900

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowse f
 
8,700


38,100

(200
)
3,600

10,700


14,800

7,200

82,900

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 

12,800



38,500


356,800



408,100

Future production costb
 

4,200



16,100


238,400



258,700

Future development costb
 

800



3,600


19,300



23,700

Future taxationc
 

5,900



4,400


17,700



28,000

Future net cash flows
 

1,900



14,400


81,400



97,700

10% annual discountd
 

600



8,500


48,100



57,200

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsh i
 

1,300



5,900


33,300



40,500

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows
 
8,700

1,300

38,100

(200
)
9,500

10,700

33,300

14,800

7,200

123,400

The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows:
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Subsidiaries

Equity-accounted
entities (BP share)

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities

Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs
 
(18,800
)
(8,000
)
(26,800
)
Development costs for the current year as estimated in previous year
 
8,500

4,300

12,800

Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs
 
5,800

3,300

9,100

Net changes in prices and production cost
 
41,000

13,100

54,100

Revisions of previous reserves estimates
 
(2,100
)
2,000

(100
)
Net change in taxation
 
(17,000
)
(4,600
)
(21,600
)
Future development costs
 
1,000

(3,500
)
(2,500
)
Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place
 
7,600

400

8,000

Addition of 10% annual discount
 
5,200

3,100

8,300

Total change in the standardized measure during the yearj
 
31,200

10,100

41,300

a 
The marker prices used were Brent $71.43/bbl, Henry Hub $3.10/mmBtu.
b 
Production costs, which include production taxes, and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on the continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included. 2018 comparative for Russia equity-accounted entity future production cost has been restated from $232,100 million to maintain consistency with 2019 presentation.
c 
Taxation is computed with reference to appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates. 2018 comparative for Russia equity-accounted entity future taxation has been restated from $24,000 million to maintain consistency with 2019 presentation.
d 
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.
e 
In certain situations, revenues and costs are included in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows valuation and excluded from the determination of proved reserves and vice versa. This can result in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows being negative.
f 
Non-controlling interests in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $1,100 million.
g 
The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities includes standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
h 
Non-controlling interests in Rosneft amounted to $2,500 million in Russia.
i 
No equity-accounted future cash flows in Africa because proved reserves are received as a result of contractual arrangements, with no associated costs.
i 
Total change in the standardized measure during the year includes the effect of exchange rate movements. Exchange rate effects arising from the translation of our share of Rosneft changes to US dollars are included within ‘Net changes in prices and production cost’.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
255


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia 
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 
26,300


99,200

7,100

15,200

27,000


118,800

26,200

319,800

Future production costb
 
13,800


46,700

4,100

7,100

8,600


52,600

8,400

141,300

Future development costb
 
1,700


12,100

1,100

2,400

3,400


18,200

3,200

42,100

Future taxationc
 
4,200


6,500


1,700

3,800


33,200

4,800

54,200

Future net cash flows
 
6,600


33,900

1,900

4,000

11,200


14,800

9,800

82,200

10% annual discountd
 
2,100


13,100

1,100

500

3,400


5,500

4,800

30,500

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowse
 
4,500


20,800

800

3,500

7,800


9,300

5,000

51,700

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 

9,000



32,900


205,100

400


247,400

Future production costb
 

4,100



15,500


114,900

300


134,800

Future development costb
 

800



3,400


17,600

100


21,900

Future taxationc
 

3,100



3,100


12,400



18,600

Future net cash flows
 

1,000



10,900


60,200



72,100

10% annual discountd
 

400



6,400


34,900



41,700

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsg h
 

600



4,500


25,300



30,400

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows
 
4,500

600

20,800

800

8,000

7,800

25,300

9,300

5,000

82,100

The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows:
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Subsidiaries

Equity-accounted
entities (BP share)

Total subsidiaries and
equity-accounted
entities

Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs
 
(12,800
)
(5,500
)
(18,300
)
Development costs for the current year as estimated in previous year
 
9,800

4,200

14,000

Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs
 
2,300

1,300

3,600

Net changes in prices and production cost
 
33,100

7,300

40,400

Revisions of previous reserves estimates
 
2,800

1,000

3,800

Net change in taxation
 
(12,500
)
(1,500
)
(14,000
)
Future development costs
 
3,000

(4,600
)
(1,600
)
Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place
 
800

(600
)
200

Addition of 10% annual discount
 
2,300

2,600

4,900

Total change in the standardized measure during the yearj
 
28,800

4,200

33,000

a 
The marker prices used were Brent $54.36/bbl, Henry Hub $2.96/mmBtu.
b 
Production costs, which include production taxes, and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on the continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included.
c 
Taxation is computed with reference to appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates.
d 
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.
e 
Non-controlling interests in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $1,100 million.
f 
The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities includes standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g 
Non-controlling interests in Rosneft amounted to $1,963 million in Russia.
h 
No equity-accounted future cash flows in Africa because proved reserves are received as a result of contractual arrangements, with no associated costs.
i 
Total change in the standardized measure during the year includes the effect of exchange rate movements. Exchange rate effects arising from the translation of our share of Rosneft to US dollars are included within ‘Net changes in prices and production cost’.


256
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Operational and statistical information
The following tables present operational and statistical information related to production, drilling, productive wells and acreage. Figures include amounts attributable to assets held for sale.
Crude oil and natural gas production
The following table shows crude oil, natural gas liquids and natural gas production for the years ended 31 December 2019, 2018 and 2017.
Production for the yeara b 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiac

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiariesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oile
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2019
 
100


400

24

7

156


343

17

1,046

2018
 
101


385

24

7

204


313

17

1,051

2017
 
80


370

20

12

241


325

17

1,064

Natural gas liquids
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2019
 
3


81


9

8



2

104

2018
 
5


60


9

11



2

88

2017
 
6


56


10

10



2

85

Natural gasf
 
 
million cubic feet per day
 
2019
 
129


2,358

2

1,977

1,138


976

786

7,366

2018
 
152


1,900

7

2,136

1,061


826

819

6,900

2017
 
182


1,659

9

1,936

949


371

783

5,889

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oile
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2019
 

35



56

1

955



1,047

2018
 

34



55

1

933

16


1,040

2017
 

31



63

1

905

99


1,099

Natural gas liquids
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2019
 

2



1

8

3



14

2018
 

2




6

4



12

2017
 

2




6

4



12

Natural gasf
 
 
million cubic feet per day
 
2019
 

56



314

87

1,279



1,736

2018
 

59



335

80

1,286



1,760

2017
 

53



418

77

1,308



1,855

a 
Production excludes royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Amounts reported for Russia include BP’s share of Rosneft worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia.
d 
All of the oil and liquid production from Canada is bitumen.
e 
Crude oil includes condensate.
f 
Natural gas production excludes gas consumed in operations.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
257


Operational and statistical information – continued
Productive oil and gas wells and acreage
The following tables show the number of gross and net productive oil and natural gas wells and total gross and net developed and undeveloped oil and natural gas acreage in which the group and its equity-accounted entities had interests as at 31 December 2019. A ‘gross’ well or acre is one in which a whole or fractional working interest is owned, while the number of ‘net’ wells or acres is the sum of the whole or fractional working interests in gross wells or acres. Productive wells are producing wells and wells capable of production. Developed acreage is the acreage within the boundary of a field, on which development wells have been drilled, which could produce the reserves; while undeveloped acres are those on which wells have not been drilled or completed to a point that would permit the production of commercial quantities, whether or not such acres contain proved reserves.
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Totalb

 
 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Number of productive wells at 31 December 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Oil wellsc
– gross
 
117

80

2,775

177

5,526

290

66,696

2,067

12

77,740

 
– net
 
70

24

1,152

48

2,528

65

13,278

477

2

17,644

Gas wellsd
– gross
 
36

1

18,552

238

1,119

220

447

129

78

20,820

 
– net
 
7


8,811

118

401

91

92

60

16

9,596

Oil and natural gas acreage at 31 December 2019
 
 
 
 
 
thousands of acres
 
Developed
– gross
 
75

81

6,232

143

1,354

823

7,709

1,322

173

17,912

 
– net
 
44

24

3,658

62

361

287

1,377

292

41

6,146

Undevelopede
– gross
 
2,851

150

5,311

14,953

23,892

51,105

439,848

9,793

4,022

551,925

 
– net
 
1,594

45

3,749

7,890

8,456

33,683

84,689

2,430

1,889

144,425

a 
Based on information received from Rosneft as at 31 December 2019.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Includes approximately 6,916 gross (1,314 net) multiple completion wells (more than one formation producing into the same well bore).
d 
Includes approximately 2,618 gross (1,265 net) multiple completion wells. If one of the multiple completions in a well is an oil completion, the well is classified as an oil well.
e 
Undeveloped acreage includes leases and concessions.
Net oil and gas wells completed or abandoned
The following table shows the number of net productive and dry exploratory and development oil and natural gas wells completed or abandoned in the years indicated by the group and its equity-accounted entities. Productive wells include wells in which hydrocarbons were encountered and the drilling or completion of which, in the case of exploratory wells, has been suspended pending further drilling or evaluation. A dry well is one found to be incapable of producing hydrocarbons in sufficient quantities to justify completion.
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Totala

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 

0.2

0.8

0.8

3.5

2.3

11.6

5.2


24.4

Dry
 
1.0

0.3

1.6

0.5

1.1

0.3

0.5

0.4

0.2

5.9

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
1.7

2.4

193.0

0.2

110.7

6.0

230.8

49.6

0.4

594.8

Dry
 

0.3

10.0


0.6



1.0


11.9

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
0.3


1.7


2.0


15.0

5.0


24.0

Dry
 



0.5

2.0

2.4




4.9

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
1.4

0.6

142.7

5.0

103.9

14.4

137.3

53.5

1.3

460.1

Dry
 


6.8


3.6



2.6


13.0

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
2.8

0.1

1.5

1.2

3.2

2.6

9.4

1.4


22.2

Dry
 
2.4





2.9


1.0


6.3

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
2.5

0.5

124.0

8.0

103.7

16.5

282.7

43.6

1.1

582.6

Dry
 


0.5


1.6

2.1


0.8


5.0

a 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.

258
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Operational and statistical information – continued
Drilling and production activities in progress
The following table shows the number of exploratory and development oil and natural gas wells in the process of being drilled by the group and its equity-accounted entities as of 31 December 2019. Suspended development wells and long-term suspended exploratory wells are also included in the table.
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Totala

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross
 


8.0


2.0

4.0


5.0


19.0

Net
 


4.9


0.5

1.6


0.5


7.5

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
6.0

3.6

213.0

6.0

13.0

26.0


216.0

2.0

485.6

Net
 
2.0

1.1

140.0

3.0

4.1

14.5


29.1

0.8

194.6

a 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
259


























Pages 260-296 have been removed as they do not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.




























260
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


 
 
 
Additional
disclosures
 
298
 
301
 
303
 
307
 
308
 
 
314
 
 
314
 
 
319
 
 
320
 
 
321
 
 
321
 
 
321
 
 
321
 
 
322
 
 
322
 
 
322
Principal accountant’s fees and services
 
 
323
 
 
323
 
 
324
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
297


Selected financial information
This information has been extracted or derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of the BP group. Note 1 to the financial statements includes details on the basis of preparation of these financial statements. The selected information should be read in conjunction with the audited financial statements and related notes. The audited consolidated financial statements and related notes as of 31 December 2019 and 2018 and for the three years ended 31 December 2019 are presented on page 146.
 
 
$ million except per share amounts
 
 
 
2019

2018

2017

2016

2015

Income statement data
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
278,397

298,756

240,208

183,008

222,894

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
11,706

19,378

9,474

(430
)
(7,918
)
Finance costs and net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
(3,552
)
(2,655
)
(2,294
)
(1,865
)
(1,653
)
Taxation
 
(3,964
)
(7,145
)
(3,712
)
2,467

3,171

Non-controlling interests
 
(164
)
(195
)
(79
)
(57
)
(82
)
Profit (loss) for the yeara
 
4,026

9,383

3,389

115

(6,482
)
Inventory holding (gains) losses«, before tax
 
(667
)
801

(853
)
(1,597
)
1,889

Taxation charge (credit) on inventory holding gains and losses
 
156

(198
)
225

483

(569
)
RC profit (loss)«for the year
 
3,515

9,986

2,761

(999
)
(5,162
)
Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items« and fair value accounting effects«, before taxb
 
8,263

3,380

3,730

6,746

15,067

Taxation charge (credit) on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
(1,788
)
(643
)
(325
)
(3,162
)
(4,000
)
Underlying RC profit«for the year
 
9,990

12,723

6,166

2,585

5,905

Earnings per sharec – cents
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) for the yeara per ordinary share
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
19.84

46.98

17.20

0.61

(35.39
)
Diluted
 
19.73

46.67

17.10

0.60

(35.39
)
RC profit (loss) for the year per ordinary share«
 
17.32

50.00

14.02

(5.33
)
(28.18
)
Underlying RC profit for the year per ordinary share«
 
49.24

63.70

31.31

13.79

32.22

Dividends paid per share – cents
 
41.00

40.50

40.00

40.00

40.00

– pence
 
31.977

30.568

30.979

29.418

26.383

Capital expenditure«d
 
 
 
 
 
 
Organic capital expenditure«
 
15,238

15,140

16,501

16,675

N/A

Inorganic capital expenditure«
 
4,183

9,948

1,339

777

N/A

 
 
19,421

25,088

17,840

17,452

20,202

Balance sheet data (at 31 December)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
295,194

282,176

276,515

263,316

261,832

Net assets
 
100,708

101,548

100,404

96,843

98,387

Share capital
 
5,404

5,402

5,343

5,284

5,049

BP shareholders’ equity
 
98,412

99,444

98,491

95,286

97,216

Finance debt due after more than one year
 
57,237

55,803

54,873

51,073

45,567

Gearing«
 
31.1%
30.0%
27.0%
26.5%
21.2%
Ordinary share datae
 
Share million
 
Basic weighted average number of shares
 
20,285

19,970

19,693

18,745

18,324

Diluted weighted average number of shares
 
20,400

20,102

19,816

18,855

18,324

a 
Profit attributable to BP shareholders.
b 
See pages 300 and 344 for further analysis of these items.
c 
A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 344.
d 
From 2017 onwards BP reports organic, inorganic and total capital expenditure on a cash basis which were previously reported on an accruals basis. This aligns with BP's financial framework and is consistent with other financial metrics used when comparing sources and uses of cash. An analysis of capital expenditure on a cash basis for 2015 is not available.
e 
The number of ordinary shares shown has been used to calculate the per share amounts.















298
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Additional information
Capital expenditure
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Capital expenditure
 
 
 
 
Organic capital expenditure
 
15,238

15,140

16,501

Inorganic capital expenditurea
 
4,183

9,948

1,339

 
 
19,421

25,088

17,840

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Organic capital expenditure by segment
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,019

3,482

2,999

Non-US
 
7,885

8,545

10,764

 
 
11,904

12,027

13,763

Downstream
 
 
 
 
US
 
913

877

809

Non-US
 
2,084

1,904

1,590

 
 
2,997

2,781

2,399

Other businesses and corporate
 






US
 
47

54

64

Non-US
 
290

278

275

 
 
337

332

339

 
 
15,238

15,140

16,501

Organic capital expenditure by geographical area
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,979

4,413

3,872

Non-US
 
10,259

10,727

12,629

 
 
15,238

15,140

16,501

a On 31 October 2018, BP acquired from BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc. 100% of the issued share capital of Petrohawk Energy Corporation, a wholly owned subsidiary of BHP that holds a portfolio of unconventional onshore US oil and gas assets. The entire consideration payable of $10,268 million, after customary closing adjustments, was paid in instalments between July 2018 and April 2019. The amounts presented as inorganic capital expenditure include $3,480 million for 2019 and $6,788 million for 2018 relating to this transaction. 2018 includes $1,739 million relating to the purchase of an additional 16.5% interest in the Clair field west of Shetland in the North Sea, as part of the agreements with Conoco-Phillips in which Conoco-Philips simultaneously purchased BP's entire 39.2% interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area on the North Slope of Alaska. 2019 and 2018 also include amounts relating to the 25-year extension to our ACG production-sharing agreement* in Azerbaijan. 2017 includes amounts paid to acquire interests in Mauritania and Senegal and in the Zohr gas field in Egypt.
.
 


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
299


Non-operating items
Non-operating items are charges and credits included in the financial statements that BP discloses separately because it considers such disclosures to be meaningful and relevant to investors. They are items that management considers not to be part of underlying business operations and are disclosed in order to enable investors to understand better and evaluate the group’s reported financial performance. An analysis of non-operating items is shown in the table below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Upstream
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assetsa b
 
(6,893
)
(90
)
(563
)
Environmental and other provisions
 
(32
)
(35
)
1

Restructuring, integration and rationalization costsc
 
(89
)
(131
)
(24
)
Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 

17

33

Otherd
 
67

56

(118
)
 
 
(6,947
)
(183
)
(671
)
Downstream
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assetsa e
 
(72
)
(54
)
579

Environmental and other provisions
 
(78
)
(83
)
(19
)
Restructuring, integration and rationalization costsc
 
85

(405
)
(171
)
Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 



Other
 
(12
)
(174
)

 
 
(77
)
(716
)
389

Rosneft
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(103
)
(95
)

Environmental and other provisions
 



Restructuring, integration and rationalization costs
 



Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 



Other
 



 
 
(103
)
(95
)

Other businesses and corporate
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assetsa f
 
(917
)
(260
)
(22
)
Environmental and other provisionsg
 
(231
)
(640
)
(156
)
Restructuring, integration and rationalization costsc
 
6

(190
)
(72
)
Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 



Gulf of Mexico oil spill response
 
(319
)
(714
)
(2,687
)
Other
 
(30
)
(159
)
90

 
 
(1,491
)
(1,963
)
(2,847
)
Total before interest and taxation
 
(8,618
)
(2,957
)
(3,129
)
Finance costsh
 
(511
)
(479
)
(493
)
Total before taxation
 
(9,129
)
(3,436
)
(3,622
)
Taxation credit (charge) on non-operating itemsi
 
1,943

510

1,172

Taxation - impact of US tax reformj
 

121

(859
)
Total after taxation
 
(7,186
)
(2,805
)
(3,309
)
a 
See Financial statements – Note 4 for further information.
b 
2019 includes impairments charges principally resulting from the announcements to dispose of certain assets in the US and Egypt. 2018 includes an impairment reversal for assets in the North Sea and Angola. 2017 includes an impairment charge relating to BPX Energy (previously known as the US Lower 48 business), partially offset by gains associated with asset divestments. In addition, 2017 includes an impairment charge arising following the announcement of the agreement to sell the Forties Pipeline System business to INEOS.
c 
Restructuring charges are classified as non-operating items where they relate to an announced major group restructuring. A major group restructuring is a restructuring programme affecting more than one of the group’s operating segments that is expected to result in charges of more than $1 billion over a defined period. Following the Gulf of Mexico oil spill in 2010 and since the fall in oil prices in late 2014, major group restructuring programmes were initiated.The group's restructuring programme, originally announced in 2014, was completed in 2018.
d 
2018 and 2017 include exploration write-offs of $124 million and $145 million respectively in relation to the value ascribed to certain licences in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico as part of the accounting for the acquisition of upstream assets from Devon Energy in 2011. 2017 also includes BP’s share of an impairment reversal recognized by the Angola LNG equity-accounted entity, partially offset by other items.
e 
2017 primarily reflects the disposal of our shareholding in the SECCO joint venture.
f 2019 includes $877 million relating to the reclassification of accumulated foreign exchange losses from reserves to the income statement upon the contribution of our Brazilian biofuels bussiness to BP Bunge Bioenergia.
g 
2019 and 2018 primarily reflects charges due to the annual update of environmental provisions, including asbestos-related provisions for past operations, together with updates of non-Gulf of Mexico oil spill related legal provisions.
h 
Relates to the unwinding of discounting effects relating to Gulf of Mexico oil spill payables.
i 
2017 includes the tax effect of the increase in the provision in the fourth quarter for business economic loss and other claims associated with the Deepwater Horizon Court Supervised Settlement Program (DHCSSP) at the new US tax rate.
j 
In 2017 the US tax reform reduced the US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018. The impact disclosed has been calculated as the change in deferred tax balances at 31 December 2017, excluding the increase in the provision in the fourth quarter for business economic loss and other claims associated with the DHCSSP, which arises following the reduction in the tax rate. 2018 reflects a further impact following a clarification of the tax reform. The impact of the US tax reform has been treated as a non-operating item because it is not considered to be part of underlying business operations, has a material impact upon the reported result and is substantially impacted by Gulf of Mexico oil spill charges, which are also treated as non-operating items. Separate disclosure is considered meaningful and relevant to investors.


300
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Liquidity and capital resources
Financial framework
BP’s financial framework sets a number of parameters in support of growing shareholder value, distributions and returns, while maintaining a strong balance sheet. BP’s objective over time is to grow sustainable free cash flow« through a combination of operating cash flow« growth and capital discipline, in service of growing shareholder distributions over the long term.
We maintain our progressive dividend policy that reflects ongoing consideration of factors including changes in the environment, the underlying performance of the business, the outlook for the group financial framework, and other market factors which may vary quarter to quarter.
In a constant price environment, surplus organic free cash flow« is expected to grow and be used to ensure the right balance between deleveraging the balance sheet, growing distributions and disciplined investment, depending on the context and outlook at the time. In a period of low prices, the group has the flexibility to reduce cash costs and to reduce or defer capital investment, as appropriate.
Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments were $2.4 billion on a post-tax basis in 2019 and are expected to step down to around $1 billion per annum thereafter. In 2020, we expect to meet our target of $10 billion divestment and other proceeds and plan a further $5 billion of agreed disposals by mid-2021. In 2020, divestment proceeds« will be primarily focussed on reducing gearing«.
We continue to target a gearing band of 20-30%. In 2019, gearing moved to 31.1%, above the top end of the band, reflecting the impact of completing the acquisition of BHP’s onshore US assets using available cash. Gearing may increase in the short-term with the impact of lower prices, but is expected to reduce again in line with the receipt of divestment proceeds.
In 2019, the return on average capital employed« was 8.9%a at an average of $64 per barrel. At $55 per barrel 2017 real, return on average capital employed is targeted to improve to over 10% by 2021, as we continue to grow our underlying business.
a Nearest equivalent GAAP measures: Numerator – Profit attributable to BP shareholders $4.0 billion; Denominator – Average capital employed $167.6 billion.
Dividends and other distributions to shareholders
The dividend is determined in US dollars, the economic currency of BP, and the dividend level is reviewed by the board each quarter. The quarterly dividend was increased to 10.50 cents per share for the fourth quarter of 2019, having been increased to 10.25 cents from 10.00 cents per share in the third quarter of 2018.
The total dividend distributed to BP shareholders in 2019 was $8.3 billion (2018 $8.1 billion). Prior to its suspension in the fourth quarter of 2019, shareholders had the option to receive a scrip dividend in place of receiving cash and in 2019 the total dividend paid in cash was $6.9 billion (2018 $6.7 billion). The impact of the scrip dilution since the third quarter of 2017 was fully offset in January 2020.
Details of share repurchases to satisfy the requirements of certain employee share-based payment plans are set out on page 334. The share buyback programme, to offset the dilutive impact of the scrip dividend, purchased 235 million ordinary shares in 2019 at a cost of $1.5 billion (2018 $355 million), including fees and stamp duty.
 
Financing the group’s activities
The group’s principal commodities, oil and gas, are priced internationally in US dollars. Group policy has generally been to minimize economic exposure to currency movements by financing operations with US dollar debt. Where debt is issued in other currencies, including euros, it is generally swapped back to US dollars using derivative contracts, or else hedged by maintaining offsetting cash positions in the same currency. Cash balances of the group are mainly held in US dollars or swapped to US dollars and holdings are well diversified to reduce concentration risk. The group is not, therefore, exposed to significant currency risk regarding its cash or borrowings. Also see Risk factors on page 70 for further information on risks associated with prices and markets and Financial statements – Note 29.
The group’s finance debt at 31 December 2019 amounted to $67.7 billion (2018 $65.1 billionb). Of the total finance debt, $10.5 billion is classified as short term at the end of 2019 (2018 $9.3 billion). See Financial statements – Note 26 for more information on the short-term balance. Net debt« was $45.4 billion at the end of 2019, an increase of $1.9 billion from the 2018 year-end position of $43.5 billionb.
The ratio of finance debt to finance debt plus total equity at 31 December 2019 was 40.2% (2018 39.1%b). The ratio of net debt to net debt plus total equity« was 31.1% at the end of 2019 (2018 30.0%b). See Financial statements – Note 27 for finance debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis, and for further information on net debt.
Cash and cash equivalents of $22.5 billion at 31 December 2019 (2018 $22.5 billion) are included in net debt. We manage our cash position so that the group has adequate cover to respond to potential short-term market illiquidity, short term price environment volatility and expect to maintain a robust cash position.
The group also has an undrawn committed $10 billion credit facility and undrawn committed bank facilities of $7.6 billion (see Financial statements – Note 29 for more information).
We believe that the group has sufficient working capital for foreseeable requirements, taking into account the amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities and levels of cash and cash equivalents, and its ongoing ability to generate cash.
BP utilizes various arrangements in order to manage its working capital including discounting of receivables and, in the supply and trading business, the active management of supplier payment terms, inventory and collateral.
Standard & Poor’s Ratings’ long-term credit rating for BP is A- (positive outlook) and the Moody’s Investors Service rating is A1 (stable outlook).
The group’s sources of funding, its access to capital markets and maintaining a strong cash position are described in Financial statements – Note 25 and Note 29. Further information on the management of liquidity risk and credit risk, and the maturity profile and fixed/floating rate characteristics of the group’s debt are also provided in Financial statements – Note 26 and Note 29.
b As a result of the adoption of IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, leases that were previously classified as finance leases under IAS 17 are now presented as ‘Lease liabilities’ on the group balance sheet and therefore do not form part of finance debt. Comparative information for finance debt (previously termed ‘gross debt’), net debt and gearing (previously termed 'net debt ratio') have been amended to be on a consistent basis with amounts presented for 2019.






The information above contains forward-looking statements, which by their nature involve risk and uncertainty because they relate to events and depend on circumstances that will or may occur in the future and are outside the control of BP. You are urged to read the Cautionary statement on page 324 and Risk factors on page 70, which describe the risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
301


Off-balance sheet arrangements
At 31 December 2019, the group’s share of third-party finance debt of equity-accounted entities was $17.3 billion (2018 $16.1 billion). These amounts are not reflected in the group’s debt on the balance sheet. The group has issued third-party guarantees under which amounts outstanding, incremental to amounts recognized on the balance sheet, at 31 December 2019 were $692 million (2018 $696 million) in respect of liabilities of joint ventures«and associates«and $523 million (2018 $432 million) in respect of liabilities of other third parties. Of these amounts, $681 million (2018 $684 million) of the joint ventures and associates guarantees relate to borrowings and for other third-party guarantees, $494 million (2018 $423 million) relate to guarantees of borrowings.
Contractual obligations
The following table summarizes the group’s capital expenditure commitments for property, plant and equipment at 31 December 2019 and the proportion of that expenditure for which contracts have been placed.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Payments due by period
 
Capital expenditure
 
Total

2020

2021

2022

2023

2024

2025 and thereafter

Committed
 
24,853

12,745

7,070

2,599

1,398

396

645

of which is contracted
 
11,382

7,497

3,388

347

52

27

71

Capital expenditure is considered to be committed when the project has received the appropriate level of internal management approval. For joint operations«, the net BP share is included in the amounts above.
In addition, at 31 December 2019, the group had committed to capital expenditure relating to investments in equity-accounted entities amounting to $1,156 million. Contracts were in place for $864 million of this total.
The following table summarizes the group’s principal contractual obligations at 31 December 2019, distinguishing between those for which a liability is recognized on the balance sheet and those for which no liability is recognized. Further information on borrowings is given in Financial statements – Note 26 and more information on leases is given in Financial statements – Note 28.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Payments due by period
 
Expected payments by period under contractual obligations
 
Total

2020

2021

2022

2023

2024

2025 and thereafter

Balance sheet obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Borrowingsa
 
75,567

14,166

8,119

9,156

8,030

8,363

27,733

Lease liabilitiesb
 
11,299

2,514

1,839

1,364

1,105

876

3,601

Decommissioning liabilitiesc
 
25,964

395

218

80

196

146

24,929

Environmental liabilitiesc
 
1,867

278

276

224

206

170

713

Gulf of Mexico oil spill liabilitiesd
 
16,129

1,628

1,355

1,267

1,219

1,141

9,519

Pensions and other post-retirement benefitse
 
18,016

1,127

1,155

1,076

1,072

1,048

12,538

 
 
148,842

20,108

12,962

13,167

11,828

11,744

79,033

Off-balance sheet obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Unconditional purchase obligationsf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oil and oil products
 
64,486

48,954

6,720

3,919

2,016

1,288

1,589

Natural gas and LNG
 
39,097

12,182

4,478

3,247

2,692

2,183

14,315

Chemicals and other refinery feedstocks
 
5,009

2,918

927

922

118

53

71

Power
 
5,001

2,673

1,164

394

204

121

445

Utilities
 
964

144

123

103

67

64

463

Transportation
 
20,526

1,650

1,637

1,428

1,361

1,332

13,118

Use of facilities and services
 
20,855

2,565

2,132

1,767

1,460

1,252

11,679

 
 
155,938

71,086

17,181

11,780

7,918

6,293

41,680

Total
 
304,780

91,194

30,143

24,947

19,746

18,037

120,713

a 
Expected payments include interest totalling $7,843 million ($1,730 million in 2020, $1,393 million in 2021, $1,207 million in 2022, $1,008 million in 2023, $809 million in 2024 and $1,696 million thereafter).
b 
Expected payments include interest totalling $1,577 million ($307 million in 2020, $248 million in 2021, $202 million in 2022, $164 million in 2023, $133 million in 2024 and $523 million thereafter).
c 
The amounts presented are undiscounted.
d 
The amounts presented are undiscounted. Gulf of Mexico oil spill liabilities are included in the group balance sheet, on a discounted basis, within other payables. See Financial statements – Note 22 for further information.
e 
Represents the expected future contributions to funded pension plans and payments by the group for unfunded pension plans and the expected future payments for other post-retirement benefits.
f 
Represents any agreement to purchase goods or services that is enforceable and legally binding and that specifies all significant terms (such as fixed or minimum purchase volumes, timing of purchase and pricing provisions). Agreements that do not specify all significant terms, or that are not enforceable, are excluded. The amounts shown include arrangements to secure long-term access to supplies of crude oil, natural gas, feedstocks and pipeline systems. In addition, the amounts shown for 2020 include purchase commitments existing at 31 December 2019 entered into principally to meet the group’s short-term manufacturing and marketing requirements. The price risk associated with these crude oil, natural gas and power contracts is discussed in Financial statements – Note 29.

Commitments for the delivery of oil and gas
We sell crude oil, natural gas and liquefied natural gas under a variety of contractual obligations.  Some of these contracts specify the delivery of fixed and determinable quantities.  For the period from 2020 to 2022 worldwide, we are contractually committed to deliver approximately 292 million barrels of oil, 8,600 billion cubic feet of natural gas, and 36 million tonnes of liquefied natural gas. The commitments principally relate to group subsidiaries based in Canada, Egypt, Singapore, United Kingdom and United States.  We expect to fulfil these delivery commitments with production from our proved developed reserves and supplies from existing contracts, supplemented by market purchases as necessary.


302
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Upstream analysis by region
Our upstream operations are set out below by geographical area, with associated significant events for 2019. BP’s percentage working interest in oil and gas assets is shown in brackets. Working interest is the cost-bearing ownership share of an oil or gas lease. Consequently, the percentages disclosed for certain agreements do not necessarily reflect the percentage interests in proved reserves and production.
In addition to exploration, development and production activities, our upstream business also includes midstream and liquefied natural gas (LNG) supply activities. Midstream activities involve the ownership and management of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, processing facilities and export terminals, LNG processing facilities and transportation, and our natural gas liquids (NGLs) processing business.
Our LNG supply activities are located in Abu Dhabi, Angola, Australia, Indonesia and Trinidad. In 2019 we marketed around 4.6 million tonnes of our LNG production to IST, which uses contractual rights to access import terminal capacity in the liquid markets of Italy (Rovigo), the Netherlands (Gate), Spain (Bilbao), the UK (the Isle of Grain) and the US (Cove Point), with the remainder marketed directly to customers or trading entities. LNG is supplied to customers into markets including Argentina, China, the Dominican Republic, European Union, India, Japan, Kuwait, Singapore, South Korea, Taiwan, Thailand and Turkey.
Europe
BP is active in the North Sea and the Norwegian Sea. In 2019 BP’s production came from three key areas: the Shetland area comprising the Clair, Foinaven, and Schiehallion fields; the central area comprising the Andrew area, Culzean, ETAP, Kinnoull and Shearwater fields; and Norway, through our equity accounted 30% interest in Aker BP.
In March 2019 a final investment decision was made on Seagull (BP 50%), a development tieback to ETAP in the central UK North Sea.
In June BP confirmed the start-up of gas production from the Total operated Culzean field (BP 32%) in the central UK North Sea.
Also in June, BP was awarded a new exploration licence in the 31st Offshore Licensing Round in the West of Shetland Area in the UK North Sea for one licence covering 10 blocks (BP 50% and operator).
In October production started at the Equinor operated Johan Sverdrup field (Aker BP 11.57%).
The Alligin field commenced production through the Glen Lyon facility in December 2019.
Development of the Vorlich field continued with two wells successfully drilled during the year. Production is expected to commence in 2020.
In January 2020 BP announced that it had agreed terms to sell its interests in the Andrew Area and non-operated interest in Shearwater to Premier Oil. The deal covers the Andrew, Arundel, Cyrus, Farragon and Kinnoull fields plus our interest in Shearwater. BP currently owns 62.75% of Andrew, 100% of Arundel, 100% of Cyrus, 50% of Farragon and 77.06% of Kinnoull.  We have a 27.50% share in Shearwater. Under the terms of the agreement, Premier Oil will pay BP $625m. The transaction is expected to complete in 2020.
North America
Our upstream activities in North America are located in five areas: deepwater Gulf of Mexico, the Lower 48 states, Alaska, Canada and Mexico.
BP has around 290 lease blocks in the Gulf of Mexico and operates four production hubs.
In February 2019 we announced the start-up of the Constellation project (BP 66.67%), operated by Anadarko.
On 6 May BP announced the final investment decision for the Thunder Horse South Expansion Phase 2 in the US Gulf of Mexico
 
(BP operator 75%, ExxonMobil 25%). This project will add two new subsea production units approximately two miles to the south of the existing Thunder Horse platform with two new production wells in the near term. Eventually eight wells will be drilled as part of the overall development, with first oil expected in 2021.
In June BP confirmed the discovery of King Embayment in the Mars corridor, in the US Gulf of Mexico (BP 28.5%).
BP participated in two lease sales in 2019. In March we were awarded 23 leases in lease sale 252, and in August we were awarded 21 leases in lease sale 253.
We have interests in three Paleogene fields: Tiber, Guadalupe, and Kaskida. Over the next few years we will be running subsurface work to better understand and define the concept development for these fields. BP has history with the development of technology required to develop such high pressure, deepwater fields and will continue to connect with the market to understand the options we will have available for the development of these fields.
See also Financial Statements Note 1 for further information on exploration leases.
BPX Energy, BP's onshore oil and gas business in the Lower 48 states, has significant operated and non-operated activities across Colorado, Louisiana, New Mexico, Oklahoma, Texas and Wyoming producing natural gas, oil, NGLs and condensate, with primary focus on developing unconventional resources in Texas. It had a 1.5 billion boe proved reserve base at 31 December 2019, predominantly in unconventional reservoirs (tight gas, shale gas and coalbed methane, and newly acquired shale oil). This resource spans 3.4 million net developed acres and has approximately 10,000 operated gross wells, with daily net production around 500mboe/d.
BPX Energy operates as a separate business while remaining part of our Upstream segment. With its own governance, systems and processes, it is structured to increase competitive performance through swift decision making and innovation, while maintaining BP’s commitment to safe, reliable and compliant operations.
On 1 March BPX Energy assumed physical control of all Petrohawk Energy Corporation operations from BHP following acquisition of these assets in 2018. BPX is making progress towards its goal of achieving $400 million of annual synergies by 2021, when integration is completed. BPX surpassed the 2019 savings estimate of $90m, delivering $240m in the first year after the acquisition.
In November 2019 BPX Energy confirmed agreements to sell its oil and gas interests in the San Juan basin in Colorado and New Mexico and the Arkoma basin in Oklahoma. These disposals completed in March 2020.  Additionally, in December 2019 BPX Energy completed divestments in certain fields within the Anadarko basin in Oklahoma and Texas and the Haynesville basin in Texas.  Primarily as a result of the divestment program of heritage assets, BPX Energy incurred $4.7 billion in impairment charges. Proceeds of $642 million were received in 2019, including performance deposits for the disposals that closed in 2020.
BP’s onshore US crude oil and product pipelines and related transportation assets are included in the Downstream segment.
In Alaska, BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. (BPXA) operated nine North Slope oilfields in the Greater Prudhoe Bay area at the end of the year. BP owns significant interests in three producing fields operated by others, as well as a non-operating interest in the Liberty development project.
BP Pipelines (Alaska) Inc. (BPPA) owns a 49% interest in the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System (TAPS). TAPS transports crude oil from Prudhoe Bay on the Alaska North Slope to the port of Valdez in southcentral Alaska. In April 2012 Unocal (1.37%) gave notice to the other TAPS owners of their intention to withdraw as an owner of TAPS. The remaining Owners and Unocal reached agreement in mid-2019 to settle ongoing litigation and transfer Unocal’s interest in TAPS to the other owners.  The Parties are seeking regulatory approval at the state and federal level.
On 27 August BP announced an agreement to sell the entirety of interests in its Alaska operations to Hilcorp Energy, including upstream and midstream businesses, for a headline price of $5.6

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
303


billion. BP will retain decommissioning liabilities associated with TAPS as part of the transaction. Subject to regulatory approval, the transaction is expected to complete in 2020. As part of this transaction BP recognized impairments of circa $1 billion in 2019.
In Canada BP is focused on oil sands development as well as pursuing offshore exploration opportunities. We utilize in-situ steam-assisted gravity drainage (SAGD) technology in our oil sands developments, which uses the injection of steam into the reservoir to warm the bitumen so that it can flow to the surface through producing wells. We hold interests in three oil sands lease areas through the Sunrise Oil Sands and Terre de Grace partnerships and the Pike Oil Sands joint operation«. In addition, we have offshore exploration licences in Nova Scotia, Newfoundland and Labrador and the Canadian Beaufort Sea.
In July the government of Canada issued an order prohibiting any work or activity authorized under the Canada Oil and Gas Operations Act on frontier lands that are situated in Canadian Arctic offshore waters. This includes the Beaufort Sea. The order will remain in effect until 31 December 2021. BP currently holds an intangible balance of $64 million related to two blocks operated by others in this area.
In Mexico, we have interests in two exploration joint operations in the Salina Basin with Equinor and Total, Block 1 (BP 33% and operator) and Block 3 (BP 33%), and in one exploration joint operation in the Sureste Basin with Total and Hokchi, a subsidiary of Pan American Energy Group (PAEG), Block 34 (BP 42.5% and operator).
Following approval from Comisión Nacional de Hidrocarburos (CNH), the Mexican regulator, of the exploration plans for both Salina Basin operations in March 2018, seismic interpretation and well planning activities continued in 2019. These activities are expected to ramp up in 2020 with tentative plans to commence drilling in the first half of 2021.
The Sureste Basin operation received exploration plan approval in July 2019 from CNH. Seismic licensing and reprocessing activities were initiated in 2019 and are expected to continue in 2020 with plans for drilling to commence in 2022.
In November we signed a swap agreement with Equinor covering our interests in Blocks 1 and 3 in the Salina Basin. Subject to receipt of Government approvals expected in the second half of 2020, BP’s interests are expected to be 56.67% in Block 1 and 10% in Block 3.
South America
BP has upstream activities in Brazil and Trinidad & Tobago and through PAEG, in Argentina and Bolivia and Uruguay.
In Brazil BP has interests in 26 exploration concessions across five basins.
In the North Campos basin BP is now formally the operator of BM-C-30 and BM-C-32 blocks following Anadarko's withdrawal from both blocks and the transfer of their interest. The Brazilian National Petroleum Agency (ANP) approved the joint venture’s request for a postponement of declaration of commerciality.
In the Foz de Amazonas basin Total as operator of blocks FZA-M-57, 86, 88, 125 and 127 is analysing the next steps following IBAMA’s license denial. The Foz do Amazonas blocks are eligible for a 2-year license extension according to Resolution 708, the deadline to request such extension is May 2020 for the Total-operated blocks. In the BP-operated block FZA-M-59, the extension deadline is March 2020, environmental licensing process is ongoing and the extension has been requested. All blocks may also be subject to further extensions should ANP agree. 
In the South Campos basin ANP approved a revised plan of appraisal for the BM-C-35 block. The agreement includes a commitment to drill an exploratory well in 2021 with a deadline to declare commerciality or end the appraisal period by 1 March 2022.
In the Pau Brasil block the consortium group is undertaking seismic reprocessing to aid in subsurface description.
In the Potiguar basin blocks ANP approved the consortium's request to modify the appraisal plan timelines.
 
In October, in the 16th bid round, BP was awarded exploration and production rights to block C-M-477 offshore Brazil in the Campos Basin (BP 30%) and to block S-M-1500 (BP 100%) in the Santos Basin.
PAEG, a joint venture that is owned by BP (50%) and Bridas Corporation (50%), has activities mainly in Argentina and Mexico, but is also present in Uruguay and Bolivia.
During the second quarter, BP achieved new access in Argentina’s first offshore licensing round blocks, obtaining the CAN-111 and CAN-113 blocks (BP 50%).
In Trinidad & Tobago BP holds interests in exploration and production licences and production-sharing contracts«(PSCs) covering 1.6 million acres offshore of the east and north-east coast. Facilities include 15 offshore platforms and two onshore processing facilities. Production comprises gas and associated liquids.
BP also holds interests in the Atlantic LNG facility. BP’s shareholding averages 39% across four LNG trains« with a combined capacity of approximately 15 million tonnes per annum. We sell gas to trains 1, 2 and 3 and process gas in train 4. Most of the LNG produced from BP gas supplied to trains 2, 3 and 4 is sold to third parties under long- term contracts. BP sells approximately one third of its gas production to the National Gas Company who supply the volumes into the petrochemical, power and other industrial markets. The remainder BP sells to third parties under long-term contracts.
Production started at the Angelin project (BP 100% and operator) in February 2019.
BP confirmed the following hydrocarbon discoveries during the year: Bélé-1 in April, Tuk-1 in May, Hi-Hat-1 in June, Boom-1 in September, and Ginger in November, all located offshore Trinidad and Tobago (BP 30%).
The initial gas sales and LNG offtake arrangements for Atlantic LNG Train 1 ended in September 2018 and gas is currently sold into Train 1 on a short-term basis with BP lifting the majority of the LNG produced. The Train 1 gas supply arrangements are under discussion for the period April 2020 onwards.
BP is operator of the Manakin Block which was discovered in 1998 and is a cross border reservoir field with the Venezuelan reservoir, Cocuina. Manakin declared commerciality in January 2018 however cross border commercial agreements have not progressed due to the impact of US sanctions.
Africa
BP’s upstream activities in Africa are located in Algeria, Angola, Côte d'Ivoire, Egypt, The Gambia, Libya, Madagascar, Mauritania, São Tomé & Príncipe and Senegal.
In Algeria BP, Sonatrach and Equinor are partners in the In Salah (BP 33.15%) and In Amenas (BP 45.89%) non-operated joint ventures that supply gas to the domestic and European markets.
In Angola, BP owns an interest in five major deepwater offshore licences and is operator in two of these, Blocks 18 and 31, that are producing. We also have an equity interest in the Angola LNG plant (BP 13.6%).
On 6 June BP announced an agreement to extend the production- sharing agreement«(PSA) for Block 15 to 2032 and to provide for Sonangol to take a 10% equity interest in the Block. The transaction completed on 27 January 2020.
Development progressed at the Total-operated Zinia 2 deep offshore development project in Block 17 (BP 16.67%). At the end of 2019 construction activities were underway, with first production expected in 2021.
Development progressed at the Platina project in Block 18, with construction activities expected to commence in 2020 and first production expected in 2021.
In November BP agreed to join the New Gas Consortium (NGC), subject to completion of certain conditions precedent. This will be the first upstream natural gas partnership in Angola and will be operated by ENI (BP 11.8%).

304
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


In December the Total-operated Block 17 contractor group signed an agreement with the national agency ANPG (Agência Nacional de Petróleo, Gás e Biocombustíveis) and Sonangol, to extend all Block 17 production licenses up to 2045, subject to Government approval. As part of the extension agreement, Sonangol will become a 5% holder in Block 17 from 2020 with an additional 5% interest from 2036.
In Côte d’Ivoire, BP has interests in five offshore oil blocks with Kosmos Energy (KE) under agreements with the government of Côte d'Ivoire and the state oil company Société Nationale d'Operations Pétrolières de la Côte d'Ivoire (PETROCI) (BP 45%). Seismic reprocessing and interpretation are ongoing and are expected to be completed by the end of 2020.
In Egypt, BP and its partners currently produce 60% of Egypt’s gas production.
In February 2019 production started at the Giza and Fayoum fields in the West Nile Delta development (BP 82.75%).
In March 2019 BP confirmed a gas discovery, in the ENI operated Nour North Sinai offshore prospect (BP 25%) in the Egyptian Eastern Mediterranean. Technical studies are currently being progressed by the operator.
In June BP announced an agreement to sell its interests in Gulf of Suez oil concessions in Egypt, including BP’s interest in the Gulf of Suez Production Company (GUPCO), to Dragon Oil. The agreement, completed in October 2019.
In September BP confirmed the start-up of the offshore Baltim South West gas field in Egypt (BP 50%).
Work continues at the West Nile Delta Raven project, which is mechanically complete and currently addressing issues identified during commissioning. Start up is now expected in the second half of 2020.
In the Gambia, BP has a 90% interest in offshore block A1 with the state oil company, Gambia National Petroleum Corporation. An exploration well is expected to be drilled during the first two years of the licence.
In Libya, BP partners with the Libyan Investment Authority (LIA) in an exploration and production-sharing agreement (EPSA) to explore acreage in the onshore Ghadames and offshore Sirt basins (BP 85%). BP wrote off all balances associated with the Libya EPSA in 2015.
BP, LIA and Eni continue to work with the NOC towards Eni acquiring a 42.5% interest in the BP-operated EPSA in Libya. On completion, Eni would become operator of the EPSA. The companies are continuing to work together to finalize and complete all agreements.

In Mauritania and Senegal, BP has a 62% participating interest in the C6, C8, C12 and C13 exploration blocks in Mauritania and a 60% participating interest in the Cayar Profond Offshore and St Louis Profond Ofshore exploration blocks in Senegal. Together these blocks cover approximately 24,300 square kilometres. BP also had a 15% interest in the Total operated C18 exploration block until exit in May 2019. For the Greater Tortue Ahmeyin (GTA) Unit across the border of Mauritania and Senegal, BP has 56% participating interest. The Phase 1 Execute activity has continued to ramp up following the exploitation license grant on 20th February 2019.
In July BP confirmed that the GTA-1 (BP 56% and operator) appraisal well, located offshore Senegal, encountered approximately 30 metres of net gas pay in high-quality Albian reservoir confirming gas resource expectations.
In September BP confirmed the Yakaar-2 appraisal well in the Cayar Profond block (BP 60% and Operator), located offshore Senegal, encountered approximately 22 metres of net gas pay in the reservoir confirming gas resource.
In December BP confirmed the successful result of the Orca-1 appraisal well located in block C8 (BP 62% and operator) in the Bir Allah appraisal area offshore Mauritania. The well successfully encountered all five of the gas sands originally targeted. The well
 
was then further deepened to reach an additional target, which also encountered gas.
In Madagascar, BP has interest in four PSCs for exploration licences situated offshore northwest Madagascar, under agreements with the government of Madagascar represented by Office des Mines Nationales et des Industries Stratégiques (OMNIS) (BP 100%). A baseline monitoring survey is underway as part of Phase 1 of the exploration period.
In São Tomé & Príncipe, BP is operator in two offshore blocks under PSAs with KE and the state oil company Agencia Nacional do Petroleo (BP 50%). Following the acquisition and analysis of baseline environmental data, seismic acquisition is ongoing and expected to be completed by mid-2020.
Asia
BP has activities in Abu Dhabi, Azerbaijan, China, India, Iraq, Kuwait, Oman and Russia.
In China we have a 30% equity stake in the Guangdong LNG regasification terminal and trunkline project with a total storage capacity of 640,000 cubic metres. The project is supplied under a long-term contract with Australia’s North West Shelf venture (BP 16.67%).
In the first quarter of 2019 BP relinquished its interest in its two PSCs for shale gas exploration, development and production in the Neijiang-Dazu block and Rong Chang Bei block in the Sichuan basin, resulting in a $141m exploration write-off. Exit was fully completed in the fourth quarter of 2019 when a termination agreement was formally executed with CNPC.
In Azerbaijan, BP operates two PSAs, Azeri-Chirag-Gunashli (ACG) (BP 30.37%) and Shah Deniz (BP 28.83%) and also holds a number of other exploration leases.
Naftiran Intertrade Co Ltd (NICO), a subsidiary of the National Iranian Oil Company, holds a 10% interest in the Shah Deniz joint venture. For information on the exclusion of this project from EU and US trade sanctions, or exemptions from such trade sanctions in relation to this project, see International trade sanctions on page 320.
In April a final investment decision was made on the Azeri Central East (ACE) project, the next stage of the Azeri-Chirag-Deepwater Gunashli (ACG) field. The $6 billion development includes a new offshore platform and facilities designed to process up to 100,000 barrels of oil per day. The project is expected to achieve first production in 2023.
BP holds a 30.1% interest in and operates the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan oil pipeline. The 1,768-kilometre pipeline transports oil from the BP-operated ACG oilfield and gas condensate from the Shah Deniz gas field in the Caspian Sea, along with other third-party oil, to the eastern Mediterranean port of Ceyhan. The pipeline has a capacity of 1mmboe/d, with an average throughput in 2019 of 643mboe/d.
BP (as operator of Azerbaijan International Operating Company) also operates the Western Route Export Pipeline that transports ACG oil to Supsa on the Black Sea coast of Georgia, with an average throughput of 76mboe/d in 2019.
BP is technical operator of, and currently holds a 28.83% interest in, the 693 kilometre South Caucasus Pipeline. The pipeline takes gas from Azerbaijan through Georgia to the Turkish border and has a capacity of 440mboe/d (including expansion), with average throughput in 2019 of 177mboe/d.
BP also holds a 12% interest in the Trans Anatolian Natural Gas Pipeline. In the first phase, which commenced in 2018, gas from Shah Deniz is transported from Georgia to Eskishehir in Turkey. The capacity of the pipeline during the first phase is 100mboe/d and the average throughput in 2019 was 47mboe/d. The second phase will take gas from Eskishehir to the connection with the Trans Adriatic Pipeline (TAP) in Greece. BP has a 20% interest in TAP, that will take gas through Greece and Albania into Italy.
In Oman BP operates the Khazzan field in Block 61 (BP 60%).
Progress on the Ghazeer project, phase two of the Khazzan development, is on track for first gas in 2021.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
305


In July BP and Eni signed an EPSA for Block 77 (BP 50%) in central Oman with the Ministry of Oil and Gas of the Sultanate of Oman. Approval by Royal Decree is still pending.
In Abu Dhabi, BP holds a 10% interest in the ADNOC Onshore concession. We also have a 10% equity shareholding in ADNOC LNG and a 10% shareholding in the shipping company NGSCO. ADNOC LNG supplied approximately 6 million tonnes of LNG (0.786bcfed regasified) in 2019. Our interest in the ADNOC Onshore concession expires at the end of 2054.
In March 2019 ADNOC and ADNOC LNG agreed to extend the gas supply agreement to 2040. The new agreement took effect from 1 April 2019, and replaced an existing agreement which expired on 31 March 2019.
Also in March 2019 ADNOC LNG and NGSCO agreed to extend the transportation agreements and the shipping services agreement to 2022. The new agreements took effect from 1 April 2019, and replaced an existing agreement which expired on 31 March 2019.
In 2016 BP signed an enhanced technical service agreement for south and east Kuwait conventional oilfields, which includes the Burgan field, with Kuwait Oil Company. Target performance for the 2018-19 plan was delivered and implementation of the 2019-20 plan is underway.
In India we have a participating interest in two oil and gas PSAs (KG D6 33.33% and NEC25 33.33%), one oil and gas block under a Revenue Sharing Contract (KG-UDWHP-2018/1), all operated by Reliance Industries Limited (RIL). We also have a stake in a 50:50 joint venture (India Gas Solutions Private Limited) with RIL for the sourcing and marketing of gas in India.
In June BP and RIL announced the sanction of the MJ gas development project (also known as D55) in Block KG D6, offshore the east coast of India. MJ is the third of three new projects in the Block KG D6 integrated development plan.
All three KG D6 Projects (R-Series, Satellites Cluster and MJ) are under development with first gas production phased over 2020-2022. R-Series, the first of the three projects, is expected to begin production in 2020.
BP and its partner RIL have been awarded the ultra deep-water Block KG-UDWHP-2018/1 (RIL operator 60%, BP 40%) adjacent to Block KG D6 in India’s Open Acreage Licensing Policy round 2 and both RIL and BP have entered into a Revenue Sharing Contract with the Government of India (GoI).
Pursuant to government approval, Niko (NECO) Limited’s 10% participating interest in Block KG D6 has been assigned to BP and RIL proportionately in the ratio of their existing interests (RIL 6.67%, BP 3.33%), in compliance with the PSC and JOA requirements.
In Iraq BP holds a 47.6% working interest and is the lead contractor in the Rumaila technical service contract in southern Iraq. The technical services contract runs to December 2034. Rumaila is one of the world’s largest oil fields, comprising five producing reservoirs. BP's activities have not been materially impacted by the continued political instability and public protests which have occurred in 2019.
In Russia in addition to its 19.75% equity interest in Rosneft, BP holds a 20% interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha (Taas) together with Rosneft (50.1%) and a consortium comprising Oil India Limited, Indian Oil Corporation Limited and Bharat PetroResources Limited (29.9%). Taas is developing the Srednebotuobinskoye oil and gas condensate field in East Siberia. Also with Rosneft, we hold a 49% interest in Kharampurneftegaz LLC (Kharampur) to develop subsoil resources within the Kharampurskoe and Festivalnoye licence areas in Yamalo-Nenets. Rosneft (51%) and BP (49%) jointly own Yermak Neftegaz LLC (Yermak), which conducts onshore exploration in the West Siberian and Yenisei-Khatanga basins and currently holds five exploration and production licences. See Rosneft on page 61 for further details.
In April the right to explore two additional oil and gas licence areas located in Sakha (Yakutia) was transferred to a Yermak wholly owned subsidiary.
 
Australasia
BP has activities in Australia and Eastern Indonesia.
In Australia BP is one of seven participants in the North West Shelf (NWS) venture, which has been producing LNG, pipeline gas, condensate, LPG and oil since the 1980s. Six partners (including BP) hold an equal 16.67% interest in the gas infrastructure and an equal 15.78% interest in the gas and condensate reserves, with a seventh partner owning the remaining 5.32%. BP also has a 16.67% interest in some of the NWS oil reserves and related infrastructure. The NWS venture is currently the largest single source supplier to the domestic market in Western Australia and one of the largest LNG export projects in the region, with five LNG trains in operation. BP’s net share of the capacity of NWS LNG trains 1-5 is 2.7 million tonnes of LNG per year.
BP is also one of five participants in the Browse LNG venture (operated by Woodside) and holds a 17.33% interest.
The Browse joint venture participants are progressing the development of Browse by connecting it via a 900km pipeline to the NWS Venture's Karratha Gas Plant. A final investment decision is expected in late 2021.
During the second quarter BP achieved new access with a farm-in to an exploration permit WA-359-P offshore Western Australia (BP 42.5% and operator).
In September BP confirmed the award of the WA-541 acreage permit in Western Australia’s offshore Northern Carnarvon basin (BP 50%).
In Papua Barat, Eastern Indonesia, BP operates the Tangguh LNG plant (BP 40.22%). The asset currently comprises 16 producing wells, two offshore platforms, two pipelines and an LNG plant with two production trains. It has a total capacity of 7.6 million tonnes of LNG per annum. Tangguh supplies LNG to customers in Indonesia, Mexico, China, South Korea, and Japan through a combination of long, medium and short-term contracts.
The Tangguh expansion project comprises a third LNG processing train, two offshore platforms, 13 new production wells, an expanded LNG loading facility, and supporting infrastructure. The project will add 3.8 million tonnes per annum (mtpa) of production capacity to the existing facility, bringing total plant capacity to 11.4mtpa. The installation of offshore platforms and pipelines has completed while the multi-year drilling campaign continues after the completion of the first production well. The construction of the LNG processing train is in progress with expected start-up in 2021.
.

306
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Downstream plant capacity
The following tablea summarizes BP group’s interests in refineries and average daily crude distillation capacities as at 31 December 2019.
 
 
 
 
Crude distillation capacitiesbc
 
Fuels value chain
Country
Refinery
 
Group interestd
(%)

BP share
thousand barrels
per day

US
 
 
 
 
 
US North West
US
Cherry Point
 
100

251

US East of Rockies
 
Whiting
 
100

440

 
 
Toledo
 
50

80

 
 
 
 
 
771

Europe
 
 
 
 
 
Rhine
Germany
Gelsenkirchen
 
100

265

 
 
Lingen
 
100

97

 
Netherlands
Rotterdam
 
100

387

Iberia
Spain
Castellón
 
100

110

 
 
 
 
 
859

Rest of world
 
 
 
 
 
Australia
Australia
Kwinana
 
100

152

New Zealand
New Zealand
Whangareief
 
10.1

34

Southern Africa
South Africa
Durbane
 
50

90

 
 
 
 
 
276

Total BP share of capacity at 31 December 2019
 
 
1,906

a This does not include BP’s interest in Pan American Energy Group.
b Crude distillation capacity is gross rated capacity, which is defined as the highest average sustained unit rate for a consecutive 30-day period under normal operational conditions.
c On 31 December 2019 we completed the sale of our interest in the German Bayernoil refinery.
d BP share of equity, which is not necessarily the same as BP share of processing entitlements.
e Indicates refineries not operated by BP.
f Reflects BP share of processing entitlement, which is not the same as BP share of equity.

Petrochemicals production capacitya 
The following table summarizes BP group’s share of petrochemicals production capacities as at 31 December 2019.
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP share of capacity
thousand tonnes per annumb
 
 
 
 
 
 
Product

Geographical area
Site
Group interestc
(%)

 
PTA

PX

Acetic
acid

Olefins and
derivatives

Others

US
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cooper River
100

 
1,400





 
Texas Cityd
100

 

900

600


100

 
 
 
 
1,400

900

600


100

Europe
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UK
Hull
100

 


500


200

Belgium
Geel
100

 
1,400

700




Germany
Gelsenkirchene
100

 



3,300


 
Mülheime
100

 




200

 
 
 
 
1,400

700

500

3,300

400

Rest of world
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trinidad & Tobago
Point Lisas
36.9

 




700

China
Chongqing
51

 


200


100

 
Nanjing
50

 


300



 
Zhuhaif
91.9

 
2,500





Indonesia
Merak
100

 
500





South Korea
Ulsang
34-51

 


300


100

Malaysia
Kertih
70

 


400



Taiwan
Mai Liao
50

 


200



 
Taichung
61.4

 
500





 
 
 
 
3,500


1,400


900

 
 
 
 
6,300

1,600

2,500

3,300

1,400

Total BP share of capacity at 31 December 2019
 
 
 


15,100

a 
Petrochemicals production capacity is the proven maximum sustainable daily rate (MSDR) multiplied by the number of days in the respective period, where MSDR is the highest average daily rate ever achieved over a sustained period.
b 
Capacities are shown to the nearest hundred thousand tonnes per annum.
c 
Includes BP share of non-operated equity-accounted entities, as indicated.
d 
For acetic acid, group interest is quoted at 100%, reflecting the capacity entitlement which is marketed by BP.
e 
Due to the integrated nature of these plants with our Gelsenkirchen refinery, the income and expenditure of these plants is managed and reported through the fuels business.
f 
BP Zhuhai Chemical Company Ltd is a subsidiary«of BP, the capacity of which is shown above at 100%.
g 
Group interest varies by product.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
307


Oil and gas disclosures for the group
Resource progression
BP manages its hydrocarbon resources in three major categories: prospect inventory, contingent resources and reserves. When a discovery is made, volumes usually transfer from the prospect inventory to the contingent resources category. The contingent resources move through various sub-categories as their technical and commercial maturity increases through appraisal activity.
At the point of final investment decision, most proved reserves will be categorized as proved undeveloped (PUD). Volumes will subsequently be recategorized from PUD to proved developed (PD) as a consequence of development activity. When part of a well’s proved reserves depends on a later phase of activity, only that portion of proved reserves associated with existing, available facilities and infrastructure moves to PD. The first PD bookings will typically occur at the point of first oil or gas production. Major development projects typically take one to five years from the time of initial booking of PUD to the start of production. Changes to proved reserves bookings may be made due to analysis of new or existing data concerning production, reservoir performance, commercial factors and additional reservoir development activity.
Volumes can also be added or removed from our portfolio through acquisition or divestment of properties and projects. When we dispose of an interest in a property or project, the volumes associated with our adopted plan of development for which we have a final investment decision will be removed from our proved reserves upon completion of the transaction. When we acquire an interest in a property or project, the volumes associated with the existing development and any committed projects will be added to our proved reserves if BP has made a final investment decision and they satisfy the SEC’s criteria for attribution of proved status. Following the acquisition, additional volumes may be progressed to proved reserves from non-proved reserves or contingent resources.
Non-proved reserves and contingent resources in a field will only be recategorized as proved reserves when all the criteria for attribution of proved status have been met and the volumes are included in the business plan and scheduled for development, typically within five years. BP will only book proved reserves where development is scheduled to commence after more than five years, if these proved reserves satisfy the SEC’s criteria for attribution of proved status and BP management has reasonable certainty that these proved reserves will be produced.
At the end of 2019 BP had material volumes of proved undeveloped reserves held for more than five years in Russia, Trinidad, Gulf of Mexico and the North Sea. These are part of ongoing infrastructure-led development activities for which BP has a historical track record of completing comparable projects in these countries. We have no proved undeveloped reserves held for more than five years in our onshore US developments.
In each case the volumes are being progressed as part of an adopted development plan where there are physical limits to the development timing such as infrastructure limitations, contractual limits including gas delivery commitments, late life compression and the complex nature of working in remote locations, or where there are significant commitments on delivery to the relevant authority.
Over the past five years, BP has annually progressed a weighted average 19% (19% for 2018 five-year average) of our group proved undeveloped reserves (including the impact of disposals and price acceleration effects in PSAs) to proved developed reserves. This equates to a turnover time of less than five and a half years. We expect the turnover time to remain near this level and anticipate the volume of proved undeveloped reserves held for more than five years to remain about the same.
Proved reserves as estimated at the end of 2019 meet BP’s criteria for project sanctioning and SEC tests for proved reserves. We have not halted or changed our commitment to proceed with any material project to which proved undeveloped reserves have been attributed.
 
In 2019 we progressed 1,328mmboe of proved undeveloped reserves (561mmboe for our subsidiaries« alone) to proved developed reserves through ongoing investment in our subsidiaries’ and equity-accounted entities’ upstream development activities. Total development expenditure, excluding midstream activities, was $15,206 million in 2019 ($10,815 million for subsidiaries and $4,391 million for equity-accounted entities). The major areas with progressed volumes in 2019 were Russia, US, Trinidad, Egypt, Azerbaijan, Argentina, Oman and UAE. Revisions of previous estimates for proved undeveloped reserves are due to changes relating to field performance, well results or changes in commercial conditions including price impacts. There were material net negative revisions in the US Lower 48 due to reducing price impacts and changes in our development plan to incorporate activity associated with the purchase of new assets partially offset by material net positive revisions to our proved undeveloped resources in Russia as a result of development drilling results. The following tables describe the changes to our proved undeveloped reserves position through the year for our subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities and for our subsidiaries alone.
Subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
volumes in mmboea

Proved undeveloped reserves at 1 January 2019
8,908

Revisions of previous estimates
(320
)
Improved recovery
316

Discoveries and extensions
563

Purchases
17

Sales
(35
)
Total in year proved undeveloped reserves changes
541

Proved developed reserves reclassified as undeveloped
31

Progressed to proved developed reserves by development activities (e.g. drilling/completion)
(1,328
)
Proved undeveloped reserves at 31 December 2019
8,152

 
 
Subsidiaries only
volumes in mmboea

Proved undeveloped reserves at 1 January 2019
4,447

Revisions of previous estimates
(545
)
Improved recovery
309

Discoveries and extensions
130

Purchases
10

Sales
(29
)
Total in year proved undeveloped reserves changes
(127
)
Proved developed reserves reclassified as undeveloped
13

Progressed to proved developed reserves by development activities (e.g. drilling/completion)
(561
)
Proved undeveloped reserves at 31 December 2019
3,771

a 
Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.

BP bases its proved reserves estimates on the requirement of reasonable certainty with rigorous technical and commercial assessments based on conventional industry practice and regulatory requirements. BP only applies technologies that have been field tested and have been demonstrated to provide reasonably certain results with consistency and repeatability in the formation being evaluated or in an analogous formation. BP applies high-resolution seismic data for the identification of reservoir extent and fluid contacts only where there is an overwhelming track record of success in its local application. In certain cases BP uses numerical simulation as part of a holistic assessment of recovery factor for its fields, where these simulations have been field tested and have been demonstrated to provide reasonably certain results with consistency and repeatability in the formation being evaluated or in an analogous formation. In certain deepwater fields BP has booked proved reserves before production flow tests are conducted, in part because of the significant safety, cost and environmental implications of conducting these tests. The industry has made substantial technological improvements in understanding, measuring and delineating reservoir properties without the need for flow tests. To determine reasonable

308
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


certainty of commercial recovery, BP employs a general method of reserves assessment that relies on the integration of three types of data:
well data used to assess the local characteristics and conditions of reservoirs and fluids
field scale seismic data to allow the interpolation and extrapolation of these characteristics outside the immediate area of the local well control
data from relevant analogous fields.
Well data includes appraisal wells or sidetrack holes, full logging suites, core data and fluid samples. BP considers the integration of this data in certain cases to be superior to a flow test in providing understanding of overall reservoir performance. The collection of data from logs, cores, wireline formation testers, pressures and fluid samples calibrated to each other and to the seismic data can allow reservoir properties to be determined over a greater volume than the localized volume of investigation associated with a short-term flow test. There is a strong track record of proved reserves recorded using these methods, validated by actual production levels.
Governance
BP’s centrally controlled process for proved reserves estimation approval forms part of a holistic and integrated system of internal control. It consists of the following elements:
Accountabilities of certain officers of the group to ensure that there is review and approval of proved reserves bookings independent of the operating business and that there are effective controls in the approval process and verification that the proved reserves estimates and the related financial impacts are reported in a timely manner.
Capital allocation processes, whereby delegated authority is exercised to commit to capital projects that are consistent with the delivery of the group’s business plan. A formal review process exists to ensure that both technical and commercial criteria are met prior to the commitment of capital to projects.
Group audit, whose role is to consider whether the group’s system of internal control is adequately designed and operating effectively to respond appropriately to the risks that are significant to BP.
Approval hierarchy, whereby proved reserves changes above certain threshold volumes require immediate review and all proved reserves require annual central authorization and have scheduled periodic reviews. The frequency of periodic review ensures that 100% of the BP proved reserves base undergoes central review every three years.
BP’s vice president of segment reserves is the petroleum engineer primarily responsible for overseeing the preparation of the reserves estimate. He has more than 35 years of diversified industry experience, with 14 years spent managing the governance and compliance of BP’s reserves estimation. He is a past member of the Society of Petroleum Engineers Oil and Gas Reserves Committee and of the American Association of Petroleum Geologists Committee on Resource Evaluation and is the current chair of the bureau of the United Nations Economic Commission for Europe Expert Group on Resource Management.
No specific portion of compensation bonuses for senior management is directly related to proved reserves targets. Additions to proved reserves is one of several indicators by which the performance of the Upstream segment is assessed by the remuneration committee for the purposes of determining compensation bonuses for the executive directors. Other indicators include a number of financial and operational measures.
BP’s variable pay programme for the other senior managers in the Upstream segment is based on individual performance contracts. Individual performance contracts are based on agreed items from the business performance plan, one of which, if chosen, could relate to proved reserves.
 
Compliance
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) do not provide specific guidance on reserves disclosures. BP estimates proved reserves in accordance with SEC Rule 4-10 (a) of Regulation S-X and relevant Compliance and Disclosure Interpretations (C&DI) and Staff Accounting Bulletins as issued by the SEC staff.
By their nature, there is always some risk involved in the ultimate development and production of proved reserves including, but not limited to: final regulatory approval; the installation of new or additional infrastructure, as well as changes in oil and gas prices; changes in operating and development costs; and the continued availability of additional development capital. All the group’s proved reserves held in subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities are estimated by the group’s petroleum engineers or by independent petroleum engineering consulting firms and then assured by the group’s petroleum engineers.
DeGolyer & MacNaughton (D&M), an independent petroleum engineering consulting firm, has estimated the net proved crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids (NGLs) and natural gas reserves, as of 31 December 2019, of certain properties owned by Rosneft as part of our equity-accounted proved reserves. The properties evaluated by D&M account for 100% of Rosneft’s net proved reserves as of 31 December 2019. The net proved reserves estimates prepared by D&M were prepared in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rule 4-10(a)(1)-(32) of Regulation S-X. All reserves estimates involve some degree of uncertainty. BP has filed D&M’s independent report on its reserves estimates as an exhibit to this Annual Report on Form 20-F filed with the SEC.
Netherland, Sewell & Associates (NSAI), an independent petroleum engineering consulting firm, has estimated the net proved crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids (NGLs) and natural gas reserves, as of 31 December 2019, of certain properties owned by BP in the US Lower 48. The properties evaluated by NSAI account for 100% of BP’s net proved reserves in the US Lower 48 as of 31 December 2019. The net proved reserves estimates prepared by NSAI were prepared in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rule 4-10(a)(1)-(32) of Regulation S-X. All reserves estimates involve some degree of uncertainty. BP has filed NSAI’s independent report on its reserves estimates as an exhibit to this Annual Report on Form 20-F filed with the SEC.
Our proved reserves are associated with both concessions (tax and royalty arrangements) and agreements where the group is exposed to the upstream risks and rewards of ownership, but where our entitlement to the hydrocarbons« is calculated using a more complex formula, such as with PSAs. In a concession, the consortium of which we are a part is entitled to the proved reserves that can be produced over the licence period, which may be the life of the field. In a PSA, we are entitled to recover volumes that equate to costs incurred to develop and produce the proved reserves and an agreed share of the remaining volumes or the economic equivalent. As part of our entitlement is driven by the monetary amount of costs to be recovered, price fluctuations will have an impact on both production volumes and reserves.
We disclose our share of proved reserves held in equity-accounted entities (joint ventures« and associates«), although we do not control these entities or the assets held by such entities.
BP’s estimated net proved reserves and proved reserves replacement
91% of our total proved reserves of subsidiaries at 31 December 2019 were held through joint operations«(89% in 2018), and 28% of the proved reserves were held through such joint operations where we were not the operator (34% in 2018).

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
309


Estimated net proved reserves of crude oil at 31 December 2019a b c 
 
 
million barrels
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

UK
206

200

406

USd
1,063

842

1,905

Rest of North Americae
40

179

218

South Americaf
7

5

12

Africa
156

40

196

Rest of Asia
1,074

525

1,599

Australasia
26

4

30

Subsidiaries
2,572

1,794

4,367

Equity-accounted entities
3,567

2,847

6,415

Total
6,140

4,642

10,781

Estimated net proved reserves of natural gas liquids at 31 December 2019a b 
 
 
million barrels
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

UK
8

5

13

US
229

250

479

Rest of North America



South America
2

21

23

Africa
12

4

16

Rest of Asia



Australasia
4


4

Subsidiaries
255

280

535

Equity-accounted entities
107

55

162

Total
363

334

697

Estimated net proved reserves of liquids«
 
 
million barrels
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

Subsidiariesf
2,828

2,074

4,902

Equity-accounted entitiesg
3,675

2,902

6,576

Total
6,502

4,976

11,478

Estimated net proved reserves of natural gas at 31 December 2019a b 
 
billion cubic feet
 
 
Developed

Undeveloped

Total

UK
493

207

700

US
6,330

2,127

8,458

Rest of North America



South Americah
2,192

2,235

4,427

Africa
1,163

742

1,905

Rest of Asia
3,667

3,401

7,068

Australasia
2,256

1,132

3,389

Subsidiaries
16,101

9,844

25,946

Equity-accounted entitiesi
11,079

8,576

19,656

Total
27,181

18,421

45,601

Estimated net proved reserves on an oil equivalent basisj 
 
million barrels of oil equivalent
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

Subsidiaries
5,604

3,771

9,375

Equity-accounted entities
5,585

4,381

9,965

Total
11,189

8,152

19,341

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently, and include non-controlling interests in consolidated operations. We disclose our share of reserves held in joint ventures and associates that are accounted for by the equity method although we do not control these entities or the assets held by such entities.
b 
The 2019 marker prices used were Brent« $62.74/bbl (2018 $71.43/bbl and 2017 $54.36/bbl) and Henry Hub« $2.58/mmBtu (2018 $3.10/mmBtu and 2017 $2.96/mmBtu).
c 
Includes condensate.
d 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 4.5 million barrels on which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e 
All of the reserves in Canada are bitumen.
 
f 
Includes 11 million barrels of liquids in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
g 
Includes 357 million barrels of liquids in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 26 million barrels held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
h 
Includes 1,330 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
i 
Includes 1,430 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 569 billion cubic feet held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
j Includes 982 million barrels of oil equivalent associated with Assets held for sale in the US.


Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.
Proved reserves replacement
Total hydrocarbon proved reserves at 31 December 2019, on an oil equivalent basis including equity-accounted entities, decreased by 3% (decrease of 8% for subsidiaries and increase of 2% for equity-accounted entities) compared with 31 December 2018. Natural gas represented about 41% (48% for subsidiaries and 34% for equity-accounted entities) of these reserves. The change includes a net decrease from acquisitions and disposals of 133mmboe (decrease of 134mmboe within our subsidiaries and increase of 1mmboe within our equity-accounted entities). Acquisition activity in our subsidiaries occurred in India, and divestment activity in our subsidiaries in the US and Egypt. There were no material acquisitions or divestments in our equity-accounted entities.
The proved reserves replacement ratio« is the extent to which production is replaced by proved reserves additions. This ratio is expressed in oil equivalent terms and includes changes resulting from revisions to previous estimates, improved recovery, and extensions and discoveries. For 2019, the proved reserves replacement ratio excluding acquisitions and disposals was 67% (100% in 2018 and 143% in 2017) for subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities, 25% for subsidiaries alone and 141% for equity-accounted entities alone. There was a net decrease (221mmboe) of reserves due to lower gas and oil prices mainly within the US Lower 48 (-206mmboe). The total loss was partly offset by increases in reserves in our PSAs, principally in Azerbaijan, Iraq and Angola.
In 2019 net additions to the group’s proved reserves (excluding production and sales and purchases of reserves-in-place) amounted to 939mmboe (230mmboe for subsidiaries and 709mmboe for equity-accounted entities), through revisions to previous estimates, improved recovery from, and extensions to, existing fields and discoveries of new fields. The subsidiary additions were through improved recovery from, and extensions to, existing fields and discoveries of new fields where they represented a mixture of proved developed and proved undeveloped reserves. Volumes added in 2019 principally resulted from the application of conventional technologies and extensions of field size by development drilling. The principal proved reserves additions in our subsidiaries by region were in the US, Oman, UAE, Azerbaijan and India. We had material reductions in our proved reserves in US Lower 48 principally due to lower oil and gas prices. The principal reserves additions in our equity-accounted entities were in Pan American Energy Group, Rosneft and Kharampurneftegaz LLC.
15% of our proved reserves are associated with PSAs. The countries in which we produced under PSAs in 2019 were Algeria, Angola, Azerbaijan, Egypt, India, Indonesia and Oman. In addition, the technical service contract (TSC) governing our investment in the Rumaila field in Iraq functions as a PSA.
The group holds no licences due to expire within the next three years that would have a significant impact on BP’s reserves or production. BP holds reserves classified as Assets held for sale within the US associated with our announced divestment of our Alaska and San Juan fields.
For further information on our reserves see page 239.

310
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


BP’s net production by country – crude oila and natural gas liquids
 
 
 
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP net share of productionb
 
 
 
 
Crude oil

 
 
 
Natural gas
liquids

 
2019

2018

2017

 
2019

2018

2017

Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UKc d
100

101

80

 
3

5

6

Total Europe
100

101

80

 
3

5

6

Alaskac
71

106

109

 



Lower 48 onshorec
66

18

10

 
58

37

34

Gulf of Mexico deepwater
263

261

251

 
24

23

21

Total US
400

385

370

 
81

60

56

Canadae
24

24

20

 



Total Rest of North America
24

24

20

 



Total North America
424

408

390

 
81

60

56

Trinidad & Tobagoc
7

7

12

 
9

9

10

Total South America
7

7

12

 
9

9

10

Angola
115

147

192

 



Egyptc
34

49

40

 



Algeria
7

9

9

 
8

11

10

Total Africa
156

204

241

 
8

11

10

Abu Dhabic
180

169

158

 



Azerbaijan
79

72

90

 



Iraq
64

54

73

 



India


1

 



Oman
20

17

2

 



Total Rest of Asia
343

313

325

 



Total Asia
343

313

325

 



Australiac
15

16

15

 
2

2

2

Eastern Indonesiac
2

2

1

 



Total Australasia
17

17

17

 
2

2

2

Total subsidiaries
1,046

1,051

1,064

 
104

88

85

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 

Rosneft (Russia, Canada, Venezuela, Vietnam)
920

919

900

 
3

4

4

Abu Dhabi

16

99

 



Argentinac
54

52

60

 
1



Boliviac
2

3

3

 



Egypt



 
3

3

2

Norwayc
35

34

31

 
2

2

2

Russiac
35

14

5

 



Angola
1

1

1

 
5

3

4

Other



 



Total equity-accounted entities
1,047

1,040

1,099

 
14

12

12

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entitiesf
2,093

2,091

2,163

 
118

100

97

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
a 
Includes condensate.
b 
Production excludes royalties due to others whether payable in cash or in kind where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
c 
In 2019, BP completed the sale of its interest in the Gulf of Suez Petroleum Company (GUPCO) in Egypt and certain US assets in Lower 48 onshore and disposed of its interests in the Gulf of Mexico Santiago and Santa Cruz wells. In 2018, BP acquired various interests in the Permian Basin, Eagle Ford and Haynesville Shales in Lower 48 onshore as a result of the acquisition of BHP’s US unconventional assets, increased its interest in the Clair asset in the UK North Sea, and acquired an interest in LLC Kharampurneftegaz in Russia, and in certain US offshore assets. It also disposed of its interests in the Greater Kuparuk Area in Alaska, the Magnus field in the UK North Sea, and in certain other assets in the UK North Sea and US onshore assets. In 2017, BP renewed its onshore concession of the United Arab Emirates that grants BP 10% interest in ADCO onshore concession. It also decreased its interest in Magnus field in North Sea and completed the formation of Pan American Energy Group (PAEG) (BP 50%, Bridas Corporation 50%), which is a combination of Pan American Energy and Axion Energy with an effective decrease in interest.
d 
Volumes relate to six BP-operated fields within ETAP. BP has no interests in the remaining three ETAP fields, which are operated by Shell.
e 
All of the production from Canada in Subsidiaries is bitumen.
f 
Includes 3 net mboe/d of NGLs from processing plants in which BP has an interest (2018 3mboe/d and 2017 3mboe/d).

Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
311


BP’s net production by country – natural gas
 
 
million cubic feet per day
 
 
 
BP net share of productiona
 
 
 
2019

2018

2017

Subsidiaries
UKb
 
129

152

182

Total Europe
 
129

152

182

Lower 48 onshoreb
 
2,175

1,705

1,467

Gulf of Mexico deepwater
 
179

190

186

Alaska
 
4

5

5

Total US
 
2,358

1,900

1,659

Canada
 
2

7

9

Total Rest of North America
 
2

7

9

Total North America
 
2,361

1,907

1,667

Trinidad & Tobagob
 
1,977

2,136

1,936

Total South America
 
1,977

2,136

1,936

Egyptb
 
952

878

745

Algeria
 
186

183

205

Total Africa
 
1,138

1,061

949

Azerbaijan
 
367

256

232

India
 
15

32

60

Oman
 
594

538

79

Total Rest of Asia
 
976

826

371

Total Asia
 
976

826

371

Australiab
 
411

437

426

Eastern Indonesiab
 
375

382

357

Total Australasia
 
786

819

783

Total subsidiariesc
 
7,366

6,900

5,889

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
Rosneft (Russia, Canada, Egypt, Venezuela, Vietnam)
 
1,279

1,286

1,308

Argentina
 
250

264

329

Bolivia
 
64

71

89

Norwayb
 
56

59

53

Angola
 
87

80

77

Western Indonesia
 



Total equity-accounted entitiesc
 
1,736

1,760

1,855

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
9,102

8,659

7,744

a Production excludes royalties due to others whether payable in cash or in kind where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b In 2019, BP completed the sale of its interest in the Gulf of Suez Petroleum Company (GUPCO) in Egypt and certain US assets in Lower 48 onshore and disposed of its interests in the Gulf of Mexico Santiago and Santa Cruz wells. In 2018, BP acquired various interests in the Permian Basin, Eagle Ford and Haynesville Shales in Lower 48 onshore as a result of the acquisition of BHP’s US unconventional assets, increased its interest in the Clair asset in the UK North Sea, and acquired an interest in LLC Kharampurneftegaz in Russia, and in certain US offshore assets. It also disposed of its interests in the Greater Kuparuk Area in Alaska, the Magnus field in the UK North Sea, and in certain other assets in the UK North Sea and US onshore assets. In 2017, BP decreased its interest in Magnus field in North Sea and completed the formation of Pan American Energy Group (PAEG) (BP 50%, Bridas Corporation 50%), which is a combination of Pan American Energy and Axion Energy with an effective decrease in interest.
c Natural gas production volumes exclude gas consumed in operations within the lease boundaries of the producing field, but the related reserves are included in the group’s reserves.

Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.

312
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


The following tables provide additional data and disclosures in relation to our oil and gas operations.
Average sales price per unit of production (realizations«)a 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ per unit of production
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America

Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total
group
average

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
Americab

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 
65.44


59.19

40.92

63.30

63.75


64.39

59.65

61.56

Natural gas liquids
 
29.58


14.67


25.86

31.89



38.11

18.23

Gas
 
4.01


1.93


2.78

4.59


3.99

6.86

3.39

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 
71.28


67.11

33.57

69.17

68.81


70.80

67.54

67.81

Natural gas liquids
 
31.63


25.81


35.74

39.14


92.47

52.14

29.42

Gas
 
7.71


2.43


3.08

4.82


3.85

7.97

3.92

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 
53.67


49.98

36.80

55.44

53.61


52.88

53.26

51.71

Natural gas liquids
 
32.77


22.42


26.79

36.48



39.39

26.00

Gas
 
5.09


2.36


2.25

3.82


3.44

6.14

3.19

Equity-accounted entitiesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 

64.75



56.85


57.00



57.36

Natural gas liquidse
 




18.14


N/A



20.40

Gas
 

5.01



3.98


1.83



3.39

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 

70.24



62.35


62.46

39.49


62.24

Natural gas liquidse
 






N/A




Gas
 

7.93



4.36


1.70



2.50

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 

55.08



49.97


45.66

15.61


42.33

Natural gas liquidse
 






N/A




Gas
 

5.78



4.49


1.63



2.47


Average production cost per unit of productionf 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ per unit of production
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total
group
average

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 
13.22


8.46

13.36

3.36

7.95


5.15

2.33

6.84

2018
 
13.76


9.63

13.10

3.08

7.31


5.72

2.35

7.15

2017
 
14.58


8.68

15.02

4.41

6.47


6.37

2.79

7.11

Equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
 

12.51



11.50

10.40

3.07



5.13

2018
 

12.15



10.61


3.09

5.92


4.16

2017
 

10.33



11.92


3.19

3.27


4.32

a Units of production are barrels for liquids and thousands of cubic feet for gas. Realizations include transfers between businesses, except in the case of Russia.
b All of the production from Canada in Subsidiaries is bitumen.
c Includes condensate.
d In certain countries it is common for equity-accounted entities’ agreements to include pricing clauses that require selling a significant portion of the entitled production to local governments or markets at discounted prices.
e Natural gas liquids for Russia are included in crude oil.
f Units of production are barrels for liquids and thousands of cubic feet for gas. Amounts do not include ad valorem and severance taxes.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
313


Environmental expenditure
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Operating expenditure
 
511

501

441

Capital expenditure
 
468

449

487

Clean-ups
 
23

31

22

Additions to environmental remediation provision
 
272

428

249

Increase (decrease) in decommissioning provision
 
1,045

137

(228
)
Operating and capital expenditure on the prevention, control, treatment or elimination of air and water emissions and solid waste is often not incurred as a separately identifiable transaction. Instead, it forms part of a larger transaction that includes, for example, normal operations and maintenance expenditure. The figures for environmental operating and capital expenditure in the table are therefore estimates, based on the definitions and guidelines of the American Petroleum Institute.
Environmental operating expenditure of $511 million in 2019 (2018 $501 million) showed an overall increase of 2%, with increases in Upstream costs (due in large part to increases in expenditure associated with the acquisitions of BHP assets into BPX Energy) largely balanced out by slight reductions in costs for Downstream and Shipping.
Environmental capital expenditure in 2019 was slightly higher overall than in 2018 largely due to increased costs in Upstream, due in large part to increases in expenditure associated with the acquisitions of BHP assets into BPX Energy.
Clean-up costs were $23 million in 2019 (2018 $31 million) representing oil spill clean-up costs and other associated remediation and disposal costs. The reduction compared to 2018 results largely from the downstream business where clean-up costs in BP Pipelines (North America) were significantly lower than in 2018.
In addition to operating and capital expenditure, we also establish provisions for future environmental remediation work. Expenditure against such provisions normally occurs in subsequent periods and is not included in environmental operating expenditure reported for such periods.
Provisions for environmental remediation are made when a clean-up is probable and the amount of the obligation can be reliably estimated. Generally, this coincides with the commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites.
The extent and cost of future environmental restoration, remediation and abatement programmes are inherently difficult to estimate. They often depend on the extent of contamination, and the associated impact and timing of the corrective actions required, technological feasibility and BP’s share of liability. Though the costs of future programmes could be significant and may be material to the results of operations in the period in which they are recognized, it is not expected that such costs will be material to the group’s overall results of operations or financial position.
Additions to our environmental remediation provision was similar to prior years and also reflects scope reassessments of the remediation plans of a number of our sites in the US and Canada. The charge for environmental remediation provisions in 2019 included $9 million in respect of provisions for new sites (2018 $8 million and 2017 $8 million).
In addition, we make provisions on installation of our oil and gas producing assets and related pipelines to meet the cost of eventual decommissioning. On installation of an oil or natural gas production facility, a provision is established that represents the discounted value of the expected future cost of decommissioning the asset.
In 2019, the net increase in the decommissioning provision was due to a change in the discount rate and a detailed reviews of expected future costs.
We undertake periodic reviews of existing provisions. These reviews take account of revised cost assumptions, changes in decommissioning requirements and any technological developments.
 
Provisions for environmental remediation and decommissioning are usually established on a discounted basis, as required by IAS 37 ‘Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets’.
Further details of decommissioning and environmental provisions appear in Financial statements – Note 23.
Regulation of the group’s business
BP’s activities are subject to a broad range of EU, US, international, national, regional, and local legislation and regulations, including legislation that implements international conventions and protocols. These cover virtually all aspects of BP’s activities and include matters such as licence acquisition, production rates, royalties, environmental, health and safety protection, fuel specifications and transportation, trading, pricing, anti-trust, export, taxes, and foreign exchange.
Following the UK’s exit from the European Union on 31 January 2020, the UK has now entered a transition period which, unless extended, is due to run until 31 December 2020. During the transition period, most EU law will continue to apply to the UK and therefore to BP’s UK business during that period. The vast majority of environment-related statutory instruments passed by the UK Government in anticipation of Brexit have included no substantive changes to the current EU underlying regime, but rather seek to make the amendments required to allow their continued operation after the transition period. The UK Government’s Environment Bill and 25 Year Plan will be central to the UK’s environmental regime going forward but further changes are as yet uncertain. The following section describes EU laws and regulations relevant to our business both in the UK and the EU.
Upstream contractual and regulatory framework
The terms and conditions of the leases, licences and contracts under which our upstream oil and gas interests are held vary from country to country. These leases, licences and contracts are generally granted by or entered into with a government entity or state-owned or controlled company and are sometimes entered into with private property owners. Arrangements with governmental or state entities usually take the form of licences or production-sharing agreements (PSAs), although arrangements with US government entities are usually by lease. Arrangements with private property owners are also usually in the form of leases.
Licences (or concessions) give the holder the right to explore for, develop and produce a commercial discovery. Under a licence, the holder bears the risk of exploration, development and production activities and provides the financing for these operations. In principle, the licence holder is entitled to all production, minus any royalties that are payable in kind. A licence holder is generally required to pay production taxes or royalties, which may be in cash or in kind.
In certain countries, separate licences are required for exploration and production activities, and in some cases production licences are limited to only a portion of the area covered by the original exploration licence. Both exploration and production licences are generally for a specified period of time. In the US, leases from the US government typically remain in effect for a specified term, but may be extended beyond that term as long as there is production in paying quantities. The term of BP’s licences and the extent to which these licences may be renewed vary from country to country.
PSAs entered into with a government entity or state-owned or controlled company generally require BP (alone or with other contracting companies) to provide all the financing and bear the risk of exploration and production activities in exchange for a share of the production remaining after royalties, if any. Less typically, BP may explore for, develop and produce hydrocarbons under a service agreement with the host entity in exchange for reimbursement of costs and/or a fee paid in cash rather than production.
BP frequently conducts its exploration and production activities in joint arrangements or co-ownership arrangements with other international oil companies, state-owned or controlled companies and/or private companies. These joint arrangements may be incorporated or unincorporated arrangements, while the co- ownerships are typically unincorporated. Whether incorporated or unincorporated, relevant agreements set out each party’s level of

314
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


participation or ownership interest in the joint arrangement or co- ownership. Conventionally, all costs, benefits, rights, obligations, liabilities and risks incurred in carrying out joint arrangement or co-ownership operations under a lease, licence or PSA are shared among the joint arrangement or co-owning parties according to these agreed ownership interests. Ownership of joint arrangement or co-owned property and hydrocarbons to which the joint arrangement or co-ownership is entitled is also shared in these proportions. To the extent that any liabilities arise, whether to governments or third parties, or as between the joint arrangement parties or co-owners themselves, each joint arrangement party or co-owner will generally be liable to meet these in proportion to its ownership interest. In many upstream operations, a party (known as the operator) will be appointed (pursuant to a joint operating agreement) to carry out day-to-day operations on behalf of the joint arrangement or co-ownership. The operator is typically one of the joint arrangement parties or a co- owner and will carry out its duties either through its own staff, or by contracting out various elements to third-party contractors or service providers. BP acts as operator on behalf of joint arrangements and co- ownerships in a number of countries.
Frequently, work (including drilling and related activities) will be contracted out to third-party service providers. The relevant contract will specify the work, the remuneration, and typically the risk allocation between the parties. Depending on the service to be provided, the contract may also contain provisions allocating risks and liabilities associated with pollution and environmental damage, damage to a well or hydrocarbon reservoirs and for claims from third parties or other losses. The allocation of those risks vary among contracts and are determined through negotiation between the parties.
In general, BP incurs income tax on income generated from production activities (whether under a licence or PSA). In addition, depending on the area, BP’s production activities may be subject to a range of other taxes, levies and assessments, including special petroleum taxes and revenue taxes. The taxes imposed on oil and gas production profits and activities may be substantially higher than those imposed on other activities, for example in Abu Dhabi, Angola, Egypt, Norway, the UK, the US, Russia and Trinidad & Tobago.
Greenhouse gas regulation
In December 2015, nearly 200 nations at the United Nations climate change conference in Paris (COP21) agreed the Paris Agreement, for implementation post-2020. The Paris Agreement aims to hold the increase in the global average temperature to well below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and to pursue efforts to limit the temperature increase to 1.5°C above pre-industrial levels. There is no quantitative long-term emissions goal. However, countries aim to reach global peaking of greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions as soon as possible and to undertake rapid reductions thereafter, so as to achieve a balance between human caused emissions by sources and removals by sinks of GHGs in the second half of this century. The Paris Agreement commits all parties to submit Nationally Determined Contributions (NDCs) (i.e. pledges or plans of climate action) and pursue domestic measures aimed at achieving the objectives of their NDCs. Developed country NDCs should include absolute emission reduction targets, and developing countries are encouraged to move towards absolute emission reduction targets over time. The Paris Agreement places binding commitments on countries to report on their emissions and progress made on their NDCs and to undergo international review of collective progress. It also requires countries to submit revised NDCs every five years, which are expected to be more ambitious with each revision. Global assessments of progress will occur every five years, starting in 2023. On 1 June 2017, the US announced that it will withdraw from the Paris Agreement. The process for withdrawal can be completed no earlier than 4 November 2020.
Recent annual United Nations climate change conferences have established a ‘Paris Rulebook’ defining how some elements of the Paris Agreement will be implemented. Rules for implementing Article 6, which could enable international carbon trading to assist in meeting NDCs, have not been agreed. This has now been deferred to COP26 to take place in Glasgow, Scotland in November 2020.
More stringent national and regional measures relating to the transition to a lower carbon economy, such as the UK's 2050 net zero
 
carbon emissions commitment can be expected in the future. These measures could increase BP’s production costs for certain products, increase compliance and litigation costs, increase demand for competing energy alternatives or products with lower-carbon intensity, and affect the sales and specifications of many of BP’s products. Further, such measures could lead to constraints on production and supply and access to new reserves, particularly due to the long term nature of many of BP’s projects. Current and announced measures and developments potentially affecting BP’s businesses include the following:
United States
In the US, BP's operations are affected by GHG regulation in a number of ways. The federal Clean Air Act (CAA), for example, regulates air emissions, permitting, fuel specifications and other aspects of our production, refining, distribution and marketing activities.
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) regulations aimed at limiting methane emissions from new and modified sources in the oil and natural gas sector in the US by 40-45% from 2012 levels by 2025 were introduced by the Obama administration. In August 2019, however, the EPA issued a new proposed rule to that would both rescind certain methane regulations and potentially remove storage and transmission facilities from the regulatory scheme. In addition, the Bureau of Land Management (BLM) in 2018 issued a new waste prevention rule which rescinded the prior 2017 rule regarding methane regulation on federal lands. The EPA rule and the new BLM rule are being challenged by states and NGOs. The final outcome of the rule revisions and legal challenges with respect to these EPA and BLM rules is uncertain.
In 2019, the EPA issued the final Affordable Clean Energy (ACE) Rule, which is intended to address GHG emissions from certain existing sources in the electricity sector, and which is intended to replace the Obama-administration’s Clean Power Plan (CPP). A number of lawsuits have been filed regarding the legality of the ACE Rule and the repeal of the CPP regulations. The outcome with respect to these rules may affect electricity generation practices and prices, reliability of electricity supply, and regulatory requirements affecting other GHG emission sources in other sectors and have potential impacts on combined heat and power installations.
The Energy Policy Act of 2005 and the Energy Independence and Security Act of 2007 impose the Renewable Fuel Standard (RFS), requiring transportation fuel sold in the United States to contain a minimum volume of renewable fuels. Certain state initiatives impose lower GHG emissions thresholds for transportation fuels (e.g., in California and Oregon). In 2019, EPA promulgated regulations easing volatility requirements for certain categories of gasoline and revising certain elements of the RFS credit-trading programme, which is the open market for renewables credit trading.
The GHG mandatory reporting rule (GHGMRR), requires annual GHG emissions reports to be filed with the EPA. In addition to direct emissions from affected facilities, producers and importers/exporters of petroleum products, certain natural gas liquids and GHG products are required to report product volumes and notional GHG emissions as if these products were fully combusted.
A number of states, municipalities and regional organizations have responded to current and proposed federal changes easing environmental regulation with separate initiatives that affect our US operations. For example, the California cap and trade programme started in January 2012 and expanded to cover emissions from transportation fuels in 2015. The State of Washington has adopted a carbon cap rule although the state’s supreme court has modified the rule to exclude coverage of sales and distribution of petroleum fuels.
Our US businesses are subject to increased GHG and other environmental requirements and regulatory uncertainty, including that future US administrations could revise or revoke current administration programs, as well as increased expenditures in having to comply with numerous diverse and non-uniform regulatory initiatives at the state and local level.
European Union
The EU has adopted various measures seeking to reduce GHG emissions and encourage renewables. A set of regulatory

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
315


measures were adopted which included: a collective national reduction target for emissions not covered by the EU Emissions Trading System (EU ETS) Directive; binding national renewable energy targets (including targets in the transport sector) under the Renewable Energy Directive; and a legal framework to promote carbon capture and storage (CCS).
In 2014 EU leaders adopted a climate and energy framework setting targets for the year 2030 including at least 40% cuts in GHG emissions from 1990 levels. The GHG reduction target is to be achieved by a 43% reduction of emissions from sectors covered by the EU ETS, and a 30% GHG reduction by Member States for all other GHG emissions. Measures to achieve the 2030 targets include a significant revision of the EU ETS for Phase 4 addressing surplus allowances and the amount of free allocation for sectors prone to international competition. In November 2018 a 32% share of renewable energy and a 32.5% increase in energy efficiency was agreed which must be met by EU Member States by 2030. It also sets a renewable energy target of 14% for the transportation sector.
In December 2019 the European Commission proposed an ambitious ‘European Green Deal’. These proposals will require formal approval by European Member States and include:
a climate neutrality commitment for 2050 and raising the 2030 ambition to at least 50% GHG reductions by 2030 from 1990 levels, up from the 40% currently agreed;
a proposal to enshrine the 2050 climate-neutrality target into legislation;
a plan to extend the Emissions Trading System to include the maritime sector and reduce the allowances allocated for free to airlines;
a proposal to implement a carbon border tax adjustment to protect European industry from carbon leakage; and
a review of the Energy Taxation Directive, with the aim of harmonising and directing energy taxation across the member states.
The Medium Combustion Plants Directive 2015 (MCPD) regulates sulphur dioxide (SO2), nitrogen oxides (NOx) and particulates emissions and monitoring of carbon monoxide (CO) emissions from certain mid-size plants. It applies to new plants and by 2025 or 2030 to existing plants, depending on their size.
The National Emission Ceilings Directive 2016 (NECD) introduces stricter emissions limits from 2020 and 2030, with new indicative national targets applying from 2025. NECD has been implemented in the UK by the National Emission Ceilings Regulations 2018. Each EU Member State was also required to produce a National Air Pollution Control Programme setting out the measures it will take to ensure compliance with the 2020 and 2030 reduction commitments.
The EU Fuel Quality Directive affects our production and marketing of transport fuels. Revisions adopted in 2009 mandate reductions in the life cycle GHG emissions per unit of energy and tighter environmental fuel quality standards for petrol and diesel.
In December 2019 the Dutch Supreme Court (De Hoge Raad) ruled that the Dutch Government must reduce gross GHG Emissions in the Netherlands by 25% based on 1990 levels. The Dutch Government is expected to publish its policy proposals to achieve the 25% target in early 2020.
The German Government has passed a national emissions trading law that will in a first phase include limits on emissions from transport and heating fuels. Impacted fuel suppliers in Germany will pay a fixed price for emissions certificates of EUR 25 per tonne CO2 in 2021 rising to EUR 55 per tonne by 2025. From 2026 emissions certificates will be auctioned but with prices limited between EUR 55 and EUR 65 per tonne CO2 emitted.
Other
Alberta Province has adopted large facility carbon emission regulations requiring reductions in carbon intensity year-on-year which can be met by improving emissions intensity, the purchase
 
of offsets or payments into a provincial emissions technology fund. Emissions not covered under these regulations are subject to escalating Federal carbon emissions backstop pricing. Additional requirements are in place relating to electricity generation sources and limits on overall oil sands emissions.
The Canadian federal climate change regulations include a national backstop carbon price starting at C$20/tonne in 2019 and escalating to C$50/tonne by 2022 (or equivalent system for provinces with cap-and-trade systems), with provincial implementation of the price and associated large emitters pricing system, use of any funds generated, and outcome reporting. Newfoundland & Labrador and Nova Scotia have implemented regulations that meet equivalency requirements of the Federal regulations via economy wide carbon taxes on fuels and large emitter programs (intensity based for Newfoundland & Labrador and cap and trade for Nova Scotia).
China is operating emission trading pilot programmes in five cities and three provinces. One of BP's subsidiaries and one of BP’s joint venture companies in China are participating in these schemes. China launched its national emissions trading market (initially covering the power sector only) politically in 2017 with a three-step roadmap (“National ETS”). The National ETS will not supersede the above eight pilot programmes immediately but allow those pilot schemes to be incorporated into the national scheme gradually. In the short term, the existing pilot schemes are expected to operate in parallel covering the non-power sectors. In March 2018, the new Ministry of Ecology and Environment was established as part of the overall ministerial restructuring which absorbs the climate change responsibilities previously under the National Development and Reform Commission and takes charge of the development of the National ETS. As of December 2019, the National ETS is still at the first phase (infrastructure development phase) and preparing for the second phase (simulation trading phase).
China has also adopted more stringent vehicle tailpipe emission standards and vehicle efficiency standards to address air pollution and GHG emissions. These standards will have an impact on transportation fuel product mix and overall demand. In addition, China has also introduced a mandate for sales of new energy vehicles (NEVs) commencing in 2020. This has been accelerating NEV penetration into the light vehicle sector and impact light fuel demand.
For information on the steps that BP is taking in relation to climate change issues and for details of BP’s GHG reporting, see Sustainability – Environment on page 40.
Other environmental regulation
Current and proposed fuel and product specifications, emission controls (including control of vehicle emissions), climate change programmes and regulation of unconventional oil and gas extraction under a number of environmental laws may have a significant effect on the production, sale and profitability of many of BP’s products.
Environmental laws also require BP to remediate and restore areas affected by the release of hazardous substances or hydrocarbons associated with our operations or properties. These laws may apply to sites that BP currently owns or operates, sites that it previously owned or operated, or sites used for the disposal of its and other parties’ waste. See Financial Statements – Note 23 for information on provisions for environmental restoration and remediation.
A number of pending or anticipated governmental proceedings against certain BP group companies under environmental laws could result in monetary or other sanctions. Group companies are also subject to environmental claims for personal injury and property damage alleging the release of, or exposure to, hazardous substances. The costs associated with future environmental remediation obligations, governmental proceedings and claims could be significant and may be material to the results of operations in the period in which they are recognized. We cannot accurately predict the effects of future developments, such as stricter environmental laws or enforcement policies, or future events at our facilities, on the group, and there can be no assurance that material liabilities and costs will not be incurred in the future. For a discussion of the group’s environmental expenditure, see page 314 and for a discussion of legal proceedings, see page 319.

316
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


A significant proportion of our fixed assets are located in the US and the EU. US and EU environmental, health and safety regulations significantly affect BP’s operations. Significant legislation and regulation in the US and the EU affecting our businesses and profitability include the following:
United States
The Trump administration has issued a number of Executive Orders affecting federal permitting and rulemaking processes that seek to reduce regulatory burdens placed on manufacturing generally and the energy industry specifically. It is not clear how much or how quickly these regulatory requirements will be reduced given statutory and rulemaking constraints and the likely legal challenges to some of these initiatives which can result in regulatory uncertainty and compliance challenges for our operations.
The National Environmental Policy Act (NEPA) requires an environmental analysis prior to undertaking any major federal action that significantly affects the environment, which includes the issuance of federal permits. The environmental reviews required by NEPA can delay, modify or block projects. State law analogues to NEPA could also limit or delay our projects. The Trump administration has taken steps to significantly modify and streamline the NEPA review process for major infrastructure projects including energy production, pipeline and transmission systems. The timing and effect on our operations remain uncertain and any final rule is likely to face legal challenges.
As discussed above under ‘Greenhouse gas regulation’, US fuel markets are affected by EPA regulation of light, medium and heavy duty vehicle emissions (both fuel economy and tailpipe standards) as well as for non-road engines and vehicles and certain large GHG stationary emission sources. California also imposes Low Emission Vehicle (LEV) and Zero Emission Vehicle (ZEV) standards on vehicle manufacturers and a number of other states, as allowed by CAA authority, have adopted standards identical to California’s standards. These regulations may impact fuel demand and product mix in California and those states adopting LEV and ZEV standards and may impact BP’s product mix and demand for particular products. The Trump administration has challenged California’s authority to impose stricter vehicle emission standards, which are followed by numerous other states, and the outcome of this challenge remains uncertain.
In 2018 the Trump administration proposed rolling back the Obama administration’s fuel economy and tailpipe carbon dioxide emissions standards for passenger cars and light trucks covering model years (MY) 2021 through 2026 by locking in the 2020 standards until 2026. It has also proposed eliminating the waiver allowing California to set its own LEV and ZEV standards and for other states to adopt standards identical to California. In September 2019, NHTSA and EPA issued part one of One National Program for fuel economy regulation by announcing EPA's decision to withdraw California's waiver of pre-emption for its LEV and ZEV standards and finalizing the Department of Transportation’s regulatory text relating to pre-emption of state fuel economy standards. California and twenty-five states and cities filed a lawsuit challenging those regulations. The outcome of that litigation is uncertain.
In January 2020, EPA issued an Advance Notice of Proposed Rule (ANPR) soliciting pre-proposal comments on a rulemaking known as the Cleaner Trucks Initiative. The rule would establish new emission standards for oxides of nitrogen (NOx) and other pollutants for highway heavy-duty engines. It would seek to streamline and improve certification procedures to reduce costs for engine manufacturers. California is also working on tighter heavy-duty engine NOx standards. EPA has not notified fuels suppliers of any expected fuel specification changes that would be included with these new engine standards and BP continues to monitor this rule for implications for fuels.
The Clean Water Act regulates wastewater and other effluent discharges from BP’s facilities, and BP is required to obtain discharge permits, install control equipment and implement operational controls and preventative measures.
 
The Resource Conservation and Recovery Act regulates the generation, storage, transportation and disposal of wastes associated with our operations and can require corrective action at locations where such wastes have been disposed of or released.
The Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (CERCLA) can, in certain circumstances, impose the entire cost of investigation and remediation on a party who owned or operated a site contaminated with a hazardous substance, or who arranged for disposal of a hazardous substance at a site. BP has incurred, or is likely to incur, liability under CERCLA or similar state laws, including costs attributed to insolvent or unidentified parties. BP is also subject to claims for remediation costs and natural resource damages under other federal and state laws which also require notification of spills to designated government agencies.
The Emergency Planning and Community Right-to-Know Act requires reporting on the storage, use and releases of certain quantities of listed hazardous substances to designated government agencies.
The Toxic Substances Control Act (TSCA) regulates BP’s manufacture, import, export, sale and use of chemical substances and products. In addition, EPA has revised processes and procedures for prioritization of existing chemicals for risk evaluation, assessment and management. Agency actions and announcements are monitored regularly to identify developments with potential impacts on chemical substances important to BP products and operations. Thus far, two substances have been identified for specific ongoing monitoring of developments and impacts.
The Occupational Safety and Health Act imposes workplace safety and health requirements on BP operations along with significant process safety management obligations (PSM), requiring continuous evaluation and improvement of operational practices to enhance safety and reduce workplace emissions at gas processing, refining and other regulated facilities. The US Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) conducts inspections under the National Emphasis Program to ensure compliance with PSM requirements in both refineries and chemical plants.
The Oil Pollution Act 1990 (OPA) imposes operational requirements, liability standards and other obligations governing the transportation of petroleum products in US waters. States may impose additional obligations. Alaska and the West Coast states currently have the most demanding state requirements.
The Outer Continental Shelf Land Act, the MLA and other statutes give the Department of Interior (DOI) and the BLM authority to regulate operations and air emissions, including equipment and testing, on offshore and onshore operations on federal lands subject to DOI authority.
The Endangered Species Act and Marine Mammal Protection Act protect certain species’ habitats from adverse human impacts by restricting operations or development at certain times and in certain places. With an increasing number of species being protected, we have experienced increasing restrictions on our activities.
European Union
The Industrial Emissions Directive (IED) 2010 provides the framework for granting permits for major industrial sites. It lays down rules on integrated prevention and control of air, water and soil pollution arising from industrial activities. As part of the IED framework, additional emission limit values are informed by sector specific and cross-sector Best Available Technology (BAT) Conclusions. These include the BAT Conclusions for the refining sector, for large combustion plants as well as common wastewater and waste gas treatment and management systems in the chemical sector these may require BP to further reduce its emissions, particularly its air and water emissions.
The EU regulation on ozone depleting substances 2009 (ODS Regulation) requires companies to reduce the use of ozone depleting substances (ODSs) and phase out use of certain ODSs.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
317


BP continues to replace ODSs in refrigerants and/or equipment in the EU and elsewhere, in accordance with the Montreal Protocol and related legislation. The Kigali Amendment to the Montreal Protocol (which aims to reduce hydrofluorocarbons) came into force on 1 January 2019. In addition, the EU regulation on fluorinated GHGs with high global warming potential (the F-gas Regulations) require a phase-out of certain hydrofluorocarbons, based on global warming potential.
European regulations also establish passenger car performance standards for CO2 tailpipe emissions (European Regulation (EC) No 443/2009). By 2021, the European passenger fleet emissions target for new vehicles will be 95 grams of CO2 per kilometre. This target will be achieved by manufacturing fuel efficient vehicles and vehicles using alternative, low carbon fuels such as hydrogen and electricity. In addition, vehicle emission test cycles and vehicle type approval procedures are being updated to improve accuracy of emission and efficiency measurements. European vehicle CO2 emission regulations also impact the fuel efficiency of vans. By 2020, the EU fleet of newly registered vans must meet a target of 147 grams of CO2 per kilometre, which is 19% below the 2012 fleet average.
In 2019, the European Parliament and the Council adopted Regulation (EU) 2019/631 setting CO2 emission performance standards for new passenger cars and for new light commercial vehicles (vans) in the EU for the period after 2020. From a 2021 baseline, it requires EU fleet-wide reductions of 15% by 2025 and 37.5% by 2030 for passenger cars, and 15% by 2025 and 31% by 2030 for new light commercial vehicles.
The EU Registration, Evaluation Authorization and Restriction of Chemicals (REACH) Regulation 2006 requires registration of chemical substances manufactured in or imported into the EU, together with the submission of relevant hazard and risk data. REACH affects our manufacturing or trading/import operations in the EU. BP maintains compliance by checking whether imports are covered by the registrations of non-EU suppliers’ representatives, preparing and submitting registration dossiers to cover new manufactured and imported substances, and updating previously submitted registrations as required. Some substances registered previously, including substances supplied to us by third parties for our use, are now subject to evaluation and review for potential authorization or restriction procedures, and possible banning, by the European Chemicals Agency and EU member state authorities. In addition, BP’s facilities and operations in several EU countries continue to undergo REACH compliance inspections by the competent authority for the respective EU member state. An amendment to the Annex of the Regulation on classification, labelling and packaging of substances and mixture (CLP Regulation) requires harmonized notification of information on hazardous materials (certain lubricant and fuel formations) to EU member state poison centres. The uniform notification rules will apply as of January 2020 for consumer products, from 2021 for professional and 2024 for industrial uses.
The EU Offshore Safety Directive was adopted in 2013. Its purpose is to introduce a harmonized regime aimed at reducing the potential environmental, health and safety impacts of the offshore oil and gas industry throughout EU waters. The Directive has been implemented in the UK primarily through the Offshore Installations (Offshore Safety Directive) (Safety Case etc.) Regulations 2015.
The Water Framework Directive (WFD) published in 2000 aims to protect the quantity and quality of ground and surface waters of the EU member states. The implementation in the EU member states is still ongoing, planned to be finalised by 2027. At the moment a Fitness Check (comprehensive policy evaluation) of the EU Water Legislation is ongoing, also covering the WFD and its daughter directives (Groundwater Directive and Environmental Quality Standards Directive). The outcome of the policy evaluation, expected to be published in 2020, may require additional compliance efforts and increased costs for managing freshwater withdrawals and discharges from BP’s EU operations.
Other countries and regions
 
Turkey has published REACH-like regulations, known as KKDIK, as well as related implementation schedules and substance registrations.
Regulations governing the discharge of treated water have also been developed in countries outside of the US and EU. This includes regulations in Trinidad and Angola. In Trinidad, BP is upgrading its water treatment facilities to meet consent levels agreed with the regulators to apply water discharge rules arising from the Certificate of Environmental Clearance (CEC) Regulations 2001 and associated Water Pollution Rules 2007. In Angola, BP has upgraded produced water treatment systems to meet revised oil in water limits for produced water discharge under Executive Decree ED 97-14.
The Abidjan Convention, along with the Additional Protocol published in 2012, sets environmental quality standards for the discharge of chemicals to the marine environment. The convention and associated protocols has been ratified by 19 African nations including Senegal and Mauritania. BP is currently designing produced water management systems to meet the environmental quality standards for our future gas operations in Mauritania and Senegal.
Environmental maritime regulations
BP’s shipping operations are subject to extensive national and international regulations governing liability, operations, training, spill prevention and insurance. These include:
Liability and spill prevention and planning requirements governing, among others, tankers, barges, and offshore facilities are imposed by OPA in US waters. OPA also mandates a levy on imported and domestically produced oil to fund oil spill responses. Some states, including Alaska, Washington, Oregon and California, impose additional liability for oil spills. Outside US territorial waters, BP Shipping tankers are subject to international liability, spill response and preparedness regulations under the UN’s International Maritime Organization (IMO), including the International Convention on Civil Liability for Oil Pollution Damage, the International Convention for the Prevention of Pollution from Ships (MARPOL), the International Convention on Oil Pollution, Preparedness, Response and Co-operation, and the International Convention on Civil Liability for Bunker Oil Pollution Damage. In April 2010, the Hazardous and Noxious Substance (HNS) Protocol 2010 was adopted to address issues that have inhibited ratification of the International Convention on Liability and Compensation for Damage in Connection with the Carriage of Hazardous and Noxious Substances by Sea 1996. As at 31 December 2019, the HNS Convention had not entered into force.
A global sulphur cap of 0.5% applies to marine fuel under MARPOL. In order to comply, ships will either need to consume low sulphur marine fuels, operate on alternative low sulphur fuels such as LNG or implement approved abatement technology to enable them to meet the low sulphur emissions requirements while continuing to use higher sulphur fuel. This new global cap will not alter the lower limits that apply in the sulphur oxides Emissions Control Areas established by the IMO.
In December 2019 EPA finalized measures to facilitate smooth implementation of IMO 2020. EPA finalized technical corrections that will allow fuel suppliers to distribute distillate diesel fuel that complies with the 5,000 ppm international sulphur standard for ships instead of the fuel standards that otherwise apply to distillate diesel fuel in the United States. The EPA clarified that fuel meeting the 5,000 ppm global sulphur cap may not be used inside of Emission Control Area (ECA) boundaries.
The Convention for the Protection of the Marine Environment of the North-East Atlantic (OSPAR), aims to protect the marine environment of the North-East Atlantic. OSPAR Recommendation 2001/1 regulates the management of produced water from offshore installations in the North Sea including reductions in the total quantity of oil in produced water and a performance standard for dispersed oil in produced water discharged into the sea. Guidelines for the implementation of a risk-based approach to the management of produced water discharges from offshore installations supports a key goal of achieving a reduction of oil in produced water discharged into the sea by 2020 to a level which

318
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


will adequately ensure that each of those discharges will present no harm to the marine environment.
To meet its financial responsibility requirements, BP Shipping maintains marine pollution liability insurance in respect of its operated ships to a maximum limit of $1 billion for each occurrence through mutual insurance associations (P&I Clubs), although there can be no assurance that a spill will necessarily be adequately covered by insurance or that liabilities will not exceed insurance recoveries.
Legal proceedings
Proceedings relating to the Deepwater Horizon oil spill
Introduction
BP Exploration & Production Inc. (BPXP) was lease operator of Mississippi Canyon, Block 252 in the Gulf of Mexico, where the semi-submersible rig Deepwater Horizon was deployed at the time of the 20 April 2010 explosion and fire and resulting oil spill (the Incident). Lawsuits and claims arising from the Incident were brought principally in US federal and state courts.
Many of the lawsuits in federal court relating to the Incident were consolidated into two multi-district litigation proceedings, one in federal district court in Houston for the securities cases (MDL 2185) and another in federal district court in New Orleans for the remaining cases (MDL 2179). A Plaintiffs’ Steering Committee (PSC) was established to act on behalf of individual and business plaintiffs in MDL 2179. All federal and state governmental claims in relation to the Incident have now been settled or dismissed and the 2014 administrative agreement with the US Environmental Protection Agency and BP’s obligations thereunder ended in March 2019. The remaining proceedings arising from the Incident are discussed below.
PSC settlements
PSC settlements – Economic and Property Damages Settlement Agreement
In 2012 the Economic and Property Damages Settlement was entered into with the PSC to resolve certain economic and property damage claims.
The economic and property damages claims process, which is under court supervision through the settlement claims process established by the Economic and Property Damages Settlement, continued in 2019. Only a very small number of business economic loss claims remain to be determined, although certain business economic loss claims continue to be appealed by BP and/or the claimants.
PSC settlements – Medical Benefits Class Action Settlement
In 2012 the Medical Benefits Class Action Settlement (Medical Settlement) was entered into with the PSC. It involves payments to qualifying class members based on a matrix for certain Specified Physical Conditions (SPCs), as well as a 21-year Periodic Medical Consultation Program (PMCP) for qualifying class members, and also includes provisions regarding class members pursuing claims for later-manifested physical conditions (LMPCs).
The deadline for submitting SPC and PMCP claims was 12 February 2015. A total of 37,226 claims have been submitted. As of 31 December 2019, 27,604 claims (comprising 22,831 SPC claims and 4,773 PMCP claims) have been approved for compensation totalling approximately $67 million; 9,621 claims have been denied; and 1 claim is pending determination.
In order to seek compensation from BP for an LMPC, class members must file a notice with the Medical Claims Administrator within 4 years after the date of first diagnosis of the LMPC. As of 31 December 2019, there were 2,701 pending lawsuits brought by class members claiming LMPCs.
Other civil complaints – economic loss
The vast majority of economic loss and property damage claims from individuals and businesses that either opted out of the 2012 PSC settlement and/or were excluded from that settlement have
 
been settled or dismissed. On 19 July 2017 the district court held that maritime claims by 215 plaintiffs would be subject to further proceedings in MDL 2179 under OPA 90 and under general maritime law. Most of these have now been either settled or dismissed. On 5 February 2019, the district court issued a case management order addressing the 184 remaining plaintiffs in MDL 2179 with claims for economic loss or property damage. The district court ordered BP and 69 of those plaintiffs to undertake mandatory mediation and so far this has resulted in settlement of more than 40 plaintiffs’ claims. The district court ordered that BP file any dispositive motions as to the other 115 plaintiffs (principally Mexican-resident plaintiffs who are fishermen or fishing cooperatives) by 7 March 2019. BP moved to dismiss those 115 claims on 7 March 2019, and its motion remains pending.
Other civil complaints – personal injury
The vast majority of post-explosion clean-up, medical monitoring and personal injury claims from individuals that either opted out of the 2012 PSC settlement and/or were excluded from that settlement have been dismissed.
In 2019, the district court in MDL 2179 determined in a series of proceedings that 923 plaintiffs had post-explosion clean-up, medical monitoring and personal injury claims that complied with the court’s prior order to show cause why their claims should not be dismissed. Five plaintiffs have appealed their dismissal to the Fifth Circuit. Briefing is ongoing and oral argument and a decision are expected in 2020.
Individual securities litigation
Following court approval of the settlement of a securities class action brought on behalf of a class of post-explosion American depository share (ADS) holders in 2017, there remained individual cases filed in state and federal courts by pension funds, investment funds and advisers. These were against BP entities and several current and former officers and directors seeking damages for alleged losses those funds suffered because of their purchases and/or holdings of BP ordinary shares and, in certain cases, ADSs. The funds assert claims under English law and, for plaintiffs purchasing ADSs, federal securities law. All of the cases, with the exception of one case that has been stayed, were transferred to MDL 2185. As at 31 December 2019, 28 actions on behalf of 115 plaintiffs remained pending in MDL 2185. Pursuant to a scheduling order issued by the district court, fact and expert discovery with respect to 16 representative plaintiffs is scheduled to proceed through to August 2020 and dispositive motions are scheduled to be filed by 27 October 2020.
Canadian class actions
Following various legal proceedings, on 26 February 2016, a plaintiff seeking to assert claims under Canadian law against BP on behalf of a class of Canadian residents who allegedly suffered losses because of their purchase of BP ordinary shares and ADSs filed a motion in the Court of Appeal for Ontario to lift a stay on the action. The plaintiff’s motion was granted on 29 July 2016. On 1 September 2017 the court granted in part and denied in part BP’s motion for summary judgment, limiting the case to three alleged misstatements and narrowing the class period. On 3 April 2018, the Court of Appeal for Ontario affirmed that decision. On 24 June 2019, the plaintiff filed an amended complaint adding fraud claims. On 8 November 2019, the court granted BP’s motion to dismiss the case in its entirety. On 6 December 2019, the plaintiff appealed that decision.
Non-US government lawsuits
On 18 October 2012, before a Mexican Federal District Court located in Mexico City, a class action complaint was filed against BP America Production Company (BPAPC) and other BP subsidiaries. The plaintiffs, who allegedly are fishermen, are seeking, among other things, compensatory damages for the class members who allegedly suffered economic losses, as well as an order requiring BP to remediate environmental damage resulting from the Incident, to provide funding for the preservation of the environment and to conduct environmental impact studies in the Gulf of Mexico for the next 10 years. On 27 June 2018, BP answered the complaint by seeking dismissal on various grounds including that no oil reached Mexican waters or land and there was no economic or environmental harm in Mexico.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
319


On 3 December 2015 and 29 March 2016, Acciones Colectivas de Sinaloa (ACS) filed two class actions (which have since been consolidated) in a Mexican Federal District Court on behalf of several Mexican states against BPXP, BPAPC, and other purported BP subsidiaries. In these class actions, plaintiffs seek an order requiring the BP defendants to repair the damage to the Gulf of Mexico, to pay penalties, and to compensate plaintiffs for damage to property, to health and for economic loss. BPXP and BPAPC opposed class certification and sought dismissal, principally on the basis that no oil reached Mexican waters or land and there was no economic or environmental harm in Mexico. On 25 September 2019, the court certified the class. On 15 October 2019, BP appealed that decision.
Other legal proceedings
FERC and CFTC matters
Following an investigation by the US Federal Energy Regulatory Commission (FERC) and the US Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC) of several BP entities, the Administrative Law Judge of the FERC ruled on 13 August 2015 that BP manipulated the market by selling next-day, fixed price natural gas at Houston Ship Channel in 2008 in order to suppress the Gas Daily index and benefit its financial position. On 11 July 2016 the FERC issued an Order affirming the initial decision and directing BP to pay a civil penalty of $20.16 million and to disgorge $207,169 in unjust profits. On 10 August 2016, BP filed a request for rehearing with the FERC. BP strongly disagrees with the FERC’s decision and will ultimately appeal to the US Court of Appeals if necessary.
Lead paint matters
Since 1987, Atlantic Richfield Company (Atlantic Richfield), a subsidiary of BP, has been named as a co-defendant in numerous lawsuits brought in the US alleging injury to persons and property caused by lead pigment in paint. The majority of the lawsuits have been abandoned or dismissed against Atlantic Richfield. Atlantic Richfield is named in these lawsuits as alleged successor to International Smelting and Refining and another company that manufactured lead pigment during the period 1920-1946. The plaintiffs include individuals and governmental entities. Several of the lawsuits purport to be class actions. The lawsuits seek various remedies including compensation to lead-poisoned children, cost to find and remove lead paint from buildings, medical monitoring and screening programmes, public warning and education of lead hazards, reimbursement of government healthcare costs and special education for lead-poisoned citizens and punitive damages. No lawsuit against Atlantic Richfield has been settled nor has Atlantic Richfield been subject to a final adverse judgment in any proceeding. The amounts claimed and, if such suits were successful, the costs of implementing the remedies sought in the various cases could be substantial. While it is not possible to predict the outcome of these legal actions, Atlantic Richfield believes that it has valid defences. It intends to defend such actions vigorously and believes that the incurrence of liability is remote. Consequently, BP believes that the impact of these lawsuits on the group’s results, financial position or liquidity will not be material.
Scharfstein v. BP West Coast Products, LLC
A class action lawsuit was filed against BP West Coast Products, LLC (BPWCP) in Oregon State Court under the Oregon Unlawful Trade Practices Act on behalf of customers who used a debit card at ARCO gasoline stations in Oregon during the period 1 January 2011 to 30 August 2013, alleging that ARCO sites in Oregon failed to provide sufficient notice of the 35 cents per transaction debit card fee. In January 2014, the jury rendered a verdict against BPWCP and awarded statutory damages of $200 per class member. On 25 August 2015, the trial court determined the size of the class to be slightly in excess of two million members. On 31 May 2016 the trial court entered a judgment against BPWCP for the amount of $417.3 million. On 31 May 2018 the Oregon Court of Appeals affirmed the trial court’s ruling. In March 2019, BP and the Plaintiffs agreed to a settlement of the class action lawsuit, subject to final court approval. On 4 June 2019 the court granted final approval of the settlement agreement.  The judgment dismissing the case was entered on 13 June 2019.  No appeal was taken from the judgment on or before the
 
14 July 2019 deadline. On 15 July 2019, BP made its first payment under the terms of the settlement agreement. The second and final payment is due in July 2020.
Climate change
BP p.l.c., BP America Inc. and BP Products North America Inc. are co-defendants with other oil and gas companies in multiple lawsuits brought in various state courts on behalf of several US cities and counties, one state, and a crab fishing industry association. In the lawsuits, the plaintiffs generally plead a variety of legal theories seeking to hold the defendant companies responsible for impacts allegedly caused by and/or relating to climate change and claim damages. All of the cases remain at relatively early stages.
Louisiana Coastal restoration 
Six coastal parishes and the State of Louisiana have filed over 40 separate lawsuits in state courts in Louisiana against various oil and gas companies seeking damages for coastal erosion. BP entities are defendants in 17 of these cases. The lawsuits allege that the defendants' historical operations in oil fields within the Louisiana onshore coastal zone failed to comply with state permits and/or were conducted without the required coastal use permits. The plaintiffs seek unspecified statutory penalties and damages, including the costs of restoring coastal wetlands allegedly impacted by oil field operations. All of the cases are at relatively early stages.
In addition, four private landowners have filed separate claims in the state courts in Jefferson and Plaquemines Parishes of Louisiana for restoration damages related to alleged impacts to their marshlands associated with historic oil field operations. BP entities are defendants in three of these private landowner cases.
International trade sanctions
During the period covered by this report, non-US subsidiaries, or other non-US entities of BP, conducted limited activities in, or with persons from, certain countries identified by the US Department of State as State Sponsors of Terrorism or otherwise subject to US and EU sanctions (Sanctioned Countries). Sanctions restrictions continue to be insignificant to the group’s financial condition and results of operations. BP monitors its activities with Sanctioned Countries, persons from Sanctioned Countries and individuals and companies subject to US and EU sanctions and seeks to comply with applicable sanctions laws and regulations.
BP has a 28.8% interest in and operates the Azerbaijan Shah Deniz field (Shah Deniz) and a related gas pipeline entity, South Caucasus Pipeline Company Limited (SCPC), and has a 23% non-operating interest in a related gas marketing entity, Azerbaijan Gas Supply Company Limited (AGSC). Naftiran Intertrade Co. Limited and NICO SPV Limited (collectively, NICO) have a 10% non-operating interest in each of Shah Deniz and SCPC and an 8% non-operating interest in AGSC. Shah Deniz, SCPC and AGSC continue in operation as they were excluded from the main operative provisions of the EU regulations as well as from the application of the US sanctions, and fall within the exception for certain natural gas projects under Section 603 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012 (ITRA).
On 3 December 2018 BP entered into an agreement with, among others, SOCAR and NICO pursuant to which SOCAR shall pay to BP Exploration Shah Deniz Limited (BPXSD), as the Shah Deniz Operator, an amount in respect of compensation for NICO’s waiver of its right to lift its share of Shah Deniz condensate. Such amounts shall be used to cover cash calls to NICO in respect of operating costs due from NICO to BPXSD. On 27 November 2019, OFAC issued a new licence in relation to these arrangements.
Following the imposition in 2011 of further US and EU sanctions against Syria, BP terminated all sales of crude oil and petroleum products into Syria, though BP continues to supply aviation fuel to non-governmental Syrian resellers outside of Syria.
BP has a joint arrangement in Cuba which imports, manufactures, markets and sells lubricants.
During 2014 the US and the EU imposed sanctions on certain Russian activities, individuals and entities, including Rosneft. Certain sectoral sanctions also apply to entities in which entities on the relevant

320
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


sectoral sanctions list own a certain percentage interest. In August 2017, Russia related sanctions were passed in the US which target among other things: (i) Russian energy export pipelines; (ii) privatisation of state owned assets in Russia; and (iii) certain international offshore Arctic, deepwater and/or shale exploration and production oil projects. We are not aware of any material adverse effect on our current income and investment in Russia or elsewhere as a consequence of those sanctions.
BP maintains bank accounts and has registered and paid required fees to maintain registrations of patents and trademarks in certain Sanctioned Countries.
BP has equity interests in non-operated joint arrangements with air fuel sellers, resellers, and fuel delivery services around the world. From time to time, the joint arrangement operator or other partners may sell or deliver fuel to airlines from Sanctioned Countries or flights to Sanctioned Countries, without BP's involvement.
BP has no control over the activities non-controlled associates may undertake in Sanctioned Countries or with persons from Sanctioned Countries.
Disclosure pursuant to ITRA Section 219
To our knowledge, none of BP’s activities, transactions or dealings are required to be disclosed pursuant to ITRA Section 219.
Material contracts
On 4 April 2016 the district court approved the Consent Decree among BP Exploration & Production Inc., BP Corporation North America Inc., BP p.l.c., the United States and the states of Alabama, Florida, Louisiana, Mississippi and Texas (the Gulf states) which fully and finally resolved any and all natural resource damages (NRD) claims of the United States, the Gulf states, and their respective natural resource trustees and all Clean Water Act (CWA) penalty claims, and certain other claims of the United States and the Gulf states.
Concurrently, the definitive Settlement Agreement that BP entered into with the Gulf states (Settlement Agreement) with respect to State claims for economic, property and other losses became effective.
BP has filed the Consent Decree and the Settlement Agreement as exhibits to its Annual Report on Form 20-F 2019 filed with the SEC. For further details of the Consent Decree and the Settlement Agreement, see Legal proceedings in BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2015.
Property, plant and equipment
BP has freehold and leasehold interests in real estate and other tangible assets in numerous countries, but no individual property is significant to the group as a whole. For more on the significant subsidiaries of the group at 31 December 2019 and the group percentage of ordinary share capital see Financial statements – Note 37. For information on significant joint ventures« and associates« of the group see Financial statements – Notes 16 and 17.
Related-party transactions
Transactions between the group and its significant joint ventures and associates are summarized in Financial statements – Note 16 and Note 17. In the ordinary course of its business, the group enters into transactions with various organizations with which some of its directors or executive officers are associated. Except as described in this report, the group did not have any material transactions or transactions of an unusual nature with, and did not make loans to, related parties in the period commencing 1 January 2019 to 3 March 2020.
Corporate governance practices
In the US, BP ADSs are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE). The significant differences between BP’s corporate governance practices as a UK company and those required by NYSE listing standards for US companies are listed as follows:
 
Independence
BP has adopted a robust set of board governance principles, which reflect the UK Corporate Governance Code approach to corporate governance. As such, the way in which BP makes determinations of directors’ independence differs from the NYSE rules.
BP’s board governance principles require that all non-executive directors be determined by the board to be ‘independent in character and judgement and free from any business or other relationship which could materially interfere with the exercise of their judgement’. The BP board has determined that, in its judgement, all of the non-executive directors are independent. In doing so, however, the board did not explicitly take into consideration the independence requirements outlined in the NYSE’s listing standards.
Committees
BP has a number of board committees that are broadly comparable in purpose and composition to those required by NYSE rules for domestic US companies. For instance, BP has a chairman’s (rather than executive) committee and remuneration (rather than compensation) committee. BP also has an audit committee, which NYSE rules require for both US companies and foreign private issuers. These committees are composed solely of non-executive directors whom the board has determined to be independent, in the manner described above.
The BP board governance principles prescribe the composition, main tasks and requirements of each of the committees (see the board committee reports on pages 90-99). BP has not, therefore, adopted separate charters for each committee but the board will focus on developing a new corporate governance framework as the successor to the BP governance principles. This framework will reinforce the effectiveness of the internal control framework and be more closely aligned with BP’s new purpose and ambition.
Under US securities law and the listing standards of the NYSE, BP is required to have an audit committee that satisfies the requirements of Rule 10A-3 under the Exchange Act and Section 303A.06 of the NYSE Listed Company Manual. BP’s audit committee complies with these requirements. The BP audit committee does not have direct responsibility for the appointment, reappointment or removal of the independent auditors. Instead, it follows the UK Companies Act 2006 and the UK Corporate Governance code 2018 by making recommendations to the board on these matters for it to put forward for shareholder approval at the AGM.
One of the NYSE’s additional requirements for the audit committee states that at least one member of the audit committee is to have ‘accounting or related financial management expertise’. The board determined that Brendan Nelson possesses such expertise and also possesses the financial and audit committee experiences set forth in both the UK Corporate Governance Code and SEC rules (see Audit committee report on page 91). Mr Nelson is the audit committee financial expert as defined in Item 16A of Form 20-F.
Shareholder approval of equity compensation plans
The NYSE rules for US companies require that shareholders must be given the opportunity to vote on all equity-compensation plans and material revisions to those plans. BP complies with UK requirements that are similar to the NYSE rules. The board, however, does not explicitly take into consideration the NYSE’s detailed definition of what are considered ‘material revisions’.
Code of ethics
The NYSE rules require that US companies adopt and disclose a code of business conduct and ethics for directors, officers and employees. BP has adopted a code of conduct, which applies to all employees and members of the board, and has board governance principles that address the conduct of directors. In addition BP has adopted a code of ethics for senior financial officers as required by the SEC. BP considers that these codes and policies address the matters specified in the NYSE rules for US companies.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
321


Code of ethics
The company has adopted a code of ethics for its group chief executive, chief financial officer, group controller, group head of audit and chief accounting officer as required by the provisions of Section 406 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the rules issued by the SEC. There have been no waivers from the code of ethics relating to any officers.
BP also has a code of conduct, which is applicable to all employees, officers and members of the board. This was updated (and published) in July 2014.
Controls and procedures
Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures
The company maintains ‘disclosure controls and procedures’, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e), that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports the company files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the company’s group chief executive and chief financial officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.
In designing and evaluating our disclosure controls and procedures, our management, including the group chief executive and chief financial officer, recognize that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the disclosure controls and procedures are met. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud within the company, if any, have been detected. Further, in the design and evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures our management necessarily was required to apply its judgement in evaluating the costs and benefits of possible control and procedure design options. Also, we have investments in unconsolidated entities. As we do not control these entities, our disclosure controls and procedures with respect to such entities are necessarily substantially more limited than those we maintain with respect to our consolidated subsidiaries. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. The company’s disclosure controls and procedures have been designed to meet, and management believes that they meet, reasonable assurance standards.
The company’s management, with the participation of the company’s group chief executive and chief financial officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(b) as of the end of the period covered by this annual report. Based on that evaluation, the group chief executive and chief financial officer have concluded that the company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective at a reasonable assurance level.
Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting
Management of BP is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. BP’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the principal executive and financial officers to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of BP’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with IFRS.
As of the end of the 2019 fiscal year, management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the criteria in the UK Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting relating to internal control over financial reporting. Based on this assessment, management has determined that BP’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2019 was effective.
 
The company’s internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect transactions and dispositions of assets; provide reasonable assurances that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with IFRS and that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and the directors of BP; and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of BP’s assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements. BP’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2019 has been audited by Deloitte LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing on page 151 of BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019.
Changes in internal control over financial reporting
There were no changes in the group’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the Form 20-F that have materially affected or are reasonably likely to materially affect our internal control over financial reporting.
Principal accountant's fees and services
The audit committee has established policies and procedures for the engagement of the independent registered public accounting firm, Deloitte LLP, to render audit and certain assurance services. The policies provide for pre-approval by the audit committee of specifically defined audit, audit-related, non-audit and other services that are not prohibited by regulatory or other professional requirements. Deloitte is engaged for these services when its expertise and experience of BP are important. Most of this work is of an audit nature. The committee regularly reviews the policy, including in 2019, to assesses whether the policy remains fit for purpose against the latest ethical standards and guidance. The committee will review the policy again in 2020 and the policy will be updated in line with the revised FRC 2019 Ethical Standards.
Under the policy, pre-approval is given for specific services within the following categories: advice on accounting, auditing and financial reporting matters; internal accounting and risk management control reviews (excluding any services relating to information systems design and implementation); non-statutory audit; project assurance and advice on business and accounting process improvement (excluding any services relating to information systems design and implementation relating to BP’s financial statements or accounting records); due diligence in connection with acquisitions, disposals and joint arrangements« (excluding valuation or involvement in prospective financial information); provision of, or access to, Deloitte publications, workshops, seminars and other training materials; provision of reports from data gathered on non-financial policies and information; provision of the independent third party audit in accordance with US Generally Accepted Government Auditing Standards, over the company’s Conflict Minerals Report – where such a report is required under the SEC rule ‘Conflict Minerals’, issued in accordance with Section 1502 of the Dodd Frank Act; and assistance with understanding non-financial regulatory requirements. BP operates a two-tier system for audit and non-audit services. For audit related services, the audit committee has a pre-approved aggregate level, within which specific work may be approved by management. Non-audit services are pre-approved for management to authorize per individual engagement, but above a defined level must be approved by the chairman of the audit committee or the full committee. In response to the revised regulatory guidelines of the UK Financial Reporting Council, the audit committee reviewed and updated its policies with effect from 1 January 2017 and in 2018 further updated its policies to clarify the engagement of the incoming auditor, Deloitte, and the outgoing auditor (and auditor of Rosneft) Ernst & Young to ensure independence. The defined maximum level for pre-approval has been reduced in line with FRC guidance on ‘non-trivial’ engagements. The audit committee has delegated to the chairman of the audit committee authority to approve permitted services provided that the chairman reports any decisions to the committee at its next scheduled meeting. Any proposed service not included in the

322
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


approved service list must be approved in advance by the audit committee chairman and reported to the committee, or approved by the full audit committee in advance of commencement of the engagement.
The audit committee evaluates the performance of the auditor each year. The audit fees payable to Deloitte are reviewed by the committee in the context of other global companies for cost effectiveness. The committee keeps under review the scope and results of audit work and the independence and objectivity of the auditor. External regulation and BP policy requires the auditor to rotate its lead audit partner every five years. See Financial statements – Note 36 and Audit committee report on page 93 for details of fees for services provided by the auditor.
Directors’ report information
This section of BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 forms part of, and includes certain disclosures which are required by law to be included in, the Directors’ report.
Indemnity provisions
In accordance with BP’s Articles of Association, on appointment each director is granted an indemnity from the company in respect of liabilities incurred as a result of their office, to the extent permitted by law. These indemnities were in force throughout the financial year and at the date of this report. In respect of those liabilities for which directors may not be indemnified, the company maintained a directors’ and officers’ liability insurance policy throughout 2019. During the year, a review of the terms and scope of the policy was undertaken. The policy was renewed during 2018 and continued into 2019. Although their defence costs may be met, neither the company’s indemnity nor insurance provides cover in the event that the director is proved to have acted fraudulently or dishonestly. Certain subsidiaries are trustees of the group’s pension schemes. Each director of these subsidiaries«is granted an indemnity from the company in respect of liabilities incurred as a result of such a subsidiary’s activities as a trustee of the pension scheme, to the extent permitted by law. These indemnities were in force throughout the financial year and at the date of this report.
Financial risk management objectives and policies
The disclosures in relation to financial risk management objectives and policies, including the policy for hedging, are included in How we manage risk on page 68, Liquidity and capital resources on page 301 and Financial statements – Notes 29 and 30.
Exposure to price risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and cash flow risk
The disclosures in relation to exposure to price risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and cash flow risk are included in Financial statements – Note 29.
Important events since the end of the financial year
Disclosures of the particulars of the important events affecting BP which have occurred since the end of the financial year are included in the Strategic report as well as in other places in the Directors’ report.
Likely future developments in the business
An indication of the likely future developments in the business of the company is included in the Strategic report.
Research and development
Indications of our activities in the field of research and development are provided throughout the Strategic report and the Directors’ report including examples on pages 15 (technology and innovation), 16 (creating low carbon businesses), 28 and 65 (venturing), 31 (modernizing the group) and 57 (BP Infinia). See also page 180 for our expenditure on research and development.
Branches
As a global group our interests and activities are held or operated through subsidiaries, branches, joint arrangements« or associates« established in – and subject to the laws and regulations of – many different jurisdictions.
 
Employees
Disclosures in respect of how the directors have engaged with employees and had regard to their interests are included in How the board has engaged with shareholders, the workforce and other stakeholders on page 88 and section 172 statement on page 66.
The disclosures concerning policies in relation to the employment of disabled persons and employee involvement are included in Sustainability – Our people on page 47.
Employee share schemes
Certain shares held as a result of participation in some employee share plans carry voting rights. Voting rights in respect of such shares are exercisable via a nominee. Dividend waivers are in place in respect of unallocated shares held in employee share plan trusts.
Suppliers, customers and others
Disclosures in respect of how the directors have engaged with suppliers, customers and others in business relationships with the company are included in How the board has engaged with shareholders, the workforce and other stakeholders on page 88 and section 172 statement on page 66.
Change of control provisions
On 5 October 2015, the United States lodged with the district court in MDL 2179 a proposed Consent Decree between the United States, the Gulf states, BP Exploration & Production Inc., BP Corporation North America Inc. and BP p.l.c., to fully and finally resolve any and all natural resource damages claims of the United States, the Gulf states and their respective natural resource trustees and all Clean Water Act penalty claims, and certain other claims of the United States and the Gulf states. Concurrently, BP entered into a definitive Settlement Agreement with the five Gulf states (Settlement Agreement) with respect to state claims for economic, property and other losses. On 4 April 2016, the district court approved the Consent Decree, at which time the Consent Decree and Settlement Agreement became effective. The federal government and the Gulf states may jointly elect to accelerate the payments under the Consent Decree in the event of a change of control or insolvency of BP p.l.c., and the Gulf states individually have similar acceleration rights under the Settlement Agreement. For further details of the Consent Decree and the Settlement Agreement, see Legal proceedings in BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2015.
Greenhouse gas emissions
The disclosures in relation to greenhouse gas emissions are included in Sustainability – Climate change on page 40.
Disclosures required under Listing Rule 9.8.4R
The information required to be disclosed by Listing Rule 9.8.4R can be located as set out below:
Information required
Page

(1) Amount of interest capitalized
180

(2) – (11)
Not applicable

(12), (13) Dividend waivers
323

(14)
Not applicable



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
323


Cautionary statement
In order to utilize the ‘safe harbor’ provisions of the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (the ‘PSLRA’) and the general doctrine of cautionary statements, BP is providing the following cautionary statement. This document contains certain forecasts, projections and forward-looking statements - that is, statements related to future, not past, events and circumstances - with respect to the financial condition, results of operations and businesses of BP and certain of the plans and objectives of BP with respect to these items. These statements may generally, but not always, be identified by the use of words such as ‘will’, ‘expects’, ‘is expected to’, ‘aims’, ‘should’, ‘may’, ‘objective’, ‘is likely to’, ‘intends’, ‘believes’, ‘anticipates’, ‘plans’, ‘we see’ or similar expressions. In particular, among other statements, (i) certain statements in the Chairman’s letter (pages 2-3), the Chief executive officer’s letter (pages 4-5), the Strategic report (inside cover and pages 1-71), Additional disclosures (pages 297-325) and Shareholder information (pages 327-336), including but not limited to statements under the headings ‘Our ambition for the energy transition’, ‘Our business model’, ‘Our strategy’ and ‘Measuring our progress’ and including but not limited to statements regarding: the coronavirus pandemic (COVID19), its impact, consequences and challenges and how BP is prepared for and responding to this; plans and expectations relating to organic capital expenditure, maintaining a strong financial frame, deleveraging our balance sheet, working capital and operating cash flows, capital discipline, growth in sustainable free cash flow and shareholder distributions and future dividend payments; BP's new ambition to be a net zero company by 2050 or sooner and help the world get to net zero, including its aims regarding emissions across operations, the carbon content of its oil and gas production; a 50% cut in the carbon intensity of products BP sells, methane measurement at major oil and gas processing sites by 2023 and subsequent reduction of methane intensity of operations, and aims to increase the proportion of investment into non-oil and gas businesses over time; aims to help the world get to net zero; plans for incentivising BP's global workforce; plans for a wide-ranging restructuring of the business; the aim to build a more agile, innovative and efficient BP; continuing commitment to safe and reliable operations; commitment to continuing to perform as BP transforms; continuing commitment to the investor proposition and commitment to transparency and advocacy for a low carbon world; plans and expectations regarding the new leadership structure, including timing of its implementation and areas of focus; plans to focus on developing a new corporate governance framework; plans and expectations regarding our relationships with trade associations; plans to advance a low-carbon future through the reduce, improve, create framework; plans and expectations regarding BP’s level of investment in energy sources and technologies other than oil and gas resources and reserves; expectations regarding world energy demand, including the growth in relative demand for renewables, oil and gas, and the proportional growth of renewables; expectations regarding scenarios that are consistent with the Paris goals; expectations with respect to the world energy mix, production, consumption and emissions to 2040; plans and expectations regarding BP’s portfolio, including to maintain a focused portfolio, to manage the portfolio through disciplined investment to support growing returns and to focus on highest-quality barrels; plans and expectations to deliver 2021 financial targets; expectations with respect to reserves bookings from new discoveries; plans and expectations regarding BP’s quality of execution, including to get more from a unit of capital compared to peers; plans and expectations with regard to the supply and trading function, the fuels, lubricants and the petrochemicals businesses; plans and expectations with regard to new technologies, including their efficiency and impact on production; plans and expectations regarding the retail business, including BP Chargemaster, and to roll-out electric vehicle charging networks in China, Germany and the UK; plans to develop a number of digital platforms to connect consumers with local, low carbon electricity and to enhance productivity through digital solutions; plans and expectations regarding BP’s role in OGCI’s Net Zero Teesside project; plans and expectations regarding BP’s advancing low carbon accreditation programme; plans and expectations with respect to the commercial optimization programme; plans and expectations regarding BPX Energy, including for it to achieve $400 million of
 
annual synergies by 2021; plans and expectations with respect to the Alternative Energy portfolio, including for Lightsource BP to have 10GW of developed assets by the end of 2023, Grid Edge’s impact on energy use and carbon emissions of buildings and expectations for Brazil’s ethanol demand to increase up to 55% by 2030; plans and expectations regarding BP Launchpad, including to quickly create multiple businesses valued over $1 billion; plans and expectations regarding BP Ventures, including to grow advanced mobility, power and storage, carbon management, bio and low carbon products and its investment in Finite Resources; plans and expectations regarding the Other business and corporate annual charge and underlying quarterly charge in 2020; plans and expectations relating to divestments and disposals, including expectations that BP will meet its target of $10 billion of divestment proceeds by the end of 2020 and a further $5 billion of agreed disposals by mid-2021; expectations with respect to completion and the timing of receipt of proceeds of agreed divestments and disposals including the sale of BP’s Alaska operations to Hilcorp Energy and the sale of BP’s interests in the Andrew Area and Shearwater to Premier Oil; expectations regarding the determination of business economic loss claims in respect of the 2012 PSC settlement and expectations with respect to the timing and amount of future payments relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill including 2012 PSC settlement payments; plans and expectations regarding sales commitments of BP and its equity-accounted entities; expectations regarding underlying production and capital investment; plans and expectations with respect to gearing including to target gearing within a 20-30% band, for divestment proceeds to be primarily focused on reducing gearing and for gearing to increase in the short-term and subsequently reduce in line with divestment proceeds; expectations regarding oil prices, including for prices to be challenging in 2020; expectations for return on average capital employed to improve to over 10% by 2021; plans with regard to BP’s exploration budget; expectations regarding depreciation, depletion and amortization charges; expectations regarding the effective tax rate in 2020; plans to produce 900,000boe/d from new projects by 2021 and expectations regarding operating cash margins of this production; plans to start up four projects in 2020; plans and expectations for the Raven project to come onstream at the end of 2020; plans and expectations with respect to a joint venture with ZPCC to build an acetic acid plant; plans and expectations regarding investment, development, and production levels and the timing thereof with respect to projects and partnerships in Angola, Australia, Azerbaijan, Brazil, Egypt, the Gambia, India, Indonesia, Mexico, Russia, São Tomé and Príncipe, Turkey, Oman, the UK North Sea, the Gulf of Mexico, and the continental United States; expectations regarding the Trans Anatolian Natural Gas Pipeline; plans and expectations regarding relationships with governments, customers, partners, suppliers, communities and key stakeholders, including working with the Washington state legislature to advance a new carbon bill; plans and expectations with respect to BP’s public reporting of ambitions, plans, progress and reporting structure; plans and expectations regarding the effectiveness of the group’s foreign currency exchange risk management; plans and expectations regarding plant reliability and base decline, including for base decline to remain between 3-5%; plans and expectations regarding business models in sustainable chemicals and plastics, including with respect to BP Infinia technology and to build a $25-million pilot plant to prove the technology; plans and expectations regarding the Tangguh gas facility; expectations regarding refining margins, North American heavy crude oil discounts and refining turnarounds; plans to undertake joint exploration and development with Rosneft, including to create a joint venture investment fund; expectations regarding pensions and other post-retirement benefits, including contributions; expectations regarding payments under contractual obligations and sales commitments; plans and expectations regarding BP’s workforce, including the aim to attract, develop and retain the best talent, to create a diverse inclusive working environment and an open culture and to ensure equal opportunity in recruitment; policies and goals related to risk management plans; aim to help countries around the world grow their domestic energy supplies and boost energy security; plans and projections regarding oil and gas reserves, including the turnover time of proved undeveloped reserves to proved developed reserves and volume of turnover; expectations regarding the costs of environmental restoration programmes; expectations regarding contingent liabilities and their impact on BP; expectations

324
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


regarding the future value of assets; expectations regarding future regulations and policy, their impact on BP’s business and plans regarding compliance with such regulations; and expectations regarding legal and trial proceedings, court decisions, potential investigations and civil actions by regulators, government entities and/or other entities or parties, and the timing and potential impact of such proceedings and BP’s intentions in respect thereof; and (ii) certain statements in Corporate governance (pages 72-99) and the Directors’ remuneration report (pages 100-127) with regard to the anticipated future composition of the board of directors and the effects thereof; the board’s goals and areas of focus, including changes to KPIs and those goals stemming from the board’s annual evaluation; plans and expectations regarding directors’ share ownership and remuneration; plans regarding the governance and remuneration processes; and goals, activities and areas of focus of board committees, are all forward looking in nature.
By their nature, forward-looking statements involve risk and uncertainty because they relate to events and depend on circumstances that will or may occur in the future and are outside the control of BP. Actual results may differ materially from those expressed in such statements, depending on a variety of factors, including: the specific factors identified in the discussions accompanying such forward looking statements; the receipt of relevant third party and/or regulatory approvals; the timing and level of maintenance and/or turnaround activity; the timing and volume of refinery additions and outages; the timing of bringing new projects onstream; the timing, quantum and nature of certain acquisitions and divestments; future levels of industry product supply, demand and pricing, including supply growth in North America; OPEC quota restrictions; production-sharing agreements effects; operational and safety problems; potential lapses in product quality; economic and financial market conditions generally or in various countries and regions; political stability and economic growth in relevant areas of the world; changes in laws and governmental regulations and policies, including related to climate change; changes in social attitudes and customer preferences; regulatory or legal actions including the types of enforcement action pursued and the nature of remedies sought or imposed; the actions of prosecutors, regulatory authorities and courts; delays in the processes for resolving claims; amounts ultimately determined to be payable and the timing of payments relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill; exchange rate fluctuations; development and use of new technology; recruitment and retention of a skilled workforce; the success or otherwise of partnering; the actions of competitors, trading partners, contractors, subcontractors, creditors, rating agencies and others; our access to future credit resources; business disruption and crisis management; the impact on our reputation of ethical misconduct and non-compliance with regulatory obligations; trading losses; major uninsured losses; decisions by Rosneft’s management and board of directors; the actions of contractors; natural disasters and adverse weather conditions; changes in public expectations and other changes to business conditions; public health situations (including an outbreak of an epidemic or pandemic); wars and acts of terrorism; cyberattacks or sabotage; and other factors discussed elsewhere in this report including under Risk factors (pages 70-71). In addition to factors set forth elsewhere in this report, those set out above are important factors, although not exhaustive, that may cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements.
Statements regarding competitive position
Statements referring to BP’s competitive position are based on the company’s belief and, in some cases, rely on a range of sources, including investment analysts’ reports, independent market studies and BP’s internal assessments of market share based on publicly available information about the financial results and performance of market participants.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
325



























THIS PAGE HAS BEEN LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY


326
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


 
 
 
Shareholder
information
 
328
 
328
 
328
 
330
 
331
 
 
331
 
 
334
 
 
335
 
 
335
 
 
335
 
 
336
 
 
336
2020 Shareholder calendar
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
327


Share prices and listings
Markets and market prices
The primary market for the company’s ordinary shares (trading symbol 'BP.'), 8% cumulative first preference shares (trading symbol 'BP.A') and 9% cumulative second preference shares (trading symbol 'BP.B') is the London Stock Exchange (LSE). The company’s ordinary shares are a constituent element of the Financial Times Stock Exchange 100 Index.
In the US, the company’s securities are listed and traded on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the form of ADSs (trading symbol 'BP'), for which JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. is the depositary (the Depositary) and transfer agent. The Depositary’s principal office is 383 Madison Avenue, Floor 11, New York, NY, 10179, US. Each ADS represents six ordinary shares. ADSs are evidenced by American depositary receipts (ADRs), which may be issued in either certificated or book entry form.
The company's ordinary shares are also traded in the form of a global depositary certificate representing the company's ordinary shares on the Frankfurt, Hamburg and Dusseldorf Stock Exchanges.
On 27 February 2020, 916,049,377 ADSs (equivalent to approximately 5,496,296,262 ordinary shares or some 27.15% of the total issued share capital, excluding shares held in treasury) were outstanding and were held by approximately 77,424 ADS holders. Of these, about 76,535 had registered addresses in the US at that date. One of the registered holders of ADSs represents some 1,237,693 underlying holders.
On 27 February 2020 there were approximately 229,193 ordinary shareholders. Of these shareholders, around 1,535 had registered addresses in the US and held a total of some 4,094,154 ordinary shares.
Since a number of the ordinary shares and ADSs were held by brokers and other nominees, the number of holders in the US may not be representative of the number of beneficial holders or their respective country of residence.
Dividends
The company’s current policy is to pay interim dividends on a quarterly basis on its ordinary shares.
Its policy is also to announce dividends for ordinary shares in US dollars and state an equivalent sterling dividend. Dividends on the company's ordinary shares will be paid in sterling and on the company's ADSs in US dollars. The rate of exchange used to determine the sterling amount equivalent is the average of the market exchange rates in London over the four business days prior to the sterling equivalent announcement date. The directors may choose to declare dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced. It is not the company’s intention to change its current policy of announcing dividends on ordinary shares in US dollars.
Information regarding dividends announced and paid by the company on ordinary shares and preference shares is provided in Financial statements – Note 10.
A Scrip Dividend Programme (Scrip Programme) was approved by shareholders in 2010 and was renewed for a further three years at the 2018 AGM. It enabled the company's ordinary shareholders and ADS holders to elect to receive dividends by way of new fully paid ordinary shares (or ADSs in the case of ADS holders) instead of cash. The operation of the Scrip Programme is always subject to the directors’ decision to make the Scrip Programme offer available in respect of any particular dividend.
The company announced on 29 October 2019 and 4 February 2020 that the board had suspended the Scrip Programme in respect of the third quarter 2019 and fourth quarter 2019 dividends. Ordinary shareholders and ADS holders (subject to certain exceptions) may be able to participate in dividend reinvestment plans. Any decisions with respect to future dividends will be made by the board of BP p.l.c. following the end of each quarter.
 
Future dividends will be dependent on future earnings, the financial condition of the group, the Risk factors set out on page 70 and other matters that may affect the business of the group set out in Our strategy on page 16 and in Liquidity and capital resources on page 301.
The following table shows dividends announced and paid by the company per ADS for the past five years.
Dividends per ADSa
March

June

September

December

Total

2015
UK pence
40.00

39.18

39.29

39.81

158.28

 
US cents
60

60

60

60

240

2016
UK pence
42.08

41.50

45.35

47.59

176.52

 
US cents
60

60

60

60

240

2017
UK pence
48.95

46.54

45.73

44.66

185.88

 
US cents
60

60

60

60

240

2018
UK pence
43.01

44.66

47.58

48.15

183.40

US cents
60

60

61.50

61.50

243

2019
UK pence
46.43

48.39

50.09

46.95

191.86

US cents
61.50

61.50

61.50

61.50

246

a 
Dividends announced and paid by the company on ordinary and preference shares are provided in Financial statements – Note 10.

There are currently no UK foreign exchange controls or restrictions on remittances of dividends on the ordinary shares or on the conduct of the company’s operations, other than restrictions applicable to certain countries and persons subject to EU economic sanctions or those sanctions adopted by the UK government which implement resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations.
Shareholder taxation information
This section describes the material US federal income tax and UK taxation consequences of owning ordinary shares or ADSs to a US holder who holds the ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets for tax purposes. It does not apply, however, inter alia to members of special classes of holders some of which may be subject to other rules, including: tax-exempt entities, life insurance companies, dealers in securities, traders in securities that elect a mark-to-market method of accounting for securities holdings, investors liable for alternative minimum tax, holders that, directly or indirectly, hold 10% or more of the company’s voting stock, holders that hold the shares or ADSs as part of a straddle or a hedging or conversion transaction, holders that purchase or sell the shares or ADSs as part of a wash sale for US federal income tax purposes, or holders whose functional currency is not the US dollar. In addition, if a partnership holds the shares or ADSs, the US federal income tax treatment of a partner will generally depend on the status of the partner and the tax treatment of the partnership and may not be described fully below.
A US holder is any beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs that is for US federal income tax purposes (1) a citizen or resident of the US, (2) a US domestic corporation, (3) an estate whose income is subject to US federal income taxation regardless of its source, or (4) a trust if a US court can exercise primary supervision over the trust’s administration and one or more US persons are authorized to control all substantial decisions of the trust.
This section is based on the tax laws of the United States, including the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, its legislative history, existing and proposed US Treasury regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions, and the taxation laws of the UK, all as currently in effect, as well as the income tax convention between the US and the UK that entered into force on 31 March 2003 (the ‘Treaty’). These laws are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis. This section further assumes that each obligation under the terms of the deposit agreement relating to BP ADSs and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms.
For purposes of the Treaty and the estate and gift tax Convention (the ‘Estate Tax Convention’) and for US federal income tax and UK taxation purposes, a holder of ADRs evidencing ADSs will be treated as the owner of the company’s ordinary shares represented by those ADRs. Exchanges of ordinary shares for ADRs and ADRs for ordinary shares generally will not be subject to US federal income tax or to UK

328
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


taxation other than stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax, as described below.
Investors should consult their own tax adviser regarding the US federal, state and local, UK and other tax consequences of owning and disposing of ordinary shares and ADSs in their particular circumstances, and in particular whether they are eligible for the benefits of the Treaty in respect of their investment in the shares or ADSs.
Taxation of dividends
UK taxation
Under current UK taxation law, no withholding tax will be deducted from dividends paid by the company, including dividends paid to US holders. A shareholder that is a company resident for tax purposes in the UK or trading in the UK through a permanent establishment generally will not be taxable in the UK on a dividend it receives from the company. A shareholder who is an individual resident for tax purposes in the UK is subject to UK tax but until 5 April 2016, was entitled to a tax credit on cash dividends paid on ordinary shares or ADSs of the company equal to one-ninth of the cash dividend.
From 6 April 2016 the dividend tax credit was replaced by a new tax-free dividend allowance and dividends paid by the company on or after 6 April 2016 do not carry a UK tax credit. The dividend allowance was £5,000 but this has been reduced to £2,000 as of 6 April 2018.
The dividend allowance of £2,000 means there is no UK tax due on the first £2,000 of dividends received. Dividends above this level are subject to tax at 7.5% for basic tax payers, 32.5% for higher rate tax payers and 38.1% for additional rate tax payers.
Although the first £2,000 of dividend income is not subject to UK income tax, it does not reduce the total income for tax purposes. Dividends within the dividend allowance still count towards basic or higher rate bands, and may therefore affect the rate of tax paid on dividends received in excess of the £2,000 allowance. For instance, if an individual has an annual gross salary of £50,000 and also receives a dividend of £12,000 they will be subject to the following scenario. The individual's personal allowance and the basic rate tax band will be used up by the gross salary. The remaining part of the salary and the whole of the dividend will be subject to tax at the higher rate, although the dividend allowance will reduce the amount of dividend subject to tax. The dividend of £12,000 will be reduced by the dividend allowance of £2,000 leaving taxable dividend income of £10,000. The dividend will be taxed at 32.5% so that the total tax payable on the dividends is £3,250.
How the shareholder pays the tax arising on the dividend income depends on the amount of dividend income and salary they receive in the tax year. If less than £2,000 they will not need to report anything or pay any tax. If between £2,000 and £10,000, the shareholder can pay what they owe by: contacting the helpline; asking HMRC to change their tax code – the tax will be taken from their wages or pension or through completion of the ‘Dividends’ section of their tax return, where one is being filed. If over £10,000 they will be required to file a self-assessment tax return and should complete the ‘Dividends’ section with details of the amounts received.
US federal income taxation
A US holder is subject to US federal income taxation on the gross amount of any dividend paid by the company out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for US federal income tax purposes). Dividends paid to a non-corporate US holder that constitute qualified dividend income will be taxable to the holder at a preferential rate, provided that the holder has a holding period in the ordinary shares or ADSs of more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date and meets other holding period requirements. Dividends paid by the company with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs will generally be qualified dividend income.
For US federal income tax purposes, a dividend must be included in income when the US holder, in the case of ordinary shares, or the Depositary, in the case of ADSs, actually or constructively receives the dividend and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction generally allowed to US corporations in respect of dividends received from other US corporations. US ADS holders
 
should consult their own tax adviser regarding the US tax treatment of the dividend fee in respect of dividends. Dividends will be income from sources outside the US and generally will be ‘passive category income’ or, in the case of certain US holders, ‘general category income’, each of which is treated separately for purposes of computing a US holder’s foreign tax credit limitation.
As noted above in UK taxation, a US holder will not be subject to UK withholding tax. Accordingly, the receipt of a dividend will not entitle the US holder to a foreign tax credit.
The amount of the dividend distribution on the ordinary shares that is paid in pounds sterling will be the US dollar value of the pounds sterling payments made, determined at the spot pounds sterling/US dollar rate on the date the dividend distribution is includible in income, regardless of whether the payment is, in fact, converted into US dollars. Generally, any gain or loss resulting from currency exchange fluctuations during the period from the date the pounds sterling dividend payment is includible in income to the date the payment is converted into US dollars will be treated as ordinary income or loss and will not be eligible for the preferential tax rate on qualified dividend income. The gain or loss generally will be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.
Distributions in excess of the company’s earnings and profits, as determined for US federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a return of capital to the extent of the US holder’s basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as capital gain, subject to taxation as described in Taxation of capital gains – US federal income taxation section below.
In addition, the taxation of dividends may be subject to the rules for passive foreign investment companies (PFIC), described below under ‘Taxation of capital gains – US federal income taxation’. Distributions made by a PFIC do not constitute qualified dividend income and are not eligible for the preferential tax rate applicable to such income.
Taxation of capital gains
UK taxation
A US holder may be liable for both UK and US tax in respect of a gain on the disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs if the US holder is (1) resident for tax purposes in the United Kingdom at the date of disposal, (2) if he or she has left the UK for a period not exceeding five complete tax years between the year of departure from and the year of return to the UK and acquired the shares before leaving the UK and was resident in the UK in the previous four out of seven tax years before the year of departure, (3) a US domestic corporation resident in the UK by reason of its business being managed or controlled in the UK or (4) a citizen of the US that carries on a trade or profession or vocation in the UK through a branch or agency or a corporation that carries on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK, through a permanent establishment, and that has used, held, or acquired the ordinary shares or ADSs for the purposes of such trade, profession or vocation of such branch, agency or permanent establishment. However, such persons may be entitled to a tax credit against their US federal income tax liability for the amount of UK capital gains tax or UK corporation tax on chargeable gains (as the case may be) that is paid in respect of such gain.
Under the Treaty, capital gains on dispositions of ordinary shares or ADSs generally will be subject to tax only in the jurisdiction of residence of the relevant holder as determined under both the laws of the UK and the US and as required by the terms of the Treaty.
Under the Treaty, individuals who are residents of either the UK or the US and who have been residents of the other jurisdiction (the US or the UK, as the case may be) at any time during the six years immediately preceding the relevant disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs may be subject to tax with respect to capital gains arising from a disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs of the company not only in the jurisdiction of which the holder is resident at the time of the disposition but also in the other jurisdiction.
For gains on or after 23 June 2010, the UK Capital Gains Tax rate will be dependent on the level of an individual’s taxable income. Where total taxable income and gains after all allowable deductions are less than the upper limit of the basic rate income tax band of £37,500 (for

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
329


2019/20), the rate of Capital Gains Tax will be 10%. For gains (and any parts of gains) above that limit the rate will be 20%.
From 6 April 2008, entitlement to the annual exemption is based on an individual’s circumstances (taking into account Domicile status, remittance basis of taxation and number of years in the UK). For individuals who are entitled to the exemption for 2019/20, this has been set at £12,000. Corporation tax on chargeable gains is levied at 19 per cent for companies from 1 April 2017.
US federal income taxation
A US holder who sells or otherwise disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs will recognize a capital gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the US dollar value of the amount realized on the disposition and the US holder’s tax basis, determined in US dollars, in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Any such capital gain or loss generally will be long-term gain or loss, subject to tax at a preferential rate for a non-corporate US holder, if the US holder’s holding period for such ordinary shares or ADSs exceeds one year.
Gain or loss from the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs will generally be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.
We do not believe that ordinary shares or ADSs will be treated as stock of a passive foreign investment company (PFIC) for US federal income tax purposes, but this conclusion is a factual determination that is made annually and thus is subject to change. If we are treated as a PFIC, unless a US holder elects to be taxed annually on a mark-to-market basis with respect to ordinary shares or ADSs, any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs would in general not be treated as capital gain. Instead, a US holder would be treated as if he or she had realized such gain rateably over the holding period for ordinary shares or ADSs and would be taxed at the highest tax rate in effect for each such year to which the gain was allocated, in addition to which an interest charge in respect of the tax attributable to each such year would apply. Certain ‘excess distributions’ would be similarly treated if we were treated as a PFIC.
Additional tax considerations
Scrip Programme
Until the publication of the 2019 third quarter results, the company had an optional Scrip Programme, wherein holders of BP ordinary shares or ADSs could elect to receive any dividends in the form of new fully paid ordinary shares or ADSs of the company instead of cash. Please consult your tax adviser for the consequences to you.
UK inheritance tax
The Estate Tax Convention applies to inheritance tax. ADSs held by an individual who is domiciled for the purposes of the Estate Tax Convention in the US and is not for the purposes of the Estate Tax Convention a national of the UK will not be subject to UK inheritance tax on the individual’s death or on transfer during the individual’s lifetime unless, among other things, the ADSs are part of the business property of a permanent establishment situated in the UK used for the performance of independent personal services. In the exceptional case where ADSs are subject to both inheritance tax and US federal gift or estate tax, the Estate Tax Convention generally provides for tax payable in the US to be credited against tax payable in the UK or for tax paid in the UK to be credited against tax payable in the US, based on priority rules set forth in the Estate Tax Convention.
UK stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax
The statements below relate to what is understood to be the current practice of HM Revenue & Customs in the UK under existing law.
Provided that any instrument of transfer is not executed in the UK and remains at all times outside the UK and the transfer does not relate to any matter or thing done or to be done in the UK, no UK stamp duty is payable on the acquisition or transfer of ADSs. Neither will an agreement to transfer ADSs in the form of ADRs give rise to a liability to stamp duty reserve tax.
Purchases of ordinary shares, as opposed to ADSs, through the CREST system of paperless share transfers will be subject to stamp
 
duty reserve tax at 0.5%. The charge will arise as soon as there is an agreement for the transfer of the shares (or, in the case of a conditional agreement, when the condition is fulfilled). The stamp duty reserve tax will apply to agreements to transfer ordinary shares even if the agreement is made outside the UK between two non-residents. Purchases of ordinary shares outside the CREST system are subject either to stamp duty at a rate of £5 per £1,000 (or part, unless the stamp duty is less than £5, when no stamp duty is charged), or stamp duty reserve tax at 0.5%. Stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax are generally the liability of the purchaser.
A subsequent transfer of ordinary shares to the Depositary’s nominee will give rise to further stamp duty at the rate of £1.50 per £100 (or part) or stamp duty reserve tax at the rate of 1.5% of the value of the ordinary shares at the time of the transfer. For ADR holders electing to receive ADSs instead of cash, after the 2012 first quarter dividend payment, HM Revenue & Customs no longer seeks to impose 1.5% stamp duty reserve tax on issues of UK shares and securities to non-EU clearance services and depositary receipt systems.
US Medicare Tax
A US holder that is an individual or estate, or a trust that does not fall into a special class of trusts that is exempt from such tax, is subject to a 3.8% tax on the lesser of (1) the US holder’s ‘net investment income’ (or ‘undistributed net investment income’ in the case of an estate or trust) for the relevant taxable year and (2) the excess of the US holder’s modified adjusted gross income for the taxable year over a certain threshold (which in the case of individuals is between $125,000 and $250,000, depending on the individual’s circumstances). A holder’s net investment income generally includes its dividend income and its net gains from the disposition of shares or ADSs, unless such dividend income or net gains are derived in the ordinary course of the conduct of a trade or business (other than a trade or business that consists of certain passive or trading activities). If you are a US holder that is an individual, estate or trust, you are urged to consult your tax advisers regarding the applicability of the Medicare tax to your income and gains in respect of your investment in the shares or ADSs.
Major shareholders
The disclosure of certain major and significant shareholdings in the share capital of the company is governed by the Companies Act 2006, the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules (DTR) and the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
Register of members holding BP ordinary shares as at 31 December 2019
Range of holdings
Number of ordinary
shareholders

Percentage of total
ordinary shareholders
Percentage of total
ordinary share capital
excluding shares
held in treasury
1-200
52,926

22.96
0.01
201-1,000
77,165

33.47
0.21
1,001-10,000
88,204

38.26
1.37
10,001-100,000
10,640

4.61
1.10
100,001-1,000,000
928

0.40
1.68
Over 1,000,000a
693

0.30
95.63
Totals
230,556

100.00
100.00
a 
Includes JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. holding 27.04% of the total ordinary issued share capital (excluding shares held in treasury) as the approved depositary for ADSs, a breakdown of which is shown in the table below.

330
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Register of holders of American depositary shares (ADSs) as at 31 December 2019a 
Range of holdings
Number of
ADS holders

Percentage of
 total ADS holders
Percentage of 
total ADSs
1-200
46,802

59.80
0.27
201-1,000
20,337

25.98
1.05
1,001-10,000
10,654

13.61
3.00
10,001-100,000
466

0.60
0.84
100,001-1,000,000
7

0.01
0.14
Over 1,000,000b
1

0.00
94.70
Totals
78,267

100.00
100.00
a 
One ADS represents six 25 cent ordinary shares.
b 
One holder of ADSs represents 1,231,543 underlying shareholders.
As at 31 December 2019 there were also 1,236 preference shareholders. Preference shareholders represented 0.41% and ordinary shareholders represented 99.59% of the total issued nominal share capital of the company (excluding shares held in treasury) as at that date.
As at 31 December 2019, we had been notified pursuant to DTR5 that BlackRock, Inc. held 7.37% of the voting rights attached to the issued share capital of the company.
The company did not receive any notifications pursuant to DTR5 between 1 January 2020 and 27 February 2020.
Under the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 BP is aware of the following interests as at 27 February 2020:
Holder
Holding of
ordinary shares

Percentage of ordinary share capital excluding shares held in treasury
JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., depositary for ADSs, through its nominee Guaranty Nominees Limited
5,496,296,263

27.13
BlackRock, Inc.
1,531,724,983

7.60
The Vanguard Group, Inc
813,197,253

4.00
The company’s major shareholders do not have different voting rights.
The company has also been notified of the following interests in preference shares as at 27 February 2020:
Holder
Holding of 8%
cumulative first
preference shares

Percentage
of class
The National Farmers Union Mutual Insurance Society Limited
945,000

13.10
Hargreaves Lansdown Asset Management Limited
644,225

8.90
Canaccord Genuity Group Inc.
544,163

7.50
M&G Investment Management Ltd.
528,150

7.30
Interactive Investor Share Dealing Services
513,068

7.10
A J Bell Securities Limited
390,807

5.40
Holder
Holding of 9%
cumulative second
preference shares

Percentage
of class

The National Farmers Union Mutual Insurance Society Limited
987,000

18.00

M&G Investment Management Ltd.
644,450

11.80

Safra Group
385,000

7.00

Canaccord Genuity Group Inc.
273,135

5.00

Barclays PLC
271,080

5.00

As at 27 February 2020, the total preference shares in issue comprised only 0.42% of the company’s total issued nominal share capital (excluding shares held in treasury), the rest being ordinary shares.
 
Annual general meeting
The 2020 AGM will be held on Wednesday 27 May 2020 at 11.00am. A separate notice convening the meeting is distributed to shareholders, which includes an explanation of the items of business to be considered at the meeting.
All resolutions for which notice has been given will be decided on a poll. Deloitte LLP have expressed their willingness to continue in office as auditors and a resolution for their reappointment is included in the Notice of BP Annual General Meeting 2020.
Memorandum and Articles of Association
The following summarizes certain provisions of the company’s Memorandum and Articles of Association and applicable English law. This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the UK Companies Act 2006 (the Act) and the company’s Memorandum and Articles of Association. The Memorandum and Articles of Association are available online at bp.com/usefuldocs.
The company’s Articles of Association may be amended by a special resolution at a general meeting of the shareholders. At the annual general meeting (AGM) held on 21 May 2018 shareholders voted to adopt new Articles of Association to reflect developments in market practice and to provide clarification and additional flexibility where necessary or appropriate.
Objects and purposes
BP is a public company limited by shares, incorporated under the name BP p.l.c. and is registered in England and Wales with the registered number 102498. The provisions regulating the operations of the company, known as its ‘objects’, were historically stated in a company’s memorandum. The Act abolished the need to have object provisions and so at the AGM held on 15 April 2010 shareholders approved the removal of its objects clause together with all other provisions of its Memorandum that, by virtue of the Act, are treated as forming part of the company’s Articles of Association.
Directors and secretary
The business and affairs of BP shall be managed by the directors. The company’s Articles of Association provide that directors may be appointed by the existing directors or by the shareholders in a general meeting. Any person appointed by the directors will hold office only until the next general meeting, notice of which is first given after their appointment and will then be eligible for re-election by the shareholders. A director may be removed by BP as provided for by applicable law and shall vacate office in certain circumstances as set out in the Articles of Association. In addition the company may, by special resolution, remove a director before the expiration of his/her period of office and, subject to the Articles of Association, may by ordinary resolution appoint another person to be a director instead. There is no requirement for a director to retire on reaching any age.
The Articles of Association place a general prohibition on a director voting in respect of any contract or arrangement in which the director has a material interest other than by virtue of such director’s interest in shares in the company. However, in the absence of some other material interest not indicated below, a director is entitled to vote and to be counted in a quorum for the purpose of any vote relating to a resolution concerning the following matters:
The giving of security or indemnity with respect to any money lent or obligation taken by the director at the request or benefit of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings.
Any proposal in which the director is interested, concerning the underwriting of company securities or debentures or the giving of any security to a third party for a debt or obligation of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings.
Any proposal concerning any other company in which the director is interested, directly or indirectly (whether as an officer or shareholder or otherwise) provided that the director and persons connected with such director are not the holder or holders of 1% or more of the voting interest in the shares of such company.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
331


Any proposal concerning the purchase or maintenance of any insurance policy under which the director may benefit.
Any proposal concerning the giving to the director of any other indemnity which is on substantially the same terms as indemnities given or to be given to all of the other directors or to the funding by the company of his expenditure on defending proceedings or the doing by the company of anything to enable the director to avoid incurring such expenditure where all other directors have been given or are to be given substantially the same arrangements.
Any proposal concerning an arrangement for the benefit of the employees and directors or former employees and former directors of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings, including but without being limited to a retirement benefits scheme and an employees’ share scheme, which does not accord to any director any privilege or advantage not generally accorded to the employees or former employees to whom the arrangement relates.
The Act requires a director of a company who is in any way interested in a contract or proposed contract with the company to declare the nature of the director’s interest at a meeting of the directors of the company. The definition of ‘interest’ includes the interests of spouses, children, companies and trusts. The Act also requires that a director must avoid a situation where a director has, or could have, a direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the company’s interests. The Act allows directors of public companies to authorize such conflicts where appropriate, if a company’s Articles of Association so permit. BP’s Articles of Association permit the authorization of such conflicts. The directors may exercise all the powers of the company to borrow money, except that the amount remaining undischarged of all moneys borrowed by the company shall not, without approval of the shareholders, exceed two times the amount paid up on the share capital plus the aggregate of the amount of the capital and revenue reserves of the company. Variation of the borrowing power of the board may only be affected by amending the Articles of Association.
Remuneration of non-executive directors shall be determined in the aggregate by resolution of the shareholders. Remuneration of executive directors is determined by the remuneration committee. This committee is made up of non-executive directors only. There is no requirement of share ownership for a director’s qualification.
The Articles of Association provide entitlement to the directors’ pensions and death and disability benefits to the directors’ relations and dependants respectively.
The circumstances in which a director’s office will automatically terminate include: when a director ceases to hold an executive office of the company and the directors resolve that he should cease to be a director; if a medical practitioner provides an opinion that a director has become incapable of acting as a director and may remain so incapable for a further three months and the directors resolve that he should cease to be a director; and if all of the other directors vote in favour of a resolution stating that the person should cease to be a director.
The company secretary has express powers to delegate any of the powers or discretions conferred on him or her.
Dividend rights; other rights to share in company profits; capital calls
If recommended by the directors of BP, shareholders of BP may, by resolution, declare dividends but no such dividend may be declared in excess of the amount recommended by the directors. The directors may also pay interim dividends without obtaining shareholder approval. No dividend may be paid other than out of profits available for distribution, as determined under IFRS and the Act. Dividends on ordinary shares are payable only after payment of dividends on BP preference shares. Any dividend unclaimed after a period of 10 years from the date of declaration of such dividend shall be forfeited and reverts to BP. If the company exercises its right to forfeit shares and sells shares belonging to an untraced shareholder then any entitlement to claim dividends or other monies unclaimed in respect of those shares will be for a period of twelve months after the sale. The company may take such steps as the directors decide are appropriate in the circumstances to trace the member entitled and
 
the sale may be made at such time and on such terms as the directors may decide.
The directors have the power to declare and pay dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced. It is not the company’s intention to change its current policy of paying dividends in US dollars. At the company’s AGM held on 15 April 2010, shareholders approved the introduction of a Scrip Dividend Programme (Scrip Programme) and to include provisions in the Articles of Association to enable the company to operate the Scrip Programme. The Scrip Programme was renewed at the company’s AGM held on 21 May 2018 for a further three years. The Scrip Programme enables ordinary shareholders and BP ADS holders to elect to receive new fully paid ordinary shares (or BP ADSs in the case of BP ADS holders) instead of cash. The operation of the Scrip Programme is always subject to the directors’ decision to make the scrip offer available in respect of any particular dividend. Should the directors decide not to offer the scrip in respect of any particular dividend, cash will automatically be paid instead. The directors may determine in relation to any scrip dividend plan or programme how the costs of the programme will be met, the minimum number of ordinary shares required in order to be able to participate in the programme and any arrangements to deal with legal and practical difficulties in any particular territory.
Apart from shareholders’ rights to share in BP’s profits by dividend (if any is declared or announced), the Articles of Association provide that the directors may set aside:
A special reserve fund out of the balance of profits each year to make up any deficit of cumulative dividend on the BP preference shares.
A general reserve out of the balance of profits each year, which shall be applicable for any purpose to which the profits of the company may properly be applied. This may include capitalization of such sum, pursuant to an ordinary shareholders’ resolution, and distribution to shareholders as if it were distributed by way of a dividend on the ordinary shares or in paying up in full unissued ordinary shares for allotment and distribution as bonus shares.
Any such sums so deposited may be distributed in accordance with the manner of distribution of dividends as described above.
Holders of shares are not subject to calls on capital by the company, provided that the amounts required to be paid on issue have been paid off. All shares are fully paid.
Share transfers and share certificates
The directors may permit transfers to be effected other than by an instrument in writing and that share certificates will not be required to be issued by the company if they are not required by law.
The company may charge an administrative fee in the event that a shareholder wishes to replace two or more certificates representing shares with a single certificate or wishes to surrender a single certificate and replace it with two or more certificates. All certificates are sent at the member’s risk.
Voting rights
The Articles of Association of the company provide that voting on resolutions at a shareholders’ meeting will be decided on a poll other than resolutions of a procedural nature, which may be decided on a show of hands. If voting is on a poll, every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy has one vote for every ordinary share held and two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of BP preference shares held. If voting is on a show of hands, each shareholder who is present at the meeting in person or whose duly appointed proxy is present in person will have one vote, regardless of the number of shares held, unless a poll is requested.
Shareholders do not have cumulative voting rights.
For the purposes of determining which persons are entitled to attend or vote at a shareholders’ meeting and how many votes such persons may cast, the company may specify in the notice of the meeting a time, not more than 48 hours before the time of the meeting, by which a person who holds shares in registered form must be entered on the company’s register of members in order to have the right to attend or vote at the meeting or to appoint a proxy to do so.

332
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Holders on record of ordinary shares may appoint a proxy, including a beneficial owner of those shares, to attend, speak and vote on their behalf at any shareholders’ meeting, provided that a duly completed proxy form is received not less than 48 hours (or such shorter time as the directors may determine) before the time of the meeting or adjourned meeting or, where the poll is to be taken after the date of the meeting, not less than 24 hours (or such shorter time as the directors may determine) before the time of the poll.
Record holders of BP ADSs are also entitled to attend, speak and vote at any shareholders’ meeting of BP by the appointment by the approved depositary, JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., of them as proxies in respect of the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs. Each such proxy may also appoint a proxy. Alternatively, holders of BP ADSs are entitled to vote by supplying their voting instructions to the depositary, who will vote the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs in accordance with their instructions.
Proxies may be delivered electronically.
Corporations who are members of the company may appoint one or more persons to act as their representative or representatives at any shareholders’ meeting provided that the company may require a corporate representative to produce a certified copy of the resolution appointing them before they are permitted to exercise their powers.
Matters are transacted at shareholders’ meetings by the proposing and passing of resolutions, of which there are two types: ordinary or special.
An ordinary resolution requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes of those persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. A special resolution requires the affirmative vote of not less than three quarters of the persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. Any AGM requires 21 clear days’ notice. The notice period for any other general meeting is 14 clear days subject to the company obtaining annual shareholder approval, failing which, a 21 clear day notice period will apply.
Liquidation rights; redemption provisions
In the event of a liquidation of BP, after payment of all liabilities and applicable deductions under UK laws and subject to the payment of secured creditors, the holders of BP preference shares would be entitled to the sum of (1) the capital paid up on such shares plus, (2) accrued and unpaid dividends and (3) a premium equal to the higher of (a) 10% of the capital paid up on the BP preference shares and (b) the excess of the average market price over par value of such shares on the LSE during the previous six months. The remaining assets (if any) would be divided pro rata among the holders of ordinary shares.
Without prejudice to any special rights previously conferred on the holders of any class of shares, BP may issue any share with such preferred, deferred or other special rights, or subject to such restrictions as the shareholders by resolution determine (or, in the absence of any such resolutions, by determination of the directors), and may issue shares that are to be or may be redeemed.
Variation of rights
The rights attached to any class of shares may be varied with the consent in writing of holders of 75% of the shares of that class or on the adoption of a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. At every such separate meeting, all of the provisions of the Articles of Association relating to proceedings at a general meeting apply, except that the quorum with respect to a meeting to change the rights attached to the preference shares is 10% or more of the shares of that class, and the quorum to change the rights attached to the ordinary shares is one third or more of the shares of that class.
Shareholders’ meetings and notices
Shareholders must provide BP with a postal or electronic address in the UK to be entitled to receive notice of shareholders’ meetings. Holders of BP ADSs are entitled to receive notices under the terms of the deposit agreement relating to BP ADSs. The substance and timing of notices are described above under the heading Voting rights.
Under the Act, the AGM of shareholders must be held once every year, within each six month period beginning with the day following
 
the company’s accounting reference date. All general meetings shall be held at a time and place determined by the directors. If any shareholders’ meeting is adjourned for lack of quorum, notice of the time and place of the adjourned meeting may be given in any lawful manner, including electronically. Powers exist for action to be taken either before or at the meeting by authorized officers to ensure its orderly conduct and safety of those attending.
The directors have power to convene a general meeting which is a hybrid meeting, that is to provide facilities for shareholders to attend a meeting which is being held at a physical place by electronic means as well (but not to convene a purely electronic meeting).
The provisions of the Articles of Association in relation to satellite meetings permit facilities being provided by electronic means to allow those persons at each place to participate in the meeting.
Limitations on voting and shareholding
There are no limitations, either under the laws of the UK or under the company’s Articles of Association, restricting the right of non-resident or foreign owners to hold or vote BP ordinary or preference shares in the company other than limitations that would generally apply to all of the shareholders and limitations applicable to certain countries and persons subject to EU economic sanctions or those sanctions adopted by the UK government which implement resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations.
Disclosure of interests in shares
The Act permits a public company to give notice to any person whom the company believes to be or, at any time during the three years prior to the issue of the notice, to have been interested in its voting shares requiring them to disclose certain information with respect to those interests. Failure to supply the information required may lead to disenfranchisement of the relevant shares and a prohibition on their transfer and receipt of dividends and other payments in respect of those shares and any new shares in the company issued in respect of those shares. In this context the term ‘interest’ is widely defined and will generally include an interest of any kind whatsoever in voting shares, including any interest of a holder of BP ADSs.
Called-up share capital
Details of the allotted, called-up and fully-paid share capital at 31 December 2019 are set out in Financial statements – Note 31. In accordance with institutional investor guidelines, the company deems it appropriate to grant authority to the directors to allot shares and other securities and to disapply pre-emption rights by way of shareholders' resolutions at each AGM in place of authority granted by virtue of the company's Articles of Association. At the AGM on 21 May 2019, authorization was given to the directors to allot shares in the company and to grant rights to subscribe for, or to convert any
security into, shares in the company up to an aggregate nominal amount as set out in the Notice of Meeting 2019. These authorities were given for the period until the next AGM in 2020 or 21 August 2020, whichever is the earlier. These authorities are renewed annually at the AGM.
Company records and service of notice
In relation to notices not covered by the Act, the reference to notice by advertisement in a national newspaper also includes advertisements via other means such as a public announcement.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
333


Purchases of equity securities by the issuer and affiliated purchasers
In November 2017 BP began a share repurchase or buyback programme (the programme). The sole purpose of the programme is to reduce the issued share capital of the company to offset the ongoing dilutive effect of scrip dividends over time, as announced by the company on 31 October 2017. Authorization for the company to make market purchases (as defined in section 693(4) of the Companies Act 2006) of ordinary shares with a nominal value of $0.25 each in the company was renewed at the company’s 2019 AGM covering the period until the date of the company's 2020 AGM or 21 August 2020, whichever is earlier. The maximum number of ordinary shares to be purchased under this authority will not exceed 2,025,988,313 ordinary shares. The shares purchased will be cancelled.
The following table provides details of ordinary share purchases made (1) under the programme and (2) by the Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) and other purchases of ordinary shares and ADSs made to satisfy the requirements of certain employee share-based payment plans.
 
 
Total number of shares purchaseda

Average price
paid per share
$

Number of shares
purchased
by ESOPs or for
certain employee
share-based plans
b

Number of shares purchased as part of the buyback programmec

Maximun approximate dollar value of shares yet to be purchased under the programme
$ million
2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
January
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
February 5 – February 21
 
2,753,983

7.10

120,000

2,633,983

N/A
March 11 – March 29
 
4,260,056

7.29

Nil

4,260,056

N/A
April 30
 
120,000

7.32

120,000

Nil

N/A
May 8 – May 31
 
5,012,700

6.97

Nil

5,012,700

N/A
June 3 – June 25
 
5,763,677

6.96

Nil

5,763,677

N/A
July
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
August 5 – August 29
 
18,852,607

6.11

Nil

18,852,607

N/A
September 2 – September 24
 
16,867,892

6.24

878,000

15,989,892

N/A
October 7 - October 31
 
103,926,413

6.33

Nil

103,926,413

N/A
November 1 – November 29
 
55,589,904

6.53

Nil

55,589,904

N/A
December 2 - December 19
 
23,921,618

6.25

Nil

23,921,618

N/A
2020
 
 
 
 
 
 
January 7 - January 28
 
120,057,464

6.47

Nil

120,057,464

N/A
February (to February 26)
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
a 
All share purchases were of ordinary shares of 25 cents each and/or ADSs (each representing six ordinary shares) and were on/open market transactions.
b 
Transactions represent the purchase of ordinary shares by ESOPs and other purchases of ordinary shares and ADSs made to satisfy requirements of certain employee share-based payment plans.
c 
The company announced its intent to commence the programme on 31 October 2017 and announced further details and commencement of the programme on 15 November 2017. At the AGM on 21 May 2019, authorization was given to the company to repurchase up to 2,025,988,313 ordinary shares, for the period ending on the date of the AGM in 2020 or 21 August 2020, whichever is the earlier. This authorization is renewed annually at the AGM. The total number of ordinary shares repurchased during 2019 under the programme was 235,950,850 at a cost of $1,511 million (including fees and stamp duty) representing 1.16% of the company’s issued share capital excluding shares held in treasury on 31 December 2019. All ordinary shares repurchased in 2019 under the programme were cancelled in order to reduce the company’s issued share capital.

334
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Fees and charges payable by ADS holders
The Depositary collects fees for delivery and surrender of ADSs directly from investors depositing shares or surrendering ADSs for the purpose of withdrawal or from intermediaries acting for them. The Depositary collects fees for making distributions to investors by deducting those fees from the amounts distributed or by selling a portion of the distributable property to pay the fees.
The charges of the Depositary payable by investors are as follows:
Type of service
Depositary actions
Fee
Depositing or substituting the underlying shares
Issuance of ADSs against the deposit of shares, including deposits and issuances in respect of:
Share distributions, stock splits, rights, merger.
Exchange of securities or other transactions or event or other distribution affecting the ADSs or deposited securities.
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the new ADSs delivered.
Selling or exercising rights
Distribution or sale of securities, the fee being an amount equal to the fee for the execution and delivery of ADSs that would have been charged as a result of the deposit of such securities.
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or portion thereof).
Withdrawing an underlying share
Acceptance of ADSs surrendered for withdrawal of deposited securities.
$5.00 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the ADSs surrendered.
Expenses of the Depositary
Expenses incurred on behalf of holders in connection with:
Stock transfer or other taxes and governmental charges.
Delivery by cable, telex, electronic and facsimile transmission.
Transfer or registration fees, if applicable, for the registration of transfers of underlying shares.
Expenses of the Depositary in connection with the conversion of foreign currency into US dollars (which are paid out of such foreign currency).
Expenses payable are subject to agreement between the company and the Depositary by billing holders or by deducting charges from one or more cash dividends or other cash distributions.
Dividend fees
ADS holders who receive a cash dividend are charged a fee which BP uses to offset the costs associated with administering the ADS programme.
The Deposit Agreement provides that a fee of $0.05 or less per ADS can be charged. The current fee is $0.02 per BP ADS per calendar year (equivalent to $0.005 per BP ADS per quarter per cash distribution).
Global Invest Direct (GID) Plan
New investors and existing ADS holders can buy, sell or reinvest dividends into further BP ADSs by enrolling in BP’s GID Plan, sponsored and administered by the Depositary.
Cost per transaction is $2.00 for recurring, $2.00 for one-time automatic investments, and $5.00 for investment made by check. Dividend reinvestment is 5% of the dividend amount up to a maximum of $5.00. Purchase trading commission is $0.12 per share.
Fees and payments made by the Depositary to the issuer
The Depositary has agreed to reimburse certain company expenses related to the company’s ADS programme and incurred by the company in connection with the ADS programme arising during the year ended 31 December 2019. The Depositary reimbursed to the company, or paid amounts on the company’s behalf to third parties, or waived its fees and expenses, of $15,923,592.90 for the year ended 31 December 2019.
The table below sets out the types of expenses that the Depositary has agreed to reimburse and the fees it has agreed to waive for standard costs associated with the administration of the ADS programme relating to the year ended 31 December 2019.
Category of expense reimbursed,
waived or paid directly to third parties
Amount reimbursed, waived or paid directly to third parties for the year ended 31 December 2019
$

Fees for delivery and surrender of BP ADSs
169,235.12

Dividend feesa
15,754,357.78

Total
15,923,592.90

a 
Dividend fees are charged to ADS holders who receive a cash distribution, which BP uses to offset the costs associated with administering the ADS programme.
Under certain circumstances, including removal of the Depositary or termination of the ADR programme by the company, the company is required to repay the Depositary certain amounts reimbursed and/or expenses paid to or on behalf of the company during the 12-month period prior to notice of removal or termination.

 
Documents on display
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 is available online at bp.com/annualreport. To obtain a hard copy of BP’s complete audited financial statements, free of charge, UK based shareholders should contact BP Distribution Services by calling +44 (0) 800 037 2172 or by emailing bpdistributionservices@bp.com. If based in the US or Canada shareholders should contact Issuer Direct by calling +1 888 301 2505 or by emailing bpreports@issuerdirect.com.
The company is subject to the information requirements of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 applicable to foreign private issuers. In accordance with these requirements, the company files its Annual Report and Form 20-F and other related documents with the SEC. The SEC maintains an internet site at www.sec.gov that contains reports and other information regarding issuers, including BP, that file electronically with the SEC. BP's SEC filings are also available at bp.com/sec. BP discloses in this report (see Corporate governance practices (Form 20-F Item 16G) on page 321) significant ways (if any) in which its corporate governance practices differ from those mandated for US companies under NYSE listing standards.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
335


Shareholding administration
If you have any queries about the administration of shareholdings, such as change of address, change of ownership, dividend payment options or to change the way you receive your company documents (such as the BP Annual Report and Form 20-F and Notice of BP Annual General Meeting) please contact the BP Registrar or the BP ADS Depositary.
Ordinary and preference shareholders
The BP Registrar, Link Asset Services
The Registry, 34 Beckenham Road, Beckenham, Kent BR3 4TU, UK
Freephone in UK 0800 701107
From outside the UK +44 (0)371 277 1014

ADS holders
BP Shareowner Services
PO Box 64504, St Paul, MN 55164-0504, US
Toll-free in US and Canada +1 877 638 5672
From outside the US and Canada +1 651 306 4383
2020 shareholder calendara
27 Mar 2020
Fourth quarter interim dividend payment for 2019
28 April 2020
First quarter results announced
11 May 2020
Record date (to be eligible for the first quarter interim dividend)
27 May 2020
Annual general meeting
19 Jun 2020
First quarter interim dividend payment for 2020
3 Jul 2020
8% and 9% preference shares record date
28 Jul 2020
Second quarter results announced
31 Jul 2020
8% and 9% preference shares dividend payment
7 Aug 2020
Record date (to be eligible for the second quarter interim dividend)
18 Sep 2020
Second quarter interim dividend payment for 2020
27 Oct 2020
Third quarter results announced
6 Nov 2020
Record date (to be eligible for the third quarter interim dividend)
18 Dec 2020
Third quarter interim dividend payment for 2020
a 
All future dates are provisional and may be subject to change. For the full calendar see bp.com/financialcalendar.

336
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Glossary
Abbreviations
ADR
American depositary receipt.
ADS
American depositary share. 1 ADS = 6 ordinary shares.
Barrel (bbl)
159 litres, 42 US gallons.
bcf/d
Billion cubic feet per day.
bcfe
Billion cubic feet equivalent.
b/d
Barrels per day.
boe/d
Barrels of oil equivalent per day.
FPSO
Floating production, storage and offloading.
GAAP
Generally accepted accounting practice.
Gas
Natural gas.
gCO2e/MJ
Grams of carbon dioxide equivalent per megajoule of energy.
GHG
Greenhouse gas.
GRI
Global Reporting Initiative.
GtCO2 
Gigatonnes of carbon dioxide.
GWh
Gigawatt hour.
HSSE
Health, safety, security and environment.
IFRS
International Financial Reporting Standards.
KPIs
Key performance indicators.
LNG
Liquefied natural gas.
LPG
Liquefied petroleum gas.
mb/d
Thousand barrels per day.
mboe/d
Thousand barrels of oil equivalent per day.
mmb/d or Mb/d
Million barrels per day.
mmboe/d
Million barrels of oil equivalent per day.
mmBtu
Million British thermal units.
mmcf/d
Million cubic feet per day.
mmte or Mte
Million tonnes.
 
MteCO2 
Million tonnes of CO2 equivalent.
MW
Megawatt.
NGLs
Natural gas liquids.
PSA
Production-sharing agreement.
PTA
Purified terephthalic acid.
RC
Replacement cost.
SEC
The United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
Definitions
Unless the context indicates otherwise, the definitions for the following glossary terms are given below.
Non-GAAP measures are sometimes referred to as alternative performance measures.
 
 
CA100+ resolution glossary
CA100+ resolution
The CA100+ resolution means the special resolution requisitioned by Climate Action 100+ and passed at BP’s 2019 Annual General Meeting, the text of which is set out below.
Special resolution: Climate Action 100+ shareholder resolution on climate change disclosures.
That in order to promote the long term success of the company, given the recognised risks and opportunities associated with climate change, we as shareholders direct the company to include in its strategic report and/or other corporate reports, as appropriate, for the year ending 2019 onwards, a description of its strategy which the board considers, in good faith, to be consistent with the goals of Articles 2.1(a)(1) and 4.1(2) of the Paris Agreement(3) (the ‘Paris goals’), as well as:
(1)
Capital expenditure: how the company evaluates the consistency of each new material capex investment, including in the exploration, acquisition or development of oil and gas resources and reserves and other energy sources and technologies, with (a) the Paris goals and separately (b) a range of other outcomes relevant to its strategy.
(2)
Metrics and targets: the company’s principal metrics and relevant targets or goals over the short, medium and/or long-term, consistent with the Paris goals, together with disclosure of:
a.
The anticipated levels of investment in (i) oil and gas resources and reserves; and (ii) other energy sources and technologies.
b.
The company’s targets to promote reductions in its operational greenhouse gas emissions, to be reviewed in line with changing protocols and other relevant factors
c.
The estimated carbon intensity of the company’s energy products and progress on carbon intensity over time.
d.
Any linkage between the above targets and executive remuneration.
(3)
Progress reporting: an annual review of progress against (1) and (2) above.
Such disclosure and reporting to include the criteria and summaries of the methodology and core assumptions used, and to omit commercially confidential or competitively sensitive information and be prepared at reasonable cost; and provided that nothing in this resolution shall limit the company’s powers to set and vary its strategy, or associated targets or metrics, or to take any action which

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
337


it believes in good faith, would best promote the long-term success of the company.
The Paris goals
(1)
Article 2.1(a) of the Paris Agreement states the goal of ‘Holding the increase in the global average temperature to well below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and pursuing efforts to limit the temperature increase to 1.5°C above pre-industrial levels, recognizing that this would significantly reduce the risks and impacts of climate change’.
(2)
Article 4.1 of the Paris Agreement: In order to achieve the long-term temperature goal set out in Article 2, parties aim to reach global peaking of greenhouse gas emissions as soon as possible, recognizing that peaking will take longer for developing country parties, and to undertake rapid reductions thereafter in accordance with best available science, so as to achieve a balance between anthropogenic emissions by sources and removals by sinks of greenhouse gases in the second half of this century, on the basis of equity, and in the context of sustainable development and efforts to eradicate poverty.
(3)
U.N. Framework Convention on Climate Change Conference of Parties, Twenty-First Session, Adoption of the Paris Agreement, U.N. Doc. FCCC/CP/2015/L.9/Rev.1 (Dec. 12, 2015).
New material capex investment
For the purposes of the 2019 evaluation discussed on pages 19-22, ‘new material capex investment’ means a decision taken by the resource commitment meeting (RCM) in 2019 to incur inorganic or organic investments greater than $250 million that relate to a new project or asset, extending an existing project or asset, or acquiring or increasing a share in a project, asset or entity.
There were eight investments that met the above criteria in 2019.
Material capex evaluation: Paris-consistency quantitative tests.
For the purposes of evaluating material capex investments for consistency with the Paris goals, two quantitative tests were applied, see page 22.
1.
Operational carbon intensity (CI)
The annual average operational GHG emissions (TeCO2e/unit), divided by the relevant unit of output:
per thousand barrels of oil equivalent in Upstream
per utilized equivalent distillation capacity in refining
per thousand tonnes in petrochemicals.
2.
Profitability index (PI)
Operating cash flow divided by investment required (both on a present value basis).
‘Investment required’ means economic resources including capital investment, decommissioning expenditure and the value of any credit support to third parties (e.g. partner carry).
Average emissions intensity of marketed energy products
The weighted average GHG emissions per unit of energy delivered grams CO2e/MJ, estimated in respect of marketing sales of energy products. GHG emissions are estimated on a lifecycle basis covering production, distribution and use of the relevant products, assuming full stoichiometric combustion to CO2.
Net zero aims and ambition glossary
Net zero
References to global net zero in the phrase, 'to help the world get to net zero', means achieving '...a balance between anthropogenic emissions by sources and removals by sinks of greenhouse gases...on the basis of equity, and in the context of sustainable development and efforts to eradicate poverty', as set out in Article 4(1) of the Paris Agreement.
References to net zero for BP in the context of our ambition and Aims 1 and 2 as set out on page 7 (such as 'be a net zero company by 2050 or sooner'), means achieving a balance between (a) the relevant Scope 1 and 2 emissions (for our Aim 1), or Scope 3 emissions (for our Aim 2), and (b) the aggregate of applicable deductions from
 
qualifying activities such as sinks under our methodology at the applicable time.
Emissions from the carbon in our Upstream oil and gas production
Estimated CO2 emissions from the combustion of upstream production of crude oil, natural gas and natural gas liquids (NGLs) on a BP equity-share basis based on BP’s net share of production, excluding BP’s share of Rosneft production and assuming that all produced volumes undergo full stoichiometric combustion to CO2.
Adjusted 2015 baseline
In accordance with our zero net growth methodology, the starting direct and indirect GHG emissions baseline (end of 2015) is adjusted at the end of each reporting year for any qualifying changes (being changes due to (a) acquisitions, divestments, outsourcing or insourcing where the total for the year is greater than 5% the total direct and indirect GHG emissions in the previous year or (b) methodology or protocol changes).

 
 
Adjusted effective tax rate (ETR)
Non-GAAP measure. The adjusted ETR is calculated by dividing taxation on an underlying replacement cost (RC) basis excluding the impact of reductions in the rate of the UK North Sea supplementary charge (in 2016 and 2015) by underlying RC profit or loss before tax. Taxation on an underlying RC basis is taxation on a RC basis for the period adjusted for taxation on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects. Information on underlying RC profit or loss is provided below. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the adjusted ETR because this measure may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, period on period. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is the ETR on profit or loss for the period. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 344.
Associate
An entity over which the group has significant influence and that is neither a subsidiary nor a joint arrangement of the group. Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the investee but is not control or joint control over those policies.
Brent
A trading classification for North Sea crude oil that serves as a major benchmark price for purchases of oil worldwide.
Capital expenditure
Total cash capital expenditure as stated in the group cash flow statement.
Consolidation adjustment – UPII
Unrealized profit in inventory arising on inter-segment transactions.
Commodity trading contracts
BP’s Upstream and Downstream segments both participate in regional and global commodity trading markets in order to manage, transact and hedge the crude oil, refined products and natural gas that the group either produces or consumes in its manufacturing operations. These physical trading activities, together with associated incremental trading opportunities, are discussed in Upstream on page 50 and in Downstream on page 56. The range of contracts the group enters into in its commodity trading operations is described below. Using these contracts, in combination with rights to access storage and transportation capacity, allows the group to access advantageous pricing differences between locations, time periods and arbitrage between markets.

338
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Exchange-traded commodity derivatives
Contracts that are typically in the form of futures and options traded on a recognized exchange, such as Nymex and ICE. Such contracts are traded in standard specifications for the main marker crude oils, such as Brent and West Texas Intermediate; the main product grades, such as gasoline and gasoil; and for natural gas and power. Gains and losses, otherwise referred to as variation margin, are generally settled on a daily basis with the relevant exchange. These contracts are used for the trading and risk management of crude oil, refined products, and natural gas and power. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on exchange-traded commodity derivatives are included in sales and other operating revenues for accounting purposes.
Over-the-counter contracts
Contracts that are typically in the form of forwards, swaps and options. Some of these contracts are traded bilaterally between counterparties or through brokers, others may be cleared by a central clearing counterparty. These contracts can be used both for trading and risk management activities. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on over-the-counter (OTC) contracts are included in sales and other operating revenues for accounting purposes. Many grades of crude oil bought and sold use standard contracts including US domestic light sweet crude oil, commonly referred to as West Texas Intermediate, and a standard North Sea crude blend – Brent, Forties, Oseberg and Ekofisk (BFOE). Forward contracts are used in connection with the purchase of crude oil supplies for refineries, products for marketing and sales of the group’s oil production and refined products. The contracts typically contain standard delivery and settlement terms. These transactions call for physical delivery of oil with consequent operational and price risk. However, various means exist and are used from time to time, to settle obligations under the contracts in cash rather than through physical delivery. Because the physically settled transactions are delivered by cargo, the BFOE contract additionally specifies a standard volume and tolerance.
Gas and power OTC markets are highly developed in North America and the UK, where commodities can be bought and sold for delivery in future periods. These contracts are negotiated between two parties to purchase and sell gas and power at a specified price, with delivery and settlement at a future date. Typically, the contracts specify delivery terms for the underlying commodity. Some of these transactions are not settled physically as they can be achieved by transacting offsetting sale or purchase contracts for the same location and delivery period that are offset during the scheduling of delivery or dispatch. The contracts contain standard terms such as delivery point, pricing mechanism, settlement terms and specification of the commodity. Typically, volume, price and term (e.g. daily, monthly and balance of month) are the main variable contract terms.
Swaps are often contractual obligations to exchange cash flows between two parties. A typical swap transaction usually references a floating price and a fixed price with the net difference of the cash flows being settled. Options give the holder the right, but not the obligation, to buy or sell crude, oil products, natural gas or power at a specified price on or before a specific future date. Amounts under these derivative financial instruments are settled at expiry. Typically, netting agreements are used to limit credit exposure and support liquidity.
Spot and term contracts
Spot contracts are contracts to purchase or sell a commodity at the market price prevailing on or around the delivery date when title to the inventory is taken. Term contracts are contracts to purchase or sell a commodity at regular intervals over an agreed term. Though spot and term contracts may have a standard form, there is no offsetting mechanism in place. These transactions result in physical delivery with operational and price risk. Spot and term contracts typically relate to purchases of crude for a refinery, products for marketing, or third-party natural gas, or sales of the group’s oil production, oil products or gas production to third parties. For accounting purposes, spot and term sales are included in sales and other operating revenues when title passes. Similarly, spot and term purchases are included in purchases for accounting purposes.
Divestment proceeds
Disposal proceeds as per the group cash flow statement.
 
Dividend yield
Sum of the four quarterly dividends announced in respect of the year as a percentage of the year-end share price on the respective exchange.
Effective tax rate (ETR) on replacement cost (RC) profit or loss
Non-GAAP measure. The ETR on RC profit or loss is calculated by dividing taxation on a RC basis by RC profit or loss before tax. Information on RC profit or loss is provided below. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the ETR on RC profit or loss because this measure excludes the impact of price changes on the replacement of inventories and allows for more meaningful comparisons between reporting periods. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is the ETR on profit or loss for the period. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 344.
Fair value accounting effects
Non-GAAP adjustments to IFRS profit or loss. We use derivative instruments to manage the economic exposure relating to inventories above normal operating requirements of crude oil, natural gas and petroleum products. Under IFRS, these inventories are recorded at historical cost. The related derivative instruments, however, are required to be recorded at fair value with gains and losses recognized in the income statement. This is because hedge accounting is either not permitted or not followed, principally due to the impracticality of effectiveness-testing requirements. Therefore, measurement differences in relation to recognition of gains and losses occur. Gains and losses on these inventories are not recognized until the commodity is sold in a subsequent accounting period. Gains and losses on the related derivative commodity contracts are recognized in the income statement, from the time the derivative commodity contract is entered into, on a fair value basis using forward prices consistent with the contract maturity.
BP enters into physical commodity contracts to meet certain business requirements, such as the purchase of crude for a refinery or the sale of BP’s gas production. Under IFRS these physical contracts are treated as derivatives and are required to be fair valued when they are managed as part of a larger portfolio of similar transactions. Gains and losses arising are recognized in the income statement from the time the derivative commodity contract is entered into.
IFRS require that inventory held for trading is recorded at its fair value using period-end spot prices, whereas any related derivative commodity instruments are required to be recorded at values based on forward prices consistent with the contract maturity. Depending on market conditions, these forward prices can be either higher or lower than spot prices, resulting in measurement differences.
BP enters into contracts for pipelines and other transportation, storage capacity, oil and gas processing and liquefied natural gas (LNG) that, under IFRS, are recorded on an accruals basis. These contracts are risk-managed using a variety of derivative instruments that are fair valued under IFRS. This results in measurement differences in relation to recognition of gains and losses.
The way that BP manages the economic exposures described above, and measures performance internally, differs from the way these activities are measured under IFRS. BP calculates this difference for consolidated entities by comparing the IFRS result with management’s internal measure of performance. Under management’s internal measure of performance the inventory, transportation and capacity contracts in question are valued based on fair value using relevant forward prices prevailing at the end of the period. The fair values of derivative instruments used to risk manage certain oil, gas and other contracts, are deferred to match with the underlying exposure and the commodity contracts for business requirements are accounted for on an accruals basis. We believe that disclosing management’s estimate of this difference provides useful information for investors because it enables investors to see the economic effect of these activities as a whole.
In addition, from 2018 fair value accounting effects include changes in the fair value of the near-term portions of LNG contracts that fall within BP’s risk management framework. LNG contracts are not considered derivatives, because there is insufficient market liquidity, and they are therefore accrual accounted under IFRS. However, oil

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
339


and natural gas derivative financial instruments (used to risk manage the near-term portions of the LNG contracts) are fair valued under IFRS. The fair value accounting effect reduces timing differences between recognition of the derivative financial instruments used to risk manage the LNG contracts and the recognition of the LNG contracts themselves, which therefore gives a better representation of performance in each period. Comparative information has not been restated on the basis that the effect was not material.
Finance debt ratio
Finance debt ratio is defined as the ratio of finance debt to the total of finance debt plus total equity.
Free cash flow
Operating cash flow less net cash used in investing activities and lease liability payments included in financing activities, as presented in the group cash flow statement.
Gearing and net debt
Non-GAAP measures. Net debt is calculated as finance debt, as shown in the balance sheet, plus the fair value of associated derivative financial instruments that are used to hedge foreign currency exchange and interest rate risks relating to finance debt, for which hedge accounting is applied, less cash and cash equivalents. Gearing is defined as the ratio of net debt to the total of net debt plus total equity. BP believes these measures provide useful information to investors. Net debt enables investors to see the economic effect of finance debt, related hedges and cash and cash equivalents in total. Gearing enables investors to see how significant net debt is relative to total equity. The derivatives are reported on the balance sheet within the headings ‘Derivative financial instruments’. See Financial statements – Note 27 for information on finance debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure to net debt on an IFRS basis.
We are unable to present reconciliations of forward-looking information for gearing to finance debt ratio, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately certain adjusting items required to present a meaningful comparable GAAP forward-looking financial measure. These items include fair value asset (liability) of hedges related to finance debt and cash and cash equivalents, that are difficult to predict in advance in order to include in a GAAP estimate.
Henry Hub
A distribution hub on the natural gas pipeline system in Erath, Louisiana, that lends its name to the pricing point for natural gas futures contracts traded on the New York Mercantile Exchange and the over-the-counter swaps traded on Intercontinental Exchange.
Hydrocarbons
Liquids and natural gas. Natural gas is converted to oil equivalent at 5.8 billion cubic feet = 1 million barrels.
Inorganic capital expenditure
A subset of capital expenditure and is a non-GAAP measure. Inorganic capital expenditure comprises consideration in business combinations and certain other significant investments made by the group. It is reported on a cash basis. BP believes that this measure provides useful information as it allows investors to understand how BP’s management invests funds in projects which expand the group’s activities through acquisition. Further information and a reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 299.
 
Inventory holding gains and losses
The difference between the cost of sales calculated using the replacement cost of inventory and the cost of sales calculated on the first-in first-out (FIFO) method after adjusting for any changes in provisions where the net realizable value of the inventory is lower than its cost. Under the FIFO method, which we use for IFRS reporting, the cost of inventory charged to the income statement is based on its historical cost of purchase or manufacture, rather than its replacement cost. In volatile energy markets, this can have a significant distorting effect on reported income. The amounts disclosed represent the difference between the charge to the income statement for inventory on a FIFO basis (after adjusting for any related movements in net realizable value provisions) and the charge that would have arisen based on the replacement cost of inventory. For this purpose, the replacement cost of inventory is calculated using data from each operation’s production and manufacturing system, either on a monthly basis, or separately for each transaction where the system allows this approach. The amounts disclosed are not separately reflected in the financial statements as a gain or loss. No adjustment is made in respect of the cost of inventories held as part of a trading position and certain other temporary inventory positions. See Replacement cost (RC) profit or loss definition below.
Joint arrangement
An arrangement in which two or more parties have joint control.
Joint control
Contractually agreed sharing of control over an arrangement, which exists only when decisions about the relevant activities require the unanimous consent of the parties sharing control.
Joint operation
A joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control of the arrangement have rights to the assets, and obligations for the liabilities, relating to the arrangement.
Joint venture
A joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control of the arrangement have rights to the net assets of the arrangement.
Liquids
Comprises crude oil, condensate and natural gas liquids. For the Upstream segment, it also includes bitumen.
LNG train
An LNG train is a processing facility used to liquefy and purify natural gas in the formation of LNG.
Major projects
Have a BP net investment of at least $250 million, or are considered to be of strategic importance to BP or of a high degree of complexity.
Net debt including leases
Non-GAAP measure. Net debt including leases is calculated as net debt plus lease liabilities, less the net amount of partner receivables and payables relating to leases entered into on behalf of joint operations. BP believes this measure provides useful information to investors as it enables investors to understand the impact of the group’s lease portfolio on net debt. See Financial statements – Note 27 for information on finance debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure to net debt on an IFRS basis.
Net generating capacity
The sum of the rated capacities of the assets/turbines that have entered into commercial operation, including BP’s share of equity-accounted entities. The gross data is the equivalent capacity on a gross-joint venture basis, which includes 100% of the capacity of equity-accounted entities where BP has partial ownership.

340
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Non-operating items
Charges and credits are included in the financial statements that BP discloses separately because it considers such disclosures to be meaningful and relevant to investors. They are items that management considers not to be part of underlying business operations and are disclosed in order to enable investors better to understand and evaluate the group’s reported financial performance. Non-operating items within equity-accounted earnings are reported net of incremental income tax reported by the equity-accounted entity. An analysis of non-operating items by segment and type is shown on page 300.
Operating cash flow
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities as stated in the group cash flow statement. When used in the context of a segment rather than the group, the terms refer to the segment’s share thereof.
Operating cash flow excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments
Non-GAAP measure. It is calculated by excluding post-tax operating cash flows relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill from net cash provided by operating activities as reported in the group cash flow statement. BP believes net cash provided by operating activities excluding amounts related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill is a useful measure as it allows for more meaningful comparisons between reporting periods. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is net cash provided by operating activities.
Organic free cash flow is operating cash flow excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments less organic capital expenditure.
Operating cash margin
Operating cash margin is operating cash flow divided by the applicable number of barrels of oil equivalent produced, at $52/bbl flat oil prices. Expected operating cash margins are calculated over the period 2016-2025.
Operating management system (OMS)
BP’s OMS helps us manage risks in our operating activities by setting out BP’s principles for good operating practice. It brings together BP requirements on health, safety, security, the environment, social responsibility and operational reliability, as well as related issues, such as maintenance, contractor relations and organizational learning, into a common management system.
Organic capital expenditure
A subset of capital expenditure and is a non-GAAP measure. Organic capital expenditure comprises capital expenditure less inorganic capital expenditure. BP believes that this measure provides useful information as it allows investors to understand how BP’s management invests funds in developing and maintaining the group’s assets. An analysis of organic capital expenditure by segment and region, and a reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 299.
We are unable to present reconciliations of forward-looking information for organic capital expenditure to total cash capital expenditure, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately the adjusting item, inorganic capital expenditure, that is difficult to predict in advance in order to derive the nearest GAAP estimate.
Organic sources of cash and organic uses of cash
Non-GAAP measure. Organic sources of cash is the sum of operating cash flow, excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments, and proceeds of loan repayments. Organic uses of cash is the sum of organic capital expenditure, dividends and share buybacks. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis for organic sources of cash is net cash provided by operating activities and the nearest equivalent measures on an IFRS basis for organic uses of cash are total cash capital expenditure, dividends paid to BP shareholders and net issue (repurchase) of shares.
Production-sharing agreement / contract (PSA / PSC)
An arrangement through which an oil and gas company bears the risks and costs of exploration, development and production. In return, if exploration is successful, the oil company receives entitlement to variable physical volumes of hydrocarbons, representing recovery of
 
the costs incurred and a stipulated share of the production remaining after such cost recovery.
Readily marketable inventory (RMI)
RMI is inventory held and price risk-managed by our integrated supply and trading function (IST) which could be sold to generate funds if required. It comprises oil and oil products for which liquid markets are available and excludes inventory which is required to meet operational requirements and other inventory which is not price risk-managed. RMI is reported at fair value. Inventory held by the Downstream fuels business for the purpose of sales and marketing, and all inventories relating to the lubricants and petrochemicals businesses, are not included in RMI. BP believes that disclosing the amounts of RMI and paid-up RMI is useful to investors as it enables them to better understand and evaluate the group’s inventories and liquidity position by enabling them to see the level of discretionary inventory held by IST and to see builds or releases of liquid trading inventory.
Paid-up RMI excludes RMI which has not yet been paid for. For inventory that is held in storage, a first-in first-out (FIFO) approach is used to determine whether inventory has been paid for or not. Unpaid RMI is RMI which has not yet been paid for by BP. RMI at fair value, Paid-up RMI and Unpaid RMI are non-GAAP measures. A reconciliation of total inventory as reported on the group balance sheet to paid-up RMI is provided on page 346.
Realizations
Realizations are the result of dividing revenue generated from hydrocarbon sales, excluding revenue generated from purchases made for resale and royalty volumes, by revenue generating hydrocarbon production volumes. Revenue generating hydrocarbon production reflects the BP share of production as adjusted for any production which does not generate revenue. Adjustments may include losses due to shrinkage, amounts consumed during processing, and contractual or regulatory host committed volumes such as royalties. For the Upstream segment, realizations include transfers between businesses.
Refining availability
Represents Solomon Associates’ operational availability for BP-operated refineries, which is defined as the percentage of the year that a unit is available for processing after subtracting the annualized time lost due to turnaround activity and all planned mechanical, process and regulatory downtime.
Refining marker margin (RMM)
The average of regional indicator margins weighted for BP’s crude refining capacity in each region. Each regional marker margin is based on product yields and a marker crude oil deemed appropriate for the region. The regional indicator margins may not be representative of the margins achieved by BP in any period because of BP’s particular refinery configurations and crude and product slate.
Refining net cash margin per barrel
Refining net cash margin is defined by Solomon Associates as the net margin achieved after subtracting cash operating expenses and adding any refinery revenue from other sources. Net cash margin is expressed in US dollars per barrel of net refinery input.
Refinery utilization
Refinery utilization is calculated as annual throughput (thousands of barrels per day) divided by crude distillation capacity.
Replacement cost (RC) profit or loss
Reflects the replacement cost of inventories sold in the period and is arrived at by excluding inventory holding gains and losses from profit or loss. RC profit or loss is the measure of profit or loss that is required to be disclosed for each operating segment under IFRS. RC profit or loss for the group is a non-GAAP measure. Management believes this measure is useful to illustrate to investors the fact that crude oil and product prices can vary significantly from period to period and that the impact on our reported result under IFRS can be significant. Inventory holding gains and losses vary from period to period due to changes in prices as well as changes in underlying inventory levels. In order for investors to understand the operating performance of the group excluding the impact of price changes on the replacement of inventories, and to make comparisons of operating performance between reporting periods, BP’s management

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
341


believes it is helpful to disclose this measure. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders. See Financial statements – Note 5. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 298.
RC profit or loss per share
Non-GAAP measure. Earnings per share is defined in Financial statements – Note 11. RC profit or loss per share is calculated using the same denominator. The numerator used is RC profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders rather than profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the RC profit or loss per share because this measure excludes the impact of price changes on the replacement of inventories and allows for more meaningful comparisons between reporting periods. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is basic earnings per share based on profit or loss for the period attributable to BP shareholders. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 344.
Reserves replacement ratio
The extent to which the year’s production has been replaced by proved reserves added to our reserve base. The ratio is expressed in oil-equivalent terms and includes changes resulting from discoveries, improved recovery and extensions and revisions to previous estimates, but excludes changes resulting from acquisitions and disposals.
Return on average capital employed
Non-GAAP measure. Return on average capital employed (ROACE) is underlying replacement cost profit, after adding back non-controlling interest and interest expense net of tax (for 2015, 2016 and 2017 interest expense was net of notional tax at an assumed 35%), divided by average capital employed (total equity plus finance debt), excluding cash and cash equivalents and goodwill. Interest expense is finance costs excluding lease interest and the unwinding of the discount on provisions and other payables before tax. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the ROACE because this measure gives an indication of the company's capital efficiency. The nearest GAAP measures of the numerator and denominator are profit or loss for the period attributable to BP shareholders and average capital employed respectively. The reconciliation of the numerator and denominator is provided on page 345.
We are unable to present forward-looking information of the nearest GAAP measures of the numerator and denominator for ROACE, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately certain adjusting items required to calculate a meaningful comparable GAAP forward-looking financial measure. These items include inventory holding gains or losses and interest net of tax, that are difficult to predict in advance in order to include in a GAAP estimate.
Subsidiary
An entity that is controlled by the BP group. Control of an investee exists when an investor is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the investee.
Tier 1 and tier 2 process safety events
Tier 1 events are losses of primary containment from a process of greatest consequence – causing harm to a member of the workforce, damage to equipment from a fire or explosion, a community impact or exceeding defined quantities. Tier 2 events are those of lesser consequence. These represent reported incidents occurring within BP’s operational HSSE reporting boundary. That boundary includes BP’s own operated facilities and certain other locations or situations.
Tight oil and gas
Natural oil and gas reservoirs locked in hard sandstone rocks with low permeability, making the underground formation extremely tight.
UK National Balancing Point
A virtual trading location for sale, purchase and exchange of UK natural gas. It is the pricing and delivery point for the Intercontinental Exchange natural gas futures contract.
Unconventionals
Resources found in geographic accumulations over a large area, that usually present additional challenges to development such as low
 
permeability or high viscosity. Examples include shale gas and oil, coalbed methane, gas hydrates and natural bitumen deposits. These typically require specialized extraction technology such as hydraulic fracturing or steam injection.
Underlying effective tax rate (ETR)
Non-GAAP measure. The underlying ETR is calculated by dividing taxation on an underlying replacement cost (RC) basis by underlying RC profit or loss before tax. Taxation on an underlying RC basis is taxation on a RC basis for the period adjusted for taxation on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects. Information on underlying RC profit or loss is provided below. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the underlying ETR because this measure may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, period on period. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is the ETR on profit or loss for the period. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 344.
We are unable to present reconciliations of forward-looking information for underlying ETR to ETR on profit or loss for the period, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately certain adjusting items required to present a meaningful comparable GAAP forward-looking financial measure. These items include the taxation on inventory holding gains and losses, non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, that are difficult to predict in advance in order to include in a GAAP estimate.
Underlying production
Production after adjusting for acquisitions and divestments and entitlement impacts in our production-sharing agreements (PSAs). 2019 underlying production, when compared with 2018, is production after adjusting for BPX Energy, other acquisitions and divestments, and entitlement impacts in our PSAs.
Underlying RC profit or loss
Non-GAAP measure. RC profit or loss after adjusting for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects. See page 300 and 344 for additional information on the non-operating items and fair value accounting effects that are used to arrive at underlying RC profit or loss in order to enable a full understanding of the events and their financial impact. BP believes that underlying RC profit or loss is a useful measure for investors because it is a measure closely tracked by management to evaluate BP’s operating performance and to make financial, strategic and operating decisions and because it may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, year on year, by adjusting for the effects of these non-operating items and fair value accounting effects.
The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis for the group is profit or loss for the year attributable to BP shareholders. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis for segments is RC profit or loss before interest and taxation. Underlying profit in the chief executive officer’s letter on page 4 refers to full year underlying RC profit for the group. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 298.
Underlying replacement cost (RC) profit or loss per share
Non-GAAP measure. Earnings per share is defined Financial statements – Note 11. Underlying RC profit or loss per share is calculated using the same denominator. The numerator used is underlying RC profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders rather than profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the underlying RC profit or loss per share because this measure may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, period on period. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is basic earnings per share based on profit or loss for the period attributable to BP shareholders. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 344.

342
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Upstream plant reliability
BP-operated Upstream plant reliability is calculated taking 100% less the ratio of total unplanned plant deferrals divided by installed production capacity. Unplanned plant deferrals are associated with the topside plant and where applicable the subsea equipment (excluding wells and reservoir). Unplanned plant deferrals include breakdowns, which does not include Gulf of Mexico weather related downtime.
Upstream unit production cost
Upstream unit production cost is calculated as production cost divided by units of production. Production cost does not include ad valorem and severance taxes. Units of production are barrels for liquids and thousands of cubic feet for gas. Amounts disclosed are for BP subsidiaries only and do not include BP’s share of equity-accounted entities.
Wellwork
Activities undertaken on previously completed wells with the primary objective to restore or increase production.
West Texas Intermediate (WTI)
A light sweet crude oil, priced at Cushing, Oklahoma, which serves as a benchmark price for purchases of oil in the US.
Working capital
Movements in inventories and other current and non-current assets and liabilities as stated in the group cash flow statement.
Trade marks
Trade marks of the BP group appear throughout this report. They include: Aral, ARCO, BP, BP Infinia, BPme, BPme Rewards, Castrol
Trade marks:
Butamax – a registered trade mark of Butamax Advance Biofuels LLC.
Fulcrum BioEnergy – registered trade marks of Fulcrum BioEnergy, Inc.
M&S Simply Food – a registered trade mark of Marks & Spencer plc.
REWE to Go – a registered trade mark of REWE.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
343


Non-GAAP measures reconciliations
Non-GAAP information on fair value accounting effects
The impacts of fair value accounting effects, relative to management’s internal measure of performance, and a reconciliation to GAAP information is set out below. Further information on fair value accounting effects is provided on page 339.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

Upstream
 
 
 
 
Unrecognized (gains) losses brought forward from previous perioda
 
(455
)
(419
)
(393
)
Favourable (adverse) impact relative to management’s measure of performance
 
706

(39
)
27

Exchange translation gains (losses) on fair value accounting effects
 
2

3

2

Unrecognized (gains) losses carried forward
 
253

(455
)
(364
)
Downstreamb
 


 
Unrecognized (gains) losses brought forward from previous perioda
 
(56
)
(151
)
(71
)
Favourable (adverse) impact relative to management’s measure of performance
 
160

95

(135
)
Unrecognized (gains) losses carried forward
 
104

(56
)
(206
)
 
 
 
 
 
Favourable (adverse) impact relative to management’s measure of performance – by region
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
 
 
 
US
 
(179
)
(35
)
192

Non-US
 
885

(4
)
(165
)
 
 
706

(39
)
27

Downstreamb
 


 
US
 
148

(155
)
(29
)
Non-US
 
12

250

(106
)
 
 
160

95

(135
)
 
 
866

56

(108
)
Taxation credit (charge)
 
(155
)
12

12

 
 
711

68

(96
)
a 
2018 brought forward fair value accounting effect balances include a $55-million adjustment between Upstream and Downstream as part of the transfer of the NGL business between segments.
b 
Fair value accounting effects arise solely in the fuels business.

Reconciliation of basic earnings per ordinary share to RC profit (loss) per share and to underlying RC profit per share
 
 
Per ordinary share – cents
 
 
 
2019

2018

2017

2016

2015

Profit (loss) for the yeara
 
19.84

46.98

17.20

0.61

(35.39
)
Inventory holding (gains) losses, before tax
 
(3.29
)
4.01

(4.32
)
(8.52
)
10.31

Taxation charge (credit) on inventory holding gains and losses
 
0.77

(0.99
)
1.14

2.58

(3.10
)
RC profit (loss) for the year
 
17.32

50.00

14.02

(5.33
)
(28.18
)
Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, before tax
 
40.73

16.93

18.94

35.99

82.23

Taxation charge (credit) on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
(8.81
)
(3.23
)
(1.65
)
(16.87
)
(21.83
)
Underlying RC profit for the year
 
49.24

63.70

31.31

13.79

32.22

a 
Profit attributable to BP shareholders.


344
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Reconciliation of effective tax rate (ETR) to ETR on RC profit or loss and adjusted ETR
Taxation (charge) credit
 
 
$ million
 
 
 
2019

2018

2017

2016

2015

Taxation on profit or loss for the year
 
(3,964
)
(7,145
)
(3,712
)
2,467

3,171

Adjusted for taxation on inventory holding gains and losses
 
(156
)
198

(225
)
(483
)
569

Taxation on a RC profit or loss basis
 
(3,808
)
(7,343
)
(3,487
)
2,950

2,602

Adjusted for taxation on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
1,788

522

1,184

3,162

4,000

Adjusted for the impact of US tax reform
 

121

(859
)


Adjusted for the impact of the reduction in the rate of the UK North Sea supplementary charge
 



434

915

Adjusted taxation
 
(5,596
)
(7,986
)
(3,812
)
(646
)
(2,313
)
Effective tax rate
 
 
%
 
 
 
2019

2018

2017

2016

2015

ETR on profit or loss for the year
 
49

43

52

107

33

Adjusted for inventory holding gains and losses
 
2

(1
)
3

(31
)
1

ETR on RC profit or loss
 
51

42

55

76

34

Adjusted for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
(15
)
(5
)
(9
)
(69
)
(15
)
Adjusted for the impact of US tax reform
 

1

(8
)


Adjusted for the impact of the reduction in the rate of the UK North Sea supplementary charge
 



16

12

Adjusted ETR
 
36

38

38

23

31


Return on average capital employed (ROACE)
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

2017

2016

2015

Profit (loss) for the year attributable to BP shareholders
 
4,026

9,383

3,389

115

(6,482
)
Inventory holding (gains) losses, net of tax
 
(511
)
603

(628
)
(1,114
)
1,320

Non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, net of tax
 
6,475

2,737

3,405

3,584

11,067

Underlying RC profit
 
9,990

12,723

6,166

2,585

5,905

Interest expense, net of taxa
 
1,744

1,583

924

635

576

Non-controlling interests
 
164

195

79

57

82

Adjusted underlying RC profit
 
11,898

14,501

7,169

3,277

6,563

Total equity
 
100,708

101,548

100,404

96,843

98,387

Finance debt
 
67,724

65,132

62,574

57,665

52,465

Capital employed (2019 average $167,556 million)
 
168,432

166,680

162,978

154,508

150,852

Less: Goodwill
 
11,868

12,204

11,551

11,194

11,627

Cash and cash equivalents
 
22,472

22,468

25,586

23,484

26,389

 
 
134,092

132,008

125,841

119,830

112,836

Average capital employed excluding goodwill and cash and cash equivalents
 
133,050

128,925

123,481

117,002

118,702

ROACE
 
8.9
%
11.2
%
5.8
%
2.8
%
5.5
%
a 
Calculated on a post-tax basis (for 2017 and earlier interest expense was net of notional tax at an assumed 35%).

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
345


Readily marketable inventory (RMI)
Readily marketable inventory (RMI) is oil and oil products inventory held and price risk-managed by BP`s integrated supply and trading function (IST) which could be sold to generate funds if required. Details of RMI balances and a reconciliation to GAAP information is set out below. Further information on RMI, RMI at fair value, paid-up RMI and unpaid RMI is provided on page 341.
At 31 December
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

RMI at fair value
 
6,837

4,202

Paid-up RMI
 
3,217

1,641

Reconciliation of non-GAAP information
At 31 December
 
 
$ million

 
 
2019

2018

Reconciliation of total inventory to paid-up RMI
 
 
 
Inventories as reported on the group balance sheet
 
20,880

17,988

Less: (a) inventories which are not oil and oil products and (b) oil and oil product inventories which are not risk-managed by IST
 
(14,280
)
(14,066
)
RMI on IFRS basis
 
6,600

3,922

Plus: difference between RMI at fair value and RMI on an IFRS basis
 
237

280

RMI at fair value
 
6,837

4,202

Less: unpaid RMI at fair value
 
(3,620
)
(2,561
)
Paid-up RMI
 
3,217

1,641


































The Directors’ report on pages 72-99, 101 (in respect of the remuneration committee report shown in green only), 130, 232-259 and 297-346 was approved by the board and signed on its behalf by Ben J. S. Mathews, company secretary on 18 March 2020.
BP p.l.c.
Registered in England and Wales No. 102498

346
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Signatures
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.

BP p.l.c.
(Registrant)

/s/ Ben J. S. Mathews
Company secretary
18 March 2020


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 
347


Cross reference to Form 20-F
 
 
 
 
 
 
Page
Item 1.
 
 
 
Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors
 
n/a
Item 2.
 
 
 
Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable
 
n/a
Item 3.
 
 
 
Key Information
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Selected financial data
 
298, 328
 
 
B.
 
Capitalization and indebtedness
 
n/a
 
 
C.
 
Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds
 
n/a
 
 
D.
 
Risk factors
 
70-71
Item 4.
 
 
 
Information on the Company
 
 
 
 
A.
 
History and development of the company
 
23, 36-38, 50-65, 174-176, 181, 187, 189-191, 303-306, 331
 
 
B.
 
Business overview
 
8-9, 13, 36-38, 50-65, 177-180, 303-306, 314-319, 325
 
 
C.
 
Organizational structure
 
222
 
 
D.
 
Property, plants and equipment
 
33, 55, 58, 186, 257-259, 301-313, 323
Item 4A.
 
 
 
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
None
Item 5.
 
 
 
Operating and Financial Review and Prospects
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Operating results
 
36-38, 50-65, 70, 180, 189-191, 200, 202-214, 314-320
 
 
B.
 
Liquidity and capital resources
 
156, 187, 200-207, 301-302
 
 
C.
 
Research and development, patent and licenses
 
180, 323
 
 
D.
 
Trend information
 
36-38, 50-65
 
 
E.
 
Off-balance sheet arrangements
 
177-179, 189-191, 301
 
 
F.
 
Tabular disclosure of contractual commitments
 
301
 
 
G.
 
Safe harbor
 
324-325
Item 6.
 
 
 
Directors, Senior Management and Employees
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Directors and senior management
 
74-81
 
 
B.
 
Compensation
 
32-35, 101-127, 194-199, 220-221
 
 
C.
 
Board practices
 
74-77, 88-95, 100, 114
 
 
D.
 
Employees
 
47, 221
 
 
E.
 
Share ownership
 
47, 113, 194-199, 220-220
Item 7.
 
 
 
Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Major shareholders
 
330-331
 
 
B.
 
Related party transactions
 
189, 321
 
 
C.
 
Interests of experts and counsel
 
n/a
Item 8.
 
 
 
Financial Information
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Consolidated statements and other financial information
 
146-149, 152, 154-156, 157-259, 319-320, 328
 
 
B.
 
Significant changes
 
n/a
Item 9.
 
 
 
The Offer and Listing
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Offer and listing details
 
328
 
 
B.
 
Plan of distribution
 
n/a
 
 
C.
 
Markets
 
328
 
 
D.
 
Selling shareholders
 
n/a
 
 
E.
 
Dilution
 
n/a
 
 
F.
 
Expenses of the issue
 
n/a
Item 10.
 
 
 
Additional Information
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Share capital
 
n/a
 
 
B.
 
Memorandum and articles of association
 
331-333
 
 
C.
 
Material contracts
 
321
 
 
D.
 
Exchange controls
 
328
 
 
E.
 
Taxation
 
328-330
 
 
F.
 
Dividends and paying agents
 
n/a
 
 
G.
 
Statements by experts
 
n/a
 
 
H.
 
Documents on display
 
335
 
 
I.
 
Subsidiary information
 
n/a
Item 11.
 
 
 
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
 
202-207
Item 12.
 
 
 
Description of securities other than equity securities
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Debt Securities
 
n/a
 
 
B.
 
Warrants and Rights
 
n/a
 
 
C.
 
Other Securities
 
n/a
 
 
D.
 
American Depositary Shares
 
335
Item 13.
 
 
 
Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies
 
None
Item 14.
 
 
 
Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds
 
None
Item 15.
 
 
 
Controls and Procedures
 
150, 322
Item 16A.
 
 
 
Audit Committee Financial Expert
 
77, 86, 91
Item 16B.
 
 
 
Code of Ethics
 
322
Item 16C.
 
 
 
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
93, 221, 322
Item 16D.
 
 
 
Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees
 
n/a
Item 16E.
 
 
 
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers
 
334
Item 16F.
 
 
 
Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant
 
n/a
Item 16G.
 
 
 
Corporate governance
 
321
Item 17.
 
 
 
Financial Statements
 
n/a
Item 18.
 
 
 
Financial Statements
 
152-156
Item 19.
 
 
 
Exhibits
 
349

348
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
 


Information about this report
This document constitutes the Annual Report and Accounts in accordance with UK requirements and the Annual Report on Form 20-F in accordance with the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, for BP p.l.c. for the year ended 31 December 2019. A cross reference to Form 20-F requirements is included on page 348.

This document contains the Strategic report on the inside front cover and pages 1-71 and the Directors’ report on pages 72-99, 101 (in part only), 130, 232-259 and 297-346. The Strategic report and the Directors’ report together include the management report required by DTR 4.1 of the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules. The Directors’ remuneration report is on pages 100-127. The consolidated financial statements of the group are on pages 131-231 and the corresponding reports of the auditor are on pages 146-151.


BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 may be downloaded from bp.com/annualreport. No material on the BP website, other than the items identified as BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019, forms any part of this document. References in this document to other documents on the BP website, such as BP Energy Outlook, BP Sustainability Report, BP Statistical Review of World Energy and BP Technology Outlook are included as an aid to their location and are not incorporated by reference into this document.

BP p.l.c. is the parent company of the BP group of companies. The company was incorporated in 1909 in England and Wales and changed its name to BP p.l.c. in 2001. Where we refer to the company, we mean BP p.l.c. The company and each of its subsidiaries« are separate legal entities. Unless otherwise stated or the context otherwise requires, the term “BP” and terms such as “we”, “us” and “our” are used in this report for convenience to refer to one or more of the members of the BP group instead of identifying a particular entity or entities. Information in this document reflects 100% of the assets and operations of the company and its subsidiaries that were consolidated at the date or for the periods indicated, including non-controlling interests.

The company’s primary share listing is the London Stock Exchange. In the US, the company’s securities are traded on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the form of ADSs (see page 328 for more details) and in Germany in the form of a global depositary certificate representing BP ordinary shares traded on the Frankfurt, Hamburg and Dusseldorf Stock Exchanges.

The term ‘shareholder’ in this report means, unless the context otherwise requires, investors in the equity capital of BP p.l.c., both direct and indirect. As the company's shares, in the form of ADSs, are listed on the NYSE, an Annual Report on Form 20-F is filed with the SEC. Ordinary shares are ordinary fully paid shares in BP p.l.c. of 25 cents each. Preference shares are cumulative first preference shares and cumulative second preference shares in BP p.l.c. of £1 each.
Registered office and
our worldwide headquarters:
BP p.l.c.
1 St James’s Square
London SW1Y 4PD
UK
Tel +44 (0)20 7496 4000
Our agent in the US:

BP America Inc.
501 Westlake Park Boulevard
Houston, Texas 77079
US
Tel +1 281 366 2000
Registered in England and Wales No. 102498.
London Stock Exchange symbol ‘BP.’

 
Exhibits
The following documents are filed in the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) EDGAR system, as part of this Annual Report on Form 20-F, and can be viewed on the SEC’s website.
 
Memorandum and Articles of Association of BP p.l.c.*******†
 
Description of rights of each class of securities registered under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934†
 
The BP Executive Directors’ Incentive Plan******†
 
Director’s Service Agreement for B Looney†
 
Director’s Service Contract for Dr B Gilvary***†
 
The BP Share Award Plan 2015*******†
 
Subsidiaries (included as Note 37 to the Financial Statements)
 
Code of Ethics*†
 
Rule 13a – 14(a) Certifications†
 
Rule 13a – 14(b) Certifications#†
 
Consent of DeGolyer and MacNaughton†
 
Report of DeGolyer and MacNaughton†
 
Consent of Netherland, Sewell & Associates†
 
Report of Netherland, Sewell & Associates†
 
Consent Decree*******†
 
Gulf states Settlement Agreement*******†
 
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
 
Consent of Deloitte LLP
Exhibit 101
 
Interactive data files
*
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2009.
**
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2010.
***
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2011.
*****
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2013.
******
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2014.
*******
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2015.
#
 
Furnished only.
 
Included only in the annual report filed in the Securities and Exchange Commission EDGAR system.
 
 
 
The total amount of long-term securities of BP p.l.c. and its subsidiaries under any one instrument does not exceed 10% of their total assets on a consolidated basis.
The company agrees to furnish copies of any or all such instruments to the SEC on request.



Paper: Nautilus Super White is a premium ecological paper. It is made from 100% post-consumer waste recycled paper and is FSC® (Forest Stewardship Council®) certified. The paper also holds the EU Ecolabel certification. The manufacturing mill also holds ISO 14001 environmental certification. Printed in the UK by Pureprint Group.

  RECYCLEDLANDSCAPEBLACKA06.JPG

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019
«See Glossary
 
349

BP’s corporate reporting suite includes information about our financial and operating performance, sustainability performance and also on global energy trends and projections. Annual Report Sustainability Financial and Operating and Form 20-F 2019 Report 2019 Information 2015-2019 Details of our financial Details of our sustainability How technology could and operating performance performance with additional influence the way we meet in print and online. information online. the energy challenge into the future. bp.com/annualreport bp.com/sustainability bp.com/financialandoperating BP Energy Outlook Statistical Review Provides our projections of World Energy 2020 of future energy trends An objective review of and factors that could key global energy trends. affect them out to 2040. bp.com/statisticalreview bp.com/energyoutlook Copies US and Canada Feedback You can order BP’s Issuer Direct Your feedback is important printed publications Toll-free: +1 888 301 2505 to us. You can email the free of charge from bpreports@issuerdirect.com corporate reporting team at bp.com/annualreport. corporatereporting@bp.com UK and rest of world BP Distribution Services You can also telephone Tel: +44 (0)870 241 3269 +44 (0)20 7496 4000 bpdistributionservices@bp.com or write to Corporate reporting BP p.l.c. 1 St James’s Square London SW1Y 4PD, UK © BP p.l.c. 2020


 

Exhibit 2 DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES REGISTERED UNDER SECTION 12 OF THE EXCHANGE ACT As of 31 December 2019 BP p.l.c. (“BP,” the “Company,” “we,” “us,” and “our”) had the following series of securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934: Name of each exchange on which Title of each class registered American Depositary Shares New York Stock Exchange Ordinary Shares of 25c each New York Stock Exchange(*) Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2020 New York Stock Exchange Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2021 New York Stock Exchange Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2022 New York Stock Exchange 2.315% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 New York Stock Exchange 2.521% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 New York Stock Exchange 4.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 New York Stock Exchange 4.742% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 New York Stock Exchange 3.561% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 New York Stock Exchange 2.112% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 New York Stock Exchange 2.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 New York Stock Exchange 2.520% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 New York Stock Exchange 3.245% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 New York Stock Exchange 3.062% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 New York Stock Exchange 2.750% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 New York Stock Exchange 3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 New York Stock Exchange 3.994% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 New York Stock Exchange 3.535% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 New York Stock Exchange 3.814% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 New York Stock Exchange 3.224% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 New York Stock Exchange 3.790% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 New York Stock Exchange 3.506% Guaranteed Notes due 2025 New York Stock Exchange 3.796% Guaranteed Notes due 2025 New York Stock Exchange 3.119% Guaranteed Notes due 2026 New York Stock Exchange 3.410% Guaranteed Notes due 2026 New York Stock Exchange 3.017% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 New York Stock Exchange 3.279% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 New York Stock Exchange 3.588% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 New York Stock Exchange 3.723% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 New York Stock Exchange 3.937% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 New York Stock Exchange 4.234% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 New York Stock Exchange 3.067% Guaranteed Notes due 2050 New York Stock Exchange (*) Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission.


 
Capitalized terms used but not defined herein have the meanings given to them in BP’s Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019. I. ORDINARY SHARES The following description of our ordinary shares of US$0.25 each is a summary and does not purport to be complete. It is subject to and qualified in its entirety by BP’s Articles of Association and by the Companies Act 2006 (the “Act”) and any other applicable English law concerning companies, as amended from time to time. A copy of BP’s Articles of Association is filed as Exhibit 1 to BP’s Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019. A. General The number of ordinary shares outstanding at 31 December 2019, excluding treasury shares, and including certain shares that will be issuable in the future under employee share-based payment plans was 20,241,170,965. The primary market for the company’s ordinary shares (trading symbol ‘BP.’) is the London Stock Exchange (LSE). The company’s ordinary shares are a constituent element of the Financial Times Stock Exchange 100 Index. In the US, the company’s securities are listed and traded on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the form of ADSs (trading symbol 'BP'), for which JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. is the depositary (the Depositary) and transfer agent. The Depositary’s principal office is 383 Madison Avenue, Floor 11, New York, NY, 10179, US. Each ADS represents six ordinary shares. ADSs are evidenced by American depositary receipts (ADRs), which may be issued in either certificated or book entry form. The company's ordinary shares are also traded in the form of a global depositary certificate representing the company's ordinary shares on the Frankfurt, Hamburg and Dusseldorf Stock Exchanges. All of the existing issued BP ordinary shares are fully paid. BP ordinary shares are represented in certificated registered form and also in uncertificated form under “CREST”. CREST is an electronic settlement system in the U.K. which enables BP ordinary shares to be evidenced and transferred electronically without use of a physical certificate. B. Dividend rights If recommended by the directors of BP, shareholders of BP may, by resolution, declare dividends but no such dividend may be declared in excess of the amount recommended by the directors. The directors may also pay interim dividends without obtaining shareholder approval. No dividend may be paid other than out of profits available for distribution, as determined under IFRS and the Act. Dividends on ordinary shares are payable only after payment of dividends on BP preference shares. Any dividend unclaimed after a period of 10 years from the date of declaration of such dividend shall be forfeited and reverts to BP. If the company exercises its right to forfeit shares and sells shares belonging to an untraced shareholder then any entitlement to claim dividends or other monies unclaimed in respect of those shares will be for a period of twelve months after the sale. The company may take such steps as the directors decide are appropriate in the circumstances to trace the member entitled and the sale may be made at such time and on such terms as the directors may decide. The directors have the power to declare and pay dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced. It is not the company’s intention to change its current policy of paying dividends in US dollars. At the company’s AGM held on 15 April 2010, shareholders approved the introduction of a 2


 
Scrip Dividend Programme (the “Scrip Programme”) and to include provisions in the Articles of Association to enable the company to operate the Scrip Programme. The Scrip Programme was renewed at the company’s AGM held on 21 May 2018 for a further three years. The Scrip Programme enables ordinary shareholders and BP ADS holders to elect to receive new fully paid ordinary shares (or BP ADSs in the case of BP ADS holders) instead of cash. The operation of the Scrip Programme is always subject to the directors’ decision to make the scrip offer available in respect of any particular dividend. Should the directors decide not to offer the scrip in respect of any particular dividend, cash will automatically be paid instead. The directors may determine in relation to any scrip dividend plan or programme how the costs of the programme will be met, the minimum number of ordinary shares required in order to be able to participate in the programme and any arrangements to deal with legal and practical difficulties in any particular territory. Apart from shareholders’ rights to share in BP’s profits by dividend (if any is declared or announced), BP’s Articles of Association provide that the directors may set aside: • A special reserve fund out of the balance of profits each year to make up any deficit of cumulative dividend on the BP preference shares. • A general reserve out of the balance of profits each year, which shall be applicable for any purpose to which the profits of the company may properly be applied. This may include capitalization of such sum, pursuant to an ordinary shareholders’ resolution, and distribution to shareholders as if it were distributed by way of a dividend on the ordinary shares or in paying up in full unissued ordinary shares for allotment and distribution as bonus shares. Any such sums so deposited may be distributed in accordance with the manner of distribution of dividends as described above. Holders of shares are not subject to calls on capital by the company, provided that the amounts required to be paid on issue have been paid off. All shares are fully paid. C. Voting rights BP’s Articles of Association provide that voting on resolutions at a shareholders’ meeting will be decided on a poll other than resolutions of a procedural nature, which may be decided on a show of hands. If voting is on a poll, every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy has one vote for every ordinary share held and two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of BP preference shares held. If voting is on a show of hands, each shareholder who is present at the meeting in person or whose duly appointed proxy is present in person will have one vote, regardless of the number of shares held, unless a poll is requested. Shareholders do not have cumulative voting rights. For the purposes of determining which persons are entitled to attend or vote at a shareholders’ meeting and how many votes such persons may cast, the company may specify in the notice of the meeting a time, not more than 48 hours before the time of the meeting, by which a person who holds shares in registered form must be entered on the company’s register of members in order to have the right to attend or vote at the meeting or to appoint a proxy to do so. Holders on record of ordinary shares may appoint a proxy, including a beneficial owner of those shares, to attend, speak and vote on their behalf at any shareholders’ meeting, provided that a duly completed proxy form is received not less than 48 hours (or such shorter time as the directors may determine) before the time 3


 
of the meeting or adjourned meeting or, where the poll is to be taken after the date of the meeting, not less than 24 hours (or such shorter time as the directors may determine) before the time of the poll. Proxies may be delivered electronically. Corporations who are members of the company may appoint one or more persons to act as their representative or representatives at any shareholders’ meeting provided that the company may require a corporate representative to produce a certified copy of the resolution appointing them before they are permitted to exercise their powers. Matters are transacted at shareholders’ meetings by the proposing and passing of resolutions, of which there are two types: ordinary or special. An ordinary resolution requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes of those persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. A special resolution requires the affirmative vote of not less than three quarters of the persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. Any AGM requires 21 clear days’ notice. The notice period for any other general meeting is 14 clear days subject to the company obtaining annual shareholder approval, failing which, a 21 clear day notice period will apply. D. Liquidation rights; redemption provisions In the event of a liquidation of BP, after payment of all liabilities and applicable deductions under UK laws and subject to the payment of secured creditors, the holders of BP preference shares would be entitled to the sum of (1) the capital paid up on such shares plus, (2) accrued and unpaid dividends and (3) a premium equal to the higher of (a) 10% of the capital paid up on the BP preference shares and (b) the excess of the average market price over par value of such shares on the London Stock Exchange during the previous six months. The remaining assets (if any) would be divided pro rata among the holders of ordinary shares. Without prejudice to any special rights previously conferred on the holders of any class of shares, BP may issue any share with such preferred, deferred or other special rights, or subject to such restrictions as the shareholders by resolution determine (or, in the absence of any such resolutions, by determination of the directors), and may issue shares that are to be or may be redeemed. Subject to authorisation by shareholder resolution, BP may purchase its own shares in accordance with the Act. A. Pre-emption rights and new issues of shares Under Section 549 of the Act, the directors are, with certain exceptions, unable to allot equity securities without the authority of the shareholders in a general meeting. The term “equity securities” as defined in the Act includes BP ordinary shares or securities convertible into BP ordinary shares. In addition, Section 561 of the Act imposes further restrictions on the issue of equity securities (as defined in the Act, which would include BP ordinary shares or securities convertible into BP ordinary shares) which are, or are to be, paid up wholly in cash and not first offered to existing shareholders in proportion to their existing shareholdings. Holders of BP ADSs would, acting through the Depositary, be entitled to participate in any such preemptive offer. BP’s Articles of Association authorize the directors to issue equity securities subject to the provisions of the Act and any resolution passed by shareholders in general meeting (such authority is sought on an annual basis). 4


 
In accordance with institutional investor guidelines, the company deems it appropriate to grant authority to the directors to allot shares and other securities and to disapply pre-emption rights by way of shareholders resolutions at each AGM in place of authority granted by virtue of the company’s Articles of Association. At the AGM on 21 May 2019, authorization was given to the directors to allot shares in the company and to grant rights to subscribe for, or to convert any security into, shares in the company up to an aggregate nominal amount as if section 561(1) of the Act (providing for pre-emption rights for the shareholders of a company in respect of allotments by such company of its equity securities) did not apply. The resolutions dis-applying pre-emption rights comply with institutional shareholder guidance and in particular the Statement of Principles on Disapplying Pre-Emption Rights most recently published by the Pre-Emption Group. These authorities were given for the period until the next AGM in 2020 or 21 August 2020, whichever is the earlier. These authorities are renewed annually at the AGM. B. Variation of rights The rights attached to any class of shares may be varied with the consent in writing of holders of 75% of the shares of that class or on the adoption of a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. At every such separate meeting, all of the provisions of the Articles of Association relating to proceedings at a general meeting apply, except that the quorum with respect to a meeting to change the rights attached to the preference shares is 10% or more of the shares of that class, and the quorum to change the rights attached to the ordinary shares is one third or more of the shares of that class. C. Shareholders’ meetings and notices Shareholders must provide BP with a postal or electronic address in the UK to be entitled to receive notice of shareholders’ meetings. Holders of BP ADSs are entitled to receive notices under the terms of the deposit agreement relating to BP ADSs. The substance and timing of notices are described above under the heading Voting rights. Under the Act, the AGM of shareholders must be held once every year, within each six month period beginning with the day following the company’s accounting reference date. All general meetings shall be held at a time and place determined by the directors. If any shareholders’ meeting is adjourned for lack of quorum, notice of the time and place of the adjourned meeting may be given in any lawful manner, including electronically. Powers exist for action to be taken either before or at the meeting by authorized officers to ensure its orderly conduct and safety of those attending. The directors have power to convene a general meeting which is a hybrid meeting, that is to provide facilities for shareholders to attend a meeting which is being held at a physical place by electronic means as well (but not to convene a purely electronic meeting). The provisions of the Articles of Association in relation to satellite meetings permit facilities being provided by electronic means to allow those persons at each place to participate in the meeting. D. Limitations on voting and shareholding There are no limitations, either under the laws of the UK or under the company’s Articles of Association, restricting the right of non-resident or foreign owners to hold or vote BP ordinary or preference shares in the company other than limitations that would generally apply to all of the shareholders and limitations applicable to certain countries and persons subject to EU economic sanctions or those sanctions adopted by the UK government which implement resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations. 5


 
E. Transfer of Shares Except as described in this paragraph, the Articles of Association do not restrict the transferability of BP ordinary shares. BP ordinary shares may be transferred by an instrument in any usual form or in any other form acceptable to the directors. The directors may refuse to register a transfer: • if it is of shares which are not fully paid; or • if it is in favor of more than four persons jointly BP may not refuse to register transfers of BP ordinary shares if it would prevent dealings in the shares on the London Stock Exchange from taking place on an open and proper basis. F. Disclosure of interests in shares The Act permits a public company to give notice to any person whom the company believes to be or, at any time during the three years prior to the issue of the notice, to have been interested in its voting shares requiring them to disclose certain information with respect to those interests. Failure to supply the information required may lead to disenfranchisement of the relevant shares and a prohibition on their transfer and receipt of dividends and other payments in respect of those shares and any new shares in the company issued in respect of those shares. In this context the term ‘interest’ is widely defined and will generally include an interest of any kind whatsoever in voting shares, including any interest of a holder of BP ADSs. There are no provisions in the BP’s Articles of Association whereby persons acquiring, holding or disposing of a certain percentage of BP’s shares are required to make disclosure of their ownership percentage, although there are such requirements under Part 6 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 and Rule 5 of the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules made by the Financial Conduct Authority (successor to the UK Financial Services Authority). These requirements impose a statutory obligation on a person to notify BP and the Financial Conduct Authority of the percentage of the voting rights in BP such person directly or indirectly holds or controls, or has rights over, through his direct or indirect holding of certain financial instruments, if the percentage of those voting rights: • reaches, exceeds or falls below 3% and/or any subsequent whole percentage figure as a result of an acquisition or disposal of shares or financial instruments; or • reaches, exceeds or falls below any such threshold as a result of any change in the breakdown or number of voting rights attached to shares in BP. The Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules set out in detail the circumstances in which an obligation of disclosure will arise, as well as certain exemptions from those obligations for specified persons. Under section 793 of the Act, BP may, by notice in writing, require a person that BP knows or has reasonable cause to believe is or was during the three years preceding the date of notice interested in BP’s shares to indicate whether or not that is the case and, if that person does or did hold an interest in BP’s shares, to provide certain information as set out in that Act. Article 19 of the EU Market Abuse Regulation (2014/596) further requires persons discharging managerial responsibilities within BP (and their persons closely associated) to notify BP of transactions conducted on their own account in BP shares or derivatives or certain financial instruments relating to BP shares. 6


 
The City Code on Takeovers and Mergers also imposes strict disclosure requirements with regard to dealings in the securities of an offeror or offeree company on all parties to a takeover and also on their respective associates during the course of an offer period. G. Company records and service of notice In relation to notices not covered by the Act, the reference to notice by advertisement in a national newspaper also includes advertisements via other means such as a public announcement. 7


 
II. AMERICAN DEPOSITARY SHARES A. General The ordinary shares of BP may be issued in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADSs). Each ADS represents six ordinary shares. ADSs are listed on the NYSE. ADSs are evidenced by American depositary receipts (ADRs), which may be issued in either certificated or book entry form. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. is the depositary (the “Depositary”) and transfer agent. Each ADS represents an ownership interest in six ordinary shares deposited with the custodian, as agent of the depositary, under the Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement, dated 6 December 2013, as amended (the Deposit Agreement). The Depositary’s principal office is presently located at 383 Madison Avenue, Floor 11, New York, NY, 10179, US. You may hold ADSs either directly or indirectly through your broker or other financial institution. If you hold ADSs directly, by having an ADS registered in your name on the books of the depositary, you are an ADR holder. If you hold the ADSs through your broker or financial institution nominee, you must rely on the procedures of such broker or financial institution to assert the rights of an ADR holder described in this section. You should consult with your broker or financial institution to find out what those procedures are. The following is a summary of the material terms of the Deposit Agreement. Because it is a summary, it does not contain all the information that may be important to you. For more complete information, you should read the entire form of Deposit Agreement and the form of ADR, which contain the terms of the ADSs. Please refer to Exhibit 99.(A) filed on a post-effective amendment to Form F-6 (File No. 333- 144817) with the SEC on 12 June 2013 and Exhibit 99.(a)(2) filed on a post-effective amendment to Form F-6 (File No. 333-144817) with the SEC on 9 February 2017. Copies of the Deposit Agreement are also available for inspection at the offices of the Depositary. B. Voting Procedure Record holders of BP ADSs are also entitled to attend, speak and vote at any shareholders’ meeting of BP by the appointment by the Depositary of them as proxies in respect of the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs. Each such proxy may also appoint a proxy. Alternatively, holders of BP ADSs are entitled to vote by supplying their voting instructions to the Depositary, who will vote the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs in accordance with their instructions. If ADSs are held indirectly through a brokerage account or otherwise in street name, the holder must rely on the procedures established by his or her broker or financial institution to assert the rights of ADS holders described in this section. In the event a situation arises where the aggregate number of votes to be cast by or on behalf of the Depositary at a BP shareholder meeting exceeds the total number of ordinary shares registered in the name of the Depositary or its custodian as of the record date for ordinary shares, the BP Articles of Association provide an adjustment mechanism intended to ensure that the Depositary may only vote those shares which are registered in its name at the record date for ordinary shares. The adjustment may be made on a pro rata basis or may be made with respect to specific votes. In any circumstance where the Depositary is unable to make an adjustment, the chairman may make any adjustment of the votes to be cast by or on behalf of the Depositary on a pro rata basis or in such other manner as may have been prescribed by regulations or procedures established by the directors. 8


 
Except in respect of an adjustment of votes as described in the preceding paragraph, if any question arises as to whether an ADS holder, as proxy for the Depositary, or the proxy of an ADS holder, has been validly appointed to vote (or exercise any other right), according to BP’s Articles of Association the question shall be determined: • by the chairman of the meeting or in accordance with procedures established by the board of directors, if such question arises at or in relation to a general shareholders meeting; or • by the board of directors at their discretion, if such question arises in any other circumstances. The Depositary or BP will notify direct ADS holders of the upcoming meeting and arrange to distribute certain materials to such holders. The materials will: • contain such information as is contained in the meeting’s notice or in the solicitation materials; and • explain how ADS holders may instruct the Depositary to vote the ordinary shares or other deposited securities (if any) underlying ADSs if the ADS holder appoints the Depositary as proxy, or how an ADS holder may appoint a proxy other than the Depositary. ADS holders may also vote directly as an ordinary shareholder by withdrawing from the Depositary at least six of the BP ordinary shares underlying one of their ADSs. C. Share Dividends and Other Distributions The Depositary will pay to ADS holders the cash dividends or other distributions it or the custodian receives on ordinary shares or any other deposited securities, after deducting any applicable fees and expenses. The Depositary may also, pursuant to BP’s Articles of Association, request BP to pay to the ADS holder directly the cash dividends or other distributions, if the ADSs are held directly. ADS holders will receive those distributions in proportion to the number or of ordinary shares represented by their ADSs. ADS holders will generally receive cash dividends payable on ordinary shares or any other deposited securities in U.S. dollars. To the extent that BP pays any cash dividend other than in U.S. dollars, the Depositary will convert such dividend into U.S. dollars and distribute the amount received in U.S. dollars except where the Depositary determines that in its judgment any foreign currency received by it cannot be converted on a reasonable basis into U.S. dollars transferable in the U.S. or if any governmental approval for payment in U.S. dollars is required and cannot be obtained with a reasonable cost or within a reasonable time period. In that circumstance the Deposit Agreement allows the Depositary to distribute, subject to applicable laws and regulations, foreign currency only to those ADS holders who are entitled to receive payment in foreign currency. It will hold the foreign currency it cannot convert for the account of ADS holders who have not been paid. It will not invest the foreign currency and it will not be liable for any interest. Before making a distribution the Depositary deducts any withholding taxes. The Depositary will distribute only whole U.S. dollars and cents. Fractional cents will be withheld without liability and dealt with by the Depositary in accordance with its then current practices. If the exchange rates fluctuate during a time when the Depositary cannot convert the foreign currency, holders may lose some or all of the value of the distribution depending on the extent of such currency fluctuation. 9


 
The Depositary may distribute new ADSs representing any shares BP distributes as a dividend or free distribution, if BP requests it to make this distribution. The Depositary may issue fractional ADSs only in connection with such share distributions. Fractional ADSs may only be issued through the direct registration system maintained by the Depositary. If the Depositary does not distribute additional ADSs, each ADS will also represent the proportion of the new shares allocable to such ADS. If BP offers holders of its securities any rights to subscribe for additional shares or any other rights, BP may make these rights available to holders of ADSs by means of warrants or otherwise, if lawful and feasible. If it is not lawful and not feasible and it is practical to sell the rights, the Depositary may in its discretion sell the rights and distribute the proceeds to ADS holders in the same way as it does with cash. The Depositary may allow rights that are not distributed or sold to lapse. In that case, holders of ADSs will receive no value for them. The Deposit Agreement provides that in respect of any other distributions the Depositary will make distributions to ADS holders by any means the Depositary thinks is equitable and practical, including the sale of what BP distributed and distribute the net proceeds, in the same way as it does with cash, or it may adopt such other methods it deems equitable and practical. The Depositary is not responsible if it decides that it is unlawful or impractical to make a distribution available to any ADS holders. BP has no obligation to register ADSs, shares, rights or other securities under the Securities Act of 1933. It also has no obligation to take any other action to permit the distribution of ADSs, shares, rights or anything else to ADS holders. This means that ADS holders may not receive the distributions BP makes on its shares or any value for them if it is unlawful or impractical for them to be made available to ADS holders. D. Deposit, Withdrawal and Cancellation ADS holders who hold or acquire ordinary shares may deposit them with the Depositary or custodian for the Depositary and hold ADSs instead. Where ordinary shares are deposited with the custodian they will be held by the custodian for the account and to the order of the Depositary. To the extent that an ADS holder is requested to do so by the custodian for the Depositary, an ADS holder must deliver to it the following: • certificates or other instruments of title for the ordinary shares to be deposited, properly endorsed and in a form satisfactory to the custodian; • a written order directing the Depositary to issue to an ADS holder, or upon the written order of an ADS holder, ADRs evidencing the number of ADSs which will represent the number of ordinary shares deposited; • any required payments; • an instrument which provides for the prompt transfer to the custodian of any dividend, right to subscribe for additional ordinary shares or right to receive other property--or, in lieu of such a transfer instrument, an agreement of indemnity; and • any other required documents. The custodian will then as soon as practicable present the ordinary shares for registration of the transfer into the name of the custodian, or its nominee, and notify the Depositary that the registration occurred. The deposit of the ordinary shares will be done at the ADS holder’s cost and expense. 10


 
Once the Depositary receives notice of the deposit, it shall issue to an ADS holder American Depositary receipts evidencing the number of ADSs to which that holder is entitled. ADSs will be issued in book-entry form, unless an ADS holder specifically requests them in certificated form. ADS holders may deposit ordinary shares directly with the Depositary for the purpose of having them forwarded to the custodian, but a charge will apply and delivery will be at the holder’s risk. Where an ADS holder wishes to hold ordinary shares instead of ADSs, the holder must submit a written order to the Depositary to withdraw ordinary shares from deposit and surrender the ADSs at the Depositary’s office. Upon payment of its fees and expenses and of any taxes or charges, the Depositary will deliver the underlying shares at the office of the custodian. At the holder’s request, risk and expense, the Depositary may also deliver the deposited securities at office or any other place specified by the holder. Fractional shares are not deliverable on the cancellation of ADSs and, to the extent the cancellation of ADSs would give rise to the delivery of a fractional share, the Depositary will promptly advise the holder and will either deliver a new ADR in book entry form evidencing such fractional ADS or arrange to sell the fractional share and deliver the net proceeds from such sale net of the costs and expenses of such sale to the holder entitled thereto. E. Amendment and Termination BP may agree with the Depositary to amend the Deposit Agreement and the ADRs without the consent of ADR holders, and for any reason. If the amendment adds or increases fees or charges, except for taxes and governmental charges, or prejudices an important right of ADR holders, it will only become effective 30 days after the Depositary notifies ADR holders of the amendment. At the time an amendment becomes effective, ADR holders are considered to agree to the amendment and to be bound by the Deposit Agreement as amended. However, no amendment will impair the right of an ADS holder to receive the deposited securities in exchange for ADRs, except in order to comply with mandatory provisions of applicable law. The Depositary will terminate the Deposit Agreement if BP asks it to do so, in which case it must notify ADR holders at least 30 days before termination. The Depositary may also terminate the Deposit Agreement after notifying ADR holders. If the Depositary informs BP that it would like to resign and BP does not appoint a new depositary within 60 days, the Depositary is subject to certain obligations with respect to distributions and deposited securities which are set forth in the Deposit Agreement. F. Reports and Other Communications The Depositary will make available for inspection by holders at its office and at any other designated transfer offices any reports and other communications received from BP which are made generally available to the holders of ordinary shares by BP and will arrange for the transmittal or, when requested by BP, otherwise make available to holders copies of such reports and communications, as provided in the Deposit Agreement. The Depositary will also make available at its offices a register for the transfer of ADRs, which at all reasonable times will be open for the inspection of holders. G. Reclassifications, Recapitalizations and Mergers If BP: 11


 
• changes the par value of, splits, cancels, consolidates or otherwise reclassifies any of the BP ordinary shares; or • recapitalizes, reorganizes, merges, consolidates, sells its assets, or takes any similar action, then: (1) The cash, ordinary shares or other securities received by the Depositary automatically will become new deposited securities under the Deposit Agreement, and each ADR will represent its equal share of the new deposited securities unless additional ADRs are delivered as in the case of a stock dividend; and (2) The Depositary will, if BP asks it to, issue new ADSs or ask the ADR holder to surrender outstanding ADRs in exchange for new ADRs identifying the new deposited securities. H. Limitations on Obligations and Liability to ADR Holders The Deposit Agreement expressly limits the obligations of BP and the Depositary. It also limits their liability. Pursuant to the Deposit Agreement, BP and the Depositary: • are obliged only to take the actions specifically set forth in the Deposit Agreement without negligence or bad faith; • are not liable if either of them is prevented or delayed by law, any provision of the BP Articles of Association or circumstances beyond their control from performing their obligations under the Deposit Agreement; • are not liable if either of them exercises, or fails to exercise, any discretion permitted under the agreement; • have no obligation to become involved in a lawsuit or proceeding related to the ADRs or the Deposit Agreement on an ADR holder’s behalf or on behalf of any other party unless they are indemnified to their satisfaction; • may rely upon any advice of or information from any legal counsel, accountants, any person depositing ordinary shares, any ADR holder or any other person whom they believe in good faith is competent to give them that advice or information; • may rely and shall be protected in acting upon any written notice or other document believed by them to be genuine; and • shall not be responsible for any failure to carry out any instructions to vote any of the ordinary shares. In the Deposit Agreement, BP and the Depositary agree to indemnify each other under specified circumstances. 12


 
III. DEBT SECURITIES Each series of notes listed on the New York Stock Exchange and set forth on the cover page to BP’s Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019 has been issued by BP Capital Markets plc. (“BP Capital UK”) or BP Capital Markets America Inc. (“BP Capital America” and, together with BP Capital UK, the “BP Debt Issuers”) and guaranteed by BP. Each of these series of notes and related guarantees was issued pursuant to an effective registration statement and a related prospectus and prospectus supplement (if applicable) setting forth the terms of the relevant series of notes and related guarantees (collectively, the “Notes”). The following description of our Notes is a summary and does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by the full terms of the Notes. The following table sets forth the aggregate principal amount outstanding, issuer, file numbers of the registration statements and dates of issuance for each relevant series of Notes. Certain of the Notes issued by BP Capital UK (the “Old Exchange Notes”) were exchanged for new Notes issued by BP Capital America on 14 December 2018 (the “New Exchange Notes”) pursuant to an registration statement filed on Form F-4 (Registration Nos. 333-228369 and 333-228369-01). The New Exchange Notes have substantially identical terms to the Old Exchange Notes for which they were exchanged. Aggregate Registration Principal Amount Statement File Series Outstanding Date(s) of Issuance Issuer(s) No. Floating Rate Guaranteed $1,000,000,000 24 May 2019 BP Capital U.K. 333-226485 and Notes due 2020 333-226485-01 Floating Rate Guaranteed $250,000,000 16 September 2016 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and Notes due 2021 333-208478-01 Floating Rate Guaranteed — — — — Notes due 2022 Old Exchange Notes $117,849,000 19 September 2017 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $182,151,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 2.315% Guaranteed Notes due $1,750,000,000 13 February 2015 and BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 2020 14 February 2017 1 and 333-208478-01 2.521% Guaranteed Notes due $1,250,000,000 4 November 2014 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 2020 and 333-179953-01 4.500% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2020 Old Exchange Notes $317,996,000 1 October 2010 BP Capital U.K. 333-157906 and 333-157906-01 New Exchange Notes $1,182,004,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 4.742% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2021 Old Exchange Notes $272,684,000 11 March 2011 BP Capital U.K. 333-157906 and 333-157906-01 1 13 February 2015 (with respect to 1,250,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) and 14 February 2017 (with respect to 500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) 13


 
Aggregate Registration Principal Amount Statement File Series Outstanding Date(s) of Issuance Issuer(s) No. New Exchange Notes $1,127,316,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.561% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 1 November 2011 BP Capital U.K. 333-157906 and 2021 333-157906-01 2.112% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2021 Old Exchange Notes $146,557,000 16 September 2016 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $603,443,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 2.500% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 6 November 2012 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 and 2022 333-179953-01 2.520% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2022 Old Exchange Notes $135,041,000 19 September 2017 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $564,959,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.245% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2022 Old Exchange Notes $349,823,000 7 May 2012 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 and 333-179953-01 New Exchange Notes $1,400,177,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.062% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 17 March 2015 BP Capital U.K. 333-201894 2022 and 333-201894-01 2.750% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2023 Old Exchange Notes $398,152,000 10 May 2013 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 and 333-179953-01 New Exchange Notes $1,101,848,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 Old Exchange Notes $206,060,000 28 November 2016 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $993,940,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.994% Guaranteed Notes due $750,000,000 26 September 2013 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 and 2023 333-179953-01 3.535% Guaranteed Notes due $750,000,000 4 November 2014 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 2024 and 333-179953-01 3.814% Guaranteed Notes due $1,250,000,000 10 February 2014 BP Capital U.K. 333-179953 2024 and 333-179953-01 3.224% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2024 Old Exchange Notes $903,287,000 14 February 2017 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 14


 
Aggregate Registration Principal Amount Statement File Series Outstanding Date(s) of Issuance Issuer(s) No. New Exchange Notes $96,713,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.790% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 6 November 2018 BP Capital 333-226485 2024 America and 333-226485-02 3.506% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 17 March 2015 BP Capital U.K. 333-201894 2025 and 333-201894-01 3.796% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 21 September 2018 BP Capital 333-226485 and 2025 America 333-226485-02 3.119% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2026 Old Exchange Notes $251,423,000 4 May 2016 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $998,577,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.410% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 11 February 2019 BP Capital 333-226485 2026 America and 333-226485-02 3.017% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2027 Old Exchange Notes $123,582,000 16 September 2016 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $876,418,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.279% Guaranteed Notes due $1,500,000,000 19 September 2017 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 2027 and 333-208478-01 3.588% Guaranteed Notes due — — — — 2027 Old Exchange Notes $236,291,000 14 February 2017 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 and 333-208478-01 New Exchange Notes $613,709,000 12 December 2018 BP Capital 333-228369 and America 333-228369-01 3.723% Guaranteed Notes due $800,000,000 28 November 2016 BP Capital U.K. 333-208478 2028 and 333-208478-01 3.937% Guaranteed Notes due $1,000,000,000 21 September 2018 BP Capital 333-226485 2028 America and 333-226485-02 4.234% Guaranteed Notes due $2,000,000,000 6 November 20182 and BP Capital 333-226485 2028 11 February 2019 America and 333-226485-02 3.067% Guaranteed Notes due $500,000,000 13 December 2019 BP Capital 333-226485 2050 America and 333-226485-02 A. Descriptions of Notes 2 6 November 2018 (with respect to $1,000,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) and 11 February 2019 (with respect to $1,000,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes). 15


 
Description of Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2020 The following terms are applicable to the Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2020. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2020 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 24 May 2019 • Maturity date: 24 November 2020 • Interest rate: The interest rate for the first interest period will be the 3-month U.S. dollar London Interbank Offered Rate ("U.S. dollar LIBOR"), as determined on May 22, 2019, plus the spread (as described below). Thereafter, the interest rate for any interest period will be U.S. dollar LIBOR, as determined on the applicable interest determination date, plus the spread. The interest rate will be reset quarterly on each interest reset date. • Date interest starts accruing: 24 May 2019 • Interest payment dates: 24 February, 24 May, 24 August and 24 November of each year, subject to the Day Count Convention. • First interest payment date: 24 August 2019 • Spread: 0.250% • Interest reset dates: The interest reset date for each interest period other than the first interest period will be the first day of such interest period, subject to the day count convention. • Interest periods: The period beginning on, and including an interest payment date and ending on, but not including, the following interest payment date provided that the first interest period will begin on 24 May 2019, and will end on, but not include, the first interest payment date. • Interest determination date: The interest determination date relating to a particular interest reset date will be the second London business day preceding such interest reset date. • London business day: Any week day on which banking or trust institutions in London are not authorized generally or obligated by law, regulation or executive order to close, on which dealings in deposits in U.S. dollars are transacted in the London interbank market. • Calculation Agent: The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. • Calculation of U.S. dollar LIBOR: The calculation agent will determine U.S. dollar LIBOR in accordance with the following provisions: With respect to any interest determination date, U.S. dollar LIBOR will be the rate for deposits in U.S. dollars having a maturity of three months commencing on the interest reset date that appears on the designated LIBOR page as of 11:00 a.m., 16


 
London time, on that interest determination date. If no rate appears, U.S. dollar LIBOR, in respect of that interest determination date, will be determined as follows: the calculation agent will request the principal London offices of each of four major reference banks in the London interbank market, as selected and identified by the issuer, to provide the calculation agent with its offered quotation for deposits in U.S. dollars for the period of three months, commencing on the interest reset date, to prime banks in the London interbank market at approximately 11:00 a.m., London time, on that interest determination date and in a principal amount that is representative for a single transaction in U.S. dollars in that market at that time. If at least two quotations are provided, then U.S. dollar LIBOR on that interest determination date will be the arithmetic mean of those quotations. If fewer than two quotations are provided, then U.S. dollar LIBOR on the interest determination date will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted at approximately 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on the interest determination date by three major banks in The City of New York selected and identified by the issuer for loans in U.S. dollars to leading European banks, having a three-month maturity and in a principal amount that is representative for a single transaction in U.S. dollars in that market at that time? provided, however, that if the banks selected and identified by the issuer are not providing quotations in the manner described by this sentence, U.S. dollar LIBOR determined as of that interest determination date will be U.S. dollar LIBOR in effect on that interest determination date (i.e., the same as the rate determined for the immediately preceding interest reset date). The designated LIBOR page is Bloomberg L.P.'s page "BBAM", or any successor service for the purpose of displaying the London interbank rates of major banks for U.S. dollars. Bloomberg L.P.'s page "BBAM" is the display designated as "BBAM" or such other page as may replace Bloomberg L.P.'s page "BBAM" on that service or such other service or services as may be nominated for the purpose of displaying London interbank offered rates for U.S. dollar deposits by ICE Benchmark Administration Limited ("IBA") or its successor or such other entity assuming the responsibility of IBA or its successor in calculating the London Interbank Offered Rate in the event IBA or its successor no longer does so. All calculations made by the calculation agent for the purposes of calculating the interest rates on the notes shall be conclusive and binding on the holders of the notes, BP, the issuer and the trustee, absent manifest error. • Redemption: The notes are not redeemable, except as described below under "Description of Debt Securities and Guarantees-Optional Tax Redemption". The provisions for optional tax redemption described in the prospectus will apply to changes in tax treatments occurring after 21 May 2019. At maturity, the notes will be repaid at par. • Governing law and jurisdiction: The indenture, the notes and the guarantee are governed by New York law. Any legal proceeding arising out of or based upon the indenture, the notes or the guarantee may be instituted in any state or federal court in the Borough of Manhattan in New York City, New York, the issuer's principal executive offices are located at Chertsey Road, Sunbury on Thames, Middlesex TW16 7BP, England. 17


 
Description of Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2021 The following terms are applicable to the Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2021. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2021 • Total principal amount outstanding: $250,000,000 • Issuance date: 16 September 2016 • Maturity date: 16 September 2021 • Interest rate: The interest rate for the first interest period will be the 3-month U.S. dollar London Interbank Offered Rate ("U.S. dollar LIBOR"), as determined on 14 September 2016, plus the spread (as described below). Thereafter, the interest rate for any interest period will be U.S. dollar LIBOR, as determined on the applicable interest determination date, plus the spread. The interest rate will be reset quarterly on each interest reset date. • Date interest starts accruing: 16 September 2016 • Interest payment dates: Each 16 March, 16 June, 16 September and 16 December of each year, subject to the Day Count Convention. • First interest payment date: 16 December 2016 • Spread: 0.870% • Interest reset dates: The interest reset date for each interest period other than the first interest period will be the first day of such interest period, subject to the day count convention. • Interest periods: The period beginning on, and including an interest payment date and ending on, but not including, the following interest payment date? provided that the first interest period will begin on 16 September 2016, and will end on, but not include, the first interest payment date. • Interest determination date: The interest determination date relating to a particular interest reset date will be the second London business day preceding such interest reset date. • London business day: Any week day on which banking or trust institutions in London are not authorized generally or obligated by law, regulation or executive order to close. • Calculation Agent: The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. • Calculation of U.S. dollar LIBOR: The calculation agent will determine U.S. dollar LIBOR in accordance with the following provisions: With respect to any interest determination date, U.S. dollar LIBOR will be the rate for deposits in U.S. dollars having a maturity of three months commencing on the interest reset date that appears on the designated LIBOR page as of 11:00 a.m., London time, on that interest determination date. If no rate appears, U.S. dollar LIBOR, in respect 18


 
of that interest determination date, will be determined as follows: the calculation agent will request the principal London offices of each of four major reference banks in the London interbank market, as selected and identified by the issuer, to provide the calculation agent with its offered quotation for deposits in U.S. dollars for the period of three months, commencing on the interest reset date, to prime banks in the London interbank market at approximately 11:00 a.m., London time, on that interest determination date and in a principal amount that is representative for a single transaction in U.S. dollars in that market at that time. If at least two quotations are provided, then U.S. dollar LIBOR on that interest determination date will be the arithmetic mean of those quotations. If fewer than two quotations are provided, then U.S. dollar LIBOR on the interest determination date will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted at approximately 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on the interest determination date by three major banks in The City of New York selected and identified by the issuer for loans in U.S. dollars to leading European banks, having a three-month maturity and in a principal amount that is representative for a single transaction in U.S. dollars in that market at that time? provided, however, that if the banks selected and identified by the issuer are not providing quotations in the manner described by this sentence, U.S. dollar LIBOR determined as of that interest determination date will be U.S. dollar LIBOR in effect on that interest determination date. The designated LIBOR page is the Reuters screen "LIBOR01", or any successor service for the purpose of displaying the London interbank rates of major banks for U.S. dollars. The Reuters screen "LIBOR01" is the display designated as the Reuters screen "LIBOR01", or such other page as may replace the Reuters screen "LIBOR01" on that service or such other service or services as may be nominated for the purpose of displaying London interbank offered rates for U.S. dollar deposits by ICE Benchmark Administration Limited ("IBA") or its successor or such other entity assuming the responsibility of IBA or its successor in calculating the London Interbank Offered Rate in the event IBA or its successor no longer does so. All calculations made by the calculation agent for the purposes of calculating the interest rates on the 2021 floating rate notes shall be conclusive and binding on the holders of the 2021 floating rate notes, BP, the issuer and the trustee, absent manifest error. Description of Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2022 The following terms are applicable to the Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Issuers: the issuer (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2022 • Total principal amount outstanding: $117,849,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $182,151,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance dates: 19 September 2017 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 19 September 2022 • Interest rate: The interest rate for the first interest period will be the 3-month U.S. dollar London Interbank Offered Rate ("U.S. dollar LIBOR"), as determined on 15 September 2017, plus the spread (as described below). Thereafter, the interest rate for any interest period will be U.S. dollar LIBOR, as determined on the applicable interest determination date, plus the spread. The interest rate will be reset quarterly on each interest reset date. 19


 
• Date interest starts accruing: 19 September 2017 • Interest payment dates: 19 March, 19 June, 19 September and 19 December of each year, subject to the Day Count Convention. • First interest payment date: 19 December 2017 • Spread: 0.650% • Interest reset dates: The interest reset date for each interest period other than the first interest period will be the first day of such interest period, subject to the day count convention. • Interest periods: The period beginning on, and including an interest payment date and ending on, but not including, the following interest payment date? provided that the first interest period will begin on 19 September 2017, and will end on, but not include, the first interest payment date. • Interest determination date: The interest determination date relating to a particular interest reset date will be the second London business day preceding such interest reset date. • London business day: Any week day on which banking or trust institutions in London are not authorized generally or obligated by law, regulation or executive order to close, on which dealings in deposits in U.S. dollars are transacted in the London interbank market. • Calculation Agent: The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. • Calculation of U.S. dollar LIBOR: The calculation agent will determine U.S. dollar LIBOR in accordance with the following provisions: With respect to any interest determination date, U.S. dollar LIBOR will be the rate for deposits in U.S. dollars having a maturity of three months commencing on the interest reset date that appears on the designated LIBOR page as of 11:00 a.m., London time, on that interest determination date. If no rate appears, U.S. dollar LIBOR, in respect of that interest determination date, will be determined as follows: the calculation agent will request the principal London offices of each of four major reference banks in the London interbank market, as selected and identified by the issuer, to provide the calculation agent with its offered quotation for deposits in U.S. dollars for the period of three months, commencing on the interest reset date, to prime banks in the London interbank market at approximately 11:00 a.m., London time, on that interest determination date and in a principal amount that is representative for a single transaction in U.S. dollars in that market at that time. If at least two quotations are provided, then U.S. dollar LIBOR on that interest determination date will be the arithmetic mean of those quotations. If fewer than two quotations are provided, then U.S. dollar LIBOR on the interest determination date will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted at approximately 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on the interest determination date by three major banks in The City of New York selected and identified by the issuer for loans in U.S. dollars to leading European banks, having a three-month maturity and in a principal amount that is representative for a single transaction in U.S. dollars in that market at that time? provided, however, that if the banks selected and identified by the issuer are not providing quotations in the manner described by this sentence, U.S. dollar LIBOR determined as of that interest determination date will be U.S. dollar LIBOR in effect on that interest determination date (i.e., the same as the rate determined for the immediately preceding interest reset date). The designated LIBOR page is Bloomberg L.P.'s page "BBAM", or any successor service for the purpose of displaying the London interbank rates of major banks for U.S. dollars. 20


 
Bloomberg L.P.'s page "BBAM" is the display designated as "BBAM", or such other page as may replace Bloomberg L.P.'s page "BBAM" on that service or such other service or services as may be nominated for the purpose of displaying London interbank offered rates for U.S. dollar deposits by ICE Benchmark Administration Limited ("IBA") or its successor or such other entity assuming the responsibility of IBA or its successor in calculating the London Interbank Offered Rate in the event IBA or its successor no longer does so. All calculations made by the calculation agent for the purposes of calculating the interest rates on the 2022 floating rate notes shall be conclusive and binding on the holders of the 2022 floating rate notes, BP, the issuer and the trustee, absent manifest error. Description of 2.315% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 The following terms are applicable to the 2.315% Guaranteed Notes due 2020. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 2.315% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,750,000,000 • Issuance dates: 13 February 2015 (with respect to 1,250,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) and 14 February 2017 (with respect to 500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) • Maturity date: 13 February 2020 • Interest rate: 2.315% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 13 February 2017 • Interest payment dates: Each 13 February and 13 August, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 13 August 2017 • Optional redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2020 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2020 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2020 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 12.5 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. "Treasury rate" means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. "Comparable treasury issue" means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2020 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable 21


 
maturity to the remaining term of such notes. "Comparable treasury price" means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. "Quotation agent" means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer "Reference treasury dealer" means Goldman, Sachs & Co., Mizuho Securities USA Inc. and RBS Securities Inc. (marketing name "NatWest Markets") or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a "primary treasury dealer"), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. "Reference treasury dealer quotations" means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 2.521% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 The following terms are applicable to the 2.521% Guaranteed Notes due 2020. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 2.521% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,250,000,000 • Issuance date: 4 November 2014 • Maturity date: 15 January 2020 • Interest rate: 2.521% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 4 November 2014 • Interest payment dates: Each 15 January and 15 July, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 15 January 2015 • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2020 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2020 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2020 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. "Treasury rate" means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the 22


 
comparable treasury price for such redemption date. "Comparable treasury issue" means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2020 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. "Comparable treasury price" means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. "Quotation agent" means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer "Reference treasury dealer" means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a "primary treasury dealer"), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. "Reference treasury dealer quotations" means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 4.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2020 The following terms are applicable to the 4.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2020. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 4.50% Guaranteed Notes due 2020. • Total principal amount outstanding: $317,996,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $1,182,004,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 1 October 2010 (Old Exchange Notes) and December 12, 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 1 October 2020. • Interest rate: 4.50% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 1 October 2010. • Interest payment dates: Each 1 April and 1 October. • First interest due date: 1 April 2011. • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2020 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2020 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2020 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued to the redemption date) discounted to the 23


 
redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 35 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. "Treasury rate" means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. "Comparable treasury issue" means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2020 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. "Comparable treasury price" means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. "Quotation agent" means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer "Reference treasury dealer" means Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and RBS Securities Inc. or their affiliates which are primary U.S. government securities dealers, and their respective successors, and two other primary U.S. government securities dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a "primary treasury dealer"), the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. "Reference treasury dealer quotations" means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 4.742% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 The following terms are applicable to the 4.742% Guaranteed Notes due 2021. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 4.742% Guaranteed Notes due 2021. • Total principal amount outstanding: $272,684,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $1,127,316,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 11 March 2011 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 11 March 2021. • Interest rate: 4.742% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 11 March 2011. • Interest payment dates: Each 11 March and 11 September. • First interest due date: 11 September 2011. 24


 
• Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2021 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2021 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2021 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. "Treasury rate" means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. "Comparable treasury issue" means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2021 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. "Comparable treasury price" means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. "Quotation agent" means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer "Reference treasury dealer" means BNP Paribas Securities Corp. and Citigroup Global Markets Inc. or their affiliates which are primary U.S. government securities dealers, and their respective successors, and two other primary U.S. government securities dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a "primary treasury dealer"), the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. "Reference treasury dealer quotations" means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.561% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 The following terms are applicable to the 3.561% Guaranteed Notes due 2021. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.561% Guaranteed Notes due 2021. • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000. • Issuance date: 1 November 2011. • Maturity date: 1 November 2021. • Interest rate: 3.561% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 1 November 2011. 25


 
• Interest payment dates: Each 1 May and 1 November, subject to the day count convention. • First interest due date: 1 May 2012. • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2021 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2021 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2021 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. "Treasury rate" means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. "Comparable treasury issue" means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2021 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. "Comparable treasury price" means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. "Quotation agent" means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer "Reference treasury dealer" means Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a "primary treasury dealer"), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. "Reference treasury dealer quotations" means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 2.112% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 The following terms are applicable to the 2.112 Guaranteed Notes due 2021. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 2.112% Guaranteed Notes due 2021 • Total principal amount outstanding: $146,557,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $603,443,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 16 September 2016 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) 26


 
• Maturity date: 16 September 2021 • Interest rate: 2.112% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 16 September 2016 • Interest payment dates: Each 16 September and 16 March, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 16 March 2017 • Optional redemption: Prior to 16 August 2021 (the date that is one month prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2021 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2021 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2021 fixed rate notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2021 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 16 August 2021 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 16 August 2021 (the date that is one month prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2021 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2021 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2021 fixed rate notes to be redeemed , plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. "Treasury rate" means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. "Comparable treasury issue" means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2021 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. "Comparable treasury price" means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. "Quotation agent" means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer "Reference treasury dealer" means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Mizuho Securities USA Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a "primary treasury dealer"), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. "Reference treasury dealer quotations" means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 2.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 27


 
The following terms are applicable to the 2.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 2.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000. • Issuance date: 6 November 2012. • Maturity date: 6November 2022. • Interest rate: 2.500% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 6 November 2012. • Interest payment dates: Each 6 May and 6 November. • First interest due date: 6 May 2013. • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2022 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2022 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2022 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2022 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Citigroup Global Markets Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to 28


 
the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 2.520% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 The following terms are applicable to the 2.520% Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 2.520% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 • Total principal amount outstanding: $135,041,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $564,959,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 19 September 2017 (Old Exchange Notes) and December 12, 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 19 September 2022 • Interest rate: 2.520% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 19 September 2017 • Interest payment dates: Each 19 March and 19 September, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 19 March 2018 • Optional redemption: Prior to 19 August 2022 (the date that is one month prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2022 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2022 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2022 fixed rate notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2022 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 19 August 2022 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 12.5 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 19 August 2022 (the date that is one month prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2022 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2022 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2022 fixed rate notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2022 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial 29


 
practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC, HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.245% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 The following terms are applicable to the 3.245% Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 3.245% Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Total principal amount outstanding: $349,823,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $1,400,177,000 (New Exchange Notes). • Issuance date: 7 May 2012 (Old Exchange Notes) and December 12, 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 6 May 2022. • Interest rate: 3.245% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 7 May 2012. • Interest payment dates: Each 6 May and 6 November. • First interest due date: 6 November 2012. • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2022 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2022 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2022 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or 30


 
interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2022 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Mizuho Securities USA Inc., Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, RBS Securities Inc. and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.062% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 The following terms are applicable to the 3.062% Guaranteed Notes due 2022. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.062% Guaranteed Notes due 2022 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 17 March 2015 • Maturity date: 17 March 2022 • Interest rate: 3.062% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 17 March 2015 • Interest payment dates: Each 17 March and 17 September, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 17 September 2015 • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2022 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2022 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2022 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) 31


 
discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2022 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 2.750% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 The following terms are applicable to the 2.750% Guaranteed Notes due 2023. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 2.750% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 • Total principal amount outstanding: $398,152,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $1,101,848,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 10 May 2013 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 10 May 2023. • Interest rate: 2.750% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 10 May 2013. • Interest payment dates: Each 10 May and 10 November. • First interest due date: 10 November 2013. 32


 
• Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2023 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2023 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2023 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2023 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Mizuho Securities USA Inc., Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and SG Americas Securities, LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and one primary treasury dealer selected by Mitsubishi UFJ Securities (USA), Inc., and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 The following terms are applicable to the 3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 • Total principal amount outstanding: $206,060,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $993,940,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 28 November 2016 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 28 November 2023 33


 
• Interest rate: 3.216% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 28 November 2016 • Interest payment dates: Each 28 May and 28 November, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 28 May 2017 • Optional redemption: Prior to 28 September 2023 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2023 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2023 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2023 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2023 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 28 September 2023 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 28 September 2023 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2023 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2023 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2023 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2023 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Goldman, Sachs & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and MUFG Securities Americas Inc. or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.994% Guaranteed Notes due 2023 The following terms are applicable to the 3.994% Guaranteed Notes due 2.23. 34


 
• Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.994% Guaranteed Notes due 2023. • Total principal amount outstanding: $750,000,000. • Issuance date: 26 September 2013. • Maturity date: 26 September 2023. • Interest rate: 3.994% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 26 September 2013. • Interest payment dates: Each 26 March and 26 September. • First interest due date: 26 March 2014. • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2023 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2023 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2023 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2023 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. 35


 
Description of 3.535% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 The following terms are applicable to the 2.535% Guaranteed Notes due 2024. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.535% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 • Total principal amount outstanding: $750,000,000 • Issuance date: 4 November 2014 • Maturity date: 4 November 2024 • Interest rate: 3.535% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 4 November 2014 • Interest payment dates: Each 4 May and 4 November, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 4 May 2015 • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2024 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2024 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2024 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2024 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation 36


 
agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.814% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 The following terms are applicable to the 3.814% Guaranteed Notes due 2024. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.814% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,250,000,000 • Issuance date: 10 February 2014 • Maturity date: 10 February 2024 • Interest rate: 3.814% per annum. • Date interest starts accruing: 10 February 2014. • Interest payment dates: Each 10 February and 10 August, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 10 August 2014 • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2024 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2024 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2024 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2024 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and RBS Securities Inc. or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government 37


 
securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.224% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 The following terms are applicable to the 3.224% Guaranteed Notes due 2024. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 3.224% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 • Total principal amount outstanding: $903,287,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $96,713,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 14 February 2017 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 14 April 2024 • Interest rate: 3.224% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 14 February 2017 • Interest payment dates: Each 14 April and 14 October, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 14 October 2017 • Optional redemption: Prior to 14 February 2024 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2024 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2024 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2024 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2024 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 14 February 2024 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi- annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 14 February 2024 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2024 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2024 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2024 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum 38


 
equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2024 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, MUFG Securities Americas Inc., and RBS Securities Inc. (marketing name “NatWest Markets”) or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.790% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 The following terms are applicable to the 3.790% Guaranteed Notes due 2024. • Issuer: BP Capital America • Title: 3.790% Guaranteed Notes due 2024 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 6 November 2018 • Maturity date: 6 February 2024 • Interest rate: 3.790% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 6 November 2018 • Interest payment dates: Each 6 February and 6 August, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 6 February 2019 • Optional redemption: Prior to 6 January 2024 (the date that is one month prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2024 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2024 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2024 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present 39


 
values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2024 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 6 January 2024 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semiannual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in either case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 6 January 2024 (the date that is one month prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2024 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2024 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2024 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2024 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by BP Capital America. “Reference treasury dealer” means Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, NatWest Markets Securities Inc., SG Americas Securities, LLC and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by BP Capital America, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, BP Capital America shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.506% Guaranteed Notes due 2025 The following terms are applicable to the 3.506% Guaranteed Notes due 2025. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.506% Guaranteed Notes due 2025 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 17 March 2015 • Maturity date: 17 March 2025 • Interest rate: 3.506% per annum 40


 
• Date interest starts accruing: 17 March 2015 • Interest payment dates: Each 17 March and 17 September, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 17 September 2015 • Optional make-whole redemption: the issuer has the right to redeem the 2025 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2025 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2025 notes to be redeemed (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 25 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2025 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.796% Guaranteed Notes due 2025 The following terms are applicable to the 3.796% Guaranteed Notes due 2025. • Issuer: BP Capital America • Title: 3.796% Guaranteed Notes due 2025 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 21 September 2018 41


 
• Maturity date: 21 September 2025 • Interest rate: 3.796% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 21 September 2018 • Interest payment dates: Each 21 March and 21 September, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 21 March 2019 • Optional redemption: Prior to 21 July 2025 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2025 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2025 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2025 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2025 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 21 July 2025 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 21 July 2025 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2025 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2025 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2025 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2025 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by BP Capital America. “Reference treasury dealer” means Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC, HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Mizuho Securities USA LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by BP Capital America, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, BP Capital America shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.119% Guaranteed Notes due 2026 42


 
The following terms are applicable to the 3.119% Guaranteed Notes due 2026. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes). • Title: 3.119% Guaranteed Notes due 2026 • Total principal amount outstanding: $251,423,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $998,577,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 4 May 2016 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 4 May 2026 • Interest rate: 3.119% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 4 May 2016 • Interest payment dates: Each 4 May and 4 November, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 4 November 2016 • Optional make-whole redemption: Prior to 4 February 2026 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2026 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2026 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2026 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2026 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 4 February 2026 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 4 February 2026 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2026 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2026 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2026 notes to be redeemed , plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional make-whole redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2026 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Mizuho Securities USA Inc. or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. 43


 
government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.410% Guaranteed Notes due 2026 The following terms are applicable to the 3.410% Guaranteed Notes due 2026. • Issuer: BP Capital America • Title: 3.410% Guaranteed Notes due 2026 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 11 February 2019 • Maturity date: 11 February 2026 • Interest rate: 3.410% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 11 February 2019 • Interest payment dates: Each 11 February and 11 August, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 11 August 2019 • Optional redemption: Prior to 11 December 2025 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2026 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2026 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2026 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2026 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 11 December 2025 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semiannual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in either case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 11 December 2025 (the date that is two months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2026 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2026 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2026 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the 44


 
comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2026 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by BP Capital America. “Reference treasury dealer” means BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by BP Capital America, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, BP Capital America shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.017% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 The following terms are applicable to the 3.017% Guaranteed Notes due 2027. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) • Title: 3.017% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 • Total principal amount outstanding: $123,582,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $876,418,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 16 September 2016 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) 16 December 2016 • Maturity date: 16 January 2027 • Interest rate: 3.017% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 16 September 2016 • Interest payment dates: Each 16 January and 16 July, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 16 January 2017 • Optional redemption: Prior to 16 October 2026 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2027 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2027 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed and (ii) the 45


 
sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 16 October 2026 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 16 October 2026 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2027 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2027 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed , plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Mizuho Securities USA Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.279% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 The following terms are applicable to the 3.279% Guaranteed Notes due 2027. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.279% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,500,000,000 • Issuance date: 19 September 2017 • Maturity date: 19 September 2027 • Interest rate: 3.279% per annum 46


 
• Date interest starts accruing: 19 September 2017 • Interest payment dates: Each 19 March and 19 September, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 19 March 2018 • Optional redemption: Prior to 19 June 2027 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2027 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2027 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 19 June 2027 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 19 June 2027 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2027 fixed rate notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2027 fixed rate notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2027 fixed rate notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC, HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.588% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 The following terms are applicable to the 3.588% Guaranteed Notes due 2027. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. (Old Exchange Notes) and BP Capital America (New Exchange Notes) 47


 
• Title: 3.588% Guaranteed Notes due 2027 • Total principal amount outstanding: $236,291,000 (Old Exchange Notes) and $613,709,000 (New Exchange Notes) • Issuance date: 14 February 2017 (Old Exchange Notes) and 12 December 2018 (New Exchange Notes) • Maturity date: 14 April 2027 • Interest rate: 3.588% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 14 February 2017 • Interest payment dates: Each 14 April and 14 October, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 14 October 2017 • Optional redemption: Prior to 14 January 2027 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2027 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2027 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2027 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 14 January 2027 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semiannual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 14 January 2027 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2027 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2027 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2027 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2027 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means Barclays Capital Inc., BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, MUFG Securities Americas Inc., and RBS Securities Inc. (marketing name “NatWest Markets”) or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury 48


 
dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefore another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.723% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 The following terms are applicable to the 3.723% Guaranteed Notes due 2028. • Issuer: BP Capital U.K. • Title: 3.723% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 • Total principal amount outstanding: $800,000,000 • Issuance date: 28 November 2016 • Maturity date: 28 November 2028 • Interest rate: 3.723% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 28 November 2016 • Interest payment dates: Each 28 May and 28 November, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 28 May 2017 • Optional redemption: Prior to 28 August 2028 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2028 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2028 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2028 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2028 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 28 August 2028 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semiannual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 25 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 28 August 2028 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2028 notes), the issuer has the right to redeem the 2028 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2028 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of 49


 
the 2028 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by the issuer “Reference treasury dealer” means BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Goldman, Sachs & Co., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and MUFG Securities Americas Inc. or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by the issuer, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, the issuer shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.937% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 The following terms are applicable to the 3.937% Guaranteed Notes due 2028. • Issuer: BP Capital America • Title: 3.937% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 • Total principal amount outstanding: $1,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 21 September 2018 • Maturity date: 21 September 2028 • Interest rate: 3.937% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 21 September 2018 • Interest payment dates: Each 21 March and 21 September, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 21 March 2019 • Optional redemption: Prior to 21 June 2028 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2028 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2028 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2028 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2028 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 21 June 2028 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in each case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of 50


 
redemption. On or after 21 June 2028 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2028 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2028 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2028 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2028 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by BP Capital America. “Reference treasury dealer” means Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC, HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Mizuho Securities USA LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by BP Capital America, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, BP Capital America shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 4.234% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 The following terms are applicable to the 4.234% Guaranteed Notes due 2028. • Issuer: BP Capital America • Title: 4.234% Guaranteed Notes due 2028 • Total principal amount outstanding: $2,000,000,000 • Issuance date: 6 November 2018 (with respect to $1,000,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) and 11 February 2019 (with respect to $1,000,000,000 aggregate principal amount of notes) • Maturity date: 6 November 2028 • Interest rate: 4.234% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 6 November 2018 • Interest payment dates: Each 6 May and 6 November, subject to the day count convention. 51


 
• First interest payment date: 6 May 2019 • Optional redemption: Prior to 6 August 2028 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2028 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2028 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the 2028 notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the 2028 notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 6 August 2028 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semiannual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 20 basis points, plus in either case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 6 August 2028 (the date that is three months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the 2028 notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the 2028 notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the 2028 notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the 2028 notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by BP Capital America. “Reference treasury dealer” means Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, NatWest Markets Securities Inc., SG Americas Securities, LLC and UBS Securities LLC or their affiliates, each of which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and their respective successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by BP Capital America, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, BP Capital America shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. Description of 3.067% Guaranteed Notes due 2050 • Issuer: BP Capital America • Title: 3.067% Guaranteed Notes due 2050 • Total principal amount outstanding: $500,000,000 • Issuance date: 13 December 2019 52


 
• Maturity date: 30 March 2050 • Interest rate: 3.067% per annum • Date interest starts accruing: 13 December 2019 • Interest payment dates: 30 March and 30 September of each year, subject to the day count convention. • First interest payment date: 30 March 2020 (short first coupon) • Redemption at the option of BP Capital America: On or after 31 March 2025 and prior to 30 September 2049 (the date that is six months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed and (ii) the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest on the notes to be redeemed that would be due if such notes matured on 30 September 2049 (not including any portion of payments of interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the treasury rate plus 15 basis points, plus in either case accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. On or after 30 September 2049 (the date that is six months prior to the scheduled maturity date for the notes), BP Capital America has the right to redeem the notes, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, thereon to, but excluding, the date of redemption. For purposes of determining the optional redemption price, the following definitions are applicable. “Treasury rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity or interpolated (on a day count basis) of the comparable treasury issue, assuming a price for the comparable treasury issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the comparable treasury price for such redemption date. “Comparable treasury issue” means the U.S. Treasury security or securities selected by the quotation agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes. “Comparable treasury price” means, with respect to any redemption date, the average of the reference treasury dealer quotations for such redemption date. “Quotation agent” means one of the reference treasury dealers appointed by BP Capital America “Reference treasury dealer” means Citigroup Global Markets Inc. or one of its affiliates, which is a primary U.S. government securities dealer in the United States (a “primary treasury dealer”), and its successors, and two other primary treasury dealers selected by BP Capital America, provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a primary treasury dealer, BP Capital America shall substitute therefor another primary treasury dealer. “Reference treasury dealer quotations” means with respect to each reference treasury dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the quotation agent, of the bid and asked prices for the comparable treasury issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the quotation agent by such reference treasury dealer at 5:00 p.m. New York time on the third business day preceding such redemption date. • Redemption at the option of the holder: Holders of the notes have the right to elect to have BP Capital America redeem the notes in whole or in part in increments of $1,000 on 30 March 2025 at 53


 
a price equal to 94.022% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed together with accrued interest to such date. If the notes are held in book-entry form through DTC, then in order to exercise the option to redeem the notes, a beneficial holder of the notes must (i) instruct its direct or indirect participant through which it holds an interest in the notes to notify the trustee of its election to exercise its repayment option in accordance with the then-applicable operating procedures of DTC and (ii) provide an email notice of such holder’s intention to exercise its option to redeem the notes to gtreasuryp54@bp.com. In order for the exercise of the option to be effective and the note to be repaid, such notice must be delivered to the trustee through DTC during the period from and including 30 January 2025 to and including the close of business on February 28, 2025 (or, if 28 February 2025 is not a business day, the next succeeding business day). DTC must receive any such notice from its participants in time to exercise such repayment option request in accordance with their applicable operating procedures and the terms of the notes. Different firms have different deadlines for accepting instructions from their customers. The beneficial holder should consult the direct or indirect participant through which it holds an interest in the notes to ascertain the deadline for ensuring that timely notice will be delivered to DTC. If the notes are not held in book-entry form, then in order for the exercise of the option to be effective and a note to be repaid, BP Capital America must receive, at the office of the trustee located at The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., 2 North LaSalle Street, Suite 700, Chicago, Illinois 60602 Attention: Corporate Trust Administration, with a copy (which shall not constitute notice) sent to gtreasuryp54@bp.com, during the period from and including January 30, 2025 to and including the close of business on 28 February 2025 (or, if 28 February 2025 is not a business day, the next succeeding business day), such note, together with the form entitled “Option to Elect Repayment” attached to such note duly completed. Exercise of the repayment option by the holder of a note shall be irrevocable. No transfer or of any note (or, in the event that any note is to be repaid in part, such portion of the note to be repaid) will be permitted after exercise of the repayment option. 54


 
B. Other Terms Applicable to All Notes The following terms are applicable to all Notes. Guarantee: Payment of the principal of and interest on the notes is fully guaranteed by BP. Denomination: The notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000. Regular record dates for interest: The 15th calendar day preceding each interest payment date, whether or not such day is a business day. Business day: If any payment is due in respect of the notes on a day that is not a business day, it will be made on the next following business day, provided that no interest will accrue on the payment so deferred. A “business day” for these purposes is any week day on which banking or trust institutions in neither New York nor London are authorized generally or obligated by law, regulation or executive order to close. Ranking: The notes are unsecured and unsubordinated and will rank equally with all of the issuer’s other unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness. Further issuances: The issuer of the Notes may, at its sole option, at any time and without the consent of the then existing note holders issue additional notes in one or more transactions subsequent to the date of the applicable prospectus supplement with terms (other than the issuance date, issue price and, possibly, the first interest payment date and the date interest starts accruing) identical to the notes issued under such prospectus supplement. These additional notes will be deemed part of the same series as the notes issued under such prospectus supplement and will provide the holders of these additional notes the right to vote together with holders of the notes issued under such prospectus supplement, provided that such additional notes will be issued with no more than de minimis original issue discount or will be part of a “qualified reopening” for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Day Count: • For Notes which are floating rate notes – Actual / 360 • For Notes which are fixed rate notes – 30/360 Day count convention: • For Notes which are floating rate notes – Modified following. If any interest payment date falls on a day that is not a business day, that interest payment date will be postponed to the next succeeding business day unless that business day is in the next succeeding calendar month, in which case the interest payment date will be the immediately preceding business day. • For Notes which are fixed rate notes – Following Unadjusted Trading through DTC, Clearstream, Luxembourg and Euroclear: Initial settlement for the notes has been made in immediately available funds. Secondary market trading between DTC participants will occur in the ordinary way in accordance with DTC’s rules and will be settled in immediately available funds using DTC’s Same-Day Funds Settlement System. Secondary market trading between Clearstream Banking, société anonyme, in Luxembourg (“Clearstream, Luxembourg”), customers and/or Euroclear Bank S.A./N.V. (“Euroclear”) participants will occur in the ordinary way in accordance with the applicable rules 55


 
and operating procedures of Clearstream, Luxembourg and Euroclear and will be settled using the procedures applicable to conventional Eurobonds in immediately available funds. Name of depositary: The Depository Trust Company, commonly referred to as “DTC”. Sinking Fund: There is no sinking fund. Trustee: • If the issuer is BP Capital U.K., the notes have been issued under an indenture with The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank), as trustee, dated as of 8 March 2002, as supplemented by a supplemental indenture with respect to the notes entered into on the issuance date. • If the issuer is BP Capital America, the notes have been issued under an indenture with The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank), as trustee, dated as of 4 June 2003, as supplemented by a supplemental indenture with respect to the notes entered into on the issuance date. Use of proceeds: The net proceeds from the sale of the notes will be used for general corporate purposes, including working capital for BP or other companies in the BP Group and the repayment of existing borrowings of BP and its subsidiaries. Governing law and jurisdiction: The indenture, the notes and the guarantee are governed by New York law. Any legal proceeding arising out of or based upon the indenture, the notes or the guarantee may be instituted in any state or federal court in the Borough of Manhattan in New York City, New York. BP Capital U.K.’s principal executive offices are located at Chertsey Road, Sunbury on Thames, Middlesex TW16 7BP, England. BP Capital America’s principal executive offices are located at 501 Westlake Park Boulevard, Houston, Texas 77079. C. Description of Debt Securities and Guarantees The following terms are applicable to all Notes. In the following description, “you” means direct holders of the Notes (and not street name or other indirect holders of securities). 56


 
DESCRIPTION OF DEBT SECURITIES AND GUARANTEES Each of the BP Debt Issuers may issue guaranteed debt securities using this prospectus. As required by U.S. federal law for all bonds and notes of companies that are publicly offered, the debt securities are governed by a document called the indenture. BP Capital America has entered into Indenture, dated 4 June 2003, between BP Capital America., BP p.l.c. and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.) as trustee. BP Capital U.K. has entered into an Indenture, dated 8 March 2002, between BP Capital U.K., BP p.l.c. and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.) as trustee. The trustee under each of the indentures has two main roles: • first, it can enforce your rights against us if we default. There are some limitations on the extent to which the trustee acts on your behalf, described under “Default and Related Matters—Events of Default—Remedies If an Event of Default Occurs” below; and • second, the trustee performs administrative duties for us, such as sending you interest payments, transferring your debt securities to a new buyer if you sell and sending you notices. BP acts as the guarantor of the guaranteed debt securities issued under the BP Debt Issuers’ indentures. The guarantees are described under “—Guarantees” below. The indentures and their associated documents contain the full legal text governing the matters described in this section. The indentures, the debt securities and the guarantees are governed by New York law. The indentures are exhibits to our registration statement. This section contains what we believe is a materially complete and accurate summary of the material provisions of the indentures, which are substantially identical to each other, the debt securities and the guarantees. However, because it is a summary, it does not describe every aspect of the indentures, the debt securities or the guarantees. This summary is subject to and qualified in its entirety by reference to all the provisions of the indentures, including some of the terms used in the indentures. We describe the meaning for only the more important terms. We also include references in parentheses to some sections of the indentures. Whenever we refer to particular sections or defined terms of the indentures in this prospectus or in the prospectus supplement, those sections or defined terms are incorporated by reference here or in the prospectus supplement. This summary also is subject to and qualified by reference to the description of the particular terms of your series described above. The BP Debt Issuers may each issue as many distinct series of debt securities under its respective indenture as it wishes. This section summarizes all material terms of the debt securities that are common to all series, unless otherwise described above. We may issue the debt securities as original issue discount securities, which are debt securities that are offered and sold at a substantial discount to their stated principal amount. (Section 101) Special U.S. federal income tax, accounting and other considerations may apply to original issue discount securities. The applicable U.S. federal income tax considerations for original issue discount securities are described under “Original Issue Discount” below. The debt securities may also be issued as indexed securities or securities denominated in foreign currencies or currency units, as described in more detail above. 57


 
Accordingly, this summary also is subject to and qualified by reference to the description of the terms of the series described above. Unless otherwise described above, the debt securities will be issued only in fully registered form without interest coupons. Guarantees BP will fully and unconditionally guarantee the payment of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the guaranteed debt securities, including certain additional amounts which may be payable under the guarantees, as described under “Special Situations—Payment of Additional Amounts”. BP guarantees the payment of such amounts when such amounts become due and payable, whether at the stated maturity of the debt securities, by declaration of acceleration, call for redemption or otherwise. Overview of Remainder of This Description The remainder of this description summarizes: • Additional mechanics relevant to the debt securities under normal circumstances, such as how you transfer ownership and where we make payments. • Your rights under several special situations, such as if we merge with another company or if we want to change a term of the debt securities. • Your rights to receive payment of additional amounts due to changes in U.K. tax withholding or deduction requirements. • Your rights if we default or experience other financial difficulties. • Our relationship with the trustee. Additional Mechanics Exchange and Transfer You may have your debt securities broken into more debt securities of smaller denominations or combined into fewer debt securities of larger denominations, as long as the total principal amount is not changed. (Section 305) This is called an exchange. You may exchange or transfer registered debt securities at the office of the trustee. The trustee acts as our agent for registering debt securities in the names of holders and transferring registered debt securities. We may change this appointment to another entity or perform the service ourselves. The entity performing the role of maintaining the list of registered holders is called the security registrar. It will also register transfers of the registered debt securities. (Section 305) You will not be required to pay a service charge to transfer or exchange debt securities, but you may be required to pay for any tax or other governmental charge associated with the exchange or transfer. The transfer or exchange of a registered debt security will only be made if the security registrar is satisfied with your proof of ownership. 58


 
If we have designated additional transfer agents, they are described above. We may cancel the designation of any particular transfer agent. We may also approve a change in the office through which any transfer agent acts. (Section 1002) If the debt securities are redeemable and we redeem less than all of the debt securities of a particular series, we may block the transfer or exchange of debt securities during a specified period of time in order to freeze the list of holders to prepare the mailing. The period begins 15 days before the day we mail the notice of redemption and ends on the day of that mailing. We may also refuse to register transfers or exchanges of debt securities selected for redemption. However, we will continue to permit transfers and exchanges of the unredeemed portion of any security being partially redeemed. (Section 305) Payment and Paying Agents We will pay interest to you if you are a direct holder listed in the trustee’s records at the close of business on a particular day in advance of each due date for interest, even if you no longer own the security on the interest due date. That particular day, usually about two weeks in advance of the interest due date, is called the regular record date and is as described above. (Section 307) We will pay interest, principal and any other money due on the registered debt securities at the corporate trust office of the trustee in Chicago, Illinois. That office is currently located at The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., 2 North LaSalle Street, Suite 700, Chicago, Illinois 60602. You must make arrangements to have your payments picked up at or wired from that office. We may also choose to pay interest by mailing checks. Interest on global securities will be paid to the holder thereof by wire transfer of same­day funds. Holders buying and selling debt securities must work out between them how to compensate for the fact that we will pay all the interest for an interest period to the one who is the registered holder on the regular record date. The most common manner is to adjust the sales price of the debt securities to pro rate interest fairly between buyer and seller. This prorated interest amount is called accrued interest. We may also arrange for additional payment offices, and may cancel or change these offices, including our use of the trustee’s corporate trust office. These offices are called paying agents. We may also choose to act as our own paying agent. We must notify you through the trustee of changes in the paying agents for any particular series of debt securities. (Section 1002) Notices We and the trustee will send notices only to direct holders, using their addresses as listed in the trustee’s records. (Section 106) Regardless of who acts as paying agent, all money that we pay to a paying agent that remains unclaimed at the end of two years after the amount is due to direct holders will be repaid to us. After that two­year period, you may look only to us for payment and not to the trustee, any other paying agent or anyone else. (Section 1006) Special Situations Mergers and Similar Events 59


 
We are generally permitted to consolidate or merge with another company or firm. We are also permitted to sell or lease substantially all of our assets to another corporation or other entity or to buy or lease substantially all of the assets of another corporation or other entity. No vote by holders of debt securities approving any of these actions is required, unless as part of the transaction we make changes to the indenture requiring your approval, as described below under “—Modification and Waiver”. We may take these actions as part of a transaction involving outside third parties or as part of an internal corporate reorganization. We may take these actions even if they result in: • a lower credit rating being assigned to the debt securities; or • additional amounts becoming payable in respect of U.K. withholding tax, and the debt securities thus being subject to redemption at our option, as described below under “—Optional Tax Redemption”. We have no obligation under the indenture to seek to avoid these results, or any other legal or financial effects that are disadvantageous to you, in connection with a merger, consolidation or sale or lease of assets that is permitted under the indenture. However, we may not take any of these actions unless all the following conditions are met: • Where a BP Debt Issuer or BP, as applicable, merges out of existence or sells or leases substantially all of its assets, the other entity must assume its obligations on the debt securities or the guarantees. Such other entity must be organized under the laws of such BP entity’s jurisdiction or a political subdivision thereof. • The merger, sale or lease of assets or other transaction must not cause a default on the debt securities, and we must not already be in default. For purposes of this no­default test, a default would include an event of default that has occurred and not been cured, as described below under “Default and Related Matters—Events of Default—What Is an Event of Default?” A default for this purpose would also include any event that would be an event of default if the requirements for giving us default notice or our default having to exist for a specific period of time were disregarded. • It is possible that the merger, sale or lease of assets or other transaction would cause some of our property to become subject to a mortgage, security interest, lien or other legal mechanism giving lenders preferential rights in that property over other lenders or over our general creditors if we fail to pay them back. • It is possible that the U.S. Internal Revenue Service may deem a merger or other similar transaction to cause an exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes of debt securities for new securities by the holders of the debt securities. This could result in the recognition of taxable gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes and possible other adverse tax consequences. Modification and Waiver There are three types of changes we can make to the indenture and the debt securities. Changes Requiring Your Approval • First, there are changes that cannot be made to your debt securities without your specific approval. We must obtain your specified approval in order to: 60


 
• change the stated maturity of the principal or interest on a debt security; • reduce any amounts due on a debt security; • reduce the amount of principal payable upon acceleration of the maturity of a debt security following a default; • change the place or currency of payment on a debt security; • impair your right to sue for payment; • reduce the percentage of holders of debt securities whose consent is needed to modify or amend the indenture; • reduce the percentage of holders of debt securities whose consent is needed to waive compliance with various provisions of the indenture or to waive various defaults; • modify any other aspect of the provisions dealing with modification and waiver of the indenture; and • change the obligations of BP to pay any principal, premium or interest under the guarantees. (Section 902) Changes Requiring a Majority Vote • The second type of change to the indenture and the debt securities is the kind that requires a vote in favor by holders of debt securities owning a majority of the principal amount of the particular series affected. Most changes fall into this category, except for clarifying changes and other changes that would not adversely affect holders of the debt securities in any material respect. The same vote would be required for us to obtain a waiver of all or part of the covenants described in this summary or a waiver of a past default. However, we cannot obtain a waiver of a payment default or any other aspect of the indenture or the debt securities listed in the first category described above under “Changes Requiring Your Approval” unless we obtain your individual consent to the waiver. (Section 513) Changes Not Requiring Approval The third type of change does not require any vote by holders of debt securities. This type is limited to clarifications and other changes that would not adversely affect holders of the debt securities in any material respect. (Section 901) Further Details Concerning Voting When taking a vote, we will use the following rules to decide how much principal amount to attribute to a security: • For original issue discount securities, we will use the principal amount that would be due and payable on the voting date if the maturity of the debt securities were accelerated to that date because of a default. 61


 
• For debt securities whose principal amount is not known (for example, because it is based on an index), we will use a special rule for that security, as described above. • For debt securities denominated in one or more foreign currencies or currency units, we will use the U.S. dollar equivalent as of the date of original issuance. • Debt securities will not be considered outstanding, and therefore not eligible to vote, if we have deposited or set aside in trust for you money for their payment or redemption. Debt securities will also not be eligible to vote if they have been fully defeased as described below under “—Defeasance and Discharge”. (Section 101) • We will generally be entitled to set any day as a record date for the purpose of determining the holders of outstanding debt securities that are entitled to vote or take other action under the indenture. If we set a record date for a vote or other action to be taken by holders of a particular series, that vote or action may be taken only by persons who are holders of outstanding debt securities of that series on the record date and must be taken within 90 days following the record date or another period that we may specify (or as the trustee may specify, if it set the record date). We may shorten or lengthen (but not beyond 90 days) this period from time to time. (Sections 501, 502, 512, 513 and 902) Redemption and Repayment Unless otherwise described above, your debt security will not be entitled to the benefit of any sinking fund—that is, we will not deposit money on a regular basis into any separate custodial account to repay your debt securities. In addition, we will not be entitled to redeem your debt security before its stated maturity unless a redemption commencement date is specified above. You will not be entitled to require us to buy your debt security from you, before its stated maturity, unless one or more repayment dates is specified above. If a redemption commencement date or a repayment date is specified above, one or more redemption prices or repayment prices may be specified, which may be expressed as a percentage of the principal amount of your debt security or by reference to one or more formulae used to determine the redemption price(s). It may also specify one or more redemption periods during which the redemption prices relating to a redemption of debt securities during those periods will apply. If a redemption commencement date is specified above, we may redeem your debt security at our option at any time on or after that date. If we redeem your debt security, we will do so at the specified redemption price, together with interest accrued to the redemption date. If different prices are specified for different redemption periods, the price we pay will be the price that applies to the redemption period during which your debt security is redeemed. If a repayment date is specified above, your debt security will be repayable by us at your option on the specified repayment date(s) at the specified repayment price(s), together with interest accrued to the repayment date. In the event that we exercise an option to redeem any debt security, we will give written notice of the principal amount of the debt security to be redeemed to the trustee at least 45 days before the applicable redemption date and to the holder not less than 30 days nor more than 60 days before the applicable redemption date. We will give the notice in the manner described above under “Additional Mechanics— Notices”. 62


 
If a debt security represented by a global security is subject to repayment at the holder’s option, the depositary or its nominee, as the holder, will be the only person that can exercise the right to repayment. Any indirect holders who own beneficial interests in the global security and wish to exercise a repayment right must give proper and timely instructions to their banks or brokers through which they hold their interests, requesting that they notify the depositary to exercise the repayment right on their behalf. Different firms have different deadlines for accepting instructions from their customers; we urge you to take care to act promptly enough to ensure that your request is given effect by the depositary before the applicable deadline for exercise. We or our affiliates may purchase debt securities from investors who are willing to sell from time to time, either in the open market at prevailing prices or in private transactions at negotiated prices. Debt securities that we or they purchase may, in our discretion, be held, resold or canceled. Payment of Additional Amounts The government of any jurisdiction where BP or BP Capital U.K. is incorporated may require BP or BP Capital U.K. to withhold or deduct amounts from payments on the principal or interest on a debt security or any amounts to be paid under the guarantees for or on account of taxes or any other governmental charges. If the jurisdiction requires a withholding or deduction of this type, BP or BP Capital U.K., as the case may be, may be required to pay you an additional amount so that the net amount you receive will be the amount specified in the debt security to which you are entitled. However, in order for you to be entitled to receive the additional amount, you must not be resident in the jurisdiction that requires the withholding or deduction. BP or BP Capital U.K., as the case may be, will not have to pay additional amounts under any of the following circumstances: • The U.S. government or any political subdivision of the U.S. government is the entity that is imposing the tax or governmental charge. • The tax or governmental charge is imposed due to the presentation of a debt security, if presentation is required, for payment on a date more than 30 days after the security became due or after the payment was provided for. • The tax or governmental charge is on account of an estate, inheritance, gift, sale, transfer, personal property or similar tax or other governmental charge. The tax or governmental charge is for a tax or governmental charge that is payable in a manner that does not involve withholdings. • The tax or governmental charge is imposed or withheld because the holder or beneficial owner failed: • to provide information about the nationality, residence or identity of the holder or beneficial owner, or • to make a declaration or satisfy any information requirements, that the statutes, treaties, regulations or administrative practices of the taxing jurisdiction require as a precondition to exemption from all or part of such tax or governmental charge. 63


 
• The withholding or deduction is imposed pursuant to European Council Directive 2003/48/EC or European Council Directive 2014/48/EC, regarding taxation of, and information exchange among member states of the European Union with respect to, interest income, or any other Directive implementing the conclusions of the ECOFIN Council meeting of 26­27 November 2000, or any law implementing or complying with, or introduced in order to conform to, such Directives. • The withholding or deduction is imposed on a holder or beneficial owner who could have avoided such withholding or deduction by presenting its debt securities to another paying agent. • The holder is a fiduciary or partnership or an entity that is not the sole beneficial owner of the payment of the principal of, or any interest on, any security, and the laws of the jurisdiction require the payment to be included in the income of a beneficiary or settlor for tax purposes with respect to such fiduciary or a member of such partnership or a beneficial owner who would not have been entitled to such additional amounts had it been the holder of such security. These provisions will also apply to any taxes or governmental charges imposed by any jurisdiction in which a successor to BP or BP Capital U.K. is organized. Additional circumstances in which BP would not be required to pay additional amounts, if any, are described above. (Section 1010) Optional Tax Redemption We may also have the option to redeem the debt securities of a given series if, as a result of any change in United Kingdom tax treatment, BP or BP Capital U.K. would be required to pay additional amounts as described in the previous subsection under “—Payment of Additional Amounts”. This option applies only in the case of changes in United Kingdom tax treatment that occur on or after the date specified above for the applicable series of debt securities. The redemption price for the debt securities, other than original issue discount debt securities, will be equal to the principal amount of the debt securities being redeemed plus accrued interest. The redemption price for original issue discount debt securities will be specified above for such securities. (Section 1108) Event Risk Provisions The debt securities do not contain event risk provisions designed to require BP or the BP Debt Issuers to redeem or repurchase the debt securities, reset the interest rate or take other actions in response to highly leveraged transactions, changes in credit ratings or similar occurrences. Defeasance and Discharge The following discussion of full defeasance and discharge will be applicable to your series of debt securities only if we choose to have them apply to that series. If we do so choose, it will be stated in the above description of your debt securities. (Section 403) We can legally release ourselves from any payment or other obligations on the debt securities, except for various obligations described below, if we, in addition to other actions, put in place the following arrangements for you to be repaid: • We must deposit in trust for your benefit and the benefit of all other direct holders of the debt securities a combination of money and U.S. government or U.S. government agency notes or bonds that will generate enough cash to make interest, principal and any other payments on the 64


 
debt securities on their various due dates. In addition, on the date of such deposit, we must not be in default. For purposes of this no­default test, a default would include an event of default that has occurred and not been cured, as described below under “Default and Related Matters— Events of Default—What Is an Event of Default?” A default for this purpose would also include any event that would be an event of default if the requirements for giving us default notice or our default having to exist for a specific period of time were disregarded. • We must deliver to the trustee a legal opinion of our counsel confirming that under current U.S. federal income tax law we may make the above deposit without causing you to be taxed on the debt securities any differently than if we did not make the deposit and just repaid the debt securities ourselves. In the case of debt securities being discharged, we must deliver along with this opinion a private letter ruling from U.S. Internal Revenue Service to this effect or a revenue ruling pertaining to a comparable form of transaction to that effect published by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service. • If the debt securities are listed on the New York Stock Exchange, we must deliver to the trustee a legal opinion of our counsel confirming that the deposit, defeasance and discharge will not cause the debt securities to be delisted. However, even if we take these actions, a number of our obligations relating to the debt securities will remain. These include the following obligations: • to register the transfer and exchange of debt securities; • to replace mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen debt securities; • to maintain paying agencies; and • to hold money for payment in trust. Default and Related Matters Ranking • The debt securities are not secured by any of our property or assets. Accordingly, your ownership of debt securities means you are one of our unsecured creditors. The debt securities are not subordinated to any of our other debt obligations and therefore they rank equally with all our other unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness. Events of Default You will have special rights if an event of default occurs and is not cured, as described later in this subsection. What Is an Event of Default? The term “event of default” means, with respect to a debt security, any of the following: • We do not pay the principal or any premium on the debt security at maturity. • We do not pay interest on the debt security within 30 days of its due date. 65


 
• We do not deposit any sinking fund payment for the debt security on its due date. • We remain in breach of a covenant or any other term of the applicable indenture for 90 days after we receive a notice of default stating we are in breach. The notice must be sent by either the trustee or holders of 25% of the principal amount of debt securities of the affected series. • We file for bankruptcy or certain other events if bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization occur. • Any other event of default described above occurs. (Section 501) Remedies If an Event of Default Occurs. If an event of default has occurred and has not been cured, the trustee or the holders of 25% in principal amount of the debt securities of the affected series may declare the entire principal amount of all the debt securities of that series to be due and immediately payable. This is called a declaration of acceleration of maturity. A declaration of acceleration of maturity may be canceled by the holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the debt securities of the affected series if: • all amounts due (as interest, principal and otherwise) are paid or deposited with the trustee; and • all events of default, other than the non­payment of the principal of the debt securities which have become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or waived. (Section 502) Except in cases of default, where the trustee has some special duties, the trustee is not required to take any action under the indenture at the request of any holders unless the holders offer the trustee reasonable protection from expenses and liability. This protection is called an indemnity. (Section 603) If reasonable indemnity is provided, the holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding debt securities of the relevant series may direct the time, method and place of conducting any lawsuit or other formal legal action seeking any remedy available to the trustee. These majority holders may also direct the trustee in performing any other action under the indenture. (Section 512) Before you bypass the trustee and bring your own lawsuit or other formal legal action or take other steps to enforce your rights or protect your interests relating to the debt securities, the following must occur: • You must give the trustee written notice that an event of default has occurred and remains uncured. • The holders of 25% in principal amount of all outstanding debt securities of the relevant series must make a written request that the trustee take action because of the default, and must offer reasonable indemnity to the trustee against the cost and other liabilities of taking that action. • The trustee must have not taken action for 60 days after receipt of the above notice, request and offer of indemnity. (Section 507) We will furnish to the trustee every year a written statement of certain of our officers certifying that, to their knowledge, we are in compliance with the indenture and the debt securities, or else specifying any default. (Section 1008) Regarding the Trustee 66


 
BP and several of its subsidiaries maintain banking relations with the trustee group of companies in the ordinary course of their business. The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A. acts as trustee under other indentures under which BP acts as guarantor. If an event of default occurs, or an event occurs that would be an event of default if the requirements for giving us default notice or our default having to exist for a specific period of time were disregarded, the trustee may in certain circumstances prescribed by the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 be considered to have a conflicting interest with respect to the debt securities or the applicable indenture. In that case, the trustee may be required to resign as trustee under the applicable indenture and we would be required to appoint a successor trustee. 67


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 
Exhibit 12

EXHIBIT 12

Rule 13a—14(a) Certificates

I, Bernard Looney, certify that:

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of BP p.l.c.;

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures
(as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act
Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: 18 March 2020
/s/ Bernard Looney
 
Bernard Looney
 
Chief Executive Officer



I, Brian Gilvary, certify that:

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of BP p.l.c.;

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4. The company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures
(as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act
Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

5. The company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: 18 March 2020
/s/ Brian Gilvary
 
Brian Gilvary
 
Chief Financial Officer


Exhibit 13

Rule 13a — 14(b) Certificates

Certification
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
(Subsections (a) and (b) of Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code)

Pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code), the undersigned officer of BP p.l.c., a company incorporated under the laws of England and Wales (the “company”), hereby certifies, to such officer’s knowledge, that:

The Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019 (the “Report”) of the company fully complies with the requirements of section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the company.

Date: 18 March 2020
/s/ Bernard Looney
 
Bernard Looney
 
Chief Executive Officer

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code) and is not being filed as part of the Report or as a separate disclosure document.

A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906 has been provided to the company and will be retained by the company and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.





Certification
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
(Subsections (a) and (b) of Section 1350, Chapter 63 of Title 18, United States Code)

Pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code), the undersigned officer of BP p.l.c., a company incorporated under the laws of England and Wales (the “company”), hereby certifies, to such officer’s knowledge, that:

The Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019 (the “Report”) of the company fully complies with the requirements of section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the company.

Date: 18 March 2020
/s/ Brian Gilvary
 
Brian Gilvary
 
Chief Financial Officer

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code) and is not being filed as part of the Report or as a separate disclosure document.

A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906 has been provided to the company and will be retained by the company and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.

DeGolyer and MacNaughton 5001 Spring Valley Road Suite 800 East Dallas, Texas 75244 March 11, 2020 BP p.l.c. 1 St. James Square London, SW1Y 4PD United Kingdom Ladies and Gentlemen: We hereby consent to the references to DeGolyer and MacNaughton contained in the section entitled “Oil and gas disclosures for the group” of the Annual Report and Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019, of BP p.l.c. (the Form 20-F), as set forth under the heading “Compliance” on page 309, to the inclusion of our report of third party dated January 15, 2020, concerning our estimates of the net proved oil, condensate, natural gas liquids, and gas reserves, as of December 31, 2019, of certain properties in which PJSC Rosneft Oil Company has represented it holds an interest (the Report of Third Party), which is included as an exhibit to the Form 20-F, and to the incorporation by reference of the reference to DeGolyer and MacNaughton in the Form 20-F and of the Report of Third Party in the Registration Statements on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-226485, 333-226485-01, and 333- 226485-02) of BP p.l.c., BP Capital Markets p.l.c., and BP Capital Markets America Inc. and the Registration Statements on Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-67206, 333-79399, 333-103924, 333- 123482, 333-123483, 333-131583, 333-131584, 333-132619, 333-146868, 333-146870, 333-146873, 333-173136, 333-177423, 333-179406, 333-186462, 333-186463, 333-199015, 333-200794, 333-200795, 333-207188, 333-207189, 333-210316, and 333-210318) of BP p.l.c. Very truly yours, /s/ DeGolyer and MacNaughton DeGOLYER and MacNAUGHTON Texas Registered Engineering Firm F-716


 
DeGolyer and MacNaughton 5001 Spring Valley Road Suite 800 East Dallas, Texas 75244 January 15, 2020 BP Russian Investments Limited Chertsey Road Sunbury on Thames, Middlesex, TW16 7BP United Kingdom Ladies and Gentlemen: Pursuant to your request, this report of third party presents an independent evaluation, as of December 31, 2019, of the extent of the estimated net proved oil, condensate, natural gas liquids (NGL), and gas reserves of certain properties in which PJSC Rosneft Oil Company (ROSNEFT) has represented it holds or controls an interest. This evaluation was completed on January 15, 2020. The fields evaluated consist of working interests located in the Russian Federation, Canada, Egypt, Kurdistan, Iraq, Venezuela, and Vietnam. ROSNEFT has represented that it holds or controls an interest in certain fields located in the Russian Federation either directly or through various subsidiary enterprises. ROSNEFT has represented that all fields are held at 100 percent by the respective subsidiary enterprise. ROSNEFT has represented that its ownership in all the subsidiary enterprises ranges between 20 and 100 percent. ROSNEFT has represented that these properties account for 100 percent on a net equivalent barrel basis of ROSNEFT’s net proved reserves as of December 31, 2019. The net proved reserves estimates have been prepared in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rules 4–10(a) (1)–(32) of Regulation S–X of the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) of the United States. At the request of BP Russian Investments Limited (BP), a wholly owned subsidiary of BP p.l.c., this report was prepared in accordance with guidelines specified in Item 1202(a)(8) of Regulation S–K and is to be used for inclusion in certain SEC filings by BP p.l.c. Also included in this report are interests held through 5 production sharing agreements (PSA) and 10 joint ventures (JV). As represented by ROSNEFT, the PSA holdings include the Sakhalin-1 Project in Russia, the Shorouk Concession in Egypt, the Bijeel field in Kurdistan, the Salman field in Iraq, and Block 6.1 in Vietnam. The JV holdings include 4 JVs in Russia, 10 fields in 5 JVs in Venezuela, and 1 JV in Canada.


 
2 DeGolyer and MacNaughton These subsidiary enterprises, the ROSNEFT direct holdings in the Russian Federation (including those in the Chechen Republic), the Sakhalin-1 Project, the Egyptian PSA, the Kurdish PSA, the Iraqi PSA, the Vietnam PSA, the Russian JVs, the Venezuela JVs, and the Canadian JV are collectively referred to hereinafter as “ROSNEFT Holdings.” BP has represented that it holds a 19.75-percent interest in ROSNEFT Holdings. Certain properties in which ROSNEFT has an interest are subject to the terms of various PSAs. The terms of these PSAs generally allow for working interest participants to be reimbursed for portions of capital costs and operating expenses and to share in the profits. The reimbursements and profit proceeds are converted to a barrel of oil equivalent or standard cubic foot of gas equivalent by dividing by product prices to estimate the “entitlement quantities.” These entitlement quantities are equivalent in principle to net reserves and are used to calculate an equivalent net share, termed an “entitlement interest.” In this report, ROSNEFT net reserves or interest for certain properties subject to these PSAs is the entitlement based on ROSNEFT’s working interest. The reserves estimated herein are reported at 100 percent for those subsidiaries of which ROSNEFT has majority control, either through direct ownership or through voting rights. The estimated reserves for those subsidiaries which ROSNEFT does not control are reported at ROSNEFT’s ownership interest. All of the fields evaluated are located in the Russian Federation, Canada, Egypt, Kurdistan, Iraq, Venezuela, or Vietnam. ROSNEFT has represented that upon completion of the primary term of its current licenses, each of the subsidiary enterprises intends to continue to extend these licenses until the end of the economic lives of the associated fields, and that they intend to proceed accordingly with development and operation of these fields. Based on these representations and consistent with Russian law, we have included as proved reserves those volumes that were estimated to be economically producible from the fields evaluated after the expiration of the primary terms of their licenses. Reserves estimates included herein are expressed as net reserves attributable to or controlled by ROSNEFT (ROSNEFT net). Gross reserves are defined as the total estimated petroleum remaining to be produced from these fields after December 31, 2019. ROSNEFT Net reserves are defined as that portion of the gross reserves attributable to the interests held by ROSNEFT after deducting all interests held by others plus certain interests not held by ROSNEFT, which ROSNEFT has represented that it controls. For the PSAs, these reserves are expressed in terms of the barrel equivalent of the cost recovery and profit share (entitlement) after deducting interests held by others.


 
3 DeGolyer and MacNaughton Estimates of reserves should be regarded only as estimates that may change as further production history and additional information become available. Not only are such estimates based on that information which is currently available, but such estimates are also subject to the uncertainties inherent in the application of judgmental factors in interpreting such information. Information used in the preparation of this report was obtained from ROSNEFT and from public sources. In the preparation of this report we have relied, without independent verification, upon such information furnished by ROSNEFT with respect to the field interests being evaluated, production from such fields, current costs of operation and development, current prices for production, agreements relating to current and future operations and sale of production, and various other information and data that were accepted as represented. A field examination was not considered necessary for the purposes of this report. Definition of Reserves Petroleum reserves estimated by us and included in this report are classified as proved. Only proved reserves have been evaluated for this report. Reserves classifications used by us in this report are in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rules 4–10(a) (1)– (32) of Regulation S–X of the SEC. Reserves are judged to be economically producible in future years from known reservoirs under existing economic and operating conditions and assuming continuation of current regulatory practices using conventional production methods and equipment. In the analyses of production-decline curves, reserves were estimated only to the limit of economic rates of production under existing economic and operating conditions using prices and costs consistent with the effective date of this report, including consideration of changes in existing prices provided only by contractual arrangements but not including escalations based upon future conditions. The petroleum reserves are classified as follows: Proved oil and gas reserves – Proved oil and gas reserves are those quantities of oil and gas, which, by analysis of geoscience and engineering data, can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible—from a given date forward, from known reservoirs, and under existing economic conditions, operating methods, and government regulations—prior to the time at which contracts providing the right to operate expire, unless evidence indicates that renewal is reasonably certain, regardless of whether deterministic or probabilistic methods are used for the estimation. The project to extract the hydrocarbons must have commenced or the operator


 
4 DeGolyer and MacNaughton must be reasonably certain that it will commence the project within a reasonable time. (i) The area of the reservoir considered as proved includes: (A) The area identified by drilling and limited by fluid contacts, if any, and (B) Adjacent undrilled portions of the reservoir that can, with reasonable certainty, be judged to be continuous with it and to contain economically producible oil or gas on the basis of available geoscience and engineering data. (ii) In the absence of data on fluid contacts, proved quantities in a reservoir are limited by the lowest known hydrocarbons (LKH) as seen in a well penetration unless geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establishes a lower contact with reasonable certainty. (iii) Where direct observation from well penetrations has defined a highest known oil (HKO) elevation and the potential exists for an associated gas cap, proved oil reserves may be assigned in the structurally higher portions of the reservoir only if geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establish the higher contact with reasonable certainty. (iv) Reserves which can be produced economically through application of improved recovery techniques (including, but not limited to, fluid injection) are included in the proved classification when: (A) Successful testing by a pilot project in an area of the reservoir with properties no more favorable than in the reservoir as a whole, the operation of an installed program in the reservoir or an analogous reservoir, or other evidence using reliable technology establishes the reasonable certainty of the engineering analysis on which the project or program was based; and (B) The project has been approved for development by all necessary parties and entities, including governmental entities. (v) Existing economic conditions include prices and costs at which economic producibility from a reservoir is to be determined. The price shall be the average price during the 12-month period prior to the


 
5 DeGolyer and MacNaughton ending date of the period covered by the report, determined as an unweighted arithmetic average of the first-day-of-the-month price for each month within such period, unless prices are defined by contractual arrangements, excluding escalations based upon future conditions. Developed oil and gas reserves – Developed oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that can be expected to be recovered: (i) Through existing wells with existing equipment and operating methods or in which the cost of the required equipment is relatively minor compared to the cost of a new well; and (ii) Through installed extraction equipment and infrastructure operational at the time of the reserves estimate if the extraction is by means not involving a well. Undeveloped oil and gas reserves – Undeveloped oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that are expected to be recovered from new wells on undrilled acreage, or from existing wells where a relatively major expenditure is required for recompletion. (i) Reserves on undrilled acreage shall be limited to those directly offsetting development spacing areas that are reasonably certain of production when drilled, unless evidence using reliable technology exists that establishes reasonable certainty of economic producibility at greater distances. (ii) Undrilled locations can be classified as having undeveloped reserves only if a development plan has been adopted indicating that they are scheduled to be drilled within five years, unless the specific circumstances justify a longer time. (iii) Under no circumstances shall estimates for undeveloped reserves be attributable to any acreage for which an application of fluid injection or other improved recovery technique is contemplated, unless such techniques have been proved effective by actual projects in the same reservoir or an analogous reservoir, as defined in [section 210.4–10 (a) Definitions], or by other evidence using reliable technology establishing reasonable certainty.


 
6 DeGolyer and MacNaughton Methodology and Procedures Estimates of reserves were prepared by the use of appropriate geologic, petroleum engineering, and evaluation principles and techniques that are in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rules 4–10(a) (1)–(32) of Regulation S–X of the SEC and with practices generally recognized by the petroleum industry as presented in the publication of the Society of Petroleum Engineers entitled “Standards Pertaining to the Estimating and Auditing of Oil and Gas Reserves Information (revised June 2019) Approved by the SPE Board on 25 June 2019.” The method or combination of methods used in the analysis of each reservoir was tempered by experience with similar reservoirs, stage of development, quality and completeness of basic data, and production history. Based on the current stage of field development, production performance, the development plans provided by ROSNEFT, and analyses of areas offsetting existing wells with test or production data, reserves were classified as proved. The proved undeveloped reserves estimates were based on opportunities identified in the plan of development provided by ROSNEFT. The proved developed non-producing reserves include those quantities associated with behind-pipe zones and include minor remaining capital as compared to the cost of a new well. ROSNEFT has represented that its senior management is committed to the development plan provided by ROSNEFT and that ROSNEFT has the financial capability to execute the development plan, including the drilling and completion of wells and the installation of equipment and facilities. The volumetric method was used to estimate the original oil in place (OOIP) and the original gas in place (OGIP). Structure maps were prepared to delineate each reservoir, and isopach maps were constructed to estimate reservoir volume. Electrical logs, radioactivity logs, core analyses, and other available data were used to prepare these maps as well as to estimate representative values for porosity and water saturation. Estimates of ultimate recovery were obtained after applying recovery factors to OOIP or OGIP. These recovery factors were based on consideration of the type of energy inherent in the reservoirs, analyses of the petroleum, the structural positions of the properties, and the production histories. Other than production data, technical information utilized in the evaluation of the Zohr field located in the Shorouk Concession was limited to information available through the drilling of the sixth development well in 2017. We are not aware of any additional information obtained from the Zohr field that would lead to a material overstatement of the reserves estimated herein.


 
7 DeGolyer and MacNaughton For depletion-type reservoirs or those whose performance disclosed a reliable decline in producing-rate trends or other diagnostic characteristics, reserves were estimated by the application of appropriate decline curves or other performance relationships. In the analyses of production-decline curves, reserves were estimated only to the limits of economic production as defined under the Definition of Reserves heading of this report or to the limit of the production licenses as appropriate. In certain cases, reserves were estimated by incorporating elements of analogy with similar wells or reservoirs for which more complete data were available. Data provided by ROSNEFT from wells drilled through December 2019 and made available for this evaluation were used to prepare the reserves estimates herein. These reserves estimates were based on consideration of monthly production data available for certain properties only through June 2019. Estimated cumulative production, as of December 31, 2019, was deducted from the estimated gross ultimate recovery to estimate gross reserves. This required that production be estimated for up to 6 months. Estimates of prices, as of December 31, 2019, were used in calculations to estimate the entitlement reserves for properties in the Sakhalin-1, Vietnam Block 6.1, Egyptian, Kurdish, and Iraqi PSAs. Oil and condensate reserves estimated herein are to be recovered by normal field separation. NGL reserves estimated herein include pentanes and heavier fractions (C5+) and liquefied petroleum gas (LPG), which consists primarily of propane and butane fractions, and are the result of low-temperature plant processing. Oil, condensate, and NGL reserves included in this report are expressed in thousands of barrels (103bbl). In these estimates, 1 barrel equals 42 United States gallons. For reporting purposes, oil and condensate reserves have been estimated separately and are presented herein as a summed quantity. Gas reserves estimated herein are expressed as fuel gas, sales gas, and marketable gas. Fuel gas is that portion of the total volume of gas to be produced from the reservoirs used in the operation of the field; in certain cases, fuel gas also represents the estimated volume of gas utilized in existing and future power-generation plants. ROSNEFT provided information about currently operating and future plants, including a schedule of operation, plant inlet rates, fields associated with each plant, and pertinent economic parameters. Sales gas is defined as the total volume of gas to be produced from the reservoirs, measured at the point of delivery, available for sales, after deduction for fuel usage, flare, and shrinkage resulting from field separation and processing. Marketable gas is defined as the sum of fuel gas and sales gas.


 
8 DeGolyer and MacNaughton The fuel gas quantities included as a portion of ROSNEFT net marketable gas reserves, as of December 31, 2019, are summarized as follows, expressed in millions of cubic feet (106ft3): Fuel Gas Portion of ROSNEFT Net Marketable Gas Reserves (106ft3) Proved Developed Producing 2,028,841 Proved Developed Non-Producing 318,140 Proved Developed 2,346,981 Proved Undeveloped 955,194 Total Proved 3,302,175 Gas reserves estimated herein are expressed at a temperature base of 20 degrees Celsius (°C) and at a pressure base of 1 atmosphere (atm). Gas reserves included in this report are expressed herein in millions of cubic feet (106ft3). Gas reserves are identified by the type of reservoir from which the gas will be produced. Nonassociated gas is gas at initial reservoir conditions with no oil present in the reservoir. Associated gas is both gas-cap gas and solution gas. Gas-cap gas is gas at initial reservoir conditions and is in communication with an underlying oil zone. Solution gas is gas dissolved in oil at initial reservoir conditions. Gas reserves estimated herein include both associated and nonassociated gas. ROSNEFT has represented that most of gas produced from the fields evaluated herein and located in the Unified gas supply system zone will be delivered to market through the Gazprom Gas Transmission System (GTS). In accordance with Russian Federation Resolution no. 858, dated July 14, 1997, ROSNEFT is entitled to access to the GTS for transportation and delivery of gas. Additionally, Russian Federation Resolution no. 1021, dated December 29, 2000, obligates Gazprom and its affiliates to sell gas, produced by Gazprom and its affiliates, at a price within a range of wholesale prices regulated by the Federal Anti-Monopoly Service with adjustment for the energy value of the gas, and permits Gazprom to collect a service charge for retail distribution. The range of prices is established for each Russian region where the gas is sold. ROSNEFT has represented that all gas not used for fuel will be sold, whether at an agreed-upon contract price or at the lower price associated with gas sales through the GTS. Sales gas reserves have been estimated herein on the basis of these representations. ROSNEFT provided sales gas prices to be used for the estimation of the value of the gas reserves reported herein, and it has represented that these prices are consistent with the conditions described above.


 
9 DeGolyer and MacNaughton Primary Economic Assumptions This report has been prepared using initial prices, expenses, and costs provided by ROSNEFT in United States dollars (U.S.$). Future prices were estimated using guidelines established by the SEC and the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB). The following economic assumptions were used for estimating the reserves reported herein: Oil and Condensate Prices ROSNEFT has represented that the sales prices of oil and condensate were based on a 12-month average price (reference price), calculated as the unweighted arithmetic average of the first-day-of-the-month price for each month within the 12-month period prior to the end of the reporting period, unless prices are defined by contractual arrangements. ROSNEFT supplied oil and condensate prices, which were based on a Urals reference price of 29,579 Russian rubles per metric ton (U.S.$62.31 per barrel). The Urals reference oil price is an average of the Urals (MED) and Urals (Rdam) prices as published in the Platts Oilgram Price Report. For the ROSNEFT Holdings in the Russian Federation (including those in both the Chechen Republic and the Sakhalin-1 Project), the volume-weighted average oil and condensate prices over the lives of the fields were U.S.$53.46 per barrel and U.S.$45.72 per barrel, respectively. For the JV holding in Canada, ROSNEFT supplied differentials to an Edmonton Light Oil reference price of U.S.$52.29 per barrel and the prices were held constant thereafter. The volume-weighted average oil price over the lives of the fields in the Canadian JV was U.S.$47.33 per barrel. For the JV holdings in Venezuela, ROSNEFT has represented that the Brent oil reference price of U.S.$62.74 per barrel was used. ROSNEFT provided differentials to the reference price for each of the Venezuelan fields. Prices were held constant. The volume-weighted average oil price over the lives of the fields for the Venezuelan holdings was U.S.$49.99 per barrel. For the PSA holdings in Vietnam, ROSNEFT has represented that the Brent oil reference price of U.S.$62.74 per barrel was used. The volume-weighted average price of the condensate over the lives of the fields for the Vietnamese holdings was U.S.$62.74 per barrel. For the PSA holdings in Egypt, ROSNEFT has represented that the Brent oil reference price of U.S.$62.74 per barrel was used. The


 
10 DeGolyer and MacNaughton volume-weighted average price of condensate over the lives of the fields for the Egyptian holdings was U.S.$58.66 per barrel. NGL Prices For the ROSNEFT Holdings in the Russian Federation (including those in the Chechen Republic), the volume-weighted average NGL price over the lives of the fields was U.S.$11.09 per barrel. For the JV holding in Canada, ROSNEFT supplied an NGL price of U.S.$13.73 per barrel and the prices were held constant thereafter. Gas Prices For the ROSNEFT Holdings in the Russian Federation (including those in both the Chechen Republic and the Sakhalin-1 Project), the volume- weighted average price over the lives of the fields was U.S.$1.03 per thousand cubic feet (103ft3). For the JV holding in Canada, ROSNEFT supplied differentials to an Alberta Export Canadian metering outlet (AECO) reference price of U.S.$1.61 per 103ft3 and the prices were held constant thereafter. The volume-weighted average gas price over the lives of the fields in the Canadian JV was U.S.$1.03 per 103ft3. For the Petromonagas field in Venezuela, ROSNEFT supplied a domestic sales gas price of U.S.$0.005 per 103ft3, which was held constant for the life of the field. For the PSA holdings in Vietnam, ROSNEFT has represented that sales gas is priced according to terms of a Gas Sales Agreement. The volume-weighted average gas price over the lives of the Vietnamese fields was U.S.$3.04 per 103ft3. For the PSA holdings in Egypt, ROSNEFT has represented that sales gas is priced according to terms of a Gas Sales Agreement. The volume-weighted average gas price over the lives of the Egyptian fields was U.S.$5.70 per 103ft3. Expenses and Costs Current expenses and costs, and forecasts of expenses and costs, provided by ROSNEFT were used in estimating future expenditures required to operate the fields. In certain cases, future expenditures, either higher or lower than current expenditures, may have been used because of anticipated changes in operating conditions, but no general escalation that might result from inflation was applied.


 
11 DeGolyer and MacNaughton In our opinion, the information relating to estimated proved reserves of oil, condensate, NGL, and gas contained in this report has been prepared in accordance with Paragraphs 932-235-50-4 and 932-235-50-6 through 932-235-50-9 of the Accounting Standards Update 932-235-50, Extractive Industries – Oil and Gas (Topic 932): Oil and Gas Reserve Estimation and Disclosures (January 2010) of the FASB and Rules 4–10(a) (1)–(32) of Regulation S–X and Rules 302(b), 1201, 1202(a) (1), (2), (3), (4), (8), (i), (ii), and (v)–(x) and 1203(a) of Regulation S–K of the SEC; provided, however, that (i) estimates of proved developed and proved undeveloped reserves are not presented at the beginning of the year, (ii) certain proved undeveloped reserves are scheduled for development more than 5 years in the future, and (iii) certain economically producible quantities of reserves beyond the primary term of the current production licenses have been classified as proved reserves in this report based on ROSNEFT’s representation that each of the subsidiary enterprises discussed therein has the ability to and intends to extend the applicable current production licenses to the end of the economic lives of the associated fields and that ROSNEFT believes with reasonable certainty that the inclusion of the reserves and revenue under extended license terms is consistent with SEC regulations. ROSNEFT has represented to us that the Russian Law on Subsoil requires that an operator develop a field according to a development plan that has been submitted to and approved by the appropriate government authority. Once approved, failure to follow the development plan is a violation of the Russian Law on Subsoil and may result in the cancellation of the operator’s production license for the field. Since the implementation of the approved development plan, including that portion that may occur more than 5 years in the future, is a requirement for maintaining the production license, we have included in certain of our estimates of SEC proved reserves those quantities associated with development activities that are part of the approved development plan and scheduled more than 5 years in the future. We believe that, since they must be developed to prevent the loss of licenses, there is reasonable certainty that the reserves will be developed. We believe it is reasonable therefore to include these quantities as SEC proved reserves. ROSNEFT has represented to us that the development plans provided to us are in accordance with the approved development plans. We cannot render an opinion regarding the actual possibility that a license will be terminated for failure to follow approved development plans nor an opinion on how many companies have lost their licenses for not following approved development plans. We are not in a position to offer an opinion on the duration of the subsidiary enterprises’ production licenses under the Russian Law on Subsoil, but, in light of the above, believe ROSNEFT’s view on the probability of license extensions to be reasonable, although


 
12 DeGolyer and MacNaughton such view may not be confirmed by the SEC. We believe it is reasonable therefore to include these quantities as SEC proved reserves. To the extent the above-enumerated rules, regulations, and statements require determinations of an accounting or legal nature, we, as engineers, are necessarily unable to express an opinion as to whether the above-described information is in accordance therewith or sufficient therefor.


 
13 DeGolyer and MacNaughton Summary of Conclusions The estimated ROSNEFT net proved reserves, as of December 31, 2019, of the fields evaluated herein were based on the definition of proved reserves of the SEC and are summarized as follows, expressed in thousands of barrels (103bbl) and millions of cubic feet (106ft3): ROSNEFT Net Reserves Oil and Marketable Sales Reserves Condensate NGL Gas Gas Rosneft Holdings Classification (103bbl) (103bbl) (106ft3) (106ft3) Russia Proved Developed Producing 12,750,014 267,654 22,909,093 20,911,293 Proved Developed Non-Producing 2,955,663 182,240 12,650,813 12,332,673 Proved Developed 15,705,677 449,894 35,559,906 33,243,966 Proved Undeveloped 12,508,287 264,075 38,190,356 37,235,162 Total Proved 28,213,964 713,969 73,750,262 70,479,128 Canada Proved Developed Producing 177 105 776 776 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 177 105 776 776 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 177 105 776 776 Egypt Proved Developed Producing 1,608 0 886,999 855,958 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 1,608 0 886,999 855,958 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 1,608 0 886,999 855,958 Kurdistan Proved Developed Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 0 0 0 0 Proved Undeveloped 2,255 0 0 0 Total Proved 2,255 0 0 0 Iraq Proved Developed Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 0 0 0 0 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 0 0 0 0 Venezuela Proved Developed Producing 76,001 0 77,384 77,384 Proved Developed Non-Producing 1,038 0 0 0 Proved Developed 77,039 0 77,384 77,384 Proved Undeveloped 104,825 0 65,592 65,592 Total Proved 181,864 0 142,976 142,976


 
14 DeGolyer and MacNaughton Table – (Continued) ROSNEFT Net Reserves Oil and Marketable Sales Reserves Condensate NGL Gas Gas Rosneft Holdings Classification (103bbl) (103bbl) (106ft3) (106ft3) Vietnam Proved Developed Producing 104 0 50,958 50,958 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 104 0 50,958 50,958 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 104 0 50,958 50,958 Total Proved Developed Producing 12,827,904 267,759 23,925,210 21,896,369 Proved Developed Non-Producing 2,956,701 182,240 12,650,813 12,332,673 Proved Developed 15,784,605 449,999 36,576,023 34,229,042 Proved Undeveloped 12,615,367 264,075 38,255,948 37,300,754 Total Proved 28,399,972 714,074 74,831,971 71,529,796 Note: ROSNEFT has represented that it controls the management of certain of the ROSNEFT Holdings in Russia through various subsidiary enterprises. For those ROSNEFT Holdings controlled by ROSNEFT, 100 percent of the reserves are reported herein as ROSNEFT net reserves and include those reserves not directly held by ROSNEFT. The estimated ROSNEFT net proved reserves, as of December 31, 2019, attributable to the evaluated fields, adjusted for BP’s ownership interest of 19.75 percent, are summarized as follows, expressed in thousands of barrels (103bbl) and millions of cubic feet (106ft3): BP Share of ROSNEFT Net Reserves Oil and Marketable Sales Reserves Condensate NGL Gas Gas Country Classification (103bbl) (103bbl) (106ft3) (106ft3) Russia Proved Developed Producing 2,518,128 52,862 4,524,546 4,129,980 Proved Developed Non-Producing 583,743 35,992 2,498,535 2,435,703 Proved Developed 3,101,871 88,854 7,023,081 6,565,683 Proved Undeveloped 2,470,387 52,155 7,542,596 7,353,945 Total Proved 5,572,258 141,009 14,565,677 13,919,628 Canada Proved Developed Producing 35 21 153 153 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 35 21 153 153 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 35 21 153 153 Egypt Proved Developed Producing 318 0 175,182 169,052 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 318 0 175,182 169,052 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 318 0 175,182 169,052 Table – (Continued)


 
15 DeGolyer and MacNaughton BP Share of ROSNEFT Net Reserves Oil and Marketable Sales Reserves Condensate NGL Gas Gas Country Classification (103bbl) (103bbl) (106ft3) (106ft3) Kurdistan Proved Developed Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 0 0 0 0 Proved Undeveloped 445 0 0 0 Total Proved 445 0 0 0 Iraq Proved Developed Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 0 0 0 0 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 0 0 0 0 Venezuela Proved Developed Producing 15,010 0 15,283 15,283 Proved Developed Non-Producing 205 0 0 0 Proved Developed 15,215 0 15,283 15,283 Proved Undeveloped 20,703 0 12,955 12,955 Total Proved 35,918 0 28,238 28,238 Vietnam Proved Developed Producing 21 0 10,064 10,064 Proved Developed Non-Producing 0 0 0 0 Proved Developed 21 0 10,064 10,064 Proved Undeveloped 0 0 0 0 Total Proved 21 0 10,064 10,064 Total Proved Developed Producing 2,533,512 52,883 4,725,228 4,324,532 Proved Developed Non-Producing 583,948 35,992 2,498,535 2,435,703 Proved Developed 3,117,460 88,875 7,223,763 6,760,235 Proved Undeveloped 2,491,535 52,155 7,555,551 7,366,900 Total Proved 5,608,995 141,030 14,779,314 14,127,135 BP has represented that the BP share of ROSNEFT net reserves account for 43 percent of BP net proved reserves as of December 31, 2019, on a barrel of oil equivalent basis. In addition to the 19.75-percent net interest in ROSNEFT’s net reserves, BP also holds a separate direct ownership interest in two of the ROSNEFT subsidiary enterprises in Russia: 49-percent interest in Kharampurneftegaz and 20-percent interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazdobycha. This direct ownership interest is referred to hereinafter as “BP Holdings.” The estimates of BP Holdings’ net proved reserves, as of December 31, 2019, attributable to the evaluated fields are summarized as follows, expressed in thousands of barrels (103bbl) and millions of cubic feet (106ft3): BP Holdings Net Reserves


 
16 DeGolyer and MacNaughton Oil and Marketable Sales Reserves Condensate NGL Gas Gas BP Holdings Classification (103bbl) (103bbl) (106ft3) (106ft3) Kharampurneftegaz Proved Developed Producing 41,272 26,957 89,286 89,286 Proved Developed Non-Producing 1,530 11,355 2,252,770 2,252,770 Proved Developed 42,802 38,312 2,342,056 2,342,056 Proved Undeveloped 44,061 13,955 2,904,716 2,904,716 Total Proved 86,863 52,267 5,246,772 5,246,772 Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazdobycha Proved Developed Producing 20,674 0 13,753 0 Proved Developed Non-Producing 731 0 133 0 Proved Developed 21,405 0 13,886 0 Proved Undeveloped 20,988 0 2,029 0 Total Proved 42,393 0 15,915 0 Total Proved Developed Producing 61,946 26,957 103,039 89,286 Proved Developed Non-Producing 3,791 22,710 4,505,673 4,505,540 Proved Developed 64,207 38,312 2,355,942 2,342,056 Proved Undeveloped 109,110 27,910 5,811,461 5,809,432 Total Proved 129,256 52,267 5,262,687 5,246,772 The BP Holdings net reserves shown above are included in the ROSNEFT net reserves shown herein. Additionally, a portion of the BP Holdings net reserves shown above is included in the BP share of ROSNEFT net reserves shown herein. BP has represented that the BP Holdings net reserves account for 3 percent of BP net proved reserves as of December 31, 2019, on a barrel of oil equivalent basis. While the oil and gas industry may be subject to regulatory changes from time to time that could affect an industry participant’s ability to recover its reserves, we are not aware of any such governmental actions which would restrict the recovery of the December 31, 2019, estimated reserves.


 
17 DeGolyer and MacNaughton DeGolyer and MacNaughton is an independent petroleum engineering consulting firm that has been providing petroleum consulting services throughout the world since 1936. DeGolyer and MacNaughton does not have any financial interest, including stock ownership, in ROSNEFT or BP. Our fees were not contingent on the results of our evaluation. This report has been prepared at the request of BP. DeGolyer and MacNaughton has used all methods and procedures as it considered necessary under the circumstance to prepare this report. All assumptions, data, procedures, and methods used to prepare this report are considered by DeGolyer and MacNaughton to be appropriate for the purposes served by this report. Submitted, DeGOLYER and MacNAUGHTON Texas Registered Engineering Firm F-716 /s/ Thomas D. Scott, Jr. Thomas D. Scott, Jr., T.P.G., C.P.G. [Seal] Senior Vice President DeGolyer and MacNaughton /s/ Michael A. Eubanks Michael A. Eubanks, P.E. [Seal] Vice President DeGolyer and MacNaughton


 
DeGolyer and MacNaughton CERTIFICATE of QUALIFICATION I, Thomas D. Scott, Jr., Petroleum Geologist and Texas Professional Geoscientist with DeGolyer and MacNaughton, 5001 Spring Valley Road, Suite 800 East, Dallas, Texas, 75244 U.S.A., hereby certify: 1. That I am a Senior Vice President with DeGolyer and MacNaughton, which firm did prepare the report of third party addressed to BP dated January 10, 2020, and that I, as Senior Vice President, was responsible for the preparation of this report of third party. 2. That I attended the University of Oklahoma, and that I graduated with a Master of Science degree in Geology in the year 1988; that I am a Registered Certified Professional Geologist in the State of Texas; that I am a Registered Professional Geologist with the American Association of Petroleum Geologists; and that I have in excess of 30 years of experience in oil and gas reservoir studies and evaluations. /s/ Thomas D. Scott, Jr. Thomas D. Scott, Jr., T.P.G., C.P.G. [Seal] Senior Vice President DeGolyer and MacNaughton


 
DeGolyer and MacNaughton CERTIFICATE of QUALIFICATION I, Michael A. Eubanks, Petroleum Engineer with DeGolyer and MacNaughton, 5001 Spring Valley Road, Suite 800 East, Dallas, Texas, 75244 U.S.A., hereby certify: 1. That I am a Vice President with DeGolyer and MacNaughton, which firm did prepare the report of third party addressed to BP dated January 10, 2020, and that I, as Vice President, was responsible for the preparation of this report of third party. 2. That I attended the University of Texas at Austin, and that I graduated with a Bachelor of Science degree in Petroleum Engineering in the year 2005; that I am a Registered Professional Engineer in the State of Texas; and that I have in excess of 14 years of experience in oil and gas reservoir studies and evaluations. /s/ Michael A. Eubanks Michael A. Eubanks, P.E. [Seal] Vice President DeGolyer and MacNaughton


 
EXHIBIT 15.3 CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PETROLEUM ENGINEERS AND GEOLOGISTS We hereby consent to the reference to Netherland, Sewell & Associates contained in the section entitled “Oil and gas disclosures for the group” of the Annual Report and Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019, of BP p.l.c. (the Form 20-F), as set forth under the heading “Compliance” on page 309, to the inclusion of our third-party letter report dated March 3, 2020, concerning our estimates of the proved reserves and future revenue, as of December 31, 2019, to the BP America Production Company interest in certain oil and gas properties located in the United States (the Third-Party Report), which is included as an exhibit to the Form 20-F, and to the incorporation by reference of the reference to Netherland, Sewell & Associates in the Form 20-F and of the Third-Party Report in the following Registration Statements: Registration Statement on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-226485, 333-226485-01, and 333-226485-02) of BP p.l.c., BP Capital Markets p.l.c., and BP Capital Markets America Inc.; and Registration Statements on Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-67206, 333-79399, 333-103924, 333-123482, 333-123483, 333-131583, 333-131584, 333-132619, 333-146868, 333-146870, 333-146873, 333-173136, 333- 177423, 333-179406, 333-186462, 333-186463, 333-199015, 333-200794, 333-200795, 333- 207188, 333-207189, 333-210316 and 333-210318) of BP p.l.c. NETHERLAND, SEWELL & ASSOCIATES, INC. /s/ Danny D. Simmons By: ____________________________________ Danny D. Simmons, P.E. President and Chief Operating Officer Houston, Texas March 18, 2020


 
March 3, 2020 Mr. Kyle Koontz BP America Production Company 1700 Platte Street, Suite 150 Denver, Colorado 80202 Dear Mr. Koontz: In accordance with your request, we have estimated the proved reserves and future revenue, as of December 31, 2019, to the BP America Production Company (BP) interest in certain oil and gas properties located in the United States. We completed our evaluation on January 15, 2020. It is our understanding that the proved reserves estimated in this report constitute all of the proved reserves within BP's U.S. Lower 48 business unit and that the proved reserves within BP's U.S. Lower 48 business unit represent 21 percent of the BP p.l.c. subsidiaries' proved reserves. The estimates in this report have been prepared in accordance with the definitions and regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) and, with the exception of the exclusion of future income taxes, conform to the FASB Accounting Standards Codification Topic 932, Extractive Activities—Oil and Gas. Definitions are presented immediately following this letter. This report has been prepared for BP p.l.c.'s use in filing with the SEC; in our opinion the assumptions, data, methods, and procedures used in the preparation of this report are appropriate for such purpose. We estimate the net reserves and future net revenue to the BP interest in these properties, as of December 31, 2019, to be: Net Reserves Future Net Revenue (M$) Oil NGL Gas Present Worth Category (MBBL) (MBBL) (MMCF) Total at 10% Proved Developed Producing 103,735.0 124,764.4 4,565,652.8 6,513,417.0 4,066,910.5 Proved Undeveloped 402,419.7 231,479.1 1,926,199.7 9,090,807.2 2,863,876.1 Total Proved 506,154.7 356,243.5 6,491,852.5 15,604,224.2 6,930,786.6 The oil volumes shown include crude oil and condensate. Oil and natural gas liquids (NGL) volumes are expressed in thousands of barrels (MBBL); a barrel is equivalent to 42 United States gallons. Gas volumes are expressed in millions of cubic feet (MMCF) at standard temperature and pressure bases. Reserves categorization conveys the relative degree of certainty; reserves subcategorization is based on development and production status. Our study indicates that as of December 31, 2019, there are no proved developed non-producing, probable, or possible reserves for these properties. The estimates of reserves and future revenue included herein have not been adjusted for risk. This report does not include any value that could be attributed to interests in undeveloped acreage beyond those tracts for which undeveloped reserves have been estimated. Gross revenue is BP's share of the gross (100 percent) revenue from the properties prior to any deductions. Future net revenue is after deductions for BP's share of production taxes, ad valorem taxes, capital costs, abandonment costs, and operating expenses but before consideration of any income taxes. The future net revenue has been discounted at an annual rate of 10 percent to determine its present worth, which is shown to indicate the effect of time on the value of money. Future net revenue presented in this report, whether discounted or undiscounted, should not be construed as being the fair market value of the properties. Prices used in this report are based on the 12-month unweighted arithmetic average of the first-day-of-the-month price for each month in the period January through December 2019. For oil and NGL volumes, the average West


 
Texas Intermediate Platt's Mth1 (Adj) Mid spot price of $55.929 per barrel is adjusted for quality, transportation fees, and market differentials. For gas volumes, the average Louisiana-Onshore South Henry Hub spot price of $2.578 per MMBTU is adjusted for energy content, transportation fees, and market differentials. All prices are held constant throughout the lives of the properties. The average adjusted product prices weighted by production over the remaining lives of the properties are $54.421 per barrel of oil, $18.164 per barrel of NGL, and $1.708 per MCF of gas. Operating costs used in this report are based on operating expense records of BP. For the nonoperated properties, these costs include the per-well overhead expenses allowed under joint operating agreements along with estimates of costs to be incurred at and below the district and field levels. As requested, operating costs for the operated properties are limited to direct lease- and field-level costs and BP's estimate of the portion of its headquarters general and administrative overhead expenses necessary to operate the properties. Operating costs have been divided into field-level costs, per-well costs, and per-unit-of-production costs and are not escalated for inflation. Capital costs used in this report were provided by BP and are based on authorizations for expenditure, budget estimates, and actual costs from recent activity. Capital costs are included as required for new development wells and production equipment. Based on our understanding of future development plans, a review of the records provided to us, and our knowledge of similar properties, we regard these estimated capital costs to be reasonable. Abandonment costs used in this report are BP's estimates of the costs to abandon the wells and production facilities, net of any salvage value. Capital costs and abandonment costs are not escalated for inflation. For the purposes of this report, we did not perform any field inspection of the properties, nor did we examine the mechanical operation or condition of the wells and facilities. We have not investigated possible environmental liability related to the properties; therefore, our estimates do not include any costs due to such possible liability. We have made no investigation of potential volume and value imbalances resulting from overdelivery or underdelivery to the BP interest. Therefore, our estimates of reserves and future revenue do not include adjustments for the settlement of any such imbalances; our projections are based on BP receiving its net revenue interest share of estimated future gross production. Additionally, although we are aware of firm transportation contracts that are in place for these properties, the associated costs are considered by BP to be corporate-level expenses; no adjustments have been made to our estimates of future revenue to account for such contracts. The reserves shown in this report are estimates only and should not be construed as exact quantities. Proved reserves are those quantities of oil and gas which, by analysis of engineering and geoscience data, can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible; probable and possible reserves are those additional reserves which are sequentially less certain to be recovered than proved reserves. Estimates of reserves may increase or decrease as a result of market conditions, future operations, changes in regulations, or actual reservoir performance. In addition to the primary economic assumptions discussed herein, our estimates are based on certain assumptions including, but not limited to, that the properties will be developed consistent with current development plans as provided to us by BP, that the properties will be operated in a prudent manner, that no governmental regulations or controls will be put in place that would impact the ability of the interest owner to recover the reserves, and that our projections of future production will prove consistent with actual performance. If the reserves are recovered, the revenues therefrom and the costs related thereto could be more or less than the estimated amounts. Because of governmental policies and uncertainties of supply and demand, the sales rates, prices received for the reserves, and costs incurred in recovering such reserves may vary from assumptions made while preparing this report. For the purposes of this report, we used technical and economic data including, but not limited to, well logs, geologic maps, seismic data, well test data, production data, historical price and cost information, and property ownership interests. The reserves in this report have been estimated using deterministic methods; these estimates have been prepared in accordance with the Standards Pertaining to the Estimating and Auditing of Oil and Gas Reserves Information promulgated by the Society of Petroleum Engineers (SPE Standards). We used standard engineering and geoscience methods, or a combination of methods, including performance analysis, volumetric analysis,


 
analogy, and reservoir modeling, that we considered to be appropriate and necessary to categorize and estimate reserves in accordance with SEC definitions and regulations. A substantial portion of these reserves are for undeveloped locations and producing wells that lack sufficient production history upon which performance-related estimates of reserves can be based; such reserves are based on estimates of reservoir volumes and recovery efficiencies along with analogy to properties with similar geologic and reservoir characteristics. As in all aspects of oil and gas evaluation, there are uncertainties inherent in the interpretation of engineering and geoscience data; therefore, our conclusions necessarily represent only informed professional judgment. The data used in our estimates were obtained from BP, public data sources, and the nonconfidential files of Netherland, Sewell & Associates, Inc. (NSAI) and were accepted as accurate. Supporting work data are on file in our office. We have not examined the titles to the properties or independently confirmed the actual degree or type of interest owned. The technical persons primarily responsible for preparing the estimates presented herein meet the requirements regarding qualifications, independence, objectivity, and confidentiality set forth in the SPE Standards. C. Ashley Smith, a Licensed Professional Engineer in the State of Texas, has been practicing consulting petroleum engineering at NSAI since 2006 and has over 5 years of prior industry experience. Mike K. Norton, a Licensed Professional Geoscientist in the State of Texas, has been practicing consulting petroleum geoscience at NSAI since 1989 and has over 10 years of prior industry experience. We are independent petroleum engineers, geologists, geophysicists, and petrophysicists; we do not own an interest in these properties nor are we employed on a contingent basis. Sincerely, NETHERLAND, SEWELL & ASSOCIATES, INC. Texas Registered Engineering Firm F-2699 /s/ C.H. (Scott) Rees III By: C.H. (Scott) Rees III, P.E. Chairman and Chief Executive Officer /s/ C. Ashley Smith /s/ Mike K. Norton By: By: C. Ashley Smith, P.E. 100560 Mike K. Norton, P.G. 441 Vice President Senior Vice President Date Signed: March 3, 2020 Date Signed: March 3, 2020 CAS:MSS


 
DEFINITIONS OF OIL AND GAS RESERVES Adapted from U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a) The following definitions are set forth in U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a). Also included is supplemental information from (1) the 2018 Petroleum Resources Management System approved by the Society of Petroleum Engineers, (2) the FASB Accounting Standards Codification Topic 932, Extractive Activities—Oil and Gas, and (3) the SEC's Compliance and Disclosure Interpretations. (1) Acquisition of properties. Costs incurred to purchase, lease or otherwise acquire a property, including costs of lease bonuses and options to purchase or lease properties, the portion of costs applicable to minerals when land including mineral rights is purchased in fee, brokers' fees, recording fees, legal costs, and other costs incurred in acquiring properties. (2) Analogous reservoir. Analogous reservoirs, as used in resources assessments, have similar rock and fluid properties, reservoir conditions (depth, temperature, and pressure) and drive mechanisms, but are typically at a more advanced stage of development than the reservoir of interest and thus may provide concepts to assist in the interpretation of more limited data and estimation of recovery. When used to support proved reserves, an "analogous reservoir" refers to a reservoir that shares the following characteristics with the reservoir of interest: (i) Same geological formation (but not necessarily in pressure communication with the reservoir of interest); (ii) Same environment of deposition; (iii) Similar geological structure; and (iv) Same drive mechanism. Instruction to paragraph (a)(2): Reservoir properties must, in the aggregate, be no more favorable in the analog than in the reservoir of interest. (3) Bitumen. Bitumen, sometimes referred to as natural bitumen, is petroleum in a solid or semi-solid state in natural deposits with a viscosity greater than 10,000 centipoise measured at original temperature in the deposit and atmospheric pressure, on a gas free basis. In its natural state it usually contains sulfur, metals, and other non-hydrocarbons. (4) Condensate. Condensate is a mixture of hydrocarbons that exists in the gaseous phase at original reservoir temperature and pressure, but that, when produced, is in the liquid phase at surface pressure and temperature. (5) Deterministic estimate. The method of estimating reserves or resources is called deterministic when a single value for each parameter (from the geoscience, engineering, or economic data) in the reserves calculation is used in the reserves estimation procedure. (6) Developed oil and gas reserves. Developed oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that can be expected to be recovered: (i) Through existing wells with existing equipment and operating methods or in which the cost of the required equipment is relatively minor compared to the cost of a new well; and (ii) Through installed extraction equipment and infrastructure operational at the time of the reserves estimate if the extraction is by means not involving a well. Supplemental definitions from the 2018 Petroleum Resources Management System: Developed Producing Reserves – Expected quantities to be recovered from completion intervals that are open and producing at the effective date of the estimate. Improved recovery Reserves are considered producing only after the improved recovery project is in operation. Developed Non-Producing Reserves – Shut-in and behind-pipe Reserves. Shut-in Reserves are expected to be recovered from (1) completion intervals that are open at the time of the estimate but which have not yet started producing, (2) wells which were shut-in for market conditions or pipeline connections, or (3) wells not capable of production for mechanical reasons. Behind-pipe Reserves are expected to be recovered from zones in existing wells that will require additional completion work or future re-completion before start of production with minor cost to access these reserves. In all cases, production can be initiated or restored with relatively low expenditure compared to the cost of drilling a new well. (7) Development costs. Costs incurred to obtain access to proved reserves and to provide facilities for extracting, treating, gathering and storing the oil and gas. More specifically, development costs, including depreciation and applicable operating costs of support equipment and facilities and other costs of development activities, are costs incurred to: (i) Gain access to and prepare well locations for drilling, including surveying well locations for the purpose of determining specific development drilling sites, clearing ground, draining, road building, and relocating public roads, gas lines, and power lines, to the extent necessary in developing the proved reserves. (ii) Drill and equip development wells, development-type stratigraphic test wells, and service wells, including the costs of platforms and of well equipment such as casing, tubing, pumping equipment, and the wellhead assembly. Definitions - Page 1 of 6


 
DEFINITIONS OF OIL AND GAS RESERVES Adapted from U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a) (iii) Acquire, construct, and install production facilities such as lease flow lines, separators, treaters, heaters, manifolds, measuring devices, and production storage tanks, natural gas cycling and processing plants, and central utility and waste disposal systems. (iv) Provide improved recovery systems. (8) Development project. A development project is the means by which petroleum resources are brought to the status of economically producible. As examples, the development of a single reservoir or field, an incremental development in a producing field, or the integrated development of a group of several fields and associated facilities with a common ownership may constitute a development project. (9) Development well. A well drilled within the proved area of an oil or gas reservoir to the depth of a stratigraphic horizon known to be productive. (10) Economically producible. The term economically producible, as it relates to a resource, means a resource which generates revenue that exceeds, or is reasonably expected to exceed, the costs of the operation. The value of the products that generate revenue shall be determined at the terminal point of oil and gas producing activities as defined in paragraph (a)(16) of this section. (11) Estimated ultimate recovery (EUR). Estimated ultimate recovery is the sum of reserves remaining as of a given date and cumulative production as of that date. (12) Exploration costs. Costs incurred in identifying areas that may warrant examination and in examining specific areas that are considered to have prospects of containing oil and gas reserves, including costs of drilling exploratory wells and exploratory- type stratigraphic test wells. Exploration costs may be incurred both before acquiring the related property (sometimes referred to in part as prospecting costs) and after acquiring the property. Principal types of exploration costs, which include depreciation and applicable operating costs of support equipment and facilities and other costs of exploration activities, are: (i) Costs of topographical, geographical and geophysical studies, rights of access to properties to conduct those studies, and salaries and other expenses of geologists, geophysical crews, and others conducting those studies. Collectively, these are sometimes referred to as geological and geophysical or "G&G" costs. (ii) Costs of carrying and retaining undeveloped properties, such as delay rentals, ad valorem taxes on properties, legal costs for title defense, and the maintenance of land and lease records. (iii) Dry hole contributions and bottom hole contributions. (iv) Costs of drilling and equipping exploratory wells. (v) Costs of drilling exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells. (13) Exploratory well. An exploratory well is a well drilled to find a new field or to find a new reservoir in a field previously found to be productive of oil or gas in another reservoir. Generally, an exploratory well is any well that is not a development well, an extension well, a service well, or a stratigraphic test well as those items are defined in this section. (14) Extension well. An extension well is a well drilled to extend the limits of a known reservoir. (15) Field. An area consisting of a single reservoir or multiple reservoirs all grouped on or related to the same individual geological structural feature and/or stratigraphic condition. There may be two or more reservoirs in a field which are separated vertically by intervening impervious strata, or laterally by local geologic barriers, or by both. Reservoirs that are associated by being in overlapping or adjacent fields may be treated as a single or common operational field. The geological terms "structural feature" and "stratigraphic condition" are intended to identify localized geological features as opposed to the broader terms of basins, trends, provinces, plays, areas-of-interest, etc. (16) Oil and gas producing activities. (i) Oil and gas producing activities include: (A) The search for crude oil, including condensate and natural gas liquids, or natural gas ("oil and gas") in their natural states and original locations; (B) The acquisition of property rights or properties for the purpose of further exploration or for the purpose of removing the oil or gas from such properties; (C) The construction, drilling, and production activities necessary to retrieve oil and gas from their natural reservoirs, including the acquisition, construction, installation, and maintenance of field gathering and storage systems, such as: (1) Lifting the oil and gas to the surface; and (2) Gathering, treating, and field processing (as in the case of processing gas to extract liquid hydrocarbons); and Definitions - Page 2 of 6


 
DEFINITIONS OF OIL AND GAS RESERVES Adapted from U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a) (D) Extraction of saleable hydrocarbons, in the solid, liquid, or gaseous state, from oil sands, shale, coalbeds, or other nonrenewable natural resources which are intended to be upgraded into synthetic oil or gas, and activities undertaken with a view to such extraction. Instruction 1 to paragraph (a)(16)(i): The oil and gas production function shall be regarded as ending at a "terminal point", which is the outlet valve on the lease or field storage tank. If unusual physical or operational circumstances exist, it may be appropriate to regard the terminal point for the production function as: a. The first point at which oil, gas, or gas liquids, natural or synthetic, are delivered to a main pipeline, a common carrier, a refinery, or a marine terminal; and b. In the case of natural resources that are intended to be upgraded into synthetic oil or gas, if those natural resources are delivered to a purchaser prior to upgrading, the first point at which the natural resources are delivered to a main pipeline, a common carrier, a refinery, a marine terminal, or a facility which upgrades such natural resources into synthetic oil or gas. Instruction 2 to paragraph (a)(16)(i): For purposes of this paragraph (a)(16), the term saleable hydrocarbons means hydrocarbons that are saleable in the state in which the hydrocarbons are delivered. (ii) Oil and gas producing activities do not include: (A) Transporting, refining, or marketing oil and gas; (B) Processing of produced oil, gas, or natural resources that can be upgraded into synthetic oil or gas by a registrant that does not have the legal right to produce or a revenue interest in such production; (C) Activities relating to the production of natural resources other than oil, gas, or natural resources from which synthetic oil and gas can be extracted; or (D) Production of geothermal steam. (17) Possible reserves. Possible reserves are those additional reserves that are less certain to be recovered than probable reserves. (i) When deterministic methods are used, the total quantities ultimately recovered from a project have a low probability of exceeding proved plus probable plus possible reserves. When probabilistic methods are used, there should be at least a 10% probability that the total quantities ultimately recovered will equal or exceed the proved plus probable plus possible reserves estimates. (ii) Possible reserves may be assigned to areas of a reservoir adjacent to probable reserves where data control and interpretations of available data are progressively less certain. Frequently, this will be in areas where geoscience and engineering data are unable to define clearly the area and vertical limits of commercial production from the reservoir by a defined project. (iii) Possible reserves also include incremental quantities associated with a greater percentage recovery of the hydrocarbons in place than the recovery quantities assumed for probable reserves. (iv) The proved plus probable and proved plus probable plus possible reserves estimates must be based on reasonable alternative technical and commercial interpretations within the reservoir or subject project that are clearly documented, including comparisons to results in successful similar projects. (v) Possible reserves may be assigned where geoscience and engineering data identify directly adjacent portions of a reservoir within the same accumulation that may be separated from proved areas by faults with displacement less than formation thickness or other geological discontinuities and that have not been penetrated by a wellbore, and the registrant believes that such adjacent portions are in communication with the known (proved) reservoir. Possible reserves may be assigned to areas that are structurally higher or lower than the proved area if these areas are in communication with the proved reservoir. (vi) Pursuant to paragraph (a)(22)(iii) of this section, where direct observation has defined a highest known oil (HKO) elevation and the potential exists for an associated gas cap, proved oil reserves should be assigned in the structurally higher portions of the reservoir above the HKO only if the higher contact can be established with reasonable certainty through reliable technology. Portions of the reservoir that do not meet this reasonable certainty criterion may be assigned as probable and possible oil or gas based on reservoir fluid properties and pressure gradient interpretations. (18) Probable reserves. Probable reserves are those additional reserves that are less certain to be recovered than proved reserves but which, together with proved reserves, are as likely as not to be recovered. (i) When deterministic methods are used, it is as likely as not that actual remaining quantities recovered will exceed the sum of estimated proved plus probable reserves. When probabilistic methods are used, there should be at least a 50% probability that the actual quantities recovered will equal or exceed the proved plus probable reserves estimates. Definitions - Page 3 of 6


 
DEFINITIONS OF OIL AND GAS RESERVES Adapted from U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a) (ii) Probable reserves may be assigned to areas of a reservoir adjacent to proved reserves where data control or interpretations of available data are less certain, even if the interpreted reservoir continuity of structure or productivity does not meet the reasonable certainty criterion. Probable reserves may be assigned to areas that are structurally higher than the proved area if these areas are in communication with the proved reservoir. (iii) Probable reserves estimates also include potential incremental quantities associated with a greater percentage recovery of the hydrocarbons in place than assumed for proved reserves. (iv) See also guidelines in paragraphs (a)(17)(iv) and (a)(17)(vi) of this section. (19) Probabilistic estimate. The method of estimation of reserves or resources is called probabilistic when the full range of values that could reasonably occur for each unknown parameter (from the geoscience and engineering data) is used to generate a full range of possible outcomes and their associated probabilities of occurrence. (20) Production costs. (i) Costs incurred to operate and maintain wells and related equipment and facilities, including depreciation and applicable operating costs of support equipment and facilities and other costs of operating and maintaining those wells and related equipment and facilities. They become part of the cost of oil and gas produced. Examples of production costs (sometimes called lifting costs) are: (A) Costs of labor to operate the wells and related equipment and facilities. (B) Repairs and maintenance. (C) Materials, supplies, and fuel consumed and supplies utilized in operating the wells and related equipment and facilities. (D) Property taxes and insurance applicable to proved properties and wells and related equipment and facilities. (E) Severance taxes. (ii) Some support equipment or facilities may serve two or more oil and gas producing activities and may also serve transportation, refining, and marketing activities. To the extent that the support equipment and facilities are used in oil and gas producing activities, their depreciation and applicable operating costs become exploration, development or production costs, as appropriate. Depreciation, depletion, and amortization of capitalized acquisition, exploration, and development costs are not production costs but also become part of the cost of oil and gas produced along with production (lifting) costs identified above. (21) Proved area. The part of a property to which proved reserves have been specifically attributed. (22) Proved oil and gas reserves. Proved oil and gas reserves are those quantities of oil and gas, which, by analysis of geoscience and engineering data, can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible—from a given date forward, from known reservoirs, and under existing economic conditions, operating methods, and government regulations—prior to the time at which contracts providing the right to operate expire, unless evidence indicates that renewal is reasonably certain, regardless of whether deterministic or probabilistic methods are used for the estimation. The project to extract the hydrocarbons must have commenced or the operator must be reasonably certain that it will commence the project within a reasonable time. (i) The area of the reservoir considered as proved includes: (A) The area identified by drilling and limited by fluid contacts, if any, and (B) Adjacent undrilled portions of the reservoir that can, with reasonable certainty, be judged to be continuous with it and to contain economically producible oil or gas on the basis of available geoscience and engineering data. (ii) In the absence of data on fluid contacts, proved quantities in a reservoir are limited by the lowest known hydrocarbons (LKH) as seen in a well penetration unless geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establishes a lower contact with reasonable certainty. (iii) Where direct observation from well penetrations has defined a highest known oil (HKO) elevation and the potential exists for an associated gas cap, proved oil reserves may be assigned in the structurally higher portions of the reservoir only if geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establish the higher contact with reasonable certainty. (iv) Reserves which can be produced economically through application of improved recovery techniques (including, but not limited to, fluid injection) are included in the proved classification when: (A) Successful testing by a pilot project in an area of the reservoir with properties no more favorable than in the reservoir as a whole, the operation of an installed program in the reservoir or an analogous reservoir, or other evidence using reliable technology establishes the reasonable certainty of the engineering analysis on which the project or program was based; and Definitions - Page 4 of 6


 
DEFINITIONS OF OIL AND GAS RESERVES Adapted from U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a) (B) The project has been approved for development by all necessary parties and entities, including governmental entities. (v) Existing economic conditions include prices and costs at which economic producibility from a reservoir is to be determined. The price shall be the average price during the 12-month period prior to the ending date of the period covered by the report, determined as an unweighted arithmetic average of the first-day-of-the-month price for each month within such period, unless prices are defined by contractual arrangements, excluding escalations based upon future conditions. (23) Proved properties. Properties with proved reserves. (24) Reasonable certainty. If deterministic methods are used, reasonable certainty means a high degree of confidence that the quantities will be recovered. If probabilistic methods are used, there should be at least a 90% probability that the quantities actually recovered will equal or exceed the estimate. A high degree of confidence exists if the quantity is much more likely to be achieved than not, and, as changes due to increased availability of geoscience (geological, geophysical, and geochemical), engineering, and economic data are made to estimated ultimate recovery (EUR) with time, reasonably certain EUR is much more likely to increase or remain constant than to decrease. (25) Reliable technology. Reliable technology is a grouping of one or more technologies (including computational methods) that has been field tested and has been demonstrated to provide reasonably certain results with consistency and repeatability in the formation being evaluated or in an analogous formation. (26) Reserves. Reserves are estimated remaining quantities of oil and gas and related substances anticipated to be economically producible, as of a given date, by application of development projects to known accumulations. In addition, there must exist, or there must be a reasonable expectation that there will exist, the legal right to produce or a revenue interest in the production, installed means of delivering oil and gas or related substances to market, and all permits and financing required to implement the project. Note to paragraph (a)(26): Reserves should not be assigned to adjacent reservoirs isolated by major, potentially sealing, faults until those reservoirs are penetrated and evaluated as economically producible. Reserves should not be assigned to areas that are clearly separated from a known accumulation by a non-productive reservoir (i.e., absence of reservoir, structurally low reservoir, or negative test results). Such areas may contain prospective resources (i.e., potentially recoverable resources from undiscovered accumulations). Excerpted from the FASB Accounting Standards Codification Topic 932, Extractive Activities—Oil and Gas: 932-235-50-30 A standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows relating to an entity's interests in both of the following shall be disclosed as of the end of the year: a. Proved oil and gas reserves (see paragraphs 932-235-50-3 through 50-11B) b. Oil and gas subject to purchase under long-term supply, purchase, or similar agreements and contracts in which the entity participates in the operation of the properties on which the oil or gas is located or otherwise serves as the producer of those reserves (see paragraph 932-235-50-7). The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows relating to those two types of interests in reserves may be combined for reporting purposes. 932-235-50-31 All of the following information shall be disclosed in the aggregate and for each geographic area for which reserve quantities are disclosed in accordance with paragraphs 932-235-50-3 through 50-11B: a. Future cash inflows. These shall be computed by applying prices used in estimating the entity's proved oil and gas reserves to the year-end quantities of those reserves. Future price changes shall be considered only to the extent provided by contractual arrangements in existence at year-end. b. Future development and production costs. These costs shall be computed by estimating the expenditures to be incurred in developing and producing the proved oil and gas reserves at the end of the year, based on year-end costs and assuming continuation of existing economic conditions. If estimated development expenditures are significant, they shall be presented separately from estimated production costs. c. Future income tax expenses. These expenses shall be computed by applying the appropriate year-end statutory tax rates, with consideration of future tax rates already legislated, to the future pretax net cash flows relating to the entity's proved oil and gas reserves, less the tax basis of the properties involved. The future income tax expenses shall give effect to tax deductions and tax credits and allowances relating to the entity's proved oil and gas reserves. d. Future net cash flows. These amounts are the result of subtracting future development and production costs and future income tax expenses from future cash inflows. Definitions - Page 5 of 6


 
DEFINITIONS OF OIL AND GAS RESERVES Adapted from U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-X Section 210.4-10(a) e. Discount. This amount shall be derived from using a discount rate of 10 percent a year to reflect the timing of the future net cash flows relating to proved oil and gas reserves. f. Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows. This amount is the future net cash flows less the computed discount. (27) Reservoir. A porous and permeable underground formation containing a natural accumulation of producible oil and/or gas that is confined by impermeable rock or water barriers and is individual and separate from other reservoirs. (28) Resources. Resources are quantities of oil and gas estimated to exist in naturally occurring accumulations. A portion of the resources may be estimated to be recoverable, and another portion may be considered to be unrecoverable. Resources include both discovered and undiscovered accumulations. (29) Service well. A well drilled or completed for the purpose of supporting production in an existing field. Specific purposes of service wells include gas injection, water injection, steam injection, air injection, salt-water disposal, water supply for injection, observation, or injection for in-situ combustion. (30) Stratigraphic test well. A stratigraphic test well is a drilling effort, geologically directed, to obtain information pertaining to a specific geologic condition. Such wells customarily are drilled without the intent of being completed for hydrocarbon production. The classification also includes tests identified as core tests and all types of expendable holes related to hydrocarbon exploration. Stratigraphic tests are classified as "exploratory type" if not drilled in a known area or "development type" if drilled in a known area. (31) Undeveloped oil and gas reserves. Undeveloped oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that are expected to be recovered from new wells on undrilled acreage, or from existing wells where a relatively major expenditure is required for recompletion. (i) Reserves on undrilled acreage shall be limited to those directly offsetting development spacing areas that are reasonably certain of production when drilled, unless evidence using reliable technology exists that establishes reasonable certainty of economic producibility at greater distances. (ii) Undrilled locations can be classified as having undeveloped reserves only if a development plan has been adopted indicating that they are scheduled to be drilled within five years, unless the specific circumstances, justify a longer time. From the SEC's Compliance and Disclosure Interpretations (October 26, 2009): Although several types of projects — such as constructing offshore platforms and development in urban areas, remote locations or environmentally sensitive locations — by their nature customarily take a longer time to develop and therefore often do justify longer time periods, this determination must always take into consideration all of the facts and circumstances. No particular type of project per se justifies a longer time period, and any extension beyond five years should be the exception, and not the rule. Factors that a company should consider in determining whether or not circumstances justify recognizing reserves even though development may extend past five years include, but are not limited to, the following:  The company's level of ongoing significant development activities in the area to be developed (for example, drilling only the minimum number of wells necessary to maintain the lease generally would not constitute significant development activities);  The company's historical record at completing development of comparable long-term projects;  The amount of time in which the company has maintained the leases, or booked the reserves, without significant development activities;  The extent to which the company has followed a previously adopted development plan (for example, if a company has changed its development plan several times without taking significant steps to implement any of those plans, recognizing proved undeveloped reserves typically would not be appropriate); and  The extent to which delays in development are caused by external factors related to the physical operating environment (for example, restrictions on development on Federal lands, but not obtaining government permits), rather than by internal factors (for example, shifting resources to develop properties with higher priority). (iii) Under no circumstances shall estimates for undeveloped reserves be attributable to any acreage for which an application of fluid injection or other improved recovery technique is contemplated, unless such techniques have been proved effective by actual projects in the same reservoir or an analogous reservoir, as defined in paragraph (a)(2) of this section, or by other evidence using reliable technology establishing reasonable certainty. (32) Unproved properties. Properties with no proved reserves. Definitions - Page 6 of 6


 



Exhibit 15.7

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
We consent to the incorporation by reference of our report dated 29 March 2018, with respect to the group financial statements of BP p.l.c. included in this Annual Report and Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2019 in the following Registration Statements:


Registration Statements on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-226485, 333-226485-01, 333-226485-02) of BP p.l.c., BP Capital Markets p.l.c., and BP Capital Markets America Inc.; and Registration Statements on Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-67206, 333-79399, 333-103924, 333-123482, 333-123483, 333-131583, 333-131584, 333-132619, 333-146868, 333-146870, 333-146873, 333-173136, 333-177423, 333-179406, 333-186462, 333-186463, 333-199015, 333-200794, 333-200795, 333-207188, 333-207189, 333-210316 and 333-210318) of BP p.l.c.


/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
London, United Kingdom
18 March 2020






Exhibit 15.8

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
We consent to the incorporation by reference of our reports dated 18 March 2020, relating to the consolidated financial statements of BP p.l.c. (the 'company'), and the effectiveness of the company's internal control over financial reporting, appearing in this Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2019, in the following Registration Statements:

Registration Statement Nos. 333-226485, 333-226485-01 and 333-226485-02 of the company, BP Capital Markets p.l.c. and BP Capital Markets America Inc. on Form F-3; and
Registration Statement Nos. 333-67206, 333-79399, 333-103924, 333-123482, 333-123483, 333-131583, 333-131584, 333-132619, 333-146868, 333-146870, 333-146873, 333-173136, 333-177423, 333-179406, 333-186462, 333-186463, 333-199015, 333-200794, 333-200795, 333-207188, 333-207189, 333-210316, 333-210318 of the company on Form S-8.


/s/ Deloitte LLP
London, United Kingdom
18 March 2020